NEC Water System N 1093100 User Manual

Empowered by Innovation  
Software Manual  
P/N 1093100  
Rev 3, June 2006  
Printed in U.S.A.  
01.00.00  
For additional resources, visit our Technical Support site on the web at http://www.necdsx.com.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
Table of Contents  
Table of  
Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Table of Contents  
i
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
ii  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Table of Contents  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
iv  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Table of Contents  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
vi  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Table of Contents  
vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
viii  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Table of Contents  
ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
x
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Table of Contents  
xi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
xii  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Table of Contents  
xiii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
xiv  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Table of Contents  
xv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
xvi  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Table of Contents  
xvii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
xviii  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Table of Contents  
xix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
xx  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Table of Contents  
xxi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
xxii  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Table of Contents  
xxiii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
354x-1+XXX-XXX / TBL-A XXXXXXX (1 + NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table) .  
xxiv  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Table of Contents  
xxv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
xxvi  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Table of Contents  
xxvii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
xxviii  
Table of Contents  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Using the DSX Software Manual  
Using the DSX Software Manual  
How the Manual is Organized  
This manual describes the features and programming of the DSX telephone system. It is divided into eight  
chapters as follows:  
Introduction  
This is the chapter you are reading now. It provides information about the DSX system’s default feature  
setup and basic startup programming. You’ll also nd handy charts for system codes and capacities, as  
well as key layout illustrations for each DSX telephone.  
Features  
The Features chapter contains the description, programming, related features, and operation for each  
DSX telephone system feature. The programming required to customize each feature is presented in a  
handy, easy to understand, step-by-step guide. For feature operation, use the convenient operation charts  
at the end of each feature.  
IntraMail  
For description, programming, related features and operation of each IntraMail Voice Mail with Auto-  
mated Attendant feature, turn to the IntraMail chapter.  
System 1001-1702  
Turn to this chapter for details on the DSX system option programming.  
Station 2101-2501  
Refer to this chapter for details on the DSX station option programming.  
Line 3101-3715  
For details on the DSX line option programming, read this chapter.  
Voice Mail 4101-4231  
When setting up IntraMail, you’ll nd the details on each IntraMail option in this chapter. This chapter  
also provides the specics on options required for UltraMail and external NVM-Series voice mail.  
Maintenance 9001-9042  
You will nd details on the maintenance options in this chapter.  
Additionally, at the end of this manual are the DSX Program List (page 929) and Index (page 947).  
The System Document CD  
The System Document CD provided with your system contains documentation, software, and other DSX  
resources. Insert this CD into your PC and browse through its contents.  
DSX Software Manual  
Introduction  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Default Feature Setup  
Default Feature Setup  
Default Features  
Default Features for Lines  
All lines are loop start DTMF.  
1.  
2.  
In DSX-80/160, lines 1-12 ring on line keys 1-12 for extensions 300-315.  
All other extensions are lamp only for lines 1-12.  
Lines 13-64 do not appear on line keys.  
In DSX40, lines 1-8 ring on line keys 1-8.  
Lines 5-8 require the Line Expansion Board.  
3.  
4.  
To customize line ringing, use one of the following:  
Default Features for Extensions  
1.  
2.  
The circuit types for keyset extensions are automatically set when the extension is plugged in.  
Keyset users can place outside calls by:  
Pressing a line key and dialing the outside number.  
Pressing INTERCOM, dialing 9, then dialing the outside number.  
Line Dial-Up and Direct Line Access are disabled.  
All extensions have full incoming and outgoing access to all outside lines.  
See Initial Startup Programming on the next page if you want to change this assignment.  
3.  
4.  
The default Feature Key assignments are:  
Keys 1-12 (1-8 on DSX-40) are line keys.  
Keys 13-24 (9-24 on DSX-40) are undened.  
At the attendant’s telephone:  
5.  
Key 12 (on 22-button) or key 24 (on 34-button) is an Operator Call Key.  
-Use the Operator Call Key to answer incoming Intercom calls queued at the attendant’s extension. See Attendant  
Default Features for IntraMail  
1.  
2.  
Each extension has an IntraMail voice mailbox.  
All mailboxes are enabled.  
The IntraMail Automated Attendant does not answer outside calls.  
To set up the Automated Attendant, turn to Automated Attendant (page 433).  
3.  
2
Introduction  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Default Feature Setup  
Initial Startup Programming  
1.  
Enter the programming mode.  
1. From any display telephone:  
- Press INTERCOM + Dial #*#*  
- Enter the system password + HOLD  
2. The system passwords are:  
- 632379 (NECDSX) for Installer (level 3)  
- 9999 for System Administrator 2 (level 2)  
- 0000 for System Administrator 1 (level 1)  
2.  
3.  
Assign the correct circuit type to each of your installed lines.  
- 51 for loop start DTMF  
- 52 for loop start DP  
By default, each extension has full incoming and outgoing access to each line.To change this  
assignment:  
1. If yes, in 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763), change each extension’s line access as required:  
- 0 for no access  
- 1 for incoming access only  
- 2 for outgoing access only  
- 3 for full access  
2. Using 902x-Copy (page 921) may save you time.  
By default, all extensions 300-315 ring immediately day and night for on lines 1-12.To change  
this assignment:  
4.  
- 0 for lamp only (no ringing) day and night  
- 1 for day and night ringing  
- 2 for night ringing only  
- 3 for delay ringing day and night  
2. Using 902x-Copy (page 921) may save you time.  
5.  
6.  
To change the default system passwords:  
To return the system to the factory installed (default) programming:  
DSX Software Manual  
Introduction  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Default Feature Setup  
Checking your System’s Software Level  
How to Check your System’s Software Level  
To check your system’s software level:  
1.  
2.  
Press INTERCOM.  
Dial #*#*.  
• The system software level shows on the rst line of your display.  
You see: DSX-nn vxx.xx.xx  
3.  
Press SPEAKER to exit.  
4
Introduction  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Charts  
Charts  
DSX Dial Codes by Feature (Page 1 of 2)  
For this feature  
Barge In (Intrusion)  
Call Forwarding  
Dial this code  
4
When you are  
Barging-In on a co-worker’s call  
INTERCOM + *30  
Canceling Call Forwarding at an  
extension  
INTERCOM + *32 + Extension or 0  
(for the operator)  
Enabling Call Forwarding Busy/No  
Answer  
INTERCOM + *33  
Setting up Call Forwarding Off  
Premise  
INTERCOM + *34 + Extension or 0  
(for the operator)  
Enabling Call Forwarding All Calls  
INTERCOM + *36 + Extension or 0  
(for the operator)  
Enabling Call Forwarding No Answer  
INTERCOM + *37 + 2 (all calls) or 8 Setting up Personal Answering  
(outside calls)  
Machine Emulation  
2 + Do not hang up  
Camping-On to a co-worker  
Leaving a Callback for a co-worker  
Call Waiting / Camp-On  
2 + Hang up  
INTERCOM + #9 + Line number  
(e.g., 01)  
Using Line Dial-Up to place an out-  
side call  
Central Ofce Calls, Placing  
INTERCOM + Line extension number Using Direct Line Access to place an  
(e.g., 101)  
outside call  
INTERCOM + 9 or 90-98  
Accessing a Line Group to place an  
outside call  
*
Previewing a number before dialing  
Dial Number Preview  
Directed Call Pickup  
INTERCOM + ** + Extension  
Intercepting a call ringing a  
co-worker’s extension  
#3  
Flashing a line at a single line  
extension  
Flash  
Forced Line Disconnect  
Group Call Pickup  
Hold  
#
Using Forced Line Disconnect to dis-  
connect a busy outside line  
INTERCOM + *#  
Answering a call ringing a phone in  
your Pickup Group  
INTERCOM + *4 + Line number (e.g., Picking up an outside call on System  
01)  
Hold at a co-worker’s extension  
INTERCOM + Extension (e.g., 301)  
Placing an Intercom call to a co-  
worker  
Intercom  
INTERCOM + #11 or # 12  
Setting up or joining a Meet-Me Con-  
ference  
Meet-Me Conference  
DSX Software Manual  
Introduction  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Charts  
DSX Dial Codes by Feature (Page 2 of 2)  
For this feature  
Dial this code  
6
When you are  
Setting up Monitor after calling a busy  
co-worker  
Monitor / Silent Monitor  
** + UNA code (01-04)  
Answering a call ringing UNA at  
night  
Night Service / Night Ring  
INTERCOM + *1 + Page zone (1-7 or Making an internal Paging announce-  
0 for All Call) ment  
Paging  
Park  
INTERCOM + * + System Park Orbit Parking or retrieving a call from Sys-  
(60-69)  
tem Park Orbit  
INTERCOM + ** + Extension (e.g.,  
301)  
Using Personal Park to Park or  
retrieve a call at a co-workers exten-  
sion  
INTERCOM + #40 + Extension (e.g., Removing or returning an extension  
301) or line (e.g., 101) + 4 (to return) or line to service  
or 6 (to remove)  
Removing Lines and Extensions  
From Service  
INTERCOM + *38 + Message (00-16) Enabling a Selectable Display Mes-  
+ Hold + Add additional digits + Hold sage  
Selectable Display Messaging  
INTERCOM + # + System bin (201-  
299) or Personal bin (701-720)  
Dialing a System or Personal Speed  
Dial number  
Speed Dial  
Transfer  
INTERCOM + Extension (e.g., 301)  
Transferring a call to a co-worker’s  
extension  
INTERCOM + Extension (e.g., 301) + Transferring a call to a co-worker’s  
V-MAIL  
mailbox  
2
Queuing or leaving a Callback for a  
busy line  
Line Queuing / Line Callback  
Voice Mail  
INTERCOM + V-MAIL  
Calling your mailbox from your key-  
set  
Lift handset + *8  
Calling your mailbox from your single  
line telephone  
INTERCOM + Extension (e.g., 301) + Transferring a call to a co-worker’s  
V-MAIL  
mailbox from your keyset  
Hookash + Extension (e.g., 301) + 8 Transferring a call to a co-worker’s  
mailbox from your single line telephone  
INTERCOM + *37 + 2 (all calls) or 8 Setting up Personal Answering  
(outside calls)  
Machine Emulation  
INTERCOM + *30  
Canceling Personal Answering  
Machine Emulation  
9
Initiating a Voice Over to a busy  
extension (after hearing busy/ring  
tone)  
Voice Over  
6
Introduction  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Charts  
System Number Plan/Capacities (Page 1 of 2)  
DSX40  
DSX80/160  
System Options  
Classes of Service  
Conference  
1-15  
(COS 1 normally reserved for attendants)  
32 simultaneous users in Conference (total of all Conferences system-wide)  
8 simultaneous Conferences maximum  
8 parties maximum in any one Conference  
Extension Hunting (UCD) Master  
Numbers  
8
Extension Hunting Groups  
Group Call Pickup Groups  
Privacy Release Groups  
Speed Dial, Personal  
8 (1-8)  
8 (1-8, 0 = unassigned)  
16 (1-16, 0 = unassigned)  
20 bins at each extension (701-720)  
Speed Dial, System  
Tenant Groups  
999  
1
Timeslots  
Non-blocking  
7 (1-7, 0 = no restriction)  
1 (normally 700)  
Toll Restriction Levels  
Voice Mail Master Numbers  
Lines  
Direct Line Access Codes  
Line Dial Up Codes  
Ring Groups  
101-108  
101-164  
#901-#908  
#901-#964  
8 (1-8)  
0 = no assignment  
Ring Group master numbers are normally 600-607.  
Line Group Access Codes  
Line Groups  
90-98  
9 (0-8)  
Line Ports  
8 (1-8)  
Lines 5-8 require the Expansion Board.  
64 (1-64)  
Extensions  
Attendant (Operator) Access  
Number  
0 (single operator)  
01-04 (multiple operators)  
Attendants  
4
DSX Software Manual  
Introduction  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Charts  
System Number Plan/Capacities (Page 2 of 2)  
DSX40  
DSX80/160  
Analog Door Boxes, Built-In  
Analog Door Boxes, Total  
2
0
The maximum number of DSX Analog Door Boxes you can install is determined by  
the number of 2PGDAD Modules, which in turn is limited only by the availability  
of 16ESIU station ports.  
DSS Consoles  
4
The System Load Factor may limit the total number that you can install. Refer to  
the system’s Hardware Manual  
.
Telephone Extension Numbers  
Telephone Station Numbers  
Total Number of Station Devices  
300-325  
34 (1-34)  
34  
300-427  
128 (1-128)  
128  
May be limited by load factor.  
This includes digital extensions, analog  
extensions, and analog Door Boxes.  
Paging and Park  
Page Zones (Internal)  
Page Zone (External)  
Page Relays  
7 zones (1-7) and All Call (0)  
All Call and zone 1 broadcast from the Page audio minijack  
2 in each built-in Door Box port  
2 in each 2PGDAD Module (Future)  
2 in each 2PGDAD Module (Future)  
Park Orbits  
10 (60-69)  
Orbits 68 and 69 have extended (5 min.) timers  
Passwords  
System Administrator 1  
(Level 1)  
0000  
System Administrator 2  
(Level 2)  
9999  
Installer (Level 3)  
632379 (NECDSX)  
8
Introduction  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Telephone Illustrations  
Telephone Illustrations  
Ring/Message Lamp  
Thu June 8  
Pat Smith  
Menu Dir VM:00 CL:00  
11:52 AM  
x301  
Alpanumeric Display  
CHECK  
CLEAR  
Speed Dial  
Bin keys  
Soft keys  
Feature keys  
In DSX-40:  
Keys 1-8 are line keys.  
Keys 9-12 are undefined.  
Line 1  
Line 7  
Line 2  
Line 8  
Line 3  
Line 9  
Line 4  
Line 5  
Line 6  
Line 10  
Line 11  
Line 12  
In DSX-80/160:  
Keys 1-12 are line keys.  
ABC  
JKL  
TUV  
DEF  
TRANSFER  
INTERCOM  
For Attendants:  
FLASH  
REDIAL  
MUTE  
V-MAIL  
DND  
MNO  
GHI  
Key 12 is the  
Operator Call key.  
PQRS  
WXYZ  
CONF  
HOLD  
SPEAKER  
VOLUME  
Microphone  
Fixed Function keys  
22-Button Display Telephone  
DSX Software Manual  
Introduction  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Telephone Illustrations  
Ring/Message Lamp  
Alpanumeric Display  
Thu June 8  
Pat Smith  
Menu Dir VM:00 CL:00  
11:52 AM  
x301  
CHECK  
CLEAR  
Speed Dial  
Bin keys  
Soft keys  
Feature keys  
Line 1  
Line 7  
Line 2  
Line 8  
Line 3  
Line 9  
Line 4  
Line 5  
Line 6  
In DSX-40:  
Keys 1-8 are line keys.  
Keys 9-24 are undefined.  
Line 10  
Line 11  
Line 12  
In DSX-80/160:  
Keys 1-12 are line keys.  
Keys 13-24 are undefined.  
ABC  
JKL  
TUV  
DEF  
TRANSFER  
INTERCOM  
FLASH  
REDIAL  
MUTE  
V-MAIL  
DND  
For Attendants:  
MNO  
GHI  
Key 24 is the  
Operator Call key.  
PQRS  
WXYZ  
CONF  
HOLD  
SPEAKER  
VOLUME  
Microphone  
Fixed Function keys  
34-Button Display Telephone  
10  
Introduction  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Telephone Illustrations  
Ring/Message Lamp  
CHECK  
CLEAR  
Thu June 8  
Pat Smith  
11:52 AM  
x301  
Alpanumeric Display  
Menu  
Director  
y
Soft keys  
V-Mail 00  
Calls 00  
Pa e  
Soft keys  
SP Dial 1  
SP Dial 2  
g
Feature keys  
Line 1  
Line 2  
Line 8  
Line 3  
Line 9  
Line 4  
Line 5  
Line 6  
In DSX-40:  
Keys 1-8 are line keys.  
Line 7  
Line 10  
Line 11  
Line 12  
Keys 9-24 are undefined.  
In DSX-80/160:  
Keys 1-12 are line keys.  
Keys 13-24 are undefined.  
ABC  
JKL  
TUV  
DEF  
TRANSFER  
INTERCOM  
FLASH  
REDIAL  
MUTE  
V-MAIL  
DND  
For Attendants:  
MNO  
GHI  
Key 24 is the  
Operator Call key.  
PQRS  
WXYZ  
CONF  
HOLD  
SPEAKER  
VOLUME  
Microphone  
Fixed Function keys  
34-Button Super Display Telephone  
DSX Software Manual  
Introduction  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Telephone Illustrations  
300  
306  
301  
307  
302  
308  
303  
309  
315  
321  
327  
333  
339  
345  
304  
310  
305  
311  
312  
313  
314  
316  
317  
318  
319  
320  
322  
323  
324  
325  
326  
328  
329  
330  
331  
332  
334  
335  
336  
337  
338  
340  
341  
342  
343  
344  
346  
347  
ALL  
Page 1  
Park 62  
Page 2  
Park 63  
Page 3  
Park 64  
Park 60  
Park 66  
Park 61  
Night  
CALL  
Park 65  
ANSWER  
RELEASE  
TRANSFER  
60-Button DSS Console  
12  
Introduction  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Features  
Introduction  
Introduction  
How To Use This Chapter  
This chapter provides detailed information on the system’s features. The features in this chapter are in alpha-  
betical order, like a dictionary, and are subdivided into headings as follows:  
Description  
Read Description to get an overview of the feature. Along with the feature’s description is the Default  
Setting, which outlines how the feature works with the default (factory installed) programming. When  
initially installed, the system uses the default setting. For specic default settings on each programmable  
option, follow the cross-reference to that option.  
Programming  
This heading provides a handy, easy to understand, step-by-step guide to the system programming  
required to activate and/or customize the feature. If you need more detail about an option, follow the  
cross-reference to that option.  
Related Features  
Read Related Features to learn how the feature interacts with other features.  
Operation  
Refer to this heading for convenient, compact, yet detailed operation charts for using each feature.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Account Codes  
Account Codes  
Description  
Use Account codes to categorize and/or restrict outside calls.  
Account Codes are user-dialed codes that help categorize and/or restrict outside calls. Account Codes are  
from 2-10 digits long, using any combination of the digits 0-9. There are three types of Account Codes:  
Optional (Unforced Account Codes)  
Forced Account Codes  
Veried Account Codes  
Optional (Unforced) Account Codes  
Optional Account Codes allow a keyset extension user to enter an Account Code while placing an outside  
call or any time while on a call. This type of Account Code is optional: the system does not require the user  
to enter it. If the keyset user is already talking on an outside call, their conversation continues uninterrupted  
while they enter an Account Code.  
Single line telephone users can only enter an Account Code while placing their outside call.  
Forced Account Codes  
Forced Account Codes require an extension user to enter an Account Code every time they place an outside  
call. If the user doesn’t enter the code, the system prevents the call. The system can require Forced Account  
Codes for all outside calls, or just for toll calls (as determined by Toll Restriction programming). Note that  
Forced Account Codes do not pertain to incoming calls.  
Veried Account Codes  
With Veried Account Codes, the system compares the Account Code the user dials with a list of codes pro-  
grammed into the Veried Account Code Table. If the Account Code is in the table, the call goes through  
(provided it is not prevented by an extension’s Toll Restriction programming). If the code is not in the table,  
the system prevents the call. Veried Account Codes, if enabled, apply only to Forced Account Codes.  
Using Account Codes and Speed Dial  
To simplify Account Code operation, Personal and System Speed Dial bins can contain Account Codes.  
Keep the following in mind when using Speed Dial and Account Codes:  
The Account Code can be either the rst or last entry in the bin, and must be preceded and followed by  
the # character. For example, the Account Code 1234 must be entered as #1234#.  
The Speed Dial bin can contain an Account Code followed by an outside number, or just the Account  
Code. The Account Code must be preceded and followed by a # entry. If the bin contains just the  
Account Code, the user must be sure to press the bin key before dialing the outside number.  
If the system has Veried Account Codes enabled, the Account Code entered in the Speed Dial bin must  
match an entry in the Veried Account Code Table.  
If the Speed Dial bin does not contain an Account Code, the user must enter the Account Code manually.  
If Forced Account Codes are enabled, the system requires the user to enter the Account Code before it  
outdials the stored Speed Dial number.  
An extension user can preselect a line for a Speed Dial call.  
Using Account Codes with Last Number Redial and Save  
Last Number Redial and Save do not store Account Codes. This means that the user must manually enter an  
Account Code to have it included with a call dialed using Last Number Redial and Save. If Forced Account  
Codes are enabled, the system requires the user to enter the Account Code before it outdials the stored num-  
ber saved by Last Number Redial or Save.  
14  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Account Codes  
An extension user can preselect a line for a Last Number Redial or Save call.  
Account Codes and Emergency Calls  
Account Codes are never enforced for emergency (911 and 1+911) calls.  
DSS Console Account Code Key  
A keyset user can have an Account Code key on their DSS Console. It works the same as a keyset Account  
Code key.  
Conditions  
• Do not use Account Codes that begin with 911 or 1911.  
Default Setting  
• Account Codes disabled.  
Programming  
General Account Code Programming  
1.  
2.  
Should users be able to store Account Codes in Speed Dial bins?  
While on outside calls, should extension users be able to dial # to enter Account Codes?  
Should Account Code entries by hidden (i.e., replaced by * characters) on each telephone’s  
display?  
3.  
4.  
Should a keyset have an Account Code key to simplify entering Account Codes?  
1. If yes, in 2121-Feature Keys (page 753), select an available key and assign it key code 26.  
2. If no, make sure the keyset has no Account Code keys (key code 26) assigned in 2121-Feature Keys  
Should a keyset’s DSS Console have an Account Code key to simplify entering Account  
Codes?  
5.  
1. If yes, in 2401-Cong (DSS Console Conguration) (page 800), select an available key on the DSS Con-  
sole and assign it key code 26.  
2. If no, make sure the DSS Console has no Account Code keys (key code 26) assigned in 2401-Cong  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Account Codes  
Setting Up Forced Account Codes  
Should an extension have Forced Account Codes (i.e., be required to enter an Account Code  
while placing an outside call)?  
1.  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. If yes (enable Forced Account Codes), in 1412-04: Forced Account Codes (page 651) for the extension’s  
Class of Service level, enterYes.  
3. If no (disable Forced Account Codes), 1412-04: Forced Account Codes (page 651) for the extension’s  
Class of Service level, enter No.  
2.  
Should an extension have Forced Account Codes only for long distance (toll) calls?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. If yes:  
use to differentiate toll calls from local calls.  
3.  
Do you have specic lines that should never require users to enter a Forced Account Code?  
Setting Up Veried Account Codes  
Should an extension be required to enter a Veried Account Code while placing an outside  
call?  
1.  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. If yes:  
Codes Table.  
your Veried Account Codes.  
16  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Account Codes  
Programming Examples  
1.  
Forced Account Codes Require an Account Code only for 900 and 1 + 900 Long Distance Calls.  
Make the following entries for Toll Restriction Level 2.  
(i.e., deny nothing). This is the default setting.  
900.  
deny table with no entries (i.e., deny nothing). This is the default entry.  
900.  
with no entries (i.e., deny nothing). This is the default setting.  
to the extension.  
sure the extension does not use Toll Level 2. If it does, Toll Restriction will always deny 1 + 900 and 900  
calls (regardless of whether the user enters an Account Code).  
With this programming, an extension user can:  
1. Press a line key or dial a code for an outside line.  
2. Wait for a reminder tone (3 beeps).  
• With Forced Account Codes enabled, the system automatically goes into the Account Code mode after  
you press a line key in step 1 above.  
• If you have an Account Code Feature Key, it ashes green.  
3. If dialing a 1 + 900 or 900 call, dial the Account Code.  
If dialing any other long distance call, skip this step.  
4. Press # (if enabled), the Account Code soft key, or an Account Code Feature Key (if programmed).  
5. Dial the outside number.  
• If the user doesn’t enter an Account Code for 900 or 1 + 900 calls, the system will cut off the call.  
• The system will also cut off any call not allowed by the extension’s Toll Restriction programming.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Account Codes  
2.  
Forced Account Codes Allow 800 and 1 + 800 Long Distance Dialing without an Account Code.  
Make the following entries for Toll Restriction Level 2.  
(i.e., deny nothing). This is the default setting.  
enter 800.  
deny table with no entries (i.e., deny nothing). This is the default entry.  
800.  
with no entries (i.e., deny nothing). This is the default setting.  
to the extension.  
With this programming, an extension user can:  
1. Press a line key or dial a code for an outside line.  
2. Wait for a reminder tone (3 beeps).  
• With Forced Account Codes enabled, the system automatically goes into the Account Code mode after  
you press a line key in step 1 above.  
• If you have an Account Code Feature Key, it ashes green.  
3. If dialing a 1 + 800 or 800 call, skip this step.  
If dialing any other long distance call, dial the Account Code.  
4. Press # (if enabled), the Account Code soft key, or an Account Code Feature Key (if programmed).  
5. Dial the outside number.  
• The call will go through without an Account Code. If the user doesn’t enter an Account Code for all  
other calls, the system will cut off the call.  
• The system will also cut off any call not allowed by the extension’s Toll Restriction programming.  
18  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Account Codes  
Other Related Features  
Features  
You can use Store and Forward with Forced Account Codes.  
• Last Number Redial and Save do not store Account Codes. This means that the user must manually  
enter an Account Code to have it included with a call redialed using Last Number Redial and Save.  
• An extension user can store an Account Code in a Speed Dial bin. See Using Account Codes and  
• Account Codes print on the SMDR report.  
Voice mail callout features (such as Message Notication) may interact with Account Codes if the  
callout number contains # characters.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Optional (Unforced) Account Codes  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
For keysets, Optional Account Codes apply to both incoming and outgoing calls. For outgoing calls, you can enter the  
Account Code before or after dialing the outside number.  
For Single Line sets, Optional Account Codes apply only to outgoing calls. You must enter the Account Code after get-  
ting dial tone on the line but before dialing the outside number.  
To enter an Optional (Unforced) Account Code:  
1.  
2.  
Place or Answer outside call.  
Press Account Code soft key.  
[Acct Code]  
[Acct]  
You can optionally press an Account Code Feature Key or dial # (if enabled).  
When you see Enter Account Code, enter Account Code.  
• An Account Code can be up to 10 digits long, using the digits 0-9.  
3.  
Press Account Code soft key.  
You can optionally press an Account Code Feature Key or dial # (if enabled).  
[Acct Code]  
[Acct]  
4.  
5.  
For outside calls only:  
Dial your outside number.  
• Toll Restriction may still prevent you from dialing certain outside numbers.  
a.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Account Codes  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Forced Account Codes  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Forced Account Codes may prevent Speed Dial from dialing 911 emergency services.  
Forced Account Codes do not apply to incoming calls.  
To enter a Forced Account Code:  
Access a line for an outgoing call.  
You hear three beeps.  
1.  
When you see Enter Account Code, enter Account Code.  
• An Account Code can be up to 10 digits long, using the digits 0-9.  
2.  
• If your system has Veried Account Codes enabled, you must enter one from the Veried Account Codes  
Table. If you enter an invalid Veried Account Code, your call will be cut off in the next step.  
• Skip this step to bypass Account Code entry (for example, when dialing a local call and your system requires  
Account Codes only for toll calls).  
Press Account Code soft key.  
You can optionally press an Account Code Feature Key or dial # (if enabled).  
[Acct Code]  
[Acct]  
3.  
4.  
Dial your outside number.  
• Toll Restriction may still prevent you from dialing certain outside numbers.  
20  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Alphanumeric Display  
Alphanumeric Display  
Description  
The Alphanumeric Display messages help the display telephone user process calls, identify  
callers and customize features.  
The 22- and 34-Button Display Telephones have a three-line, 24-character per line alphanumeric display.  
The rst line displays the date and time (while idle) and feature status messages. The second line is used  
extensively by IntraMail. The third line displays the Soft Key denitions.  
The 34-Button Super Display Telephone has a nine-line, 24-character per line alphanumeric display. The  
rst line displays the date and time (while idle) and feature status messages, just like the 22- and 34-Button  
Display Telephones. The second line is used extensively by IntraMail. Lines 4-9 are the comprehensive  
Super Display Telephone soft key denitions.  
To learn more about the display telephones:  
To learn more about the Soft Keys, see Interactive Soft Keys on page 210.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled for all display telephones.  
Programming  
None  
Other Related Features  
Features  
The interactive Soft keys provide users with intuitive access to the telephone’s features.  
While a feature is active, pressing a VOLUME key adjusts the volume of the active feature. While the  
telephone is idle, pressing a VOLUME key adjusts the display contrast. Turn to this feature for addi-  
tional volume, brightness, and contrast controls.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
Refer to the individual features for feature operation.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Attendant Call Queuing  
Attendant Call Queuing  
Description  
Attendant Call Queuing helps minimize call congestion in systems that use the attendant as  
the overow destination for unanswered calls.  
An unlimited number of callers can queue for the attendant. The callers hear ringback while they wait for the  
attendant to answer — not busy tone. If you have the attendant as the overow destination for Direct Inward  
Lines, for example, unanswered DILs will “stack up” at the attendant until they are answered.  
Operator Call Key  
The last Feature Key on an attendant telephone is permanently assigned as an Operator Call key. When the  
operator has Intercom calls waiting to be answered, the calls queue under this key. The key winks (on) when  
calls are queued.  
The Operator Call key is a permanent assignment for all extensions assigned as operators. You cannot  
change this assignment. Attendant Call Queuing is a permanent, non-programmable feature.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No operators assigned by default. Once assigned, key 12 (on 22-button) or key 24 (on 34-button) is an  
Operator Call Key.  
Programming  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Assign system attendants.  
A Call Coverage Key will not pick up a call ringing the attendant’s Operator Call Key.  
The Operator Call Key does not activate off-hook signaling.  
Ringing Line Preference will not answer a call ringing the Operator Call Key.  
• Automated Attendant Screened (STRF) Transfers ash the Operator Call key and the Ring Indicator  
lamp. The call does not ash a line/loop key. (Note that Ringing Line Preference will not pick up a call  
ringing the attendant’s Operator Call key.)  
• Automated Attendant Unscreened (UTRF) Transfers ash the line’s line/loop key and the Ring Indica-  
tor lamp.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
22  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Attendant Call Queuing  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Attendant Call Queuing  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
To answer a call ashing the Operator Call Key:  
1.  
Press the ashing Operator Call key.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Attendant Position  
Attendant Position  
Description  
The attendant is the system’s call processing focal point.  
The attendant is the focal point for call processing within the system. The system can have up to four atten-  
dants. In addition to the features of a standard keyset, the attendant also has the following unique capabilities  
(refer to the respective feature for details):  
Incoming Intercom calls from co-workers queue for the attendant. The callers never hear busy tone.  
The attendant can break into another extension user’s established call. This option is enabled in the atten-  
dant’s Class of Service (COS 1).  
Direct Line Access lets the attendant user dial a code to access an individual line. This option is enabled  
in the attendant’s Class of Service (COS 1).  
In an emergency, the attendant can release (disconnect) another user’s active outside call. This option is  
enabled in the attendant’s Class of Service (COS 1).  
The attendant can Camp-On (queue) for a busy line. This option is enabled in the attendant’s Class of  
Service (COS 1).  
An attendant with a System Night key can put the system in the night mode. This option is enabled in the  
attendant’s Class of Service (COS 1).  
The attendant can remove problem lines from service —then return them to service once the problem is  
corrected. This option is enabled because the attendant has Direct Line Access enabled in their Class of  
Service (COS 1).  
The attendant should use a 34-Button Display or 34-Button Super Display Telephone. In addition, most  
attendants should nd a DSS Console helpful when processing calls.  
Conditions  
• Ringing Line Preference will not pick up a call ringing the attendant’s Operator Call key.  
• System operators will not ring for Ring Group calls.  
Default Setting  
• No attendants assigned.  
24  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Attendant Position  
Programming  
For best performance, install a 34-Button Display or 34-Button Super Display telephone for the  
attendant.  
1.  
1. A DSS Console will also help the attendant process calls more quickly.  
2.  
Set up the system attendants (operators).  
1. For a single operator:  
- In 1502-01: Operator Number 1 (page 653), enter the extension number for operator 1.  
- If you omit this step, by default users can dial 0 for extension 300 bit it won’t be an operator.  
extension number.  
2. For multiple operators:  
- In 1502-01: Operator Number 1 (page 653), enter the extension number for operator 1.  
- In 1502-02: Operator Number 2 (page 653), enter the extension number for operator 2.  
- In 1502-03: Operator Number 3 (page 653), enter the extension number for operator 3.  
- In 1502-04: Operator Number 4 (page 654), enter the extension number for operator 4.  
3. For no operators:  
extension.  
While busy on a call, should the attendant get Off-Hook Signaling audible notication of  
incoming calls?  
3.  
1. If yes:  
sion enter 1 for Camp-On or 2 for Off-Hook Ringing.  
2. If no:  
sion enter 0.  
4.  
Should 0 (or 01-04 in multiple-operator systems) be the digit users dial to reach their operator?  
1. If yes, leave the following at their factory default values:  
2. If no:  
- In 1301-[01-10]: Function Type (page 620), assign the new digit Function Type 1 (Operator).  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Attendant Position  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Since the attendant is never busy, Intercom callers cannot Barge In on an attendant.  
A Call Coverage Key will not pick up a call ringing the attendant’s Operator Call Key.  
Since the attendant is never busy, Intercom callers cannot Camp-On to an attendant.  
Since the attendant is never busy, Intercom callers cannot leave a Callback for an attendant.  
By default, the system assigns Class of Service 1 to the attendant. This provides the attendant with  
Barge In, Call Forwarding Off Premises, Direct Line Access, Forced Line Disconnect, Night Service,  
and Line Queuing (Camp-On) capability.  
The attendant can have Do Not Disturb. In addition, pressing DND at the attendant activates the night  
mode for any lines directly terminated to the attendant.  
An operator can monitor a Door Box by having a Call Coverage key to monitor ringing and a Hotline  
key to call the Door Box.  
If an operator is reassigned (i.e., moved from 300 to 301), only the Operator Call key will automati-  
cally follow the new assignment. All other Feature Keys must be reprogrammed for the new operator.  
System operators will not ring for Ring Group calls.  
Designate each extension’s operator.  
Since the attendant is never busy, Intercom callers cannot Monitor an attendant.  
Since the attendant is never busy for Intercom calls, the attendant always has Privacy enabled.  
Normally, the attendant should be able to remove extensions and lines from service.  
• STRF transfers to the attendant from the voice mail Automated Attendant ash the Operator Call key  
and the Ring Indicator lamp. The call does not ash a line/loop key. (Note that Ringing Line Prefer-  
ence will not pick up a call ringing the attendant’s Operator Call key.)  
• UTRF transfers to the attendant from the voice mail Automated Attendant ash the line’s line/loop key  
and the Ring Indicator lamp.  
An operator cannot receive a Voice Over from a co-worker since their extension is never busy to Inter-  
com callers.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
26  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Attendant Position  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Attendant Position  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
To call the attendant:  
Press INTERCOM.  
You hear dial tone.  
1.  
2.  
Dial 0.  
You hear two beeps.  
• This calls the attendant assigned to your extension. If your system has multiple attendants, you can reach them  
by dialing 01-04.  
• In a multiple attendant system, you can dial 0 and wait on the line to automatically call operator 1.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Redial  
Auto Redial  
Description  
Instead of redialing, have Auto Redial periodically retry a busy outside number.  
Auto Redial periodically redials a busy outside number. If a keyset user places an outside call and the call  
recipient is busy, the user can press a soft key to enable Auto Redial. The keyset user doesn’t have to retry  
the number, hoping it will go through.  
Auto Redial will periodically retry the number up to 15 times. Auto Redial cancels when the called party  
rings or answers, or when the extension:  
Places or answers another outside call.  
Receives an Intercom voice announcement or answers an Intercom call by lifting the handset or pressing  
SPEAKER.  
Presses SPEAKER to cancel Auto Redial.  
Presses any other xed feature key except MIC.  
Lifts and replaces the handset.  
Presses the CANCEL soft key (Super Display only).  
For your reference, the following table shows the standard call progress tones.  
Call Progress Tones  
Description  
Frequencies  
Rate  
Dial tone  
350 Hz + 440 Hz  
480 Hz + 620 Hz  
Steady  
Reorder (Fast Busy) tone  
250 mS on, 250 mS off  
(+ 25 mS)  
Busy tone  
480 Hz + 620 Hz  
440 Hz + 880 Hz  
350 Hz + 440 Hz  
500 mS on, 500 mS off  
(+ 50 mS)  
Audible ring tone (ring-  
back)  
800mS to 1.2 sec on, 2.7  
sec to 3.3 sec off  
Stutter dial tone  
800 mS to 1.2 sec on,  
800mS to 1.2 sec off  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
28  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Auto Redial  
Programming  
1.  
Is the interval between Auto Redial callout attempts correctly set?  
2.  
Is the system waiting an adequate time for busy tone when handling an Auto Redial?  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Last Number Redial allows an extension user to quickly redial the last outside number dialed.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Auto Redial  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
To enable Auto Redial:  
1.  
2.  
Place an outside call and receive busy tone.  
[Auto Redial]  
[Alnd]  
Press to enable Auto Redial.  
• The system enables Auto Redial for the last outside call you dialed.  
WAITING (30 SEC)  
AUTO REDIAL 1 OF 15  
You see:  
The display shows the interval between callout attempts (e.g., 30 seconds), as  
well as how many times redial has occurred (e.g., 1 of 15).  
SPEAKER winks when your telephone has Auto Redial enabled.  
3.  
The system periodically redials the call, up to 15 times.  
Auto Redial cancels when you:  
• Place or answer another outside call.  
• Receive an Intercom voice announcement or answer an Intercom call by lifting the handset or  
pressing SPEAKER.  
• Press SPEAKER to cancel Auto Redial.  
• Lift and replace the handset.  
• Press the CANCEL soft key (Super Display only).  
If a Caller ID call rings while Auto Redial is enabled, your display will show the number and optional  
name of the incoming caller. However, the ringing does not cancel Auto Redial. In addition, the Auto  
Redial display will be restored after the Caller ID call stops ringing.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automatic Handsfree  
Automatic Handsfree  
Description  
Automatic Handsfree is a convenience for workers who don’t have a free hand to answer a call  
or use a feature.  
Automatic Handsfree allows a keyset user to place or answer a call Handsfree by just pressing a key — with-  
out lifting the handset or pressing SPEAKER rst. If enabled, the system provides Automatic Handsfree for:  
Call Coverage keys  
Central Ofce Calls (line and loop calls)  
Group Call Pickup keys  
Hotline Keys  
Intercom (INTERCOM key)  
Last Number Redial (REDIAL key)  
Paging keys  
Park keys  
Personal Speed Dial bin keys  
Personal and System Speed Dial Feature Keys  
The system always provides Automatic Handsfree for:  
Dial Number Preview  
Directory Dialing  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
1.  
Enable or disable Automatic Handsfree system-wide.  
2.  
If enabled system-wide, enable or disable Automatic Handsfree for an extension.  
30  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Automatic Handsfree  
Other Related Features  
Features  
With Automatic Handsfree, an extension user can press a line key to place an outside call without rst  
lifting the handset or pressing SPEAKER. Users without Automatic Handsfree can preselect a line  
key before lifting the handset or pressing SPEAKER.  
Process calls using the speaker and microphone in the telephone (instead of the handset).  
While in the headset mode, Automatic Handsfree simplies answering outside calls.  
Automatic Handsfree allows the keyset user to answer a call ringing a line key without lifting the  
handset; they just press the line key instead.  
Automatic Handsfree allows the keyset user to answer a call ringing a loop key without lifting the  
handset; they just press the loop key instead.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
If enabled, Automatic Handsfree operation is automatic when you press the key.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automatic Ring Down  
Automatic Ring Down  
Description  
32  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Automatic Slot Configuration  
Automatic Slot Conguration  
Description  
The system automatically installs PCBs when you power up the system.  
Automatic Slot Conguration automatically sets up station and line PCBs when you initially power up the  
system. This simplies installation because you don’t have to use system programming to activate station  
and line PCBs after you plug them in.  
Here’s how Automatic Slot Conguration works:  
1. With power off, install your station and line PCBs.  
2. With the system powered down, install the station and line PCBs from left to right in the order you want  
your extension and line numbers set up.  
• Be sure to install a 16ESIU PCB in the rst slot (CN1).  
You don’t have to group your station and line PCBs together, although it may be more convenient to  
do so.  
3. Power up the system.  
4. On power up, the system scans the PCBs from left to right and sets up the extension and line numbering  
as follows.  
• Extension numbers will begin with 300 in the rst slot and increment from left to right.  
• Line numbers will begin with 101 (starting from the rst installed line PCB) and will also increment  
from left to right.  
System reset does not cause reconguration. Automatic Slot Conguration is temporarily disabled during a  
system reset.  
Programming  
1.  
Optionally recongure station PCBs after the initial installation.  
1. Use 120x-Stations (page 611) to recongure your station PCBs.  
2.  
Optionally recongure line PCBs after the initial installation.  
1. Use 121x-Lines (page 614) to recongure your line PCBs.  
Other Related Features  
None  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Background Music  
Background Music  
Description  
Broadcast music through the telephone speaker for a more pleasing work environment.  
Background Music (BGM) sends music from a customer-provided music source to speakers in keysets. If an  
extension user activates it, BGM plays whenever the extension is idle. Incoming calls and Paging announce-  
ments temporarily override (turn off) Background Music. Background Music requires a customer-provided  
external music source connected to one of two audio input minijacks.  
In DSX-40, the audio input minijacks are located on the equipment cabinet.  
In DSX-80/160, the audio input minijacks are located on the CPU PCB.  
The external music source you connect to the audio input minijacks is typically a CD player or FM receiver.  
The source, which you can also use for Music on Hold, must be compatible with the following specications:  
Music Source Specications  
Input Impedance  
10K Ohms  
Relative Input Level  
+18 dBr (+/- dBr) at 1.0 kHz  
For more on connecting a customer-provided music source, refer to the system’s Hardware Manual.  
Note:  
In accordance with U.S. copyright law, a license may be required from the American Society of Composers,  
Authors and Publishers (ASCAP) or other similar organizations, if radio, television broadcasts or music  
other than material not in the public domain are transmitted through the Music on Hold feature of telecom-  
munications systems. NEC Unied Solutions, Inc. hereby disclaims any liability arising out of the failure to  
obtain such a license.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled system-wide and at each extension.  
Programming  
1.  
Enable or disable Background Music system-wide.  
1 or 2 for audio input 2).  
2.  
If enabled system-wide, enable or disable Background Music for an extension.  
34  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Background Music  
Other Related Features  
Features  
DND does not affect the operation of Background Music.  
Background Music plays in the headset when the extension is in the headset mode.  
Background Music and Music on Hold share the same music source.  
Background Music can broadcast over the External Paging speakers.  
Background Music is not available to single line telephones.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Background Music  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
To turn Background Music on and off:  
1.  
2.  
Do not lift the handset or press SPEAKER.  
Press HOLD.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Barge In (Intrusion)  
Barge In (Intrusion)  
Description  
In an emergency, use Barge In to get through to a co-worker right away.  
Barge In permits an extension user to break into another extension user’s established call. This sets up a  
three-way conversation between the intruding extension and the two parties on the initial call. The user can  
Barge In on an Intercom call or outside call.  
CAUTION  
Unauthorized intrusion on calls using this feature may be interpreted as an  
invasion of privacy.  
Conditions  
• Barge In uses a system Conference circuit. See Conference (page 89) for more.  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
1.  
Enable or disable an extension’s ability to Barge In on a co-worker’s call.  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2.  
Should the called extension be able to block Barge In attempts?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. To block Barge In attempts, in 1401-03: Privacy (page 628) enterYes.  
3. To allow Barge In attempts, in 1401-03: Privacy (page 628) enter No.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Since the attendant is never busy, Intercom callers cannot Barge In on an attendant.  
An extension user can Barge In on a Conference.  
As an alternative to Barging In, disconnect the line instead.  
Privacy blocks Barge In attempts.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
36  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Barge In (Intrusion)  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Barge In (Intrusion)  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
To Barge In on a call:  
Place one of the following types of call:  
1.  
Call busy extension.  
Press line key for busy line.  
Press INTERCOM and dial 101 for busy line (i.e., using Direct Line Access).  
Press INTERCOM and dial #901 for busy line (i.e., using Line Dial-up).  
Press INTERCOM and dial Line Group access code (e.g., 9).  
[Barge In]  
[MORE + Barg}  
Press to Barge In.  
• Alternately dial 4.  
You hear two beeps.  
2.  
3.  
Join the conversation in progress.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Battery Backup  
Battery Backup  
Description  
The system provides permanent backup of system memory.  
In the event of commercial AC power failure, the NAND Flash memory on the CPU PCB permanently main-  
tains the site database. Additionally, an internal battery on the CPU provides short-term backup of the sys-  
tem date and time (Real Time Clock) and certain station parameters (such as the Caller ID log). The battery  
will hold the Real Time Clock and station parameters for up to 10-14 days. When commercial AC power is  
restored, the system restarts with all programming and the time and date intact.  
Additional Battery Backup capability can be provided by a customer-supplied Uninterruptable Power Sup-  
ply (UPS). The length of time the UPS will power the system when power fails depends on the capacity of  
the UPS unit. Consult with the UPS manufacturer for the specics. Refer to the Hardware Manual for addi-  
tional details.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• None  
Programming  
None  
Other Related Features  
Features  
When commercial AC power fails, the system does not back up the status of the following:  
• Call Forwarding  
• Call Waiting / Camp-On  
• Do Not Disturb  
• Line Queuing  
• Message Waiting  
• Microphone Mute  
The system’s internal battery backs up the CPU Real Time Clock for 10-14 days.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
If the system is properly installed, Battery Backup is automatic during AC power failures and brownouts.  
38  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Brightness Control  
Brightness Control  
Description  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Call Coverage Keys  
Call Coverage Keys  
Description  
Call Coverage keys allow an extension user to cover a co-worker’s calls from their own telephone.  
A keyset can have Call Coverage Keys for a co-worker’s extensions, Ring Group master numbers and UCD  
Group master numbers. The Call Coverage Key lights when the co-worker’s extension is busy, ashes slowly  
when the co-worker has an incoming call, and ashes fast when the co-worker is in Do Not Disturb. The Call  
Coverage Key can ring immediately when a call comes into the covered extension, ring after a delay or not  
ring at all. In addition, the keyset user can press the Call Coverage Key to intercept their co-worker’s incom-  
ing call. They can also go off hook and press the Call Coverage key to call the covered extension. An exten-  
sion can have as many Call Coverage Keys as they have available Feature Keys on their telephone.  
Call Coverage Key Busy Lamp Indications  
When the key is:  
The covered extension is:  
Off  
On  
Idle or not installed  
Busy  
Slow Flash  
Medium Flash  
Ringing  
Covered extension is in DND for outside  
calls (option 1).  
Fast Flash  
Covered extension is in DND for Intercom  
calls (option 2) or All Calls (option 3).  
Call Coverage Keys will intercept the following types of calls:  
Key Ring Calls  
Ringing Intercom calls  
Calls to a UCD Group master number  
Calls ringing a Group Ring master number  
Transferred calls  
Call Coverage Keys will not intercept a call ringing the attendant’s Operator Call Key.  
Call Coverage Guard Timer  
The 4 second Call Coverage Guard Timer helps extensions that have the same Call Coverage key assign-  
ments. As soon as an extension user presses their Call Coverage key to answer a call, the key becomes  
unavailable for 4 seconds to all other extensions with that same key. (Users will hear reorder tone if they  
press their key before the 4 seconds expire.) This helps prevent users from inadvertently placing a call to the  
covered destination.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No Call Coverage Keys assigned.  
• The Call Coverage Delay Ring timer is 10 seconds.  
40  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Call Coverage Keys  
Programming  
1.  
Setting up Call Coverage keys on a keyset.  
- For an Immediate Ring Call Coverage key, assign key code 06.  
- For a No Ring (Lamp Only) Call Coverage key, assign key code 07.  
- For a Delay Ring Call Coverage key, assign key code 08.  
- Extension number  
- Ring Group master number  
- UCD Group master number  
2.  
Setting up Call Coverage keys on a DSS Console.  
- For an Immediate Ring Call Coverage key, assign key code 06.  
- For a No Ring (Lamp Only) Call Coverage key, assign key code 07.  
- For a Delay Ring Call Coverage key, assign key code 08.  
- Extension number  
- Ring Group master number  
- UCD Group master number  
3.  
For Delay Ring Call Coverage keys (if any), set the delay ring interval.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Coverage Keys  
Other Related Features  
Features  
DSS Consoles can have Call Coverage keys.  
By using Key Ring Override, Distinctive Ringing allows an extension user to set up unique ringing for  
their Call Coverage keys.  
If you enter Door Chime type 0 (normal ring) above, you can set up Call Coverage keys for the Door  
Box Ring Group. This allows extensions that are not members of the Ring Group to answer Door Box  
calls. Extensions with Call Coverage keys to the Door Box Ring Group can also activate the relay.  
A keyset can have Call Coverage keys for UCD Group master numbers. The group can be a normal  
UCD Group or a “dummy” group with no members.  
A keyset can have Call Coverage keys for Ring Group master numbers.  
Hotline keys provide many of the features available with Call Coverage keys.  
A user can press a Call Coverage Key as an alternative to dialing Intercom numbers.  
Call Coverage will pick up Key Ring calls.  
An extension user can use a Call Coverage key to Transfer a call to the covered extension.  
An extension user can use the User Programmable Features to set up their own Call Coverage keys.  
Pressing TRANSFER + Call Coverage key can Transfer a call to an uninstalled extension’s mailbox  
(if the mailbox is enabled).  
After calling a co-worker by pressing their Call Coverage key, and extension user can dial 9 to leave a  
Voice Over (if enabled in programming).  
IntraMail Features  
None  
42  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Coverage Keys  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Answering Call Coverage Keys  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
To answer a call ringing or ashing a Call Coverage key:  
1.  
Press the ashing Call Coverage key.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Call Coverage Keys to Place Calls  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
To place a call from an idle Call Coverage key to the covered extension:  
Press the Call Coverage key.  
You hear two beeps or Intercom ringing.  
1.  
2.  
Speak with the co-worker at the covered extension.  
• The Call Coverage key lights green while you are connected.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Call Coverage Keys to Transfer Calls  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
To Transfer your call using a Call Coverage key:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
Do not hang up.  
Press TRANSFER.  
Press your Call Coverage key.  
Do one of the following.  
Announce the call to make a Screened Transfer.  
Hang up if your co-worker accepts the call.  
a.  
b.  
c.  
Hang up to send the call through as an Unscreened Transfer.  
Press the ashing line key to return to the call if your co-worker doesn’t want it.  
When you Transfer a call, it will recall to you if it is unanswered at the destination. If you don’t answer the recall, it  
diverts to Key Ring.  
5.  
User Programmable Feature  
Setting Call Coverage Key Ringing  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#RA (#72)  
Operation  
Access Level  
Feature Key Ringing  
#RAC + Call Coverage key repeatedly to select ringing  
2-5  
mode + SPEAKER to exit.  
Call Coverage keys ash as follows:  
- Lamp only = On red  
- Immediate ring = On green  
- Delay ring = Fast ash green.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Call Forwarding  
Call Forwarding  
Description  
Call Forwarding ensures that the user’s calls are covered when they are away from their work area.  
Call Forwarding permits an extension user to redirect their call to another extension. The types of Call For-  
warding are:  
Call Forwarding when Not Answered  
Calls ringing the extension forward when not answered.  
Call Forwarding when Busy or Not Answered  
Calls ringing the extension forward when not answered, and all calls forward while the extension is busy.  
Call Forwarding Immediate  
All calls to the extension forward immediately.  
You can set up Call Forwarding to reroute all calls or just outside calls. If an extension with forwarding set  
for outside calls only receives a screened Transfer, the initial voice-announcement broadcasts at the exten-  
sion. When the caller hangs up to complete the transfer, the outside call forwards as programmed.  
Call Forwarding Chaining  
Extension user’s can chain Call Forwards. For example, extension 301 can forward all calls immediately to  
304, which in turn can forward all calls immediately to extension 302. Any co-worker calling 301 or 304  
goes to 302 instead. If extension 302 is Call Forwarded to voice mail, callers to 301 or 304 go directly to  
302’s mailbox.  
Call Forwarding Cancel  
Call Forwarding cancel allows a keyset user to dial a code to simultaneously cancel all Call Forwarding sys-  
tem-wide. The extension must have access level 4 or 5 set up in 2102-04: User Programming Access Level  
Call Forwarding Key  
A keyset user can have a key on their telephone or DSS Console assigned as a Call Forwarding key.  
While the extension is idle, pressing the key puts the extension in the Call Forwarding programming  
mode - the same as pressing INTERCOM and dialing *3.  
- If the extension has Call Forwarding enabled, and the user presses the key and waits (for at least 6  
seconds), Call Forwarding is automatically cancelled.  
- If the extension has Call Forwarding disabled, and the user presses the key and waits (for at least 6  
seconds), the prior Call Forwarding mode is automatically enabled (if any).  
While the extension is busy, pressing the key switches Call Forwarding on and off.  
Call Forwarding Key BLF  
This ash rate:  
Means:  
Off  
Call Forwarding is disabled.  
Fast ash  
The extension is in the Call For-  
warding programming mode.  
Slow ash  
Call Forwarding is enabled at the  
extension.  
44  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Call Forwarding  
Call Forwarding Toggle in a Personal Speed Dial Bin  
If an extension doesn’t have an available Feature Key for a Call Forwarding key, the user can program a Per-  
sonal Speed Dial bin for similar operation (without the BLF). To do this:  
While on hook, dial #77.  
Press the key for the Personal Speed Dial bin you want to program + HOLD.  
For LINE/GRP/ICM, press INTERCOM + HOLD.  
For NUM, dial *3 + HOLD.  
For NA, enter a name of your choosing + HOLD.  
Press SPEAKER to exit.  
While the extension is idle, pressing the bin key puts the extension in the Call Forwarding programming  
mode - the same as pressing INTERCOM and dialing *3.  
If the extension has Call Forwarding enabled, and the user presses the bin key and waits (for at least 6  
seconds), Call Forwarding is automatically cancelled.  
If the extension has Call Forwarding disabled, and the user presses the bin key and waits (for at least 6  
seconds), the prior Call Forwarding mode is automatically enabled (if any).  
Call Forwarding Conrmation Tone  
Keyset users will hear a single conrmation beep after enabling or cancelling Call Forwarding. Single line  
telephone users will hear Intercom dial tone after enabling or cancelling Call Forwarding.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Call Forwarding  
Call Forwarding Timers  
The following diagrams show how the system implements various timers when handling forwarded calls.  
Refer to the programming for each individual timer for more information.  
Transferred Outside Call to Forwarded Extension  
Extension A transfers line to extension B, which  
is forwarded Busy/No Answer (type 2) to exten-  
sion C.  
The line rings extension B for the Transfer Recall  
If unanswered, the call then rings extension C  
(the forward destination) for the Call Forward  
Ring No Answer time.  
If still unanswered, the call rings the extension  
that initially transferred the call (A) for the Call  
Forward Ring No Answer time.  
If still unanswered, call diverts to Key Ring.  
DIL (no overow) to Forwarded Extension  
DIL (with no overow) rings programmed desti-  
nation, which is forwarded Busy/No Answer  
(type 2) to a co-worker.  
DIL rings programmed DIL destination for the  
DIL No Answer time.  
If unanswered, the call rings the extension to which  
it is call forwarded for the DIL No Answer time.  
If still unanswered, call diverts to Key Ring.  
46  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Call Forwarding  
DIL (with overow) to Forwarded Extension  
DIL (with overow) rings programmed destina-  
tion, which is forwarded Busy/No Answer (type  
2) to a co-worker.  
DIL rings programmed DIL destination for the  
DIL No Answer time.  
If unanswered, the call rings the extension to which  
it is forwarded for the DIL No Answer time.  
If unanswered, the DIL rings the programmed  
overow destination for the DIL No Answer time.  
If still unanswered, call diverts to Key Ring.  
Outside Call on Hold at Forwarded Extension  
Extension forwarded to co-worker using Busy/  
No Answer (type 2) to a co-worker puts outside  
call on Hold.  
If not picked up, outside call recalls the extension  
that put it on Hold after the Hold Recall time.  
The call then rings the extension that put it on  
Hold for the Line Revert time.  
If still unanswered, call diverts to Key Ring.  
Conditions  
• An extension’s Call Forwarding is reinstated after a power down or system reset. For example, an  
extension with calls forwarded immediately to voice mail will still be forwarded to voice mail after the  
system resets or is powered down and then powered back up.  
• The display CFWD Not Allowed indicates that an Call Forwarding is denied because it would set up  
an illegal Call Forwarding loop. For example, if extension 305 if forwarded to 301, and 301 attempts  
to forward to 305, the user at 305 would see the display CFWD Not Allowed.  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Forwarding  
Programming  
1.  
Should an extension be able to use Call Forwarding?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
If an extension has Ring No Answer forwarding enabled, do calls route to the forwarding  
destination after the correct interval?  
2.  
3.  
Should extension be allowed to use Call Forwarding Cancel?  
4.  
5.  
Should extension have a Call Forwarding key?  
1. In 2121-[01 to 24]: Feature Key Codes (page 758), assign key code 27 to an available Feature Key.  
Should extension’s DSS Console have a Call Forwarding key?  
1. In 2402-[01-60]: DSS Console Key Codes (page 801), assign key code 27 to an available Feature Key on  
the DSS Console.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Call Forwarding will not reroute a call ringing a Call Coverage Key.  
Off Premises Call Forwarding allows a keyset user to forward their calls to an off-site location (such  
as a cell phone or remote ofce).  
Call Forwarding will reroute Direct Inward Lines.  
• Call Forwarding considers an extension in DND as busy. In addition, an extension can have both DND  
and Call Forwarding enabled at the same time.  
• Note that Call Forwarding has priority over Do Not Disturb. If both are enabled simultaneously at an  
extension, Call Forwarding is in force.  
An extension user cannot forward a call to a Door Box.  
• If a member of a Circular or Terminal Hunting group forwards their calls, hunting will follow Call  
Forwarding.  
• Calls to a UCD Group will not follow Call Forwarding at a group member’s extension. However, calls  
directed to the group member’s extension (such as DILs and transferred calls) will follow the Call For-  
warding set up at the extension.  
48  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Forwarding  
Call Forwarding will not reroute Group Ring calls.  
Call Forwarding when Busy and Call Forwarding when Busy/Not Answered will not reroute voice-  
announced Intercom calls. It will reroute only ringing Intercom calls.  
Call Forwarding will not reroute Key Ring calls.  
Call Forwarding will not reroute calls ringing line keys.  
Call Forwarding will not reroute a call ringing a loop key (unless the call is a DIL).  
• An extension user cannot leave a Message Waiting at a co-worker that has Call Forwarding Immediate  
(*34) enabled. Pressing V-MAIL automatically leaves a message at the forwarding destination instead.  
• An extension user cannot leave a Message Waiting at a busy co-worker that has Call Forwarding  
Busy/No Answer (*32) enabled. Pressing V-MAIL will automatically leave a message at the forward-  
ing destination instead.  
Enabling or canceling Call Forwarding cancels an extension’s Selectable Display Messaging.  
• Call Forwarding will reroute transferred calls.  
• When handling Transfer recalls, Call Forwarding has priority over Extension Hunting. See Interaction  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Forwarding  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Activating or Canceling Call Forwarding  
To activate Call Forwarding:  
1.  
Select the Call Forwarding options.  
[Menu + Call Forward]  
[Menu + Cfwd]  
Alternately do one of the following:  
• Press INTERCOM and dial *3.  
• Press your Call Forwarding Feature Key.  
2.  
Select or cancel a Call Forwarding type.  
[Immediate]  
[Immed]  
Select Call Forwarding Immediate.  
• Alternately dial 4.  
1
[Ring/No Ans]  
[RNA]  
Select Call Forwarding when Not Answered.  
• Alternately dial 6.  
1
[Busy/No Ans]  
[BNA]  
Select Call Forwarding when Busy or Not Answered.  
• Alternately dial 2.  
[Off-Premise]  
[MORE + OFFP]  
Select Call Forwarding Off Premises.  
• Alternately dial 3.  
[Ans Machine]  
[MORE + AME]  
Select Personal Answering Machine Emulation.  
• Alternately dial 7.  
[Message]  
[MORE + MSG]  
Select Selectable Display Messaging.  
• Alternately dial 8.  
[None]  
[MORE + MORE + NONE]  
Select to cancel Call Forwarding.  
• Alternately dial 0.  
Select the Call Forwarding destination:  
• An extension number or UCD Group master number.  
0 for the operator.  
3.  
4.  
V-MAIL for voice mail.  
Select the Call Forwarding mode.  
[All]  
[All]  
Select forwarding all calls.  
• Alternately dial 2.  
[Line Only]  
[Line]  
Select forwarding outside calls only.  
• Alternately dial 8.  
1
Option will not forward voice-announced Intercom calls.  
User Programmable Feature  
Canceling All Call Forwards System-Wide  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#CC (#22)  
Operation  
Access Level  
Call Forwarding Clear All  
#CC +Y to clear (cancel) forwarding or N to exit without  
4 and 5  
clearing + SPEAKER to hang up.  
50  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Call Forwarding Off Premises  
Call Forwarding Off Premises  
Description  
When a user is out of the ofce, they can send their calls to their home ofce or cell phone.  
Off Premises Call Forwarding allows a keyset user to forward their calls to an off-site location (such as a cell  
phone or remote ofce) if allowed by their Class of Service. Keyset users can stay in touch by having Off  
Premises Call Forwarding automatically forward their calls while they are away from the ofce. To set up  
Off Premises Call Forwarding, the user selects the line or Line Group over which the call should route, as  
well as the number the system should dial. The number dialed can be from an extension’s Personal Speed  
Dial bin containing an outside number, or the user can enter an outside number directly into their Personal  
Speed Dial bin 720. When a call rings the forwarded extension, the system selects the specied line or group  
and then outdials the stored number.  
Off Premises Call Forwarding reroutes:  
Intercom calls  
Transferred calls  
Direct Inward Lines  
UTRF (unscreened transfer) calls routed from the voice mail Automated Attendant  
Circular and Terminal Extension Hunting calls  
Off Premises Call Forwarding does not reroute:  
Key Ring calls  
Calls to a UCD Group master number.  
Group Ring calls (i.e., calls to a Ring Group master number)  
UCD Group Calls (i.e., calls to a UCD Group master number)  
Ringing Call Coverage key calls  
You can set up Off Premises Call Forwarding to reroute all calls or just outside calls. If an extension with  
forwarding set for outside calls only receives a screened Transfer, the initial voice-announcement broadcasts  
at the extension. When the caller hangs up to complete the transfer, the outside call forwards as programmed.  
Call Forwarding Off Premises Example  
Call Routes to Emergency Service Number After Hours  
A service department dispatcher has Key Ring for lines 1-4 during the day. The dispatcher answers calls on  
those lines and assigns dispatchers accordingly. At night, the calls on lines 1-4 must automatically route to  
the technician on call for emergency service. To do this:  
1. In 3112-01: Direct Termination in the Day (page 819), make sure lines 1-4 are assigned as Key Ring  
lines (by pressing CLEAR).  
extension (e.g., extension 300).  
3. At the dispatcher’s extension, program a Personal Speed Dial bin for each technician that is qualied to  
take emergency calls.  
4. At the end of the day, the dispatcher presses their System Night key to put the system in the night mode.  
5. After enabling the night mode, the dispatcher implements Off Premises Call Forwarding to whichever  
Speed Dial bin represents the technician on call for that evening.  
6. Calls ringing lines 1-4 at night automatically route to the technician on call.  
Conditions  
• Telco must provide Loop Disconnect Supervision on the originating line (i.e., the line that Off Pre-  
mises Call Forwarding will reroute).  
• All other Speed Dial programming also applies to Off Premises Call Forwarding.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Call Forwarding Off Premises  
• An extension Speed Dial number stored in bin 719 should not be longer than 16 digits. If it is, the sys-  
tem automatically clears bin 719 when it stores an Off Premises Call Forwarding number in bin 720.  
• An extension user cannot off premise call forward to a Personal Speed Dial bin that contains an Inter-  
com number. If the user selects a bin that contains an Intercom number, the system cancels Off Pre-  
mises Call Forwarding.  
• Off Premises Call Forwarding is cleared after a system reset or power down.  
• If a line rings an off-premise forwarded extension and the specied outbound route is busy, the sys-  
tem reroutes the call to the programmed overow destination (normally Key Ring). Intercom callers  
will hear busy tone if the outbound route is busy, and have the option of dialing 2 for Line Queuing  
or Line Callback.  
• Tandem Calling must be enabled for the originating line (i.e., the line that Off Premises Call Forward-  
ing will reroute).  
- If a screened Transfer is made to an extension with Line Only forwarding, and Tandem Calling is  
not enabled for the originating line, the transferred line immediately goes to Key Ring when the  
transferring party hangs up.  
- If a screened Transfer is made to an extension with All Calls forwarding, and Tandem Calling is not  
enabled for the originating line, the transferred line will stay at the transferring extension when that  
party hangs up.  
• Off Premises Call Forwarding is not available at single line telephones.  
Default Setting  
• Call Forwarding Off Premises is disabled in an extension’s Class of Service.  
• Tandem Calling is disabled for lines.  
Programming  
1.  
Should an extension be able to use Off Premises Call Forwarding?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. If yes:  
2.  
3.  
Should Off Premises Call Forwarding be able to reroute incoming outside calls?  
Do you want to enter the Personal Speed Dial numbers an extension will use for Off Premises  
Call Forwarding from system programming?  
- Off Premises Call Forwarding cannot use Intercom Speed Dial.  
2. If no, skip this step.  
52  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Forwarding Off Premises  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Call Forwarding permits an extension user to redirect their call to another extension.  
Call Forwarding Off Premises is not available at single line telephones.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Activating or Canceling Call Forwarding Off Premises  
To activate Call Forwarding:  
Select the Call Forwarding options.  
1.  
[Menu + Call Forward]  
[Menu + Cfwd]  
Alternately do one of the following:  
• Press INTERCOM and dial *3.  
• Press your Call Forwarding Feature Key.  
Select or cancel a Call Forwarding Off Premises.  
2.  
[Off-Premise]  
[MORE + OFFP]  
Select Call Forwarding Off Premises, then proceed to step 3 below.  
• Alternately dial 3.  
[None]  
[MORE + MORE + None]  
Select to cancel Call Forwarding.  
• Alternately dial 0 or press CLEAR.  
Do one of the following.  
3.  
a.  
To select a Personal Speed Dial bin as your Off Premises Call Forwarding number:  
[SPEED DIAL BIN]  
[Bin]  
Select the bin option.  
When you see BIN#:  
• Enter the Personal Speed Dial bin you want to use (701-720) + HOLD.  
b.  
To store a new Off Premises Call Forwarding number:  
• The system automatically stores this number in bin 720.  
[NUMBER]  
[Num]  
Select the number option.  
When you see LINE/GRP/ICM:  
• Enter the line number (e.g., 1 for line 1) or Line Group number (e.g.,  
90 for group 0) + HOLD.  
• Following Speed Dial programming methods, enter the number you  
want to store (up to 16 digits long) + HOLD.  
- Press MUTE to store a Pause.  
- Press FLASH to store a Flash.  
- You cannot enter a name using this option.  
If you see 720: IN USE OVERRIDE?  
[YES]  
[YES]  
Select to override the existing entry and enter a  
new number.  
[NO]  
[NO]  
Select to cancel and back up to step 3.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Forwarding Off Premises  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Activating or Canceling Call Forwarding Off Premises  
c.  
To view the currently enabled Off Premises Call Forwarding number (if any):  
[VIEW]  
[View]  
Select to view the currently stored number.  
• Press SPEAKER to exit the view mode.  
Select the Call Forwarding mode.  
4.  
[All]  
[All]  
Select forwarding all calls.  
• Alternately dial 2.  
[Line Only]  
[Line]  
Select forwarding outside calls only.  
• Alternately dial 8.  
54  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Timer  
Call Timer  
Description  
Call Timer helps users that must keep track of their time on the phone.  
Call Timer lets a keyset user with a Call Timer key time their outside calls on the telephone display. There  
are two types of Call Timer keys:  
Manual Call Timer  
Any time while placing a call or while on a call, a display keyset user can press their Manual Call Timer  
key to start the Call Timer. The Call Timer will continue until the user hangs up or presses their Manual  
Call Timer key again.  
Automatic Call Timer  
In addition to the features of the Manual Call Timer key, the Automatic Call Timer key provides automatic  
timing for outside calls. When a display keyset with an Automatic Call Timer key places or answers an out-  
side call, the Call Timer automatically starts when that outside call connects. The Automatic Call Timer  
does not automatically start for Intercom calls. The Automatic Call Timer can also work like a Manual Call  
Timer key. There is no need to have a Manual and Automatic Call Timer key on the same phone.  
The Call Timer feature also provides:  
Review of Previously Timed Call  
Any time after hanging up from a timed call, a display keyset user can press their Manual or Automatic  
Call Timer key to review the duration of that call.  
Timer Reset for Current Call  
While the display keyset user is timing their call, they can press CLEAR at any time to reset the Call  
Timer to 00:00:00.  
Automatic Timer Stop  
The system assigns the Call Timer to the active call. When the user terminates the active call, the Call  
Timer automatically shuts down.  
Wrap-up Timer Display  
After hanging up a timed call, a display keyset will show the Call Timer data for 6 seconds before returning  
the display to idle. This gives the extension user adequate time to make a record of the timed call, if desired.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No Call Timer keys assigned.  
Programming  
1.  
Assign a Manual Call Timer Feature Key to a keyset?  
1. In 2121-[01 to 24]: Feature Key Codes (page 758), assign key code 16 to an available Feature Key.  
1.  
Assign an Automatic Call Timer Feature Key to a keyset?  
1. In 2121-[01 to 24]: Feature Key Codes (page 758), assign key code 16 to an available Feature Key.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Call Timer  
Other Related Features  
Features  
The Auto Timer feature interacts with Caller ID on the rst line of the telephone display.  
Call Timer shows the time a user has been on an outside call.  
Flash restarts the Call Timer.  
A user’s Call Timer starts when they pick up a call from Hold. If they place the call on Hold and  
another user picks it up, the timer restarts for the new user.  
The SMDR report also keeps track of the time on a call.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Automatically TimingYour Outside Call  
To time your outside call if you have an Automatic Call Timer key:  
Place or answer outside call.  
• The Call Timer starts automatically. The Automatic Call Timer key lights red while the system times the call.  
1.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Manually TimingYour Outside Call  
To manually time your Intercom or outside call:  
1.  
While placing or while on the call, do one of the following.  
[Timer]  
[Time]  
a.  
b.  
Press the Call Timer soft key.  
Press the Manual or Automatic Call Timer key.  
• The Automatic Call Timer key lights red while the system times the call.  
56  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Timer  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Stopping and Restarting the Call Timer forYour Call  
To stop the Call Timer:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
[Timer]  
[Time]  
a.  
b.  
Press the Call Timer soft key.  
Press the Manual or Automatic Call Timer key.  
2.  
The Call Timer disappears from the display.  
To restart the Call Timer:  
• The timer will restart from 00:00.  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
[Timer]  
[Time]  
a.  
Press the Call Timer soft key.  
b.  
Press the Manual or Automatic Call Timer key.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Resetting the Call Timer  
To reset the Call Timer while it is running (i.e., timing your call):  
Press CLEAR.  
• The Call Timer restarts from 00:00. It does not disappear from the display.  
1.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Reviewing a Call’s Duration  
To review the duration of your last timed call:  
1.  
2.  
Wait for the Manual or Automatic Call Timer key to go out.  
Press the Manual or Automatic Call Timer key.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Waiting / Camp-On  
Call Waiting / Camp-On  
Description  
Call Waiting helps busy extension users know when they have additional waiting calls. It also  
lets callers wait in line for a busy extension without being forgotten.  
With Call Waiting, an extension user may call a busy extension and wait in line (Camp-On) without hanging  
up. When the user Camps-On (by dialing 2), the system signals the busy extension with two beeps indicating  
the rst waiting call. (The busy extension can be on a handset or Handsfree call.) The call goes through when  
the extension becomes free.  
If an extension has more than one caller waiting, they queue on a rst-in/rst-out basis (FIFO). The exten-  
sion will not hear Camp-On beeps for additional waiting calls.  
Off-Hook Signaling also alerts the user when unanswered calls are waiting to get through. Turn to Off-Hook  
The following chart shows when the two types of Off-Hook Signaling occur. Note that Camp-On tones occur  
for an extension when they are the exclusive recipient of the call (such as a DIL).  
1
2
Off-Hook Ringing  
Camp-On Tones  
Key Ring  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Transferred Outside Call  
Direct Inward Line  
Transfer from voice mail (UTRF)  
Call Coverage Key  
Group Call Pickup Key  
1
No  
2
Conditions  
• A system reset or power failure cancels all Camp-Ons system wide.  
• While busy on a call, Camp-On tones occur only for the rst incoming call and do not repeat.  
Default Setting  
• Call Waiting tones enabled.  
58  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Call Waiting / Camp-On  
Programming  
1.  
Should an extension be able to send Camp-On tones to a busy co-worker?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the sending extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. If yes, in 1402-03: Camp-On to Busy Extension (page 633), enterYes for the initiating extension.  
- Check step 2 below to be sure Camp-On is not blocked by the receiving extension.  
- This option does not restrict Callback.  
2.  
Should an extension be able to receive Camp-On tones when a co-worker camps-on?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the receiving extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. If yes:  
ing Camp-On tones at an extension.  
- In 1401-03: Privacy (page 628), enter No to be sure that Privacy does not block incoming  
Camp-On signals.  
3. If no, do one of the following:  
- To disable Camp-On system-wide, in 1512-02: Call Waiting Tones (page 657) enter No.  
- To disable Camp-On for a specic extension, in 2116-01: Off Hook Signaling for Incoming Inter-  
- To have Privacy block incoming Camp-On tones, in 1401-03: Privacy (page 628) enter No.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Waiting / Camp-On  
Other Related Features  
Features  
An extension user cannot Camp-On to the attendant because the attendant’s extension is never busy.  
If an extension user Camps-On and then hangs up, the system converts the Camp-On to a Callback.  
An extension programmed to receive Camp-On tones or Off-Hook Ringing from a waiting call will  
also receive Second Call Caller ID.  
DILs to a busy extension automatically send Camp-On tones.  
An extension cannot Camp-On to a busy co-worker that is also in Do Not Disturb.  
A user can Camp-On after placing an Intercom call to a busy co-worker.  
A Key Ring call will not send Camp-On beeps to a busy extension that normally rings for that call.  
Line Queuing lets an extension user Camp-On to a busy line.  
Privacy blocks Camp-On / Call Waiting.  
Camp-On lets an extension user know that a call is waiting to be answered. The user can Split between  
the waiting call and their current call.  
An extension user can Transfer a call to a busy extension. The call will automatically  
Camp-On to the busy extension.  
The extension user cannot adjust the volume of incoming Camp-On tone.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Camp-On to a Busy Extension  
To Camp-On to a busy extension:  
Call the busy extension.  
• Listen for busy or busy/ring tone.  
• With IntraMail installed, you will hear a voice prompt rst.  
1.  
Dial 2 but do not hang up.  
• If you hang up, the system converts your Camp-On to a Callback.  
2.  
3.  
When your co-worker hangs up their initial call, you hear:  
• Ringback as their telephone rings.  
Your co-worker’s voice when they answer.  
60  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Callback  
Callback  
Description  
With Callback, a user does not have to repeatedly call a busy extension back, hoping to nd it idle.  
When an extension user calls a busy co-worker, they can leave a Callback request for a return call. The sys-  
tem services Callback requests as follows:  
Caller at extension A leaves a Callback at extension B.  
- Caller can place or answer additional calls in the mean time.  
When extension B becomes idle, the system rings extension A. This is the Callback ring.  
Once caller A answers the Callback ring, the system rings (formerly busy) extension B.  
- If caller A doesn’t answer the Callback ring, the system cancels the Callback.  
As soon as caller B answers, the system sets up an Intercom call between A and B.  
An extension user can leave a Callback at many extensions simultaneously. The system processes the Call-  
backs as the extensions become free. In addition, many extensions can leave a Callback at the same exten-  
sion. The system processes these Callbacks on a rst-in/rst-out (FIFO) basis.  
If an extension user leaves a Callback request and then fails to answer within four rings, the system cancels  
the Callback.  
Conditions  
• A system reset or power failure cancels all Callbacks system-wide.  
Default Setting  
• Callback enabled.  
Programming  
Should an extension be able to receive Camp-On tones when a co-worker leaves them a  
Callback request?  
1.  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the receiving extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. If yes:  
ing Camp-On tones at an extension.  
- In 1401-03: Privacy (page 628), enter No to be sure that Privacy does not block incoming  
Camp-On signals.  
3. If no, do one of the following:  
- To disable Camp-On system-wide, in 1512-02: Call Waiting Tones (page 657) enter No.  
- To disable Camp-On for a specic extension, in 2116-01: Off Hook Signaling for Incoming Inter-  
- To have Privacy block incoming Camp-On tones, in 1401-03: Privacy (page 628) enter No.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Callback  
Other Related Features  
Features  
An extension user cannot leave a Callback for the attendant because the attendant’s extension is  
never busy.  
If an extension user starts to leave a Callback request but doesn’t hang up, the system Camps-On  
instead.  
If a line is ringing an extension because of a prior Callback, and then receives a new outside call, it  
will start ringing for the new call. The Callback request is then queued.  
An extension cannot leave a Callback for a busy co-worker that is also in Do Not Disturb.  
An extension user can queue for a busy line and then hang up to turn the queue into a line Callback.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Leaving a Callback  
To leave a Callback at a busy extension:  
Call the busy extension.  
• Listen for busy or busy/ring tone.  
1.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
Dial 2 and hang up.  
• Stay on the line without hanging up if you want to Camp-On instead.  
When the busy co-worker becomes free:  
You hear Intercom ring.  
Answer the Intercom ring.  
• The system automatically places a call to your co-worker.  
• Speak to your co-worker when the call goes through.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Cancelling a Callback  
To cancel a Callback:  
Do not lift the handset, do not press INTERCOM, and do not press SPEAKER.  
1.  
2.  
Dial # + DC (32).  
• This cancels the Callback you have left. If you have left callbacks for several extensions, this simultaneously  
cancels all your Callbacks.  
62  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Caller ID  
Caller ID  
Description  
Caller ID automatically displays the phone number and optional name for incoming outside calls.  
Caller ID allows a display keyset to show an incoming caller’s telephone number (called Directory Number  
or DN) and optional name as the call is ringing. Caller ID supports the telco’s Called Number Identication  
(CNI) and Called Number Delivery (CND) service, when available. These services provide the Caller ID  
information (i.e., messages) between the rst and second ring burst of an incoming call.  
Caller ID provides the following features:  
Single and Multiple Message Format Compatibility  
There are two types of Caller ID message formats currently available: Single Data Message Format (SDMF)  
and Multiple Data Message Format (MDMF). With Single Message Data Format, the telco sends only the  
caller’s phone number (DN). The DN can be up to 10 digits long. In Multiple Data Message Format, the  
telco sends the DN and the caller’s name. The DN for this format can be up to 15 digits long, and the name  
provided can consist of up to 15 ASCII characters.  
If no DN is received, no number or error message displays.  
Caller ID on the SMDR Report  
Caller ID data prints on the SMDR report. SDMF records print a single line which shows just the incoming  
number. MDMF records print on two lines, with the rst line showing the number and the second line show-  
ing the name. Unlike the telephone display, the SMDR report can show the entire 15 digits in the DN, if  
required.  
Following is a sample SMDR report showing Caller ID data. The rst two lines of the report show a com-  
plete MDMF record with both the caller’s number and name. The last two lines of the report show two Caller  
ID error messages: Private Number and Out of Area. The “IN” in the type column indicates that the records  
shown are for incoming calls.  
If no DN is received, no number or error message displays.  
Station Message Detail Recording  
05/10/2005 11:11A  
---+---+--------------------------------+----------+---------+--------+---  
Sta|Lin|  
---+---+--------------------------------+----------+---------+--------+---  
Number Dialed  
| Account | Start |Duration| T  
301| 02|  
301| 02|  
301| 02|  
301| 02|  
2139261000|  
ANDERSON ALLEN|  
Private Number|  
|11:11:39A|00:00:13|IN  
|11:11:39A|00:00:13|IN  
|11:12:26A|00:00:12|IN  
|11:13:16A|00:00:12|IN  
Out of Area Number|  
Caller ID Integration with Voice Mail  
Caller ID fully integrates with IntraMail, UltraMail, and the NVM-Series voice mail systems. This enables  
voice mail features such as Make Call with Caller ID. Make Call allows the voice mail subscriber to return a  
call to someone who left them a message without knowing the calling party’s phone number.  
Second Call Caller ID (Extension Level Call Waiting Caller ID)  
While a display keyset user is busy on a call, the system can show the Caller ID information for a waiting  
call. If the busy extension is programmed to receive Camp-On tones or Off-Hook Ringing from the waiting  
call, the system will send the Caller ID data to the busy telephone’s display. If the busy extension does not  
receive Camp-On tones or Off-Hook Ringing, it will also not receive the waiting call’s Caller ID. (Note that  
Caller ID data from a Camp-On is displayed only once, corresponding to the single Camp-On beep.) This is  
an internal system feature and does not use the telco’s Call Waiting Caller ID.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Caller ID  
Third Party Caller ID Check  
Third Party Caller ID Check allows an idle or busy keyset user to display the Caller ID data for another line.  
The line that the user checks can be ringing or busy.  
Caller ID Display Separator  
An extension’s display can optionally show a calling party number separator. The separator is a dash after  
the area code and after the local exchange on a 7 or 10 digit number. If disabled, the calling party number  
displays without a separator.  
Caller ID to Single Line Telephones  
The system provides Caller ID data to single line ports. This allows single line Caller ID telephones to  
receive the Caller ID data also available at keysets. Up to 8 single line telephones can receive Caller ID data  
simultaneously. (To conserve system resources, consider turning off Caller ID in 1404-01: Caller ID Display  
(page 638) for extensions that do not require or support Caller ID.)  
On Intercom calls, the single line telephone display will show the extension number and name (if pro-  
grammed) of the internal caller.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Caller ID for each a line is disabled.  
• Caller ID with voice mail is enabled.  
• An extension’s Caller ID display is enabled.  
• Second Call Caller ID is enabled.  
• Third Party Caller ID Check is disabled.  
• The Caller ID Display Separator is disabled.  
• The telco must provide Caller ID service for each line that has Caller ID programming enabled.  
64  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Caller ID  
Programming  
1.  
Should the outside line provide Caller ID (if Caller ID service is also provided by the telco)?  
1. If yes:  
2, T1/E1 ANI = 3).  
2.  
Should an extension display the incoming Caller ID data?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. If yes:  
- Make sure the extension rings for the line. See Central Ofce Calls, Answering (page 74) for  
more.  
3.  
Should an extension display 2nd Call Caller ID (Extension Level Call Waiting Caller ID)?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. If yes:  
tones) or 2 (for off-hook ringing). See Account Codes (page 14) for more.  
- Check to see if Call Timer key blocks the rst line of the 2nd Call Caller ID display. If it does, make  
sure the extension doesn’t have a Call Timer key.  
4.  
5.  
6.  
Should an extension be able to use 3rd Party Caller ID Check?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
Should an extension’s Caller ID display use the display separator?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
Should outside lines send Caller ID data to voice mail?  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Caller ID  
Other Related Features  
Features  
The Auto Timer feature interacts with Caller ID on the rst line of the telephone display. If an exten-  
sion has Call Timer enabled, the rst line (i.e., caller’s name) of the Second Call Caller ID display  
won’t show. The user will only see the caller’s number (in the second line).  
• An extension programmed to receive Camp-On tones or Off-Hook Ringing from a waiting call will  
also receive Second Call Caller ID.  
• If an extension is set up to receive Off Hook Ringing, it will receive Second Call Caller ID for each  
new outside call. The display returns to idle when the second call stops ringing.  
• If an extension is set up to receive Call Wait beeps, it will receive Second Call Caller ID only for the rst  
call. This occurs, for example, for DILs and transferred outside calls. With transferred outside calls, the  
Second Call Caller ID displays until the call recalls the transferring destination (if not picked up). With  
DILs, the Second Call Caller ID displays remains until the extension activates another feature.  
An extension can store the caller’s name and phone number for easy review and redialing.  
An extension’s display will show Caller ID data for a line terminated to a Ring Group master number  
as the call is ringing.  
Caller ID prints out on the SMDR report.  
Caller ID fully integrates with IntraMail, UltraMail and NVM-Series voice mail systems.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
66  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Caller ID  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Clearing the Display  
To cancel (clear) the Caller ID display and return your phone to its normal display:  
You can only do this while you are on a call, not while your phone is ringing.  
Press CLEAR.  
1.  
To turn the Caller ID display back on (after you press CLEAR to cancel it):  
Press CHECK.  
1.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Third Party Caller ID  
To display the Caller ID data for the third party’s call:  
Press INTERCOM + CHECK.  
1.  
2.  
Press one of the following keys for the call you want to check.  
You see Caller ID data for the line you select.  
Press a line key while the call is ringing or connected to the third party.  
Press a loop key while the call is ringing the third party.  
Press a Hotline key while the call is connected to the third party.  
Press a Call Coverage key while the call is ringing the third party.  
Hang up when you are done.  
3.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Caller ID Logging  
Caller ID Logging  
Description  
An extension can store the caller’s name and phone number for easy review and redialing.  
When caller ID is enabled, Caller ID Logging stores a record of the caller’s number and name (if provided  
by the telco) for each outside call that rings an extension. This allows an extension user to easily review and  
redial their calls. The system can log records directly to an extension or to one of 8 Caller ID Logging  
Groups. All the extensions in the same Logging Group share the same Caller ID records. Each extension or  
Logging Group can store up to 99 Caller ID records. The system stores up to 1000 Caller ID records, allo-  
cated among all extensions and Caller ID Logging Groups. All Caller ID records are retained when the sys-  
tem is powered down or reset. If a line rings more than one extension simultaneously, the system logs the  
call at all ringing extensions.  
Caller ID Logging also provides:  
Programmable Caller ID Callback Routing  
You can set up Caller ID Callbacks (return calls) to select either a line or Line Group to redial calls  
allowed by the extension’s Toll Restriction. Caller ID Callback Routing can also optionally:  
- Strip the area code from the number dialed.  
- Strip the leading 1 from the number dialed.  
- Add a leading 1 to the number dialed.  
Soft Key Integration  
Unique Caller ID soft keys provide the extension user with the capability to view all of their Caller ID  
records or just records for unanswered calls. Super Display telephone users can additionally view  
records of answered calls.  
Save Number to Speed Dial  
While reviewing a Caller ID record, the extension user can optionally store the number and optional  
name directly in an Extension Speed Dial bin.  
New Record for Calls on Hold and Parked Calls  
The system creates a new Caller ID record for a call retrieved from Hold at an extension other than the  
one that initially placed it on Hold. The same is also true for Parked calls.  
- A new call rings the system and creates a CID record.  
- Extension 301 answers the call and places it on Hold.  
- Extension 302 retrieves the call from Hold.  
- The system creates another record of the call at extension 302.  
New Record for Transferred Call  
A transferred call creates a new call record each time it is transferred. For example:  
- A new call rings the system and creates a CID record.  
- Extension 300 answers the call and transfers it to extension 301.  
- The system creates a new (answered) record for the call at extension 301.  
- Extension 301 transfers the call to extension 302.  
- The system creates another new (answered) record for the call at extension 302.  
Answered Status for Calls Answered at Analog Ports  
Calls answered by keyset (digital) and single line (analog) extensions are marked as answered. Calls  
answered by voice mail ports are not marked as answered.  
Record Created for Voice Mail Park and Page  
If a call is placed in Personal Park Orbit by voice mail, the system creates a record for the call on the  
extension at which it is parked, and at the extension that picked up the call. (Note that there is no record  
created at the voice mail port.)  
68  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Caller ID Logging  
Types of Calls that are Logged  
Call ID Logging will make a record of any outside call to an extension that can normally be answered using  
Ringing Line Preference. These include:  
Line key (Key Ring) and Loop Key calls  
Transfers  
Direct Inward Lines (DILs)  
Group Ring calls  
Caller ID and Answering Machines  
If voice mail is not installed, Caller ID Logging can provide unique handling of a customer-provided  
answering machine. If an extension is designated as an answering machine in programming, any outside call  
picked up by the answering machine will not be marked as answered in the Caller ID log. For example, if a  
call rings into the system and is picked up by the answering machine, it will show as a new call in the Caller  
ID log. In addition, it will ash green on the Ring/Message lamp indicating that there is a new call.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• There is no Caller ID outbound line/group specied.  
• There is no home area code specied. In addition, all local calls are 7 digits long.  
• In DSX-40, all keyset extensions (300-315) are in Caller ID Logging Group 1. Since all keysets share  
a common group log, deleting a record at one keyset will automatically update the log for all others.  
• In DSX-80/160, extensions 300-315 are set up for personal logging with 10 records each. There are no  
records assigned to other extensions.  
• Caller ID Logging Group 1 can store 99 records. All other groups are blank.  
• All lines are assigned to Caller ID Logging Group 1.  
• The Caller ID Alert Lamp is enabled.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Caller ID Logging  
Programming  
Setting Up Caller ID Callbacks  
1.  
Make sure Caller ID is installed.  
1. If Caller ID is not installed, turn to Caller ID (page 63) and set up your system’s Caller ID.  
2.  
Assign the outgoing route the system will use for Caller ID callbacks.  
backs (1 = line, 2 = Line Group).  
use for Caller ID callbacks.  
98) the system will use for Caller ID callbacks.  
3.  
Designate the system’s home area code (i.e., the area code in which the system is installed).  
1. Before programming for the rst time, use 3712-01: Initialize Caller ID Dial Treatment Tables  
installed.  
- You must make an assignment in this program so that Caller ID can properly process callbacks  
(return calls).  
4.  
Should the extension have personal or group Caller ID Logging?  
1. For personal Caller ID logging:  
extension should have.  
- When assigning records, be careful not to exceed the system maximum (1000).  
2. For group Caller ID logging:  
belong (1-8).  
the line should log its calls. The line can be a member of any or all groups.  
that can be stored in each Caller ID Logging group.  
- When assigning records, be careful not to exceed the system maximum (1000).  
5.  
6.  
Does the area in which the system is installed use 10-digit local calling?  
Are there any calls within the system’s home area code that are toll calls?  
1. If yes:  
70  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Caller ID Logging  
tion List Table as a Toll Table (1) or a Local Table (0).  
- If it is a Toll Table, the codes you enter in the table are toll calls. All other codes are local calls.  
- If it is a Local Table, the codes you enter in the table are local calls. All other codes are toll calls.  
NXX) within the home area code that are exceptions.  
2. If no:  
- Leave these options at their default settings (i.e., a Toll Table with no entries).  
7.  
Are there any calls in an area code adjacent to the home area code that are local calls?  
NXX) in the adjacent area code that are local calls.  
2. If no, make no entries in the Foreign Area Code Exception List Table.  
Additional Caller ID Logging Programming  
1.  
Do you want to clear (initialize) all the Caller ID logs in the system?  
2. If no, skip this step without initializing.  
Should the Ring/Message Lamp ash when the extension has new Caller ID logs that have not  
yet been reviewed?  
2.  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
3.  
Does the system use a customer-provided answering machine instead of voice mail?  
- Any line picked up by the answering machine will not be marked as answered in the Caller ID log.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Caller ID Logging  
Programming Examples  
Enable Caller ID callbacks (return calls) for a system in area code 203.  
• There is no 10-digit local calling or other special requirement.  
1.  
-
(DSP = 1, ATRU-DB = 2, T1/E1 ANI = 3).  
2. Set up the outbound route for Caller ID callbacks.  
callbacks (1 = line, 2 = Line Group).  
will use for Caller ID callbacks.  
(90-98) the system will use for Caller ID callbacks.  
- The system will add a leading 1 to all calls to all area codes other than 203.  
- Calls to area code 203 will be redialed as 7-digit calls.  
Enable Caller ID callbacks (return calls) for a system in area code 203 where there is 10-digit  
local calling and a local exchange in adjacent area code 860.  
2.  
- DSP = 1  
- ATRU-DB = 2  
- T1/E1 ANI = 3).  
2. Set up the outbound route for Caller ID callbacks.  
callbacks (1 = line, 2 = Line Group).  
will use for Caller ID callbacks.  
(90-98) the system will use for Caller ID callbacks.  
- Congure the table as a local table (L).  
- Enter the local exchanges within area code 203.  
- Calls within area code 203 that are found in the list are redialed as 10-digit local calls. Calls within  
area code 203 not found in the list are redialed as 1 + 10 digit toll calls.  
bination for area code 860 that is a local call. The call is redialed as a 10-digit local call.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Caller ID automatically displays the phone number and optional name for incoming outside calls.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
72  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Caller ID Logging  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Reviewing the Caller ID Log  
To review your Caller ID log:  
[Calls XX]  
[CLXX]  
Select the Caller ID log.  
Your Ring/Message Lamp will wink on (green) when you have Caller ID records  
that you have not yet reviewed.  
1.  
[View All]  
[All]  
Select to review all your Caller ID records.  
You see the following review options.  
• Press Volume Up and Volume Down to scroll through your records.  
Review Options  
• On a 3-line display telephone, press CHECK to switch between the name (page 1)  
and number (page 2) display.  
[Callback]  
[Call]  
Select to call the person back.  
[Delete]  
[Del]  
Select to delete the displayed record.  
[Store Bin]  
[Stor]  
Select to store the number in one of your Personal Speed Dial  
bins (following normal Speed Dial programming steps).  
[Delete All]  
[N/A]  
Select to delete all your Caller ID records.  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
Back up to the beginning without making any changes.  
[View Unans]  
[Unan]  
Select to review Caller ID records for calls that rang your extension and  
were unanswered.  
• Go to the review options (see above).  
• Press Volume Up and Volume Down to scroll through your records.  
[Delete All]  
[Del*]  
Select to delete all Caller ID records logged at your phone or in your group.  
[View Ans]  
[N/A]  
Select to review Caller ID records for calls that rang your phone and were  
answered (somewhere in the system).  
• Press Volume Up and Volume Down to scroll through your records.  
• Go to the review options (see above).  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
Select to exit.  
• Alternately dial 9.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Central Office Calls, Answering  
Central Ofce Calls, Answering  
Description  
The system allows outside calls to ring and be answered at any combination of system extensions.  
The system provides exible routing of incoming CO calls to meet the exact site requirements.  
Answering Priority  
When multiple calls ring an extension simultaneously, the system services the ringing calls in the follow-  
ing order:  
1. Ringing Intercom call  
2. Line or loop key (from lowest to highest)  
Overow  
Single Ring Option for Single Line Sets  
gle line extensions. If enabled (Y), analog single line extensions always receive single ringing for outside  
calls. (Certain analog single line devices connected to the system may require this type of ringing.) If dis-  
abled (N), outside call ringing at analog single line extensions follows the ringing pattern of the line. For  
example, if a line is ringing the system with two ring bursts, the single line extensions will follow the same  
ringing pattern.  
Conditions  
• Per FCC regulations, do not set 3103-01: Transmit Gain (page 814) higher than 0 dB.  
• None  
Default Setting  
• All extensions have full access on all lines.  
• In DSX-40, lines 5-8 require the Expansion Board.  
• Extensions have immediate day/night ring on all lines.  
• Single line sets ring according to 2132-[01-64]: Line Ringing (page 764) programming (just like  
keysets).  
• Lines 1-8 ring extensions on line keys 1-8.  
74  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Central Office Calls, Answering  
Programming  
Basic Programming  
Make sure each line’s circuit type and loop length setting match the requirements of the  
connected service.  
1.  
2. In 3101-03: DTMF Dialing (page 811), indicate whether the line is DTMF (1) or Dial Pulse (0).  
3. In 3103-03: Loop Length (page 815) for analog lines only, set this option to compensate for the telco cir-  
cuits loop length.  
- For normal installations, enter 0.  
- If the system is very close to the central ofce or behind a PBX, enter 1.  
- If the loop length is abnormally long, enter 2.  
2.  
Review the system timers for compatibility with the connected service.  
1. Review the following timers:  
3.  
Set the line access options at extension for each line.  
1. For no incoming or outgoing access, in 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763) enter 0.  
2. For incoming access only, in 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763) enter 1.  
3. For outgoing access only, in 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763) enter 2.  
4.  
Set the line ringing options at extension for each line.  
1. For lamp only (no ringing) day and night, in 2132-[01-64]: Line Ringing (page 764) enter 1.  
2. For day and night ringing, in 2132-[01-64]: Line Ringing (page 764) enter 2.  
3. For night ringing only, in 2132-[01-64]: Line Ringing (page 764) enter 3.  
4. For delay ringing day and night, in 2132-[01-64]: Line Ringing (page 764) enter 4.  
- In 1604-01: Delay Ring Timer (page 678), set the interval after which a delay ring line will change  
from ashing to ringing.  
5. For single line telephones:  
- In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
- To have single line telephones ring with a single ring for outside calls, in 1403-02: Single Ring for  
- To have single line telephones follow the ringing pattern of the outside line, in 1403-02: Single  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Central Office Calls, Answering  
Setting Up Line and Loop Keys  
1.  
Set up line and loop keys for an extension.  
1. For line keys:  
- If an extension doesn’t have any line keys, you should assign Fixed or Switched Loop keys to  
make handling outside calls easier.  
2. For Fixed Loop keys:  
3. For Switched Loop keys:  
2.  
Set up line keys for a DSS Console.  
1. For line keys:  
- Loop keys are not available on a DSS Console.  
Setting Up Transmit and Receive Gain  
While on an outside call, is a user’s conversation transmitted to the caller at a comfortable  
level?  
1.  
2. If no, in 3103-01: Transmit Gain (page 814) adjust the line’s transmit gain as required.  
2.  
While on an outside call, is the conversation received by the user at a comfortable level?  
1. If yes, leave 3103-02: Receive Gain (page 814) for the line at it’s current value.  
2. If no, in 3103-02: Receive Gain (page 814) adjust the line’s receive gain as required.  
- For a “hot” (high gain) line, decreasing the receive gain should improve Handsfree performance for  
keysets using that line.  
76  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Central Office Calls, Answering  
Other Related Features  
Features  
The Call Timer helps a user keep track of the time they spend on the phone.  
A DIL rings an extension directly.  
Line keys simplify answering outside calls.  
In order to answer outside calls, extensions without line keys should have loop keys.  
Night Service determines how outside calls ring at night.  
Outside call ringing can broadcast over the External Paging speakers.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Answering Outside Calls  
To answer an outside call:  
• An incoming call on a line or loop key will ash red.  
• An incoming call on your Direct Inward Line will ash green.  
Lift handset.  
1.  
2.  
• If you have Ringing Line Preference, this will answer the incoming call.  
• If you have Automatic Handsfree, you can press the line or loop key without rst lifting the handset.  
Press ashing line or loop key.  
• The key will be on (green) after you answer the call.  
User Programmable Feature  
Setting Up Line Key Ringing  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
Operation  
Access Level  
#RAL  
(#725)  
Feature Keys  
Outside Line Keys: #RAL + Line Key repeatedly to select  
ringing mode + SPEAKER to exit.  
2-5  
Line keys ash as follows:  
- Lamp only = On red  
- Immediate ring = On green  
- Delay ring = Fast ash green  
- Night ring = Slow ash green  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Central Office Calls, Placing  
Central Ofce Calls, Placing  
Description  
Customize the call placing options to meet the site requirements and each individual’s needs.  
The system provides exibility in the way each extension user can place outgoing calls. A user can place a  
call by:  
Pressing a Line Key  
Any keyset can have line keys for one-touch access to specic lines.  
Pressing a Loop Key  
Loop Keys provide a user with one-touch access to the assigned Loop Group. Loop Groups can consist  
of one or more Line Groups.  
Using Line Dial-Up  
With Line Dial-Up, a user can select a specic line by pressing INTERCOM and dialing the Line  
Dial-Up code (#9) followed by the line number (1-64).  
Using Direct Line Access  
Direct Line Access allows a user to access a line by pressing INTERCOM and dialing the line’s exten-  
sion number (e.g., 101 for line 1, 102 for line 2. etc.).  
Dialing a Line Group Access Code  
User’s can also place outside calls by pressing INTERCOM and dialing a Line Group Access Code (90-98).  
Line Group Routing  
If the system has Line Group Routing enabled, user’s get the rst available line when they press INTER-  
COM and dial 9.  
Dial Buffering  
When placing an outside call, extension users can dial an unlimited number of digits. Users are assured that they  
can use services such as telephone banking without encountering restrictions imposed by the telephone system.  
Store and Forward  
Store and Forward is an alternate method of placing outside calls in which the system stores (“collects”) the  
digits a user dials, waits for the user to nish dialing, and then redials the digits on the selected line. Store  
and forward provides Intercom dial tone to the caller as soon as they dial a line access code or press a loop  
key, similar to conventional ARS operation. When the user has completed dialing, the system will dial out  
the call over the connected line after 6 seconds or when the user dials #. Store and Forward can also be an  
advantage when connected to a T1 service that does not provide line dial tone.  
Post dialing for Store and Forward calls is also available. After a user dials using Store and Forward, they  
can manually dial additional digits. The normal post dialing soft keys (such as AUTO REDIAL [ALND] for  
Auto Redial) are also enabled.  
Store and Forward does not apply to line keys, Direct Line Access, or line dial up (i.e., #9 plus the line  
number).  
You can use Account Codes with Store and Forward enabled (see Operation below).  
Conditions  
• Systems using Line Groups or Line Group Access should use the hybrid FCC registration number  
(i.e., the number that ends in MF-E). Look at the label on the bottom of your equipment cabinet for  
more information.  
• Per FCC regulations, do not set 3103-01: Transmit Gain (page 814) higher than 0 dB.  
78  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Central Office Calls, Placing  
Default Setting  
• Lines 1-12 ring on line keys 1-12 for extensions 300-315. All other extensions are lamp only for lines  
1-12. Lines 13-64 do not appear on line keys.  
• All extensions have full access on all lines.  
• Line Group Routing (dial 9) is assigned to Line Group 90 (which contains lines 1-8). Dial 9 works by  
default. The outgoing line priority for the dial 9 group is as follows:  
Order 1 = line 8  
Order 2 = line 7  
Order 3 = line 6  
Order 4 = line 5  
Order 5 = line 4  
Order 6 = line 3  
Order 7 = line 2  
Order 8 = line 1  
• Store and Forward is disabled.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Central Office Calls, Placing  
Programming  
Basic Programming  
Make sure each line’s circuit type and loop length setting match the requirements of the  
connected service.  
1.  
2. In 3101-03: DTMF Dialing (page 811), indicate whether the line is DTMF (1) or Dial Pulse (0).  
3. In 3103-03: Loop Length (page 815) for analog lines only, set this option to compensate for the telco cir-  
cuits loop length.  
- If the system is very close to the central ofce or behind a PBX, enter 1.  
- For normal installations, enter 2.  
2.  
Review the system timers for compatibility with the connected service.  
1. Review the following timers:  
3.  
Are the connected lines DTMF or Dial Pulse (DP)?  
1. If DTMF, check the settings in 1111-DTMF Setup (page 608).  
2. If analog Dial Pulse, check the settings in:  
3. If T1 Dial Pulse, check the settings in:  
4.  
Set the line access options at extension for each line.  
1. For no incoming or outgoing access, in 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763) enter 0.  
2. For incoming access only, in 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763) enter 1.  
3. For outgoing access only, in 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763) enter 2.  
80  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Central Office Calls, Placing  
Access Code Options  
1.  
Should extension have single digit (dial 9) or 2-digit (90-98) access to outside Line Groups?  
1. For single digit access:  
- In 2113-01: Dial 9 Group (page 738), assign the Line Group the extension will reach when the user  
dials 9.  
2. For 2-digit access:  
-
You can optionally set up the digit 9 for single digit access and another digit (e.g., 8) for 2-digit access.  
2.  
3.  
Should extension have Line Dial-Up capability?  
Should 1 be the rst digit in the Direct Line Access code?  
1. If yes, leave the following at their default values:  
-
2. If no:  
- In 1301-[01-10]: Function Type (page 620) for the new Direct Line Access digit, enter 2.  
In 1301-[01-10]: Expected Number of Digits (page 620) for the new Direct Line Access digit,  
enter  
-
3.  
Setting Up Line and Loop Keys  
1.  
Set up line and loop keys for an extension.  
1. For line keys:  
- If an extension doesn’t have any line keys, you should assign Fixed or Switched Loop keys to  
make handling outside calls easier.  
2. For Fixed Loop keys:  
3. For Switched Loop keys:  
2.  
Set up line keys for a DSS Console.  
1. For line keys:  
- Loop keys are not available on a DSS Console.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Central Office Calls, Placing  
Setting Up Transmit and Receive Gain  
While on an outside call, is a user’s conversation transmitted to the caller at a comfortable  
level?  
1.  
2.  
2. If no, in 3103-01: Transmit Gain (page 814) adjust the line’s transmit gain as required.  
While on an outside call, is the conversation received by the user at a comfortable level?  
1. If yes, leave 3103-02: Receive Gain (page 814) for the line at it’s current value.  
2. If no, in 3103-02: Receive Gain (page 814) adjust the line’s receive gain as required.  
- For a “hot” (high gain) line, decreasing the receive gain should improve Handsfree performance for  
keysets using that line.  
Setting Up Store and Forward  
1.  
Should the system use Store and Forward when placing outside calls?  
1. If yes:  
- In 3111-05: Store and Forward (page 818), enterYes for every line in the Line Group accessed by  
Store and Forward.  
- When Store and Forward is outdialing on DTMF lines, it uses the following settings:  
- When Store and Forward is outdialing on analog Dial Pulse lines, it uses the following settings:  
- When Store and Forward is outdialing on T1 Dial Pulse lines, it uses the following settings:  
- The setting of 1602-01: Interdigit Timer (page 671) determines the interval the system waits, after  
the user has dialed their last digit, before dialing the call on the selected line.  
82  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Central Office Calls, Placing  
Other Related Features  
Features  
You can use Store and Forward with Forced Account Codes.  
With Automatic Handsfree, an extension user can press a line key to place an outside call without rst  
lifting the handset or pressing SPEAKER. Users without Automatic Handsfree can preselect a line  
key before lifting the handset or pressing SPEAKER.  
The Call Timer helps a user keep track of the time they spend on the phone.  
Dial Number Preview allows an extension user to review a number before the system dials it out.  
Direct Line Access allows an extension user to seize an individual line and place a call without restric-  
tion.  
The system is compatible with Equal Access numbers (e.g., 10-10-321).  
Easily redial the last number dialed.  
With Line Group Routing enabled, an extension user can dial 9 to place an outside call.  
Line Keys give a user one-touch access to specic lines.  
An extension user can queue for a busy line, or queue and hang up to leave a callback for a busy line.  
An extension user may also be able to press a Loop Key to place an outside call.  
Save a number you dialed, then easily redial it later on.  
You can store outside numbers in Speed Dial bins for quick access to frequently called numbers.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Central Office Calls, Placing  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Placing Outside Calls Using Line Keys  
To place an outside call over a specic line using a line key:  
1.  
2.  
Lift handset.  
Press line key.  
You hear dial tone on the line you select and the line key lights green.  
• To use loop keys for placing calls, see Loop Keys (page 233).  
3.  
Dial outside number.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Placing Outside Calls Using Line Dial-up or Direct Line Access  
To place an outside call over a specic line using a Line Dial-up or Direct Line Access:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Lift handset.  
Press INTERCOM.  
Do one of the following:  
a.  
For Line Dial-up:  
Dial #9 followed by the line number (e.g., 01 for line 1).  
• If you hear busy tone, you may be able to dial 2 to queue for the busy line.  
For Direct Line Access:  
b.  
Dial 1 plus the line number (e.g., 01 for line 1).  
• If you hear busy tone, you may be able to dial 2 to queue for the busy line.  
3.  
Dial outside number.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Placing Outside Calls Using Line Groups  
By default, pressing Intercom and dialing 911 or lifting the handset and dialing 911 will not call emergency services.  
To place an outside call over a Line Group:  
1.  
2.  
2.  
Lift handset.  
Press INTERCOM.  
Dial the Line Group code (90-98).  
• If you hear dial tone as soon as you dial 9, your system has Line Group Routing enabled. See Line Group  
3.  
Dial outside number.  
84  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Central Office Calls, Placing  
Using Store and Forward  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Feature Name  
To place an outside call using Store and Forward:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
Press INTERCOM and dial 9.  
You may optionally be able to dial 90-98.  
b.  
c.  
Press a Switched Loop key + Dial Line Group number (90-98).  
Press Fixed Loop key.  
2.  
3.  
Dial the outside telephone number.  
When you have nished dialing, wait 6 seconds or dial # for the call to go though,  
• The stored number dials out.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Store and Forward and Account Codes  
To place an outside call when both Store and Forward and Account Codes are enabled:  
• With Forced Account Codes for Toll Calls Only, you do not have to enter an Account Code for local calls. Just dial  
the call normally.  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
c.  
Press INTERCOM and dial 9 (or optionally 90-98).  
Press Switched Loop key + Dial the Line Group number (90-98).  
Press Fixed Loop key.  
2.  
3.  
Dial the outside telephone number.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
c.  
Wait for three beeps (Forced Account Codes only).  
[Account Code]  
[ACCT]  
Select Account Code soft key.  
Press your Account Code Feature Key.  
4.  
5.  
Enter the Account Code.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
c.  
Wait 6 seconds.  
[Account Code]  
[ACCT]  
Select Account Code soft key.  
Press your Account Code Feature Key.  
Dial #.  
d.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Check Key  
Check Key  
Description  
Quickly check keyset and DSS Console Feature Key assignments.  
A keyset user can use the CHECK key to check keyset and DSS Console Feature Key assignments and Per-  
sonal Speed Dial bin names.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
None  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Check DSS Console Feature Key assignments.  
Check Feature Key assignments.  
Check Personal Speed Dial bin assignments.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Checking Feature Key Assignments  
To check a Feature Key assignment:  
Press CHECK.  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Press the Feature Key on keyset or DSS Console.  
Do one of the following.  
Press another Feature Key to check.  
a.  
b.  
Press SPEAKER to exit the check mode.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Checking Personal Speed Dial Bin Name and Number  
(22-Button and 34-Button 3-Line Keysets Only)  
To check a Personal Speed Dial name and number:  
Press CHECK.  
1.  
2.  
Do one of the following.  
86  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Check Key  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Checking Personal Speed Dial Bin Name and Number  
(22-Button and 34-Button 3-Line Keysets Only)  
a.  
b.  
Press the Personal Speed Dial bin key once to display the name for the lower numbered bin.  
• For example, pressing bin 1 in this step displays the name for 701.  
Press the Personal Speed Dial bin key a second time to display the number stored in the lower num-  
bered bin.  
• For example, pressing bin 1 in this step displays the number stored for 701.  
c.  
d.  
Press the Personal Speed Dial bin key a third time to display the name for the higher numbered bin.  
• For example, pressing bin 1 in this step displays the name stored for 711.  
Press the Personal Speed Dial bin key a fourth time to display the number stored in the higher num-  
bered bin.  
• For example, pressing bin 1 in this step displays the number stored for 711.  
Press another key or SPEAKER to exit the check mode.  
3.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Class of Service  
Class of Service  
Description  
Customize features and options for extensions and outside lines.  
Class of Service (COS) sets various features and options for extensions and outside lines. The system allows  
any number of extensions and lines to share the same Class of Service. The Class of Service options are pro-  
vided by the following programs:  
140x-Station Options  
141x-Line Options  
Conditions  
• None.  
Default Setting  
• Extension 300 has Class of Service 1. All other extensions have Class of Service 2.  
• All lines have Class of Service 1.  
Programming  
1.  
Make a unique Class of Service (1-15) for each set of features and options the site requires.  
2.  
Assign Class of Service to extensions and lines.  
1. For extensions, assign Class of Service in 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724).  
2. For lines, assign Class of Service in 3102-01: Line Class of Service (page 813).  
Other Related Features  
Features  
By default, the system assigns Class of Service 1 to the attendant. This provides the attendant with  
Barge In, Call Forwarding Off Premise, Direct Line Access, Forced Line Disconnect, Night Service,  
and Line Queuing (Camp-On) capability.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
None.  
88  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Conference  
Conference  
Description  
A user can set up a multiple-party telephone meeting without leaving the ofce.  
Conference lets an extension user add additional inside and outside callers to their conversation. The follow-  
ing table shows the system’s Conference capacities:  
Description  
Capacity  
Conference circuits  
32  
32  
Maximum simultaneous users in Conference  
(total of all Conferences system-wide)  
Maximum simultaneous conferences  
8
8
Maximum parties in any one Conference  
(lines and/or extensions)  
The system’s 32 Conference circuits are dynamically allocated as users request them.  
Conditions  
• None.  
Default Setting  
• Conference enabled.  
Programming  
None  
Other Related Features  
Features  
If an extension user places a Conference on Hold, no other participants can place the Conference on  
Hold, split it, or terminate it.  
After hearing off-hook signals, an extension user can Conference their active call with the waiting call.  
An extension user cannot add an incoming Reverse Voice Over call to a Conference.  
Single line telephones can use Conference.  
An extension user cannot Voice Over to a co-worker busy on a Conference call.  
The following features also allow different types of multiple party calls:  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Conference  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Setting up a Conference  
To set up a Conference:  
Establish an Intercom or outside call.  
1.  
2.  
Press CONF.  
Your hear Intercom dial tone.  
Your caller hears Music on Hold (if installed) while they wait for you to set up the Conference.  
Do one of the following:  
3.  
a.  
b.  
c.  
Dial extension you want to add.  
Place or answer an outside call.  
Retrieve a call from Park Orbit.  
Press CONF to set up the Conference.  
• If you cannot add additional parties to your Conference, you have exceeded the system’s Conference limit.  
4.  
5.  
Repeat steps 2-4 to add additional parties to your Conference. You can also do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
To optionally place a Conference on Hold:  
Press HOLD.  
To reinstate the Conference on Hold.  
Press CONF.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Exiting a Conference  
To exit a Conference without affecting the other parties:  
Hang up.  
• The remaining parties can continue their conversation uninterrupted.  
1.  
• If you were in Conference with two outside lines, this may set up a tandem call. Refer to Tandem Calls /  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Conference at a Single LineTelephone  
To use Conference at a single line telephone:  
Establish an Intercom or outside call.  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Hookash and dial the extension or outside line you want to add.  
Hookash and dial #10 to set up the Conference.  
• If you cannot add additional parties to your Conference, you have exceeded the system’s Conference limit.  
Repeat steps 2 and 3 to add additional parties to your Conference.  
4.  
90  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conference, Meet-Me  
Conference, Meet-Me  
Description  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Conference, Unsupervised  
Conference, Unsupervised  
Description  
92  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Contrast Controls  
Contrast Controls  
Description  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cordless Telephone  
Cordless Telephone  
Description  
Provides cordless mobility and a rich feature set for employees away from their desks.  
The DSX Cordless Lite II Telephone (P/N 730087) is a 900 Mhz digital narrow band FM cord-  
less telephone that provides mobility, exibility and convenience for those who spend much of  
the workday away from their desk. Fully integrated with the DSX system, the DSX Cordless  
Lite II Telephone offers many standard features such as Call Forwarding, Call Coverage, Hot-  
line, and Voice Mail. Complemented by 4 fully programmable function keys (with LEDs), the  
DSX Cordless Lite II Telephone achieves a whole new level of convenience and mobility. An  
easy-to-read 16-character by 2-line LCD display (with four status icons), volume controls, a  
rechargeable Nickel Metal Hydride Battery Pack, and a handy belt clip round out the elegant  
and affordable DSX Cordless Lite II Telephone.  
Conditions  
• None.  
Default Setting  
• N/A.  
Programming  
The DSX Cordless Lite II Telephone auto-IDs in 2101-01: Station Type (page 719) with circuit type 08. No  
additional programming is required.  
Other Related Features  
Refer to the DSX Cordless Lite II Telephone User Guide (P/N 1093092).  
Operation  
Refer to the DSX Cordless Lite II Telephone User Guide (P/N 1093092).  
94  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Delayed Ringing  
Delayed Ringing  
Description  
Delayed Ringing helps co-workers cover each other’s unanswered calls.  
Delayed Ringing allows a line to start ringing a preset interval after the call starts ashing a line key. This is  
helpful for co-workers that cover each other’s calls. For example, a secretary can have Delayed Ringing for  
the lines that ring the boss’s telephone. If the boss doesn’t answer after the Delayed Ringing interval, the call  
will start ringing the secretary’s extension.  
Conditions  
• None.  
Default Setting  
• Lines 1-8 immediately ring on line keys 1-8  
Programming  
1.  
Should a line have delayed ringing at an extension?  
1. If yes:  
- In 1604-01: Delay Ring Timer (page 678), set the delay ring interval to meet the site requirements.  
- 1 = Lamp only day and night  
- 2 = Immediate ring day and night  
- 3 = Immediate ring night, lamp only day  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Delayed Ringing is also available for Call Coverage Keys.  
You can set up Delayed Ringing to ring with a distinctive tone.  
Consider having Delayed Ringing for Private Lines. Users with Delayed Ringing will ring for the Pri-  
vate Line only if it is not answered.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Dial Number Preview  
Dial Number Preview  
Description  
Dial Number Preview helps the user avoid dialing errors.  
Dial Number Preview lets a display keyset user dial and review a number before the system dials it out.  
Conditions  
• None.  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
None  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Dial Number Preview allows an extension user to review a number before the system dials it out.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Dial Number Preview  
To dial using Dial Number Preview:  
Do not lift the handset and do not press SPEAKER or INTERCOM.  
1.  
2.  
Dial *.  
Your display shows: DIAL PREVIEW.  
Dial the number you want to call.  
Your display shows the digits for your call.  
3.  
4.  
Press a line key.  
Your call will dial out on the line selected.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Editing the Displayed Number  
To correct the displayed digits before dialing them out:  
Press Volume Up or Volume Down until the cursor replaces the digit you want to change.  
1.  
Volume Up moves the cursor left; Volume Down moves the cursor right.  
Dial the digit that you want to replace the cursor.  
Do one of the following.  
2.  
3.  
a.  
b.  
Press Volume Up or Volume Down to place the cursor over any other digits you want to edit.  
Press Volume Down until the entire number displays to the left of the cursor.  
• The system will only dial the digits to the left of the cursor.  
96  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Dial Number Preview  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Editing the Displayed Number  
Press a line key to have the system automatically dial the displayed number.  
4.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Dial Number Preview Editing Example  
To replace 2049265410 with 2039265400:  
Dial * followed by 2049265410. You see: 2049265410-  
Press Volume Up until you see: 20-9265410  
Dial 3. You see: 203-265410  
1.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
5.  
6.  
7.  
Press Volume Down until you see: 20392654-0  
Dial 0. You see: 203926540-  
Press Volume Down until the entire number displays to the left of the cursor. You see: 2039265400-  
Press line key to dial number.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dial Tone Detection  
Dial Tone Detection  
Description  
You can set up the system to detect CO dial tone.  
The system can optionally detect precise CO dial tone for automatically dialed outside calls (such as Speed  
Dial and Auto Redial calls). With Dial Tone Detection enabled for a line, the system will monitor the line  
when initially seized for valid dial tone or stutter dial tone. If valid EIA/TIA dial tone is detected, the system  
outdials the call on the line. If dial tone is not detected within 2 seconds, the system will try the next avail-  
able line in the same line to which the initial line belongs. If another line in the group is not available, the  
user hears busy tone. Dial Tone Detection does not apply to manually dialed outside calls.  
If Dial Tone Detection is disabled, the system waits 500mS after line seizure and then outdials the number.  
If enabled, Dial Tone Detection applies to the following types of outside calls:  
Auto Redial (initial line seizure)  
Caller ID (callbacks)  
Last Number Redial  
Call Forwarding Off Premise  
Save  
Speed Dial  
Conditions  
• None.  
Default Setting  
• Disabled.  
Programming  
1.  
Should a line have dial tone detection enabled?  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Dial Tone Detection applies to the following features:  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
None  
98  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Direct Inward Dialing  
Direct Inward Dialing  
Description  
Directly dial system extensions from outside the system.  
Direct Inward Dialing (DID) lets outside callers directly dial system extensions. DID saves time for callers  
who know the extension number they wish to reach. To place a DID call, the outside caller dials the local  
exchange (NXX) and additional digits to ring the telephone system extension. For example, DID number  
926-5400 can directly ring extension 400. The caller does not have to rely on an attendant or receptionist to  
handle the call. Direct Inward Dialing is an efcient way to handle incoming calls, since callers can reach a  
large block of extensions over a relatively small number of DID lines. Direct Inward Dialing requires a T1  
PCB and T1 DID service with a block (range) of DID numbers from the telco.  
For outgoing calls, DID lines operate identically to loop start lines.  
In addition to direct dialing of system extensions, DID provides:  
DID Dialed Number Translation  
The system provides a 100-entry DID Translation Table. This table gives you more exibility when buy-  
ing DID service from the telco. If you can't buy the exact block of numbers you need (e.g., 300-399), use  
the translation table to convert the digits received. For example, a translation table could convert digits  
500-599 to extension numbers 300-399.  
By default, the system uses the last 2 digits of the received DID number to route to extensions 300-399.  
Flexible DID Service Compatibility  
You can program the system to be compatible with DID service of varying lengths (up to 8 digits). DID  
service is typically 3 or 4 digits long. With 4 digit service, the telco sends 4 digits to the system for trans-  
lation. With 3 digit service, the telco sends 3 digits to the system for translation. Be sure to set up your  
system for compatibility with the provided telco service. Additionally, the system is compatible with  
Dial Pulse (DP) and DTMF DID signaling. DID lines can be either wink start or immediate start.  
By default, there are no DID lines programmed.  
DID Station Intercept  
DID Station Intercept automatically reroutes DID calls under certain conditions. There are 3 types of  
DID Station Intercept:  
- Busy/DND Intercept  
If a caller dials an extension that is busy or in Do Not Disturb, the system routes the call to the  
extension’s programmed DID Station Intercept destination.  
- Ring No Answer Intercept  
If a caller dials an extension that is unanswered, the system routes the call to the extension’s pro-  
grammed DID Station Intercept destination.  
- Busy/DND and Ring No Answer Intercept  
If a caller dials an extension that is busy, in Do Not Disturb, or is unanswered, the system routes the  
call to the extension’s programmed DID Station Intercept destination.  
By default, DID Station Intercept is disabled for all extensions.  
Line Overow  
If an incoming DID call is not answered at the destination extension or at the programmed intercept des-  
tination, it routes according to Line Overow. This ensures that the call has an answering point in the  
system. Line Overow typically routes to voice mail or to an extension. If the call is not answered at the  
overow extension, it normally diverts to Key Ring. If Line Overow is disabled, an unanswered DID  
call routes to Key Ring (and cannot overow).  
By default, Line Overow is disabled. Unanswered calls route to Key Ring (and cannot overow).  
Vacant Intercept  
If a caller misdials or dials an extension that does not exist, or there is a DID Translation Table error,  
Vacant Intercept handles the call routing. Vacant Intercept is always enabled. Since Line Overow is dis-  
abled by default, Vacant Intercept by default routes to Key Ring (and cannot overow).  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Direct Inward Dialing  
- If the telco doesn’t send any digits into the system, or  
If the digits sent by the telco don’t correspond to a DID Translation Table entry, or  
If the destination extension is out of service:  
The call follows the 3112-Termination routing for the line. This includes the settings for Day Ter-  
mination, Day Overow, Night Termination, and Night Overow. The call is handled the same as  
an analog line and follows the normal system timers.  
- If the digits sent by the telco have a DID Translation Table entry with no corresponding destination  
programmed:  
No routing occurs and the caller hears busy tone.  
DID Camp-On  
DID Camp-On sets what happens to DID calls to busy extensions when you have Busy/DND Intercept  
disabled. With DID Camp-On enabled, a call to a busy extension camps-on to the extension. Without  
DID Camp-On, the caller to the busy extension just hears busy tone (or follows the intercept program-  
ming if enabled).  
By default, DID Camp-On is disabled.  
DID Routing to Voice Mail  
If a DID call is unanswered and is eventually routed to voice mail, it will route to the mailbox of the ini-  
tial DID destination. This is true regardless of whether the call routed to voice mail via DID Line Over-  
ow, Call Forwarding, or Extension Hunting.  
ANI/DNIS Support  
The system is compatible with telco's T1 Automatic Number Identication (ANI) and Dialed Number Infor-  
mation Service (DNIS) services. ANI/DNIS services can be provided on T1 loop start, ground start, and DID  
lines (but not E&M). ANI/DNIS Compatibility provides:  
Selectable Receive Format  
You can set up the system for compatibility with any combination of ANI, DNIS and Dialed Number  
(Address) data provided by the telco.  
Flexible Routing  
The system can route the incoming call based on the received DNIS data and the entries stored in the  
DID Translation Table.  
Caller ID  
The system can use the received ANI data to display the caller’s number on the called extension’s dis-  
play. The ANI data can be up to 10 digits long. (Note that the T1 PCB can alternately receive normal  
FSK-based Caller ID if provided by the telco, but cannot route on that data.)  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
100  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Direct Inward Dialing  
DID Call Handling  
The following steps illustrate how the system handles DID calls when the call is not intercepted by an exten-  
sion’s Call Forwarding or Extension Hunting.  
Basic DID Call Handling  
1.  
Is telco sending incorrect digits, or is there a DID Translation Table programming error?  
1. If yes:  
Vacant Intercept  
The call normally follows the following Line Overow programming.  
2. If no, go to the next step for routing.  
2.  
Is the destination extension allowed to receive DID calls?  
1. If yes, go to the next step for routing.  
- This occurs when 1401-08: Receive DID Calls (page 630) isYes.  
2. If no, the call immediately follows Line Overow.  
3.  
4.  
Is the destination extension available?  
1. If yes, the call rings the destination extension.  
- If unanswered, go to the next step for routing.  
2. If no, go to the next step for routing.  
Is Station Intercept programmed?  
1. If yes and the intercept condition is met, the call routes to the Station Intercept destination set up in:  
2. If yes and the intercept condition is not met, go to the next step for routing.  
3. If no, go to the next step for routing.  
5.  
Is DID Camp-On programmed (1401-09: Receive DID Camp-On (page 631) = Yes)?  
1. If yes:  
- If the extension is unanswered, the call follows Line Overow.  
- If the extension is busy or in DND, the call camps-on and then follows Line Overow.  
2. If no:  
- If the extension is unanswered, the call follows Line Overow.  
- If the extension is busy or in DND, the call won’t go through (i.e., caller hears busy).  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Direct Inward Dialing  
How Call Forwarding and Extension Hunting Interact with DID Calls  
The following chart summarizes how the system handles unanswered DID calls when Call Forwarding and/  
or Extension Hunting are enabled at an extension. For the specic routing details, see:  
If the call is unanswered, the system checks the highest  
priority routing choice rst (i.e., Call Forwarding).  
Priority 1  
Call Forwarding  
If the highest priority routing choice is not set up to handle  
the call condition, the system checks the next lower choice.  
For example, if an extension has Ring No Answer Forward-  
ing enabled and the call routes to that extension while it is  
busy, the system will then check Extension Hunting.  
Extension  
Hunting  
Priority 2  
If Extension Hunting is disabled or not set up to handle the  
call condition, the system checks DID Station Intercept.  
DID Station  
Intercept  
Priority 3  
If no there routing choices are found, the call will follow  
Line Overow.  
Line Overow  
Priority 4  
If Line Overow is disabled, the call will go to Key Ring  
(with no overow).  
Priority 5  
Key Ring  
102  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Direct Inward Dialing  
DID Call Handling with Call Forwarding and Extension Hunting  
The following two tables show the detailed interaction between Call Forwarding and Extension Hunting for  
unanswered DID Calls. These interactions occur when an extension user enables Call Forwarding and their  
extension is already part of an Extension Hunting group.  
Call Forwarding and Type 1 (Ring No Answer Line) Extension Hunting  
Destination Extension  
Forwarding Type  
Ring No Answer  
Busy  
In DND  
Busy/No Answer  
*32  
DID call rings destination.  
If unanswered, it rings the  
forwarding destination.  
If still unanswered, call  
routes to Line Overow.  
DID call rings forwarding destination.  
If unanswered, call routes to Line Overow.  
Immediate  
*34  
DID call immediately rings forwarding destination.  
If unanswered, call routes to Line Overow  
No Answer  
*36  
DID call rings destination.  
If unanswered, it rings the  
forwarding destination.  
If still unanswered, call  
routes to Line Overow.  
DID call Camps-On to destination.  
If unanswered, it rings the forwarding destination.  
If still unanswered, call routes to Line Overow.  
Forwarding Off  
*30  
DID call rings destination.  
If unanswered, it rings the  
hunt destination.  
DID call Camps-On to destination.  
If unanswered, it rings the hunt destination.  
If still unanswered, call routes to Line Overow.  
If still unanswered, call  
routes to Line Overow.  
Call Forwarding and Type 2 (Ring No Answer / Busy Line) Extension Hunting  
and  
Call Forwarding and Type 3 (Ring No Answer / Busy All) Extension Hunting  
and  
Call Forwarding and Type 4 (Busy Line) Extension Hunting  
Busy/No Answer  
*32  
DID call rings destination.  
If unanswered, it rings the  
forwarding destination.  
If still unanswered, call  
routes to Line Overow.  
DID call rings forwarding destination.  
If unanswered, call routes to Line Overow.  
Immediate  
*34  
DID call immediately rings forwarding destination.  
If unanswered, call routes to Line Overow  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Direct Inward Dialing  
Call Forwarding and Type 1 (Ring No Answer Line) Extension Hunting  
Destination Extension  
Busy  
Forwarding Type  
Ring No Answer  
In DND  
No Answer  
*36  
DID call rings destination.  
If unanswered, it rings the  
forwarding destination.  
If still unanswered, call  
routes to Line Overow.  
DID call rings the hunt destination.  
If unanswered, call routes to Line Overow.  
Forwarding Off  
*30  
DID call rings destination.  
If unanswered:  
- Type 2 and 3 ring the  
hunt destination.  
- Type 4 rings the station  
intercept destination (if  
programmed).  
If still unanswered, call  
routes to Line Overow.  
All Camp-On and Ring No Answer intervals are set by the 1601-02: DIL No Answer Timer (page 669).  
104  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Inward Dialing  
DID Station Intercept and Line Overow  
The following table shows the detailed interaction between DID Station Intercept and Line Overow for unan-  
swered DID Calls. These interactions occur when an extension has DID Station Intercept enabled, the DID line  
has Line Overow enabled, and the call is not intercepted by either Call Forwarding or Extension Hunting.  
DID Station Intercept and Line Overow  
Destination Extension  
Station Intercept  
DID Camp-On  
Ring No Answer  
Busy  
In DND  
None  
(0)  
1 (Enabled)  
If unanswered, call  
routes to Line Over-  
ow.  
Call Camps-On to extension.  
If unanswered, call routes to Line Overow.  
0 (Disabled)  
If unanswered, call  
routes to Line Over-  
ow.  
Caller hears busy tone and call does not  
reroute.  
Busy / DND  
(1)  
1 (Enabled)  
If unanswered, call  
routes to Line Over-  
ow.  
Call Camps-On to  
extension.  
If unanswered, call  
routes to Line Over-  
ow.  
Call routes to inter-  
cept destination.  
If unanswered, call  
routes to Line Over-  
ow.  
0 (Disabled)  
If unanswered, call  
routes to Line Over-  
ow.  
Call routes to intercept destination.  
If unanswered, call routes to Line Overow.  
Ring No Answer  
(2)  
1 (Enabled)  
If unanswered, call  
routes to intercept  
destination.  
If still unanswered,  
call routes to Line  
Overow.  
Call Camps-On to extension.  
If unanswered, call routes to Line Overow.  
0 (Disabled)  
If unanswered, call  
routes to intercept  
destination.  
If still unanswered,  
call routes to Line  
Overow.  
Caller hears busy tone and call does not  
reroute.  
Busy / Ring No  
Answer (3)  
1 (Enabled)  
If unanswered, call  
routes to intercept  
destination.  
If still unanswered,  
call routes to Line  
Overow.  
Call Camps-On to  
extension.  
If unanswered, call  
routes to intercept  
destination.  
If still unanswered,  
call routes to Line  
Overow.  
If unanswered, call  
routes to intercept  
destination.  
If still unanswered,  
call routes to Line  
Overow.  
0 (Disabled)  
If unanswered, call  
routes to intercept  
destination.  
If still unanswered,  
call routes to Line  
Overow.  
Call routes to intercept destination.  
If unanswered, call routes to Line Overow.  
All Camp-On and Ring No Answer intervals are set in 1601-02: DIL No Answer Timer (page 669).  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Direct Inward Dialing  
Programming  
Basic Programming  
1.  
Set the circuit type for each DID line.  
1. Be sure your T1 PCB is installed and connected and that your telco is providing T1 DID service.  
- 03 for DID Wink Start  
- 04 for DID Immediate Start  
4. If your telco provides DID service using E&M Wink Start DTMF signaling, choose circuit type 03 (DID  
Wink Start) and enable 3101-03: DTMF Dialing.  
2.  
3.  
Specify the number of incoming DID digits you expect to receive from the telco.  
from the connected DID service.  
- By default, the system expects to receive three DID digits from the connected service.  
Set up the DID Translation Table.  
1. Use the following programs to set up DID Translation:  
(The default entry of *** means the system accepts any three digits.)  
(The default entry of 3** means the system routes to an extension in the day mode according to the  
last two digits dialed.)  
(The default entry of 3** means the system routes to an extension in the night mode according to  
the last two digits dialed.)  
4.  
5.  
Should the extension be allowed to receive DID calls?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
Do the T1 lines provide ANI/DNIS services?  
1. If yes:  
- In 3121-01: Caller ID Type (page 825), enter 3 to enable ANI-based Caller ID for the line.  
- In 3121-02: ANI/DNIS Format (page 825), specify the type of ANI/DNIS data received from the  
telco:  
- 0 for No ANI/DNIS data  
- 1 for ANI  
- 2 for *ANI*  
- 3 for *DNIS*  
- 4 for *ANI*DNIS*  
telco (for options 2-4 above only). The delimiter can be any character 0-9, #, or *. Normally, the  
delimiter is *.  
106  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Inward Dialing  
ANI number (for option 1 above only). This program does not apply to options 2-4 above.  
2. If no, in 3121-01: Caller ID Type (page 825) do not enter 3 to enable ANI-based Caller ID for the line.  
DID Overow, Camp-On, and Intercept Options  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Should the system provide Line Overow for the DID line during the day?  
1. If yes:  
- In 3112-03: Day Overow Destination (page 820) enter the day overow destination. The destina-  
tion can be:  
- An extension  
- A UCD Group master number  
- The voice mail master number  
- A Ring Group master number  
- Key Ring (by pressing CLEAR)  
- Overow occurs after the 1601-01: Line No Answer Timer (page 669) interval.  
- When disabled, an unanswered DID call during the day diverts to Key Ring without overow  
(unless intercepted by other features).  
- The call diverts to Key Ring after the 1601-01: Line No Answer Timer (page 669) interval.  
Should the system provide Line Overow for the DID line at night?  
1. If yes:  
nation can be:  
- An extension  
- A UCD Group master number  
- The voice mail master number  
- A Ring Group master number  
- Key Ring (by pressing CLEAR)  
- Overow occurs after the 1601-01: Line No Answer Timer (page 669) interval.  
- When disabled, an unanswered DID call at night diverts to Key Ring without overow (unless  
intercepted by other features).  
- The call diverts to Key Ring after the 1601-01: Line No Answer Timer (page 669) interval.  
Should an extension have DID Station Intercept?  
1. If yes:  
Intercept destination (e.g., an extension, UCD Group master number, voice mail master number, or  
Ring Group master number).  
Intercept to occur.  
1 = Busy/DND overow  
2 = Ring No Answer overow  
3 = Busy/DND/Ring No Answer overow  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Direct Inward Dialing  
Does an unanswered extension ring the correct amount of time before DID Station Intercept or  
Line Overow occurs?  
4.  
5.  
Should DID calls be allowed to Camp-On to an extension?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Extension Hunting has priority over DID Station Intercept and DID Line Overow. For example, if an  
extension has a Type 3 (Ring No Answer/Busy All) hunt to voice mail and a Type 3 DID Station Inter-  
cept to the operator, unanswered calls will route to voice mail. See the IntraMail System Guide for  
more on Extension Hunting to Voice Mail.  
T1 provides advanced digital calling and simplies installation. T1 lines are required for Direct  
Inward Dialing.  
Link two systems together for inter-system Intercom calling and other features.  
Transfer recalls do not follow DID Station Intercept.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
None.  
108  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Inward Line  
Direct Inward Line  
Description  
A DIL lets an employee know which calls are just for them.  
A Direct Inward Line (DIL) is a line that rings an extension directly. Since DILs only ring one extension,  
employees always know which calls are for them. For example, a company operator can have a Direct  
Inward Line for International Sales Information. When outside callers dial the DIL’s phone number, the call  
rings the operator on the International Sales line key. The DIL does not ring other extensions.  
Assigning a DIL to an extension automatically provides immediate ringing and incoming access for the line,  
with no additional programming required.  
A DIL can ring:  
Extension numbers (including the attendant’s extension)  
Ring Group master numbers  
UCD Group master numbers (including the voice mail master number)  
Night Mode Control  
The extension to which the line is terminated controls the night mode of the line. For example, if extension  
301 has line 1 assigned as a DIL, the user can press DND to switch line 1 to its night routing destination.  
Switching line 1 to night mode at extension 301 has no affect on the night mode of the system. This exibil-  
ity could allow a service dispatcher with several DILs to independently send lines to their night destinations  
without affecting the night mode of the entire system.  
Overow for Direct Inward Lines  
If unanswered, DIL calls can route to a programmed overow destination. The overow destination can be  
an extension, Ring Group, UCD Group or voice mail (i.e., DIL destination’s mailbox). You can set up sepa-  
rate DIL overow destinations for the day mode and at night. If unanswered at the overow destination, the  
call diverts to Key Ring.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No DILs assigned.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Direct Inward Line  
Programming  
Basic Programming  
1.  
2.  
Check the DIL’s circuit type.  
1. In 3101-01: Line Type (page 809), check to be sure the line’s circuit type matches the connected service.  
Assign the DIL day and night mode terminations (answering points).  
1. In the day:  
assignment can be:  
- An extension  
- A UCD Group master number  
- The voice mail master number  
- A Ring Group master number  
2. At night:  
assignment can be:  
- An extension  
- A UCD Group master number  
- The voice mail master number  
- A Ring Group master number  
3.  
Set up night keys for the DIL.  
1. For a line terminated to Key Ring or a Ring Group master number during the day:  
2. For a line terminated to a UCD Group master number or voice mail during the day:  
-
In 2121-[01 to 24]: Feature Key Data (page 758), enter the UCD Group or voice mail master number.  
3. For a line terminated to the extension during the day:  
- Use the DND key.  
4. Be sure the extension has the ability to put the system in the Night Mode.  
- In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
110  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Inward Line  
DIL Overow  
1.  
Should an unanswered DIL overow during the day?  
1. If yes:  
- In 3112-03: Day Overow Destination (page 820) enter the day overow destination. The destina-  
tion can be:  
- An extension  
- A UCD Group master number  
- The voice mail master number  
- A Ring Group master number  
- Key Ring (by pressing CLEAR)  
2.  
Should an unanswered DIL overow at night?  
1. If yes:  
nation can be:  
- An extension  
- A UCD Group master number  
- The voice mail master number  
- A Ring Group master number  
- Key Ring (by pressing CLEAR)  
If a DIL to an extension is unanswered, does it divert to its overow destination after the proper  
interval?  
-If DIL overow is disabled, the call diverts to Key Ring after this interval.  
3.  
-This interval also sets how long a call rings the overow destination before diverting to Key Ring.  
If a DIL to a Ring Group is unanswered, does it divert to its overow destination after the proper  
interval?  
-If DIL overow is disabled, the call diverts to Key Ring after this interval.  
4.  
5.  
If a DIL to a UCD Group or voice mail is unanswered, optionally set up UCD Overow.  
1. Turn to Extension Hunting (page 154) for more on how to set up UCD Overow.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Inward Line  
Setting Up Line and Loop Keys  
1.  
Set up line or loop key for the DIL.  
1. For line keys:  
- If an extension doesn’t have any line keys, you should assign Fixed or Switched Loop keys to  
make handling outside calls easier.  
2. For Fixed Loop keys:  
3. For Switched Loop keys:  
DIL belongs (90-98).  
2.  
Set up line keys for a DSS Console.  
1. For line keys:  
- Loop keys are not available on a DSS Console.  
112  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Inward Line  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Call Forwarding will reroute an extension’s DILs.  
A DIL to a busy extension will send Camp-On tones (if the extension is programmed to normally  
receive Camp-On tones).  
Refer to these features to set additional parameters for lines (such as transmit gain, receive gain and  
sidetone level). In addition, extension users can place calls on DILs, just like other lines (depending on  
programming).  
DILs automatically override Delayed Ringing.  
Enabling Do Not Disturb at an extension puts that extension’s DILs into Night Mode.  
With Extended Ringing enabled, DIL lines ring for the Number of Extended Rings before routing to  
the overow destination.  
DILs to a Circular or Terminal Hunting group member initiate hunting. In addition, DILs to a UCD  
Group master number ring the UCD Group directly.  
A DIL can ring a Ring Group master number.  
An unanswered DIL diverts to all extensions with Key Ring for the line.  
When you assign a line as a DIL, it continues to ash its previously programmed line/loop key assign-  
ments. It will not, however, ring those phones.  
Programming names for DILs makes it easier to identify incoming callers.  
The extension to which the DIL is terminated controls the night mode of the DIL by pressing their  
DND key.  
A DIL ringing a busy extension can automatically initiate Off-Hook Signaling.  
DILs cannot ring over the External Paging speakers or activate the page relay.  
If an extension’s Prime Line is another extension’s DIL, lifting the handset will answer the call even  
though it does not ring the phone.  
• The voice mail Automated Attendant will answer a DIL terminated to the voice mail Master Number.  
If a DIL is terminated to the voice mail master number, a System Mode key (code 18 + the voice mail  
number) controls the night mode status of the DIL.  
IntraMail Features  
An unanswered DIL to the Ring Group master number can be picked up by the Ring Group Mailbox.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Inward Line  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
HandlingYour Direct Inward Lines  
To answer a call on your Direct Inward Line:  
The line or loop key for your DIL ashes green.  
1.  
2.  
Lift handset.  
• The key lights on green when you connect to your caller.  
To place your Direct Inward Line into the Night Mode:  
Press DND.  
Your DND ashes.  
• This also enables Do Not Disturb for your extension.  
1.  
114  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Line Access  
Direct Line Access  
Description  
Priority users can access lines directly. Direct Line Access also lets maintenance personnel  
access and test individual lines.  
Direct Line Access lets an extension user access (seize) an individual line. After seizing the line, the user can  
dial any outside telephone number without restriction. An extension’s Class of Service allows or denies  
Direct Line Access. Direct Line Access is normally only provided for attendants, priority users and mainte-  
nance personnel.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled for Class of Service 1 (the attendant).  
• Disabled for Classes of Service 2-15.  
Programming  
1.  
Should extension have Direct Line Access capability?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. If yes;  
- It is not necessary to allow access in 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763). Direct Line Access  
automatically provides access.  
3. If no:  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Refer to this feature for other methods of placing outside calls.  
An extension user with Direct Line Access can use Forced Line Disconnect.  
An extension user with Direct Line Access can remove lines from service.  
Direct Line Access does not bypass Toll Restriction.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Direct Line Access  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Direct Line Access  
To place a call over a specic line using Direct Line Access:  
Lift the handset.  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Press INTERCOM.  
Dial 1 plus the line number (e.g., 01 for line 1).  
• If you hear busy tone, you may be able to dial 2 to queue for the line. See Line Queuing / Line Callback  
Dial the outside number.  
4.  
116  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Station Selection (DSS)  
Direct Station Selection (DSS)  
Description  
Quickly place and Transfer calls to co-workers, without having to look up or dial your co-  
worker’s extension numbers.  
Important  
If you enable an extension’s DSS Keys and leave the extension’s default Prime Line programming  
intact, the line keys automatically change to DSS keys when the user lifts the handset. To avoid con-  
fusion, be sure to explain this to your users.  
Remember, in addition to providing one-button Intercom access and Transfer, Call Coverage Keys  
also provide call pickup capability.  
If an extension’s Direct Station Selection (DSS) Keys are enabled, Feature Keys automatically become  
Direct Station Selection (DSS) keys when the user presses INTERCOM. Direct Station Selection provides an  
extension user with one-button Intercom access and Transfer to co-workers. Each DSS key also provides a  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF) for the assigned co-worker.  
When the DSS/BLF key is:  
The covered extension is:  
Off  
On  
Idle  
Busy or ringing  
In Do Not Disturb  
Flashing fast  
Conditions  
• DSS keys do not pick up ringing calls.  
Default Setting  
• Not assigned. DSS capability is disabled.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Direct Station Selection (DSS)  
Programming  
1.  
Should extension have DSS capability on their Feature Keys?  
1. If yes:  
- In 2114-01: Prime Line Key (page 741), do not enable Intercom Prime Line. This prevents the  
extension’s line keys from switching to DSS mode when the user lifts the handset while idle.  
2.  
Should the extension have pre programmed DSS keys?  
1. If yes, in 2123-[01-24]: DSS/BLF Key Assignments (page 760) program the extension’s DSS assignments.  
2. If no, in 2123-[01-24]: DSS/BLF Key Assignments (page 760) leave the extension’s DSS keys unassigned.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
A user can press a DSS key as an alternative to dialing Intercom numbers.  
With Intercom Prime Line, an idle extension user hears Intercom dial tone whenever they lift the  
handset or press SPEAKER. Since each extension’s Busy Lamp Field is disabled by default, the Fea-  
ture Keys do not go into the DSS mode when the user lifts the handset while idle. (If an outside call is  
ringing the phone, Ringing Line Preference will normally answer the call when the user lifts the hand-  
set — even with Intercom Prime Line enabled.)  
The Personal Speed Dial Keys also provide one-button access to extensions.  
You can press your DSS key to Transfer a call instead of dialing a co-worker’s extension number.  
An extension can Voice Over after using Direct Station Selection to call a co-worker.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
118  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Station Selection (DSS)  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Placing a Call using a DSS Key  
To place a call to a co-worker using a DSS key:  
Lift the handset.  
1.  
2.  
Press INTERCOM.  
Your DSS keys show the status of the assigned extension:  
Off = Idle  
On = Busy or ringing  
Fast ash = in Do Not Disturb  
Press DSS key for the co-worker you want to call.  
3.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Transferring a Call using a DSS Key  
To Transfer a call to a co-worker using a DSS key:  
Place or answer an outside call.  
1.  
2.  
Press INTERCOM.  
Your DSS keys show the status of the assigned extension:  
Off = Idle  
On = Busy or ringing  
Fast ash = in Do Not Disturb  
Press DSS key for the co-worker you want to call.  
Do one of the following:  
3.  
4.  
a.  
b.  
Press TRANSFER to have the Transfer go through unscreened.  
Wait for your co-worker to answer if you want them to screen the transfer, then pressTRANSFER.  
User Programmable Feature  
Setting Up DSS Keys  
Operation  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
Access Level  
#BLF  
(#253)  
DSS  
#BLF + Press Feature Key + HOLD + Enter extension  
number + Volume Up + Program another key or  
SPEAKER to exit.  
1-5  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Direct Station Selection (DSS) Console  
Direct Station Selection (DSS) Console  
Description  
DSS Consoles provide one-touch access to extensions, lines, and system features.  
The DSS Console (P/N 1090024 for black and P/N 090029  
for white) gives a keyset user one-button access to exten-  
sions, lines, and selected features. This saves time for users  
that do a lot of call processing such as operators or dis-  
patchers).  
The system allows you to install 4 DSS Consoles maxi-  
mum per system. DSS Consoles use their own digital sta-  
tion port and do not require a separate power supply. In  
programming, you assign each installed console to an  
“owner” keyset. Each console can only have one owner.  
You can assign the following types of Feature Keys to a DSS Console.:  
Account Code  
Intercom Directory Dialing  
Line keys  
Save Number Dialed  
Speed Dial, Personal  
Call Coverage (immediate,  
delayed or no ring)  
Call Forwarding  
Message Center  
Night key  
Speed Dial, System  
Split  
Group Call Pickup (immedi-  
ate, delayed or no ring)  
Headset key  
Hotline  
Page Zones  
Park Orbit  
Voice Mail Conversation  
Record  
120  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Direct Station Selection (DSS) Console  
Default DSS Console Key Assignments  
The following illustration shows the default DSS Console key assignments.  
300  
306  
301  
307  
302  
308  
303  
309  
315  
321  
327  
333  
339  
345  
304  
310  
305  
311  
312  
313  
314  
316  
317  
318  
319  
320  
322  
323  
324  
325  
326  
328  
329  
330  
331  
332  
334  
335  
336  
337  
338  
340  
341  
342  
343  
344  
346  
347  
ALL  
Page 1  
Park 62  
Page 2  
Park 63  
Page 3  
Park 64  
Park 60  
Park 66  
Park 61  
Night  
CALL  
Park 65  
ANSWER  
RELEASE  
TRANSFER  
Conditions  
You must consider the System Load Factor when installing DSS Consoles.  
Default Setting  
• The rst DSS Console installed auto-IDs as software port 301.  
• See the illustration above for default DSS Console key assignments.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Direct Station Selection (DSS) Console  
Programming  
1.  
Set up the DSS Console.  
port to a software port.  
- 301 for DSS Console 1  
- 302 for DSS Console 2  
- 303 for DSS Console 3  
- 304 for DSS Console 4  
- Note that the rst DSS Console installed auto-IDs as software port 301.  
2. In 2401-01: DSS Owner (page 800), enter the number of the keyset extension using the DSS Console.  
2.  
Set up the DSS Console Feature Keys.  
1. In 2402-[01-60]: DSS Console Key Codes (page 801), enter the key code for the DSS Console key you  
are programming.  
- Refer to the DSS Console Key Assignments chart below for the key codes.  
- Refer to the DSS Console Key Assignments chart below for the key codes.  
122  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Station Selection (DSS) Console  
DSS Console Feature Key Assignments  
DSS Console Feature Key Assignments (Page 1 of 4)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
0
Operation  
Use this option to designate a Feature Key as  
undened (no function).  
N/A  
Undened  
3 + nn (line  
number 1-64)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
line key.  
Press the key to  
place or answer call.  
Line  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Line is idle or not installed.  
On (red) . . . . . . . . . . . A co-worker is busy on the line or has the line on Exclusive Hold.  
On (green) . . . . . . . . . You are busy on the line.  
Wink On (red) . . . . . . . On System Hold at a co-worker’s extension.  
Wink On (green). . . . . . On System Hold at your extension.  
Double Wink On (green). On Exclusive Hold or recalling your extension.  
Slow Flash (red). . . . . . Line is ringing.  
Slow Flash (green):. . . . Lineisringingoryourextensiondirectly.  
4 + nn (Park Orbit  
60-69)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Park Orbit key.  
Press key to Park or  
retrieve parked call.  
Park Orbit  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . Orbit is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . . . . Orbit is holding a parked call.  
Wink On (green). . . Orbit is holding a call you parked.  
5 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Hotline key. You cannot set up a hotline for an  
outside line.  
Press key to call  
Hotline partner.  
Hotline  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . Partner extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . . . . Partner extension is busy or ringing.  
Medium Flash . . . . Partner extension is in DND for outside calls (option 1).  
Fast Flash. . . . . . . Partner extension is in DND for Intercom calls (option 2) or All Calls (option 3).  
6 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as an  
immediately ringing Call Coverage Key.  
Press key to call cov-  
ered extension or  
pick up ringing call.  
Call Coverage  
Immediate Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is busy.  
Slow Flash . . . . . . Covered extension is ringing.  
Medium Flash . . . . Covered extension is in DND for outside calls (option 1).  
Fast Flash. . . . . . . Covered extension is in DND for Intercom calls (option 2) or All Calls (option 3).  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Direct Station Selection (DSS) Console  
DSS Console Feature Key Assignments (Page 2 of 4)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
Operation  
7 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
lamp only (no ring) Call Coverage Key.  
Press key to call cov-  
ered extension or  
pick up ringing call.  
Call Coverage No  
Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is busy.  
Slow Flash . . . . . . Covered extension is ringing.  
Medium Flash . . . . Covered extension is in DND for outside calls (option 1).  
Fast Flash. . . . . . . Covered extension is in DND for Intercom calls (option 2) or All Calls (option 3).  
8 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
delayed ringing Call Coverage Key.  
Press key to call cov-  
ered extension or  
pick up ringing call.  
Call Coverage  
Delay Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is busy.  
Slow Flash . . . . . . Covered extension is ringing.  
Medium Flash . . . . Covered extension is in DND for outside calls (option 1).  
Fast Flash. . . . . . . Covered extension is in DND for Intercom calls (option 2) or All Calls (option 3).  
9 + nn (Pickup Group  
1-16)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as an  
immediately ringing Group Call Pickup key.  
Press key to answer  
call ringing Pickup  
Group.  
Group Pickup  
Immediate Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . No call is ringing the pickup group.  
Slow Flash (green) . A call is ringing the pickup group.  
10 + nn (Pickup  
Group 1-16)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
lamp only (no ring) Group Call Pickup key.  
Press key to answer  
call ringing Pickup  
Group.  
Group Pickup No  
Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . No call is ringing the pickup group.  
Slow Flash (green) . A call is ringing the pickup group.  
11 + nn (Pickup  
Group 1-16)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
delay ring Group Call Pickup key.  
Press key to answer  
call ringing Pickup  
Group.  
Group Pickup  
Delay Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . No call is ringing the pickup group.  
Slow Flash (green) . A call is ringing the pickup group.  
13 + n (Page Zone 1-  
7, 0 for All Call)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Page Zone key.  
Press key to Page  
into assigned zone.  
Page Zone  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
On . . . . . . . . . . . The assigned Page zone is busy.  
On (green) . . . . . . The assigned Page zone is busy broadcasting an announcement you are making.  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . The assigned Page zone is idle.  
124  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Station Selection (DSS) Console  
DSS Console Feature Key Assignments (Page 3 of 4)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
Operation  
14 + nnn (bin 001-  
999)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
System Speed Dial key. You assign the key to  
specic System Speed Dial bin.  
Press key to dial  
stored number.  
System Speed  
Dial  
• There is no BLF for this key type.  
15 + nnn (01-20)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Personal Speed Dial key.You assign the key to  
a specic Personal Speed Dial bin.  
Press key to dial  
stored number.  
Personal Speed  
Dial  
• There is no BLF for this key type.  
17 + nnn (extension  
number of valid Sub-  
scriber Mailbox)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Voice Mail Record key.  
Press key to record  
conversation into  
mailbox.  
Voice Mail  
Record  
You must have voice mail installed to  
use this key.  
• A voice prompt and periodic beep will  
remind you that your calls are being  
recorded.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . Conversation Record is off.  
Fast Flash (green) . Conversation Record is on.  
18 + CLEAR  
(System Night key)  
18 + UCD Group  
master number  
(UCD Night key)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Night key. There are two options: System  
Night key and UCD Night key. The System  
Night key puts all Key Ring lines and lines  
terminated to Ring Group master numbers  
into the night mode. The UCD Night key puts  
all lines terminated to the UCD Group master  
number into the night mode.  
Press key to put Key  
Ring lines and lines  
terminated to Ring  
Group master into  
night mode.  
Night  
OR  
Press key to put  
lines terminated to  
UCD master into  
night mode.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
On . . . . . . . . . . . Night mode is on.  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . Night mode is off.  
20  
21  
Use this option to assign a programmable key  
as a Split key.  
• There is no BLF for this key type.  
Split  
Use this option to assign a programmable key  
as an Intercom Directory Dialing key.  
Press key to access  
Intercom Directory  
Dialing.  
Intercom  
Directory Dialing  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
On . . . . . . . . . . . Intercom Directory Dialing is active (being used).  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . Intercom Directory Dialing is inactive (off).  
24 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Message Center key.  
Press key to call  
Message Center  
Mailbox.  
Message Center  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . No messages waiting in the Message Center Mailbox.  
Fast Flash (green) . Messages waiting in the Message Center Mailbox.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Station Selection (DSS) Console  
DSS Console Feature Key Assignments (Page 4 of 4)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
25  
Operation  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Save Number Dialed key.  
• There is no BLF for this key type.  
While on a call:  
Save Number  
Dialed  
Press key to save  
the number you just  
dialed.  
While idle:  
Press key to redial a  
previously saved  
number.  
26  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as an  
Account Code key.  
1. Place or answer out-  
side call.  
Account Code  
2. Press key.  
3. Enter Account Code.  
4. Press key to return to  
the call.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . Not in Account Code mode or not entering Account Codes.  
Fast Flash (green) . In the Account Code entry mode.  
On (green) . . . . . . On a call for which the user has entered an Account Code.  
27  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Call Forwarding key.  
Press key instead of  
pressing INTER-  
Call Forwarding  
COM and dialing *3  
.
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . Extension not call forwarded or in the Call Forwarding setup mode.  
Fast Flash. . . . . . . In the Call Forwarding setup mode.  
Wink Off . . . . . . . . Extension has Call Forwarding enabled.  
28  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Headset key.  
Press key to enable  
or disable headset  
mode.  
Headset  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . Extension is not in the headset mode.  
On . . . . . . . . . . . Extension is in the headset mode.  
126  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Station Selection (DSS) Console  
Other Related Features  
Features  
A DSS Console can have an Account Code key to simplify Account Code entry.  
A DSS Console can have Call Coverage keys.  
A DSS Console Call Forwarding key can streamline Call Forwarding operation.  
A DSS Console can have line keys for placing and answering outside calls.  
Assign a Directory Dialing key on a DSS Console.  
A DSS Console can have Group Call Pickup keys.  
A DSS Console headset key can simplify switching the headset mode.  
A DSS Console can have Hotline keys.  
A DSS Console can have night keys for putting the system and UCD Groups into the night mode.  
A DSS Console can have Page zone keys.  
A DSS Console can have Park keys.  
A DSS Console can have Reverse Voice Over keys.  
A DSS Console can have a Save key.  
A DSS Console can have a Split key.  
A DSS Console can have keys for Personal and System Speed Dial bins. The DSS Console Personal  
Speed Dial bins are the same as the extension to which the console is attached.  
A DSS Console can have voice mail Record and Message Center keys.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Station Selection (DSS) Console  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using the Speed Processing Keys on the DSS Console  
To use the ANSWER key:  
1.  
Press ANSWER to answer any call ringing your extension.  
To use the RELEASE key:  
1.  
Press RELEASE to hang up (disconnect) your active call.  
To use the TRANSFER key:  
1.  
Press TRANSFER on your DSS Console instead of the TRANSFER key on your extension.  
User Programmable Feature  
DSS Console Hotline Key Assignments  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#HL (#45)  
Operation  
Access Level  
Hotline  
#HL + Press ashing Hotline key + Enter extension for  
new Hotline partner + HOLD + Program another Hotline  
key or SPEAKER to exit.  
3-5  
128  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Directed Call Pickup  
Directed Call Pickup  
Description  
Directed Call Pickup allows co-workers to answer each other’s calls.  
Directed Call Pickup permits an extension user to intercept any type of call ringing another extension. With  
Directed Call Pickup, an extension user can pick up:  
Outside (Key Ring) calls ringing an extension  
Direct Inward Lines  
Transferred outside calls  
Ringing Intercom calls  
Recalls (e.g., Hold recall)  
Ring Group Calls (by dialing either the ringing extension’s number or the Ring Group master number)  
Ringing Call Coverage key calls  
Ringing Group Call Pickup calls  
Calls ringing the operator’s Operator Call key  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
1.  
Line access is not required for Directed Call Pickup.  
1. It is not necessary to allow access in 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763).  
- Directed Call Pickup allows an extension to pick up a call on a line to which it normally does not  
have access.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Directed Call Pickup can pick up Hold recalls.  
Personal Park allows an extension user to pick up a call parked at a co-worker’s extension.  
The following features also let co-worker’s cover each other’s calls:  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Directed Call Pickup  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Directed Call Pickup  
To intercept a call ringing a co-worker’s extension:  
Lift the handset.  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Dial * *.  
Dial the number of the extension whose call you want to intercept.  
• To intercept a call ringing an attendant, dial the attendant’s extension number (e.g., 300). Do not dial 0 or 01-04.  
130  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Directory Dialing  
Directory Dialing  
Description  
Allows users to place Intercom or Speed Dial calls from a displayed list of names.  
Directory Dialing allows a display keyset user to select a co-worker or outside call from a list of names,  
rather than dialing the phone number. There are three types of directory Dialing:  
System (Company-Wide) Speed Dial names.  
Intercom names (including extension, Ring Group and UCD Group names).  
Personal Speed Dial names.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Directory Dialing always enabled.  
• There are no Intercom (extension) names or Speed Dial names stored.  
Programming  
1.  
Enter names for extensions.  
- An extension user may be able to enter their own name. See Names for Extensions and Lines  
2.  
Enter names for Speed Dial bins.  
1. For Personal Speed Dial, use the following programs to set up personal bins:  
2. For System Speed Dial, use the following programs to set up system bins:  
3.  
4.  
Enter names for Ring Groups and UCD Groups.  
Optionally set up an extension or DSS Console Feature Key for Intercom Directory Dialing?  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Directory Dialing  
5.  
Do extension users have adequate time to enter their Directory Dialing options?  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Assign a Directory Dialing key on a DSS Console.  
Intercom Directory Dialing can call UCD Group names.  
Intercom Directory Dialing can call Ring Group names.  
Directory Dialing is a convenient alternative to manually dialing Intercom numbers.  
Set up the names for extensions and lines.  
Set up Speed Dial names.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Directory Dialing  
To place a call using Directory Dialing:  
1.  
Select the Directory Dialing type.  
[DIRECTORY + EXTENSION]  
[DIR + EXT]  
Select Intercom Directory Dialing.  
You can optionally dial 34 (while on hook).  
[DIRECTORY + PERSONAL]  
[DIR + PERS]  
Select Personal Speed Dial Directory Dialing.  
You can optionally dial 37 (while on hook).  
[DIRECTORY + COMPANY]  
[DIR + CMPY]  
Select System Speed Dial Directory Dialing.  
You can optionally dial 32 (while on hook).  
2.  
Do one of the following:  
a.  
b.  
To place the call by scrolling:  
i.  
Press Volume Up or Volume Down until the name you want to call displays.  
[Dial]  
[Dial]  
ii.  
Select to call the displayed name.  
To place the call by alphabetical dialing:  
Dial the rst letter of the desired name.  
i.  
• For example, dial 4 if the name begins with G, H, or I.  
132  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Directory Dialing  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Directory Dialing  
Look at your telephone’s display and dial the digit for the letter you want to call.  
• In the example in step i:  
- Dial 1 if the name begins with G.  
ii.  
- Dial 2 if the name begins with H.  
- Dial 3 if the name begins with I.  
• The rst name that begins with your selection displays. If you see UNLISTED NAME,  
there is no name stored for your selection.  
Press Volume Up or Volume Down to scroll through all the names that begin with the  
letter you selected.  
OR  
Skip to the next step if the display name is the one you want to call.  
iii.  
iv.  
[Dial]  
[Dial]  
Select to call the displayed name.  
To exit Directory Dialing at any time:  
1.  
Press SPEAKER.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Display, Alphanumeric  
Display, Alphanumeric  
Description  
134  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Distinctive Ringing  
Distinctive Ringing  
Description  
Allows users to customize their telephone’s ringing so they’ll know when calls are just for them.  
Important  
Following initialization, you must reset the system or unplug and then re-plug each telephone.  
Distinctive Ringing allows the installer or keyset extension user to customize keyset ringing. This permits  
the user to determine the type of call just by listening to their keyset ring. Distinctive Ringing provides:  
Distinctive Ring Conguration at Each Keyset  
A keyset user can follow intuitive soft key menus to set up distinctive ringing for their phone. Their  
phone will even play back the new ring tones as the distinctive rings are being set up.  
Line Override (Distinctive Ringing by Line and Ringing Mode)  
Each line can have its own distinctive ringing for each ring mode (day, night, or delay). This allows a  
keyset user, for example, to easily differentiate between new ringing calls and calls that are ringing their  
phone after a delay.  
Extension Ring Override  
Each keyset extension can additionally override a line’s distinctive ringing with the extension’s own  
unique settings. Extension Ring Override helps identify ringing phones in large, open work areas.  
Key Ring Override  
A keyset extension can set up unique ringing for each of its Call Coverage, Group Call Pickup, and line  
keys. If a user needs to know what type of call is ringing their phone, Key Ring Override will help.  
Unique Ringing for UCD Groups and Ring Groups  
UCD Groups and Ring Groups can have their own distinctive rings. This allows a user to tell the differ-  
ence between Intercom calls ringing their phone and UCD or Ring Group Calls.  
The Distinctive Ringing Hierarchy  
An extension’s Distinctive Ringing uses the following hierarchy:  
1. Key Ring Override  
2. Extension Ring Override  
3. Line Override  
4. Default ringing assigned by the system  
This means that Line Override will replace the default ringing assigned by the system. Extension Ring Over-  
ride will in turn replace ringing set by Line Override. Finally, Key Ring Override will replace ringing set by  
Extension Override or ringing set by Line Override.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Distinctive Ringing  
Understanding Ring Types  
The Ring Types determine how different types of calls rings extensions. Each Ring Type sounds unique  
because it uses one of the 10 available ring tones. The rst four Ring Types are assigned by default (see the  
table below). The last two (B and C) are unassigned by default but you can assign on your phone using  
Extension Override and Key Ring Override.  
The Ring Types  
Ring Type  
Call Type  
Intercom  
Intercom ringing  
This includes ringing Intercom calls, as well as calls ringing Extension Hunting  
groups, Call Coverage keys and the operator’s Call key.  
Ring Group  
Recall  
Ring Group ringing  
Recall ringing  
This includes Hold, Park or Transfer recall ringing.  
Ring “A”  
Ring “B”  
Ring “C”  
Type A ringing  
This includes line key, loop key, Transfer, and DIL ringing. (You can reassign  
types A, B, and C ringing in Extension Override and Key Ring Override below.)  
Type B ringing  
Not used (unassigned) by default. (You can reassign types A, B, and C ringing in  
Extension Override and Key Ring Override below.)  
Type C ringing  
Not used (unassigned) by default. (You can reassign types A, B, and C ringing in  
Extension Override and Key Ring Override below.)  
When Multiple Calls Ring an Extension  
When multiple calls with different priorities are ringing an extension, the system prioritizes ringing accord-  
ing to the list below. All LEDs will ash as appropriate for the type of call, but the telephone will ring only  
for the highest priority call.  
1. INTERCOM Key  
2. Line Key (from lowest to highest)  
3. Loop Key (from lowest to highest)  
136  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Distinctive Ringing  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Outside lines, Ring Groups, and UCD Groups use Type A ringing.  
• The ASSIGN (ASGN) and KEY soft keys are disabled.  
• The CONFIG (CNFG) soft keys is enabled.  
Programming  
1.  
Setting up Distinctive Ring Conguration.  
1. Enable the CONFIG (CNFG) soft keys.  
- In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
System Programming  
2. To set up Distinctive Ring Conguration:  
- To set the ring tone and cadence for Intercom ringing, use:  
- To set the ring tone and cadence for Ring Group ringing, use:  
- To set the ring tone and cadence for recall ringing,  
- To set the ring tone and cadence for ring tone A, use:  
- To set the ring tone and cadence for ring tone B, use:  
- To set the ring tone and cadence for ring tone C, use:  
Soft Keys  
3. To set up Distinctive Ring Conguration:  
- This allows you to select new tones and/or cadences for the Ring Types you want to customize.  
2.  
Setting up Line Override (Distinctive Ringing by Line and Ringing Mode).  
System Programming  
1. Set up Line Override using the following:  
(1=Type A, 2=Type B, 3=Type C).  
(1=Type A, 2=Type B, 3=Type C).  
(1=Type A, 2=Type B, 3=Type C).  
Soft Keys  
2. You cannot set up line override using an extension’s soft keys.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Distinctive Ringing  
3.  
Setting Up Extension Ring Override.  
1. Enable the RING soft keys.  
- In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
System Programming  
2. To set up Extension Ring Override:  
(1=Type A, 2=Type B, 3=Type C).  
(1=Type A, 2=Type B, 3=Type C).  
(1=Type A, 2=Type B, 3=Type C).  
- Does this load the defaults back in if the user has customized using Distinctive Ring Conguration?  
Soft Keys  
3. To set up Extension Ring Override using the soft keys, turn to Extension Override (page 141).  
4.  
Setting Up Key Ring Override.  
1. Enble the RING soft keys.  
- In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
System Programming  
options are:  
0 for line (follows the setting for the line in 3113-03: Night Ring Type)  
1 for ring type A  
2 for ring type B  
3 for ring type C  
Soft Keys  
3. To set up Key Ring Override using an extension’s soft keys, turn to Key Ring Override (page 142).  
5.  
Setting up Unique Ringing for Ring Groups and UCD Groups.  
System Programming  
1. To set up unique Ring Group ringing:  
(1=Type A, 2=Type B, 3=Type C).  
2. To set up unique UCD Group ringing:  
(1=Type A, 2=Type B, 3=Type C).  
Soft Keys  
3. You cannot set up unique Ring and UCD Group ringing using an extension’s soft keys.  
138  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Distinctive Ringing  
7.  
Initialize Distinctive Ringing (i.e., return to default).  
System Programming  
1. To initialize Distinctive Ringing system-wide (i.e., return to factory default):  
- This option is not available using an extension’s soft keys.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
By using Key Ring Override, Distinctive Ringing allows an extension user to set up unique ringing for  
their Call Coverage keys.  
You can set up Delayed Ringing to ring with a distinctive tone.  
By using Key Ring Override, Distinctive Ringing allows an extension user to set up unique ringing for  
their Group Call Pickup keys.  
By using Key Ring Override, Distinctive Ringing allows an extension user to set up unique ringing for  
their line keys.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Distinctive Ringing  
Operation  
Distinctive Ring Conguration  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Distinctive Ring Conguration  
To customize a Ring Set for your extension:  
[Menu + Ring  
[Menu + MORE + Ring]  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Select the Distinctive Ringing options.  
[Cong]  
[Cnfg]  
Select Distinctive Ring Conguration.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
Select a Ring Type to customize.  
[Intercom]  
[Icm]  
Select to change the Intercom Ring Type.  
Select to change the Ring Group Ring Type.  
[Ring Group]  
[Rgrp]  
[Recall]  
[Rcl]  
Select to change the Recall Ring Type.  
Select to change Type A Ring Type.  
Select to change Type B Ring Type.  
Select to change Type C Ring Type.  
[Ring “A”]  
[MORE + “A”]  
[Ring “B”]  
[MORE + “B”]  
[Ring “C”]  
[MORE + “C”]  
Select a new ring tone.  
Dial a new ring tone (0-9).  
You hear the selection you entered.  
You can optionally press SPEAKER to exit the Distinctive Ringing options.  
[Cancel]  
[Cncl]  
Select to cancel and back up to the previous step.  
Select to save your selection and back up to the  
previous step.  
[Save]  
[Save]  
b.  
Set your customized ringing back to the system default.  
Select to cancel any custom settings and choose a default Ring  
Set. You see: AreYou Sure?(Y/N)  
[Default]  
[MORE + MORE + Dt]  
[Yes]  
[Yes]  
Select to default your extension’s ringing.  
[No]  
[No]  
Select to back up without defaulting your ringing.  
c.  
Exit Distinctive Ring Conguration.  
[Exit]  
[MORE + MORE + EXIT]  
Select to exit Distinctive Ring Conguration.  
140  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Distinctive Ringing  
Extension Override  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Extension Override  
To customize ringing for your extension’s outside calls:  
[Menu + Ring]  
[Menu + MORE + Ring]  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Select the Distinctive Ringing options.  
Select Extension Override.  
[Assign]  
[Asgn]  
Select the ringing mode you want to change.  
[Day Ring]  
[Day]  
Select day ring.  
[Night Ring]  
[Nght]  
Select night ring.  
Select delay ring.  
[Delay Ring]  
[Dely]  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
Select to back up to the previous step without making any changes.  
a.  
For the ringing mode selected, select the Ring Type.  
[RING “A” + EXIT]  
[“A” + MORE + EXIT]  
Select Ring Type A.  
[RING “B” + EXIT]  
[“B” + MORE + EXIT]  
Select Ring Type B.  
[RING “C” + EXIT]  
[“C” + MORE + EXIT]  
Select Ring Type C.  
[CO LINE]  
[MORE + Line + EXIT]  
Select to have ringing follow Line Override.  
Press repeatedly to back up step-by-step.  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Distinctive Ringing  
Key Ring Override  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Key Ring Override  
To assign a Ring Type to a Call Coverage, Group Call Pickup, or line key:  
[Menu + Ring]  
[Menu + MORE + Ring]  
1.  
2.  
Select the Distinctive Ringing options.  
Select Key Ring Override.  
[Key]  
[Key]  
a.  
Select a key type to customize.  
Select your Call Coverage keys.  
Your Call Coverage keys light.  
[Call Coverage]  
[Cck]  
Select your Group Call Pickup keys.  
Your Group Call Pickup keys light.  
[Pickup]  
[Pkup]  
Select your line keys.  
Your line keys light.  
[Line]  
[Line]  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
Press repeatedly to back up step-by-step.  
b.  
c.  
Press the key for which you want to set the Ring Type.  
Do one of the following.  
For the key selected, choose the Ring Type.  
• Dial 1 for Ring Type A.  
i.  
• Dial 2 for Ring Type B.  
• Dial 3 for Ring Type C.  
• Dial 0 to Select to have ringing follow Line Override.  
For the key selected, press the key repeatedly to choose the ringing mode.  
• For line key night ring only (lamp only in the day):  
- Press key until it ashes slowly green.  
- Not for Group Call Pickup or Call Coverage keys.  
• For delay ring day and night:  
ii  
- Press key until it ashes fast green.  
• For lamp only (no ring) day and night:  
- Press key until it is on red.  
• For immediate ring day and night:  
Press key until it is on green.  
d.  
Press another key to program, or SPEAKER to exit.  
142  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Do Not Disturb  
Do Not Disturb  
Description  
DND permits an extension user to work by the phone undisturbed by incoming calls and  
announcements.  
Do Not Disturb (DND) blocks incoming calls, Off-Hook Signaling and Paging announcements. An exten-  
sion user can activate DND anytime while on a call or while their phone is idle. Once activated, incoming  
outside calls still ash the line keys. The user may use the phone in the normal manner for placing and pro-  
cessing calls.  
Do Not Disturb provides the following 4 DND options:  
(1) Incoming outside calls blocked  
(2) Incoming Intercom calls blocked  
(3) All incoming calls blocked  
(0) Cancel Do Not Disturb  
Do Not Disturb Options  
This DND option:  
Blocks these calls:  
(1) Incoming Outside Calls Blocked  
Ringing for outside calls, including:  
Key Ring calls  
Off Hook Ringing  
Call Coverage Keys  
Group Call Pickup keys  
Transferred outside calls  
Hold, Park, and Transfer recalls  
Circular or Terminal Extension Hunting calls  
DILs to the extension (if the extension is not the  
night mode termination)  
DILs to a Ring Group or UCD Group master num-  
ber (if the extension is in the group)  
(2) Incoming Intercom Calls Blocked  
Incoming Intercom calls  
Transferred Intercom calls  
Paging announcements  
Ringing from Intercom calls to the Ring Group  
master number (if the extension is in the group)  
Extension hunting calls that normally ring the  
extension  
(3) All Incoming Calls Blocked  
(0) Cancel Do Not Disturb  
All calls blocked by Option 1 and Option 2.  
Option 0 cancels Do Not Disturb  
Do Not Disturb BLF for Hotline and Call Coverage Keys  
The following charts show the Do Not Disturb Busy Lamp Field ash rates for Hotline and Call Coverage keys.  
Hotline Busy Lamp Indications  
When the key is:  
The covered extension is:  
Off  
On  
Idle or not installed  
Busy or ringing Intercom call  
In DND for outside calls (option 1)  
Medium Flash  
Fast Flash  
In DND for Intercom calls (option 2)  
or All Calls (option 3)  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Do Not Disturb  
Call Coverage Key Busy Lamp Indications  
When the key is: The covered extension is:  
Off  
On  
Idle or not installed  
Busy  
Ringing  
Slow ash  
Medium ash  
Fast Flash  
In DND for outside calls (option 1)  
In DND for Intercom calls (option 2)  
or All Calls (option 3)  
Note: When transferring an outside call to an extension in DND, the Transfer will be blocked if the extension  
has enabled DND for all calls (type 3) or DND for outside calls (type 1). The Transfer will be allowed if the  
extension has enabled DND for Intercom calls (type 2).  
Conditions  
• A system reset or power failure cancels DND.  
Default Setting  
• Do Not Disturb enabled.  
Programming  
1.  
Should an extension be allowed to use DND?  
Other Related Features  
Features  
The attendant can have Do Not Disturb. In addition, pressing DND at the attendant actives the night  
mode for any lines directly terminated to the attendant.  
DND does not affect the operation of Background Music.  
• Call Forwarding considers an extension in DND as busy. In addition, an extension can have both DND  
and Call Forwarding enabled at the same time.  
• Note that Call Forwarding has priority over Do Not Disturb. If both are enabled simultaneously at an  
extension, Call Forwarding is in force.  
An extension cannot Camp-On to a busy co-worker that is in Do Not Disturb.  
An extension cannot leave a Callback for a busy co-worker that is in Do Not Disturb.  
Do Not Disturb Override can override an extension’s Do Not Disturb.  
Placing an agent in DND temporarily removes it from the UCD Group.  
An extension user can press their Hotline key twice to override their Hotline partner’s DND.  
144  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Do Not Disturb  
An extension user can leave a Message Waiting at an extension in Do Not Disturb.  
A DIL destination activates the night mode for the DIL when they press DND.  
DND blocks Paging announcements.  
DND does not block Reverse Voice Over.  
Single line extensions cannot use DND.  
DND blocks Transfer.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Enabling or Disabling Do Not Disturb  
To enable or disable DND an extension:  
1.  
2.  
While on-hook, press DND.  
Select the DND type.  
• If you don’t select a type within 10 seconds:  
- If DND is enabled, the system automatically disables DND for your extension, or  
- If DND is disabled, the system automatically enables DND type 3 for your extension.  
Select to turn off (cancel) Do Not Disturb.  
• Alternately dial 0.  
[Off]  
[Off]  
Select to block incoming outside calls only.  
• Alternately dial 1.  
[External]  
[Ext]  
Select to block incoming Intercom calls only.  
• Alternately dial 2.  
[Intercom]  
[Icm]  
Your Intercom callers will hear DND tone and see the display DO NOT DISTURB.  
Select to block all incoming calls.  
• Alternately dial 3.  
[All]  
[All]  
Your Intercom callers will hear DND tone and see the display DO NOT DISTURB.  
[Exit]  
[N/A]  
Select to return to idle.  
Your telephone’s display shows the type of DND you enabled.  
Your DND key is on.  
3.  
If you are on a call (or anytime your telephone is not idle):  
1.  
Pressing DND does one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
If DND is enabled, the system automatically disables DND for your extension.  
If DND is disabled, the system automatically enables DND type 3 for your extension.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Do Not Disturb Override  
Do Not Disturb Override  
Description  
Easily override a co-worker’s Do Not Disturb.  
Do Not Disturb Override lets an extension user override another extension’s Do Not Disturb. This allows a  
priority employee (such as a supervisor or executive) to get through to a co-worker right away while the co-  
worker’s phone is in Do Not Disturb. DND Override is available to all extensions that have DND Override  
set in their Class of Service. It is also available to any extension that has a Hotline key for a co-worker, even  
without the Class of Service option enabled.  
Conditions  
• None.  
Default Setting  
• Do Not Disturb Override is disabled in an extension’s Class of Service.  
Programming  
1.  
Should an extension that is not a Hotline partner be allowed to use DND?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Do Not Disturb Override can override an extension’s Do Not Disturb.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Do Not Disturb Override  
To use Do Not Disturb Override:  
Dial your co-worker’s extension or press their Hotline key.  
You hear DND tone and see DO NOT DISTURB in your display.  
• If you hear busy or ring/busy tone instead, your co-worker is busy on a call.  
1.  
Select to override the extension’s Do Not Disturb.  
• Alternately dial 1.  
[DND Override]  
[Ovrd]  
2.  
3.  
The system automatically places a ringing Intercom call to your co-worker.  
146  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Door Box  
Door Box  
Description  
Use a Door Box to remotely monitor an entrance door.  
The Door Box (P/N 922450) is a self-contained analog Intercom unit typically used to monitor an entrance  
door. A visitor at the door can press the Door Box call button (like a door bell). The Door Box then sends  
chime tones or ringing to all extensions programmed to receive chimes. To answer the chime or ringing, the  
called extension user just lifts the handset. This lets the extension user talk to the visitor at the Door Box.  
The Door Box is convenient to have at a delivery entrance, for example. It is not necessary to have company  
personnel monitor the delivery entrance; they just answer the Door Box instead.  
DSX-80/160  
In DSX-80/160, a Door Box connects to an available Door Box port on a  
2PGDAD Module (P/N 0891027). Each module supports up to two Door Boxes,  
with the maximum number of Door Boxes installed limited only by the availabil-  
ity of station ports to connect additional 2PGDAD Modules.  
DSX-40  
In DSX-40, the Door Box can connect to a 2PGDAD module or to one of the two  
“built-in” Door Box ports. As in DSX-80/160, the maximum number of Door  
Boxes installed is limited only by the availability of station ports to connect addi-  
tional 2PGDAD Modules.  
Refer to Optional Equipment in the Hardware Manual that came with your system for more or installing the  
Analog Door Box.  
Door Box Relays  
Any keyset extension that receives Door Box chimes or ringing can control a control relay, which in turn  
typically enables an electric strike on an entrance door next to the Door Box. Each of the two Door Box cir-  
cuits in the 2PGDAD Module has an associated control relay that is automatically assigned. Each DSX-40  
“built-in” Door Box port has an associated “built-in” relay that you can assign for either door control or Pag-  
ing control, but not both.  
The equipment you connect to a control relay must be compatible with the following specications. Refer to  
your system’s Hardware Manual for more on connecting to the control relay contacts.  
Relay Contact Specications  
DSX-40  
Contact Conguration:  
Normally open  
Maximum Load:  
0.5A @ 120 VAC  
1A @ 24 VDC  
Maximum Initial Contact Resistance  
100 mOhms  
2PGDAD Module  
Contact Conguration:  
Normally open  
Maximum Load:  
500 mA @ 24 VDC  
250 mA @ 120 VAC  
Door Box Alerts  
The system uses Ring Groups to control Door Box alerts. When a visitor at the door presses the Door Box  
call button, the Door Box will alert (chime or ring) all the extensions in the Ring Group to which the Door  
Box belongs. For example, if Door Box 309 and extensions 301 and 302 are in Ring Group 1, pressing the  
call button alerts 301 and 302.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Door Box  
Conditions  
• Door Box P/N 922450 is a weather-tight unit, and can be mounted outside. It has an operating temper-  
ature range of -20 to 60 degrees C (-4 to 140 degrees F) and a relative humidity of 10-95%, non-con-  
densing.  
Default Setting  
• In DSX 80/160, no Door Boxes are enabled.  
• In DSX-40, the built-in Door Box ports are enabled for extensions 326 (DOOR 1) and 327 (DOOR 2).  
Programming  
Basic Door Box Programming  
1.  
Use Ring Group programming to set which extensions ring for calls from a Door Box.  
1. In 2113-02: Ring Group (page 738), assign the Door Box extension and each telephone extension to the  
same Ring Group (1-8). (DSX-40 “built-in” Door Box extensions are 326 and 327.)  
- For example, if extensions 301 and 302 should ring for calls from Door Box 309, be sure 301, 302,  
and 309 are in the same Ring Group.  
- Multiple Door Boxes can be in the same Ring Group.  
2.  
Set the chime pattern and review the operation of each Door Box.  
(DSX-40 “built-in” Door Box extensions are 326 and 327.)  
- 0 for Normal Ring Group ringing  
- 1 for Low pitch chime pattern  
- 2 for Mid range chime pattern  
- 3 for High pitch chime pattern  
2. More on Chime 0 Operation:  
- Chime 0 rings for 60 seconds and then cancels.  
- An extension user can answer the Door Box any time while it is ringing.  
- The Door Box user can press the call button again any time after ringing stops, or if an extension  
user answers their call and then hangs up.  
- The Door Box user cannot hang up (disconnect) their call.  
3. More on Chime 1-3 Operation:  
- Chimes 1-3 ring for 5 seconds and then stop.  
- An extension user can answer the Door Box any time within 30 seconds after the chime starts.  
- After 30 seconds, the Door Box call automatically cancels.  
- The Door Box user can press the call button again any time after the chime stops, or if an extension  
user answers their call and then hangs up.  
- The Door Box user cannot hang up (disconnect) their call.  
148  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Door Box  
2PGDAD Module Door Box Setup  
1.  
Set up the 2PGDAD Module Door Box ports.  
1. Locate an available 16ESIU PCB digital station port (e.g., station port 10/extension 309).  
- If you wait to plug in the 2PGDAD Module until after your programming is complete, the second-  
ary station port set up in the next step will auto-ID as a Door Box. The primary port always auto-  
IDs as a Door Box when the 2PGDAD Module is plugged in.  
above, enter an available station port for the secondary port.  
- Station ports 96-127 are available by default.  
- For example, enter port 110 (extension 409) as the secondary station port for station 10 (extension  
309).  
3. Following the instructions in your system’s Hardware Manual, connect the Door Boxes (P/N 922450) to  
the 2PGDAD Module Door Box ports.  
4. Plug the 2PGDAD Module into the 16ESIU digital station port you selected in step 1 above.  
- If you plugged in the 2PGDAD in step 1 above, you’ll need to unplug and then reconnect it in order  
for the secondary station port to auto-ID.  
2.  
3.  
Set up the Door Box Ring Groups and chime sounds.  
Set up the Door Box relays.  
1. The 2PGDAD relays are automatically assigned to their respective Door Box.  
- 2PGDAD Door Box 1 is assigned to Relay 5.  
- 2PGDAD Door Box 2 is assigned to Relay 6.  
- Refer to the system’s Hardware Manual for more.  
requirements.  
4.  
(Optional) Check for programming conicts.  
1. If the 2PGDAD Door Box does not auto-ID, check the following programs for conicts:  
extension number assigned.  
- In 2101-01: Station Type (page 719), make sure the Door Box is circuit type 10.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Door Box  
DSX-40 “Built-In” Door Box Setup  
1.  
Connect an Analog Door Box (P/N 922450) to a “built-in” Door Box port.  
1. Refer to the DSX-40 Hardware Manual for additional details.  
- DOOR 1 is extension 326.  
- DOOR 2 is extension 327.  
2.  
Optionally have a “built-in” DSX-40 Door Box activate an associated control relay?  
1. This programming does not apply to a Door Box connected to a 2PGDAD Module.  
ated control relay.  
- 1 for relay CPU #1 (normally assigned to DOOR 1/extension 326).  
- 2 for relay CPU #2 (normally assigned to DOOR 2/extension 327).  
Optionally have a Door Box connected to a 2PGDAD Module activate a DSX-40 relay in tandem  
with the 2PGDAD Module relay.  
3.  
1. In 2101-06: Door Relay Assignment (page 723) for the 2PGDAD Module Door Box extension number,  
assign the associated control relay.  
- 1 for relay CPU #1.  
- 2 for relay CPU #2.  
When an extension user activates (closes) to control relay, does it remain closed for the proper  
amount of time?  
4.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
An operator can monitor a Door Box with the following Feature Keys:  
- A Call Coverage key for the Door Box Ring Group to monitor ringing.  
- A Hotline key for the Door Box extension number to call the Door Box.  
If you enter Door Chime type 0 (normal ring) above, you can set up Call Coverage keys for the Door  
Box Ring Group. This allows extensions that are not members of the Ring Group to answer Door Box  
calls. Extensions with Call Coverage keys to the Door Box Ring Group can also activate the relay.  
An extension user cannot forward a call to a Door Box.  
An extension user can have Hotline keys for Door Boxes.  
An extension user cannot leave a Message Waiting at a Door Box.  
Door Box chimes 1-3 can broadcast over the External Paging speakers. An extension user can dial  
INTERCOM + 0 to answer the chimes and use their soft keys to control the associated relay.  
Single line telephones can only receive Door Chime type 0 (normal ring). While connected to the  
Door Box, an SLT can hookash to control the system relay.  
150  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Door Box  
An extension user cannot Transfer a call to a Door Box.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Calling from the Door Box  
To place a call from the Door Box:  
1.  
2.  
Press the Door Box call button.  
When someone inside the building answers your call, speak toward the Door Box.  
• Once you press the call button, you can not control the call. You must wait for someone to answer.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Calling to the Door Box  
To place a call to the Door Box from a keyset:  
Lift handset and press INTERCOM.  
• At a single line set, just lift the handset.  
1.  
2.  
Dial the Door Box extension number.  
You hear two beeps, then conversation with the visitor at the door.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Answering Door Box Chimes  
To answer Door Box chimes or ringing:  
Lift the handset.  
• Door Box chimes are not available at single line telephones.  
1.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Controlling the Door Strike  
To activate the Door Box relay (which in turn controls the door strike):  
• Once set up in programming, this option is available to any member of the Door Box Ring Group as well as any  
extension with a Call Coverage key for the Door Box Ring Group.  
1.  
2.  
Place or answer a Door Box call.  
Do one of the following.  
Select to open the Door Box relay (if closed/activated).  
• Alternately press FLASH.  
[Open]  
[Open]  
a.  
Select to close the Door Box relay (if open/deactivated).  
• Alternately press FLASH.  
[Close]  
[Close]  
b.  
c.  
At a single line telephone, hookash to open or close the Door Box relay,  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Equal Access Compatibility  
Equal Access Compatibility  
Description  
152  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Extended Ringing  
Extended Ringing  
Description  
Lets calls ring longer that usual to assist co-workers that can’t readily get to their phones.  
Extended Ringing forces an unanswered call to ring a telephone an extended number of times before rerout-  
ing. This helps a users that cannot get to their phone quickly to pick up calls (such as a warehouse worker).  
Extended Ringing is available with the following features:  
Direct Inward Line  
DILs ring for an extended period before routing to the overow destination.  
Transfer  
Transferred outside calls ring for an extended period before recalling the transferring extension.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled.  
Programming  
1.  
Should the extension have Extended Ringing capability?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2.  
Does Extended Ringing ring for an adequate time before the call reroutes?  
Other Related Features  
Features  
With Extended Ringing, a call rings longer at its destination before diverting to Key Ring.  
With Extended Ringing enabled, transferred outside calls ring the destination extension longer before  
recalling the transferring extension.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Extension Hunting  
Extension Hunting  
Description  
Automatically route calls to co-workers that work closely together.  
Extension Hunting routes calls to a predened group of hunt group member extensions. A call rings in  
sequence through the hunt group until answered at a member extension. Extension Hunting is helpful, for  
example, for a group of co-workers that share responsibility for answering calls. Each call cycles through the  
group until an available member picks it up.  
There are three types of Extension Hunting:  
Circular Hunting  
Terminal Hunting  
Uniform Call Distribution (UCD) Hunting  
Circular Hunting  
A Circular Hunting group consists of a group of extensions programmed into a Circular Hunting list. A call  
unanswered at a member extension rings the next extension in the programmed list. If unanswered, the call  
will continue to cycle through the hunt group. Depending on the hunt type (see below), Circular Hunting  
will occur for transferred outside calls, DILs to a hunt group member, and ringing Intercom calls. Hunting  
does not occur for Key Ring and Ring Group calls.  
There are four types of Circular Hunting:  
Ring No Answer Outside Calls (Option 1)  
Hunting will occur for unanswered outside calls. Hunting will not occur for unanswered ringing Inter-  
com calls or while the member extension is busy.  
Busy/Ring No Answer Outside Calls (Option 2)  
Hunting will occur for unanswered outside calls and for outside calls to the member extension while it is  
busy. Hunting will not occur for ringing Intercom calls.  
Busy/Ring No Answer All Calls (Option 3)  
Hunting will occur for unanswered outside and ringing Intercom calls, and for outside and ringing Inter-  
com calls to the member extension while it is busy.  
Busy Outside Calls (Option 4)  
Hunting will occur for outside calls to the member extension while it is busy. Hunting will not occur for  
unanswered outside and ringing Intercom calls.  
Overview of Circular Hunting  
When setting up Circular Hunting, do not program the last extension in the group to hunt back to the  
rst. Instead, program the last extension to hunt to the second extension in the group.  
To achieve Circular Hunting, send calls to the rst extension in the group.  
Programmed Hunt Order  
302 -> 303 -> 304 -> 305 -> 302  
Send call to extension 302.  
Hunting will not proceed past extension 305. If the call is unanswered at 305, it follows normal recall/  
routing programming.  
For example, a transferred call will recall the transferring extension and, if still unanswered, go to  
Key Ring.  
Programmed Hunt Order  
302 -> 303 -> 304 -> 305 -> 303  
Send call to extension 302.  
Hunting will circulate normally, excluding extension 302.  
154  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Extension Hunting  
Circular Hunting Notes:  
For type 3 hunting, an Intercom call will stop hunting when it voice-announces. Extension Hunting fol-  
lows the Handsfree Answerback/Forced Intercom Ringing setup at each extension.  
Placing an extension in DND temporarily removes it from the Circular Hunting group.  
Terminal Hunting  
A Terminal Hunting group consists of a group of extensions programmed into a Terminal Hunting list. A call  
unanswered at a member extension rings the next extension in the programmed list. The call will cycle  
through the group once, until it reaches the last extension in the list. Unlike Circular Hunting, the call will  
not cycle back to the top of the hunt list. Depending on the hunt type (see below), Terminal Hunting will  
occur for transferred outside calls, DILs to a hunt group member, and ringing Intercom calls. Hunting does  
not occur for Key Ring and Ring Group calls.  
Just like Circular Hunting, there are four types of Terminal Hunting:  
Ring No Answer Outside Calls (Option 1)  
Hunting will occur for unanswered outside calls. Hunting will not occur for unanswered ringing Inter-  
com calls or while the member extension is busy.  
Busy/Ring No Answer Outside Calls (Option 2)  
Hunting will occur for unanswered outside calls and for outside calls to the member extension while it is  
busy. Hunting will not occur for ringing Intercom calls.  
Busy/Ring No Answer All Calls (Option 3)  
Hunting will occur for unanswered outside and ringing Intercom calls, and for outside and ringing Inter-  
com calls to the member extension while it is busy.  
Busy Outside Calls (Option 4)  
Hunting will occur for outside calls to the member extension while it is busy. Hunting will not occur for  
unanswered outside and ringing Intercom calls.  
Terminal Hunting Notes:  
If a call cycles through the entire Terminal Hunting group and remains unanswered, it follows normal  
recall/routing programming. For example, a transferred call will recall the transferring extension and, if  
still unanswered, go to Key Ring.  
Placing an extension in DND temporarily removes it from the Terminal Hunting group.  
For type 3 hunting, an Intercom call will stop hunting when it voice-announces. Extension Hunting fol-  
lows the Handsfree Answerback/Forced Intercom Ringing setup at each extension.  
Uniform Call Distribution (UCD) Hunting  
Like Circular and Terminal Hunting, a UCD Hunting also consists of a group of extensions programmed into  
a hunt list. The system routes calls into a UCD Group according to the frequency of use of the member  
extensions. The rst extension rung is the member that has been idle the longest. The last extension rung is  
the member that has been idle the shortest.  
Each member of the group is additionally associated with a UCD Master Extension Number. To activate  
UCD Hunting, an incoming call must route to the UCD Group master number. This is done by placing an  
Intercom call to the master number, transferring a call to the master number or setting up a DIL to the master  
number. When all members of the UCD Group are busy, the call can route to the programmed UCD Over-  
ow destination.  
The system provides up to 8 UCD Groups (1-8). The UCD Group master numbers are predened as 700-707  
(with 700 reserved for voice mail), but can be any valid extension number not already in use.  
UCD Hunting and Call Coverage Keys  
If an extension has a Call Coverage key for a UCD Group, the key will ring if a call comes into the group  
while all members are busy. This allows extension users to “cover” UCD Groups when they are busy.  
If you set up the UCD Group with no members, the Call Coverage key will ring whenever a call comes into  
the group. This type of group functions as a “dummy” (phantom) extension.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Extension Hunting  
Calls to the “dummy” extension activate the Call Coverage keys on the covering extensions.  
Co-workers can transfer calls into the group. They will ring all Call Coverage keys for the group. If unan-  
swered, a call transferred into the group follows the programmed UCD Group overow destination (as  
do unanswered calls). It will not recall to the transferring party.  
A UCD Master night key for the group will control the night termination of any Direct Inward Lines  
(DILs) terminated to the group. For example, you can have a DIL to the UCD Group during the day (e.g.,  
701) and IntraMail at night (e.g., 700). When an extension user presses the UCD Master night key for the  
group, the DILs route to IntraMail.  
DILs to the group ring the Call Coverage keys on the covering extensions.  
UCD Hunting Notes:  
Unanswered transferred calls and DILs continue to cycle through the UCD Group as long as an agent  
is available.  
Placing an extension in Do Not Disturb temporarily removes it from the UCD Group.  
Intercom calls to the UCD Group master number always ring the agent extensions.  
You can set up a UCD Group to overow to voice mail. Use 2302-01: UCD Group Overow Destination  
- If a call into a UCD Group overows to voice mail, it is picked up by the UCD Group Mailbox. See  
To put DILs to a UCD Group master number into the night mode, press a uniquely programmed System  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Hunting is not set up.  
• UCD Group master numbers are predened as shown in the following table. If required, you can reas-  
UCD Group Default Assignments  
UCD Group  
Default Master Number  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
700  
701  
702  
703  
704  
705  
706  
707  
156  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Extension Hunting  
Programming  
Setting Up Circular Hunting  
1.  
Assign the hunt type to each extension in a Circular Hunting Group?  
- 1 = Ring No Answer Outside Calls  
- 2 = Busy/Ring No Answer Outside Calls  
- 3 = Busy/Ring No Answer All Calls  
- 4 = Busy Outside Calls  
2.  
3.  
Set up the hunt destination routing.  
- Each extension should route to the next in the group.  
- The last extension should route back to the second. See the Overview of Circular Hunting  
Do calls ring a hunt group member for the correct interval before routing to the next extension?  
1. If yes:  
2. If no:  
- To change how long the rst member of the group rings, adjust 1603-01: Transfer Recall Timer  
- To change how long the next and succeeding members of the group ring, adjust 1601-03: Call For-  
4.  
Do DILs ring a hunt group member for the correct interval before routing to the next extension?  
Setting Up Terminal Hunting  
1.  
Assign the hunt type to each extension in a Terminal Hunting Group?  
- 1 = Ring No Answer Outside Calls  
- 2 = Busy/Ring No Answer Outside Calls  
- 3 = Busy/Ring No Answer All Calls  
- 4 = Busy Outside Calls  
2.  
Set up the hunt destination routing.  
- Each extension (except the last) should route to the next in the group.  
- For the last extension, press CLEAR to undene the hunt assignment.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Extension Hunting  
3.  
Do calls ring a hunt group member for the correct interval before routing to the next extension?  
1. If yes:  
2. If no:  
- To change how long the rst member of the group rings, adjust 1603-01: Transfer Recall Timer  
- To change how long the next and succeeding members of the group ring, adjust 1601-03: Call For-  
4.  
5.  
Do DILs ring a hunt group member for the correct interval before routing to the next extension?  
Do you want an extension to overow to voice mail when unanswered, busy, or in DND?  
1. If yes, for 2115-01: Hunt Destination (page 746) enter 700 (the voice mail master number).  
158  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Extension Hunting  
Setting Up UCD Hunting  
1.  
Assign hunt type 05 to each member of the UCD Group.  
1. In 2115-01: Hunt Type (page 746), make sure each extension in the UCD Group has hunt type 05.  
2.  
Make sure all group members have the same master extension number.  
1. In 2115-01: UCD Group Master Number (page 746), make sure each extension in the same UCD Group  
has the same master number.  
- Normally, group 1 (master number 700) is reserved for voice mail.  
3.  
4.  
Do you want to change the UCD Group master numbers?  
1. If yes, assign new master numbers in 1315-01: UCD Group Master Extension Number (page 627).  
When all UCD Group members are busy, should calls overow to an alternate destination?  
1. If yes:  
tination can be:  
- An extension.  
- A Ring Group.  
- Another UCD Group master number (including the voice mail master number).  
- If overowing to voice mail, turn to UCD Group Mailbox (page 497) for more.  
- In 1601-04: UCD No Answer Timer (page 670), set the overow timer as required.  
2. If no, don’t enter a destination in 2302-01: UCD Group Overow Destination (page 792).  
5.  
6.  
Do calls ring an idle group member for the correct interval before routing to the next member?  
Do DILs to the master number ring an idle hunt group member for the correct interval before  
routing to the next extension?  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Extension Hunting  
Extension Hunting Timers  
The following diagrams show how the system implements various timers when handling Extension Hunt-  
ing calls.  
Transfer to Hunt Group  
Busy/Ring No Answer All Calls (Type 3)  
Circular and Terminal Hunting  
Call transferred into hunt group.  
Call rings rst member for Transfer Recall time.  
If unanswered, call rings the next and succeeding  
members for the Call Forward Ring No Answer  
time.  
If unanswered, call rings extension 300.  
300  
If unanswered at extension 300 for the Call For-  
ward Ring No Answer time, the call diverts to  
Key Ring.  
Key Ring.  
160  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Extension Hunting  
Transfer to Hunt Group  
Busy/Ring No Answer All Calls (Type 3) Circular and Terminal Hunting  
Routing to Busy UCD Group with Overow  
Call transferred to extension A, which is the sin-  
gle member of a type 3 hunt group that is set up  
to hunt to extension B.  
Call rings extension A for the Transfer Recall  
time.  
If unanswered at extension A, the call hunts to  
extension B which is the single member to a type  
5 UCD Group that is set up to overow to exten-  
sion C.  
Extension B  
The call now rings extension B for the Call  
Forward No Answer time.  
If unanswered at extension B, the call  
camps-on to the busy UCD master exten-  
sion number.  
Busy UCD  
Master  
The call camps-on to the UCD Group for the  
UCD No Answer interval, waiting for a member  
to become free. Note that the Call Coverage  
Delay timer also starts now. See Call Coverage  
If a UCD Group member does not become free,  
the call diverts to the programmed overow desti-  
nation.  
UCD  
Overow  
The call the rings the overow destination  
for the Call Forward No Answer time.  
If still unanswered, the call diverts to Key Ring.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Extension Hunting  
DIL (no overow) to Hunt Group  
Busy/Ring No Answer All Calls (Type 3)  
Circular and Terminal Hunting  
DIL (with no overow) directly rings hunt group  
member.  
DIL rings programmed DIL destination for the  
DIL No Answer time.  
If unanswered, call rings the next and succeeding  
members for the DIL No Answer time.  
If still unanswered, call diverts to Key Ring.  
DIL (with overow) to Hunt Group  
Busy/Ring No Answer All Calls (Type 3)  
Circular and Terminal Hunting  
DIL (with overow) directly rings hunt group  
member.  
DIL rings programmed DIL destination for the  
DIL No Answer time.  
If unanswered, call rings the next and succeeding  
members for the DIL No Answer time.  
If unanswered at the last extension, the DIL rings  
the programmed overow destination for the DIL  
No Answer time.  
If still unanswered, call diverts to Key Ring.  
162  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Extension Hunting  
Outside Call on Hold at Hunt Group Member  
Busy/Ring No Answer All Calls (Type 3)  
Circular and Terminal Hunting  
Hunt group member puts outside call on Hold.  
If not picked up, outside call recalls the extension  
that put it on Hold after the Hold Recall time.  
The call then rings the extension that put it on  
Hold for the Line No Answer time.  
If still unanswered, call diverts to Key Ring.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
A keyset can have a Call Coverage key for a UCD Group master number. The key will ring if a call  
comes into the group while all members are busy.  
• If a member of a Circular or Terminal Hunting group forwards their calls, hunting will follow Call  
Forwarding.  
• Calls to a UCD Group will not follow Call Forwarding at a group member’s extension. However, calls  
directed to the group member’s extension (such as DILs and transferred calls) will follow the Call For-  
warding set up at the extension.  
DILs to a Circular or Terminal Hunting group member initiate hunting. In addition, DILs to a UCD  
Group master number ring the UCD Group directly. To put DILs to a UCD Group master number into  
the night mode, press a uniquely programmed UCD Master Night key. See Night Service / Night Ring  
Intercom Directory Dialing will show UCD Group names.  
Placing an agent in DND temporarily removes it from the UCD Group.  
UCD Hunting group master numbers cannot be in the extension number range. By default, the sys-  
tems uses codes beginning with 0 for operator access and 9 for line/line group access.  
If a call into a UCD Group overows to voice mail, it is picked up by the UCD Group Mailbox.  
Group Ring calls do not activate hunting.  
Voice-announced Intercom calls do not initiate hunting.  
If Music on Hold is enabled for transferred calls, a caller transferred to a busy UCD Group hears  
MOH.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Extension Hunting  
To put DILs to a UCD Group master number into the night mode, press a uniquely programmed UCD  
Master Night key.  
• Outside calls transferred to a Terminal or Circular Hunting group member activate hunting. In addi-  
tion, outside calls transferred to a UCD Group master number activate hunting.  
• When handling Transfer recalls, Call Forwarding has priority over Extension Hunting. See Interaction  
• To set up extension overow to voice mail, turn to Extension Hunting to Voice Mail (page 478).  
• For Terminal and Circular Hunting, unsupervised transfers (UTRF) from the voice mail Automated  
Attendant route like outside calls. Supervised transfers (STRF) from the voice mail Automated Atten-  
dant route like Intercom calls. In either case, unanswered calls eventually route the initially called  
extension’s mailbox.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
164  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Extension Hunting  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Sending a Call to a Terminal or Circular Hunting Group  
To send a call to a Terminal or Circular Hunting Group:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
c.  
d.  
Transfer an outside call to a hunt group member.  
Set up a DIL to a hunt group member.  
Place a ringing Intercom call to a hunt group member.  
Set up a hunt group member as a line’s overow destination.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Sending a Call to a UCD Group  
To send a call to a UCD Group:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
c.  
d.  
Transfer a call to the UCD Group master number.  
Set up a DIL to the UCD Group master number.  
Place an Intercom call to the UCD Group master number.  
Set up the UCD Group master number as a line’s overow destination.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Removing/Reinstalling your Extension from your UCD Group  
To temporarily remove/reinstall your extension from your UCD Group:  
1.  
2.  
Press INTERCOM and dial *5.  
Do one of the following:  
a.  
b.  
Dial 4 to return your extension to your UCD Group.  
Dial 6 to remove your extension from your UCD Group.  
3.  
Press SPEAKER to hang up.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Extension Locking  
Extension Locking  
Description  
When they leave the ofce, a keyset user can secure their phone to prevent unauthorized use.  
Extension Locking allows a keyset extension user to secure their phone when they leave the ofce. The user  
may want to do this if their phone has Toll Restriction and Class of Service options enabled that could be  
easily abused. While locked, the restrictions set up in Class of Service 15 and Toll Level 7 are in force at  
the extension. When the user returns, they just unlock their extension to return it to normal operation.  
You’ll need to program the restrictions in Class of Service 15 and Toll Level 7 separately. See the Class of  
Walking Class of Service and Extension Locking  
Walking Class of Service overrides Extension Locking. For example:  
Extension 301 is permitted by their Class of Service and Toll Restriction to use Paging and place long  
distance calls.  
Extension 306 locks their extension. While locked, Class of Service 15 prevents Paging and Toll Level 7  
prevents long distance calls. These features are no longer available at extension 306.  
The extension 301 user goes to extension 306 and implements Walking Class of Service.  
The extension 301 user can then use 306 to make long distance calls and Page (even though 306 was  
locked to prevent those features).  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Extension Locking is disabled in an extension’s Class of Service.  
There are no PIN codes entered by default. In addition:  
-
-
An extension user can dial INTERCOM + ##6 to enter or change their PIN number.  
The operator can dial INTERCOM + ##3 to erase a co-worker’s PIN number and unlock their  
extension.  
Programming  
1.  
Should an extension have Extension Locking capability?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. If yes:  
-
In 2102-04: User Programming Access Level (page 725), make sure at least the operator has access  
level 4 or 5. (This allows the operator to erase a co-worker’s PIN number and unlock their extension).  
- In 2102-05: Station PIN Code (page 725), assign PIN numbers to extensions (4 digits, using 0-9. #  
and *).  
3. If no:  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Extension Locking and Walking Class of Service share the same PIN code.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
166  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Extension Locking  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Locking and UnlockingYour Extension  
To lock your extension:  
Press INTERCOM and dial ##5.  
• While your extension is locked, DND winks on and you hear pulsating dial tone when you press INTERCOM.  
1.  
To unlock your extension:  
Press INTERCOM and dial ##5.  
Your hear pulsating dial tone when you press INTERCOM.  
1.  
2.  
When you see ENTER PIN CODE:  
• Enter your PIN number + HOLD.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Entering or ChangingYour PIN Number  
To enter your PIN number (if you don’t have one assigned):  
1.  
2.  
Press INTERCOM and dial ##6.  
When you see ENTER NEW PIN:  
• Enter your new PIN number + HOLD.  
• When entering your PIN number:  
- CLEAR erases your entire entry.  
- REDIAL backspaces over (erases) the last digit entered.  
When you see REENTER NEW PIN:  
• Conrm your entry by reentering your new PIN number.  
3.  
4.  
When you see NEW PIN ACCEPTED:  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
To change your PIN number (if you already have one assigned):  
1.  
2.  
Press INTERCOM and dial ##6.  
When you see ENTER PIN CODE:  
• Enter your current PIN number + HOLD.  
When you see ENTER NEW PIN:  
3.  
• Enter your new PIN number + HOLD.  
• When entering your PIN number:  
- CLEAR erases your entire entry.  
- REDIAL backspaces over (erases) the last digit entered.  
When you see REENTER NEW PIN:  
• Conrm your entry by reentering your new PIN number.  
4.  
5.  
When you see NEW PIN ACCEPTED:  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
Select to exit PIN number programming.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Extension Locking  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Unlocking an Extension from the Attendant’s Phone  
To unlock an extension (and clear the extension’s PIN number) from the attendant’s phone:  
Press INTERCOM and dial ##3.  
You must have a PIN number entered for your phone to use this feature.  
1.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
When you see ENTER PIN CODE:  
• Enter your PIN number + HOLD.  
When you see ENTER EXTENSION:  
• Enter the number of the extension you want to unlock + HOLD.  
When you see CLEAR PIN: xxx, do one of the following:  
[YES]  
[YES]  
Select to unlock the extension entered in step 3 above.  
[NO]  
[NO]  
Select to back up to step 2 without unlocking.  
168  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Feature Keys  
Feature Keys  
Description  
Feature Keys simplify feature operation.  
Each keyset has Feature Keys. These Feature Keys simplify placing calls, answering calls and using certain  
features.You can customize the function of any keyset’s Feature Keys from the system program and the User  
Programmable Features.  
The 22-Button Standard and Display Tele-  
phones feature 12 Feature Keys.  
The 34-Button Display Telephone features 24  
Feature Keys.  
The 34-Button Super DisplayTelephone also  
features 24 Feature Keys.  
You can assign the following types of Feature Keys to an extension.  
Account Code  
Intercom Directory Dialing  
Line keys  
Park Orbit  
Call Coverage (immediate,  
delayed or no ring)  
Reverse Voice Over  
Call Forwarding  
Call Timer  
Message Center  
Save Number Dialed  
Speed Dial, Personal  
Speed Dial, System  
Loop Key, Fixed  
Loop Key, Switched  
Group Call Pickup (immedi-  
ate, delayed or no ring)  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Feature Keys  
Headset key  
Hotline  
Night key  
Split  
Page Zones  
Voice Mail Conversation  
Record  
Conditions  
• If you unplug a 34-button telephone and replace it with a 22-button telephone, Feature Keys 13-24 are  
inaccessible. However, the system still retains the programming for those keys.  
Default Setting  
• In DSX-80/160, keys 1-12 are line keys for lines 1-12 and keys 13-24 are undened.  
• In DSX-40, keys 1-8 are line keys for lines 1-8 and keys 9-24 are undened.  
• For attendants:  
- Key 12 (on 22-button) or key 24 (on 34-button) is an Operator Call Key.  
Programming  
1.  
Set up an extension’s Feature Keys.  
1. In 2121-[01 to 24]: Feature Key Codes (page 758), enter the key code for the Feature Key you are pro-  
gramming.  
- Refer to the Extension Feature Key Assignments chart below for the key codes.  
- Refer to the Extension Feature Key Assignments chart below for the key codes.  
1.  
Are any of the extensions Feature Keys set up as line keys?  
- This option does not restrict loop keys.  
- Also review the following feature for more on setting up outside calling:  
2. If no, be sure the extension has at least one loop key for incoming calls.  
- This provides an answering point for incoming calls if the extension doesn’t have line keys.  
Extension Feature Key Assignments  
Extension Feature Key Assignments (Page 1 of 6)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
00  
Operation  
Use this option to designate a Feature Key as  
undened (no function).  
N/A  
Undened  
01  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Switched Loop key.  
Press the key to  
place or answer call.  
Loop Key  
(Switched)  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Loop key idle.  
On (green) . . . .You are busy on a loop key call.  
Slow Flash . . . .Line is ringing.  
170  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Feature Keys  
Extension Feature Key Assignments (Page 2 of 6)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
Operation  
02 + nn (Line Group  
90-98)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Fixed Loop key.  
Loop Key (Fixed)  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Loop key idle.  
On (green) . . . . . . . . . You are busy on a loop key call.  
Slow Flash . . . . . . . . . Line is ringing.  
03 + nn (line  
number 1-64)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
line key.  
Press the key to  
place or answer call.  
Line  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Line is idle or not installed.  
On (red) . . . . . . . . . . . A co-worker is busy on the line or has the line on Exclusive Hold.  
On (green) . . . . . . . . . You are busy on the line.  
Wink On (red) . . . . . . . On System Hold at a co-worker’s extension.  
Wink On (green). . . . . . On System Hold at your extension.  
Double Wink On (green). On Exclusive Hold or recalling your extension.  
Slow Flash (red). . . . . . Line is ringing.  
Slow Flash (green):. . . . Lineisringingoryourextensiondirectly.  
04 + nn (Park Orbit  
60-69)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Park Orbit key.  
Press key to Park or  
retrieve parked call.  
Park Orbit  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Orbit is idle.  
On. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Orbit is holding a parked call.  
Wink On (green). . . . . . Orbit is holding a call you parked.  
05 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Hotline key.  
Press key to call  
Hotline partner.  
Hotline  
A keyset user can use the #HL user-program-  
mable procedure to change the Hotline assign-  
ments on their console.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Partner extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Partner extension is busy or ringing.  
Medium Flash . . . . . . . Partner extension is in DND for outside calls (option 1).  
Fast Flash . . . . . . . . . . Partner extension is in DND for Intercom calls (option 2) or All Calls (option 3).  
06 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as an  
immediately ringing Call Coverage Key.  
Press key to call cov-  
ered extension or  
pick up ringing call.  
Call Coverage  
Immediate Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is busy.  
Slow Flash . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is ringing.  
Medium Flash . . . . . . . Covered extension is in DND for outside calls (option 1).  
Fast Flash . . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is in DND for Intercom calls (option 2) or All Calls (option 3).  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Feature Keys  
Extension Feature Key Assignments (Page 3 of 6)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
Operation  
07 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
lamp only (no ring) Call Coverage Key.  
Press key to call cov-  
ered extension or  
pick up ringing call.  
Call Coverage No  
Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is busy.  
Slow Flash . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is ringing.  
Medium Flash . . . . . . . Covered extension is in DND for outside calls (option 1).  
Fast Flash . . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is in DND for Intercom calls (option 2) or All Calls (option 3).  
08 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
delayed ringing Call Coverage Key.  
Press key to call cov-  
ered extension or  
pick up ringing call.  
Call Coverage  
Delay Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is busy.  
Slow Flash . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is ringing.  
Medium Flash . . . . . . . Covered extension is in DND for outside calls (option 1).  
Fast Flash . . . . . . . . . . Covered extension is in DND for Intercom calls (option 2) or All Calls (option 3).  
09 + nn (Pickup  
Group 1-16)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as an  
immediately ringing Group Call Pickup key.  
Press key to answer  
call ringing Pickup  
Group.  
Group Pickup  
Immediate Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . No call is ringing the pickup group.  
Slow Flash (green) . . . . A call is ringing the pickup group.  
10 + nn (Pickup  
Group 1-16)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
lamp only (no ring) Group Call Pickup key.  
Press key to answer  
call ringing Pickup  
Group.  
Group Pickup No  
Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . No call is ringing the pickup group.  
Slow Flash (green) . . . . A call is ringing the pickup group.  
11 + nn (Pickup  
Group 1-16)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
delay ring Group Call Pickup key.  
Press key to answer  
call ringing Pickup  
Group.  
Group Pickup  
Delay Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . No call is ringing the pickup group.  
Slow Flash (green) . . . . A call is ringing the pickup group.  
13 + n (Page Zone 1-  
7, 0 for All Call)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Page Zone key.  
Press key to Page  
into assigned zone.  
Page Zone  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The assigned Page zone is busy.  
On (green). . . . . . . . . . The assigned Page zone is busy broadcasting an announcement you are making.  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The assigned Page zone is idle.  
172  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Feature Keys  
Extension Feature Key Assignments (Page 4 of 6)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
Operation  
14 + nnn (bin 001-  
999)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
System Speed Dial key. You assign the key to  
specic System Speed Dial bin.  
Press key to dial  
stored number.  
System Speed  
Dial  
• There is no BLF for this key type.  
15 + nnn (bin 01-20)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Personal Speed Dial key.You assign the key to  
a specic Personal Speed Dial bin.  
Press key to dial  
stored number.  
Personal Speed  
Dial  
• There is no BLF for this key type.  
16 + n (1=manual,  
2=automatic)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Call Timer key. There are two types of timer  
key: manual and automatic.  
Press key to start or  
stop Call Timer.  
Call Timer  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Call Timer on.  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Call Timer off.  
17 + nnn (extension  
number of valid Sub-  
scriber Mailbox)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
voice mail Record key.  
Press key to record  
conversation into  
mailbox.  
Voice Mail  
Record  
You must have voice mail installed to  
use this key.  
• A voice prompt and periodic beep will  
remind you that your calls are being  
recorded.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Conversation Record is off.  
Fast Flash (green) . . . . Conversation Record is on.  
18 + CLEAR  
(System Night key)  
18 + UCD Group  
master number  
(UCD Night key)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Night key. There are two options: System  
Night key and UCD Night key. The System  
Night key puts all Key Ring lines and lines  
terminated to Ring Group master numbers  
into the night mode. The UCD Night key puts  
all lines terminated to the UCD Group master  
number into the night mode.  
Press key to put Key  
Ring lines and lines  
terminated to Ring  
Group master into  
night mode.  
Night  
OR  
Press key to put  
lines terminated to  
UCD master into  
night mode.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Night mode is on.  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Night mode is off.  
20  
21  
Use this option to assign a programmable key  
as a Split key.  
• There is no BLF for this key type.  
Split  
Use this option to assign a programmable key  
as an Intercom Directory Dialing key.  
Press key to access  
Intercom Directory  
Dialing.  
Intercom  
Directory Dialing  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Intercom Directory Dialing is active (being used).  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Intercom Directory Dialing is inactive (off).  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Feature Keys  
Extension Feature Key Assignments (Page 5 of 6)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
Operation  
23 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Reverse Voice Over key.  
While on a handset  
call, press key to  
place a private  
Reverse Voice  
Over Key  
Intercom call to  
covered extension.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Assigned extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Assigned extension is busy or ringing.  
Medium Flash . . . . . . . Assigned extension is in DND for outside calls (option 1).  
Fast Flash . . . . . . . . . . Assigned extension is in DND for Intercom calls (option 2) or All Calls (option 3)  
24 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Message Center key.  
Press key to call  
Message Center  
Mailbox.  
Message Center  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . No messages waiting in the Message Center Mailbox.  
Fast Flash. . . . . . . . . . Messages waiting in the Message Center Mailbox.  
25  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Save Number Dialed key.  
• There is no BLF for this key type.  
While on a call:  
Save Number  
Dialed  
Press key to save  
the number you just  
dialed.  
While idle:  
Press key to redial a  
previously saved  
number.  
26  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as an  
Account Code key.  
1. Place or answer out-  
side call.  
Account Code  
2. Press key.  
3. Enter Account Code.  
4. Press key to return to  
the call.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Not in Account Code mode or not entering Account Codes.  
Fast Flash (green) . . . . In the Account Code entry mode.  
On (green) . . . . . . . . . On a call for which the user has entered an Account Code.  
27  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Call Forwarding key.  
Press key instead of  
pressing INTER-  
Call Forwarding  
COM and dialing *3  
.
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Extension not call forwarded or in the Call Forwarding setup mode.  
Fast Flash. . . . . . . . . . In the Call Forwarding setup mode.  
Wink Off . . . . . . . . . . . Extension has Call Forwarding enabled.  
174  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Feature Keys  
Extension Feature Key Assignments (Page 6 of 6)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
28  
Operation  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Headset key.  
Press key to enable  
or disable headset  
mode.  
Headset  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Extension is not in the headset mode.  
On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Extension is in the headset mode.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
An extension can have an Account Code key to simplify Account Code entry.  
An extension can have Call Coverage keys.  
An extension’s Call Forwarding key can streamline Call Forwarding operation.  
An extension can have a manual or automatic Call Timer key.  
An extension can have line keys for placing and answering outside calls.  
Check the Feature Key assignments.  
Assign a Directory Dialing key on an extension.  
If enabled in programming, Feature Keys become DSS keys when the user presses INTERCOM.  
An extension can have Group Call Pickup keys.  
An extension’s headset key can simplify switching the headset mode.  
An extension can have Hotline keys.  
An extension can have Fixed Loop and Switched Loop keys for placing and answering calls.  
An extension can have night keys for putting the system and UCD Groups into the night mode.  
An extension can have Page zone keys.  
An extension can have Park keys.  
An extension can have Reverse Voice Over keys.  
An extension can have a Save key.  
An extension can have a Split key.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Feature Keys  
An extension can have keys for Personal and System Speed Dial bins.  
An extension can have voice mail Record and Message Center keys.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
User Programmable Feature  
Programming Feature Keys  
Operation  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#KP (#57)  
Access Level  
Programmable Feature Key  
Assignments  
#KP + Press key you want to program + HOLD + INTER-  
COM + Press Volume Up or Volume Down to select key  
option + HOLD + (Enter any additional data, if required +  
HOLD) + Press Volume Up or Volume Down to select  
another key to program, or CONF + SPEAKER to exit.  
3-5  
176  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Flash  
Flash  
Description  
Extension users can access certain CO and PBX features by interrupting line loop current.  
Flash allows an extension user to access certain CO and PBX features by interrupting line loop current.  
Flash lets an extension user take full advantage of whatever features the connected telco or PBX offers. You  
must set the Flash parameters for compatibility with the connected telco.  
Flash for Single Line Extensions  
The Class of Service option 1403-01: Flash for Single Line Set (page 635) allows you to enable or disable  
hookash for analog single line extensions. If enabled (Y), a single line extension can hookash normally and  
use any of the associated system features. If disabled (N), hookash is prevented. This means the analog exten-  
sion can not use any features that require a hookash (such as Hold, Conference, or Transfer). This may be  
helpful for lobby phones and single line Ringdown Extensions that should not have access to system features.  
A single line extension user cannot seize an outside line and hookash without dialing. If they do, the  
system will disconnect the initial outside call.  
If a single line extension user hookashes to place their current outside call on Hold and then hangs up,  
the outside call will immediately recall the extension.  
The option is ignored for voice mail ports.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
1.  
Check the setting of the system’s Flash timer.  
Centrex or PBX.  
2.  
Should a single line extension be able to hookash?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
.
.
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Flash  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Flash restarts the Call Timer.  
Flash allows an extension user to access certain telco or PBX features.  
When an extension user with Toll Restriction enabled ashes a line, the system enforces toll Restric-  
tion on any digits the user dials from the new dial tone. For example, if an extension user cannot dial  
203 926 5400 before they ash, they cannot dial 203 926 5400 after they ash.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Flashing and Outside Line  
To Flash the outside line you are on:  
Do one of the following.  
1.  
a.  
b.  
At a keyset, press FLASH.  
At a single line telephone, hookash and dial #3.  
178  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Flexible Numbering Plan  
Flexible Numbering Plan  
Description  
Change the digits users dial for co-workers and other features.  
The system’s Flexible Numbering Plan allows you to change the digits users dial to reach the attendant,  
other co-worker’s, outside lines, UCD Groups, and Ring Groups. The following chart shows the areas of the  
system number plan you can change.  
You can change the digits a user  
dials to:  
These digits are  
normally:  
For this feature:  
Reach the system operator(s)  
Access a Line Group  
0 or 01-04  
90-98  
Directly access a line  
101-164  
700-707  
600-607  
300-427  
Reach a UCD Group master number  
Reach a a Ring Group master number  
Call a co-worker over the Intercom  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• See the table above.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Flexible Numbering Plan  
Programming  
1.  
Do you want to change the digit(s) users dial to reach system operator(s)?  
1. In yes:  
access).  
new digit to 2.  
- Be sure your choice does not affect other system operations.  
2. If no, leave the above options at their default settings.  
2.  
Do you want to change the digit(s) users dial to reach Line Groups?  
1. If yes:  
access).  
new digit to 2.  
2. If no, leave the above options at their default settings.  
3.  
Do you want to change the line extension number range used for Direct Line Access?  
1. If yes:  
access).  
new digit to 3.  
- In 1313-01: Line Extension Number (page 625), change the line extension numbers to use the lead-  
ing digit selected above.  
2. If no, leave the above options at their default settings.  
4.  
Do you want to change the UCD Group master extension number range?  
1. If yes:  
access).  
new digit to 3.  
the leading digit selected above.  
2. If no, leave the above options at their default settings.  
5.  
Do you want to change the Ring Group master extension number range?  
1. If yes:  
access).  
new digit to 3.  
the leading digit selected above.  
2. If no, leave the above options at their default settings.  
180  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Flexible Numbering Plan  
6.  
Do you want to change the Intercom extension number range?  
1. If yes:  
access).  
new digit to 3.  
- In 1311-01: Station Extension Number (page 623), change the extension numbers to use the leading  
digit selected above.  
2. If no, leave the above options at their default settings.  
6.  
Do you want to swap the extension numbers of two telephones?  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Change the digits users dial to reach the system operators (normally 0 or 01-04).  
Change the digits users dial to access a Line Group for an outside call (normally 90-98).  
Change the digits users dial to directly access an outside line (normally 101-164).  
Change the digits required to reach a UCD Group master number.  
Change the digits required to reach a Ring Group master number.  
Change the digits users dial to reach co-worker’s over the Intercom (normally 300-427).  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Forced Line Disconnect  
Forced Line Disconnect  
Description  
Disconnect a co-worker’s outside call in an emergency.  
Forced Line Disconnect allows an extension user to disconnect (release) another extension’s active outside  
call. Forced Line Disconnect lets a user access a busy line in an emergency, when no other lines are avail-  
able. Maintenance technicians can also use Forced Line Disconnect to release a line on which there is no  
conversation. This can happen if a line does not properly disconnect when the outside party hangs up.  
CAUTION  
Forced Line Disconnect abruptly terminates the active call on the line. Only  
use this feature in an emergency and when no other lines are available.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled for attendants (COS 1). Disabled for all other extensions (COS 2-15).  
Programming  
1.  
Should extension be allowed to use Forced Line Disconnect?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. If yes:  
- In 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763), make sure the extension has outgoing (option 2) or full  
(option 3) access to the lines it should be able to disconnect.  
3. If no:  
Other Related Features  
Features  
System attendants normally have Forced Line Disconnect capability.  
As an alternative to disconnecting the line, Barge In instead.  
An extension user with Direct Line Access can dial a code for the busy line before using Forced Line  
Disconnect.  
An extension user can end an Unsupervised Conference by using Forced Line Disconnect on one of  
the lines in the tandem call.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
182  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Forced Line Disconnect  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Forced Line Disconnect  
To disconnect a busy line:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Press the line key for the busy line.  
Press INTERCOM and dial the line’s extension number (e.g., 101 for line 1).  
When you hear busy tone, dial # to disconnect the line.  
You hear Intercom dial tone and the line key goes out.  
You can now place a new call on the line.  
2.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Group Call Pickup  
Group Call Pickup  
Description  
Easily answer a call ringing your Pickup Group, even if you don’t know which extension is ringing.  
Group Call Pickup allows an extension user to answer a call ringing an extension in their assigned Pickup  
Group. This permits co-workers in the same Pickup Group to easily answer each other’s ringing calls. The  
user can intercept the ringing call by dialing a code or pressing a programmed Group Call Pickup key. The  
system has a maximum of eight Pickup Groups, with an unlimited number of extensions in each group.  
However, an extension can be a member of only one pickup group.  
Group Call Pickup can answer the following types of calls:  
Ringing Intercom calls  
Transferred calls  
Direct Inward Lines  
Calls on lines assigned to the Pickup Group  
To simplify picking up calls, an extension can have Feature Keys assigned as Group Call Pickup keys. There  
are three types of Group Call Pickup keys: immediate ring, no ring (lamp only), or delayed ring.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No Pickup Groups assigned.  
Programming  
1.  
Should extension be part of a Pickup Group?  
extension should belong.  
2. If no, make sure 2113-03: Pickup Group (page 739) is 0.  
2.  
Should an incoming outside call ring all extensions in a Pickup Group?  
1. If yes:  
which the line should belong.  
- In 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763), make sure extensions in the Pickup Group have incoming  
(option 1) or full (option 3) access to the line.  
- In 2132-[01-64]: Line Ringing (page 764), make sure to enable ringing for all extensions in the  
Pickup Group that should ring for the line.  
184  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Group Call Pickup  
3.  
Setting up Group Call Pickup keys on a keyset.  
- For an Immediate Ring Group Call Pickup key, assign key code 09.  
- For a No Ring (Lamp Only) Group Call Pickup key, assign key code 10.  
- For a Delay Ring Group Call Pickup key, assign key code 11.  
will cover.  
4.  
Setting up Group Call Pickup keys on a DSS Console.  
- For an Immediate Ring Group Call Pickup key, assign key code 09.  
- For a No Ring (Lamp Only) Group Call Pickup key, assign key code 11.  
- For a Delay Ring Group Call Pickup key, assign key code 12.  
will cover.  
5.  
For Delay Ring Group Call Pickup keys (if any), set the delay ring interval.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
DILs to an extension activate Group Call Pickup if the extension ringing is a member of a Pickup Group.  
DSS Consoles can have Group Call Pickup keys.  
Directed Call Pickup is another way to pick up calls ringing an extension.  
By using Key Ring Override, Distinctive Ringing allows an extension user to set up unique ringing for  
their Group Call Pickup keys.  
Ringing Intercom calls activate Group Call Pickup if the extension ringing is a member of a Pickup Group.  
An outside call transferred to an extension in a Pickup Group activates Group Call Pickup.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Group Call Pickup  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Answering a Pickup Group Call  
To answer a call ringing a phone in your Pickup Group:  
1.  
2.  
Lift the handset.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Press the ashing Group Call Pickup key.  
Press INTERCOM and dial *#.  
User Programmable Feature  
Changing the Group Call Pickup Key Ringing  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#RA (#72)  
Operation  
Access Level  
Group Call Pickup  
#RAP + Group Call Pickup key repeatedly to select ring-  
1-5  
ing mode + SPEAKER to exit.  
Call Coverage Keys ash as follows:  
- Lamp only = On red  
- Immediate ring = On green  
- Delay ring = Fast ash green.  
186  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Group Listen  
Group Listen  
Description  
Use Group Listen to talk to an important client or customer and have your co-workers listen in  
on the meeting.  
Group Listen permits a keyset user to talk on the handset and have their caller’s voice broadcast over the  
telephone speaker. This lets the keyset user’s co-workers listen to the conversation. Group Listen turns off  
the keyset’s Handsfree microphone so the caller does not hear the co-worker’s voices during a Group Listen.  
When a keyset user sets up Group Listen, they hear their caller’s voice over the telephone speaker as well as  
their handset.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
1.  
Disable the headset mode for extensions that should be able to use Group Listen.  
- Extensions in the headset mode cannot use Group Listen.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Group Listen is not available to extensions in the headset mode.  
Group Listen is not available to single line telephones.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Group Listen  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Group Listen  
To set up Group Listen:  
1.  
2.  
Place or answer a call using the handset.  
Press SPEAKER twice (but do not hang up).  
SPEAKER ashes slowly red.  
Talk to the caller through your handset.  
You and your co-workers hear your caller’s voice over your telephone speaker.  
Your handsfree microphone and handset receiver are off.  
3.  
To talk Handsfree after initiating Group Listen:  
1.  
2.  
Press SPEAKER twice.  
Hang up.  
SPEAKER is on.  
• Talk to your caller using the Handsfree speaker and microphone.  
To cancel Group Listen and return to your handset:  
1.  
2.  
Do not hang up.  
Press ashing SPEAKER.  
SPEAKER is off.  
• Talk to your caller over your handset. Your co-workers can no longer hear your caller’s voice.  
188  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Group Ring  
Group Ring  
Description  
Use Group Ring to call a group of co-worker’s simultaneously.  
Group Ring allows you to arrange extensions into Ring Groups for answering calls. When a call comes into  
the Ring Group master number, all extensions in the group ring simultaneously. Any user in the Ring Group  
can answer the call just by lifting the handset. The ringing call can be:  
A Direct Inward Line to the Ring Group (i.e., terminated to the Ring Group master number).  
An outside call transferred to the Ring Group master number.  
An intercom call to the Ring Group master number.  
The system provides up to 8 Ring Groups (1-8). The Ring Group master numbers are predened as 600-607,  
but can be any valid extension number not already in use.  
Overow for Group Ring Calls  
If unanswered, DILs to a Ring Group can route to a programmed overow destination. The overow destina-  
tion can be an extension, another Ring Group, UCD Group or voice mail. You can set up separate DIL over-  
ow destinations for the day mode and at night. If unanswered at the overow destination, the call diverts to  
Key Ring. Note that a Ring Group DIL goes into the night mode when any extension with night mode capa-  
bility presses their System night key. See Night Service / Night Ring (page 252) for more.  
If the Ring Group DIL does not have overow programmed, the call will divert to Key Ring after the Line  
No Answer interval.  
Conditions  
• System operators will not ring for Ring Group calls. Do not include the operator in a Ring Group.  
Default Setting  
• Ring Group master numbers are predened as shown in the following table. If required, you can reas-  
sign the Ring Group master numbers to any other unused extension number (100-899). See Flexible  
Ring Group Default Assignments  
Ring Group  
Default Master Number  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
600  
601  
602  
603  
604  
605  
606  
607  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Group Ring  
Programming  
Basic Programming  
1.  
2.  
Should an extension be in a Ring Group?  
1. If yes, in 2113-02: Ring Group (page 738) enter the Ring Group (1-8) to which the extension belongs.  
Do you want to enter a name for a Ring Group?  
- The name shows on a keyset user’s display when they call the Ring Group.  
2. If no, leave 2201-01: Ring Group Name (page 779) at its default setting.  
3.  
Should calls into a Ring Group ring members with a distinctive ring?  
- 0 = Standard Ring  
- 1 = Ring Type A  
- 2 = Ring Type B  
- 3 = Ring Type C  
190  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Group Ring  
Setting Up Ring Group DILs  
1.  
Should a DIL route to a Ring Group during the day?  
- Use a System Night key to switch a DIL to a Ring Group from day to night mode.  
Group master number.  
2.  
Should overow occur for a DIL to a Ring Group that is unanswered during the day?  
1. If yes:  
- In 3112-03: Day Overow Destination (page 820) enter the day overow destination. The destina-  
tion can be:  
- An extension  
- A UCD Group master number  
- The voice mail master number  
- A Ring Group master number  
- Key Ring (by pressing CLEAR)  
3.  
Should a DIL route to a Ring Group at night?  
- Use a System Night key to switch a DIL to a Ring Group from day to night mode.  
Group master number.  
4.  
Should overow occur for a DIL to a Ring Group that is unanswered at night?  
1. If yes:  
- In 3112-06: Night Overow Destination (page 821) enter the day overow destination. The destina-  
tion can be:  
- An extension  
- A UCD Group master number  
- The voice mail master number  
- A Ring Group master number  
- Key Ring (by pressing CLEAR)  
5.  
6.  
Be sure the DIL destination extension has a line key for the DIL.  
Optionally set up a line key for the DIL on a DSS Console.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Group Ring  
Adjusting Ring Group Timers  
If a Ring Group DIL is unanswered, does the call divert to its overow destination after the  
proper interval?  
1.  
2.  
3.  
If a DIL is unanswered at the overow destination, does the call divert to Key Ring after the  
proper interval?  
1. If yes, leave 1601-02: DIL No Answer Timer (page 669) at it’s current setting.  
If the DIL doesn’t have overow enabled and is unanswered, does the call divert to Key Ring  
after the proper interval?  
Other Related Features  
Features  
System operators will not ring for Ring Group calls. Do not include the operator in a Ring Group.  
A keyset can have Call Coverage keys for Ring Group master numbers.  
Call Forwarding does not reroute Ring Group calls.  
An extension user cannot Camp-On to a busy Ring Group. When all extensions in the Ring Group are  
busy, the call continues to ring until an extension becomes free.  
An extension’s display will show Caller ID data for a line terminated to a Ring Group master number  
as the call is ringing.  
A DIL can terminate to a Ring Group master number. When a call comes in on the line, all phones in  
the Ring Group ring simultaneously.  
Directed Call Pickup can intercept Ring Group calls.  
Intercom Directory dialing will show Ring Group names.  
Group Ring calls do not activate hunting.  
The Night (System) key sets the day/night status of a DIL terminated to a Ring Group.  
An extension user can Transfer a call to a Ring Group master number. If unanswered, the call will  
recall the extension from which it was transferred.  
IntraMail Features  
An unanswered DIL to the Ring Group master number can be picked up by the Ring Group Mailbox.  
192  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Group Ring  
Operation  
Placing and Transferring Ring Group Calls  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Placing an Intercom Call to a Ring Group  
To make an Intercom call to a Ring Group:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Lift handset and press INTERCOM.  
Dial the Ring Group number (e.g., 600).  
Wait for co-worker to answer.  
• If all Ring Group members are busy, your call will continue to ring until a group member becomes free.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Transferring a Call to a Ring Group  
To Transfer your call to a Ring Group:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Press INTERCOM.  
Dial the Ring Group number (e.g., 600).  
Do one of the following:  
a.  
To screen (announce) the Transfer:  
Wait for a Ring Group member to answer then press TRANSFER.  
b.  
To have the call go through unscreened (unannounced):  
Press TRANSFER.  
• If your Transfer is unanswered, the call will return to you.  
c.  
To return to the call before a Ring Group member picks it up:  
Press the ashing (green) line key.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Group Ring  
Answering Ring Group Calls  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Answer a Call to a Ring Group  
To answer a call ringing your Ring Group:  
1.  
Do one of the following:  
a.  
If the call doesn’t appear on a line or loop key:  
Lift handset.  
b.  
If the call appears on a line or loop key:  
Press the ashing line or loop key.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Answer a Call to Another Ring Group  
To answer a call ringing another Ring Group (of which you are not a member):  
1.  
2.  
Lift handset and press INTERCOM.  
Dial ** and the Ring Group number (e.g., 600).  
194  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Handsfree and Handsfree Answerback  
Handsfree and Handsfree Answerback  
Description  
- Talk over the phone Handsfree, using the built-in speaker and microphone.  
- With Handsfree Answerback, answer an Intercom call by just speaking toward your phone.  
Handsfree  
Handsfree allows a keyset user to process calls using the speaker and microphone in the telephone (instead  
of the handset). Handsfree is a convenience for workers who don’t have a free hand to pick up the handset.  
For example, a terminal operator could continue to enter data with both hands while talking on the phone.  
Handsfree Answerback and Forced Intercom Ringing  
Handsfree Answerback permits an extension user to respond to a voice-announced Intercom call by speak-  
ing toward the phone, without lifting the handset. Like Handsfree, this is a convenience for workers who  
don’t have a free hand to pick up the handset. Incoming Intercom calls alert with two beeps if the extension  
has Handsfree Answerback — a single beep if it does not.  
Forced Intercom Ringing causes an Intercom call to ring the destination extension. You can enable Forced  
Intercom Ringing system-wide (for all extensions), or a user can dial a code to have their Intercom call ring  
the destination.  
Conditions  
• Since Handsfree switching is handled in each telephone, there is no limit to the number of simulta-  
neous Handsfree calls system-wide.  
Default Setting  
• Enabled.  
Programming  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Should Intercom calls voice-announce system-wide?  
1. If yes:  
announcements for specic extensions.  
2. If no:  
Should extension users be able to respond to voice announcements without lifting the handset?  
1. In yes:  
announcements for specic extensions.  
2. If no:  
Optimize speakerphone performance.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Handsfree and Handsfree Answerback  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Automatic Handsfree allows a keyset user to place or answer a call Handsfree by just pressing a key  
— without pressing SPEAKER rst.  
Handsfree is not available to extensions in the headset mode. Handsfree Answerback is still available  
— depending on system programming.  
Handsfree Answerback allows a user to answer an Intercom call by just speaking toward the phone.  
Use Microphone Mute to temporarily turn off the Handsfree microphone.  
On- and Off-Premise Extensions do not have Handsfree and Handsfree Answerback capability.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Handsfree  
To use Handsfree instead of lifting the handset:  
1.  
Press SPEAKER.  
To talk on a Handsfree call:  
Speak toward your telephone.  
• To temporarily turn off the Handsfree microphone, see Microphone Mute (page 241).  
1.  
To change a handset call into a Handsfree call:  
1.  
2.  
Press SPEAKER.  
Hang up the handset.  
To change a Handsfree call into a handset call:  
1.  
Lift the handset.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Setting Up Incoming Voice Announcements  
To turn voice-announcements for your incoming Intercom calls on and off:  
Select the voice announce option.  
1.  
[Menu + Voice Announce]  
[Menu + Vann]  
Do one of the following.  
2.  
196  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Handsfree and Handsfree Answerback  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Setting Up Incoming Voice Announcements  
a.  
b.  
To turn incoming voice announcements on:  
[On + EXIT]  
[On + EXIT]  
To turn incoming voice announcements off:  
[Off + EXIT]  
[Off + EXIT]  
User Programmable Feature  
Setting Up Incoming Voice Announcements  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#VA (#82)  
Operation  
Access Level  
Handsfree Answerback  
#VA + V for voice announce or R for ring + SPEAKER to  
exit.  
3-5  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Headset Compatibility  
Headset Compatibility  
Description  
Have the privacy of a handset call without having to hold the handset.  
A keyset user can utilize a customer-provided headset in place of the handset. Like using Handsfree, using  
the headset frees up the user’s hands for other work. However, the headset provides privacy not available  
from Handsfree.  
Headset Compatibility also provides the following features. (Note that while an extension is in the Headset  
mode, the system ignores all hookswitch depressions.)  
Background Music  
If programmed and connected, Background Music will broadcast over the telephone speaker while the  
extension is in the Headset mode.  
Central Ofce Calls, Answering  
An extension user in the Headset mode can press Volume Up and Volume Down to control the volume  
of any call ringing their phone.  
Handsfree and Handsfree Answerback  
An extension in the Headset mode can receive normal voice-announced Intercom calls, depending on the  
setting of 2112-04: Voice Announcements in Headset Mode (page 737). The extension user can respond to  
the voice-announced call by speaking toward the phone (just like non-headset extensions). To answer the  
voice-announced call in the headset, the user just presses SPEAKER after hearing the voice-announcement.  
Microphone Mute  
While on a headset call, the extension user can press MUTE to mute (i.e., turn off) the headset micro-  
phone. While responding to an Intercom call using Handsfree Answerback, pressing MUTE mutes the  
Handsfree microphone.  
Off-Hook Signaling  
Outside Calls  
extension in the headset mode can receive either Camp-On beeps or Off-Hook Ringing for incoming out-  
side calls (just like non-headset extensions).  
Intercom Calls  
extension in the headset mode can receive either Camp-On beeps or Voice Over announcements from a  
co-worker (just like non-headset extensions).  
Hotline Calls  
extension in the headset mode can receive either Camp-On beeps or Voice Over announcements from  
their Hotline partner.  
Paging  
Internal Paging announcements broadcast over the telephone speaker while the extension is in the Head-  
set mode.  
Transfer  
Screened and unscreened transfers work just like non-headset extensions. For example, if a headset  
extension user presses SPEAKER to answer a screened transfer, the call will connect to their headset  
when the transferring party hangs up. Note that Handsfree Transfers always connect to the headset exten-  
sion’s headset, not speakerphone.  
Volume Control  
While on a headset call, the extension user can press Volume Up and Volume Down to adjust the  
receive volume in the headset.  
198  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Headset Compatibility  
Headset Key  
A keyset user can have a Feature Key on their telephone or DSS Console assigned as a Headset key. The  
user presses the key to enable or disable the headset mode, as an alternative to using the #HL User Pro-  
grammable Feature. The key lights while the extension is in the Headset mode, and is off while the Headset  
mode is disabled. If an extension user is on a call, pressing the Headset key automatically switches the  
active call to the headset. Pressing the Headset key again switches the call back to Handsfree.  
Off-Hook Signaling and Headsets  
Outside Calls (transfers and DILs)  
If the extension is set up to receive Camp-On tones for waiting (transferred) outside calls, the user will hear  
the Camp-On tones in their headset. They will also hear Camp-On tones in their headset for a waiting Direct  
Inward Line (DIL). The extension will not, however, receive Camp-On tones for Key Ring calls ringing the  
phone while it is in the headset mode.  
An extension in the headset mode will not hear Off-Hook Ringing.  
Intercom Calls  
If the extension is set up to receive Camp-On tones for waiting Intercom calls, the user will hear tones in  
their headset when a co-worker dials 2 to wait in line.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Default setting text.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Headset Compatibility  
Programming  
1.  
Optionally assign a Headset key to an extension or DSS Console Feature Key.  
1. To assign a Headset key to an extension Feature Key:  
(There is no associated Data entry.)  
2. To assign a Headset key to a DSS Console Feature Key:  
(There is no associated Data entry.)  
2.  
Turn an extension’s headset mode on and off.  
1. In system programming:  
- In 2112-02: Headset Mode (page 735), enterYes to enable or No to disable as required.  
2. Using a Feature Key:  
- Press the extension or DSS Console Feature Key. (The key lights when headset mode is enabled.)  
3. Using the User Programmable Features:  
- Dial #HS (#47) + 9 (Y) to enable or 6 (N) to disable as required.  
While in the headset mode, should incoming Intercom calls beep in the headset or ring over the  
telephone speaker?  
3.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
While in the headset mode, Automatic Handsfree simplies answering outside calls.  
Background Music plays in the headset when the extension is in the headset mode.  
Group Listen is not available to extensions in the headset mode.  
Handsfree is not available to extensions in the headset mode. Handsfree Answerback is available —  
depending on system programming.  
Turn to Off-Hook Signaling and Headsets (page 199) for more on how Off-Hook Signaling interacts  
with headsets.  
• Headset Compatibility is not available to single line telephones.  
• On- and Off-Premise Extensions do not have headset capability.  
An extension user cannot Voice Over to a co-worker in the headset mode.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
200  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Headset Compatibility  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using the Headset  
To connect the headset:  
1.  
Plug a compatible headset into the telephone headset jack.  
To turn the headset mode on and off:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Press the headset Feature Key on your telephone or DSS Console.  
Use the User Programmable Features (see below).  
While in the headset mode:  
1.  
You can do the following.  
Press a line key to place or answer an outside call.  
a.  
b.  
c.  
Press INTERCOM to get Intercom dial tone.  
If on a call, press SPEAKER to hang up.  
User Programmable Feature  
Turning the Headset Mode On and Off  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#HS (#47)  
Operation  
#HS +Y to enable or N to disable + SPEAKER to exit.  
Access Level  
Headset Compatibility  
3-5  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Hold  
Hold  
Description  
Have a call wait on Hold, then pick it up to continue the conversation.  
Hold lets an extension user put a call in a temporary waiting state. The caller on Hold hears silence or Music  
on Hold, not conversation in the extension user’s work area. While the call waits on Hold, the extension user  
may process calls or use a system feature. Outside calls left on Hold too long recall the extension that placed  
them on Hold. If the recall is unanswered, the call diverts to Key Ring.  
There are four types of Hold:  
System (Regular) Hold  
With System Hold, an outside call a user places on Hold ashes the line key (if programmed) at all other  
keysets. Any keyset user with the ashing line key can pick up the call.  
Exclusive Hold  
When a user places a call on Exclusive Hold, only that user can pick up the call from Hold. The line appears  
busy to all other keysets that have a key for the line. Exclusive Hold is important if the user doesn’t want a  
co-worker picking up their call on Hold.  
Automatic Hold  
Automatic Hold allows a user to be on an outside call, activate a feature, and automatically place the call on  
Hold without rst pressing the HOLD key. The system places a call on Hold automatically when the user  
presses CONF, INTERCOM, or a Hotline key. Automatic Hold optionally allows a user, busy on an outside  
call, to press another line key or a Call Coverage Key to automatically put their initial call on Hold.  
Intercom Hold  
A user can place an Intercom call on Hold. The Intercom call on Hold does not indicate at any other exten-  
sion. There is no Hold Recall for Intercom calls.  
Distinctive Flash Rate on Recall  
System Hold and Exclusive Hold recall feature a distinctive ash rate for line keys (see the chart below).  
This allows the keyset extension user to easily differentiate new calls that are ringing from held calls that  
are recalling.  
Distinctive Flash Rate on Recall  
You see this ash rate:  
For this type of call:  
System Hold  
Exclusive Hold  
Call that you placed on Hold  
Single Wink On (green)  
Double Wink On (green)  
Call that you initially placed on Hold  
recalling your phone  
Double Wink On (green)  
Single Wink On (red)  
Double Wink On (red)  
Double Wink On (green)  
None (On red)  
Call a co-worker placed on Hold at  
their extension  
Call a co-worker initially placed on  
Hold recalling your phone  
Double Wink On (red)  
202  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Hold  
Hold Recall Display  
The Hold recall display identies:  
The type of call recalling the extension.  
The extension which initially placed the call on Hold.  
The Hold recall displays occurs as the call is ringing the extension that initially placed it on Hold, and after  
the call diverts to Key Ring.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• System Hold, Exclusive Hold and Automatic Hold enabled.  
Programming  
While busy on a call, should pressing a line key or Call Coverage key put the initial call on  
Hold?  
1.  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
Does an unanswered call on System Hold recall the extension that placed it on Hold after the  
desired interval?  
2.  
Does an unanswered call on Exclusive Hold recall the extension that placed it on Hold after the  
desired interval?  
3.  
3.  
Does an unanswered Hold recall divert to Key Ring after the desired interval?  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Hold  
Other Related Features  
Features  
A user’s Call Timer starts when they pick up a call from Hold. If they place the call on Hold and  
another user picks it up, the timer restarts for the new user.  
If an extension user places a Conference on Hold, no other participants can place the Conference on  
Hold, split it, or terminate it.  
Directed Call Pickup can pick up Hold recalls.  
Unanswered Hold Recalls revert to Key Ring if not picked up.  
If installed, Music on Hold plays to callers on Hold.  
An extension user can place their current call on Hold and answer the waiting call.  
A single line telephone user can only place an outside call on Exclusive Hold. System Hold is not  
available.  
If an extension receiving a screened Transfer answers the screen and immediately hangs up (before the  
transferring extension), the call goes on Exclusive Hold at the transferring extension.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using System Hold  
To place a call on System Hold:  
Press HOLD.  
1.  
• The line key winks (on) while on Hold, double-wink (on) while recalling.  
• Line keys on Hold are green for your calls - red for your co-workers.  
If a call on Hold recalls, you see one of the following.  
If the extension that placed to call on Hold doesn’t have a name:  
Hold Recall  
STA 301  
a.  
If the extension that placed the call on Hold has a programmed name:  
Hold Recall  
300: Attendant  
b.  
To pick up an outside call on System Hold:  
Press the ashing line key.  
1.  
• The line key lights solid (green).  
To pick up an outside call on system Hold at a co-worker’s extension:  
You must know the number of the line that is on Hold.  
204  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hold  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using System Hold  
Lift the handset and press INTERCOM.  
1.  
2.  
Dial *4.  
Dial the number of the line that is on Hold.  
• For example, dial 01 for line 1.  
3.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Exclusive Hold  
To place an outside call on Exclusive Hold:  
Press HOLD twice.  
• For you, the line key winks (on green) while on Hold, ashes slowly while recalling.  
• For your co-workers, the line key is on red while on Hold, ashes slowly (red) while recalling.  
1.  
If a call on Hold recalls, you see one of the following.  
If the extension that placed to call on Hold doesn’t have a name:  
Hold Recall  
STA 301  
a.  
If the extension that placed the call on Hold has a programmed name:  
Hold Recall  
300: Attendant  
b.  
To pick up an outside call on Exclusive Hold:  
Press the ashing line key.  
1.  
• The line key lights solid (green).  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Intercom Hold  
To place an Intercom call on Hold:  
Press HOLD.  
1.  
INTERCOM ashes with a double-wink (on green) while on Hold - slow ash (green) while recalling.  
To pick up an Intercom call from Hold:  
1.  
2.  
Lift the handset  
If you are not connected to the Intercom call, press INTERCOM.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Hold at a Single LineTelephone  
To place an outside or Intercom call on Exclusive Hold:  
• Single line telephones cannot place calls on System Hold.  
1.  
2.  
Hookash.  
Dial *7 and hang up.  
• If you leave the call on Hold too long, it will recall to you.  
• If you hookash and hang up without dialing *7, the call will recall immediately.  
• If you have a call on Exclusive Hold and have a Camped-On call waiting, dialing *7 will answer the waiting  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hold  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Hold at a Single LineTelephone  
To retrieve your call from Exclusive Hold:  
1.  
Lift the handset and dial *7.  
To pick up an outside call on system Hold at a co-worker’s extension:  
You must know the number of the line that is on Hold.  
1.  
2.  
Lift the handset and dial *4.  
Dial *4.  
Dial the number of the line that is on Hold.  
• For example, dial 01 for line 1.  
3.  
206  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hotline  
Hotline  
Description  
Hotline provides partner extensions with one-button calling and Transfer.  
Hotline gives a keyset user with a programmed Hotline key one-button calling and Transfer to another exten-  
sion (the Hotline partner). Hotline helps co-workers that work closely together. The Hotline partners can call  
or Transfer calls to each other just by pressing a single key.  
In addition, the Hotline key shows the status of the partner’s extension:  
Hotline Busy Lamp Indications  
When the key is:  
The partner extension is:  
Off  
On  
Idle or not installed  
1
Busy or ringing  
Medium Flash  
Fast Flash  
Partner extension is in DND for outside  
calls (option 1).  
Partner extension is in DND for Intercom  
calls (option 2) or All Calls (option 3).  
1
Ringing Intercom and Group Ring calls light the Hotline key. DILs, Key Ring calls  
and transferred calls do not.  
Hotline Automatic Transfer  
With Hotline Automatic Transfer, the extension can Transfer their call to a co-worker just by pressing their  
Hotline key and hanging up. Without Hotline Automatic Transfer, the user must pressTRANSFER before  
pressing the Hotline key. If the user frequently uses their Hotline key for one-button Transfer to co-workers,  
Hotline Automatic Transfer is recommended. If the user prefers to consult with their Hotline partner rather  
than Transfer, disabling Hotline Automatic Transfer would be helpful.  
Conditions  
• An extension’s Hotline partner can be any other keyset (e.g., physical port). An extension cannot have  
a Hotline key for master numbers or virtual ports.  
Default Setting  
• No Hotline keys programmed.  
Programming  
1.  
Set up Hotline keys on an extension or DSS Console.  
1. To assign a Hotline key to an extension Feature Key:  
- In 2121-[01 to 24]: Feature Key Data (page 758), enter the extension number of the Hotline partner  
(300-427).  
2. To assign a Hotline key to a DSS Console Feature Key:  
- In 2402-[01-60]: DSS Console Key Data (page 801), enter the extension number of the Hotline  
partner (300-427).  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Hotline  
Specify the type of Off-Hook Signaling available when a user presses the Hotline key for their  
busy Hotline partner.  
2.  
Hotline Automatic Transfer  
When transferring, should the user be able to press Hotline (without rst pressingTRANSFER)  
to Transfer the call?  
1.  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Call Coverage Keys provide many of the features available to Hotline partners.  
DSS Consoles can also have Hotline keys.  
An extension user can press their Hotline key twice to override their Hotline partner’s DND.  
A user can press a Hotline Key as an alternative to dialing Intercom numbers.  
An extension user can Transfer a call to their Hotline partner by pressing their Hotline key.  
Pressing a Hotline key can Transfer a call to an uninstalled extension’s mailbox (if the mailbox is  
enabled).  
An extension can Voice Over after calling a co-worker by pressing their Hotline key.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
208  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hotline  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Hotline  
To place a call to your Hotline partner:  
1.  
Press your Hotline key.  
To transfer a call to your Hotline partner:  
1.  
2.  
While on a call, press your Hotline key.  
Do one of the following.  
If your partner answers, announce the call, press TRANSFER.  
If your extension has Hotline Automatic Transfer, just announce the call and hang up.  
a.  
b.  
Press TRANSFER to have the call wait at your Hotline partner unannounced.  
If your extension has Hotline Automatic Transfer, just hang up instead.  
3.  
The call recalls to you if it is not picked up.  
To answer a call from your Hotline partner:  
1.  
When you hear two beeps, speak towards the phone.  
User Programmable Feature  
Reassigning Hotline Keys  
Operation  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#HL (#45)  
Access Level  
Hotline  
#HL + Press ashing Hotline key + Enter extension for  
new Hotline partner + HOLD + Program another Hotline  
key or SPEAKER to exit.  
3-5  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Interactive Soft Keys  
Interactive Soft Keys  
Description  
Use advanced features just by pressing a soft key, without remembering feature codes.  
Interactive Soft Keys provide intuitive feature access. It is no longer necessary to remember feature codes to  
access the telephone’s advanced features because the function of the soft keys change as the user process calls.  
For example, while on an outside call a display keyset user can press the PARK soft key to Park their call in orbit.  
For additional information on Interactive Soft Key operation, refer to Feature Operation below.  
Conditions  
• When an extension’s soft keys are enabled or disabled in programming, the user must take some  
action at the telephone (such as lifting and replacing the handset) before the change takes effect.  
Default Setting  
• Soft keys enabled.  
Programming  
1.  
Should extension have Interactive Soft Keys?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
Other Related Features  
None  
Operation  
See each feature.  
210  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Intercom  
Intercom  
Description  
Use Intercom to call any co-worker.  
Intercom gives extension users access to other extensions. This provides the system with complete internal  
calling capability.  
Handsfree Answerback and Forced Intercom Ringing  
Handsfree Answerback permits an extension user to respond to a voice-announced Intercom call by speak-  
ing toward the phone, without lifting the handset. Like Handsfree, this is a convenience for workers who  
don’t have a free hand to pick up the handset. Incoming Intercom calls alert with two beeps if the extension  
has Handsfree Answerback — a single beep if it does not.  
Forced Intercom Ringing causes an Intercom call to ring the destination extension. You can enable Forced  
Intercom Ringing system-wide (for all extensions), or a user can dial a code to have their Intercom call ring  
the destination.  
For more on setting up Handsfree Answerback and Forced Intercom Ringing, see Handsfree and Handsfree  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Intercom calling always enabled.  
Programming  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Should Intercom calls voice-announce system-wide?  
1. If yes:  
announcements for specic extensions.  
2. If no:  
Should extension users be able to respond to voice announcements without lifting the handset?  
1. In yes:  
announcements for specic extensions.  
2. If no:  
Do Intercom callers have adequate time to dial digits before hearing reorder tone?  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Intercom  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Designate each extension’s operator.  
A user can press a Call Coverage Key as an alternative to dialing Intercom numbers.  
A user can Camp-On after placing an Intercom call to a busy co-worker.  
A user can leave a Callback request after placing an Intercom call to a busy co-worker.  
A user can press a DSS key as an alternative to dialing Intercom numbers.  
Directory Dialing is a convenient alternative to manually dialing Intercom numbers.  
Voice-announced Intercom calls do not initiate hunting.  
Change the digits users dial to place Intercom calls to co-workers.  
Ringing Intercom calls activate Group Call Pickup if the extension ringing is a member of a Pickup  
Group.  
Handsfree Answerback allows a user to answer an Intercom call by just speaking toward the phone.  
Extensions with headsets cannot receive voice-announced Intercom calls.  
A user can press a Hotline Key as an alternative to dialing Intercom numbers.  
Last Number Redial cannot redial Intercom calls.  
A user can leave a Message Waiting after placing an Intercom call to a busy co-worker.  
Music on Hold plays to Intercom callers on Hold.  
Extension names help identify Intercom callers to co-workers.  
Intercom ringing can broadcast over the External Paging speakers.  
Ringdown Extension follows the voice-announce status of destination extension. For example, if an  
extension usually voice-announces Intercom calls, a ringdown to that extension will also voice-announce.  
Ringing Line Preference answers a ringing Intercom call before a ringing outside call.  
Single line telephones cannot receive voice-announced Intercom calls.  
The system cannot Transfer Intercom calls.  
An extension user can Voice Over to a co-worker busy on an Intercom call.  
The default Intercom (station-to-station) gain is 0 dB. While on an Intercom call, use Volume Up and  
Volume Down to change this setting.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
212  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Intercom  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Placing and Answering Intercom Calls  
To place an Intercom call:  
1.  
2.  
Lift handset and press INTERCOM.  
Dial your co-worker’s extension number (300-427).  
• To call the operator, dial the operator’s extension number or dial 0 or 01-04 (depending on your system setup).  
• If your call voice-announces the destination, you can dial 1 to force the call to ring.  
To answer an intercom call:  
1.  
Do one of the following  
a.  
If you hear two beeps (your phone has Handsfree Answerback):  
• Speak toward the phone.  
OR  
• Lift handset for privacy.  
b.  
c.  
If you hear one beep (your phone does not have Handsfree Answerback):  
• Lift the handset for privacy.  
If you hear ringing, lift the handset.  
User Programmable Feature  
Setting Up Incoming Voice Announcements  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#VA (#82)  
Operation  
Access Level  
Intercom  
#VA + V for voice ann. or R for ring + SPEAKER to exit.  
3-5  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Key Ring  
Key Ring  
Description  
So they are not forgotten, unanswered calls automatically ring co-worker’s extensions.  
tiple extensions can be enabled to ring immediately or after a programmed delay for each incoming line call.  
In addition, under certain conditions other types of outside calls divert to Key Ring if unanswered. The fol-  
lowing conditions also initiate Key Ring:  
Direct Inward Line  
An unanswered DIL diverts to Key Ring if unanswered at the extension to which it is terminated. See  
Hold  
Calls left on Hold too long recall the extensions that initially placed them on Hold. If still unanswered,  
they divert to Key Ring.  
Park  
Calls parked in orbit recall the extension that initially parked them. If unanswered, the call diverts to  
Key Ring.  
Transfer  
An unanswered Transfer recalls the extension that initially transferred it. If still unanswered, the line  
diverts to Key Ring.  
Overow for Key Ring Calls  
If unanswered, Key Ring calls can route to a programmed overow destination. The overow destination can  
be an extension, Ring Group, UCD Group or voice mail. You can set up separate Key Ring overow destina-  
tions for the day mode and at night. If unanswered at the overow destination, the call again diverts to Key  
Ring. Note that a Key Ring line goes into the night mode when any extension with night mode capability  
presses their System Night key. See Night Service / Night Ring (page 252) for more.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• (DSX-40) Enabled for all keyset extensions.  
• (DSX-80/160) Enabled for extensions 300-315.  
214  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Key Ring  
Programming  
1.  
Should extension have Key Ring for the outside line?  
1. If yes:  
- 1 for day and night ringing  
- 2 for night only ringing  
- 3 for delayed day and night ringing  
- For day mode Key Ring, in 3112-01: Direct Termination in the Day (page 819) press CLEAR.  
- For night mode Key Ring, in 3112-04: Direct Termination at Night (page 820) press CLEAR.  
2. If no, in 2132-[01-64]: Line Ringing (page 764) enter 0 (lamp only).  
2.  
Optionally set up overow to an alternate destination if the Key Ring line is not answered.  
1. For day mode Key Ring overow:  
- In 3112-03: Day Overow Destination (page 820) enter the day overow destination. The destina-  
tion can be:  
- An extension  
- A UCD Group master number  
- The voice mail Automated Attendant (by entering the voice mail master number)  
- A Ring Group master number  
- Key Ring (by pressing CLEAR)  
2. For night mode Key Ring overow:  
nation can be:  
- An extension  
- A UCD Group master number  
- The voice mail Automated Attendant (by entering the voice mail master number)  
- A Ring Group master number  
- Key Ring (by pressing CLEAR)  
3.  
4.  
Does Key Ring overow occur after the correct interval?  
After ringing the overow destination, does Key Ring occur after the correct interval?  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Key Ring  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Call Coverage will pick up Key Ring calls.  
A Key Ring call will not follow an extension’s Call Forwarding.  
A Key Ring call will not send Camp-On beeps to a busy extension that normally rings for that call.  
An unanswered DIL reverts to all extensions with Key Ring for the line.  
Unanswered Hold Recalls revert to Key Ring if not picked up.  
Off-Hook Signaling can occur for Key Ring calls.  
An unanswered Park recall diverts to Key Ring.  
An unanswered call transferred to an extension diverts to Key Ring if unanswered at the transferring  
extension.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
Key Ring is automatic for those extensions programmed to receive it.  
216  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Language Selection  
Language Selection  
Description  
Set up a telephone to show displays and soft keys in English or Spanish.  
Language Selection provides telephone displays for soft keys and system programming in English and Span-  
ish.You can select the language for each extension in system programming, or the extension user can choose  
their language via the soft keys. Language Selection allows the system to easily accommodate bilingual  
installations (English and Spanish). The telephone user can have their telephone display the language with  
which they are most comfortable.  
Language Selection and SMDR  
Language Selection also allows to you to print the Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) header and  
call type data in English or Spanish. Following is a sample SMDR report in Spanish:  
Registro de Detalle de Llamados  
05/11/2003 11:47A  
---+---+--------------------------------+----------+---------+--------+---  
Ext|Lin|  
Numero Marcado  
| Cuenta | Inicio |Duracion| T  
---+---+--------------------------------+----------+---------+--------+---  
304| 03|  
304| 03|  
102| 02|  
102| 02|  
304| 02|  
304| 02|  
5551212|  
5552145|  
|11:47:12A|00:00:05|SAL  
|11:42:37A|00:00:08|SAL  
|11:43:30A|00:00:16|TMB  
|11:43:30A|00:00:16|TMB  
|11:44:11A|00:00:08|ENT  
|11:44:11A|00:00:08|ENT  
2126657845|  
MACDONALD MIKE|  
2126657845|  
MACDONALD MIKE|  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• The telephone display language is English.  
• The SMDR language is English.  
• The attendant (COS 1) can change an extension’s display language. All other extensions (COS 2) cannot.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Language Selection  
Programming  
1.  
Should extension be able to set their display language?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
From system programming, do you want to set an extensions display language as English or  
Spanish?  
2.  
3.  
Should the SMDR header and call type be English or Spanish?  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Changing the Regional Default to Latin America automatically switches all telephone displays to  
Spanish and enables the Spanish SMDR header and Call Type data.  
The SMDR header and Call Type data can print in either English or Spanish.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Selecting the Display Language  
To select the language (English or Spanish) for your telephone’s display:  
1.  
Select the display language option.  
[Menu + Language]  
[Menu + MORE + MORE + Lang]  
2.  
Do one of the following.  
[English (Ingles)]  
[Eng (Ing)]  
a.  
Select English as your display language.  
Select Spanish as your display language.  
Select to exit.  
[Spanish (Espanol)]  
[Spa (Esp)]  
b.  
[EXIT (SALIR)]  
[EXIT (SAL)]  
c.  
218  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Last Number Redial  
Last Number Redial  
Description  
Quickly redial the last number dialed.  
Last Number Redial allows an extension user to quickly redial the last outside number dialed. For example,  
a user may quickly recall a busy or unanswered number without manually dialing the digits. Last Number  
Redial saves in system memory the last 20 digits a user dials. The number can be any combination of digits  
0-9, # and *. The system remembers the digits regardless of whether the call was answered, unanswered or  
busy. The system normally uses the same line as for the initial call. However, if that line is busy and is part of  
a Line Group, Last Number Redial will automatically select the next line in the group. The user can also pre-  
select a specic line if desired.  
Enhanced Last Number Redial  
If enabled, Enhanced Last Number Redial allows the extension user to select from the last 5 outside numbers  
dialed. When the user places an outside call, the number dialed is stored in the Enhanced Last Number  
Redial buffer. This buffer saves the 5 most recent numbers (including Speed Dial calls), with the most recent  
call at the top of the buffer and the oldest number at the bottom of the buffer. Old calls get pushed off the bot-  
tom of the buffer to make room for new calls at the top. If a user dials a number that is already stored in the  
buffer, the system inserts the number at the top of the buffer and deletes the duplicate entry.  
The numbers stored in the Enhanced Last Number Redial buffer are retained if the system resets or is pow-  
ered down.  
Automatic Hyphenation in the Enhanced Last Number Redial Display  
The system will automatically insert hyphens in the Enhanced Last Number Redial display for the types of  
calls listed below. All other calls are displayed without hyphens.  
NNX + xxxx calls (e.g., 926-5400)  
NPA + NNX + xxxx calls (e.g., 203-926-5400)  
1 + NPA + NNX + xxxx calls (e.g., 1-203-926-5400)  
If the call is placed on a PBX line, and the PBX access code is dialed, the display shows the PBX access  
code, a space, followed by the dialed number using the same hyphenation as shown above (e.g., 9 1-203-  
926-5400). If the PBX access code is not dialed, the number is displayed without hyphens.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Last Number Redial and Enhanced Last Number Redial are enabled.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Last Number Redial  
Programming  
1.  
Enable outgoing access on each line the user should use for Last Number Redial.  
- 2 for outgoing access only  
- 3 for full access  
2.  
Should extension be able to use Enhanced Last Number Redial?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Last Number Redial and Save do not store Account Codes. This means that the user must manually  
enter an Account Code to have it included with a call dialed using Last Number Redial and Save.  
Auto Redial periodically redials a busy outside number.  
Users can easily redial the last outside number dialed.  
Last Number Redial cannot redial Intercom calls.  
If all lines are busy and Last Number Redial cannot go through, the user can dial 2 a queue for a line  
to become free. If the user hangs up, the system converts the queue to a Line Callback.  
Save also simplies dialing important numbers.  
Last Number Redial is not available at single line telephones.  
Last Number Redial will not store a number denied by Toll Restriction.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
220  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Last Number Redial  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Last Number Redial  
To redial your last call:  
1.  
2.  
Lift the handset.  
(Optional) Press an idle line key to preselect a line.  
• If you skip this step, the system automatically selects a line from the same group as your initial call.  
Press REDIAL.  
3.  
• If you hear busy tone and your extension has Line Queuing, you can dial 2 to queue for a line to become free.  
If you hang up, the system converts the queue to a Line Callback.  
- With Line Queuing, the number automatically redials when a line is available.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Enhanced Last Number Redial  
To redial your last call at a 3-line display telephone:  
• If you select a line key before going to step 1, the system outdials your most recent call when you press REDIAL.  
1.  
Press REDIAL.  
At a 3-line display telephone you see (for example):  
LAST 5 DIALED [4]  
1-203-926-5400  
• The number to the right of the display shows the Last Number Redial record number (1-5). This is the total  
number of Last Number Redial calls stored at your extension.  
• To return to idle, press REDIAL again.  
2.  
3.  
(Optional) Press Volume Up or Volume Down to display the number you want to call.  
To redial the displayed number, do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Press SPEAKER.  
Lift the handset.  
The system tries to use the same line as that used for your initial call.  
4.  
• If that line is busy, the system automatically selects a line from the same group as your initial call.  
• If you hear busy tone and your extension has Line Queuing, you can dial 2 to queue for a line to become free.  
If you hang up, the system converts the queue to a Line Callback.  
- With Line Queuing, the number automatically redials when a line is available.  
To redial your last call at a Super Display Telephone:  
1.  
Press REDIAL.  
At a Super Display telephone you see (for example):  
LAST 5 DIALED  
1-212-555-1212  
1-203-926-5400  
411  
913-555-8764  
555-4113  
• To return to idle, press REDIAL again.  
Press the soft key for the number you want to recall.  
• The store number dials out.  
2.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Last Number Redial  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Enhanced Last Number Redial  
The system tries to use the same line as that used for your initial call.  
3.  
• If that line is busy, the system automatically selects a line from the same group as your initial call.  
• If you hear busy tone and your extension has Line Queuing, you can dial 2 to queue for a line to become free.  
If you hang up, the system converts the queue to a Line Callback.  
- With Line Queuing, the number automatically redials when a line is available.  
To erase (clear) all the numbers from your Enhanced Last Number Redial buffer:  
1.  
2.  
Press REDIAL + CLEAR.  
Do one of the following:  
[YES]  
[YES]  
a.  
Select to clear the buffer.  
[NO]  
[NO]  
b.  
Select to exit without clearing the buffer.  
222  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Line Group Routing  
Line Group Routing  
Description  
Dial a single code to place a call over the rst available line in a Line Group.  
With Line Group Routing enabled, an extension user can just press INTERCOM and dial 9 to place an out-  
side call. Line Group Routing automatically selects the rst available line in the extension’s programmed  
“dial 9” Line Group. This simplies placing calls in systems that have a lot of lines for outgoing calls.  
Rather than press one of many line keys, the user just dials 9 instead.  
Conditions  
• Systems using Line Groups or Line Group Routing should use the hybrid FCC registration number  
(i.e., the number that ends in MF-E). Look at the label on the bottom of your equipment cabinet for  
more information.  
• If you include a line in your “dial 9” group that is not physically connected, when a user dials 9 the  
system will:  
- Try the line up to 5 times.  
- Mark it as failed.  
- Automatically exclude it from the “dial 9” group.  
Default Setting  
DSX-80/160  
• Lines 1-12 ring on line keys 1-12 for extensions 300-315. All other extensions are lamp only for lines  
1-12. Lines 13-64 do not appear on line keys.  
• All extensions have full access on all lines.  
• Line Group Routing (dial 9) is assigned to Line Group 90 (which contains lines 1-8). Dial 9 works by  
default. The outgoing line priority for the dial 9 group is as follows:  
- Order 1 for line 8  
- Order 2 for line 7  
- Order 3 for line 6  
- Order 4 for line 5  
- Order 5 for line 4  
- Order 6 for line 3  
- Order 7 for line 2  
- Order 8 for line 1  
DSX-40  
• Keys 1-8 are line keys for lines 1-8.  
• All extensions have full access on all lines.  
• Lines 5-8 require the Expansion Board.  
• Line Group Routing (dial 9) is assigned to Line Group 90 (which contains lines 1-8). Dial 9 works by  
default. The outgoing line priority for the dial 9 group is as follows:  
- Order 1 for line 8  
- Order 2 for line 7  
- Order 3 for line 6  
- Order 4 for line 5  
- Order 5 for line 4  
- Order 6 for line 3  
- Order 7 for line 2  
- Order 8 for line 1  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Line Group Routing  
Programming  
-
1.  
Check the extension’s dial 9 Line Group assignment.  
1. In 2113-01: Dial 9 Group (page 738), check the extension’s dial 9 group assignment.  
- By default, all extensions use group 90.  
- A line can be in more than one group.  
2.  
3.  
Make sure the extension has access to the assigned dial 9 group.  
1. In 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763), the extension should have outgoing (2) or full (3) access to the  
lines in the dial 9 group.  
Verify that the dialing plan setup allows single digit (dial 9) Line Group access.  
- To allow users to dial specic Line Groups (90-98), change this entry to 2.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Review this feature for other ways to place outside calls.  
With Line Group Routing disabled, extension users can optionally dial 90-98 to place calls on Line  
Groups 90-98.  
An extension user camp-on or leave a Callback if all lines in the dial 9 group are busy.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Line Group Routing  
By default, pressing Intercom and dialing 911 or lifting the handset and dialing 911 will not call emergency services.  
To place a call using Line Group Routing:  
1.  
2.  
Lift the handset and press INTERCOM.  
Dial 9.  
• If you don’t hear dial tone, Line Group Routing is not enabled.  
• If you hear busy tone and your extension has Line Queuing, you can dial 2 to queue for a line to become free.  
If you hang up, the system converts the queue to a Line Callback.  
3.  
Dial your outside number.  
224  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Line Groups  
Line Groups  
Description  
Dial codes to access Line Groups for outgoing calls.  
Extension users can optionally dial Line Group access codes 90-98 to select an available line in the group for  
outgoing calls. This is helpful in applications that have different services arranged into Line Groups. For  
example, dialing 90 could access a group of DDD lines for local calls, and dialing 91 could access a group of  
WATS lines for long distance calls. Note that systems with Line Group Routing (page 223) enabled cannot  
also dial Line Group access codes 90-98.  
When a user dials a Line Group access code (90-98), the system selects the lowest number in the group that is  
available. If that line is busy, it automatically selects the next highest line. If all lines in the group are busy, the  
user can optionally queue for a line to become free. See Line Queuing / Line Callback (page 230) for more.  
Systems using Line Groups or Line Group Access should use the hybrid FCC registration number (i.e., the  
number that ends in MF-E). Look at the label on the bottom of your equipment cabinet for more information.  
Conditions  
• Systems using Line Groups or Line Group Routing should use the hybrid FCC registration number  
(i.e., the number that ends in MF-E). Look at the label on the bottom of your equipment cabinet for  
more information.  
• A line can be in more than one group.  
Default Setting  
DSX-80/160  
• Lines 1-12 ring on line keys 1-12 for extensions 300-315. All other extensions are lamp only for lines  
1-12. Lines 13-64 do not appear on line keys.  
• All extensions have full access on all lines.  
• Line Group Routing (dial 9) is assigned to Line Group 90 (which contains lines 1-8). Dial 9 works by  
default. The outgoing line priority for the dial 9 group is as follows:  
- Order 1 for line 8  
- Order 2 for line 7  
- Order 3 for line 6  
- Order 4 for line 5  
- Order 5 for line 4  
- Order 6 for line 3  
- Order 7 for line 2  
- Order 8 for line 1  
DSX-40  
• Keys 1-8 are line keys for lines 1-8.  
• All extensions have full access on all lines.  
• Lines 5-8 require the Expansion Board.  
• Line Group Routing (dial 9) is assigned to Line Group 90 (which contains lines 1-8). Dial 9 works by  
default. The outgoing line priority for the dial 9 group is as follows:  
- Order 1 for line 8  
- Order 2 for line 7  
- Order 3 for line 6  
- Order 4 for line 5  
- Order 5 for line 4  
- Order 6 for line 3  
- Order 7 for line 2  
- Order 8 for line 1  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Line Groups  
Programming  
-
1.  
2.  
Verify the Line Group congurations.  
- A line can be in more than one group.  
Make sure the extension has access to the Line Groups.  
1. In 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763), enter 2 (outgoing) or 3 (full) for each line the extension should  
be able to access.  
2. In 2133-[01-64]: Line Group Access (page 765), enterYes for each group the extension should be able to  
access.  
3.  
Verify that the dialing plan setup allows dialing Line Groups (90-98).  
- To provide Line Group Routing (dial 9), change this entry to 1.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Switched and Fixed Loop Keys use the system’s Line Groups.  
With Line Group Routing enabled, extension users can press INTERCOM and dial  
ing calls.  
9
to place outgo-  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Line Groups  
By default, pressing Intercom and dialing 911 or lifting the handset and dialing 911 will not call emergency services.  
To place a call over a Line Group:  
1.  
2.  
Lift the handset and press INTERCOM.  
Dial the Line Group code (90-98).  
• If you hear busy tone and your extension has Line Queuing, you can dial 2 to queue for a line to become free.  
If you hang up, the system converts the queue to a Line Callback.  
• If you hear dial tone after dialing 9, Line Group Routing is enabled.  
3.  
Dial your outside number.  
226  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Line Keys  
Line Keys  
Description  
Press a line key for one-touch access to an outside line.  
A line key provides an extension user with one-button access to outside lines. The extension user just presses  
a line key to place or answer a call on the line. There is no need to dial codes to access or intercept outside  
calls. In addition, a line key provides a Busy Lamp Field (BLF) for the line to which it is assigned (see the  
table below).  
Line Key BLF Indications  
When the key is:  
The line is:  
Off  
Idle or not installed  
In use or on Exclusive Hold at a co-worker’s extension  
In use at your extension  
On (red)  
On (green)  
Wink On (red)  
Wink On (green)  
Double Wink On (green)  
Slow Flash (red)  
Slow Flash (green)  
On System Hold at a co-worker’s extension  
On System Hold at your extension  
On Exclusive Hold or recalling your extension  
Ringing into the system  
Ringing or recalling directly to your extension  
Answering Priority  
When multiple calls ring an extension simultaneously, the system services the ringing calls in the follow-  
ing order:  
1. Ringing Intercom call  
2. Line or loop key (from lowest to highest)  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• (DSX-80/160) Keys 1-12 are line keys for lines 1-12.  
• (DSX-40) Keys 1-8 are line keys for lines 1-8.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Line Keys  
Programming  
1.  
Set up line keys for the extension or DSS Console.  
1. To set up a line key on an extension:  
2. To set up a line key on a DSS Console:  
- This option does not restrict loop keys.  
2.  
3.  
Set the access for the line assigned to the line key.  
- 1 for incoming access only  
- 2 for outgoing access only  
- 3 for full access  
Should the line key ring for incoming calls?  
1. If yes:  
1 for day and night ringing  
2 for night ringing only  
3 for delay ringing day and night  
- For delay ringing (option 4 only), in 1604-01: Delay Ring Timer (page 678) adjust the Delay Ring  
timer as required.  
2. If no:  
- In 2132-[01-64]: Line Ringing (page 764) 0 (lamp only - no ringing).  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Automatic Handsfree allows the keyset user to answer a call ringing a line key without lifting the  
handset; they just press the line key instead.  
Line Keys give a user one-touch access to specic lines.  
When you assign a line as a DIL, it continues to ash its previously programmed line/loop key assign-  
ments. It will ring line/loop keys only after diverting to Key Ring.  
By using Key Ring Override, Distinctive Ringing allows an extension user to set up unique ringing for  
their line keys.  
Loop keys also provide one-button access to lines.  
Ringing Line Preference allows an extension user to answer a call ringing a line key just by lifting  
the handset.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
228  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Line Keys  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using your Line Keys  
To place a call using a line key:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Lift the handset.  
Press the line key.  
Dial the outside number.  
To answer an incoming call using a line key.  
Listen for ringing and look for the ashing line key.  
• Line keys that ash red are for you and your co-workers.  
• Line keys that ash green are just for you (such as DILs and transfers).  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Lift the handset.  
Press the ashing line key.  
• If you have Ringing Line Preference, lifting the handset answers the call.  
• If you have Automatic Handsfree, while on a call you can press another line key to put your rst call on Hold.  
User Programmable Feature  
Setting Line Key Ringing  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#RA (#72)  
Operation  
Access Level  
Line Keys  
#RAL + Line key repeatedly to select ringing mode +  
2-5  
SPEAKER to exit.  
Line keys ash as follows:  
- Lamp only = On red  
- Immediate ring = On green  
- Delay ring = Fast ash green  
- Night ring = Slow ash green  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Line Queuing / Line Callback  
Line Queuing / Line Callback  
Description  
- When all lines are busy, Line Queuing lets a user wait in line for a line to become free.  
- Line Callback will automatically call the user back when a line is available.  
Line Queuing  
Line Queueing permits an extension user to queue (wait in line) on hook for a busy line or Line Group to  
become free. The system connects the queued extension as soon as the line is available. The user does not  
have to manually retry the line later.  
Line Callback  
After queuing for a line, the extension user just hangs up to convert the Line Queue into a Line Callback.  
When the line becomes free, the system automatically recalls the extension. As soon as the extension user  
answers the callback ring, the system connects the extension to the line.  
An extension user can leave a Line Callback for many lines. The system processes the callbacks as the lines  
become free. In addition, many extensions can leave a Line Callback for the same line. The system processes  
the Callbacks on a rst-in/rst-out (FIFO) basis.  
If an extension user leaves a Line Callback request and then fails to answer the callback ring, the system can-  
cels the Callback.  
Line Queuing Priority  
Selected extensions can have Line Queuing Priority enabled in their Class of Service. If more than one  
extension queues or leaves a Callback for a busy line, the system services the extension with Line Queuing  
Priority rst. If more than one extension with priority is queued for the same busy line, the system services  
the priority extensions on a rst-in/rst-out (FIFO) basis.  
Conditions  
• A system reset or power failure cancels all Line Callbacks system-wide.  
Default Setting  
• Line Queuing Priority disabled.  
230  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Line Queuing / Line Callback  
Programming  
1.  
Should extension be able to queue for a busy line?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
- This option does not restrict Line Callback.  
2.  
Should extension have Line Queuing Priority?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
An extension user can Camp-On to a busy co-worker then hang up to turn the Camp-On into a Callback.  
An extension user can Camp-On to a busy co-worker then hang up to turn the Camp-On into a Callback.  
If a line is ringing an extension because of a prior Callback, and it then receives a new outside call, it  
will start ringing for the new call. The Callback request is then queued.  
An extension user can queue for a busy line, or queue and hang up to leave a callback for a busy line.  
If all lines are busy and Last Number Redial cannot go through, the user can dial 2 a queue for a line  
to become free. If the user hangs up, the system converts the queue to a Line Callback.  
If an extension user presses their Save key and hears busy, they can dial 2 to wait in line for the line to  
become available. The system will automatically redial the call. However, if the user hangs up to con-  
vert the queue to a Line Callback, the system will not redial the saved call once the line connects.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Line Queuing / Line Callback  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Line Queuing and Line Callback  
To queue or leave a callback for a busy line:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Press the line key for the busy line.  
Press INTERCOM and dial the Direct Line Access code (e.g., 101 for line 1).  
Dial 2 and do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Wait on the line without hanging up for Line Queuing.  
Hang up for Line Callback.  
When the line becomes free, do one of the following.  
a.  
For Line Queuing, you hear outside dial tone so you can place your call again.  
For Line Callback, you hear the Line Callback ring. If you answer the ring:  
You hear outside dial tone.  
• Place your call again.  
b.  
232  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loop Keys  
Loop Keys  
Description  
Loop keys simplify answering and placing calls.  
Loop keys are Feature Keys that simplify the way extension users place and answer outside calls. There are  
two types of loop keys: Switched Loop keys and Fixed Loop keys.  
Switched Loop Keys  
For incoming calls, Switched Loop keys provide an appearance for any line not assigned to a line key for  
which the extension has access and ringing. Switched Loop keys insure that there is a visual appearance for  
lines that do not ring an extension’s line keys.  
For outgoing calls, Switched Loop keys provide convenient access to Line Groups. For example, instead of  
pressing INTERCOM and dialing 90 for Line Group 90, the user can just press the Switched Loop key and  
dial 0 instead.  
Fixed Loop Keys  
For outgoing calls, a Fixed Loop key is a loop key assigned to a specic Line Group. When the extension  
user presses the Fixed Loop key for an outgoing call, they get the rst line in the group assigned to the key.  
For incoming calls, the Fixed Loop key works just like a Switched Loop key. It provides an appearance for  
any line not assigned to a line key for which the extension has access and ringing.  
Answering Priority  
When multiple calls ring an extension simultaneously, the system services the ringing calls in the follow-  
ing order:  
1. Ringing Intercom call  
2. Line or loop key (from lowest to highest)  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No Switched Loop or Fixed Loop keys assigned.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Loop Keys  
Programming  
1.  
2.  
To set up a Switched Loop key:  
- There is no Data entry.  
To set up a Fixed Loop key:  
2. In 3201-[01-64]: Line Group (page 833), make sure there are lines assigned to the group above.  
3.  
To allow the extension be able to use the loop key for answering outside calls:  
- 1 for incoming access only  
- 3 for full access  
- 1 for Day and Night Ring  
- 2 for Night Ring only  
- 3 for Delayed Ring  
as required.  
4.  
To allow the extension be able to use the loop key for placing outside calls:  
- 2 for outgoing access only  
- 3 for full access  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Automatic Handsfree allows the keyset user to answer a call ringing a line key without lifting the  
handset; they just press the line key instead.  
Call Forwarding will not reroute a call ringing a loop key (unless the call is a DIL or transferred call).  
An extension user can press a Loop Key to answer an outside call.  
An extension user can press a Loop Key to place an outside call.  
When you assign a line as a DIL, it continues to ash its previously programmed line/loop key assign-  
ments. It will ring line/loop keys only after diverting to Key Ring.  
Switched and Fixed Loop Keys use the system’s Line Groups.  
Line keys also provide one-button access to lines.  
234  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loop Keys  
Ringing Line Preference allows an extension user to answer a call ringing a loop key just by lifting  
the handset.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Loop Keys  
To answer a call on a loop key:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Listen for ringing and look for the ashing (red) loop key.  
Lift the handset.  
Press the loop key.  
• The loop key will light green after you answer.  
• If you have Ringing Line Preference, lifting the handset answers the call.  
• If you have Automatic Handsfree, you can press the loop key without rst lifting the handset.  
To place a call on a loop key:  
1.  
2.  
Lift the handset.  
Press the loop key.  
• The loop key will light green.  
3.  
Dial the Line Group code (0-8 for groups 90-98).  
For a Switched Loop key:  
a.  
Dial the Line Group code (0-8 for groups 90-98).  
Dial the outside number.  
For a Fixed Loop key:  
Dial the outside number.  
b.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Meet-Me Conference  
Meet-Me Conference  
Description  
Set up a multiple-party telephone conversation with your co-workers.  
With Meet-Me Conference, an extension user can set up a telephone meeting with their co-workers. Each  
party joins the Conference by dialing a Meet Me Conference code. Meet Me Conference lets extension users  
have a telephone meeting — without leaving the ofce. Users must join the meeting within the Meet-Me  
Conference interval.  
The system has two Meet-Me Conference codes (#11 and #12). After a Meet-Me Conference is set up and  
the Meet-Me Conference interval expires, the code used becomes available for a new meeting. Since Meet-  
Me Conference is a type of Conference, the system’s Conference capacity determines:  
The number of users that can join a Meet-Me Conference, and  
The number of simultaneous conferences.  
The following table shows the Conference capacities:  
Description  
Capacity  
Conference circuits  
32  
32  
Maximum simultaneous users in Conference  
(total of all Conferences system-wide)  
Maximum simultaneous conferences  
8
8
Maximum parties in any one Conference  
(lines and/or extensions)  
The system’s 32 Conference circuits are dynamically allocated as users request them.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Meet-Me Conference enabled.  
Programming  
After a co-worker hears a Page inviting them to join a Meet-Me Conference, do they have  
enough time to join?  
1.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
The following features also allow different types of multiple party calls:  
236  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Meet-Me Conference  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Meet-Me Conference  
To set up a Meet-Me Conference:  
1.  
2.  
Page parties and announce the Meet-Me Conference code (#11 or #12).  
Do one of the following.  
You and your co-workers must join the conference within the Meet-Me Conference time.  
INTERCOM ashes fast (green) after the rst party joins the Conference; goes out after additional parties join.  
[Meet Me 11]  
[MT11]  
a.  
b.  
Select to join Meet Me Conference 11.  
Select to join Meet Me Conference 12.  
[Meet Me 12]  
[MT12]  
To join a Meet-Me Conference:  
1.  
2.  
Listen for paged invitation to join the conference.  
Press INTERCOM and dial the announced Meet-Me Conference code (#11 or #12).  
You and your co-workers must join the conference within the Meet-Me Conference time.  
INTERCOM ashes fast (green) after the rst party joins the Conference; goes out after additional parties join.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message Waiting  
Message Waiting  
Description  
For systems without voice mail, leave a Message Waiting request for a return call.  
An extension user can leave a Message Waiting indication at a busy or unanswered extension requesting a  
return call. The indication is a ashing V-MAIL key and Ring/Message lamp at the called extension. Answer-  
ing the Message Waiting automatically calls the extension which left the indication. Message Waiting  
ensures that a user will not have to recall an unanswered extension. It also ensures that a user will not miss  
calls when their extension is busy or unattended.  
An extension user can leave Messages Waiting at any number of extensions. Also, any number of extensions  
can leave a Message Waiting at the same extension. If an extension has multiple messages waiting, the user  
can scroll through their Messages Waiting and select a co-worker to call back.  
Single Line Telephone Message Waiting  
Message Wait Lamping  
The system provides two types of Message Wait lamping at single line telephone ports: High Voltage and  
FSK (Frequency Shift Keying).  
High Voltage Message Waiting  
With High Voltage Message Waiting, the system switches the 150 VDC signal required to light the Mes-  
sage Waiting lamps on analog telephones with messages waiting. This type of lamping is typically used on  
conventional 2500 type sets with Message Waiting lamps. Check your system’s single line sets to see if  
they require High Voltage Message Waiting. High Voltage Message waiting is not available in DSX-40.  
FSK Message Waiting  
The system can alternately provide an FSK signal to light the Message Waiting lamp on an analog tele-  
phone. Instead of 150 VDC, FSK Message Waiting uses a modulated carrier signal to control lamping.  
This type of Message Wait signaling is typically used on new, electronic single line sets. Check your sys-  
tem’s single line sets to see if they require FSK Message Waiting.  
SLT Special Dial Tone  
Either type of Message Wait lamping can be used with SLT Special Dial Tone. When SLT Special Dial Tone is  
enabled, an SLT user with messages waiting hears a pulsating Intercom dial tone when they lift the handset.  
Intercom dial tone returns to normal only after the SLT user dials *8 to answer all their Messages Waiting.  
Conditions  
• A power failure or system reset cancels all Messages Waiting system wide.  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
238  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Message Waiting  
Programming  
1.  
Should the system have Message Waiting capability?  
- The system can have either Message Waiting or voice mail, not both.  
- 1 for Built-In Automated Attendant  
- 2 for IntraMail  
- 3 for UltraMail (DSX-80/160 only)  
- 4 for external  
2.  
3.  
Should a single line set have special dial tone when a it has a message waiting left?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
Should a single line set have high voltage Message Waiting (DSX-80/160 only)?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
- If both high voltage and FSK Message Waiting are enabled, the system uses FSK.  
4.  
Should a single line set have FSK Message Waiting?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
- If both high voltage and FSK Message Waiting are enabled, the system uses FSK.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
• An extension user cannot leave a Message Waiting at an co-worker that has Call Forwarding Immediate  
(*34) enabled. Pressing V-MAIL automatically leaves a message at the forwarding destination instead.  
• An extension user cannot leave a Message Waiting at a busy co-worker that has Call Forwarding  
Busy/No Answer (*32) enabled. Pressing V-MAIL automatically leaves a message at the forwarding  
destination instead.  
An extension user can leave a Message Waiting at an extension in Do Not Disturb.  
A user can leave a Message Waiting after placing an Intercom call to a busy co-worker.  
A system can have either voice mail or Message Waiting activated — not both.  
An extension user cannot leave a Message Waiting after using Voice Over.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message Waiting  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Message Waiting  
To leave a Message Waiting:  
Place Intercom call to a co-worker.  
• The extension you call can be unanswered, busy, or in Do Not Disturb.  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Press V-MAIL.  
Hang up.  
To answer a Message Waiting:  
1.  
2.  
Look at your V-MAIL key and Ring/Message Lamp - they should be ashing (red).  
Press INTERCOM + V-MAIL.  
• The system cancels the Message Waiting if the extension you call is busy, doesn’t answer, or is Do Not Disturb.  
• If the extension you call doesn’t answer, press V-MAIL to automatically leave them a Message Waiting.  
• If your V-MAIL key and Ring/Message Lamp continue to ash you have additional messages waiting.  
To review your Messages Waiting and select a message for a return call:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Do not lift the handset.  
Press V-MAIL.  
When you see MSG xxx:  
• Press V-MAIL until the extension you want to call displays.  
4.  
5.  
When the extension you want to call displays, lift the handset.  
Press V-MAIL.  
• The system cancels the Message Waiting if the extension you call is busy, doesn’t answer, or is Do Not Disturb.  
• If the extension you call doesn’t answer, press V-MAIL to automatically leave them a Message Waiting.  
240  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Microphone Mute  
Microphone Mute  
Description  
Talk to a co-worker in your ofce without your caller hearing the conversation.  
Microphone Mute lets a keyset user turn off their phone’s handset or Handsfree microphone at any time.  
While the extension is on-hook, Microphone Mute mutes the Handsfree microphone. While off-hook,  
Microphone Mute mutes the handset microphone. Once activated, Microphone Mute prevents the caller  
from hearing conversations in the user’s work area. The user can turn off the Handsfree or handset micro-  
phone while their telephone is idle, busy on a call, in DND or while an outside call is ringing. Answering a  
call automatically cancels Microphone Mute.  
While an extension has their microphone muted, an incoming voice-announced Intercom call announces  
with a single beep (splash tone).  
Handsfree Reply Soft Key  
Display keyset users can press their HF Reply (Hfrp) soft key to turn off their telephone’s Handsfree micro-  
phone for incoming Intercom calls.  
Conditions  
• A system reset or power failure cancels all Microphone Mutes system wide.  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
None  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Use Microphone Mute to temporarily turn off the Handsfree microphone.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Microphone Mute  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Microphone Mute  
To activate or deactivate Microphone Mute:  
Press MUTE.  
You can do this any time while on the phone or idle (except when an Intercom call is ringing).  
1.  
• Microphone Mute automatically cancels when you lift the handset.  
• If you are in the headset mode, Microphone Mute cancels when you press SPEAKER.  
To turn off your telephone’s microphone for incoming Intercom calls:  
[Menu + HF Reply]  
[Menu + MORE + Hfrp]  
Select the Handsfree Reply option.  
• The rst line of the display indicates if Handsfree Reply is on or off:  
HF REPLY ON = Handsfree Reply on.  
1.  
HF REPLY OFF = Handsfree Reply off.  
2.  
Do one of the following.  
[On]  
[On]  
a.  
Select to turn Handsfree Reply on.  
[Off]  
[Off]  
Select to turn Handsfree Reply off.  
• While Handsfree Reply is off, you’ll hear a single beep for incoming voice-  
announced Intercom calls.  
b.  
To answer a voice-announced Intercom call when Handsfree Reply is off:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Lift the handset.  
Press MUTE to turn Handsfree Reply back on (for this call only).  
242  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Monitor / Silent Monitor  
Monitor / Silent Monitor  
Description  
Monitor a co-worker’s phone conversation without them knowing you are on the phone.  
Monitor lets an extension user listen to the conversation at a busy extension. To implement Monitor, an  
extension user just calls a busy extension and dials the Monitor code. The busy extension and their caller  
have no indication of the intrusion. There are no tones heard and there is no visual indication that monitoring  
is occurring. For example, Monitor could help the supervisor of a service department. The department super-  
visor could listen to the questions that callers ask without disturbing the service call.  
CAUTION  
Monitor provides no warning tones prior to intrusion. Monitor may be  
interpreted as an invasion of privacy.  
Conditions  
• Monitor uses a system Conference circuit. See Conference (page 89) for more.  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
1.  
Should an extension be able to Monitor a co-worker’s call?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Since the attendant is never busy, Intercom callers cannot Monitor an attendant.  
An extension user cannot Monitor a Conference.  
Privacy blocks Monitor attempts.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Monitor / Silent Monitor  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Monitor / Silent Monitor  
To Monitor a call:  
Place an Intercom call to the busy extension.  
• Listen for busy or busy/ring tone.  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Dial 6.  
Listen to the conversation in progress.  
244  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Multiple Directory Numbers  
Multiple Directory Numbers  
Description  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Music on Hold  
Music on Hold  
Description  
Callers can listen to music while waiting for their call to go through.  
Music on Hold (MOH) plays music to calls on Hold, parked calls, and transferred calls. The music lets the  
caller know that their call is waiting, not forgotten. Without Music on Hold, the system provides silence to  
these types of calls. Music on Hold is available from one of four sources: two internal beep tones and two  
audio input minijacks (which in turn connect to a customer-provided external music source.  
In DSX-40, the audio input minijacks are located on the equipment cabinet.  
In DSX-80/160, the audio input minijacks are located on the CPU PCB.  
The external music source you connect to the audio input minijacks is typically a CD player or FM  
receiver. The source, which you can also use for Background Music, must be compatible with the follow-  
ing specications:  
Music Source Specications  
Input Impedance  
10K Ohms  
Relative Input Level  
+18 dBr (+/- dBr) at 1.0 kHz  
For more on connecting a customer-provided music source, refer to the system’s Hardware Manual.  
With Music on Hold enabled, transferred callers can optionally listen to ringback or MOH while their call  
waits at the transfer destination.  
Note:  
In accordance with U.S. copyright law, a license may be required from the America Society of Composers,  
Authors and Publishers (ASCAP) or other similar organizations, if radio, television broadcasts or music  
other than material not in the public domain are transmitted through the Music on Hold feature of telecom-  
munications systems. NEC Unied Solutions, Inc. hereby disclaims any liability arising out of the failure to  
obtain such a license.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• External MOH enabled from audio input minijack 1.  
246  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Music on Hold  
Programming  
1.  
Should the system have Music on Hold?  
2.  
Assign the Music on Hold Source to each line.  
- 0 for none  
- 1 for audio input minijack 1  
- 2 for audio input minijack 2  
- 3 for internal tone 1  
- 4 for internal tone 2  
- 5 for IntraMail Message On Hold. See Message On Hold (page 541) for more.  
3.  
For external music sources, is the audio level (BGM volume) correct?  
1. If yes:  
2. If no:  
4.  
Should transferred callers hear MOH or ringback while waiting?  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Background Music and Music on Hold can the same external music source.  
If Music on Hold is enabled for transferred calls, a caller transferred to a busy UCD Group hears MOH.  
If installed, Music on Hold plays to callers on Hold.  
Music on Hold plays to Intercom callers on Hold. Intercom callers always hear internal Tone 1.  
If installed, Music on Hold plays to parked callers.  
With Music on Hold enabled, transferred callers can optionally listen to ringback or MOH while their  
call waits at the transfer destination. Music on Hold will also play to transferred callers camped-on to  
a busy UCD Group.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
247  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Music on Hold  
Operation  
Music on Hold is automatic once enabled.  
248  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Names for Extensions and Lines  
Names for Extensions and Lines  
Description  
Names help identify lines and extensions.  
Extensions and lines can have names instead of just circuit numbers. These names show on a keyset’s dis-  
play when the user places or answers calls. Extension and line names make it easier to identify callers. The  
user does not have to refer to a directory when processing calls. Extension and line names can consist of  
upper and lower case letters, spaces and punctuation, and can be up to 18 characters long.  
Extension names display when placing or answering Intercom calls. Line names display when using the fol-  
lowing features:  
Refer to Feature Operation below when entering names.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No extension names assigned (the extension’s number displays instead).  
• All line names are LINE followed by the line’s number (e.g., LINE 2).  
• User-entered names are available only at the attendant (Class of Service 1).  
Programming  
1.  
Should an extension user be allowed to program their own name?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. If yes:  
- To also allow the extension user to enter names for co-workers, Ring Groups, and UCD Groups, in  
3. If no:  
Name programming is used in the following programs:  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
249  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Names for Extensions and Lines  
Other Related Features  
See list under Description above.  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Programming Names  
To program your extension’s name:  
• If you have access level 4 or 5, use “To program a name for a co-worker’s extension . . .” below instead.  
[Menu + Name]  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Select name programming.  
[Menu + MORE + MORE + Name]  
Follow the instructions in the Name Programming Chart below.  
Press HOLD + SPEAKER to exit.  
To program a name for a co-worker’s extension, a Ring Group, or a UCD Group:  
[Menu + Name]  
[Menu + MORE + MORE + Name]  
1.  
2.  
Select name programming.  
When you see EXT:xxx, do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
c.  
d.  
Enter the name of the extension you want to program + HOLD.  
Press HOLD to accept the displayed name.  
Enter the master number for the Ring Group you want to program + HOLD.  
Enter the master number for the UCD Group you want to program + HOLD.  
3.  
4.  
Follow the instructions in the Name Programming Chart below.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Press HOLD to back up to step 2 and program another name.  
Press HOLD + SPEAKER to exit.  
250  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Names for Extensions and Lines  
Name Programming Chart  
Name Programming Chart  
Press a key the indicated number of times for desired character  
Key  
1 Time  
2 Times  
3 Times  
4 Times  
5 Times  
6 Times  
7 Times  
8 Times  
9 Times  
1
&
-
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
#
*
A
B
E
H
K
N
Q
U
X
:
C
F
I
a
d
g
j
b
e
c
f
2
3
4
5
6
r
D
G
h
k
i
J
M
L
O
R
V
Y
0
l
m
S
t
n
p
u
w
o
q
v
x
P
s
z
7
9
T
8
y
W
Z
space  
Not used  
Not used  
After selecting a letter, press a key for another letter or wait 2 seconds for the cursor to automatically advance.  
Additional Name Programming Options  
HOLD  
Save name.  
SPEAKER  
Volume Up  
Volume Down  
Exit user name programming.  
Scroll the cursor to the right.  
Scroll the cursor to the left.  
While editing, clears character to the right.  
At beginning of line, erases entire entry.  
At end of line, becomes a backspace key  
CLEAR  
CHECK  
Restore the previous entry,  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
251  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Night Service / Night Ring  
Night Service / Night Ring  
Description  
Use Night Service to reroute calls after hours.  
Night Service redirects outside calls to their night mode destination. Typically, the attendant or supervisor  
activates Night Service after normal working hours, when most employees are unavailable to answer calls.  
Lines can ring extensions directly at Night, providing specic answering points for Night Service calls. (For  
example, you can program lines to ring the security station at night.)  
To have outside lines ring the External Paging system (which users can answer by dialing a code), see Out-  
side Call Ringing Over External Page (page 260). To have the ringing call also activate the system relay, see  
Night Service Keys  
The night mode status of the system is controlled by the following 3 types of keys:  
Night Key Assigned as a System Night Key  
This type of key controls the night mode status of all Key Ring lines as well as all lines that are Direct  
Inward Lines (DILs) to Ring Group master numbers. To program this type of key, see 2121-Feature Keys  
Night Key Assigned as a UCD Night Key  
This type of key controls the night mode status of all lines terminated to UCD Group master numbers. It  
has no affect on Key Ring lines or lines terminated to Ring Group master numbers. To program this type  
1
sole Conguration) (page 800). The entry is 18 + UCD Group master number.  
An Extension’s DND Key  
The DND key controls the night mode status of all lines that are DILs to the extension. In the day, the  
line rings the extension. When the user presses DND, the DILs ring their programmed night mode desti-  
nations. Also see Direct Inward Line (page 109).  
Basic Night Service Types  
Following are the four basic types of Night Service operation for a line.  
Option 1: Key Ring Day and Night  
The line is a Key Ring line during the day and at night. The line rings according to the settings in 2132-  
[01-64]: Line Ringing (page 764). An extension’s System night key controls the day/night mode of the  
line. Turn to Key Ring (page 214) for more on setting up Key Ring lines.  
Option 2: Key Ring During the Day, DIL at Night  
The line is a Key Ring line during the day and a DIL at night. During the day, the line rings according to  
the settings in 2132-[01-64]: Line Ringing (page 764). At night, the line rings the DIL destination (i.e.,  
extension, Ring Group, UCD Group or voice mail). An extension’s System night key controls the day/  
night mode of the line. Turn to Key Ring (page 214) for more on setting up Key Ring lines. Turn to  
Option 3: DIL During the Day, Key Ring at Night  
The line is a DIL during the day and a Key Ring line at night. The line rings the DIL destination during the  
day and rings according to the settings in 2132-[01-64]: Line Ringing (page 764) at night. The DIL desti-  
nation’s DND key controls the night mode of the line. Turn to Direct Inward Line (page 109) for more on  
setting up Direct Inward Lines. Turn to Key Ring (page 214) for more on setting up Key Ring lines.  
1. Do not use this option if you want lines to overow to voice mail. See Key Ring (page 214) instead.  
252  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Night Service / Night Ring  
Option 4: DIL Day and Night  
The line is a DIL during the day and at night. The DIL destination’s DND key controls the night mode of the  
Conditions  
• None.  
Default Setting  
• In DSX-40, keys 1-12 are day/night ringing line keys for lines 1-12 and keys 13-24 are undened.  
• In DSX-80/160, keys 1-8 are day/night ringing line keys for lines 1-8 and keys 9-24 are undened.  
• For attendants:  
- Key 12 (on 22-button) or key 24 (on 34-button) is an Operator Call Key.  
Programming  
1.  
Should extension be able to put Key Ring lines into the Night Mode?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
- This capability is normally reserved only for attendants.  
2.  
Set up a System night key on an extension or DSS Console.  
1. To set up a System night key on an extension:  
2. To set up a System night key on a DSS Console:  
3.  
Should key ring lines ring extensions at night?  
1. If yes:  
1 for day and night ringing.  
2 for night ringing only.  
3 for delay ringing day and night.  
- For delay ringing (option 4 only), in 1604-01: Delay Ring Timer (page 678) adjust the Delay Ring  
timer as required.  
2. If no:  
- In 2132-[01-64]: Line Ringing (page 764) enter 0 for lamp only (no ringing).  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
253  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Night Service / Night Ring  
Other Related Features  
Features  
• The extension to which the DIL is terminated controls the night mode of the DIL.  
• If a DIL is terminated to the voice mail master number, a UCD night key (code 18 + the voice mail  
master number) controls the night mode status of the DIL.  
A DSS Console with a System night key can put the system in the night mode.  
A DIL destination activates the night mode for the DIL when they press DND.  
The System night key sets the day/night status of a DIL terminated to a Ring Group.  
To have lines ring the External Paging system, see Outside Call Ringing Over External Page  
(page 260). To have the ringing call also activate the system relay, see Page Relay Control (page 259)  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Night Service / Night Ring  
To activate or deactivate Night Service (i.e., to control the night mode of Key Ring and Ring Group lines):  
1.  
2.  
Do not lift the handset.  
Press your System night key.  
• While in the night mode, the key is on (red) and you see: SYSTEM IN NIGHT MODE.  
• While in the day mode, the key is off.  
To answer a call that rings a line or loop key at night:  
Listen for ringing and look for the ashing line or loop key.  
• Line and loop keys that ash red are for you and your co-workers.  
• Line keys that ash green are just for you (such as DILs and transfers).  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Lift the handset.  
Press the ashing line or loop key.  
• If you have Ringing Line Preference, lifting the handset answers the call.  
• If you have Automatic Handsfree, you can press the line or loop key without rst lifting the handset.  
To answer a call that is ringing over the Paging speakers:  
1.  
2.  
Lift the handset.  
Dial *0.  
254  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Off-Hook Signaling  
Off-Hook Signaling  
Description  
Off-Hook Signaling helps important callers get through.  
When a user is busy on a call, Off-Hook Signaling indicates that another caller is trying to get through.  
Off-Hook Signaling helps important callers get through, without waiting in line for the called extension to  
become free. After the user hears the off-hook signal, they can use other system features (such as Hold or  
Park) to process their active call and then answer the waiting call.  
Off-Hook Signaling for Outside Calls  
While a keyset user is on a call, Off-Hook Signaling for outside calls can be:  
While on a handset call,  
- A ashing green Ring/Message lamp  
- A ashing red or green line/loop key  
- Muted off-hook ringing  
(While Off-Hook Signaling ringing is occurring, use Volume Up and Volume Down to adjust the vol-  
ume of ringing.)  
While on a handset or Handsfree call,  
- A ashing green line/loop key  
- Camp-On tones  
The following chart shows when the two types of Off-Hook Signaling occur. Note that Camp-On tones occur  
for an extension when they are the exclusive recipient of the call (such as a DIL).  
1
2
Off-Hook Ringing  
Camp-On Tones  
Key Ring  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Transferred Outside Call  
Direct Inward Line  
Transfer from Voice Mail (UTRF)  
Call Coverage Key  
Group Call Pickup Key  
1
No  
2
Off-Hook Signaling for Intercom Calls  
While an extension user is on a handset or Handsfree call, they can receive Camp-On tones from a co-worker  
that called them and dialed 2 to Camp-On. Turn to Call Waiting / Camp-On (page 58) for more on how to set  
this up. Off-hook ringing for Intercom calls is not available.  
Off-Hook Signaling for Hotline Calls  
While an extension is busy on a handset call, the system provides unique handling of Off-Hook Signaling for  
calls from their Hotline partner. This unique handling occurs when the Hotline partner calls the extension by  
rst pressing their Hotline key. The Off-Hook Signaling can be Camp-On tones or Voice Over. The default is  
Camp-On tones.  
Conditions  
• None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
255  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Off-Hook Signaling  
Default Setting  
• Off-Hook Signaling for outside calls is set for Off-Hook Ringing (option 2) by default. While busy on  
a call, the extension will receive Off-Hook Ringing for outside calls that normally ring the phone. This  
includes:  
- Key Ring calls  
- Transferred outside calls  
- Direct Inward Lines  
- UTRF transfers from voice mail  
- Call Coverage keys  
- Group Call Pickup keys  
• Off-Hook Signaling for Intercom calls is Camp-On tones.  
• Off-Hook Signaling for Intercom calls from the Hotline partner is Camp-On tones.  
Programming  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Set up Off-Hook Signaling for waiting Intercom calls.  
enter 0.  
Specify the type of Off-Hook Signaling available when a user presses the Hotline key for their  
busy Hotline partner.  
Set up Off-Hook Signaling for waiting outside calls.  
enter 0.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
The Operator Call key does not activate off-hook signaling.  
An extension programmed to receive Camp-On tones or Off-Hook Ringing from a waiting call will  
also receive Second Call Caller ID.  
An extension user can Conference their active call with the waiting call.  
DILs can initiate Off-Hook Signaling beeps.  
Turn to Off-Hook Signaling and Headsets (page 199) for more on how Off-Hook Signaling interacts  
with headsets.  
256  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Off-Hook Signaling  
An extension user can place their current call on Hold and answer the waiting call.  
Hotline activates Off-Hook Signaling.  
Off-Hook Signaling can occur for Key Ring calls.  
An extension user can Park their current call and answer the waiting call.  
An extension user can alternate between their active call and their waiting call.  
An extension user can Transfer their current call to a co-worker or voice mail and then answer the  
waiting call. In addition, transferred calls can initiate Off-Hook Signaling.  
Voice Over also lets a user get through to a keyset extension user busy on a handset call. The busy key-  
set extension user hears an alert tone followed by the voice of the interrupting party.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
User Programmable Feature  
Setting Up Off-Hook Signaling  
Operation  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
Access Level  
#OHR  
(#647)  
Off-Hook Signaling  
#OHR + Select mode (see below) + Select option (see  
below) + SPEAKER to exit.  
3-5  
Off-Hook Signaling Modes  
1 = Outside line  
2 = Hotline partner  
3 = Intercom  
Off-Hook Signaling Options  
For outside lines:  
1 = Camp-On tone  
2 = Off-hook ringing  
CLEAR = None  
For Hotline partner:  
1 = Camp-On tone  
2 = Voice Over  
CLEAR = None  
For Intercom:  
1 = Camp-On tone  
2 = Voice Over  
3 = None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
257  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
One-Touch Keys  
One-Touch Keys  
Description  
Available for Personal Speed Dial. See Speed Dial (page 315) for more.  
258  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Paging  
Paging  
Description  
Use Paging to broadcast announcements or quickly locate co-workers.  
Paging lets extension users broadcast announcements to other keyset users and to external Paging speakers.  
Paging allows a user to locate a co-worker or make an announcement without calling each extension individ-  
ually. There are two types of Paging: Internal Paging and External Paging.  
Internal Paging  
Internal Paging allows extension users to broadcast announcements into 7 internal Paging Zones and All Call  
(all zone). When a user makes a zone page, the announcement broadcasts to all extensions assigned to the  
specied zone. If the user makes an All Call announcement, the announcement simultaneously broadcasts to  
extensions in all zones. All Call Paging automatically overrides any zone pages already in progress. A sys-  
tem timer can optionally limit the duration of Paging announcements.  
To simplify Paging access, a keyset can have Feature Keys assigned as Page keys.  
Paging Key Busy Lamp Indications  
When the key is:  
The zone is:  
Off  
Idle  
On (red)  
A co-worker is Paging into the assigned  
zone  
On (green)  
The extension user is Paging into the  
assigned zone.  
External Paging  
When a user pages into Internal All Call Page or Internal page Zone 1, the system simultaneously broadcasts  
the announcement into the External Paging Zone. In DSX-40, access to the external zone is via the audio  
output minijack located on the equipment cabinet. In DSX-80/160, access to the external zone is via the  
audio output minijack on the CPU. Refer to the system’s Hardware Manual for additional installation  
details.  
When connecting External Paging equipment, be sure to adhere to the following requirements:  
Audio/Paging Output  
Output Impedance  
Output Level  
600 Ohms @ 1 KHz  
0 dBr at 1.0 KHz  
Page Relay Control  
Page Relay Control allows an announcement broadcast into a Paging zone to activate a system relay. This relay  
is typically used to activate a customer-provided Paging amplier. Each of the two Door Box circuits in the  
2PGDAD Module has an associated control relay. In addition, each of the two built-in Door Box ports in the  
DSX-40 has a control relay. In either system, you can assign these relays for Door Box strike control or Page  
Relay Control, but not both. If the system relay is programmed for Page Relay Control, and an extension or  
line is set up to ring over External Paging, the relay will activate when the extension or line rings.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
259  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Paging  
The equipment you connect to a system relay must be compatible with the following specications. Refer to  
your system’s Hardware Manual for more on connecting to the system relay contacts.  
Relay Contact Specications  
DSX-40  
Contact Conguration:  
Normally open  
Maximum Load:  
0.5A @ 120 VAC  
1A @ 24 VDC  
Maximum Initial Contact Resistance  
100 mOhms  
2PGDAD Module  
Contact Conguration:  
Normally open  
Maximum Load:  
500 mA @ 24 VDC  
250 mA @ 120 VAC  
Outside Call Ringing Over External Page  
Line ringing can optionally broadcast over External Paging speakers. For each line, the Paging speakers can  
broadcast ringing for all calls ringing the line, for calls ringing only at night, or for delay ring calls. While a  
line rings External Paging, any extension user can dial a code (INTERCOM + *0) to pick up the call. If the  
system relay is programmed for Page Relay Control, and the line is set up to ring over External Paging,  
the relay will activate when the line rings.  
If Door Box chimes, ringing, and Background Music are all programmed to output over External Paging, the  
system uses the following broadcast priority:  
Paging  
Door Box chimes  
Ringing  
Background Music  
Note that External Paging can broadcast either extension ringing or line ringing, not both. In addition, Exter-  
nal Paging requires additional customer-provided equipment. Refer to the Hardware Manual that came with  
your system for more.  
Intercom Ring Over External Page  
An extension’s ringing can optionally broadcast over External Paging. If enabled, any type of call that rings  
the extension will broadcast over the Paging speakers. While an Intercom call rings External Paging, any  
extension user can dial a code (INTERCOM + *0) to pick up the call. If the system relay is programmed for  
Page Relay Control, and an extension is set up to ring over External Paging, the relay will activate when  
the extension rings.  
Door Chime Over External Page  
Door Box chimes can optionally broadcast over External Paging. While Door Box chimes broadcast over  
External Paging, any extension user can dial a code (INTERCOM + *0) to answer the Door Box. After  
answering, a keyset user can press a soft key or FLASH to control the Door Box relay.  
Background Music Over External Page  
Background Music (BGM) can optionally play over the External Paging speakers while Paging is idle. BGM  
will automatically turn off while Paging, ringing or Door Box chimes broadcast from the external zone, and  
restart when the external zone again becomes idle.  
Ring Over Page Volume Adjustment  
You can adjust the volume of ringing over the External Paging system. There are three volume adjustments: low  
(5), medium (6), and high (4). This adjustment does not affect the volume of Background Music or Door Chimes.  
260  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Paging  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• All Call and Zone Paging allowed.  
• Ringing, Door Box chimes, and Background Music do not broadcast over External Paging.  
Programming  
Basic Programming  
1.  
Should extension be able to receive Paging announcements?  
1. If yes:  
0 for All Call only).  
2. If no:  
2.  
Should extension be able to place (broadcast) Paging announcements?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. If yes:  
- For All Call Paging, 1407-01: Make All Call Page (page 644) enterYes.  
3. If no:  
- For All Call Paging, 1407-01: Make All Call Page (page 644) enter No.  
3.  
4.  
Is the maximum length of Paging announcements adequate?  
Optionally set up a one-touch Paging Feature Key on an extension or DSS Console.  
1. To set up a Paging key on an extension:  
2. To set up a Paging key on a DSS Console:  
Page Relay Control  
1.  
Do you want Paging to activate the associated DSX-40 control relay?  
1. If yes:  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
261  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Paging  
External Paging Options  
1.  
Optionally enable outside line ringing over External Paging.  
- You can have outside line ringing or Intercom ringing, not both.  
- 0 no ringing  
- 1 for day and night ringing  
- 2 for night ringing only  
- 3 for delay ringing day and night  
as required.  
volume as required.  
- 1 for low volume  
- 2 for medium volume  
- 3 for high volume  
Page port audio output.  
2.  
Optionally enable Intercom ringing over External Paging.  
- You can have outside line ringing or Intercom ringing, not both.  
should ring over the External Paging.  
volume as required.  
- 1 for low volume  
- 2 for medium volume  
- 3 for high volume  
Page port audio output.  
3.  
Optionally enable Door Box chimes over External Paging.  
2. In 2101-04: Door Chime Selection (page 722), for each Door Box extension choose one of the following  
chime patterns (not 0):  
- 1 = Low pitch chime pattern  
- 2 = Mid range chime pattern  
- 3 = High pitch chime pattern  
3. Check Door Box (page 147) to be sure Door Boxes are programmed and installed.  
volume as required.  
- 1 for low volume  
- 2 for medium volume  
- 3 for high volume  
262  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Paging  
Page port audio output.  
4.  
Optionally enable Background Music over External Paging.  
volume as required.  
- 1 for low volume  
- 2 for medium volume  
- 3 for high volume  
Page port audio output.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Background Music can broadcast over the External Paging speakers.  
Outside call ringing can broadcast over the External Paging speakers.  
DILs cannot ring over the External Paging speakers or activate the page relay.  
DSS Consoles can have Page zone keys.  
DND blocks Paging announcements.  
Door Box chimes can broadcast over the External Paging speakers.  
Intercom ringing can broadcast over the External Paging speakers.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
263  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Paging  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Making a Page Announcement  
To make an internal Paging announcement:  
1.  
2.  
Lift the handset.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
Press INTERCOM, dial *1, then dial the page zone number (1-7 or 0 for All Call).  
Press your Paging key.  
b
• If you are on an Intercom call when you press a Paging key, the system disconnects the internal  
call and activates the page.  
Make announcement and hang up.  
• The system may limit the length of your announcement.  
3.  
To answer a call that is ringing over the Paging speakers:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Lift the handset.  
Dial *0.  
Converse with the caller.  
User Programmable Feature  
Enabling Incoming Paging  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#VP (#87)  
Operation  
#VP +Y to enable or N to disable + SPEAKER to exit.  
Access Level  
Paging (Incoming)  
3-5  
264  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Paging, Meet-Me Conference  
Paging, Meet-Me Conference  
Description  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
265  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Park  
Park  
Description  
Park a call in orbit so a co-worker can pick it up. With Park, it is not necessary to locate a  
person to handle their calls.  
Park places an outside call in a waiting state (called a Park Orbit) so that an extension user may pick it up.  
There are two types of Park: System and Personal. Use System Park when you want to have the call wait in  
one of 10 system orbits (60-69). Personal Park allows you to Park a call at an extension so a co-worker can  
pick it up. After parking a call, a user can Page the person receiving the call and hang up. The paged party  
dials a code or presses a programmed System Park key to pick up the call. Many calls can be parked at the  
same extension, and are retrieved in LIFO (last-in, rst-out) order.  
A call parked in System Park Orbit for too long will recall the extension that initially parked it. The recall for  
System Park Orbits 68 and 69 is permanently xed at 5 minutes. If the recall remains unanswered, the call  
diverts to Key Ring.  
A call parked in Personal Park Orbit for too long will initially recall to the extension at which it is parked. If  
unanswered there, it recalls to the extension that parked the call. If still unanswered, it diverts to Key Ring.  
When an extension has System Park keys, the keys provide a Busy Lamp Field (BLF) for the orbit assigned  
to the key.  
Park Key Busy Lamp Indications  
When the key is:  
The Park orbit is:  
Off  
Idle  
On (red)  
A co-worker has parked a call in the orbit  
assigned to the key.  
Single wink on (green)  
The extension user has parked a call in the  
orbit assigned to the key.  
Distinctive Flash Rate on Recall  
Park recall features a distinctive ash rate for line keys (see the chart below). This allows the keyset exten-  
sion user to easily differentiate new calls that are ringing from Parked calls that are recalling.  
Distinctive Flash Rate on Park Recall  
For this type of call:  
Call that you Parked  
You see this ash rate:  
Double Wink On (green)  
Double Wink On (green)  
Call that you initially Parked recalling  
your phone  
On (red)  
Call Parked by a co-worker  
Double Wink On (red)  
Call initially Parked by a co-worker  
that is recalling your phone  
266  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Park  
Personal Park Orbit Recall Display  
The Personal Park Orbit recall display shows:  
On all extensions that are ringing with the recall:  
- The type of recall (i.e., Personal Park).  
On the extension at which the call is parked (while it is ringing):  
- The extension which initially parked the call.  
On all other extensions as they are ringing with the recall:  
- The extension at which the call was initially parked.  
The Personal Park Orbit recall display occurs:  
At the extension which initially received the Personal Park.  
At the extension which initially parked the call.  
At all other extensions after the call diverts to Key Ring.  
System Park Orbit Recall Display  
The System Park Orbit recall display shows:  
The orbit from which the call is recalling (e.g., 60).  
The extension that initially parked the call (e.g., 301).  
The System Park Orbit recall display occurs as the call is ringing the extension that initially parked it, and  
after the call diverts to Key Ring.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Park available.  
• No System Park keys assigned.  
Programming  
1.  
If a parked call is not picked up, does it recall after the correct interval?  
- The recall for orbits 68 and 69 is xed at ve minutes.  
2.  
Optionally set up System Park Orbit keys on an extension or DSS Console.  
1. To set up a System Park Orbit key on an extension:  
2. To set up a System Park Orbit key on a DSS Console:  
Other Related Features  
Features  
DSS Consoles can have Park keys.  
Directed Call Pickup also allows an extension user to pick up a call at a co-worker’s extension.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
267  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Park  
Unanswered Park recalls divert to Key Ring.  
If installed, Music on Hold plays to parked callers.  
An extension user can Park their current call and answer the waiting call.  
When an extension user with Ring No Answer/Busy Terminal Hunting to voice mail parks a call at a  
co-worker’s extension, the call recalls to them if not picked up. If still unanswered, the call diverts to  
Key Ring.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Park  
To Park or retrieve a call in System Park Orbit:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
[Park]  
[Park]  
Select Park.  
You cannot use this procedure to retrieve a parked call.  
a.  
(Park only)  
[Sys]  
[Orbit x]  
22-Button and 34-Button Display  
• Select System Park + Dial orbit number (0-9).  
Super Display  
• Select orbit (Orbit 0 - Orbit 9).  
Press TRANSFER and dial *.  
Dial the System Park Orbit (60-69).  
b.  
c.  
Press your Park key.  
Your Park key winks on (green) for calls you Park and is on steady for calls your co-worker’s Park.  
• The line/loop key for the parked call winks on (green) at your extension.  
2.  
If a call in System Park Orbits recalls, you see one of the following.  
If the extension that parked the call doesn’t have a name:  
Park xx Recall  
STA 301  
a.  
If the extension that parked the call has a programmed name:  
Park xx Recall  
300: Attendant  
b.  
To Park or retrieve a call in Personal Park Orbit:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
[Park]  
[Park]  
Select Park.  
You cannot use this procedure to retrieve a parked call.  
a.  
(Park only)  
[Pers]  
[Personal]  
Select Personal Park.  
Dial the number of the extension at which you want to Park or retrieve  
the parked call.  
Press TRANSFER and dial **.  
Dial the number of the extension at which you want to Park the call.  
- The line/loop key for the parked call winks on (green) at your extension.  
b.  
268  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Park  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Park  
2.  
If a call in Personal Park recalls, you see one of the following.  
If the extension that parked the call doesn’t have a name:  
Personal Park Recall  
STA 301  
a.  
If the extension that parked the call has a programmed name:  
Personal Park Recall  
300: Attendant  
b.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
269  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PBX / Centrex Compatibility  
PBX / Centrex Compatibility  
Description  
The DSX provides unique features when connected to a PBX or Centrex.  
PBX/Centrex Access Codes  
PBX Access Codes are the digits PBX extension users must dial to obtain outside lines. When the DSX is  
installed behind a PBX, users must dial these codes before the digits for their outside call. For example, if  
the PBX access code is 98, and the DSX user wants to reach 203-926-5400, they must dial 98-1-203-926-  
5400. Normally, DSX Toll Restriction and Forced Account Codes are applied to the digits dialed after the  
PBX Access Code. This is because any call dialed without the PBX access code is an internal PBX call, and  
usually won’t require the restrictions imposed by Forced Account Codes and Toll Restriction.  
To keep track of valid PBX Access Codes, DSX allows you to enter up to 10 PBX access codes in the PBX  
Access Codes Table. Each code is either 1 or 2 digits long, using the digits 0-9 and #. You can use the * char-  
acter as a wild card, which can be entered in any position in the PBX Access Codes Table. A wild card  
allows the user to dial any digit in that position. For example, the entry 7* represents entries 70, 71, 72, etc.  
In addition to entering codes in the PBX Access Codes Table, you must also indicate in programming which  
DSX lines are PBX lines (i.e., connected to the PBX - not the Central Ofce).  
PBX/Centrex Access Codes and Toll Restriction  
The following occurs if a DSX line is programmed as a PBX line and access codes are properly entered in  
the PBX Access Codes Table (see Programming below):  
If an extension user seizes the line and dials a number without a valid PBX access code, DSX assumes  
the call is an internal PBX call and allows it without restriction.  
If an extension user seizes the line and dials a number preceded by a valid PBX access code, DSX  
enforces Toll Restriction based on the digits following the PBX access code.  
PBX/Centrex Access Codes and Account Codes  
Forced Account Codes for All Calls  
If Forced Account Codes for All Calls is enabled, and Forced Account Codes are enabled for the line, the  
system always requires Account Code entry on PBX lines.  
Forced Account Codes for Toll Calls Only  
If Forced Account Codes for Toll Calls Only is enabled, the line is programmed as a PBX line, access codes  
are properly entered in the PBX Access Codes Table, and Forced Account Codes are enabled for the line:  
If an extension user:  
- Seizes the line.  
- Dials a number without a valid PBX access code.  
DSX assumes the call is an internal PBX call and does not require the user to enter an Account Code for  
the call.  
If an extension user:  
- Seizes the line,  
- Dials a valid PBX Access Code,  
- Dials a number restricted by the Toll Level specied,  
DSX requires the user to enter an Account Code for the call.  
270  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
PBX / Centrex Compatibility  
If an extension user:  
- Seizes the line,  
- Dials a valid PBX Access Code,  
- Dials a number that begins with 0 or 1,  
DSX requires the user to enter an Account Code for the call.  
PBX/Centrex Access Codes and SMDR  
The following occurs if a DSX line is programmed as a PBX line and access codes are properly entered in  
the PBX Access Codes Table:  
If an extension user dials a call that includes a valid PBX Access Code, the entire number dialed is  
printed in the Number Dialed column and OUT is printed in the Type column (indicating that the call is  
an outgoing call).  
If an extension user dials a call that does not include a valid PBX Access Code, the entire number dialed  
is printed in the Number Dialed column and PBX is printed in the Type column (indicating that the calls  
is an internal PBX call).  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No PBX/Centrex Access Codes programmed.  
Programming  
1.  
Specify which lines are PBX lines.  
- A line will only use the PBX Access Codes Table in step 2 if it is programmed as a PBX line.  
2.  
Enter PBX access codes into the PBX Access CodesTable.  
- You can enter up to 10 PBX Access Codes.  
- Each code is either 1 or 2 digits long, using digits 0-9 and #.  
- You can use * as a wild card character that can be entered in any position.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Speed Dial offers unique compatibility with connected Centrex services.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
Operation is automatic when the feature is enabled in programming.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
271  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
PC Program (System Administrator)  
PC Program (System Administrator)  
Description  
Use your PC or laptop to program the system remotely or while on-site.  
The PC Program is a WindowsTM-based application you can use for programming the telephone  
system and maintaining site databases, instead of using the conventional telephone programming.  
The PC Program provides:  
On-Line Programming (Direct Connection)  
With the PC connected to the telephone system’s serial USB, or Ethernet port, you can make  
immediate changes to the telephone system programming. While connected, the PC Program  
also allows you to save your new data to a le on the PC hard disk, or upload a “template”  
database from your PC to the system.  
Remote Programming  
Using an IP or modem connection between your PC and the remote system, you can custom-  
ize a customer’s system without leaving your ofce. Specify what is required for IP and  
modem connections.  
Off-Line Programming  
With Off-Line Programming, the PC Program allows you to set up a database on your PC off  
line, connect to the telephone system, and upload the entire custom conguration.  
Database Save and Restore  
Use the PC Program to save a site’s data to your PC hard disk.You can easily restore the saved  
data later on, if required.  
The PC Program has the following requirements:  
Windows NT, 2000, XP and above.  
P330 with 128 MB RAM.  
256 color 800 x 600 display (1240 x 1024 optimal).  
Do not use large fonts.  
40 mBytes of available hard disk space.  
272  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
PC Program (System Administrator)  
Conditions  
• N/A  
Default Setting  
• N/A  
Programming  
N/A  
Other Related Features  
N/A  
Operation  
Refer to the PC Program User’s Guide.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
273  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Prime Line Preference  
Prime Line Preference  
Description  
Get dial tone for a new outside or Intercom call just by lifting the handset.  
Prime Line Preference allows an extension user to place or answer a call by just lifting the handset. The user  
does not have to press a line key, loop key, or the INTERCOM key rst. This simplies handling calls. In  
programming, you designate a line key, loop key, the INTERCOM key, a line, or a Line Group as the exten-  
sion’s Prime Line. With a line key, loop key, line, or Line Group, the associated line (or lines) becomes your  
Prime Line. With the INTERCOM key, you get Intercom dial tone when you lift the handset. Any number of  
extensions can have the same Prime Line assignment.  
There are two types of Prime Line Preference: Idle Prime Line and Intercom Prime Line.  
Idle Prime Line  
Idle Prime Line lets a user place or answer a Prime Line call by just lifting the handset. An extension’s Idle  
Prime Line can be any line or Line Group, regardless of whether the extension has a line or loop key for the  
line or group.  
Idle Prime Line to any line or Line Group is also available at single line telephones.  
Intercom Prime Line  
With Intercom Prime Line, an idle extension user hears Intercom dial tone whenever they lift the handset or  
press SPEAKER. Intercom Prime Line may help the extension user that most often uses Intercom functions  
or calls co-workers. If an extension’s Busy Lamp Field is disabled (which is the default), the Feature Keys  
do not go into the DSS mode when the user lifts the handset.  
Prime Line vs. Ringing Line Preference  
Ringing Line Preference has priority over Prime Line. For example, an extension with Ringing Line Prefer-  
ence will answer a ringing line, not get dial tone on their Prime Line. In addition, a Ringing Prime Line will  
have priority over any other ringing line. The seize priority is as follows:  
• Ringing Prime Line  
• Ringing non-Prime Line  
• Prime Line  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Intercom Prime Line enabled.  
274  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Prime Line Preference  
Programming  
1.  
Set an extension’s Prime Line type.  
1. For key:  
1-14 for Feature Keys 1-24.  
00 for INTERCOM.  
- This option is not available to single line telephones.  
2. For line:  
- This option is also available to single line telephones.  
3. For Line Group:  
- This option is also available to single line telephones.  
4. To disable Prime Line:  
Other Related Features  
Features  
If an extension’s Prime Line is another extension’s DIL, lifting the handset will answer the call even  
though it does not ring the phone.  
With Intercom Prime Line, an idle extension user hears Intercom dial tone whenever they lift the  
handset or press SPEAKER. Since each extension’s Busy Lamp Field is disabled by default, the Fea-  
ture Keys do not go into the DSS mode when the user lifts the handset.  
Single line telephones can use Prime Line Preference.  
Ringing Line Preference has priority over Prime Line. For example, an extension with Ringing Line  
Preference will answer a ringing line, not get dial tone on their Prime Line.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
275  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Prime Line Preference  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Prime Line Preference  
To place a call on your Prime Line:  
Lift the handset.  
• To bypass your prime line, press another key (such as a line or loop key) before lifting the handset.  
1.  
2.  
Dial call normally.  
User Programmable Feature  
Changing your Prime Line Assignment  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
Operation  
Access Level  
#PLA  
(#752)  
Prime Line Preference  
#PLA + Press one of your ashing programmable keys,  
INTERCOM, or CLEAR for none + SPEAKER to exit.  
3-5  
276  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Privacy  
Privacy  
Description  
Use Privacy to prevent interruptions at high priority extensions.  
An extension with Privacy blocks incoming Barge In attempts and Call Waiting (Camp-On) signals. Privacy  
helps extension users that don’t want their conversations interrupted.  
Note that if an extension with Privacy enabled is on a call with an extension with Privacy disabled, they are  
still subject to Barge In attempts and Call Waiting signals to the non-private extension.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Privacy disabled in an extension’s Class of Service.  
Programming  
1.  
Should an extension have Privacy?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Since the attendant is never busy for Intercom calls, the attendant always has Privacy enabled.  
Privacy blocks Camp-On beeps.  
Privacy blocks Barge In attempts.  
Privacy blocks Monitor attempts.  
Privacy does not block off-hook ringing.  
There is no interaction between Privacy and Privacy Release Groups.  
Privacy does not block Voice Over.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
277  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Privacy Release Groups  
Privacy Release Groups  
Description  
Quickly join in a co-worker’s outside call.  
You can program extensions into Privacy Release Groups to simplify sharing outside calls. Co-workers in  
the same Privacy Release Group can easily join another group member’s outside call just by pressing the  
busy line -key. The co-worker immediately joins in unannounced and uninvited. Privacy Release Groups are  
a quick alternative to Conference where control over the Conference is not required. In a Customer Service  
group, for example, a supervisor could just press a busy line key to monitor any agent’s call.  
If desired, an extension user can prevent other members of their Privacy Release Group from interrupting  
their active call. This ensures that group members will not interrupt condential calls.  
Any number of extensions can be in the same Privacy Release Group. However, an extension can only be in  
a single group. Members of the Group must have line keys and access to the lines they want to share.  
Privacy Release Groups utilizes a Conference circuit. The following table shows the Conference capacities:  
Description  
Capacity  
Conference circuits  
32  
32  
Maximum simultaneous users in Conference  
(total of all Conferences system-wide)  
Maximum simultaneous conferences  
8
8
Maximum parties in any one Conference  
(lines and/or extensions)  
The system’s 32 Conference circuits are dynamically allocated as users request them.  
Privacy Release Guard Timer  
The system provides a guard timer that prevents an extension user from inadvertently placing a Privacy  
Release Conference on Hold. When an extension user with privacy released presses a line key to join a Con-  
ference, the system starts a 3 second guard timer. During this interval, if the initial extension on the call  
presses HOLD, they will drop out of the 3-party call. This prevents an extension user, who is trying to extend  
a call to a co-worker, from inadvertently putting a Privacy Release Conference on Hold by pressing HOLD.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No Privacy Release groups assigned.  
278  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Privacy Release Groups  
Programming  
1.  
Should an extension be in a Privacy Release Group?  
1. If yes:  
- In 2113-04: Privacy Group (page 740), enter the Privacy Release Group number (1-16).  
- Make sure the group members have line keys for the lines they want to share.  
- 0 for no access  
- 1 for incoming access only  
- 2 for outgoing access onl.  
- 3 for full access  
2. If no:  
Other Related Features  
Features  
There is no interaction between Privacy and Privacy Release Groups.  
The following features also allow different types of multiple party calls:  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Privacy Release Groups  
To join an outside call with a member of your Privacy Release group:  
Look for the busy line key.  
• The busy line key is on (green) at your extension; on (orange) at the co-worker that initially placed or  
answered the call.  
1.  
Press the line key.  
Your line key goes on (green) when you join the call.  
You can also press a line key on your DSS Console.  
2.  
To prevent a member of you Privacy Release Group from joining your call:  
Place or answer an outside call on a line key.  
Your line key goes on (orange)  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Press the line key.  
Your line key goes on (green)  
Repeat step 2 to allow or prevent users from joining the call.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
279  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Private Line  
Private Line  
Description  
You can have a line reserved exclusively for your own use.  
A Private Line is a line reserved for a keyset for placing and answering calls. A user with a Private Line  
knows when important calls are for them. Additionally, the user has their own line for placing calls that is  
not available to others in the system.  
There are three types of Private Lines:  
Incoming Only  
The keyset has a Private Line only for incoming calls. The user cannot place a call on the Private Line. A  
customer service representative may want an incoming only Private Line to be sure customers can  
always get through.  
Outgoing Only  
The keyset has a Private Line only for outgoing calls. The Private Line does not ring for incoming calls.  
A service dispatcher may want an outgoing only Private Line so they can always get in touch with eld  
technicians.  
Both Ways  
The keyset has a Private Line for both incoming and outgoing calls. An executive may want a both ways  
Private Line that is available only to them for placing and answering calls.  
You can optionally set up shared Private Lines between a group of co-workers that work closely together.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No Private Lines programmed.  
Programming  
1.  
Should an extension have a non-shared (exclusive) or shared Private Line  
1. For a non-shared (exclusive) Private Line:  
- Make sure that only the Private Line “owner” extension has a line key for the Private Line.  
- In 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763): assign the Private Line “owner” access to the line.  
- 1 for incoming access only  
- 2 for outgoing access only  
- 3 for full access  
- Assign all other extensions no access (0) to the Private Line.  
2. For a shared Private Line:  
- Make sure that all the extensions that should share the Private Line have a line key for that line.  
- In 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763), assign access to all extensions that should share the line.  
- 1 for incoming access only  
- 2 for outgoing access only  
- 3 for full access  
280  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Private Line  
2.  
Should Private Line ring for incoming calls?  
1. If yes:  
- 1 for day and night ringing  
- 2 for night ringing only  
- 3 for delay ringing day and night  
- For delay ringing (option 4 only), in 1604-01: Delay Ring Timer (page 678) adjust the Delay Ring  
timer as required.  
2. If no:  
- In 2132-[01-64]: Line Ringing (page 764) enter 0 (lamp only) for the Private Line.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
The following features work normally for Private Lines.  
The following feature does not apply to Private Lines.  
If you want to be able to forward a private line, consider setting up a Direct Inward Line.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using your Private Line  
To answer an incoming call on your Private Line:  
1.  
2.  
Look for your Private Line key ashing slowly (red).  
Lift the handset.  
To place a call over your Private Line:  
Press your Private Line key.  
• The key will light on (green).  
1.  
2.  
Dial the outside number.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
281  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programmable Idle Menu Soft Keys (Super Display)  
Programmable Idle Menu Soft Keys (Super Display)  
Description  
Customize the Super Display Telephone idle menu soft keys to exactly meet the user’s needs.  
The Super Display Telephone idle menu soft keys are customizable in system programming and by the  
extension user. This allows the idle mode display to be tailored to meet the needs of each Super Display  
Telephone user. The rst chart below shows the default idle menu soft key assignments. The second chart  
shows all the available idle mode soft keys, their denitions, and the related programming codes.  
Super Display Telephone Default Idle Menu Soft Key Assignments  
Key  
Display  
Directory  
Program  
V-Mail --  
Calls --  
Display  
Key  
1
(Blank)  
7
2
3
4
5
6
(Blank)  
(Blank)  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
SP Dial 1  
Page  
SP Dial 2  
(Blank)  
(Blank)  
Super Display Telephone Idle Menu Soft Key Options (Page 1 of 2)  
Entry  
Display  
Description  
00  
UNDEFINED  
The key has no function and the idle menu display is blank.  
Press to access additional soft keys for Intercom, System Speed Dial,  
and Personal Speed Dial Directory Dialing.  
01  
Directory  
02  
03  
Extension  
Personal  
Company  
Program  
Press to directly access Intercom Directory Dialing.  
Press to directly access Personal Speed Dial Directory Dialing.  
04  
05  
Press to directly access System Speed Dial Directory Dialing.  
Press to program the following:  
Call Forwarding  
Call Screening  
Distinctive Ringing  
Handsfree Reply  
Intercom Voice Announce and Forced Intercom Ringing  
Language Selection  
Name Programming  
Speed Dial  
Volume for Ringing, Off-Hook Ringing, and Page  
Press to call your voice mail mailbox. This soft key also shows the  
number of new messages in your mailbox.  
06  
V-Mail  
Press to review your Caller ID log. This soft key also shows the num-  
ber of new calls you have not yet reviewed.  
07  
08  
09  
Calls  
Page  
Press to initiate a Page announcement.  
Press to access Personal Speed Dial bins 701-710. The display shows  
the Speed Dial numbers (or names - if programmed).  
SP Dial 1  
282  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Programmable Idle Menu Soft Keys (Super Display)  
Super Display Telephone Idle Menu Soft Key Options (Page 2 of 2)  
Entry  
Display  
Description  
Press to access Personal Speed Dial bins 711-720. The display shows  
the Speed Dial number (or name - if programmed).  
SP Dial 2  
10  
Press to access the associated Personal Speed Dial bin (701-720). The  
display shows the Speed Dial number (or name - if programmed).  
PERS SPDL BIN 1-  
20  
11-30  
Conditions  
• Idle Menu Soft Keys are only available at Super Display telephones.  
• When an extension’s soft keys are customized, the user must take some action at the telephone (such  
as lifting and replacing the handset) before the change takes effect.  
Default Setting  
• See the Super Display Telephone Default Idle Menu Soft Key Assignments chart on the previous page.  
Programming  
1.  
Customize the Super Display Programmable Idle Menu Soft Keys from system programming.  
soft keys as required.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
A Super Display Telephone user can assign their own idle menu soft keys. Also see Feature Operation  
on the next page.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
283  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programmable Idle Menu Soft Keys (Super Display)  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
Customizing your Idle Menu Soft keys (Super Display Only)  
To customize your idle menu soft keys:  
1.  
2.  
Do not press any keys and do not lift the handset.  
Dial #SM (#76).  
You see KEY NUMBER?1.  
3.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
Press the soft key you want to program.  
b.  
Press Volume Up or Volume Down to scroll through the keys.  
4.  
5.  
Press HOLD.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Enter the key option code from the Super Display Telephone Idle Menu Softy Key Options chart.  
Press INTERCOM.  
Press Volume Up or Volume Down to select the key option.  
6.  
7.  
Press HOLD.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Select another key to program.  
Press SPEAKER to exit.  
User Programmable Feature  
Customizing your Idle Menu Soft Keys  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#SM (#76)  
Operation  
Access Level  
Programmable Idle Menu  
Soft Keys (Super Display)  
#SM + Press the soft key you want to program (or press  
Volume Up orVolume Down to scroll through the keys) +  
1-5  
HOLD  
select key option + HOLD  
+
INTERCOM  
+
Volume Up or Volume Down to  
SPEAKER to exit.  
+
284  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Pulse to Tone Conversion  
Pulse to Tone Conversion  
Description  
Use special services (such as telephone banking) over dial pulse lines.  
An extension can use Pulse to Tone Conversion while placing an outside call to change the dialing mode  
from dial pulse to DTMF. For a system in a dial pulse area, this permits users to access DTMF services (such  
as telephone banking) from their DP area. Pulse to tone conversion also helps dial pulse callers use another  
company’s automated attendant dialing options. The user can, for example:  
Place a call to their bank over a DP line.  
After the banking service answers, wait 6 seconds. (The system automatically converts dialing to DTMF.)  
Dial additional banking options.  
cics on setting up your outside calling.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Pulse to Tone Conversion always enabled for dial pulse lines.  
Programming  
1.  
Set up your dial pulse lines.  
0.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
The system does not provide Pulse to Tone Conversion for SLTs. The conversion must be switched  
manually from the telephone.  
If a Speed Dial number using a dial pulse line contains a pause, the digits following the pause auto-  
matically dial out as DTMF.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Converting Dialing from DP to DTMF  
To convert your telephone’s dialing to DTMF after placing your call on a DP line:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Dial the initial digits for the call.  
Wait six seconds.  
Dial additional digits.  
• The additional digits dial out as DTMF.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
285  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Regional Defaults  
Regional Defaults  
Description  
The system is compatible with both North American and Latin American applications.  
Use the Regional Defaults capability to switch your system from the North American mode to the Latin  
American mode. Switching your system to the Latin American mode makes the following changes:  
The default language in programming, SMDR, and all telephone displays is Spanish. See the following  
for more:  
The Latin American Toll Restriction options are enabled. This is set up when you initialize each Toll  
Restriction Table. For more, see:  
Only use these options if your system is installed in Latin America.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• System is enabled for North American installations.  
Programming  
See Description above.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Optionally switch all telephone displays to Spanish.  
Optionally enable the Spanish SMDR header and Call Type data.  
Optionally initialize each Toll Restriction Table for Latin American. Latin American Toll Restriction  
is not included in this manual.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
None  
286  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Removing Lines and Extensions from Service  
Removing Lines and Extensions from Service  
Description  
Temporarily remove problem extensions and lines from service until they can be repaired.  
Supervisors and attendants can remove problem lines and extensions from service. This helps ensure maxi-  
mum system performance. For example, the attendant can busy-out a noisy line or problem extension until  
service personnel can repair the problem. The line or extension the appears busy to all callers. Following  
repair, the attendant or supervisor can return the line to service.  
The extension or line removed from service shows as busy on the appropriate key (e.g., line key or Hotline key).  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled for the attendant (COS 1).  
• Disabled at all other extensions (COS 2-15).  
Programming  
Enable Direct Line Access for all extensions that should be able remove lines and extensions  
from service.  
1.  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Normally, system attendants should have the ability to remove lines and extensions from service.  
If Call Forwarding is enabled at an extension when it is removed from service, it is reinstated when the  
extension is returned to service.  
An extension user with Direct Line Access can remove lines from service.  
Removing and returning an extension to service does not cancel an extension’s Selectable Display  
Messaging.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
287  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Removing Lines and Extensions from Service  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Removing Lines and Extensions from Service  
To remove or return an extension or line to service:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Press INTERCOM.  
Dial #40.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Dial the number of the extension you want to remove or return to service (e.g., 302).  
Dial the extension number of the line you want to remove from service (e.g., 101 for line 1).  
4.  
5.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
Dial 4 to return the line or extension to service.  
Dial 6 to remove the line or extension from service.  
b.  
• At the extension removed from service, you see Out of Service.  
• The line key for a line removed from service will be on (red).  
Press SPEAKER to hang up.  
288  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reverse Voice Over  
Reverse Voice Over  
Description  
Privately call a co-worker while you’re busy on your handset.  
While on a handset call, Reverse Voice Over lets a busy keyset user make a private Intercom call to an idle  
co-worker. The busy user just presses and holds down a programmed Reverse Voice Over key to make a pri-  
vate call to the assigned co-worker. The initial caller cannot hear the Reverse Voice Over conversation. The  
private Intercom call continues until the Reverse Voice Over caller releases the key again. The initial handset  
call can be an outside call or an Intercom call. An extension can have Reverse Voice Over keys for more than  
one co-worker.  
Reverse Voice Over could help a salesperson, for example, when placing a call to an important client. The  
salesperson can talk with the client and give special instructions to an assistant — without interrupting the  
initial call.  
When the keyset is idle, the Reverse Voice Over key functions the same as a Hotline key. The key also shows  
at a glance the status of the associated extension:  
Reverse Voice Over Busy Lamp Indications  
When the key is:  
The covered extension is:  
Off  
On  
Idle or not installed  
Busy or ringing  
Medium Flash  
Assigned extension is in DND for outside  
calls (option 1)  
Fast Flash  
Assigned extension is in DND for Intercom  
calls (option 2) or All Calls (option 3)  
Reverse Voice Over uses a system Conference circuit while it is active. The following table shows the sys-  
tem’s Conference capacities:  
Description  
Capacity  
Conference circuits  
32  
32  
Maximum simultaneous users in Conference  
(total of all Conferences system-wide)  
Maximum simultaneous conferences  
8
8
Maximum parties in any one Conference  
(lines and/or extensions)  
The system’s 32 Conference circuits are dynamically allocated as users request them.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No Reverse Voice Over keys assigned.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
289  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Reverse Voice Over  
Programming  
1.  
To set up Reverse Voice Over keys on an extension:  
2. In 2121-[01 to 24]: Feature Key Data (page 758), enter the Reverse Voice Over partner’s extension number.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
An extension user cannot add an incoming Reverse Voice Over call to a Conference.  
A DSS Console can not have a Reverse Voice Over key.  
DND does not block Reverse Voice Over.  
An extension cannot put an incoming Reverse Voice Over call on Hold.  
While idle, an extension user can use their Reverse Voice Over key to Transfer calls.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
290  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reverse Voice Over  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Reverse Voice Over  
To place a call using Reverse Voice Over:  
While on a handset call, press and hold your Reverse Voice Over key.  
You hear two beeps, then you can talk to your co-worker.  
• The key lights red as you press it.  
1.  
To return to your initial caller:  
Release your Reverse Voice Over key.  
• The key goes out.  
1.  
To place a call to your Reverse Voice Over partner:  
While your telephone is idle, press your Reverse Voice Over key.  
You hear two beeps, then you can talk to your co-worker. (Optionally lift handset for privacy.)  
• The key lights green.  
1.  
To Transfer a call using your Reverse Voice Over key:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
While on a call, press TRANSFER.  
Press your Reverse Voice Over key.  
Do one of the following.  
Announce the call to make a Screened Transfer.  
Hang up.  
a.  
b.  
Press the ashing line key to return to the call if your co-worker doesn’t want it.  
Hang up to send the call through unscreened.  
• The call will recall to you if unanswered at the destination. If you don’t answer the recall, it  
diverts to Key Ring.  
c.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
291  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ring Groups  
Ring Groups  
Description  
292  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ringdown Extension  
Ringdown Extension  
Description  
Call another extension, group or voice mail just by lifting the handset.  
A Ringdown Extension automatically calls a co-worker, voice mail, a Ring Group, a UCD Group, or a Speed  
Dial number when the user lifts the handset. The call automatically goes through — there is no need for the  
user to dial digits or press additional keys. Ringdown extensions are frequently used for lobby phones, where  
the caller just lifts the handset to get the information desk.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Ringdown disabled.  
Programming  
1.  
Optionally set an extension’s Ringdown destination.  
1. In 2114-02: Station Ring Down Type (page 743), set the extension’s Ringdown type.  
- 0 for none  
- 1 for extension  
- 2 for Personal Speed Dial  
- 3 for System Speed Dial  
2. In 2114-02: Station Ring Down Destination (page 743), enter the Ringdown destination. The choices are:  
- Telephone extension number (not a line’s extension number).  
- Voice mail, UCD Group, or Ring Group master number.  
- System or Personal Speed Dial number.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Ringdown Extension follows the voice-announce status of destination extension. For example, if an  
extension usually voice-announces Intercom calls, a ringdown to that extension will also voice-announce.  
Ringing Line Preference has precedence over Ringdown Extension. If Ringing Line Preference is ringing  
the phone, lifting the handset answers the call. Lifting the handset does not call the Ringdown destination.  
If the Ringdown destination is the voice mail master number, the Ringdown Extension user hears the  
voice mail remote logon prompt (“Please enter your mailbox number”) after the call connects.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
293  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ringdown Extension  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Ringdown  
To use the Ringdown extension:  
1.  
Lift the handset or press SPEAKER.  
To bypass Ringdown:  
1.  
Press INTERCOM, a line/loop key, or a Feature Key before lifting the handset or pressing SPEAKER.  
294  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ringing Line Preference  
Ringing Line Preference  
Description  
Simply lift the handset to answer a ringing call.  
Ringing Line Preference lets a keyset user answer a ringing call by just lifting the handset. For a user that  
primarily answers calls, Ringing Line Preference ensures that ringing calls have priority. The tables below  
show the interaction between Ringing Line Preference and other features for both handset and headset calls.  
Keyset  
RLP =Y RLP = N  
Does lifting the handset answer the ringing call?  
Attendant  
RLP =Y RLP = N  
Feature  
Ringing Intercom calls  
No1  
Yes  
No1  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
(Line/Loop Keys)  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
N/A  
No  
No  
N/A  
(Call to UCD master)  
No1  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
1Ringing Line Preference will not answer a call ringing the Operator Call Key.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
295  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ringing Line Preference  
Keyset  
RLP =Y RLP = N  
Attendant  
RLP =Y RLP = N  
Feature  
Does pressing SPEAKER while in the Headset mode  
answer the ringing call?  
Ringing Intercom calls  
No1  
Yes  
No1  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
(Line/Loop Keys)  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
N/A  
No  
No  
N/A  
(Call to UCD master)  
No1  
No1  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
1Ringing Line Preference will not answer a call ringing the Operator Call Key.  
When multiple calls ring an extension simultaneously, the system services the ringing calls in the follow-  
ing order:  
1. INTERCOM Key  
2. Line Key (from lowest to highest)  
3. Loop Key (from lowest to highest)  
In addition, if two extensions with Ringing Line Preference answer the same outside call simultaneously, the  
system connects the call to the lowest numbered extension.  
Prime Line vs. Ringing Line Preference  
Ringing Line Preference has priority over Prime Line. For example, an extension with Ringing Line Prefer-  
ence will answer a ringing line, not get dial tone on their Prime Line. In addition, a ringing Prime Line will  
have priority over any other ringing line. The seize priority is as follows:  
Ringing Prime Line  
Ringing non-Prime Line  
Prime Line  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
1.  
To enable Ringing Line Preference for the extension:  
296  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ringing Line Preference  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Ringing Line Preference will not answer a call ringing the Operator Call Key.  
Ringing Line Preference answers a ringing Intercom call before a ringing outside call.  
Prime Line Preference overrides Ringing Line Preference. For example, if you lift the handset while a  
call is ringing your phone, you seize your Prime Line instead of answering the ringing call.  
Ringing Line Preference has precedence over Ringdown Extension. If Ringing Line Preference is ringing  
the phone, lifting the handset answers the call. Lifting the handset does not call the Ringdown destination.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Ringing Line Preference  
To use Ringing Line Preference:  
Lift the handset or press SPEAKER.  
You automatically answer the call.  
1.  
To bypass Ringing Line Preference:  
Before lifting the handset or pressing SPEAKER, press one of the following instead:  
1.  
INTERCOM  
• Line or loop key  
• Feature Key  
User Programmable Feature  
Using Ringing Line Preference  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
Operation  
#RLP +Y to enable or N to disable + SPEAKER to exit.  
Access Level  
#RLP  
(#757)  
Ringing Line Preference  
2-5  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
297  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Save Number Dialed  
Save Number Dialed  
Description  
Save the number you just dialed for quick redialing.  
Save Number Dialed permits an extension user to save their last outside number and easily redial it later on.  
For example, an extension user can recall a busy or unanswered number without manually dialing the digits.  
The system retains the saved number until the user stores a new one in its place.  
Save Number Dialed saves in system memory a dialed number up to 20 digits. The system remembers the  
digits regardless of whether the call was answered, unanswered or busy. The system normally uses the same  
line as for the initial call. However, if that line is busy and is part of a Line Group, Save Number Dialed will  
automatically select the next line in the group.  
Save Number Dialed requires a uniquely programmed Feature Key on the extension or DSS Console.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No Save keys programmed.  
Programming  
1.  
To set up a Save key on an extension:  
2.  
To set up Save key on a DSS Console:  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Last Number Redial and Save do not store Account Codes. This means that the user must manually  
enter an Account Code to have it included with a call dialed using Last Number Redial and Save.  
Save an outside number, then easily redial it later on.  
A DSS Console can have a Save key.  
Last Number Redial also simplies dialing important numbers.  
If an extension user presses their Save key and hears busy, they can dial 2 to wait in line for the line to  
become available. The system will automatically redial the call. However, if the user hangs up to con-  
vert the queue to a Line Callback, the system will not redial the saved call once the line connects.  
Save Number Dialed is not available to SLTs.  
Save Number Dialed will not store a number denied by Toll Restriction.  
298  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Save Number Dialed  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Save Number Dialed  
To save the outside number you just dialed (up to 32 digits):  
1.  
Press the Save Number Dialed key on your extension or DSS Console.  
To redial a saved number:  
1.  
2.  
(Optional) Press a line key to preselect a line key for the call.  
Press the Save Number Dialed key on your extension or DSS Console.  
• If you hear busy, you may be able to dial 2 and wait in line for the line to become free.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
299  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selectable Display Messaging  
Selectable Display Messaging  
Description  
While you’re away from the phone, callers can receive personalized text messages you set up.  
An extension user can select a pre programmed Selectable Display Message for their extension. Keyset call-  
ers see the selected message when they call the user’s extension. Selectable Display Messaging provides per-  
sonalized text messaging. For example, an extension user could select the message “GONE FOR THE  
DAY.” Any keyset user calling the extension would see the message. Other than displaying the message, the  
system puts the call though normally.  
The are 16 Selectable Display Messages (01-16) set up in system programming. Messages 01-09 are preset  
by default, but can be changed to meet the site requirements. Messages 10-16 are initially undened. Any  
message can be appended by the extension user. For example, a user could select message 09 (OUT UNTIL)  
and append the time they are expected back (e.g., 5:00). The total length of the message plus any user  
appended entries cannot exceed 18. Selectable Display Messages cannot begin with numbers.  
Following are the 16 default Selectable Display Messages.  
Option  
Default  
Message 01  
Message 02  
Message 03  
Message 04  
Message 05  
Message 06  
Message 07  
Message 08  
Message 09  
Message 10  
Message 11  
Message 12  
Message 13  
Message 14  
Message 15  
Message 16  
CALL (plus 15 user entries)  
BACK BY (plus 12 user entries)  
MEETING IN ROOM (plus 4 user entries)  
OUT TO LUNCH (plus 7 user entries)  
GONE FOR THE DAY (plus 3 user entries)  
ON VACATION (plus 8 user entries)  
ON BUSINESS TRIP (plus 3 user entries)  
IN A MEETING (plus 7 user entries)  
OUT UNTIL (plus 10 user entries)  
Undened (up to 20 characters)  
Undened (up to 20 characters)  
Undened (up to 20 characters)  
Undened (up to 20 characters)  
Undened (up to 20 characters)  
Undened (up to 20 characters)  
Undened (up to 20 characters)  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• See the table above.  
300  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Selectable Display Messaging  
Programming  
1.  
Should extension be able to enable Selectable Display Messaging?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
- Disabling this option will disable all internal Call Forwarding for the extension.  
2.  
To change the default Selectable Display Messages or create new ones:  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Enabling or canceling Call Forwarding cancels an extension’s Selectable Display Messaging.  
Removing and returning an extension to service does not cancel an extension’s Selectable Display  
Messaging.  
SLTs cannot use Selectable Display Messaging.  
Personal Speed Dial keys can store the codes that enable Selectable Display Messaging.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
301  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selectable Display Messaging  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Setting Up Selectable Display Messaging  
To select a Selectable Display Message:  
Select the Call Forwarding options.  
1.  
[Menu + Call Forward]  
[Menu + Cfwd]  
Alternately do one of the following:  
• Press INTERCOM and dial *3.  
• Press your Call Forwarding Feature Key.  
Select Selectable Display Messaging.  
2.  
[None]  
[MORE + MORE + None]  
Select to cancel Call Forwarding and Selectable Display Messaging.  
• Alternately dial 0.  
[Message]  
[MORE + Msg]  
Select to set up Selectable Display Messaging.  
• Alternately dial 8.  
Do one of the following.  
3.  
a.  
b.  
Dial the message number (01-16).  
Press Volume Up or Volume Down to scroll through the message numbers.  
4.  
5.  
Press HOLD. The selected message displays.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Press Volume Up or Volume Down to scroll through the available messages.  
Press HOLD to program or append the message text.  
Enter any additional digits.  
6.  
7.  
• The total of all digits and characters cannot exceed 20.  
• See the Name Programming Chart on the next page when entering additional data.  
You cannot add additional digits to a blank (unprogrammed) message.  
Press HOLD.  
302  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selectable Display Messaging  
Name Programming Chart  
Name Programming Chart  
Press a key the indicated number of times for desired character  
Key  
1 Time  
2 Times  
3 Times  
4 Times  
5 Times  
6 Times  
7 Times  
8 Times  
9 Times  
1
&
-
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
#
*
A
B
E
H
K
N
Q
U
X
:
C
F
I
a
d
g
j
b
e
c
f
2
3
4
5
6
r
D
G
h
k
i
J
M
L
O
R
V
Y
0
l
m
S
t
n
p
u
w
o
q
v
x
P
s
z
7
9
T
8
y
W
Z
space  
Not used  
Not used  
After selecting a letter, press a key for another letter or wait 2 seconds for the cursor to automatically advance.  
Additional Name Programming Options  
HOLD  
Save name.  
SPEAKER  
Volume Up  
Volume Down  
Exit user name programming.  
Scroll the cursor to the right.  
Scroll the cursor to the left.  
While editing, clears character to the right.  
At beginning of line, erases entire entry.  
At end of line, becomes a backspace key  
CLEAR  
CHECK  
Restore the previous entry,  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
303  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Silent Monitor  
Silent Monitor  
Description  
304  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Single Line Telephones  
Single Line Telephones  
Description  
Connect analog devices such as single line telephones and fax machines to the system.  
The system is compatible with 500 type (dial pulse) and 2500 type (DTMF) analog telephone devices. This  
includes on-premises single line telephones (SLTs), fax machines, and modems.  
In DSX-40, SLTs connect to analog ports in the main equipment cabinet. In DSX-80/160, SLTs connect to  
SLIU PCBs. Each analog port provides power and ring voltage for the connected SLT. The analog ports use  
DTMF receivers. Each system provides 10 DTMF receivers that are shared by all connected analog ports.  
Message Waiting  
Both DSX-40 and DSX-80/160 support FSK Message Waiting lamps. DSX-80/160 also provides support for  
high voltage Message Waiting lamps – while DSX-40 does not.  
Ringing For Incoming Calls  
Single line extensions ring according to the settings in 2132-[01-64]: Line Ringing (page 764). It is not  
necessary to assign single line sets to Ring Groups to make them ring for incoming calls; they follow Key  
Ring instead.  
In DSX-80/160 by default, the rst 16 extensions (300-315) ring (option 2) for lines 1-12 and ash  
(option 1) for lines 13-64. All other extensions have lamp only (no ringing) for all lines.  
In DSX-40 by default, all extensions (including single line sets) have immediate ring for all lines.  
Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) Considerations  
DSX-40  
Single line telephones assigned to Key Ring or the same Ring Group will ring simultaneously. This is also  
true for single line telephones connected to the same port. Since the Ringer Equivalence Numbers of con-  
nected single line telephones are cumulative, you must do the following:  
Add up the RENs of all connected single line telephones.  
Be sure the total REN does not exceed 4 on any single port or system-wide.  
Note that a REN of 1 is normal for an industry standard 2500 set with electromechanical ringer. Many  
phones with electronic ringers have signicantly lower RENs. Check the label on the bottom of each single  
line telephone for the REN value.  
DSX-80/160  
Single line telephones assigned to Key Ring or the same Ring Group ring in pairs according to their SLIU PCB  
port assignment. For example, ports 1 and 2 ring together, followed by 3 and 4, 5 and 6, and nally 7 and 8. If  
the system has more than one SLIU PCB installed, the respective port pairs ring simultaneously on each card  
(e.g., ports 1 and 2 ring simultaneously on each PCB). The SLIU provides the capability to support this ringing  
arrangement, and REN calculations are not required. In DSX-80/160, there is not a REN limitation.  
Conditions  
• Dial Pulse (500 type) single line telephones cannot access any features that require the user to dial # or *.  
• The system provides a pool of 10 DTMF receivers that are dynamically allocated as required.  
Default Setting  
• See Description above.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
305  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Single Line Telephones  
Programming  
1.  
Should the SLT extension follow the ringing pattern of the incoming line?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2.  
Does the SLT extension (such as an answering machine) require a loop disconnect signal?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
- 0403-Drop Pulse Send and 0403-DTMF Detect don’t exist in DSX. They were listed in DS but  
didn’t do anything/  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Background Music is not available to single line telephones.  
Single line telephones can use Conference.  
Single line telephones cannot use DND.  
The Class of Service option 1403-01: Flash for Single Line Set (page 635) allows you to enable or dis-  
able hookash for analog single line extensions.  
Single line telephones do not have Handsfree and Handsfree Answerback capability.  
Single line telephones do not have headset capability.  
All Intercom calls to single line telephones ring.  
Last Number Redial is not available at single line telephones.  
Single line telephones can make Paging announcements, but cannot receive Paging announcements.  
Single line telephones can use Prime Line Preference.  
Save Number Dialed is not available to single line telephones.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
306  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Single Line Telephones  
Operation  
Barge In  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Call busy extension.  
Dial the line extension number (e.g., 101) for Direct Line Access.  
Dial #9 + Line number for Line Dial-up.  
c.  
d.  
Dial 9 for Line Group Access.  
2.  
3.  
Dial 4.  
Join the conversation in progress.  
Call Forwarding  
1.  
2.  
Lift the handset and dial *3.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
c.  
d.  
Dial 0 for Cancel your extension’s Call Forwarding.  
Dial 2 for Call Forwarding Busy/No Answer.  
Dial 4 for Call Forwarding Immediate.  
Dial 6 for Call Forwarding No Answer.  
3.  
4.  
Dial destination extension, 0 for your operator, or voice mail master number.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Dial 2 to forward all calls.  
Dial 8 to forward just outside calls.  
5.  
Hang up.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
307  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Single Line Telephones  
Call Waiting / Camp-On  
1.  
2.  
Call busy extension.  
Dial 2 but do not hang up.  
• If you hang up, the system converts your Camp-On to a Callback.  
3.  
Speak to your co-worker when they answer their Camp-On ring.  
Callback  
1.  
2.  
Call busy extension.  
Dial 2 and hang up.  
• Stay on the line without hanging up if you want to Camp-On instead.  
3.  
4.  
When Callback rings your phone, lift handset to answer.  
Speak to your co-worker when call goes through.  
Central Ofce Calls, Answering  
1.  
When your telephone rings, lift the handset.  
Central Ofce Calls, Placing  
Lift the handset.  
1.  
2.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
c.  
For Line Dial-Up:  
i.  
Dial #9 followed by the line number (e.g., #901 for line 1).  
For Direct Line Access:  
i.  
Dial 1 followed by the line number (e.g., 101 for line 1).  
For Line Group Access:  
i.  
Dial the Line Group code (9 or 90-98).  
3.  
Dial the outside number.  
Conference  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Establish Intercom or outside call.  
Hookash and dial the extension or line you want to add/  
Hookash and dial #10 to set up the Conference.  
• If you cannot add additional parties to your Conference, you have exceeded the system’s Conference limit.  
4.  
Repeat steps 2 and 3 to add additional parties to your Conference.  
Direct Line Access  
1.  
Dial 1 plus the line number (e.g., 101 for line 1).  
308  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Single Line Telephones  
Direct Line Access  
Directed Call Pickup  
2.  
Dial outside number.  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Lift the handset.  
Dial **.  
Dial number of extension whose call you want to intercept.  
• To intercept a call ringing an attendant, dial the attendant’s extension number (e.g., 300); not 0 or 01-04.  
Door Box  
To place a call to the Door Box:  
1.  
2.  
Lift the handset.  
Dial the Door Box extension number.  
To answer the Door Box ringing:  
Lift the handset.  
• Door Box chimes are not available at single line telephones.  
1.  
To control the relay which in turn controls the Door Box strike:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Place or answer the Door Box call.  
To open the relay, hookash.  
To close the relay, hookash.  
Flash  
1.  
2.  
Place or answer an outside call.  
Hooash and dial #3.  
• When you hear CO/PBX/Centrex dial tone, dial a new call or use other features provided externally by the  
connected service.  
Forced Line Disconnect  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Lift the handset.  
Dial the line’s Direct Line Access code (e.g., 101 for line 1).  
Dial # to disconnect the line.  
You hear Intercom dial tone. To place a call on the line, dial a line access code and then dial the number.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
309  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Single Line Telephones  
Group Call Pickup  
1.  
2.  
Lift the handset.  
Dial *#.  
Hold  
To retrieve a line on System Hold at a co-worker’s extension:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Lift the handset.  
Dial *4.  
Dial the number of the line that is on Hold (e.g., 01 for line 1).  
To place a call on Exclusive Hold:  
1.  
2.  
Hookash and dial *7.  
Hang up.  
• If the call is left on Exclusive Hold too long, it will recall to you.  
• If you hang up without rst dialing *7, the call will recall immediately.  
• If you previously placed a call on Exclusive Hold or have a camped-on call waiting, dialing *7 will answer the  
waiting call. See Split for more.  
To retrieve a call from Exclusive Hold:  
1.  
Hookash and dial *7.  
Intercom  
To place an Intercom call:  
1.  
2.  
Lift the handset.  
Dial the extension number.  
• To call the operator, dial the operator s extension number or dial 0 or 01-04 (depending on how your system is  
set up).  
• If your call voice-announces the destination, you can dial 1 to force the call to ring.  
To answer an Intercom call:  
1.  
Lift the handset.  
Meet-Me Conference  
To set up a Meet-Me Conference:  
Page the parties and announce the Meet-Me Conference code (#11 or #12).  
• See Paging (page 259) for more on how to page your co-workers.  
1.  
2.  
Hang up, then lift the handset.  
310  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Single Line Telephones  
Meet-Me Conference  
Dial the announced Meet-Me Conference code (#11 or #12).  
Your co-worker’s must join the telephone meeting within the Meet Me Conference time.  
3.  
To join a Meet-Me Conference:  
1.  
2.  
Listen for paged invitation to join the Conference.  
Dial announced Meet-Me Conference code (#11 or #12).  
You can join the telephone meeting within the Meet Me Conference time.  
Message Waiting  
To leave a message for a co-worker:  
Place Intercom call to co-worker.  
• The extension you call can be unanswered, busy, or in Do Not Disturb.  
1.  
2.  
Dial 8 and hang up.  
V-MAIL ashes fast at the extension you called.  
To answer a Message Waiting:  
1.  
2,  
Lift the handset.  
Dial *8.  
Night Service / Night Ring  
To answer a call ringing over the paging system:  
1.  
2.  
Lift the handset.  
Dial *0.  
Paging  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Lift the handset.  
Dial *1.  
Dial the Paging zone (1-7 or 0 for all call).  
• SLTs cannot receive Paging announcements.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
311  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Single Line Telephones  
Park  
To Park a call:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Place or answer call.  
Hookash and dial *.  
Dial the orbit number.  
• System Park Orbits are 60-69.  
• Personal Park Orbits are *300-*427.  
To retrieve a parked call:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Lift the handset.  
Dial *.  
Dial the orbit number.  
• System Park Orbits are 60-69.  
• Personal Park Orbits are *300-*427.  
Pulse to Tone Conversion  
This feature must be switched manually from the telephone. The system does not provide Pulse to Tone Conversion for SLTs.  
Removing Lines and Extensions from Service  
1.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
Lift the handset.  
Dial #40.  
Dial the line (101-164) or extension (300-427) you want to remove from service.  
So one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Dial 4 to return a line or extension to service.  
Dial 6 to remove a line or extension from service.  
5.  
Hang up.  
Speed Dial  
To dial a Speed Dial number:  
1.  
2.  
Lift the handset.  
Dial # and the Speed Dial bin number.  
• Personal Speed Dial bins are 701-720.  
• System Speed Dial bins are normally 201-299.  
3.  
The stored number dials out.  
312  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Single Line Telephones  
Split  
A single line telephone can Split (alternate) between their current call and waiting calls. The waiting calls can include a call  
you previously placed on Exclusive Hold or camped-on calls.  
To Split (Alternate) between your current call and a waiting call:  
Hookash and dial *7.  
1.  
You are connected to your camped-on call (if any) or the call that has been on Hold the longest.  
• Repeat this procedure to cycle through all your waiting calls (from oldest to newest) and return to your rst call.  
Tandem Calls / Unsupervised Conference  
Establish outside call (e.g., lift handset, dial 9, and dial outside number)  
Hookash and dial another outside call.  
1.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
Hookash and dial #10 to set up the Conference.  
Hang up.  
• If the outside parties disconnect, the lines you selected do not have Tandem Calling capability.  
Transfer  
To transfer your call:  
1.  
2.  
Place or answer call.  
Hookash and dial the extension to which you want to Transfer the call.  
• To Transfer the call to the voice mail Automated Attendant, dial the voice mail master number (700).  
3.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
To transfer the call unscreened, hang up.  
To screen the transfer, wait for the called party to answer before hanging up.  
To receive Transfer (if you get an Intercom call announcing it):  
Stay on the line.  
• The Transfer goes through when the calling party hangs up.  
1.  
Voice Mail  
To leave a voice mail message for a co-worker:  
Place Intercom call to co-worker.  
• The extension you call can be unanswered, busy, or in Do Not Disturb.  
1.  
2.  
Dial 8 and hang up.  
V-MAIL ashes fast at the extension you called.  
To call your voice mail mailbox:  
1.  
2,  
Lift the handset.  
Dial *8.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
313  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Soft Keys  
Soft Keys  
Description  
314  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Speed Dial  
Speed Dial  
Description  
Instead of dialing a long telephone number to reach a client or customer, use Speed Dial  
instead. Also, store Intercom digits for quick access to commonly used features.  
Speed Dial gives an extension user quick access to frequently called numbers. There are two types of Speed  
Dial: System and Personal. Speed Dial numbers can be up to 32 digits long, using 0-9, # and *. Every Speed  
Dial can have a programmed name up to 18 characters long. The name shows in the telephone display as the  
Speed Dial number dials out.  
Speed Dial can store outside numbers and Intercom digits. The capability to store Intercom digits provides  
the user with “one-touch” access to features they use most often. For example, a user can have a Speed Dial  
bin that simplies forwarding calls to voice mail or a co-worker.  
System Speed Dial  
System Speed Dial gives every extension access to the same set of stored numbers. The system provides 999  
System Speed Dial numbers. Users can access these numbers by pressing a uniquely programmed System  
Speed Dial Feature Key or by dialing the Speed Dial bin number. Depending on the system option selected  
(see Programming below), users have dial access to either 9, 99 or 999 System Speed Dial bins.  
Personal Speed Dial  
Personal Speed Dial provides extensions with 20 numbers stored privately for their own use. The Personal  
Speed Dial keys on a DSS Console access the same bins as the extension to which it is attached.  
Unique Speed Dial Entries  
In addition to the digits 0-9, # and *, you can enter the following for additional dialing options:  
From system programming,  
press this key:  
From user programming,  
press this key:  
For this option:  
FLASH  
DND  
Flash  
Wait (not used)  
Pause  
Feature Key 1  
Feature Key 2  
Feature Key 3  
MUTE  
Storing Line Routing in a Speed Dial Bin  
When you program a Speed Dial bin, you can select either a line or a Line Group over which the call should  
route. For example, you can enter 1 for line 1 or 90 for Line Group 90.  
If you enter a Line Group number, the system will follow the Line Group programming and select an  
available line in the group for the call.  
If you enter a line number and the line is busy when the Speed Dial bin tries to dials out, the user hears  
busy tone. If their extension has Line Queuing, they can dial 2 to queue for a line to become free. If they  
hang up, the system converts the queue to a Line Callback.  
The capability to dial 90-98 to select a Line Group for a Speed Dial call is a permanent feature and not  
affected by programming.  
Centrex Compatibility  
Speed Dial offers unique compatibility with connected Centrex services. A Speed Dial number can accom-  
modate both placing a new call and outdialing the stored Speed Dial number on an active Centrex line. This  
enables features such as Centrex Transfer and Conference. Speed Dial adheres to the following rules.  
1. When a user active on an outside call presses TRANSFER and selects a Speed Dial number (using any  
method), the system examines the contents of the stored Speed Dial bin.  
2. If the rst entry in the bin is an F (Flash command), the system ashes the connected line and outdials  
the contents of the bin (ignoring the line selection associated with the bin).  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
315  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Speed Dial  
Note that this unique Centrex integration also pertains to voice mail ports accessing stored Speed Dial numbers.  
Chaining Bins for Dialing Long Numbers  
A Speed Dial number can be up to 32 digits long. The system allows this by automatically using the next  
adjacent bin for entries longer than 16 digits. For example, assume you want to store a Personal Speed Dial  
number for a banking service (203-926 5400) followed by a pause and your 10 digit customer code  
(9876543210). If you store the entries in bin 701, the following occurs:  
The system stores the rst 16 digits (203 926 5400 Pause 98765) in bin 701.  
The system stores the remaining digits (43210) in bin 702.  
Chaining Notes:  
In the above example, bin 702 is inaccessible for viewing, programming, or dialing. It only becomes  
available if you reprogram bin 701 to be 16 digits or less.  
Since bin 720 is the last Personal Speed Dial bin, it can contain only 16 digits.  
Manually Dialing After Speed Dial on T1 Lines  
When using a tie line or an outgoing DID line for Speed Dial, Auto Redial, Last Number Redial, or Save, the  
user can manually dial additional digits as soon as the stored number dials out.  
Answer Supervision  
Answer Supervision is only available with T1/E1 lines. It applies to:  
T1 E&M lines (tie line)  
T1 DID lines when used for outgoing calls  
All types of E1 lines (not available in North America)  
Answer Supervision is not available on analog lines. On these types of lines, the user can dial additional dig-  
its as soon as the last digit of the stored number dials out.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Dial access to 99 System Speed Dial bins (201-299).  
• All extensions can use System Speed Dial, but only extension 300 can program.  
• All bins are empty and no names are programmed.  
316  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Speed Dial  
Programming  
Setting Up Personal Speed Dial  
1.  
Should extension be able to use Personal Speed Dial?  
1. If yes:  
- In 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763), make sure the extension has outgoing (2) or full (3)  
access to the lines they want to use for Personal Speed Dial.  
- To allow the extension user to use Line Groups for their Speed Dial numbers, check the assign-  
2. If no:  
2.  
To enter Personal Speed Dial numbers from system programming:  
numbers.  
- 0 for none  
- 1 for Intercom  
- 2 for line  
- 3 for Line Group  
- 4 for Extend (i.e., the second bin in a chained number)  
number (1-64).  
the Line Group number (90-98).  
-
In 2151-[01-20]: Personal Speed Dial Bin Name (page 777), enter a name for the Speed Dial  
number.  
Setting Up System Speed Dial  
1.  
Should extension be able to use System Speed Dial numbers?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. If yes:  
- In 2131-[01-64]: Line Access (page 763), make sure extensions has outgoing (2) or full (3) access  
to the lines you want them to use for System Speed Dial.  
- To allow Line Groups for use in System Speed Dial numbers, check the assignments in  
3. If no:  
2.  
Should extension be able to store System Speed Dial numbers?  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
317  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speed Dial  
2.  
Should the system have 9 (1-digit), 99 (2-digit), or 999 (3-digit) System Speed Dial numbers?  
Speed Dial Assignment) below and set up under System Speed Dial keys.  
3.  
To enter System Speed Dial numbers from System Programming:  
bers.  
- 0 for none  
- 1 for Intercom  
- 2 for line  
- 3 for Line Group  
- 4 for Extend (i.e., the second bin in a chained number)  
number (1-64).  
the Line Group number (90-98).  
-
In 1702-[001-999]: System Speed Dial Bin Name (page 717), enter a name for the Speed Dial  
number.  
Setting Up Speed Dial Feature Keys  
1.  
To set up Personal Speed Dial Feature Keys:  
1. To set up a Personal Speed Dial key on an extension:  
1. To set up a Personal Speed Dial key on a DSS Console:  
2.  
To set up System Speed Dial Feature Keys:  
1. To set up a System Speed Dial key on an extension:  
1. To set up a System Speed Dial key on a DSS Console:  
Additional Speed Dial Options  
1.  
Is a pause stored in a Speed Dial bin the correct duration?  
318  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speed Dial  
2.  
3.  
Is a Flash stored in a Speed Dial bin the correct duration?  
Are Speed Dial calls correctly detecting dial tone?  
Other Related Features  
Features  
An extension user can store an Account Code in a Speed Dial bin. See Using Account Codes and  
You can store outside numbers in Speed Dial bins for quick access to frequently called numbers.  
Check Personal Speed Dial bin assignments.  
The DSS Console Personal Speed Dial bins are the same as the extension to which the console is  
attached. This means that DSS Consoles that share the same block number still have unique Personal  
Speed Dial.  
The system enforces Toll Restriction on Speed Dial numbers as they are dialed, not as they are stored.  
An extension user can Voice Over after calling a co-worker by using Personal Speed Dial.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Programming and Dialing Personal Speed Dial  
Forced Account Codes may prevent Speed Dial from dialing 911 emergency services.  
To program a Personal Speed Dial number:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Do not lift the handset or press any keys.  
Dial #SP (#77).  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
Dial the Personal Speed Dial bin number (701-720).  
Press a Personal Speed Dial bin key (for bins 701-710).  
b.  
4.  
5.  
Press HOLD.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
Enter the line number you want the system to use when dialing your stored number (1-64).  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
319  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speed Dial  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Programming and Dialing Personal Speed Dial  
b.  
c.  
Enter the Line Group number you want the system to use when dialing your stored number (90-98).  
Press INTERCOM if you want to enter Intercom codes.  
Press HOLD.  
6.  
7.  
Enter the number you want to store (up to 32 digits long).  
• If storing Intercom codes, you can enter a valid dial sequence using the digits 0-9, #, and *.  
• To insert a pause, press MUTE. To insert a Flash, press FLASH.  
• Do not enter a pause or ash into an Intercom code.  
8.  
9.  
Press HOLD twice.  
Enter a name for the Speed Dial number.  
10. Press HOLD.  
11. Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Repeat from step 3 to program another bin.  
Press SPEAKER to exit.  
To dial a stored Personal Speed Dial number:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
c.  
Press INTERCOM, dial #, then dial the Personal Speed Dial bin number (701-720).  
24-Button or 34-Button Telephone Only  
Press bin key for bins 701-710.  
Press a Feature Key set up as a Personal Speed Dial key.  
Super Display Telephone Only  
d.  
Press Spd Dial 1 (bins 701-710) or Spd Dial 2 (bins 711-720).  
Press the soft key for the number you want to dial.  
To chain bins, wait for the rst bin to dial out, then press a bin key or Feature Key.  
If the programmed route is busy, press an idle line key to reroute the call.  
You cannot chain Intercom numbers.  
(Optional)  
2.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Programming and Dialing System Speed Dial  
Forced Account Codes may prevent Speed Dial from dialing 911 emergency services.  
To program a System Speed Dial number:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
5.  
Do not lift the handset or press any keys.  
Dial #SP (#77).  
Dial the System Speed Dial bin number (normally 201-299).  
Press HOLD.  
Do one of the following.  
320  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speed Dial  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Programming and Dialing System Speed Dial  
a.  
b.  
Enter the line number you want the system to use when dialing your stored number (1-64).  
Enter the Line Group number you want the system to use when dialing your stored number (90-98).  
Press INTERCOM if you want to enter Intercom codes.  
c.  
Press HOLD.  
6.  
7.  
Enter the number you want to store (up to 32 digits long).  
• If storing Intercom codes, you can enter a valid dial sequence using the digits 0-9, #, and *.  
• To insert a pause, press MUTE. To insert a Flash, press FLASH.  
• Do not enter a pause or ash into an Intercom code.  
8.  
9.  
Press HOLD twice.  
Enter a name for the Speed Dial number.  
10. Press HOLD.  
11. Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Repeat from step 3 to program another bin.  
Press SPEAKER to exit.  
To dial a stored System Speed Dial number:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
Press INTERCOM, dial #, then dial the System Speed Dial bin number (normally 201-299).  
Press a Feature Key set up as a System Speed Dial key.  
a.  
c.  
To chain bins, wait for the rst bin to dial out, then press a bin key or Feature Key.  
If the programmed route is busy, press an idle line key to reroute the call.  
(Optional)  
2.  
User Programmable Features  
Programming Personal Speed Dial  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#SP (#77)  
Operation  
Access Level  
Speed Dial  
#SP + Press bin key (for bins 701-710) + HOLD + Enter  
outside line (e.g., 1), Line Group (90-98), or INTERCOM  
for Intercom feature + HOLD + Number to store + HOLD  
twice + Name + HOLD + Press another bin key or  
SPEAKER to exit.  
1-5  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
321  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Speed Dial  
Programming System Speed Dial  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#SP (#77)  
Operation  
Access Level  
Speed Dial  
#SP + Dial System Speed Dial bin number (e.g., 201) +  
HOLD + Enter outside line (e.g., 1), Line Group (e.g., 90),  
or INTERCOM for Intercom feature + HOLD + Number  
to store + HOLD twice + Name + HOLD + Dial another  
bin or SPEAKER to exit.  
4-5  
Name Programming Chart  
Name Programming Chart  
Press a key the indicated number of times for desired character  
Key  
1 Time  
2 Times  
3 Times  
4 Times  
5 Times  
6 Times  
7 Times  
8 Times  
9 Times  
1
&
-
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
#
*
A
B
E
H
K
N
Q
U
X
:
C
F
I
a
d
g
j
b
e
c
f
2
3
4
5
6
r
D
G
h
k
i
J
M
L
O
R
V
Y
0
l
m
S
t
n
p
u
w
o
q
v
x
P
s
z
7
9
T
8
y
W
Z
space  
Not used  
Not used  
After selecting a letter, press a key for another letter or wait 2 seconds for the cursor to automatically advance.  
Additional Name Programming Options  
HOLD  
Save name.  
SPEAKER  
Volume Up  
Volume Down  
Exit user name programming.  
Scroll the cursor to the right.  
Scroll the cursor to the left.  
While editing, clears character to the right.  
At beginning of line, erases entire entry.  
At end of line, becomes a backspace key  
CLEAR  
CHECK  
Restore the previous entry.  
322  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Split (Alternate)  
Split (Alternate)  
Description  
Switch between active calls without Conferencing the calls together.  
With Split, an extension user can split (alternate) between a current call and a new call. Split lets the exten-  
sion user easily alternate between the calls without joining (Conferencing) the parties together.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Split disabled (no Split keys programmed).  
Programming  
1.  
To set up a Split Feature Key:  
1. To set up a Split Feature Key on an extension:  
1. To set up a Split Feature Key on a DSS Console:  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Camp-On lets an extension user know that a call is waiting to be answered. The user can Split between  
the waiting call and their current call.  
A DSS Console can have a Split key.  
An extension user can alternate between their active call and their waiting call.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
323  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Split (Alternate)  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Split  
To Split between your current Intercom call and a new Intercom call:  
1.  
2.  
Press HOLD to place your Intercom call on Hold.  
Press INTERCOM to answer your new Intercom call.  
INTERCOM winks off (green) to indicate that you have an Intercom call on Hold.  
3.  
Press your Split Feature Key to switch between your two Intercom calls.  
To Split between your current outside call and an Intercom call:  
1.  
2
Press TRANSFER to place your outside call on Hold.  
Place or answer your new Intercom call.  
3.  
Press your Split Feature Key to switch between your Intercom call and outside call.  
To Split between your current Intercom call and an outside call:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Press HOLD to place your current Intercom call on Hold  
Answer the outside call.  
Press your Split Feature Key to switch between your outside call and Intercom call.  
To Split between your current outside call and a waiting outside call:  
1.  
2
Press INTERCOM to place your current outside call on Hold.  
Place or answer a new outside call.  
3.  
Press your Split Feature Key to switch between your two outside calls.  
324  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Station Key Telephones  
Station Key Telephones  
Description  
System keysets provide a host of sophisticated extension features.  
The system offers 22-Button, 34-Button, 34-Button Advanced, and Super Display keyset telephones. All  
telephone models are available in two colors: black and white.  
22-Button Display Telephone with Speakerphone  
The 22-Button Display Telephone features a large 3 line-  
by-24 character alphanumeric display with 4 Interactive  
Soft Keys for intuitive feature access. It also provides 10  
Personal Speed Dial bin keys, 12 programmable Feature  
Keys and 12 xed function keys for streamlined opera-  
tion. Additionally, this telephone offers a headset jack  
and built-in speakerphone. Unique features include dual  
LEDs, built-in wall mounting, and an innovative two  
position angle adjustment.  
34-Button Backlit Display Telephone with Speakerphone  
The 34-Button Display Telephone features a large 3 line-  
by-24 character backlit alphanumeric display with 4 Inter-  
active Soft Keys for intuitive feature access. It also pro-  
vides 10 Personal Speed Dial bin keys, 24 programmable  
Feature Keys and 12 xed function keys for streamlined  
operation. Additionally, this telephone offers a backlit  
keypad, a headset jack, and built-in speakerphone. Unique  
features include dual LEDs, built-in wall mounting, and  
an innovative two position angle adjustment.  
34-Button Backlit Display Telephone with Full-Duplex Speakerphone  
This feature-rich 34-Button Display Telephone features a  
large 3 line-by-24 character backlit alphanumeric display  
with 4 Interactive Soft Keys for intuitive feature access. It  
also provides 10 Personal Speed Dial bin keys, 24 pro-  
grammable Feature Keys and 12 xed function keys for  
streamlined operation. Additionally, this telephone offers a  
built-in full duplex speakerphone (with no external speaker  
or microphone required), a backlit keypad, and a headset  
jack. Unique features include dual LEDs, built-in wall  
mounting, and an innovative two position angle adjust-  
ment.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
325  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Station Key Telephones  
34-Button Backlit Super Display Telephone with Half-Duplex Speakerphone  
The Super Display Telephone is the system’s most sophis-  
ticated telephone instrument. It features a large 9 line-by-  
24 character backlit alphanumeric display with 12 Interac-  
tive Soft Keys for intuitive feature access. It also provides  
10 Personal Speed Dial bin keys, 24 programmable Fea-  
ture Keys and 12 xed function keys for streamlined oper-  
ation. Additionally, this telephone offers a built-in half  
duplex speakerphone (with no external speaker or micro-  
phone required), a backlit keypad, and a headset jack.  
Unique features include dual LEDs, built-in wall mount-  
ing, and an innovative two position angle adjustment.  
Ring/Message Lamp  
Each keyset has a Ring/Message Lamp. Located on the upper right of the keyset faceplate, the Ring/Message  
Lamp indicates for the following features:  
For this feature:  
Caller ID Logging  
The lamp does this:  
Double-wink on (green) when there is a new Caller ID  
record that has not been reviewed  
Central Ofce Calls, Answering  
Direct Inward Line  
Hold  
Slow ash (green) as call rings  
Slow ash (green) as call rings  
Slow ash (green) during Hold recall  
Slow ash (green) as call rings  
Intercom  
Fast ash (red) when user has a Message Waiting  
indication left  
Message Waiting  
Park  
Slow ash (green) during Park recall  
Transfer  
Voice Mail  
Slow ash (green as call rings) and during Transfer recall  
Fast ash (red) when messages are waiting in mailbox  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Digital station ports automatically detect the type of connect device when the keyset is plugged in.  
326  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Station Key Telephones  
Programming  
1.  
Extension Circuit Type  
device is connected to a digital station port:  
- 00 for Undened  
- 01 for DSX 22 Button  
- 02 for DSX 34 Button  
- 03 for DSX Super Display  
- 04 for DS 22 Button Non-display  
- 05 for DS 22 Button Display  
- 06 for DS 34 Button  
- 07 for DS Super Display  
- 08 for Cordless Telephone  
- 09 for Single Line Telephone  
- 10 for Analog Door Box  
Other Related Features  
None  
Operation  
Refer to the individual features.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
327  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Station Message Detail Recording  
Station Message Detail Recording  
Description  
SMDR provides a printed record of your calls.  
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) provides a record of the system’s outside calls. Typically, the  
record outputs to a customer-provided printer, terminal or SMDR data collection device. SMDR allows you to  
monitor the usage at each extension and line. This makes charge-back and trafc management easier. SMDR  
includes both incoming and outgoing calls, and can be turned off system-wide or selectively for each line.  
The SMDR call record outputs when the call completes. The system assigns the SMDR record to the last  
extension on the call. For example, if extension 306 answers the call, talks for 20 minutes, and then transfers  
the call to extension 302, extension 302 “owns” the entire call record as soon as they hang up.  
SMDR requires a customer-provided data collection device connected to the system’s RS-232 port. The  
default baud rate is 38,400. The data format is xed at 8 data bits, no parity, with one stop bit (8N1). Connec-  
tion requires:  
Adaptor P/N 1091014 to connect to the 9-pin RS-232 port on the data collection device.  
A standard 6-conductor line cord to connect the adaptor to the system’s RS-232 port.  
SMDR does not buffer records when the data collection device is disconnected.  
Call Duration Independent of System Clock  
The duration of a call on the SMDR report is calculated independently of the system clock. This prevents  
changes made to the system Time and Date from inaccurately reporting the call duration after the Time and  
Date change. The automatic Daylight Savings Time adjustment also will not affect the call duration.  
Sample SMDR Report  
Following is a sample SMDR report:  
Station Message Detail Recording  
09/07/2005 09:10P  
---+---+--------------------------------+----------+---------+--------+---  
Sta|Lin|  
---+---+--------------------------------+----------+---------+--------+---  
Number Dialed  
| Account | Start |Duration| T  
306| 01|  
306| 01|  
301| 02|  
304| 01|  
306| 01|  
12039265400|  
19055072888|  
-|  
-|  
18003651928|  
|09:10:18P|00:00:05|OUT  
|09:10:48P|00:01:13|OUT  
|09:12:13P|00:01:12|IN  
|09:12:07P|00:01:20|IN  
|09:15:38P|00:00:14|OUT  
SMDR Report Denitions  
SMDR Report Denitions  
The extension that placed or answered the call  
Sta  
Lin  
The line used for the call  
For outgoing calls, the number dialed on the line (up to 20 digits)  
Account code  
Number Dialed  
Account  
Start  
The time the call was initially answered  
The total duration of the call  
Duration  
T
OUT = Outgoing outside call  
IN = Incoming outside call  
RNA = line that rang but was not answered  
328  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Station Message Detail Recording  
SMDR Report Format  
Line  
SMDR Report Format (Page 1 of 2)  
Character  
Field  
Report Start Header  
1
1-32  
33,34  
1-10  
11  
STATION MESSAGE DETAIL RECORDING  
Carriage return, line feed  
Date (mm/dd/yyyy)  
2
Space  
12-16  
17  
Time (hh:mm:ss)  
A (for am) or P (for pm)  
Carriage return, line feed  
Carriage return, line feed  
18,19  
1,2  
3
Call Record Header  
1
1-3  
4
- characters  
+ character  
5-7  
8
- characters  
+ character  
9-40  
41  
- characters  
+ character  
42-51  
52  
- characters  
+ character  
53-61  
62  
- characters  
+ character  
63-70  
71  
- characters  
+ character  
72-74  
1-3  
4
- characters  
2
Sta  
| character  
5-7  
8
Lin  
| character  
9-40  
41  
(9 spaces) Number Dialed (10 spaces)  
| character  
42-51  
52  
(2 spaces) Account (1 space)  
| character  
53-61  
62  
(2 spaces) Start (2 spaces)  
| character  
63-70  
71  
Duration  
| character  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
329  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Station Message Detail Recording  
SMDR Report Format (Page 2 of 2)  
Line  
Character  
Field  
72  
73  
Space  
T
74  
Space  
3
1-3  
4
- characters  
+ character  
- characters  
+ character  
- characters  
+ character  
- characters  
+ character  
- characters  
+ character  
- characters  
+ character  
- characters  
5-7  
8
9-40  
41  
42-51  
52  
53-61  
62  
63-70  
71  
72-74  
Call Record  
1
1-3  
4
Extension number  
| character  
5-7  
Line number (2 digits, right justied, preceded by  
one space)  
8
| character  
9-40  
Number dialed (up to 20 characters, right justied,  
preceded by spaces)  
41  
42-51  
52  
| character  
Account Code (right justied, preceded by spaces)  
| character  
53-61  
62  
Start time of call (hh:mm:ssA or P)  
| character  
63-70  
71  
Duration of call (hh:mm:ss)  
| character  
72-74  
Type of call  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• SMDR output disabled.  
330  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Station Message Detail Recording  
Programming  
1.  
Should the system output SMDR?  
1. If yes:  
- In 1541-01: SMDR Port (page 666), enter 1 to enable the RS-232 port to output SMDR.  
1 for 2400  
2 for 9600  
3 for19,200  
4 for 38,400  
5 for 57,600  
2. If no:  
2.  
3.  
4.  
Should the SMDR report include a header for each new day?  
Should a specic line be included or excluded from the SMDR report?  
1. To exclude a line in the report, in 3111-06: Station Message Detail Recording (page 818) enterYes.  
2. To exclude a line from the report, in 3111-06: Station Message Detail Recording (page 818) enter No.  
Should the SMDR report be in English or Spanish?  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Account Codes print on the SMDR report.  
The Call Timer also helps users keep track of their time on the phone.  
Caller ID prints out on the SMDR report.  
The language of the SMDR header and the data in the SMDR Call Type (T) eld can be either English  
or Spanish.  
Time and date appear on the SMDR report.  
The system assigns the SMDR record to the last extension on the call. For example, if extension 306  
answers the call, talks for 20 minutes, and then transfers the call to extension 302, extension 302  
“owns” the entire call record as soon as they hang up.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
331  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Station Message Detail Recording  
Operation  
SMDR is automatic once enabled.  
332  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Administrator (PC Program)  
System Administrator (PC Program)  
Description  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
333  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Identification  
System Identication  
Description  
Store the site name and telephone number in the system data base.  
The system administrator can enter the site name and telephone number into the system data base. This  
information is saved into system memory.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No entries.  
Programming  
1.  
To enter the site name and telephone number into the system data base:  
Other Related Features  
N/A  
Operation  
N/A.  
334  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Programming Backup and Restore  
System Programming Backup and Restore  
Description  
Use a CompactFlash Card to back up and restore the site data.  
To prevent the loss of essential custom site programming, use a CompactFlash Card plugged into the Intra-  
Mail CompactFlash slot to back up the system database. If the need arises, you can restore the system data-  
base saved on the card. You can store the system database on the IntraMail CompactFlash Card or on a  
separate FAT16 or FAT32 formatted CompactFlash card. The entire system database uses about 500 Kbytes  
Of Compact Flash memory.  
Programming  
1.  
Back up the site data to CompactFlash Card.  
2.  
Restore data from CompactFlash Card.  
Other Related Features  
None  
Operation  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
335  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Programming Password Protection  
System Programming Password Protection  
Description  
Control access to system programming.  
The system controls access to the programmable options according to the programming password the  
administrator enters. There are three password levels:  
Logging On with this  
Gives you access to these programs:  
Password:  
System Administrator 1 (level 1)  
Password = 0000  
System Administrator 2 (level 1)  
Password = 9999  
Installer (level 3)  
Password = NECDSX (632379)  
All  
Conditions  
• When programming passwords, the system will enforce the higher level password if there are dupli-  
cate entries. For example, if you inadvertently set the level 3 (Installer) password the same as either  
level 1 (System Administrator 1) or level 2 (System Administrator 2), the system will enforce the level  
3 password.  
Default Setting  
• See the table above.  
Programming  
1.  
To change the system passwords:  
1. In 1031-01: New Password (page 602), optionally set up new level 1, 2, or 3 passwords.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Back up your system programming to provide a permanent, non-volatile backup of all the site’s  
programming.  
336  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Programming Password Protection  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
337  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
T1 Lines  
T1 Lines  
Description  
In DSX-80/160, provides for connection to advanced digital lines and simplies installation.  
T1 lines require a unique T1 PCB (P/N 80061) and give the system a maximum of 24 lines in a single PCB  
slot. The available T1 line types include:  
Loop Start (DTMF and Dial Pulse)  
Ground Start (DTMF and Dial Pulse)  
Direct Inward Dial (DID) Wink Start (DTMF and Dial Pulse)  
Direct Inward Dial (DID) Immediate Start (DTMF and Dial Pulse)  
E&M Tie Line Wink Start (DTMF and Dial Pulse)  
E&M Tie Line Immediate Start (DTMF and Dial Pulse)  
T1 gives the system the advantages of advanced digital calling as well as conserving PCB slots. For exam-  
ple, you can set up a system with 12 loop start lines, six tie lines, and six DID lines and use only a single  
PCB slot. Additionally, the T1 PCB has its own on-board processor and DSP so it minimally impacts other  
system resources.  
Note: Although the T1 PCB can connect directly to the telco’s T1 smart jack, your telco may require that you  
purchase and install a separate Channel Service Unit (CSU). This unit installs between the smart jack and  
the T1 PCB.  
ANI/DNIS Support  
The system is compatible with telco's T1 Automatic Number Identication (ANI) and Dialed Number Infor-  
mation Service (DNIS) services. ANI/DNIS services can be provided on T1 loop start, ground start, and DID  
lines (but not E&M). ANI/DNIS Compatibility provides:  
Selectable Receive Format  
You can set up the system for compatibility with any combination of ANI, DNIS and Dialed Number  
(Address) data provided by the telco.  
Flexible Routing for DID Lines  
For DID lines, the system can route the incoming call based on the received DNIS data and the entries  
stored in the DID Translation Table. See Direct Inward Dialing (page 99) for more.  
Caller ID  
The system can use the received ANI data to display the caller’s number on the called extension’s dis-  
play. The ANI data can be up to 10 digits long.  
FSK Caller ID  
The T1 PCB can also receive FSK-based Caller ID (if provided by the telco), the same as the COIU (analog)  
line cards. To receive this type of Caller ID, you must enable DSP Caller ID for the T1 line circuits in pro-  
gramming. See the Programming below for more.  
E1 Lines  
The T1 PCB also supports E1, which provides 30 digital line circuits. E1 lines are not available in North  
America.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
338  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
T1 Lines  
Programming  
1.  
Set the circuit type for each T1 line.  
1. Be sure your T1PCB is installed and connected, and that your telco is providing T1 service.  
00 for uninstalled  
01 for Loop start  
02 for Ground Start  
03 for DID Wink Start  
04 for DID Immediate Start  
05 for E&M Wink Start  
06 for E&M Immediate Start  
2.  
Review the T1/E1 timers.  
1. Review the following timers for compatibility with your connected T1 service.  
3.  
Review the T1 PCB conguration options.  
1. Review the following options for compatibility with your connected T1 service.  
(By default, this entry is 0 - all channels active.)  
(By default, this entry is 1 - T1 PCB is the clock master.)  
(By default, this setting is 0 for 0dB.)  
(By default, this entry isYes for ESF - Extended Super Frame.)  
(By default, this entry isYes for B8ZS enabled.)  
(By default, this option is 0 - no rollback.)  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
339  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
T1 Lines  
4.  
To set up T1 lines for compatibility with ANI/DNIS service:  
1. To enable ANI-based Caller ID, in 3121-01: Caller ID Type (page 825) enter 3.  
2. In 3121-02: ANI/DNIS Format (page 825), specify the type of ANI/DNIS received from the telco:  
- 0 for no ANI/DNIS data  
- 1 for ANI  
- 2 for *ANI*  
- 3 for *DNIS*  
- 4 for *ANI*DNIS*  
3. In 3121-03: ANI/DNIS Delimiter (page 826), select the type of ANI/DNIS delimiter required by your  
connected service  
- This is required only for options 2-4 in step 2.  
- The delimiter can be any character 0-9, # or *. Normally, it is *.  
number.  
- This is required only for option 1 in step 2.  
- This does not apply to options 2-4 in step 2.  
5.  
Does your T1 service provide FSK-based Caller ID (instead of ANI-based)?  
1. For FSK-based Caller ID, in 3121-01: Caller ID Type (page 825) enter 1.  
2. For ANI-based Caller ID, in 3121-01: Caller ID Type (page 825) enter 3 and see step 4 above.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Directly dial system extensions from outside the system.  
Link two systems together for inter-system Intercom calling and other features.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
None  
340  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tandem Calls / Unsupervised Conference  
Tandem Calls  
/
Unsupervised Conference  
Description  
Join two callers in Conference, leave the call and let their conversation continue.  
Tandem Calls allows an extension user to join two outside callers in a line-to-line conference. The extension  
user can then drop out of the call, leaving the lines in an Unsupervised Conference. The extension user that  
established the Conference is not part of the conversation. The Conference continues until either outside  
party hangs up.  
Tandem Calls uses a Conference circuit. The following table shows the system’s Conference capacities:  
Description  
Capacity  
Conference circuits  
32  
32  
Maximum simultaneous users in Conference  
(total of all Conferences system-wide)  
Maximum simultaneous conferences  
8
8
Maximum parties in any one Conference  
(lines and/or extensions)  
The system’s 32 Conference circuits are dynamically allocated as users request them.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Tandem Calls are disabled.  
Programming  
1.  
Should a line have the capability to be included in a Tandem Call?  
2.  
Should extension be able to set up a Tandem Call?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
341  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Tandem Calls / Unsupervised Conference  
Other Related Features  
Features  
An extension user can end an Unsupervised Conference by using Forced Line Disconnect on one of  
the lines in the tandem call.  
Tandem Calling is available at Single Line extensions.  
The following features also allow different types of multiple party calls:  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Setting up a Tandem Call  
To set up a Tandem Call:  
Establish outside call.  
1.  
2.  
Press CONF.  
Your hear Intercom dial tone.  
Your caller hears Music on Hold (if installed) while they wait for you to set up the Conference.  
Do one of the following:  
3.  
a.  
b.  
Place or answer an outside call.  
Retrieve a call from Park Orbit.  
Press CONF to set up the Conference.  
• If you cannot add additional parties to your Conference, you have exceeded the system’s Conference limit.  
4.  
5.  
Hang up.  
• The line/loop keys for the outside lines stay on (red).  
• If the outside parties disconnect, the lines you selected or your extension does not have Tandem Call capability.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Disconnecting a Tandem Call  
To disconnect a tandem call (using Forced Line Disconnect):  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Press the line key for the busy line.  
Press INTERCOM and dial the line’s Direct Line Access code (e.g., 101 for line 1).  
2.  
Dial # to disconnect the Tandem Call.  
342  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tandem Calls / Unsupervised Conference  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Barging in on a Tandem Call  
To Barge In on a Tandem Call:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
Press the line key for the busy line.  
Press INTERCOM and dial the line’s Direct Line Access code (e.g., 101 for line 1).  
b.  
Dial 4.  
2.  
You hear two beeps and you join the Tandem Call.  
To place a Tandem Call on Hold (after Barging In):  
Press HOLD.  
1.  
• The tandem callers hear Music On Hold (if installed) while they wait on Hold.  
• While on Hold, the tandem callers cannot talk to each other.  
To rejoin a Tandem Call you have Placed on Hold:  
1.  
Press CONF.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Setting up a Tandem Call at a Single LineTelephone  
To set up a Tandem Call at a single line telephone:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
Establish an outside call.  
Hookash and establish another outside call.  
Hookash and dial #10 to set up a three-way Conference.  
Hang up.  
• If the outside parties disconnect, the lines you selected or your extension does not have Tandem Call capability.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Line-to-Line Transfer to set up a Tandem Call  
To set up a Tandem Call via line-to-lineTransfer:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
Place or answer an outside call.  
Press TRANSFER.  
Place or answer another outside call.  
Hang up to set up a Tandem Call between your initial call and new call.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
343  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tie Lines  
Tie Lines  
Description  
In DSX-80/160, link two systems together for inter-system Intercom calling and other features.  
Tie lines directly link a local DSX-80/160 telephone system with one or more remote DSX-80/160 systems.  
The link is independent of the telco's switched network. When a local system user seizes a tie line, they hear  
Intercom dial tone from the remote system. The user can then use many of the features normally available to  
the remote system’s single line telephones, including:  
Dialing Intercom extensions in the remote system.  
Using the remote system's lines for outgoing calls.  
Accessing System Speed Dial bins in the remote system.  
Using the remote system’s Paging.  
Tie Lines require a T1 PCB and Tie Line service from the telco.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
1.  
Set the circuit type for each tie line.  
1. Be sure your T1PCB is installed and connected, and that your telco is providing T1 tie line service.  
- 05 for E&M Wink Start  
- 06 for E&M Immediate Start  
3. In 3101-03: DTMF Dialing (page 811), indicate whether the line is DTMF (1) or Dial Pulse (0).  
2.  
3.  
Assign the tie line caller’s operator.  
- This is the extension reached when the incoming tie line caller dials 0.  
Assign the outbound Line Group reached when an incoming tie line caller dials 9.  
when incoming tie line callers dial 9 to place an outgoing call.  
ing tie line callers can use for placing an outgoing calls.  
- 0 for no access  
- 1 for incoming only access  
- 2 for outgoing only access  
- 3 for full access  
Group incoming tie line callers can use for placing outgoing calls.  
- You can deny outgoing access to individual lines within the group in step 2 above.  
344  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Tie Lines  
Should an incoming tie line restrict the incoming caller from using certain features and dialing  
certain outgoing calls?  
4.  
1. To restrict feature access:  
2. To restrict outgoing dialing:  
- In 3102-02: Line Toll Level (page 813), assign a Toll Level to the tie line.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Directly dial system extensions from outside the system.  
The SMDR record for an outgoing tie line call also incudes the line access codes dialed.  
T1 provides advanced digital lines and simplies installation. T1 is required for Tie Lines.  
Available Single Line Features  
The following single line telephone features are available over tie lines.  
• Call Waiting / Camp-On  
• Central Ofce Calls Placing (Line Group Access)  
• Direct Line Access  
• Door Box (calling)  
• Hold (retrieve a call on Hold in the remote system)  
• Intercom  
• Night Service (*0 pick up)  
• Speed Dial (System - dialing)  
• Transfer  
Voice Mail (leave message in remote mailbox)  
Unavailable Single Line Features  
The following single line telephone features are not available over tie lines.  
• Barge In  
• Call Forwarding  
• Callback  
• Central Ofce Calls, Answering  
• Central Ofce Calls, Placing (Line Dial-up)  
• Conference  
• Directed Call Pickup  
• Flash  
• Forced Line Disconnect  
• Group Call Pickup  
• Hold (cannot place a line in the remote system on Hold)  
• Last Number Redial  
• Meet Me Conference  
• Message Waiting  
• Page  
• Park  
• Removing Lines and extensions from service  
• Speed Dial (Personal)  
• Split (between two calls in the remote system)  
• Tandem Calls (in the remote system)  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
345  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tie Lines  
Operation  
Call Waiting / Camp-On  
1.  
2.  
Access the tie line and call busy extension.  
Dial 2 but do not hang up.  
• If you hang up, the system converts your Camp-On to a Callback.  
3.  
Speak to your co-worker when they answer their Camp-On ring.  
Central Ofce Calls, Placing  
Access the tie line.  
1.  
2.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
For Direct Line Access:  
i.  
Dial 1 followed by the line number (e.g., 101 for line 1).  
b.  
For Line Group Access:  
i.  
Dial the outside number.  
Dial the Line Group code (9 or 90-98).  
3.  
Direct Line Access  
1.  
2.  
Access the tie line, then dial 1 plus the line number (e.g., 101 for line 1).  
Dial outside number.  
Door Box  
To place a call to the Door Box:  
1.  
2.  
Access the tie line.  
Dial the Door Box extension number.  
Hold  
To retrieve a line on System Hold at a remote co-worker’s extension:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Access the tie line.  
Dial *4.  
Dial the number of the line that is on Hold in the remote system (e.g., 01 for line 1).  
346  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tie Lines  
Intercom  
To place an Intercom call:  
1.  
2.  
Access the tie line.  
Dial the extension number.  
• To call the remote system’s operator, dial 0.  
• The call rings the destination extension.  
Night Service / Night Ring  
To answer a call ringing over the paging system:  
1.  
2.  
Access the tie line.  
Dial *0.  
Speed Dial (System)  
To dial a Speed Dial number in the remote system:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Access the tie line.  
Dial # and the System Speed Dial bin number (e.g., 201-299).  
The stored number dials out through a line in the remote system.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
347  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tie Lines  
Transfer  
To transfer your call to a user in the remote system:  
Place or answer call.  
• Transferring an outside call over the tie line requires that the tie line have Tandem Calls enabled and that the  
extension have Unsupervised Conference enabled in their Class of Service.  
1.  
Press TRANSFER, access the tie line, and dial the extension to which you want to Transfer the call.  
• To Transfer the call to the remote voice mail Automated Attendant, dial the voice mail master number (700).  
2.  
3.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
To transfer the call unscreened, hang up.  
To screen the transfer, wait for the called party to answer before hanging up.  
Voice Mail  
To leave a voice mail message in a remote co-worker’s mailbox:  
Access the tie line and call a remote co-worker.  
• The extension you call can be unanswered, busy, or in Do Not Disturb.  
1.  
2.  
Dial 8 and hang up.  
V-MAIL ashes fast at the extension you called.  
348  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Time and Date  
Time and Date  
Description  
The Time and Date shows on telephone displays and prints on system reports.  
The system Time and Date appears on display telephones and Station Message Detail Recording reports.  
The system administrator can change the time and date from the system programming mode. In addition,  
extension users can change the time and date from the User Programmable Features. Although the data is  
entered in 24-hour format, it always displays in 12-hour format (e.g., 1300 = 1:00PM). The system can auto-  
matically adjust the time for Daylight Savings Time.  
Conditions  
• The system retains the time and date after a system reset or short term power failure.  
Default Setting  
• The automatic Daylight Savings Time adjustment is enabled.  
Programming  
1.  
2.  
3.  
To change the time and date from system programming:  
Do you want the system to automatically adjust for daylight savings time?  
Do you want to change the time and date format?  
1. If yes, in 1511-02: Clock Display Format (page 656) enter a new clock format (1-4). The options are:  
Clock Display Format Options  
(Using Tuesday, 3/28/2006, 4:44PM as an Example)  
Option  
Display Format  
1 (Default)  
Tue March 28  
4:44 PM  
Tue March 28  
16:44  
2
3
4
4:44 PM  
Tue March 28  
16:44  
Tue March 28  
-
After changing the entry for the Clock Display Format, an extension user must either lift and replace  
the handset or receive an incoming call before their display will show the new format.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
349  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Time and Date  
Other Related Features  
Features  
The battery on the CPU PCB backs up the CPU Real Time Clock for 10-14 days.  
Time and date appear on the SMDR report.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
User Programmable Feature  
Changing the System Time and Date  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#TD (#83)  
Operation  
Access Level  
Time and Date  
#TD + Enter time in 24-hour clock using hours (2 digits),  
minutes (2 digits) and seconds (2 digits) + HOLD + Enter  
date using month (2 digits), day (2 digits) and year (4 dig-  
its) + HOLD + SPEAKER to exit.  
4 and 5  
350  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Toll Restriction  
Toll Restriction  
Description  
Use Toll Restriction to help you control the costs of outgoing long distance calls.  
For some common Toll Restriction examples, turn to page 356.  
Toll Restriction limits the numbers an extension user may dial. By allowing extensions to place only certain  
types of calls, the system administrator can control long distance costs. The system applies Toll Restriction  
according to an extension’s Toll Restriction Level. For each of the 7 Toll Restriction Levels, the administra-  
tor can enable or disable the following options.  
Active Key Pad (Continuous Dialing)  
Active Key Pad continuously enables the telephone key pad. This is important if co-workers typically  
use dial-up services (such as automated banking) or frequently dial into voice mail systems. With Active  
Key Pad disabled, the system disables the telephone key pad 6 seconds after the user has dialed their last  
digit. Toll Restriction controls Active Key Pad for both incoming and outgoing calls.  
N11 Dialing  
N11 Dialing enables or disables an extension’s ability to use N11 services such as directory assistance  
(411) and repair (611). Consider enabling this option if the connected telco charges by the call (i.e.,  
meters) these services. Note that the system never restricts a user from dialing 911 or 1 + 911.  
0 + Dialing  
0 + Dialing enables or disables an extension’s ability to manually dial 0 + (operator assisted) calls. These  
calls typically include collect calls and credit card calls. Be sure to disable this option if you don’t want  
co-workers making these types of calls. The setting of 0 + Dialing does not affect the operation of inter-  
national dialing (see the option immediately following).  
International (011) Dialing  
Use the International Dialing option to restrict extension access to high-cost international (011) dialing.  
You can, for example, enable international dialing for high priority users and executives while disabling  
international dialing for all other co-workers.  
Equal Access (1010 + XXX) Dialing  
Equal Access allows users to select long distance carriers other than your primary carrier. Your primary  
carrier is the long distance provider you access when you seize a line and dial 1. To reach another provider,  
dial 1010 and that provider’s three-digit code (e.g., 1010220). The system does not restrict the numbers  
dialed after the Equal Access code, but can prevent users from dialing specic Equal Access codes.  
1 + Dialing  
This type of Toll Restriction can restrict:  
- 1 + 3-digit (1 + NPA and 1 + NXX) dialing.  
- 1 + 6-digit (1 + NPA + NXX) dialing.  
Dialing without a Leading 1  
This type of Toll Restriction can restrict:  
- 3-digit (NPA and NXX) dialing.  
- 6-digit (NPA + NXX) dialing.  
The Toll Restriction Tables  
There are 5 separate tables for each Toll Restriction Level. Each table can hold up to 96 entries. The Toll  
Restriction Tables can individually restrict:  
Equal Access Dialing.  
Calls dialed with a leading 1 (1 + Dialing).  
Calls dialed without a leading 1.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
351  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Toll Restriction  
The following chart summarizes these tables.  
Toll Restriction Tables  
Dialing Type  
Program  
Description  
Program 352x-1010-XXX / Local Lookup table that restricts 1010 + XXX  
dialing. Can be set up as an allow or deny  
table.  
Equal Access Dialing  
1
Example : 1010 220 203 926 5400  
3-digit lookup table that handles restric-  
tion for 1 + NPA and 1 + NXX dialing.  
Can be set up as an allow or deny table.  
1 + Dialing  
1
Example : 1 203 926 5400  
TBL-A XXXXXXX (1 + NPA +  
6-digit lookup table that handles 1 + NPA  
+ NXX dialing. Can be set up as an allow  
or deny table.  
1
Example : 1 203 926 5400  
3-digit lookup table that handles NPA and  
NXX dialing. Can be set up as an allow or  
deny table.  
Dialing without a  
leading 1  
1
Example : 203 926 5400  
Program 356x-XXX-XXX / TBL- 6-digit lookup table that handles NPA +  
B XXXXXX (NPA + NXX Dialing NXX dialing. This is a deny-only table.  
1
Example : 203 926 5400  
1
The underline bold digits are the digits looked up by the specied table for the type of call dialed.  
Toll Restriction Overview  
When you dial: Telephone Banking  
Continued Dialing (Active Key Pad) is enabled or disabled by the setting of 3511-01: Active Key Pad  
When you dial: 411, 811  
N11 Dialing is enabled or disabled by the setting of 3512-04: Allow N11 Dialing (page 842).  
When you dial: 0 203 926 5400  
0+ Dialing is enabled or disabled by the setting of 3512-01: Allow 0 + XXX Operator Assisted Dialing  
When you dial: 011 International Calls  
International (011) Dialing is enabled or disabled by the setting of 3512-02: Allow 011 + XXX Interna-  
When you dial: 1015 220 203 926 5400  
Equal Access (101X XXX) Dialing is enabled or disabled in 3512-03: Allow 101x Equal Access Dialing  
- This option restricts Equal Access Codes 1011 through 1019 and has no affect on the more common  
1010 XXX Equal Access Codes.  
352  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Toll Restriction  
When you dial: 1010 220 203 926 5400  
Equal Access (1010 XXX) Dialing is controlled by the Equal Access codes entered in 352x-1010-XXX /  
- The table entries have no affect on the less common 101X XXX Equal Access dialing.  
When you dial: 1 800 365 1928, 1 900 555 1212, 1 926 5400  
- These tables work together. For example, you can deny an NPA in 353x and allow a specic NPA +  
NXX combination in 354x.  
When you dial: 203 926 5400, 926 5400  
NPA and NXX dialing (without the leading 1) is controlled by the entries in 355x-XXX / TBL-B-XXX  
- These tables work together. For example, you can allow an NPA in 355x and deny a specic NPA +  
NXX combination in 356x.  
Default Toll Restriction Conguration  
When you assign a Toll Level to an extension, the extension has the following Toll Restriction by default:  
Active Key Pad is enabled.  
N11 Dialing is enabled.  
0 + Dialing is enabled.  
International (011) Dialing is enabled.  
Equal Access (101X + XXX) Dialing is enabled.  
Equal Access (1010 + XXX) Dialing is enabled without restriction because the 1010 + XXX Equal  
Access Table is a deny table with no entries (i.e., it denies nothing).  
1 + NPA/NXX Dialing is enabled without restriction because the 1 + NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit and 1 +  
NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Tables are deny tables with no entries (i.e., they deny nothing).  
NPA/NXX Dialing and NPA + NXX Dialing are enabled without restriction because the NPA/NXX Dialing  
3-Digit Table is a deny table with no entries (i.e., it denies nothing). In addition, the NPA + NXX Dialing 6-  
Digit Table does not restrict because it is a deny table with no entries (i.e., it also denies nothing).  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• See Default Toll Restriction Conguration above.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
353  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Toll Restriction  
Programming  
Basic Setup  
1.  
2.  
3.  
To set up Toll Restriction Tables prior to programming:  
- For systems installed in North America, you should select US Domestic (1).  
Assign a Toll Restriction level to an extension.  
assign a Toll Restriction level to an extension.  
Do you want to enable Active Key Pad (Continuous Dialing)?  
4.  
5.  
6.  
Do you want to enable N11 dialing?  
Do you want to enable 0+ (Operator Assisted) dialing?  
Do you want to enable International (011) dialing?  
Equal Access Dialing Restrictions  
1.  
Do you want to enable the dialing of Equal Access Codes 1011 through 1019?  
2.  
Do you want to allow Equal Access 1010 + XXX dialing?  
ing Table.  
- Be sure to initialize the table before programming it for the rst time.  
- You can make the table a deny table and enter just the codes you want to restrict, or  
- You can make the table an allow table and enter just the codes you want to allow.  
- By default, this type of dialing is allowed because the table is a deny table with no entries (i.e., it  
denies nothing).  
354  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Toll Restriction  
table with no entries. This blocks all 1010 + XXX dialing.  
1 + Long Distance Dialing Restrictions  
1.  
Do you want to allow 1 + NPA or 1 + NXX dialing?  
- Be sure to initialize the table before programming it for the rst time.  
- You can make the table a deny table and enter just the codes you want to restrict, or  
- You can make the table an allow table and enter just the codes you want to allow.  
- By default, this type of dialing is allowed because the table is a deny table with no entries (i.e., it  
denies nothing).  
allow table with no entries. This blocks all 1 + NPA/NXX dialing.  
2.  
Do you want to have additional 6-digit (1 + NPA + NXX) dialing restriction?  
up the table.  
- Be sure to initialize the table before programming it for the rst time.  
- You can make the table a deny table and enter just the codes you want to restrict, or  
- You can make the table an allow table and enter just the codes you want to allow.  
- By default, there is no 6-digit restriction because the table is a deny table with no entries (i.e., it  
denies nothing). The 1 + restriction is handled by the 1 + 3-digit table.  
change the table to a deny table with no entries. This provides no 6-digit restriction.  
Long Distance Dialing Restrictions  
1.  
Do you want to allow NPA or NXX dialing?  
- Be sure to initialize the table before programming it for the rst time.  
- You can make the table a deny table and enter just the codes you want to restrict, or  
- You can make the table an allow table and enter just the codes you want to allow.  
- By default, this type of dialing is allowed because the table is a deny table with no entries (i.e., it  
denies nothing).  
allow table with no entries. This blocks all 1 + NPA/NXX dialing.  
2.  
Do you want to have additional 6-digit (NPA + NXX) dialing restriction?  
table.  
- Be sure to initialize the table before programming it for the rst time.  
- You can make the table a deny table and enter just the codes you want to restrict, or  
- You can make the table an allow table and enter just the codes you want to allow.  
- By default, there is no 6-digit restriction because the table is a deny table with no entries (i.e., it  
denies nothing). The restriction is handled by the 3-digit table.  
table to a deny table with no entries. This provides no 6-digit restriction.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
355  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Toll Restriction  
Some Common Toll Restriction Examples  
Note that the following 4 examples can be simultaneously programmed in the same system – just don’t rein-  
itialize the Toll Restriction Tables in examples 2-4.  
Example 1: Allowing Only Local Calling  
Allow users to dial only 7-digit and 10-digit local numbers. All 1 + 7 digit, 1 + 10 digit, 0+, and Equal  
Access dialing is restricted.  
1. Make sure the following are disabled:  
2. For Toll Level 1, be sure the following tables are set as allow tables with no entries. (This setting blocks  
all calls of the type specied by each table.)  
3. In 355x-XXX / TBL-B-XXX (NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table), make the table a deny table with no  
entries. (This will allow unrestricted dialing of 7-digit and 10-digit local numbers.)  
with no entries.  
Example 2: Setting Up 10-Digit Local Calling  
Restrict 1 + 203 calls in a neighboring (foreign) area code, but allow 203 10-digit calls in the home area code.  
1. For Toll Level 2, be sure Toll Restriction Tables 352x through 356x are deny tables with no entries. (This  
will allow unrestricted dialing.)  
extensions.  
Example 3: Preventing 1 + 900 Pay-Per-Call Charges  
Restrict 1 + 900 calls.  
1. For Toll Level 3, be sure Toll Restriction Tables 352x through 356x are deny tables with no entries. (This  
will allow unrestricted dialing.)  
extensions.  
Example 4: Permitting Only Toll-Free Dialing  
Allow only 1 + 800 long distance calls.  
1. For Toll Level 4, be sure Toll Restriction Tables 352x and 0354x through 0356x are deny tables with no  
entries. (This will allow unrestricted dialing.)  
2. In 353x-1+XXX / TBL-A XXX (NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table), set this table up as an allow table and  
add code 800.  
extensions.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Direct Line Access does not bypass Toll Restriction.  
356  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Toll Restriction  
When an extension user with Toll Restriction enabled ashes a line, the system enforces Toll Restric-  
tion on any digits the user dials from the new dial tone. For example, if an extension user cannot dial  
203 926 5400 before they ash, they cannot dial 203 926 5400 after they ash.  
Forced Line Disconnect does not bypass Toll Restriction.  
Last Number Redial will not store a number denied by Toll Restriction.  
Toll Restriction restricts Private Lines just like any other line.  
Changing the Regional Default to Latin America automatically enables the Latin American Toll  
Restriction package. Latin American Toll Restriction is not included in this manual.  
Save Number Dialed will not store a number denied by Toll Restriction.  
The system enforces Toll Restriction on Speed Dial numbers as they are dialed, not as they are stored.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
Toll Restriction operation is automatic.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
357  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transfer  
Transfer  
Description  
Send the outside call you are on to a co-worker.  
Transfer permits an extension user to send (i.e., extend) an active call to any other extension in the system,  
a Ring Group, UCD Group or voice mail. With Transfer, any extension user can quickly send a call to the  
desired co-worker. A call a user transfers automatically recalls if not picked up at the destination exten-  
sion. If a transferred outside call is still unanswered, the call diverts to Key Ring. This assures that users do  
not lose or inadvertently abandon their transfers. An extension user can Transfer both outside calls and  
Intercom calls.  
The system allows the following types of transfers:  
Screened Transfer  
The transferring user announces the call to the destination before hanging up.  
Unscreened Transfer  
The transferring party extends the call without an announcement.  
Distinctive Flash Rate on Recall  
Transfer recall features a distinctive ash rate for line keys (see the chart below). This allows the keyset  
extension user to easily differentiate new calls that are ringing from transferred calls that are recalling.  
Distinctive Flash Rate onTransfer Recall  
For this type of call:  
You see this ash rate:  
Call that you transferred  
Slow Flash (red)  
Call that you initially transferred  
recalling your phone  
Double Wink On (green)  
Transfer Recall Display  
The Transfer recall display occurs as the call is ringing the extension that initially transferred it as well as  
after the call diverts to Key Ring. It identies:  
The type of call recalling the extension.  
The extension to which the call was initially transferred.  
Handsfree Transfer  
Handsfree Transfer allows an extension user to Transfer an outside call directly to a co-worker’s speakerphone.  
Hotline Automatic Transfer  
With Hotline Automatic Transfer, the extension can Transfer their call to a co-worker just by pressing their  
Hotline key and hanging up. Without Hotline Automatic Transfer, the user must pressTRANSFER before  
pressing the Hotline key. If the user frequently uses their Hotline key for one-button Transfer to co-workers,  
Hotline Automatic Transfer is recommended. If the user prefers to consult with their Hotline partner rather  
than Transfer, disabling Hotline Automatic Transfer would be helpful.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
• Music On Hold for transferred callers is disabled.  
358  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Transfer  
Interaction Between Call Forwarding, Extension Hunting, and Transfer Recall  
The following chart shows how the system handles Transfer Recall call routing when both Call Forwarding  
and Extension Hunting are enabled at the destination extension. Call Forwarding has priority over Exten-  
sion Hunting.  
Call Forwarding and Type 1 (Ring No Answer Line) Extension Hunting  
Destination Extension  
Forwarding Type  
Ring No Answer  
Busy  
In DND  
Call rings destination for  
Recall Timer interval.  
If unanswered, it rings the  
forwarding destination for  
interval.  
Call rings the forwarding destination for the 1603-01:  
If unanswered, it rings the initial transferring destination  
and then diverts to Key Ring.  
Busy/No Answer  
*32  
If still unanswered, it rings  
the initial transferring des-  
tination for the 1601-03:  
Timer interval and then  
diverts to Key Ring.  
Call rings the forwarding destination for the 1603-01: Transfer Recall Timer interval.  
If unanswered, it rings the initial transferring destination for the 1601-03: Call Forward No  
Answer Timer interval and then diverts to Key Ring.  
Immediate  
*34  
Call rings destination for  
Recall Timer interval.  
If unanswered, it rings the  
forwarding destination for  
interval.  
Call Camps-On to the destination for the 1601-03: Call  
No Answer  
*36  
If unanswered, call rings the forwarding destination for the  
If still unanswered, it rings the initial transferring destina-  
val and then diverts to Key Ring.  
If still unanswered, it rings  
the initial transferring des-  
tination for the 1601-03:  
Timer interval and then  
diverts to Key Ring.  
Call rings destination for  
Recall Timer interval.  
Call Camps-On to the destination for the 1601-03: Call  
Forwarding Off  
*30  
If unanswered, call rings the hunt destination for the 1601-  
If still unanswered, it rings the initial transferring destina-  
val and then diverts to Key Ring.  
If unanswered, it rings the  
hunt destination for the  
No Answer Timer interval.  
If still unanswered, it rings  
the initial transferring des-  
tination for the 1601-03:  
Timer interval and then  
diverts to Key Ring.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
359  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Transfer  
Call Forwarding and Type 2 (Ring No Answer / Busy Line) Extension Hunting  
and  
Call Forwarding and Type 3 (Ring No Answer / Busy All) Extension Hunting  
Destination Extension  
Forwarding Type  
Ring No Answer  
Busy  
In DND  
Call rings destination for  
Recall Timer interval.  
If unanswered, it rings the  
forwarding destination for  
interval.  
Call rings the forwarding destination for the 1603-01:  
If unanswered, it rings the initial transferring destination  
and then diverts to Key Ring.  
Busy/No Answer  
*32  
If still unanswered, it rings  
the initial transferring des-  
ignating for the 1601-03:  
Timer interval and then  
diverts to Key Ring.  
Call rings the forwarding destination for the 1603-01: Transfer Recall Timer interval.  
If unanswered, it rings the initial transferring destination for the 1601-03: Call Forward No  
Answer Timer interval and then diverts to Key Ring.  
Immediate  
*34  
Call rings destination for  
Recall Timer interval.  
If unanswered, it rings the  
forwarding destination for  
interval.  
Call Rings the hunt destination for the 1603-01: Transfer  
Recall Timer interval.  
If unanswered, it rings the initial transferring destination  
and then diverts to Key Ring.  
No Answer  
*36  
If still unanswered, it rings  
the initial transferring des-  
tination for the 1601-03:  
Timer interval and then  
diverts to Key Ring.  
Call rings destination for  
Recall Timer interval.  
Forwarding Off  
*30  
If unanswered, it rings the  
hunt destination for the  
No Answer Timer interval.  
If still unanswered, it rings  
the initial transferring des-  
tination for the 1601-03:  
Timer interval and then  
diverts to Key Ring.  
360  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transfer  
Call Forwarding and Type 4 (Busy Line) Extension Hunting  
Destination Extension  
Forwarding Type  
Ring No Answer  
Busy  
In DND  
Call rings destination for  
Recall Timer interval.  
If unanswered, it rings the  
forwarding destination for  
interval.  
Call rings the forwarding destination for the 1603-01:  
If unanswered, it rings the initial transferring destination  
and then diverts to Key Ring.  
Busy/No Answer  
*32  
If still unanswered, it rings  
the initial transferring des-  
ignating for the 1601-03:  
Timer interval and then  
diverts to Key Ring.  
Call rings the forwarding destination for the 1603-01: Transfer Recall Timer interval.  
If unanswered, it rings the initial transferring destination for the 1601-03: Call Forward No  
Answer Timer interval and then diverts to Key Ring.  
Immediate  
*34  
Call rings destination for  
Recall Timer interval.  
If unanswered, it rings the  
forwarding destination for  
interval.  
Call Rings the hunt destination for the 1601-03: Call For-  
If unanswered, it rings the initial transferring destination  
and then diverts to Key Ring.  
No Answer  
*36  
If still unanswered, it rings  
the initial transferring des-  
tination for the 1601-03:  
Timer interval and then  
diverts to Key Ring.  
Call rings destination for  
Recall Timer interval.  
If unanswered, it rings the  
initial transferring destina-  
tion for the 1601-03: Call  
Forwarding Off  
*30  
Timer interval and then  
diverts to Key Ring.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
361  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transfer  
Programming  
Transfer Recall  
Does an unanswered Transfer ring an idle extension or Ring Group long enough before  
recalling the extension that initially transferred it?  
1.  
2.  
Does an unanswered Transfer Camp-On to a busy destination extension long enough before  
recalling the extension that initially transferred it?  
1. For non-operator extensions:  
2. For operator extensions:  
If a transferred call is not picked up, recalls the transferring extension and remains  
unanswered, does it divert to Key Ring after the correct interval?  
3.  
4.  
If a user transfers a call to a UCD Group, and it is not picked up, does it route to the  
programmed overow destination after the proper interval?  
Music on Hold for Transferred Callers  
1.  
While a transferred caller waits to be picked up, should they hear Music on Hold or ringback?  
1. To hear Music on Hold:  
- Make sure the music source is properly connected.  
2. To hear ringback:  
- 0 for none.  
- 1 for audio input minijack 1.  
- 2 for audio input minijack 2.  
- 3 for internal tone 1.  
- 4 for internal tone 2.  
- 5 for IntraMail Message On Hold. See Message On Hold (page 541) for more.  
362  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transfer  
Hotline Automatic Transfer  
When transferring, should the user be able to press Hotline (without rst pressingTRANSFER)  
to Transfer the call?  
1.  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
An extension user can use a Call Coverage key to Transfer a call to the covered extension.  
Call Forwarding will reroute transferred calls.  
Transfer can automatically Camp-On to a busy extension.  
You can press your DSS key to Transfer a call instead of dialing a co-worker’s extension number.  
DND blocks Transfer.  
An extension user cannot Transfer a call to a Door Box.  
With Extended Ringing enabled, transferred outside calls ring the destination extension for the Num-  
ber of Extended Rings before recalling the transferring extension.  
Outside calls transferred to a Terminal or Circular Hunting group member activate hunting. In addi-  
tion, outside calls transferred to a UCD Group master number activate hunting.  
An outside call transferred to an extension in a Pickup Group activates Group Call Pickup.  
An extension user can Transfer a call to a Ring Group master number. If unanswered, the call will  
recall the extension from which it was transferred.  
If an extension receiving a screened Transfer answers the screen and immediately hangs up (before the  
transferring extension), the call goes on Exclusive Hold at the transferring extension.  
An extension user can Transfer a call to their Hotline partner by pressing their Hotline key.  
The system cannot Transfer Intercom calls.  
An unanswered call transferred to an extension diverts to Key Ring if unanswered at the transferring  
extension.  
With Music on Hold enabled, transferred callers can optionally listen to ringback or MOH while their  
call waits at the transfer destination. Music on Hold will also play to transferred callers camped-on to  
a busy UCD Group.  
An extension user can Transfer their current call to a co-worker or voice mail and then answer the  
waiting call. In addition, transferred calls can initiate Off-Hook Signaling.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
363  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transfer  
While idle, an extension user can use their Reverse Voice Over key to Transfer calls.  
The system assigns the SMDR record to the last extension on the call. For example, if extension 306  
answers the call, talks for 20 minutes, and then Transfers the call to extension 302, extension 302  
“owns” the entire call record as soon as they hang up.  
• Pressing TRANSFER + Call Coverage Key can Transfer a call to an uninstalled extension’s mailbox  
(if the mailbox is enabled).  
• Pressing a Hotline key can also Transfer a call to an uninstalled extension’s mailbox (if the mailbox is  
enabled).  
An extension user can Voice Over after making a Screened Transfer and hearing busy/ring tone.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
364  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transfer  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Transfer  
To Transfer your call:  
1.  
2
Do not hang up.  
Press TRANSFER.  
Do one of the following.  
3.  
Dial your co-worker’s extension.  
• To Transfer your call directly to your co-worker’s mailbox, do this instead:  
a.  
- Press V-MAIL.  
- Dial their extension number.  
- Hang up.  
b.  
c.  
Press a DSS key.  
Dial a Ring Group or UCD Group master number.  
Press a Call Coverage or Hotline key.  
• If you have Hotline Automatic Transfer, you don’t have to pressTRANSFER before your Hot-  
line key.  
d.  
4.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Announce call to make a Screened Transfer, then hang up.  
Press the ashing line key to return to the call if your co-worker doesn’t want it.  
Hang up to send the call through unscreened.  
• The call will recall to you if unanswered by your co-worker. If you don’t answer the recall, the  
call diverts to Key Ring.  
c.  
d.  
Press V-MAIL to Transfer the call to your co-worker’s mailbox.  
5.  
If the transferred call is not picked up (i.e., recalls), you see one of the following.  
If the extension that transferred the call doesn’t have a name:  
Transfer Recall  
STA 301  
a.  
If the extension that transferred the call has a programmed name:  
Transfer Recall  
300: Attendant  
b.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
365  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transfer  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Transfer  
To Transfer a call to your co-worker’s speakerphone (i.e., use Handsfree Transfer):  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
While on an outside call:  
a.  
• Press TRANSFER.  
• Dial you co-worker’s extension number.  
b.  
Press Hotline key for your co-worker.  
Listen for two beeps.  
• If you hear ringing instead of two beeps, you cannot use Handsfree Transfer.  
2.  
3.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Press FLASH to send the call directly to your co-worker’s speakerphone.  
Press TRANSFER to get Intercom dial tone and select another co-worker for the Transfer.  
366  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Unsupervised Conference  
Unsupervised Conference  
Description  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
367  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
User Programmable Features  
User Programmable Features  
Description  
Extension users can set up their telephones to meet their own unique requirements.  
User Programmable Features allow an extension user to dial mnemonics to customize the way certain features  
work on their telephone. With User Programmable Features, there is no need to rely on a SystemAdministra-  
tor or Communications Manager to set up each phone. These User-Programmable Features include:  
Call Forwarding Clear All  
Direct Station Selection (DSS) Assignment  
Feature Key Assignment  
Feature Key Ringing for Call Coverage Keys, Group Call Pickup Keys, and Line Keys  
Headset Mode  
Hotline Key Assignment  
See Hotline (page 207) for more. (Note that a keyset user with a DSS Console can use the #HL user-pro-  
grammable procedure to change the Hotline assignments on their console.)  
Off Hook Signaling Setup (including Camp-On, Off Hook Ringing for outside calls, and Voice Over for  
Intercom calls)  
Paging (Incoming)  
Prime Line Assignment  
Programmable Idle Menu Soft Keys (Super Display)  
Ringing Line Preference  
Speed Dial Bin Setup (Personal and System)  
Time and Date  
Voice Announce (For incoming Intercom calls)  
User Programmable Features  
To program a feature, press # and the feature’s code. For example, to enable incoming Paging, press # and dial V PY, then  
SPEAKER to hang up. By default, Call Forwarding Clear All, System Speed Dial, and Time and Date are only available to  
the attendant.  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
Numeric  
Operation  
Access Level  
#CC  
#22  
Call Forwarding Clear All  
#CC +Y to clear (cancel) forwarding or N to  
4 and 5  
exit without clearing + SPEAKER to hang up.  
#HS  
#47  
Headset Mode  
#HS +Y to enable or N to disable + SPEAKER  
to exit.  
3-5  
368  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
User Programmable Features  
User Programmable Features  
To program a feature, press # and the feature’s code. For example, to enable incoming Paging, press # and dial V PY, then  
SPEAKER to hang up. By default, Call Forwarding Clear All, System Speed Dial, and Time and Date are only available to  
the attendant.  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
Numeric  
Operation  
Access Level  
#HL  
#45  
Hotline  
#HL + Press ashing Hotline key + Enter exten-  
sion for new Hotline partner + HOLD + Pro-  
gram another Hotline key or SPEAKER to exit.  
3-5  
#OHS  
#647  
Off Hook Signaling  
#OHS + Select mode (1 = Outside line  
,
2 =  
3-5  
Hotline partner, 3 = Intercom) + Select option  
(see below) + SPEAKER to exit.  
For outside lines: 1 = Camp-On tone, 2 = Off-  
hook Ringing, CLEAR = None  
For Hotline partner: 1 = Camp-On, 2 = Voice  
Over, CLEAR = None,  
For Intercom: 1 = Camp-On, 2 = Voice Over,  
CLEAR = None  
#VP  
#87  
Paging (Incoming)  
#VP +Y to enable or N to disable + SPEAKER  
to exit.  
3-5  
3-5  
#PLA  
#752  
Prime Line Assignment  
#PLA + Press one of your ashing programma-  
ble keys, INTERCOM, or CLEAR for none +  
SPEAKER to exit.  
#KP  
#57  
Feature Key Assignments  
#KP + Press key you want to program + HOLD  
+
3-5  
INTERCOM + Press Volume Up or Volume  
Down to select key option + HOLD + (Enter any  
1
additional data if required + HOLD) + Press  
Volume Up or Volume Down to select another  
key to program, or SPEAKER twice to exit.  
1
To set up a System Night key, press CLEAR  
instead of entering additional data.  
#RAC  
#722  
Feature Key Ringing  
Call Coverage Keys: #RAC + Call Coverage  
Key repeatedly to select ringing mode +  
SPEAKER to exit.  
2-5  
Call Coverage Keys ash as follows: Lamp only  
= On red, Immediate ring = On green, Delay  
ring = Fast ash green.  
#RAL  
#RAP  
#725  
#727  
Outside Line Keys: #RAL + Line Key repeatedly  
to select ringing mode + SPEAKER to exit.  
Line keys ash as follows: Lamp only = On red,  
Immediate ring = On green, Delay ring = Fast  
ash green, Night ring = Slow ash green.  
Group Call Pickup Keys: #RAP + Group Call  
Pickup Key repeatedly to select ringing mode +  
SPEAKER to exit.  
Group Call Pickup Keys ash as follows: Lamp  
only = On red, Immediate ring = On green,  
Delay ring = Fast ash green.  
#SM  
#76  
Programmable Idle Menu  
Soft Keys (Super Display)  
Press the soft key you want to program (or press  
Volume Up or Volume Down to scroll through  
the keys) + HOLD + INTERCOM +Volume Up  
or Volume Down to select key option + HOLD  
+ SPEAKER to exit.  
1-5  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
369  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
User Programmable Features  
User Programmable Features  
To program a feature, press # and the feature’s code. For example, to enable incoming Paging, press # and dial V PY, then  
SPEAKER to hang up. By default, Call Forwarding Clear All, System Speed Dial, and Time and Date are only available to  
the attendant.  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
Numeric  
Operation  
Access Level  
#RLP  
Ringing Line Preference  
#757  
#RLP +Y to enable or N to disable +  
2-5  
SPEAKER to exit.  
#SP  
#SP  
Speed Dial, Personal  
Speed Dial, System  
#77  
#77  
#SP + Press bin key (for bins 701-710) or dial  
the bin key (701-720) + HOLD + Dial outside  
line (e.g., 1), Line group (e.g., 90-98), or ICM  
for Intercom feature + HOLD + Number to store  
+ HOLD twice + Name + HOLD + Press another  
bin key or SPEAKER to exit.  
1-5  
#SP + Dial System Speed Dial bin number  
(e.g., 201) + HOLD + Dial outside line (e.g., 1),  
Line group (e.g., 90-98), or INTERCOM for  
Intercom feature + HOLD + Number to store +  
HOLD twice + Name + HOLD + Dial another  
System Speed Dial bin or SPEAKER to exit.  
4 and 5  
System Program Access  
Time and Date  
#*#*  
#*#* + Enter programming password  
3-5  
#TD  
#VA  
#83  
#82  
#TD + Enter time in 24-hour clock using hours  
(2 digits), minutes (2 digits) and seconds (2 dig-  
its) + HOLD + Enter date using month (2 digits),  
day (2 digits) and year (4 digits) + HOLD +  
SPEAKER to exit.  
4 and 5  
Intercom Voice Announce  
(for incoming Intercom  
calls)  
#VA + V for voice announce or R for ring +  
SPEAKER to exit.  
3-5  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Extension 300 has its access level xed at 5. (This means that by default only extension 300 can dial  
#TD to change the system time and date.)  
• All other extensions have access level 3.  
370  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
User Programmable Features  
Programming  
1.  
Assign an extension’s access level.  
- Access level 5 has the most capability (see the tables above). Access level 1 has the least capability.  
- By default, extension 300 has its access level xed at 5. All other extensions have Access Level 3.  
Other Related Features  
See the Feature heading in the above table.  
Operation  
See the Operation heading in the above table.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
371  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
Description  
Voice mail ends the frustration and cost of missed calls, inaccurate written messages and  
telephone tag, freeing up the company’s receptionists and secretaries for more production work.  
The system is fully compatible with IntraMail, UltraMail, and NVM-Series Voice Mail with Automated  
Attendant Systems. These systems provide telephone users with comprehensive voice mail and Automated  
Attendant features. Automated Attendant automatically answers the system’s incoming calls. After listening  
to a customized message, an outside caller can dial a system extension or use voice mail. When installing  
voice mail, refer to the documentation provided with your voice mail system for the specics.  
Integrated voice mail enhances the telephone system with the following features:  
Call Forwarding to Voice Mail  
An extension user can forward their calls to voice mail. Once forwarded, calls to the extension connect to  
that extension’s mailbox. The caller can leave a message in the mailbox instead of calling back later. For-  
warding can occur for all calls immediately, for unanswered calls or when the extension is busy, or just for  
unanswered calls.  
Leaving a Message  
Voice mail lets a keyset extension user easily leave a message at an extension that is unanswered, busy, or in  
Do Not Disturb. The caller just presses V-MAIL to leave a message in the called extension’s mailbox. There  
is no need to call back later.  
Transferring to Voice Mail  
By using Transfer to Voice Mail, an extension user can Transfer a call to the user’s own or a co-worker’s  
mailbox. After the Transfer goes through, the caller can leave a message in the mailbox. The caller will hear  
the entire mailbox greeting after the Transfer goes through.  
Conversation Record  
While on a call, an extension user can have voice mail record the conversation. The keyset user just presses  
their Record key. Once recorded, the voice mail stores the conversation as a new message in the user’s mail-  
box. After calling their mailbox, a user can save, edit or delete the recorded conversation. The ability to use  
Conversation Record is controlled by an extension’s Class of Service.  
Caution  
The use of monitoring, recording, or listening devices to eavesdrop, monitor, retrieve, or record telephone  
conversations or other sound activities, whether or not contemporaneous with transmission, may be ille-  
gal in certain circumstances under federal or state laws. Legal advice should be sought prior to imple-  
menting any practice that monitors or records any telephone conversation. Some federal and state laws  
require some form of notication to all parties to a telephone conversation, such as using a beep tone or  
other notication methods or requiring the consent of all parties to the telephone conversation, prior to  
monitoring or recording the telephone conversation.Some of these laws incorporate strict penalties.  
Conversation Record Key for a Co-worker’s Mailbox  
An extension user can have a Record key for a co-worker’s mailbox. While on a call, the user can press the  
key to record their conversation directly into the co-worker’s mailbox. The user can set up the Record key to  
record into any valid Subscriber Mailbox (including IntraMail Group Mailboxes and Master Mailboxes pro-  
grammed as Subscriber Mailboxes). This could help a dispatcher, for example, that wants to record a conver-  
sation with a client right into the responsible technician’s mailbox.  
An extension can have multiple Record keys, each associated with a different mailbox. In addition, setting  
up a Record key for a co-worker’s mailbox is also available on DSS Consoles.  
372  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Voice Mail  
Personal Answering Machine Emulation  
Refer to Call Screening (page 453). You may nd that Call Screening better meets your requirements.  
A keyset user can have their idle extension emulate a personal answering machine. This lets voice mail  
screen their calls, just like their answering machine at home. If activated, the extension’s incoming calls  
route to the user’s Subscriber Mailbox. Once the mailbox answers, the user hears the caller’s incoming mes-  
sage. The keyset user can then:  
Let the call go through to their mailbox.  
Intercept the call before it goes to their mailbox.  
Personal Answering Machine Emulation will intercept the following types of calls:  
Intercom calls  
Direct Inward Lines to the extension  
Automated Attendant Unscreened Transfers  
Automated Attendant Screened Transfers  
Personal Answering Machine Emulation will not intercept a call manually transferred to an extension.  
Voice Mail Overow  
Voice mail can be the overow destination for the following types of calls (refer to the individual features for  
the specics):  
A line that directly rings an extension can overow to voice mail.  
A line that rings an Extension Hunting group can overow to voice mail.  
A line that rings a group of extensions can overow to voice mail.  
A line ringing an extension’s line keys can overow to voice mail.  
Message Center Mailbox  
A Message Center Mailbox is a mailbox shared by more than one extension. Any keyset that has a Message  
Center Key for the shared mailbox can:  
Listen to the messages stored in the mailbox.  
Transfer calls to the shared mailbox.  
Use many other voice mail features previously available only at an extension’s individual mailbox.  
A Message Center Mailbox helps co-workers that work together closely - such as members of the same  
Pickup Group. For example, the group supervisor can send important messages to the shared Message Cen-  
ter Mailbox, to which any group member can respond when time allows. Each group member’s Message  
Center Key ashes (green) when messages are waiting.  
Interactive Soft Key Shows New Messages  
The Display and Super Display Telephone interactive soft keys show the number of new messages in the  
user’s mailbox. For example, if a Display Telephone user has 2 new messages in their mailbox, their voice  
mail soft key shows: VM02. If a Super Display Telephone user has 2 new messages in their mailbox, their  
voice mail soft key shows V-Mail 02. The new message count resets to 00 as soon as the user calls their mail-  
box (regardless of whether the new messages were listened to). The message count returns when the system  
updates the Ring/Message lamp on the phone.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
373  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Voice Mail  
Call Forwarding Timers and Voice Mail  
The following diagram shows how the system handles an outside call transferred to an extension that is for-  
warded to voice mail.  
Transferred Outside Call to Forwarded Extension  
Extension A transfers line to extension B, which  
is forwarded Busy/No Answer (type 2) to exten-  
sion C.  
The line rings extension B for the Transfer Recall  
If unanswered, the call then rings extension C  
(the forward destination) for the Call Forward  
Ring No Answer time.  
If still unanswered, the call rings the extension  
that initially transferred the call (A) for the Call  
Forward Ring No Answer time.  
If still unanswered, call diverts to Key Ring.  
Conditions  
• If an extension has a ashing Ring/Message lamp and the system resets or power fails, the lamp con-  
tinues to ash after the system restarts.  
• When using SLIU PCBs, the number of external voice mail ports you can install is limited by avail-  
able system DTMF receivers.  
• When the system rings an idle voice mail port, it will continue to ring the port until answered. The call  
will not cycle to a another member of the UCD Group (as it will for voice calls).  
• The system will never send a loop supervision disconnect signal (i.e., drop pulse) to voice mail ports.  
Default Setting  
Voice mail is not installed.  
374  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Voice Mail  
Programming  
Basic Installation  
1.  
To install IntraMail:  
1. Turn the system off.  
2. Plug in the IntraMail CompactFlash card.  
- In DSX-40, the card plugs directly into the equipment cabinet.  
- In DSX-80/160, the card plugs into the CPU PCB.  
3. Normally, you should leave the following at their default settings:  
4. Turn the system on.  
- The IntraMail will automatically install.  
5. Add additional IntraMail mailboxes as required.  
- In 2141-01: Station Mailbox Type (page 766), enter 1. This enables a Subscriber Mailbox for the  
extension.  
- By default in DSX-80/160, the rst 16 mailboxes are enabled (extensions 300-315).  
- By default in DSX-40, the rst 8 mailboxes are enabled (extensions 300-307).  
2.  
To install UltraMail (DSX-80/160 only):  
1. Plug the UltraMail PCB into any available slot (2-8).  
- UltraMail will automatically install.  
- Refer to the UltraMail/Aspire Mail System Guide for the specics.  
2. Normally, you should leave the following at their default settings:  
3.  
To install NVM-Series:  
1. For analog NVM-Series (such as NVM-2e):  
- Plug each voice mail port into a corresponding analog port in the DSX system.  
tion numbers 201-208 as required.  
2. For digital NVM-Series (such as Digital VANGARD):  
- Plug each voice mail port into a corresponding digital port in the DSX System.  
tion numbers 201, 203, 205, and 207 as required.  
numbers 202, 204, 206, and 208 as required.  
- When complete, the assignments for an 8-port Digital VANGARD would be as follows:  
NVM-Series Station Port Assignments  
Port 1  
Port 2  
Port 3  
Port 4  
201  
203  
205  
207  
Primary (1202)  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
375  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Mail  
NVM-Series Station Port Assignments  
Port 1  
Port 2  
Port 3  
Port 4  
202  
204  
206  
208  
Secondary (1203)  
4. Normally, you should leave the following at their default settings:  
5. Follow the System Guide provided with your NVM-Series to start and program your voice mail.  
376  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Mail  
Automated Attendant Answering  
1.  
To set up the Automated Attendant to answer calls during the day:  
2. To control the day/night mode of lines terminated to voice mail during the day, set up a UCD night key  
on your extension or DSS Console.  
- To set up a UCD night key on an extension:  
- To set up a UCD night key on a DSS Console:  
2.  
To set up the Automated Attendant to answer calls only at night:  
2. If the line is set to Key Ring during the day, set up a System night key control the day/night mode of the line.  
- To set up a System night key on an extension:  
- To set up a System night key on a DSS Console:  
3.  
Enable the extension to put the system into the night mode.  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
- This capability is normally reserved only for attendants.  
Voice Mail Overow  
1.  
Should outside calls overow to voice mail if unanswered?  
1. If yes for day mode answering:  
- An extension  
- A Ring Group  
- Another UCD Group master number (including the voice mail master number)  
2. If no for day mode answering:  
3. If yes for night mode answering:  
- An extension  
- A Ring Group  
- Another UCD Group master number (including the voice mail master number)  
4. If no for night mode answering:  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
377  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Mail  
Do unanswered calls ring the overow destination for the proper interval before diverting to  
Key Ring?  
2.  
When all voice mail ports are busy, should the caller wait for an idle port or overow to an  
alternate destination?  
3.  
1. To wait for an idle port:  
2. To overow:  
The destination can be:  
- An Extension number  
- A UCD Group master number (700-707)  
- A Voice mail master number (700)  
- A Ring Group master number (600-607)  
Conversation Record  
1.  
Should extension be able to use Conversation Record?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2.  
Optionally put a Record key on the extension or DSS Console.  
You can use the Record [Rec] soft key in lieu of a Record Feature Key.  
1. To set up a Record key on an extension:  
should record the conversation (i.e., your own or a co-worker’s).  
2. To set up Record key on a DSS Console:  
mailbox should record the conversation (i.e., your own or a co-worker’s).  
Message Center  
1.  
Set up Message Center keys on the extension or DSS Console.  
1. To set up a Message Center key on an extension:  
2. To set up Message Center key on a DSS Console:  
3. For more on Message Center, see the System Guide that came with your voice mail.  
378  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Mail  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Voice mail callout features (such as Message Notication) may interact with Account Codes if the  
callout number contains # characters.  
• STRF transfers to the attendant from the voice mail Automated Attendant ash the Operator Call key  
and the Ring Indicator lamp. The call does not ash a line/loop key. (Note that Ringing Line Prefer-  
ence will not pick up a call ringing the attendant’s Operator Call key.)  
• UTRF transfers to the attendant from the voice mail Automated Attendant ash the line’s line/loop key  
and the Ring Indicator lamp.  
You can forward calls voice mail.  
Caller ID fully integrates with NVM-Series voice mail systems.  
• The voice mail Automated Attendant will answer a DIL terminated to the voice mail Master Number.  
If a DIL is terminated to the voice mail master number, a System Mode key (code 18 + the voice mail  
number) controls the night mode status of the DIL.  
A DSS Console can have voice mail Record and Message Center keys.  
• To set up extension overow to voice mail:  
-
In 2115-01: Hunt Destination (page 746), designate the voice mail master number as the Hunt  
Destination.  
- Unanswered calls, in addition to calls to the extension while it is busy or in DND, route to the  
extension’s mailbox.  
• For Terminal and Circular Hunting, unsupervised transfers (UTRF) from the voice mail Automated  
Attendant route like outside calls. Supervised transfers (STRF) from the voice mail Automated Atten-  
dant route like Intercom calls. In either case, unanswered calls eventually route to the initially called  
extension’s mailbox.  
• When an extension user with Ring No Answer/Busy Terminal Hunting to voice mail parks a call at a  
co-worker’s extension, the call recalls to them if not picked up. If still unanswered, the call diverts to  
Key Ring.  
A system can have either voice mail or Message Waiting activated — not both.  
If the Ringdown destination is the voice mail master number, the Ringdown Extension user hears the  
voice mail remote logon prompt (“Please enter your mailbox number”) after the call connects.  
• Pressing TRANSFER + Call Coverage Key can Transfer a call to an uninstalled extension’s mailbox  
(if the mailbox is enabled).  
• Pressing a Hotline key can also Transfer a call to an uninstalled extension’s mailbox (if the mailbox is  
enabled).  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
379  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Mail  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
The Voice Mail Basics  
To call your mailbox:  
(Optional) Check the status of your mailbox.  
• On your display, V-Mail xx [VMxx] is the number of new messages in your mailbox.  
• In addition, your Ring/Message lamp ashes fast (red) when you have new messages.  
1.  
Press V-MAIL.  
2.  
3.  
V-MAIL is on (red) while you are connected to your mailbox.  
If requested, enter your Security Code.  
To hang up while using your mailbox:  
Press V-MAIL.  
• The key goes out.  
1.  
To leave a message in the mailbox of an unanswered extension:  
• The extension can be busy, in DND, or unanswered.  
Press V-MAIL.  
Voice mail will prompt you to leave a message.  
1.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Activating or Canceling Call Forwarding to your Mailbox  
To activate or cancel Call Forwarding to your mailbox:  
1.  
Select the Call Forwarding options.  
[Menu + Call Forward]  
[Menu + Cfwd]  
Alternately do one of the following:  
• Press INTERCOM and dial *3.  
• Press your Call Forwarding Feature Key.  
2.  
Select or cancel a Call Forwarding type.  
[Immediate]  
[Imm]  
Select Call Forwarding Immediate.  
• Alternately dial 4.  
[Ring/No Ans]  
[RNA]  
Select Call Forwarding when Not Answered.  
• Alternately dial 6.  
[Busy/No Ans]  
[BNA]  
Select Call Forwarding when Busy or Not Answered.  
• Alternately dial 2.  
[None]  
[MORE + MORE + NONE]  
Select to cancel Call Forwarding.  
• Alternately dial 0.  
3.  
4.  
Press V-MAIL.  
Select the Call Forwarding mode.  
[All]  
[All]  
Select forwarding all calls.  
Alternately dial 2.  
[Line Only]  
[Line]  
Select forwarding outside calls only.  
Alternately dial 8.  
380  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Mail  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Transferring Calls to a Mailbox  
To Transfer your active call to a mailbox:  
Method A (Ring rst, then Transfer)  
1.  
2.  
Press TRANSFER.  
Dial the number of the mailbox to receive the Transfer.  
You can optionally press the DSS key for your co-worker.  
• To transfer the call to your own mailbox, dial your extension number.  
Press V-MAIL and hang up.  
3.  
4.  
Voice mail will prompt your caller to leave a message.  
• The caller will hear the entire mailbox greeting after the Transfer goes through.  
Press SPEAKER to hang up.  
Method B (Transfer without rst ringing)  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Press TRANSFER.  
Press V-MAIL.  
Dial the number of the mailbox to receive the Transfer.  
You can optionally press the DSS key for your co-worker.  
Voice mail will prompt your caller to leave a message.  
• The caller will hear the entire mailbox greeting after the Transfer goes through.  
4.  
Press SPEAKER to hang up.  
Method C (Using a Call Coverage or Hotline key)  
Press TRANSFER.  
• If your extension has Hotline Automatic Transfer, skip this step.  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Press the Call Coverage or Hotline key.  
Press V-MAIL.  
Voice mail will prompt your caller to leave a message.  
• The caller will hear the entire mailbox greeting after the Transfer goes through.  
4.  
Press SPEAKER to hang up.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
381  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Mail  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Conversation Record  
To record your active call in a mailbox:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
Press a Record Feature Key on your extension or DSS Console.  
• The record key can be assigned to yours or a co-worker’s mailbox.  
• The key will ash fast (green) on your keyset; ash fast (red) on your DSS Console.  
a.  
[Record]  
[Rec]  
Select to record your conversation.  
• The Conversation Record soft key is only available for outside calls.  
b.  
Once recording begins:  
2.  
You and your caller hear the voice prompt “Recording.”  
You see: RECORD MAILBOX XXX  
(where XXX is the number of the mailbox into which the conversation is recording).  
To turn Conversation Record off:  
Do one of the following.  
• The portion of the call already recorded is sent to your mailbox as a new message.  
1.  
a.  
b.  
Press V-MAIL.  
Press a Record Feature Key on your extension or DSS Console.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using the Message Center  
To call the Message Center:  
(Optional) Check the status of the Message Center.  
• The Message Center key ashes fast when there are new messages waiting in the Message Center Mailbox.  
1.  
2.  
If requested, enter your Security Code.  
• The Message Center key goes out.  
To Transfer a call to the Message Center:  
1.  
2.  
While on an Intercom or outside call, press the Message Center key.  
Hang up.  
Your caller will be prompted to leave a message in the Message Center Mailbox.  
382  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Mail  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Answering Machine Emulation  
To activate or cancel Personal Answering Machine Emulation:  
• Refer to Call Screening (page 453). You may nd that Call Screening better meets your requirements.  
1.  
Select the Call Forwarding options.  
[Menu + Call Forward]  
[Menu + Cfwd]  
Alternately do one of the following:  
• Press INTERCOM and dial *3.  
• Press your Call Forwarding Feature Key.  
2.  
Select or cancel a Personal Answering Machine Emulation.  
[Ans Machine]  
[MORE + AME]  
Select Personal Answering Machine Emulation.  
• Alternately dial 7.  
[None]  
[MORE + MORE + NONE]  
Select to cancel Call Forwarding.  
• Alternately dial 0.  
3.  
Select the Call Forwarding mode.  
[All]  
[All]  
Select forwarding all calls.  
Alternately dial 2.  
[Line Only]  
[Line]  
Select forwarding outside calls only.  
Alternately dial 8.  
When Personal Answering Machine Emulation broadcasts your caller’s voice:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
c.  
Do nothing to have the caller’s message automatically recorded in your mailbox.  
Press SPEAKER or lift the handset to intercept the call.  
• If your extension is in the headset mode, you can only press SPEAKER.  
With Call Screening disabled:  
Press V-MAIL to stop the broadcast and send the call directly to your mailbox.  
With Call Screening enabled:  
Press V-MAIL to switch to the Call Screening mode.  
d.  
Refer to Call Screening (page 453). You may nd that Call Screening better meets your requirements.  
User Programmable Features  
Setting up a Conversation Record Key  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#KP (#57)  
Operation  
Access Level  
Voice Mail  
#KP + Press key you want to program + HOLD + Dial 17  
+ Enter mailbox number or 0 for your own mailbox +  
HOLD + SPEAKER twice to exit.  
3-5  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
383  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Voice Mail  
Setting up a Message Center Key  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
Operation  
Access Level  
#KP (#57)  
Voice Mail  
#KP + Press key you want to program + HOLD + Dial 24  
+ Enter mailbox number + HOLD + CONF + SPEAKER  
twice to exit.  
3-5  
384  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Over  
Voice Over  
Description  
Get through to a co-worker busy on a handset call — without interrupting their call.  
Voice Over lets a user get through to a keyset extension user busy on a handset call. With Voice Over, the  
busy keyset extension user hears an alert tone followed by the voice of the interrupting party. The keyset  
extension user can respond to the interrupting party without being heard by the original caller. If desired, the  
keyset extension user can easily switch between their original caller and the interrupting co-worker. The  
original caller and the interrupting party can never hear each other’s conversation.  
Voice Over could help a lawyer, for example, waiting for an urgent call. While on a call with another client, the  
lawyer’s paralegal could announce the urgent call as soon as it comes in. The lawyer could then give the para-  
legal instructions on how to handle the situation — all without the original client hearing the conversation.  
Either a keyset or SLT can initiate a Voice Over, but only a keyset can receive a Voice Over.  
Voice Over uses a system Conference circuit. The following table shows the system’s Conference capacities:  
Description  
Capacity  
Conference circuits  
32  
32  
Maximum simultaneous users in Conference  
(total of all Conferences system-wide)  
Maximum simultaneous conferences  
8
8
Maximum parties in any one Conference  
(lines and/or extensions)  
The system’s 32 Conference circuits are dynamically allocated as users request them.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
1.  
When an Intercom call is waiting, should the extension be able to receive a Voice Over?  
naling or 1 (Camp-On).  
When an Intercom call from their Hotline partner’s Hotline key is waiting, should the extension  
be able to receive a Voice Over?  
2.  
Signaling or 1 (Camp-On).  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
385  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Voice Over  
Other Related Features  
Features  
An operator cannot receive a Voice Over from a co-worker since their extension is never busy to Inter-  
com callers.  
An extension can Voice Over after calling a co-worker by pressing their Call Coverage key.  
An extension user cannot Voice Over to a co-worker busy on a Conference call.  
An extension can Voice Over after using Direct Station Selection to call a co-worker.  
An extension user cannot Voice Over to a co-worker in the headset mode.  
An extension can Voice Over after calling a co-worker by pressing their Hotline key.  
An extension user can Voice Over to a co-worker busy on an Intercom call.  
An extension user cannot leave a Message Waiting after using Voice Over.  
When a user is busy on a call, Off-Hook Signaling indicates that another caller is trying to get through.  
An SLT can initiate a Voice Over but cannot receive a Voice Over.Hotline (page 207)  
An extension user can Voice Over after calling a co-worker by using Personal Speed Dial.Hotline  
An extension user can Voice Over after making a Screened Transfer and hearing busy/ring tone.Hot-  
IntraMail Features  
None  
386  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Over  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Voice Over  
To initiate a Voice Over to a busy extension:  
Listen for busy/ring tone.  
• If you don’t hear busy ring, you cannot Voice Over.  
1.  
2.  
Do one of the following.  
[Vovr]  
[Voice Over]  
a.  
b.  
Press to select Voice Over, then speak with your co-worker.  
Dial 9, then speak with your co-worker.  
To respond to a Voice Over alert one to your extension:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Listen for two beeps while on a call.  
Press and hold MUTE.  
Release MUTE to talk to your initial caller.  
You can repeat this procedure as long as Voice Over initiator doesn’t hang up.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
387  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Volume, Brightness, and Contrast Controls  
Volume, Brightness, and Contrast Controls  
Description  
Easily adjust the volume of ringing, Paging, and other features.  
A keyset user can press Volume Up and Volume Down to interactively adjust the volume of the following  
features while they are active:  
Intercom handset calls  
Intercom Handsfree calls  
Outside handset calls  
Outside Handsfree calls  
Paging receive volume  
Background Music  
Ringing  
Off-Hook Ringing  
There are nine steps in the Volume Control adjustment range. This makes it easier for the keyset user to set  
up just the right volume levels. The settings a user makes are retained after a system reset or power-down.  
Volume Control Presets  
The volume control presets allow the keyset user to preset the default volume for Ringing, Off-Hook Ring-  
ing, and incoming Page announcements while their telephone is idle. Presets for the remaining volume con-  
trols are not required since the user can easily adjust those volumes while idle. For example, to adjust the  
volume of Background Music, just press HOLD to active BGM and then adjust the volume.  
Display Brightness and Contrast Control  
While a keyset is idle, pressing Volume Up or Volume Down adjusts the contrast of the display. There are  
eight user-selectable contrast control values. The value a user sets is “remembered” by the system and auto-  
matically restored in the event of a power down or system reset.  
Display Brightness and Contrast Control Presets  
The brightness and contrast control presets let the keyset user preset the default active brightness, idle  
brightness, and contrast for their keyset display. The brightness presets are not available to a 24-button key-  
set since it doesn’t offer a backlit display.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
388  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Volume, Brightness, and Contrast Controls  
Programming  
Volume Settings  
1.  
Should the system remember the volume settings you set for outside calls?  
Display Backlight and Key Pad Illumination Controls  
2.  
Set up the telephone display backlight and key pad illumination controls.  
1. These options do not apply to 24-button keysets since they have neither backlit displays nor illuminated  
key pads.  
it is active.  
- 0 for backlight off  
- 1 - 8 for relative brightness settings 1-8  
is idle.  
- 0 for backlight off  
- 1 - 8 for relative brightness settings 1-8  
4. In 1605-05: Backlight Idle Timer (page 681), set how long (1-99 seconds) an extension must be idle  
before it reverts to its idle backlight brightness setting.  
5. In 2104-03: Key Pad Illumination (page 729), enable (1) or disable (0) the key pad illumination.  
- If enabled, the key pad will illuminate when the backlit display is active.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
While a feature is active, pressing a VOLUME key adjusts the volume of the active feature. While the  
telephone is idle, pressing a VOLUME key adjusts the display contrast. A system reset or power down  
returns the user-set contrast setting to a median level.  
The extension user cannot adjust the volume of incoming Camp-On tones.  
The default Intercom (station-to-station) gain is 0 dB. While on an Intercom call, use Volume Up and  
Volume Down to change this setting.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
389  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Volume, Brightness, and Contrast Controls  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Adjusting your Telephone’s Volume  
To interactively adjust the volume while a feature is active:  
While the feature is active, press Volume Up and Volume Down.  
• Pressing Volume Up and Volume Down while idle adjusts the telephone’s display contrast.  
1
To adjust the display contrast:  
While your telephone is idle, press Volume Up and Volume Down.  
You see a display similar to: Contrast ------ 4  
1.  
• If you see BGM instead, your telephone is in the Background Music mode. Press HOLD and try again.  
To set up the volume control presets:  
[Menu + Volume]  
[Menu + MORE + Vol]  
1.  
2.  
Select the volume control preset mode.  
Do one of the following.  
[Ring]  
[Ring]  
Select to preset the ringing volume.  
When you see Ring ------, press Volume Up and Volume Down to adjust  
the incoming ring volume (1-9).  
a.  
[Off-Hook Ring]  
[Ofhk]  
Select to preset the off-hook ringing volume.  
When you see OffHk Ring ------, press Volume Up and Volume Down to  
adjust the Off-Hook Ringing volume (1-9).  
b.  
[Page]  
[Page]  
Select to preset the Page receive volume (1-9).  
When you see Page ------, press Volume Up and Volume Down to adjust  
the incoming Page volume.  
c.  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
d.  
Select to exit the Volume Control preset mode.  
390  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Volume, Brightness, and Contrast Controls  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Adjusting your Telephone’s Volume  
To set up the display brightness, contrast control, and dial pad illummination presets:  
[Menu + Display]  
[Menu + MORE (2 or 3 times) + Dsply]  
1.  
2.  
Select the display preset mode.  
Do one of the following.  
[Contrast]  
[Cont]  
Select the display contrast preset.  
When you see Contrast ------, press Volume Up and Volume Down to set  
the contrast preset (0-8).  
a.  
[Brightness + Active]  
[Brght + Actv]  
Select the active brightness preset.  
When you see Active ------, press Volume Up and Volume Down to set the  
active brightness preset (0-8).  
b.  
[Brightness + Idle]  
[Brght + Idle]  
Select the idle brightness preset.  
When you see Idle ------, press Volume Up and Volume Down to set the  
idle brightness preset (0-8).  
c.  
[Dial Pad]  
[DlPad]  
T select the dial pad illumination preset, do one of the following.  
d.  
[On]  
[On]  
Turn dial pad illumination on.  
[Off]  
[Off]  
Turn dial pad illumination off.  
[Exit]  
Select to exit the display brightness and contrast control presets.  
Select to exit the display brightness and contrast control presets.  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
3.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
391  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Walking Class of Service  
Walking Class of Service  
Description  
An extension user can temporarily use their Toll Restriction and Class of Service options at a  
co-worker’s phone.  
Walking Class of Service allows an extension user to temporarily implement their Toll Restriction and Class  
of Service settings at a co-worker’s keyset. This is normally used to override dialing restrictions at a tele-  
phone. For example, an executive with an unrestricted phone can walk to any keyset in the building, imple-  
ment Walking Class of Service, and dial without restriction. After the keyset goes idle, Walking Class of  
Service remains in effect for 10 seconds. This permits the user to make multiple calls before the keyset  
returns to its normal restrictions.  
Walking Class of Service and Extension Locking  
Walking Class of Service overrides Extension Locking. For example:  
Extension 301 is permitted by their Class of Service and Toll Restriction to use Paging and place long  
distance calls.  
Extension 306 locks their extension. While locked, Class of Service 15 prevents Paging and Toll Level 7  
prevents long distance calls. These features are no longer available at extension 306.  
The extension 301 user goes to extension 306 and implements Walking Class of Service.  
The extension 301 user can then use 306 to make long distance calls and Page (even though 306 was  
locked to prevent those features).  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Day and Night Walking Class of Service disabled in an extension’s Class of Service.  
Programming  
1.  
Should extension have Walking Class of Service capability?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2. If yes:  
- For day mode Walking Class of Service, in 1412-01: Walking Class of Service (Day) (page 649),  
enterYes.  
enterYes.  
- In 2102-05: Station PIN Code (page 725), enter the extension’s PIN code (four digits, using 0-9, #  
and *).  
3. If no:  
- To prevent day mode Walking Class of Service, in 1412-01: Walking Class of Service (Day)  
- To prevent night mode Walking Class of Service, in 1412-02: Walking Class of Service (Night)  
392  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Walking Class of Service  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Extension Locking and Walking Class of Service share the same PIN code.  
Walking Class of Service is not available to single line telephone users.  
When an extension user implements Walking Class of Service and places an outside call, the system  
assigns the SMDR record to the users’s extension. The system does not assign the record to the exten-  
sion at which the call was placed. For example, if the extension 301 user walks to extension 306,  
implements Walking Class of Service and dials an outside call, the SMDR record is assigned to exten-  
sion 301. It is not assigned to extension 306.  
IntraMail Features  
None  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Walking Class of Service  
To enable Walking Class of Service at a co-worker’s extension:  
1.  
2.  
Press INTERCOM.  
Dial ##0.  
You see:  
WALKING COS  
ENTER EXTENSION:  
Enter your own extension number + HOLD.  
You see:  
3.  
4.  
xxx: WALKING COS  
ENTER PIN CODE:  
Enter your own PIN number + HOLD.  
You’ll hear error tone if your extension does not have Walking Class of Service capability.  
• If your entry is not accepted, you have either entered the wrong PIN number or your extension has no PIN  
number assigned.  
Place any call or use any feature allowed by your Toll Restriction and Class of Service settings.  
You can place additional calls.  
• Walking Class of Service automatically deactivates if the extension is idle for longer than 10 seconds.  
5.  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Entering or ChangingYour PIN Number  
To enter your PIN number (if you don’t have one assigned):  
1.  
2.  
Press INTERCOM and dial ##6.  
When you see ENTER NEW PIN:  
• Enter your new PIN number + HOLD.  
• When entering your PIN number:  
- CLEAR erases your entire entry.  
- REDIAL backspaces over (erases) the last digit entered.  
When you see REENTER NEW PIN:  
• Conrm your entry by reentering your new PIN number.  
3.  
DSX Software Manual  
Features  
393  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Walking Class of Service  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Entering or ChangingYour PIN Number  
4.  
When you see NEW PIN ACCEPTED:  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
To change your PIN number (if you already have one assigned):  
1.  
2.  
Press INTERCOM and dial ##6.  
When you see ENTER PIN CODE:  
• Enter your current PIN number + HOLD.  
When you see ENTER NEW PIN:  
3.  
• Enter your new PIN number + HOLD.  
• When entering your PIN number:  
- CLEAR erases your entire entry.  
- REDIAL backspaces over (erases) the last digit entered.  
When you see REENTER NEW PIN:  
• Conrm your entry by reentering your new PIN number.  
4.  
5.  
When you see NEW PIN ACCEPTED:  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
Select to exit PIN number programming.  
394  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IntraMail  
Features  
Introduction  
Introduction  
How To Use This Chapter  
If you are not familiar with the IntraMail features, review  
the IntraMail Feature Glossary on page 402.  
This chapter provides detailed information on the IntraMail features. Similar to the Features chapter, the  
IntraMail features in this chapter are in alphabetical order, like a dictionary. This chapter subdivides each  
feature denition into headings as follows:  
Description  
Read Description to get an overview of the feature, its benet, any special considerations you should be  
aware of, and how it works in the default system. For specic default settings on each IntraMail pro-  
grammable option, follow the cross-reference to that option.  
Programming  
Here you’ll nd easy to follow step-by-step programming instructions on how to activate and/or customize  
the IntraMail feature. If you need more detail about an option, follow the cross-reference to that option.  
Other Related Features  
Other Related Features shows you at a glance how the feature interacts with other IntraMail features.  
Operation  
Operation provides convenient operation charts for each IntraMail feature (similar to the charts used in  
the Features chapter).  
Start-Up (Default) Configuration  
Without IntraMail Installed  
With IntraMail Installed  
IntraMail automatically assigns a mailbox to each extension in the number plan.  
By default in DSX-40, only the rst 8 (300-307) Subscriber Mailboxes are active/enabled.  
By default in DSX-80/160, only the rst 16 (300-315) subscriber mailboxes are active/enabled.  
The IntraMail Automated Attendant does not answer outside calls.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
395  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Start-Up Programming  
Start-Up Programming  
Start-Up IntraMail Programming  
1.  
Enable the mailboxes for all installed extensions (not for Built-In Automated Attendant).  
1. Add additional IntraMail mailboxes as required.  
- In 2141-01: Station Mailbox Type (page 766), enter 1. This enables a Subscriber Mailbox for the  
extension.  
- By default in DSX-80/160, the rst 16 mailboxes are enabled (extensions 300-315).  
- By default in DSX-40, the rst 8 mailboxes are enabled (extensions 300-307).  
2.  
3.  
4.  
Set up the Automated Attendant to answer outside calls during the day.  
Set up the Automated Attendant to answer outside calls at night.  
Check the Answer Table assignment.  
- Initially, you should leave all lines assigned to Answer Table 1.  
5.  
Review the default Automated Attendant setup.  
1. The block diagram below shows the default Automated Attendant conguration.  
3112-01: Direct Termination (Day)  
DIL to Voice Mail  
3112-04: Direct Termination (Night)  
Master (700)  
Automated Attendant Answering (Default)  
Lines Route to  
Answer Table 1  
3131-02: Answer Table  
Answer Table 1  
421x-Answer Table  
Dial Action Table 1  
Dialing Options  
Dial an extension number, or  
0 for the operator  
Calls always route to Call Routing Mailbox 001  
4212: Schedule  
Schedule 1 or  
Default Mailbox  
-
-
Schedule 1 active M-F 8:30AM-5:00PM.  
Default Mailbox active all other times.  
4211-01: Default Mailbox  
To record a new Instruction Menu  
All Lines  
Call Routing  
Mailbox 001  
Message (from Extension 300):  
422x: Routing Mailboxes (001)  
Automated Attendant  
V-MAIL + SA + I + 001  
Built-In Automated Attendant  
#AG + 001  
Dial Action  
Table 1  
423x: Dial Action Tables  
With these  
dialing options  
Use Answer  
Table 1  
Which Chooses Call  
Routing Mailbox 001.  
And Dial Action  
Table 1  
396  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Start-Up Programming  
6.  
Review this additional programming (not for Built-In Automated Attendant).  
1. Normally, you should leave the following programs at their default settings:  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
397  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications  
Specications  
Specifications  
Built-In Automated Attendant Capacities  
Routing Mailboxes:. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8  
Call Routing: . . . . . 8  
Mailboxes  
Announcement: . . . 0  
Subscriber:. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0  
Ring Group Mailboxes:. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0  
UCD Group Mailboxes: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0  
Total: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8  
Ports:  
2
Storage Hours:  
30 seconds for each Call Routing Mailbox  
Does not provide voice mail.  
IntraMail Part Numbers and Capacities  
P/N 1091011  
P/N 1091013  
Mailboxes  
IntraMail 4 Port/8 Hour  
IntraMail 8 Port/16 Hour  
DSX-40  
Routing Mailboxes:. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16  
Announcement: . . . 8  
Call Routing: . . . . . 8  
Subscriber:. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34  
Ring Group Mailboxes:. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8  
UCD Group Mailboxes: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8  
Total: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66  
DSX-80/160  
Routing Mailboxes:. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16  
Announcement: . . . 8  
Call Routing: . . . . . 8  
Subscriber:. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128  
Ring Group Mailboxes:. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8  
UCD Group Mailboxes: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8  
Total: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160  
Ports:  
4 or 8  
Storage Hours:  
8 or 16  
398  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Application Examples  
Application Examples  
Examples of Some Common Applications  
The examples below show some common applications. The chart in the beginning of each example shows:  
How the relevant programmable options work by default.  
The Application Summary, which provides the basic steps you need to take to set up the application.  
Following the chart are the step-by-step instructions for setting up the application.  
Example 1: Set Up Separate Day and Night Greetings  
Default Automated Attendant Answering  
All lines answered by the Automated Attendant route to Answer Table 1.  
• Answer Table 1 uses Schedule 1 to answer calls from 8:30 AM -5:00 PM Monday through Friday with Call Rout-  
ing Mailbox 1.  
• The Default Mailbox for Answer Table 1 picks up Automated Attendant calls at all other times. The Default Mail-  
box for Answer Table 1 is also Call Routing Mailbox 1.  
The greeting that plays to outside callers is the Instruction Menu for the Call Routing Mailbox that answers the call.  
Since Schedule 1 and the Default Mailbox both use Call Routing Mailbox 1, the Automated Attendant answers all  
calls the same way day and night, with the Instruction Menu for Call Routing Mailbox 1.  
Application Summary  
Change the Default Mailbox from Call Routing Mailbox 1 to 8.  
Record a night Instruction Menu for Call Routing Mailbox 8.  
1.  
2.  
Change the Default Mailbox to Call Routing Mailbox 8.  
1. In 4211-01: Default Mailbox (page 880), change the Default Mailbox assignment to 8.  
Record the daytime and night Instruction Menus.  
1. At extension 300, press V-MAIL.  
2. For IntraMail Automated Attendant  
- Dial SA (72) + I (4).  
For Built-In Automated Attendant  
- Dial #AG (#24).  
3. Dial 001 (for Call Routing Mailbox 1) + R (7).  
4. Record the daytime Instruction Menu message + # twice.  
5. Dial I (4).  
6. Dial 008 (for Call Routing Mailbox 8) + R (7).  
7. Record the night Instruction Menu message + # + hang up.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
399  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Application Examples  
Example 2: Provide Unique Day and Night Dialing Options for Callers  
Default Dial Action Table Options  
(This application does not apply to the Built-In Automated Attendant.)  
All Call Routing Mailboxes (1-8 by default) use Dial Action Table 1.  
Dial Action Table 1 provides the following dial options:  
• Dial extension number (300-427).  
• Dial 0 for extension 300.  
• Dial * + extension to leave a Quick Message.  
• Dial # + extension to do a Remote Logon to the mailbox.  
Timeout to extension 300 if no digits dialed.  
Application Summary  
Allow callers at night to dial 0 to leave a message for extension 300.  
1.  
Set up separate day and night greetings.  
1. Following example 1, set up separate day and night Instruction Menus using Call Routing Mailboxes 1  
and 2.  
- The day Instruction Menu can say something like:  
Thank you for calling. For Sales, dial 301. For Technical Support, dial 302. To talk to an operator,  
dial 0. If you know your party’s extension number, please dial it now.  
- The night Instruction menu can say something like:  
Thank you for calling. Our normal business hours are 8:30 to 5:00, Monday through Friday. To  
leave us a message, please dial 0 now.  
2.  
3.  
Assign a unique Dial ActionTable (2) to the night time Call Routing Mailbox (2).  
1. In 4222-01: Dial Action Table (page 891), assign Dial Action Table 2 to Call Routing Mailbox 2.  
Change the dialing options for the night time Dial ActionTable (2).  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), make the following changes:  
-
For the digits 3 and 4, enter 0 for the Action entry to prevent callers from dialing extensions at night.  
- For the digit 0, change the Action entry to REC1 (by dialing 3) and the Data entry to 300. This  
allows night time callers to dial 0 to leave a message for extension 300.  
- Note that the * and # entries were left unchanged so that experienced users could still leave Quick  
Messages or do Remote Logons at night.  
400  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Application Examples  
Example 3: Overflow to IntraMail in the Day, Answer in Night Mode  
Default Ringing and Overow Setup  
Lines 1-12 ring on line keys 1-12 for extensions 300-315.  
All other extensions are lamp only for lines 1-12.  
Lines 13-64 do not appear on line keys.  
Overow is disabled for all lines.  
No lines are terminated to voice mail (i.e., voice does not answer any outside lines).  
There are no System night keys programmed.  
Application Summary  
In the day, unanswered Key Ring calls overow to Automated Attendant.  
At night, all incoming calls are immediately Answered by the Automated Attendant.  
1.  
Set up unanswered Key Ring lines to overow to the voice mail Automated Attendant in the day.  
1. In 3112-01: Direct Termination in the Day (page 819), make sure lines are set to Key Ring (be pressing  
CLEAR).  
3. In 3112-03: Day Overow Destination (page 820), enter 700 (the voice mail master number).  
2.  
3.  
Set up the voice mail Automated Attendant to answer calls in the night mode.  
Enable at least one extension to put the system in the night mode.  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
- This capability is normally reserved only for attendants.  
4.  
Put a System night key on the extensions that can put the system in the night mode.  
1. To set up a System night key on an extension:  
2. To set up a System night key on a DSS Console:  
5.  
To put the system in the night mode:  
1. At an extension programmed in steps 3 and 4 above, press the System night key.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
401  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IntraMail Feature Glossary  
IntraMail Feature Glossary  
Name  
Description  
Usage  
See Security Code in this glossary  
.
Voice Mail  
Administrator Security Code  
Control  
See Next Call Routing Mailbox in this Glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Alternate Next Call Routing  
Mailbox  
Mailbox that allows a prerecorded greeting to play to callers.  
Automated Attendant  
Automated Attendant  
Announcement Mailbox  
Announcement Message  
The message that the System Administrator records for a  
specic Announcement Mailbox.  
Enables an alternate greeting and alternate dialing options  
for callers.  
Automated Attendant  
Automated Attendant  
Answer Schedule Override  
Answer Table  
Determines how theAutomatedAttendant answers outside  
calls on each line, according to the time of the day and day  
of the week that the call is ringing.  
A keyset on the connected telephone system can work like  
a home answering machine.  
Voice Mail  
Answering Machine Emulation  
Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb  
more.  
Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb sends Automated Attendant  
calls directly to an extension user’s mailbox. Their phone  
will not ring for calls from the Automated Attendant.  
Automated Attendant  
more. Also see Greeting in this glossary  
.
When a  
mailbox user completely listens to a new message  
Voice Mail  
Auto Erase or Save  
and then exits their mailbox, IntraMail will either automat-  
ically save or erase the message.  
After a user listens to a message, IntraMail can optionally  
announce the time and date the message was left.  
Voice Mail  
Auto Time Stamp  
The Automated Attendant can automatically answer the  
telephone system’s incoming calls, play an Instruction  
Menu message, and provide dialing options to callers.  
Automated Attendant  
Automated Attendant  
Provides built-in call answering capability when IntraMail  
is not installed.  
Automated Attendant  
Automated Attendant, Basic  
more.  
402  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
IntraMail Feature Glossary  
Name  
Description  
Usage  
While on an outside call, an extension user can transfer  
their call to the Automated Attendant so the caller can use  
the Automated Attendant dialing options.  
Voice Mail  
Automated Attendant Transfer  
more.  
See Go to a Mailbox in this glossary.  
Automated Attendant  
Automatic Call Routing to a  
Mailbox  
See Auto Erase or Save in this glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Automatic Message Erase/Save  
If an Automated Attendant caller doesn’t dial any digits,  
IntraMail will automatically route them to a specied  
option (such as the operator or a mailbox).  
Automated Attendant  
Automatic Routing for Rotary  
Dial Callers  
Provides IntraMail voice prompts in one of two active lan-  
guages (primary and secondary)  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
Bilingual Voice Prompts  
An extension user can forward their calls to their mailbox.  
Call Forward to a Mailbox  
Call Routing Mailbox  
The mailbox associated with an Answer Table that species Automated Attendant  
which dialing options (Dial Action Table) and announce-  
ments are available to Automated Attendant callers.  
Call Screening allows a display keyset extension user to  
listen to (screen) a voice mail message as it is being left in  
their mailbox. Unlike Personal Answering Machine emu-  
lation, Call Screening does not require the extension user  
to forward their calls immediately to voice mail.  
Voice Mail  
Call Screening  
A telephone company service that provides a caller’s number  
and optional name. The telephone system can pass this infor-  
System  
Caller ID and Voice Mail  
Caller ID with Return Call  
mation to IntraMail to enable Caller ID with Return Call  
.
glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Calling (Logging Onto) a Mailbox  
Calling the Automated Attendant  
See Log Onto Voice Mail in this glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Automated Attendant callers can use various IntraMail  
features and then return to the Automated Attendant for  
additional dialing options.  
Automated Attendant  
more.  
The Automated Attendant to transfer a caller from a Cen- Automated Attendant  
trex line to an outside number using the features of that  
Centrex line.  
Centrex Transfer  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
403  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
IntraMail Feature Glossary  
Name  
Description  
Usage  
Allows an extension user to record their active call as a mes-  
sage in their mailbox. IntraMail will broadcast a beep and a  
voice prompt to the callers as Conversation Record begins.  
Voice Mail  
Conversation Record  
See Flexible Answering Schedules in this glossary  
.
Automated Attendant  
Voice Mail  
Day, Night, and Holiday  
Greetings  
Deleting a Message  
Deleting Mailbox Security Code  
Dial Action Table  
See Message Delete in this glossary  
.
See Mailbox Security Code Delete in this glossary  
.
Maintenance  
Denes the dialing options for a Call Routing Mailbox  
chosen by the active Answer Table, which in turn provides  
those dialing options to Automated Attendant callers.  
Automated Attendant  
Directory Dialing allows an Automated Attendant caller to  
reach an extension by dialing the rst few letters in the  
extension user’s name.  
Automated Attendant  
Directory Dialing  
Lets the System Administrator delete mailbox messages  
system-wide.  
Maintenance  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
Erasing All Messages  
Exiting a Mailbox  
An extension user can exit their mailbox by dialing a code  
or by hanging up.  
Automatically sends calls to an extension’s mailbox with-  
out the user having to set up Call Forwarding.  
Extension Hunting to Voice Mail  
more.  
An Automated Attendant caller can automatically route to  
an outside telephone number.  
Automated Attendant  
System  
External Transfer  
Fax Detection  
The Automated Attendant can detect incoming fax calls  
and transfer them to a fax machine.  
The Automated Attendant can answer outside calls with  
different announcements and dialing options, depending  
on the time of day and day of week.  
Automated Attendant  
Flexible Answering Schedules  
more.  
404  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
IntraMail Feature Glossary  
Name  
Description  
Usage  
The Automated Attendant can provide outside callers with  
a wide variety of dialing (routing) options. There are 3  
components to Flexible Call Routing.  
Automated Attendant  
Flexible Call Routing  
Determines how the Automated Attendant answers out-  
side calls on each Voice Mail port, according to the time  
of the day and day of the week that the call is ringing.  
The mailbox associated with an Answer Table that  
species which dialing options (Dial Action Table)  
and announcements are available to Automated  
Attendant callers.  
Denes the dialing options for the Call Routing Mail-  
box chosen by the active Answer Table, which in turn  
provides those dialing options to Automated Atten-  
dant callers.  
If the telephone system extension numbers are customized,  
the IntraMail mailbox numbers can be customized to match.  
System  
Flexible Mailbox Numbering Plan  
Forced Unscreened Transfer  
more.  
A Subscriber Mailbox can optionally convert Automated  
Attendant Screened Transfers to Unscreened Transfers.  
Automated Attendant  
Forwarding Calls to a Mailbox  
Getting Recorded Help  
See Call Forward to a Mailbox in this glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
If an extension user dials an incorrect code or forgets what  
to dial while in their mailbox, they can request help from  
the IntraMail voice prompts.  
An Automated Attendant caller can dial a digit and route  
directly into a mailbox.  
Automated Attendant  
Voice Mail  
Go to a Mailbox  
Greeting  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can record up to three separate  
greetings and make any one of the three active. Caller’s to  
the user’s mailbox hear the active greeting.  
With Remote Greeting, an extension user can call into the  
Automated Attendant, access their mailbox, and remotely  
record their mailbox greeting.  
Also see Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb in this glos-  
sary.  
A Group Mailbox is a Subscriber Mailbox shared by a  
group of co-workers.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
Group Mailbox  
Guest Mailbox  
An outside party can have their own mailbox for receiving  
and sending messages.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
405  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
IntraMail Feature Glossary  
Name  
Description  
Usage  
An Automated Attendant option that immediately hangs  
up the outside call.  
Automated Attendant  
Hang Up  
Help  
Individual Line Greetings  
Instruction Menu  
See Getting Recorded Help in this glossary  
.
Voice Mail  
See Multiple Company Greetings in this glossary.  
Automated Attendant  
Automated Attendant  
The Instruction Menu is the announcement that plays to  
Automated Attendant callers. Normally, the Instruction  
Menu provides callers with the Automated Attendant dial-  
ing options.  
Leave a voice mail message in a co-worker’s mailbox.  
Voice Mail  
Leaving a Message  
See Leaving a Message above in this glossary  
See Quick Message in this glossary  
See Listening to Messages in this glossary  
Leaving a Message at a Busy/  
DND Extension  
.
Voice Mail  
Leave a Quick Message  
Listening Options  
.
Automated Attendant  
.
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
While or after listening to a message, an extension user has  
many message handling options from which to choose.  
Listening to Messages  
Local Notication  
See Message Notication in this glossary  
.
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
An extension user can press a key to log onto (access)  
their IntraMail mailbox.  
Log Onto Voice Mail  
With Remote Logon, an employee calling through the Auto-  
mated Attendant can dial a single digit followed by their own  
mailbox number to remotely log onto their mailbox.  
See Greeting in this glossary  
See Log Onto Voice Mail in this glossary.  
Mailbox Greeting  
Mailbox Logon  
Mailbox Name  
.
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
A mailbox caller can hear the extension user’s prerecorded  
name instead of their mailbox number.  
Sub-menu of a subscriber’s Main Menu that provides  
access to the Auto Time Stamp, Mailbox Security Code  
Delete, and Message Notication features.  
Voice Mail  
Mailbox Options Menu  
The System Administrator can delete the security code for  
any mailbox, effectively unlocking it.  
Maintenance  
Mailbox Security Code Delete  
more.  
Also see Security Code in this glossary.  
406  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
IntraMail Feature Glossary  
Name  
Mailbox Transfer  
Description  
See Transfer to a Mailbox in this glossary  
Usage  
.
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
The IntraMail options available to an extension user when  
they log onto their mailbox.  
Main Menu  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can listen to a voice message  
and dial MC to return the call without knowing their  
caller’s phone number.  
Voice Mail  
Make Call  
See Make Call (page 525) for more  
.
Master Mailboxes  
See Group Mailbox in this glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
The telephone display can show the number of new mes-  
sages waiting in a user’s mailbox.  
Message Count Display  
An extension user can delete any messages left in their  
mailbox.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
Message Delete  
A subscriber can forward a message in their mailbox to a  
co-worker. They can optionally record a comment before  
the forwarded message.  
Message Forward  
The System Administrator can set the maximum length of  
a message that can be left in a user’s voice mailbox.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
Message Length  
When a user calls their mailbox, they can dial a code to  
listen to all their messages, their new messages, or their  
saved messages.  
Message Listen Mode  
Once activated by the mailbox user, dials a telephone  
number to let the recipient know there are new messages  
in the mailbox. Notication can call extensions, local  
numbers, long distance numbers and pagers.  
Voice Mail  
Message Notication  
The System Administrator can record a message that will  
play to callers while they wait on Hold.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
Message On Hold  
An extension user can listen to their messages in either  
LIFO (last-in-rst-out) or FIFO (rst-in-rst-out) order.  
Message Playback Direction  
Message Record  
Message Reply  
See Record and Send a Message in this glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
An extension user can reply to a message in their mailbox  
by dialing a simple code, without knowing the caller’s  
extension number.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
407  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
IntraMail Feature Glossary  
Name  
Description  
Usage  
IntraMail will save a mailbox’s new or saved messages for  
the Message Retention interval, and then delete them.  
Voice Mail  
Message Retention  
Message Send  
See Record and Send a Message in this glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
Sets how many messages a mailbox can store.  
Message Storage Limit  
An extension’s Message Waiting lamp ashes on the tele-  
phone indicating that they have new messages waiting in  
their mailbox.  
Voice Mail  
Message Waiting Lamp  
By assigning a unique Answer Table to each line, a single  
IntraMail system can provide individual greetings and  
dialing options for several companies.  
Automated Attendant  
Multiple Company Greetings  
Name  
See Mailbox Name in this glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
Provides callers with additional dialing options after they  
leave a message in an extension’s mailbox (depending on  
the setting of the Next Call Routing Mailbox Dial Mode).  
Next Call Routing Mailbox  
in this glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
One-Touch Forwarding  
One-Touch Mailbox Access  
One-Touch Mailbox Retrieval  
See Mailbox Logon in this glossary.  
See Mailbox Logon in this glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
See Answering Machine Emulation in this glossary.  
Personal Answering Machine  
Emulation  
Personalized Mailbox Greeting  
Programmable Security Code  
See Greeting in this glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
in this glossary.  
You can program (customize) IntraMail using the embed-  
ded telephone programming or the separately available  
System Administrator PC program. Limited programming  
can also be done from a System Administrator’s mailbox.  
Maintenance  
Programming Voice Mail  
glossary.  
Automated Attendant callers can dial a digit followed by  
an extension number to leave a message directly in a  
user’s mailbox.  
Automated Attendant  
Voice Mail  
Quick Message  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can record and send a message  
to any other Subscriber Mailbox.  
Record and Send a Message  
408  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
IntraMail Feature Glossary  
Name  
Recorded Help  
Description  
Usage  
Pre-recorded voice prompts guide the user through the  
IntraMail features.  
Voice Mail  
Recording a Conversation  
Recording a Message  
Recording Conversation Beep  
Recording Options  
See Conversation Record in this glossary.  
See Record and Send a Message in this glossary.  
See Conversation Record in this glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
See Record and Send a Message in this glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
See Log Onto Voice Mail in this glossary.  
Remote Log On  
See Greeting in this glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
Maintenance  
Remote Greetings  
See Message Notication in this glossary.  
Remote Message Notication  
Remote Programming  
IntraMail programming is available remotely via the Sys-  
tem Administrator PC program.  
See Make Call in this glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Return Call (with Caller ID)  
Rotary Dial Telephones  
glossary.  
Automated Attendant  
A category of mailboxes normally used to route Auto-  
mated Attendant calls.  
Automated Attendant  
Automated Attendant  
Routing Mailbox  
Similar to telephone system screened transfers in which  
the transferring party controls the transfer.  
Screened Transfer  
After an Automated Attendant caller dials an exten-  
sion, IntraMail calls (screens) the destination exten-  
sion to see if the transfer can go through.  
If the destination is busy or in DND, the Automated  
Attendant doesn’t extend the call and immediately  
provides the caller with additional options.  
If the destination is available, theAutomatedAttendant  
rings it. If the destination answers, the call goes  
through. If the destination doesn’t answer within a pre-  
set interval, the Automated Attendant doesn’t extend  
the call and provides the caller with additional options.  
Also see Unscreened Transfer in this glossary.  
An extension user’s mailbox can have a security code to  
protect the mailbox from unauthorized access.  
Voice Mail  
Voice Mail  
Security Code  
Select Listen Mode  
glossary.  
See Message Listen Mode in this glossary.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
409  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
IntraMail Feature Glossary  
Name  
Description  
Usage  
An Automated Attendant caller can press a single key to  
route to an extension, route to another destination, or use  
an IntraMail feature.  
Automated Attendant  
Single Digit Dialing  
The mailbox type normally used for telephone system  
extensions.  
Voice Mail  
Maintenance  
Voice Mail  
Subscriber Mailbox  
System Administrator  
The extension user that has IntraMail system administra-  
tion capabilities.  
A Subscriber Mailbox option that enables the system  
administration capabilities.  
System Administrator Mailbox  
more.  
Also see System Administrator in this glossary.  
Reinitializing IntraMail returns all programmed options to  
their default values.  
Maintenance  
Voice Mail  
System Reinitialization  
Set the system Time and Date.  
Time and Date with Voice Mail  
more.  
Also see Auto Time Stamp in this glossary.  
With caller ID enabled, an extension can listen to a mes-  
sage and dial a code to hear the time the message was sent,  
as well as the caller’s number.  
Voice Mail  
Time and Date Stamp  
Date with Voice Mail in this glossary.  
See Time and Date Stamp in this glossary.  
Voice Mail  
Time and Date Stamp (with Caller  
ID Storage  
glossary.  
Automated Attendant  
Transfer by Extension  
Automated Attendant  
Voice Mail  
Transfer Calls to a FAX Machine  
Transfer to a Mailbox  
See Fax Detection in this glossary.  
An extension user can transfer their active call to a co-  
worker’s mailbox.  
The Automated Attendant can transfer outside callers to  
UCD Group master numbers.  
Automated Attendant  
Transfer to a UCD Group  
Transfer to an Extension  
glossary.  
Automated Attendant  
Voice Mail  
See Automated Attendant Transfer in this glossary.  
Transfer to the Automated  
Attendant  
410  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
IntraMail Feature Glossary  
Name  
Description  
Usage  
A dialpad digit for which the Automated Attendant has no  
routing dened. When an Automated Attendant caller  
dials a digit for which there is no routing assigned, Intra-  
Mail plays a brief error message and then repeats the dial-  
ing options.  
Automated Attendant  
Undened Routing  
See Undened Routing in this glossary.  
Automated Attendant  
Automated Attendant  
Undened Routing Intercept  
Similar to telephone system unscreened transfers in which  
the transferring party immediately extends the call.  
Unscreened Transfer  
After an Automated Attendant caller dials an exten-  
sion, IntraMail immediately transfers the call to the  
destination and hangs up. Any recalls or additional  
routing are handled by the telephone system – just as  
with any other unscreened transfer.  
Also see Screened Transfer in this glossary.  
Ensures that IntraMail will pick up calls that don’t go  
through.  
System  
System  
Voice Mail Overow  
Voice Prompting Messages  
Volume Control with Voice Mail  
IntraMail provides Voice Prompts that tell the extension  
user the status or progress of their call.  
A mailbox user can turn the volume up or down while lis-  
tening to their messages.  
Voice Mail  
more.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
411  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Announcement Mailbox  
Announcement Mailbox  
Description  
Play a pre-recorded announcement to callers.  
An Announcement Mailbox plays a pre-recorded announcement to Automated Attendant callers without  
providing dialing options. The Announcement Mailbox is typically set up to provide information to callers  
(such as company directions) and then route back to the Automated Attendant. For example:  
The Automated Attendant instructs the caller to dial a digit (e.g., 1) for company directions.  
- Record this in the Instruction Menu message for the active Call Routing Mailbox. See Instruction  
- Set the dialing options in the Dial Action Table associated with the active Call Routing Mailbox.  
The caller dials the digit and listens to the prerecorded Announcement Mailbox message for directions.  
After playing the directions, the caller routes back to the Automated Attendant for additional dialing options.  
- See the Hang Up and Next Call Routing Mailbox options in Programming below.  
By default, there are 8 Announcement Mailboxes (Routing Mailboxes 9-16). However, you can assign any of  
the 16 Routing Mailboxes as an Announcement Mailbox.  
The Next Call Routing Mailbox Options  
The charts beginning on the following page show how an Announcement Mailbox handles Automated  
Attendant calls.  
The rst chart explains what happens when the outside call is directly answered by the Announcement  
Mailbox. This happens when the Answer Table uses an Announcement Mailbox for routing instead of a  
Call Routing Mailbox.  
The second chart explains what happens when the outside call is answered by a Call Routing Mailbox  
and then routed to the Announcement Mailbox. This can happen, for example, when a caller dials a digit  
to hear an announcement of company directions.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• There are 8 Announcement Mailboxes (9-16).  
412  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Announcement Mailbox  
Direct Announcement Mailbox Routing  
(If the outside caller routes directly to the Announcement Mailbox)  
4223-03: Next Call  
Routing Mailbox  
4223-01: Repeat  
Count  
4223-02-Hang Up  
After  
Action  
Undened  
0 (No repeats)  
0 (No repeats)  
Yes or No  
If the caller doesn’t dial, after the  
announcement IntraMail hangs up.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, IntraMail says “That is an  
invalid entry” and hangs up.  
1-16 (valid Call  
Routing Mail-  
box)  
No  
If the caller doesn’t dial, after the  
announcement they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Yes  
If the caller doesn’t dial, after the  
announcement IntraMail hangs up.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Undened  
x (x number of  
repeats)  
Yes or No  
If caller doesn’t dial, they hear the  
announcement repeats x number of times  
and then IntraMail hangs up.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, IntraMail says “That is an  
invalid entry” and aborts the announce-  
ment. The announcement repeats (if  
allowed by the Repeat Count) and then  
IntraMail hangs up.  
1-16 (valid Call  
Routing Mail-  
box)  
x (x number of  
repeats)  
No  
If caller doesn’t dial, they hear the  
announcement x number of times and then  
route to the Next Call Routing Mailbox.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Yes  
If caller doesn’t dial, they hear the  
announcement x number of times and then  
IntraMail hangs up.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
413  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Announcement Mailbox  
Routed Announcement Mailbox Routing (Page 1 of 2)  
(If the outside caller routes to the Announcement Mailbox from a Call Routing Mailbox)  
4223-03: Next Call  
Routing Mailbox  
4223-01: Repeat  
Count  
4223-02-Hang Up  
After  
Action  
Undened  
0 (No repeats)  
No  
If the caller doesn’t dial, after the  
announcement the caller goes back to the  
initial Call Routing Mailbox.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, IntraMail says “That is an  
invalid entry” and routes the caller goes  
back to the initial Call Routing Mailbox.  
Yes  
No  
If the caller doesn’t dial, after the  
announcement IntraMail hangs up.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, IntraMail says “That is an  
invalid entry” and hangs up.  
1-16 (valid Call  
Routing Mail-  
box)  
0 (No repeats)  
If the caller doesn’t dial, after the  
announcement they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Yes  
No  
If the caller doesn’t dial, after the  
announcement IntraMail hangs up.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Undened  
x (x number of  
repeats)  
If caller doesn’t dial, they hear the  
announcement repeat x number of times  
and then go back to the initial Call Routing  
Mailbox.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, IntraMail says “That is an  
invalid entry” and aborts the announce-  
ment. The announcement repeats (if  
allowed by the Repeat Count) and then  
IntraMail routes back to the initial Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Yes  
If caller doesn’t dial, they hear the  
announcement repeat x number of times  
and then IntraMail hangs up.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, IntraMail says “That is an  
invalid entry” and aborts the announce-  
ment. The announcement repeats (if  
allowed by the Repeat Count) and then  
IntraMail hangs up.  
414  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Announcement Mailbox  
Routed Announcement Mailbox Routing (Page 2 of 2)  
(If the outside caller routes to the Announcement Mailbox from a Call Routing Mailbox)  
4223-03: Next Call  
Routing Mailbox  
4223-01: Repeat  
Count  
4223-02-Hang Up  
After  
Action  
1-16 (valid Call  
Routing Mail-  
box)  
x (x number of  
repeats)  
No  
If caller doesn’t dial, they hear the  
announcement repeat x number of times  
and then route to the Next Call Routing  
Mailbox.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Yes  
If caller doesn’t dial, they hear the  
announcement repeat x number of times  
and then IntraMail hangs up.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Programming  
1.  
Set up the Announcement Mailbox.  
1. In 4221-01: Routing Mailbox Type (page 890), to make the selected mailbox an Announcement Mailbox,  
enter 2.  
- By default, Routing Mailboxes 9-16 are Announcement Mailboxes.  
2.  
3.  
To record the Announcement Message:  
1. See Operation below.  
- By default, a message is not recorded.  
After playing the Announcement Mailbox message, should IntraMail hang up or provide  
additional dialing options?  
1. To hang up:  
2. To provide dialing options:  
ment Mailbox callers.  
4.  
5.  
Should the Announcement Mailbox message repeat while the caller listens?  
Is the maximum allowed length of the Announcement Mailbox message correctly set?  
- This affects other options as well, such as the maximum length of Instruction Menu Messages.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
415  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Announcement Mailbox  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The Automated Attendant can route callers to an Announcement Mailbox.  
A Call Routing Mailbox (and the associated Dial Action Table) provides dialing options to Automated  
Attendant callers.  
The Next Call Routing mailbox provides additional routing options to Announcement Mailbox callers.  
The System Administrator can record the Announcement Mailbox message.  
Operation  
Recording an Announcement Mailbox Message  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto System Administrator’s mailbox.  
Access System Administrator options.  
[System Admin] - [N/A]  
SA (72)  
Select Announcement Mailbox message.  
[Announcement] - [Annc]  
A (2)  
Enter the Announcement Mailbox number.  
Listen to current Announcement Mailbox message.  
[Listen] - [Lstn]  
L (5)  
Exit listen mode.  
#
Record a new Announcement Mailbox message.  
[Record] - [Rec]  
R (7)  
Record message.  
Pause or restart recording.  
[Resume] - [Resume]  
[Pause] - [Pause]  
*
Erase recording.  
[Cancel] - [Cancel]  
E (3)  
#
Exit recording mode.  
[Done] - [Done]  
Erase the Announcement Mailbox message.  
[Erase] - [Erase]  
E (3)  
Go back to the System Administrator options.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
Go back to the System Administrator options.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
Plays Help message.  
0
416  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Announcement Message  
Announcement Message  
Description  
This is the message that the System Administrator records for an Announcement Mailbox.  
The Announcement Message is the voice message that the System Administrator records for a specic  
Programming  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Operation  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
417  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Answer Schedule Override  
Answer Schedule Override  
Description  
Enables an alternate greeting and alternate dialing options for callers.  
Answer Schedule Override provides alternate answering for Automated Attendant calls. When enabled,  
Answer Schedule Override sends calls to the specied Override Mailbox. The Override Mailbox can be an  
Announcement, Call Routing, or Subscriber mailbox. You can use Answer Schedule Override to provide  
holiday and bad weather closing announcements, for example. Enable override when you want callers to  
hear the special announcements; disable override to have the Automated Attendant answer normally.You can  
enable Answer Schedule Override from system programming or from the System Administrator Mailbox.  
If the Override Mailbox is an Announcement Mailbox, the outside caller will hear the recorded  
announcement. Depending on how the Announcement Mailbox is programmed, IntraMail will then hang  
up, reroute the call, or provide additional dialing options.  
If the Override Mailbox is a Call Routing Mailbox, the outside caller will hear the instruction menu and  
can dial any options allowed by the associated Dial Action Table.  
If the Override Mailbox is a Subscriber Mailbox, the outside caller hears the mailbox greeting (if  
recorded) and can leave a message.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
1.  
Optionally Enable Answer Schedule Override from system programming.  
- You can also enable Answer Schedule Override from the System Administrator Mailbox. See Oper-  
ation below.  
- Announcement Mailbox number (1-16)  
- Call Routing Mailbox number (1-16)  
- Ring Group Mailbox number (600-607)  
- UCD Group Mailbox number (700-707)  
- Subscriber Mailbox number (300-427)  
- UND (Undened - entered by dialing 0)  
2.  
Optionally enable Answer Schedule Override from the System Administrator Mailbox.  
1. See Operation below.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The Override Mailbox can be an Announcement Mailbox.  
The Override Mailbox can be a Call Routing Mailbox.  
418  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Answer Schedule Override  
The Override Mailbox can be a Subscriber Mailbox.  
Optionally enable Answer Schedule Override from the System Administrator Mailbox.  
Operation  
Enabling Answer Schedule Override  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto System Administrator’s Mailbox.  
Access System Administrator options.  
[System Admin] - [N/A]  
SA (72)  
Access Answer Schedule Override.  
[Answer Schedule] - [N/A]  
O (6)  
Enter the number of the Answer Table you want to override.  
You go to the Answer Schedule Override Menu.  
1-8  
Turn Answer Schedule Override on or off.  
[On] - [On]  
[Off] - [Off]  
O (6)  
Select the Override Mailbox.  
[Mailbox] - [MBOX]  
C (2)  
Enter the Override Mailbox number.  
• The Override Mailbox can be an Announcement, Call Routing, or  
Subscriber Mailbox.  
• If you make an incorrect entry, you back up to the previous step.  
Go back to the Answer Schedule Override  
Menu without entering an Override Mailbox.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
Plays Answer Schedule Override Menu Help message.  
0
#
Go back to the System Administrator Menu.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
Go back to the System Administrator Menu.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
Go back to the Main Menu.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
Plays Help message.  
0
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
419  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Answer Tables  
Answer Tables  
Description  
Determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each line, according to the  
time of the day and day of the week that the call is ringing.  
The Answer Table determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each line, according to  
the time of the day and day of the week that the call is ringing. IntraMail provides 8 Answer Tables. The  
Answer Table is an integral part of the Automated Attendant. The Automated Attendant can automatically  
answer the telephone system’s incoming calls, play an Instruction Menu message, and provide dialing  
options to callers.There are 3 major Automated Attendant components:  
Answer Tables  
The Answer Table (8 maximum) determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each  
line, according to the time of the day and day of the week that the call is ringing. The Answer Table  
divides the time of day and day of the week into individual schedules, which in turn assign a Call Rout-  
ing Mailbox to each call. When a specic schedule is not in effect, the Answer Table uses its Default  
Mailbox to determine routing.  
- By default, all lines use Answer Table 1. Answer Table 1 has a single schedule that runs Monday  
through Friday from 8:30AM to 5:00PM.  
A Call Routing Mailbox (16 maximum) is a mailbox associated with an individual Answer Table schedule or  
the Default Mailbox. It species which dialing options (Dial Action Table) are available to callers. It also  
provides the Instruction Menu to callers which typically greets the callers and describes the dialing options.  
By default, Answer Table 1 has a single schedule that runs Monday through Friday from 8:30AM to  
5:00PM. This schedule and the Default Mailbox both use Call Routing Mailbox 1.  
Once the Automated Attendant answers, the Dial Action Table (16 maximum) provides the dialing  
options to callers. Each digit a caller can dial is assigned a specic action (function) in the Dial Action  
Table. The dial action used depends on the setting in the active Call Routing Mailbox, which in turn  
depends on the Answer Table setup.  
By default, Call Routing Mailbox 1 uses Dial Action Table 1.  
The block diagram below shows the default IntraMail Automated Attendant conguration.  
3112-01: Direct Termination (Day)  
3112-04: Direct Termination (Night)  
DIL to Voice Mail  
Master (700)  
Automated Attendant Answering (Default)  
Lines Route to  
Answer Table 1  
3131-02: Answer Table  
Answer Table 1  
421x-Answer Table  
Dial Action Table 1  
Dialing Options  
Dial an extension number, or  
0 for the operator  
Calls always route to Call Routing Mailbox 001  
4212: Schedule  
Schedule 1 or  
Default Mailbox  
-
-
Schedule 1 active M-F 8:30AM-5:00PM.  
Default Mailbox active all other times.  
4211-01: Default Mailbox  
To record a new Instruction Menu  
All Lines  
Call Routing  
Mailbox 001  
Message (from Extension 300):  
422x: Routing Mailboxes (001)  
Automated Attendant  
V-MAIL + SA + I + 001  
Built-In Automated Attendant  
#AG + 001  
Dial Action  
Table 1  
423x: Dial Action Tables  
With these  
dialing options  
Use Answer  
Table 1  
Which Chooses Call  
Routing Mailbox 001.  
And Dial Action  
Table 1  
420  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Answer Tables  
The Default Mailbox and Routing Hierarchy  
The Default Mailbox provides routing for an Answer Table during periods when a schedule is not in effect.  
By default, for example, Answer Table 1 Schedule 1 is active Monday through Friday from 8:30 AM to 5:00  
PM. The Default Mailbox for Answer Table 1 is active during all other times (i.e., evenings and weekends).  
Since Schedule 1 and the Default Mailbox both use Call Routing Mailbox 1, initially the routing is the same  
24 hours a day, 7 days a week. See Customizing an Answer Table below for more.  
When setting up your Answer Tables, keep in mind that a more specic type of routing has priority over a  
less specic type of routing. When selecting which routing to follow when there is more than one choice for  
a specic time, IntraMail will choose in the following order:  
- Date Schedule  
- Day of Week Schedule  
- Range of Days Schedule  
- Default Mailbox  
For example, a Date Schedule set up for Christmas day will have priority over any other schedules in effect  
on December 25.  
Customizing an Answer Table  
Use the following examples as a guide when customizing your Answer Tables to meet specic site require-  
ments. Refer to Programming below for the specics.  
To set up daytime and evening/weekend answering (2 schedules):  
In this example, use the Default Mailbox (Call Routing Mailbox 1) for evening/weekend answering and  
specify a new Call Routing Mailbox for daytime answering.  
1. Change the Call Routing Mailbox for Answer Table 1, Schedule 1.  
In 421x-Answer Table (page 880), assign Call Routing Mailbox 2 to Answer Table 1, Schedule 1. You  
will use this for daytime answering.  
2. From a System Administrator’s Mailbox, record an evening/weekend Instruction Menu message for Call  
Routing mailbox 1.  
-
This message will play to callers Monday through Friday from 5:00 PM to 8:30 AM and on weekends.  
3. From a System Administrator’s Mailbox, record a daytime Instruction Menu message for Call Routing  
Mailbox 2.  
- This message will play to callers Monday through Friday from 8:30 AM to 5:00 PM.  
To set up daytime, evening, and weekend answering (3 schedules):  
This example builds on the example above, but adds a third schedule that will play just on weekday evenings.  
1. Change the Call Routing Mailbox for Answer Table 1, Schedule 1.  
- In 421x-Answer Table (page 880), assign Call Routing Mailbox 2 to Answer Table 1, Schedule 1.  
As in the 2 schedule example, you will use this for daytime answering.  
2. Create a new schedule that will run only in the evenings.  
-
In 421x-Answer Table (page 880), create Schedule 2 for Answer Table 1 that will run Monday through  
Friday from 5:00 PM to 11:00 PM. Assign Call Routing Mailbox 3 to this new schedule.  
3. From a System Administrator’s Mailbox, record a late night/weekend Instruction Menu Message for Call  
Routing mailbox 1.  
-
This message will play Monday through Friday from 11:00 PM to 8:30 AM, as well as on weekends.  
4. From a System Administrator’s mailbox, record the weekday Instruction Menu Message for Call Rout-  
ing Mailbox 2.  
- This message will play Monday through Friday from 8:30 AM to 5:00 PM.  
5. From a System Administrator’s Mailbox, record the weekday evening Instruction Menu Message for  
Call Routing Mailbox 3.  
- This message will play Monday through Friday from 5:00 PM to 1:00 PM  
Conditions  
• None  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
421  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Answer Tables  
Default Setting  
• All lines are assigned to Answer Table 1.  
• All outside lines are set to Key Ring during the day and at night.  
Programming  
Basic Setup  
1.  
2.  
Assign Answer Tables to outside lines.  
that the Automated Attendant should answer.  
Set up the Automated Attendant to answer outside calls during the day.  
2. Set up a UCD night key on your extension or DSS Console to control the day/night mode of lines termi-  
nated to voice mail during the day  
- To set up a UCD night key on an extension:  
- To set up a UCD night key on a DSS Console:  
3.  
Set up the Automated Attendant to answer outside calls at night.  
4. Set up a System night key on your extension or DSS Console to control the day/night mode of the lines  
terminated to Key Ring during the day  
- To set up a System night key on an extension:  
- To set up a System night key on a DSS Console:  
4.  
Set up basic “non-scheduled” Answer Table options.  
schedule is in effect.  
ally set up Answer Schedule Override.  
- Use this option if 10 Answer Schedules within an Answer Table are not sufcient. Enter the number  
of the Answer Table to which you want to link the selected table. IntraMail treats the two linked  
tables as a single 20 entry Answer Table.  
422  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Answer Tables  
Setting Up a Type 1 (Day of Week) Schedule  
1.  
Assign the schedule type and routing mailbox.  
answer calls when this Schedule Entry is active.  
- You can optionally assign a Subscriber Mailbox for this option. This will route outside callers  
directly to a subscriber’s mailbox so they can leave a message.  
2.  
Set the schedule run day and time.  
be active:  
- 1 for Sunday.  
- 2 for Monday.  
- 3 for Tuesday.  
- 4 for Wednesday.  
- 5 for Thursday.  
- 6 for Friday.  
- 7 for Saturday.  
Entry should start.  
Entry should stop.  
Setting up a Type 2 (Range of Days) Schedule  
1.  
Assign the schedule type and routing mailbox.  
answer calls when this Schedule Entry is active.  
- You can optionally assign a Subscriber Mailbox for this option. This will route outside callers  
directly to a subscriber’s mailbox so they can leave a message.  
2.  
Set the schedule range and time.  
- 1 for Sunday.  
- 2 for Monday.  
- 3 for Tuesday.  
- 4 for Wednesday.  
- 5 for Thursday.  
- 6 for Friday.  
- 7 for Saturday.  
Entry should start on the Schedule Start Day.  
Entry should stop on the Schedule End Day.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
423  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Answer Tables  
Setting Up a Type 3 (Date) Schedule  
1.  
Assign the schedule type and routing mailbox.  
answer calls when this Schedule Entry is active.  
- You can optionally assign a Subscriber Mailbox for this option. This will route outside callers  
directly to a subscriber’s mailbox so they can leave a message.  
2.  
Set the schedule run date.  
DD).  
Entry should start.  
Entry should stop.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The Answer Table determines how the Automated Attendant answers calls.  
The Call Routing Mailbox provides the dialing instructions (Dial Action Table) and announcements to  
Automated Attendant Callers.  
The Dial Action Table denes the dialing options for the Call Routing Mailbox chosen by the Answer  
Table, which in turn provides those options to Automated Attendant callers.  
Operation  
N/A  
424  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Answering Machine Emulation  
Answering Machine Emulation  
Description  
A keyset on the connected telephone system can work like a home answering machine.  
A user’s keyset can work like a home answering machine. This lets IntraMail screen their calls, just like their  
answering machine at home. If activated, the extension’s incoming calls route to the user’s Subscriber Mail-  
box. Once the mailbox answers, the user hears two alert tones followed by the caller’s incoming message.  
The keyset user can then:  
Let the call go through to their mailbox, or  
Intercept the call.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Available, but not enabled at any telephones.  
Programming  
No additional programming required.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Subscriber Mailbox users can take advantage of Answering Machine Emulation.  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Personal Answering Machine Emulation  
To activate or cancel Personal Answering Machine Emulation:  
1.  
Select the Call Forwarding options.  
[Menu + Call Forward]  
[Menu + Cfwd]  
Alternately do one of the following:  
• Press INTERCOM and dial *3.  
• Press your Call Forwarding Feature Key.  
2.  
Select or cancel a Personal Answering Machine Emulation.  
[Ans Machine]  
[More + AME]  
Select Personal Answering Machine Emulation.  
• Alternately dial 7.  
[None]  
[More + More + None]  
Select to cancel Call Forwarding.  
• Alternately dial 0.  
3.  
Select the Call Forwarding mode.  
[All]  
[All]  
Select forwarding all calls.  
Alternately dial 2.  
[Line Only]  
[Line]  
Select forwarding outside calls only.  
Alternately dial 8.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
425  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Answering Machine Emulation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Using Personal Answering Machine Emulation  
When Personal Answering Machine Emulation broadcasts your caller’s voice:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
c.  
Do nothing to have the caller’s message automatically recorded in your mailbox.  
Press SPEAKER or lift the handset to intercept the call.  
• If your extension is in the headset mode, you can only press SPEAKER.  
With Call Screening disabled:  
Press V-MAIL to stop the broadcast and send the call directly to your mailbox.  
With Call Screening enabled:  
Press V-MAIL to switch to the Call Screening mode.  
d.  
426  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb  
Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb  
Description  
Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb sends Automated Attendant calls directly to an extension user’s  
mailbox.Their phone will not ring for calls from the Automated Attendant.  
When a subscriber enables Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb, Automated Attendant calls to their extension go  
directly to their mailbox. Their phone will not ring for calls from the Automated Attendant. You can option-  
ally enable Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb from system programming. A subscriber typically turns on Auto  
Attendant Do Not Disturb when they need to work at their desk undisturbed by outside calls from the Auto-  
mated Attendant.  
Keep in mind that Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb will not block Intercom calls from co-workers or any other  
type of outside call not routed through the Automated Attendant. For example, with Automated Attendant Do  
Not Disturb enabled, Direct Inwards Lines and transferred outside calls to an extension work normally.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
1.  
Enable Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb FromYour Subscriber Mailbox.  
1. See Operation below.  
2.  
Optionally enable Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb from System Programming.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
If a subscriber has their calls forwarded immediately to their mailbox, Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb  
is not necessary (i.e., the operations are redundant).  
A subscriber does not have to have their greeting recorded to activate Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
427  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb  
Operation  
Recording a Multiple Greeting and Setting Up Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
Access the Mailbox Greeting options.  
[Greeting] - [Greet]  
G (4)  
IntraMail does the following:  
Plays a summary of your current settings.  
Displays the status of your active Greeting (1-3).  
[GREETING n: RECORDED] - [GREETING n: RECORDED], or  
[GREETING n: NOT REC] - [GREETING n: NOT REC]  
Shows the Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb status.  
[Auto-Attendant DND:OFF] - [Auto-Attendant DND:OFF], or  
[Auto-Attendant DND:ON] - [Auto-Attendant DND:ON]  
Provides soft keys for each of the 3 greetings.  
[Greeting 1] - [Gr1]  
[Greeting 2] - [Gr2]  
[Greeting 3] - [Gr3]  
Select a Greeting (which also makes it active).  
(1) [Greeting 1] - [Gr1]  
(2) [Greeting 2] - [Gr2]  
(3) [Greeting 3] - [Gr3]  
Listen to the active greeting (if recorded).  
[Listen] - [Lstn]  
L (5)  
R (7)  
Record a new greeting (if not recorded), or rerecord the  
current greeting.  
[Record] - [Rec]  
Record at the tone, then press # when done.  
Pause or restart recording.  
[Resume] - [Resume]  
[Pause] - [Pause]  
*
Erase the greeting.  
E (3)  
[Cancel] - [Cancel]  
End the recording.  
[Done] - [Done]  
#
Erase the currently recorded greeting (if any).  
[Erase] - [Erase]  
Go back to the Mailbox Greeting options.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
Change Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb.  
Turn Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb off or on.  
O (6)  
Go back to mailbox Main Menu.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
0
Plays Help message.  
428  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Erase or Save  
Auto Erase or Save  
Description  
When a  
mailbox user completely listens to a new message and then exits their mailbox,  
IntraMail will either save or erase the message.  
When a  
mailbox user completely listens to a new message and then exits their mailbox, IntraMail will either  
automatically save or erase the message. The setting of this option depends on how the subscriber would pre-  
fer their mailbox to operate. When set to erase, the subscriber can review their messages and retain only those  
they specically save using the SA option. This is a good choice for a subscriber that receives frequent unes-  
sential messages. When set to save, the subscriber has the assurance of knowing that every message they lis-  
tened to was saved in their mailbox. This is a good choice for those that must carefully review and consider  
each new message.  
Handling Partially Reviewed Messages  
When listening to multiple new messages when Auto Erase or Save is set to Save:  
Any message to which you partially listen is automatically saved.  
Any message to which you hang up during or do not listen is retained as a new message.  
For example, if you have three new messages, listen to part of message 1, dial L to hear part of message 2  
and then hang up, IntraMail automatically:  
Saves message 1.  
Retains messages 2 and 3 as new messages.  
Restarts the ashing ring/message lamp.  
Resets the telephone display to V-MAIL 02 (VM02).  
When listening to multiple new messages when Auto Erase or Save is set to Erase:  
Any message to which you partially listen is automatically erased.  
Any message to which you hang up during or do not listen is retained as a new message.  
For example, if you have three new messages, listen to part of message 1, dial L to hear part of message 2  
and then hang up, IntraMail automatically:  
Erases message 1.  
Retains messages 2 and 3 as new messages.  
Restarts the ashing ring/message lamp.  
Resets the telephone display to V-MAIL 02 (VM02).  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Subscriber Mailboxes set to save.  
Programming  
1.  
Should the mailbox be set for Auto Save or Auto Erase?  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
429  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Auto Erase or Save  
Other Related Features  
N/A  
Operation  
N/A  
430  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Time Stamp  
Auto Time Stamp  
Description  
Automatically hear the time and date a message was left.  
After a Subscriber Mailbox user listens to a message, IntraMail can optionally announce the time and date  
the message was left. The Subscriber can enable Auto Time Stamp from their mailbox, or you can optionally  
enable it from system programming. Auto Time Stamp helps if the subscriber needs to know the time and  
date of each message they receive without taking any extra steps. With Auto Time Stamp turned on, Intra-  
Mail automatically announces the date, time, and (optionally) the caller’s number at the end of each mes-  
sage. With Auto Time Stamp turned off, the subscriber must dialTI while listening to a message to get the  
same information.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
1.  
Enable Auto Time Stamp from your Subscriber Mailbox.  
1. See Operation below.  
2.  
Should the mailbox be set for Auto Time Stamp?  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Auto Time Stamp is available on the Mailbox Options Menu.  
IntraMail uses the telephone system Time and Date.  
An extension can listen to a message and dial a code to hear the time the message was sent.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
431  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Auto Time Stamp  
Operation  
Turning Auto Time Stamp On or Off  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
Access the Mailbox Options Menu.  
[MBOX Options] - [N/A]  
OP (67)  
Access Auto Time Stamp.  
[Time Stamp] - [Time]  
AT (28)  
IntraMail plays a summary of your Auto Time Stamp setting.  
• By default, Auto Time Stamp is turned off.  
Turn Auto Time Stamp on or off.  
O (6)  
Go back to the Mailbox Options Menu.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
0
Plays Help message.  
432  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automated Attendant  
Automated Attendant  
Description  
Automatically answers the telephone system’s incoming calls, plays an Instruction Menu  
message, and provides dialing options to callers.  
For a built-in call answering capability when IntraMail is not installed, see Automated  
Attendant, Built-In (page 433).  
The Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each line, according to the time of the day and day of the  
week that the call is ringing. The Automated Attendant can automatically answer the telephone system’s incom-  
ing calls, play an Instruction Menu message, and provide dialing options to callers. The block diagram below  
shows the default IntraMail Automated Attendant conguration. There are 3 major components:  
The Answer Table (8 maximum) determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each  
line, according to the time of the day and day of the week that the call is ringing. The Answer Table  
divides the time of day and day of the week into individual schedules, which in turn assign a Call Rout-  
ing Mailbox to each call. When a specic schedule is not in effect, the Answer Table uses its Default  
Mailbox to determine routing.  
- By default, all lines use Answer Table 1. Answer Table 1 has a single schedule that runs Monday  
through Friday from 8:30AM to 5:00PM.  
A Call Routing Mailbox (16 maximum) is a mailbox associated with an individual Answer Table schedule or  
the Default Mailbox. It species which dialing options (Dial Action Table) are available to callers. It also  
provides the Instruction Menu to callers which typically greets the callers and describes the dialing options.  
- By default, Answer Table 1 has a single schedule that runs Monday through Friday from 8:30AM to  
5:00PM. This schedule and the Default Mailbox both use Call Routing Mailbox 1.  
Once the Automated Attendant answers, the Dial Action Table (16 maximum) provides the dialing  
options to callers. Each digit a caller can dial is assigned a specic action (function) in the Dial Action  
Table. The dial action used depends on the setting in the active Call Routing Mailbox, which in turn  
depends on the Answer Table setup.  
- By default, Call Routing Mailbox 1 uses Dial Action Table 1.  
3112-01: Direct Termination (Day)  
3112-04: Direct Termination (Night)  
DIL to Voice Mail  
Master (700)  
Automated Attendant Answering (Default)  
Lines Route to  
Answer Table 1  
3131-02: Answer Table  
Answer Table 1  
421x-Answer Table  
Dial Action Table 1  
Dialing Options  
Dial an extension number, or  
0 for the operator  
Calls always route to Call Routing Mailbox 001  
4212: Schedule  
Schedule 1 or  
Default Mailbox  
-
-
Schedule 1 active M-F 8:30AM-5:00PM.  
Default Mailbox active all other times.  
4211-01: Default Mailbox  
To record a new Instruction Menu  
Message (from Extension 300):  
All Lines  
Call Routing  
Mailbox 001  
422x: Routing Mailboxes (001)  
Automated Attendant  
V-MAIL + SA + I + 001  
Built-In Automated Attendant  
#AG + 001  
Dial Action  
Table 1  
423x: Dial Action Tables  
With these  
dialing options  
Use Answer  
Table 1  
Which Chooses Call  
Routing Mailbox 001.  
And Dial Action  
Table 1  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
433  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Automated Attendant  
Upgrading from the Built-In Automated Attendant  
To upgrade to IntraMail from the Built-In Automated Attendant:  
1. Plug the IntraMail CompactFlash card into the system.  
- See your system’s Hardware Manual for more.  
2. Reset the system. IntraMail automatically installs.  
3. Rerecord your Instruction Menu Messages.  
- Your Answer Schedule and Dial Action Table programming remain intact.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• See Description above.  
Programming  
1.  
Assign Answer Tables to outside lines.  
that the Automated Attendant should answer.  
2.  
Set up the Automated Attendant to answer outside calls during the day.  
2. Set up a UCD night key on your extension or DSS Console to control the day/night mode of lines termi-  
nated to voice mail during the day  
- To set up a UCD night key on an extension:  
- To set up a UCD night key on a DSS Console:  
3.  
Set up the Automated Attendant to answer outside calls at night.  
4. Set up a System night key on your extension or DSS Console to control the day/night mode of the lines  
terminated to Key Ring during the day  
- To set up a System night key on an extension:  
- To set up a System night key on a DSS Console:  
4.  
5.  
6.  
Set up the Answer Tables.  
Set up the Call Routing Mailboxes.  
Set up the Dial Action Tables.  
434  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Automated Attendant  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each line.  
The mailbox associated with an Answer Table that species the dialing options (Dial Action Table)  
and Instruction Menu that announcements are available to Automated Attendant callers.  
Denes the dialing options for the Call Routing Mailbox chosen by the active Answer Table.  
The Automated Attendant can route outside calls to the company fax machine.  
One IntraMail system can provide individual greetings and dialing options for several companies.  
Operation  
Using the Automated Attendant  
For the outside caller:  
1.  
After Automated Attendant answers, the voice prompts will instruct you on which digits to dial.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
435  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automated Attendant, Built-In  
Automated Attendant, Built-In  
Description  
Provides built-in call answering capability when IntraMail is not installed.  
For the full-featured IntraMail Automated Attendant that automatically answers incoming calls,  
plays an Instruction Menu message, and provides dialing options to callers, see Automated  
Attendant (page 433).  
The Built-In Automated Attendant gives the system call answering and routing capabilities when IntraMail  
is not installed. The Built-In Automated Attendant can use any of the rst eight Call Routing Mailboxes  
(001-008) for call handling, and each of these eight Routing Mailboxes can have a 30 second Instruction  
Menu message (Attendant Greeting). The Routing Mailboxes must be Call Routing Mailboxes, and all other  
Routing Mailbox types are ignored. Additionally, the Built-In Automated Attendant provides two voice mail  
ports, allowing it to process two calls simultaneously.  
The Built-In Automated Attendant does not provide voice mail.  
Just like the full featured IntraMail Automated Attendant, the Built-In Automated Attendant can answer out-  
side calls on each line according to the time of the day and day of the week that the call is ringing. After  
answering, the Built-In Automated Attendant plays an Instruction Menu message (greeting) to the caller and  
provides them with dialing options. The block diagram below shows the default Built-In Automated Atten-  
dant conguration. There are 3 major Automated Attendant components:  
The Answer Table (8 maximum) determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each  
line, according to the time of the day and day of the week that the call is ringing. The Answer Table  
divides the time of day and day of the week into individual schedules, which in turn assign a Call Rout-  
ing Mailbox to each call. When a specic schedule is not in effect, the Answer Table uses its Default  
Mailbox to determine routing.  
- By default, all lines use Answer Table 1. Answer Table 1 has a single schedule that runs Monday  
through Friday from 8:30AM to 5:00PM.  
- All eight Answer Tables are available to the Built-In Automated Attendant.  
A Call Routing Mailbox (16 maximum) is a mailbox associated with an individual Answer Table schedule or  
the Default Mailbox. It species which dialing options (Dial Action Table) are available to callers. It also  
provides the Instruction Menu to callers which typically greets the callers and describes the dialing options.  
- By default, Answer Table 1 has a single schedule that runs Monday through Friday from 8:30AM to  
5:00PM. This schedule and the Default Mailbox both use Call Routing Mailbox 1.  
- Routing Mailboxes 001-008 are available to the Built-In Automated Attendant. Each Routing Mail-  
box must be a Call Routing Mailbox.  
Once the Automated Attendant answers, the Dial Action Table (16 maximum) provides the dialing  
options to callers. Each digit a caller can dial is assigned a specic action (function) in the Dial Action  
Table. The dial action used depends on the setting in the active Call Routing Mailbox, which in turn  
depends on the Answer Table setup. The valid Dial Action Table actions for the Built-In Automated  
Attendant are:  
- UTRF (Unscreened Transfer)  
- GOTO (Go to a Mailbox)  
- Hang Up  
- By default, Call Routing Mailbox 1 uses Dial Action Table 1.  
- All 16 Dial Action Tables are available to the Built-In Automated Attendant.  
436  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Automated Attendant, Built-In  
3112-01: Direct Termination (Day)  
3112-04: Direct Termination (Night)  
DIL to Voice Mail  
Master (700)  
Automated Attendant Answering (Default)  
Lines Route to  
Answer Table 1  
3131-02: Answer Table  
Answer Table 1  
421x-Answer Table  
Dial Action Table 1  
Dialing Options  
Dial an extension number, or  
0 for the operator  
Calls always route to Call Routing Mailbox 001  
4212: Schedule  
4211-01: Default Mailbox  
Schedule 1 or  
Default Mailbox  
-
-
Schedule 1 active M-F 8:30AM-5:00PM.  
Default Mailbox active all other times.  
To record a new Instruction Menu  
Message (from Extension 300):  
All Lines  
Call Routing  
Mailbox 001  
422x: Routing Mailboxes (001)  
Automated Attendant  
V-MAIL + SA + I + 001  
Built-In Automated Attendant  
#AG + 001  
Dial Action  
Table 1  
423x: Dial Action Tables  
With these  
dialing options  
Use Answer  
Table 1  
Which Chooses Call  
Routing Mailbox 001.  
And Dial Action  
Table 1  
Upgrading from the Built-In Automated Attendant  
To upgrade to IntraMail from the Built-In Automated Attendant:  
1. Plug the IntraMail CompactFlash card into the system.  
- See your system’s Hardware Manual for more.  
2. Reset the system. IntraMail automatically installs.  
3. Rerecord your Instruction Menu Messages.  
- Your Answer Schedule and Dial Action Table programming remain intact.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• See Description above.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
437  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Automated Attendant, Built-In  
Programming  
1.  
Enable the Built-In Automated Attendant.  
2. (Optional) If you want to upgrade the Built-In Automated Attendant to IntraMail:  
- Plug in the IntraMail CompactFlash Card.  
- Reset the system.  
- All system programming (Answer Tables, Dial Action Tables, etc.) will be retained.  
- Any custom Instruction Menu messages will be unavailable.  
2.  
Should extension be able to record the Instruction Menu message (greeting)?  
3.  
4.  
Assign Answer Tables to outside lines.  
that the Automated Attendant should answer.  
Set up the Automated Attendant to answer outside calls during the day.  
2. Set up a UCD night key on your extension or DSS Console to control the day/night mode of lines termi-  
nated to voice mail during the day  
- To set up a UCD night key on an extension:  
- To set up a UCD night key on a DSS Console:  
5.  
Set up the Automated Attendant to answer outside calls at night.  
4. Set up a System night key on your extension or DSS Console to control the day/night mode of the lines  
terminated to Key Ring during the day  
- To set up a System night key on an extension:  
- To set up a System night key on a DSS Console:  
6.  
7.  
Set up the Answer Tables.  
Set up the Call Routing Mailboxes.  
438  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automated Attendant, Built-In  
8.  
9.  
Set up the Dial Action Tables.  
Set the maximum message length for Automated Attendant callers leaving a message in a  
mailbox.  
1. Set the maximum message length in 4201-02: Incoming Message Length (page 872).  
- This sets the maximum message length (1-4095 seconds) for outside Automated Attendant callers  
leaving a message or Quick Message in a Subscriber Mailboxes.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each line.  
The mailbox associated with an Answer Table that species the dialing options (Dial Action Table)  
and Instruction Menu that announcements are available to Automated Attendant callers.  
Denes the dialing options for the Call Routing Mailbox chosen by the active Answer Table.  
The Automated Attendant can route outside calls to the company fax machine.  
One IntraMail system can provide individual greetings and dialing options for several companies.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
439  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automated Attendant, Built-In  
Operation  
Using the Built-In Automated Attendant  
For the outside caller:  
1.  
After Automated Attendant answers, the voice prompts will instruct you on which digits to dial.  
Recording an Automated Attendant Instruction Menu (Attendant Greeting) Message  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Access the Attendant Greeting options.  
Your extension must have access level 5.  
#AG  
(#24)  
Enter the Call Routing Mailbox number (001-008).  
Listen to the current Instruction Menu (if any).  
[Listen] - [Lstn]  
L (5)  
#
Exit.  
X (9)  
Record a new Instruction Menu.  
[Record] - [Rec]  
R (7)  
Record message.  
Pause or restart recording.  
[Resume] - [Resume]  
[Pause] - [Pause]  
*
Erase recording.  
E (3)  
[Cancel] - [Cancel]  
Exit recording mode.  
[Done] - [Done]  
#
Erase the Instruction Menu.  
[Erase] - [Erase]  
E (3)  
Exit.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
X (9)  
Plays Help message.  
0
440  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automated Attendant Transfer  
Automated Attendant Transfer  
Description  
While on an outside call, an extension user can transfer their call to the Automated Attendant  
for additional dialing options.  
An extension user can transfer their outside call to the Automated Attendant so the outside caller can use the  
Automated Attendant dialing options. This helps an outside caller, for example, that wants to return to the  
Automated Attendant so they can dial another co-worker or use a different Automated Attendant option.  
Conditions  
• Extensions cannot call or be transferred to the IntraMail Automated Attendant.  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
No additional programming required.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The Automated Attendant can automatically answer the telephone system’s incoming calls, play an  
Instruction Menu message, and provide dialing options to callers.  
Operation  
Automated Attendant Transfer  
To transfer an outside call to the Automated Attendant:  
1.  
While on an outside call, press V-MAIL.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
441  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Automatic Routing for Rotary Dial Callers  
Automatic Routing for Rotary Dial Callers  
Description  
Automatically route Automated Attendant callers that don’t dial any digits to a specied option.  
If an Automated Attendant caller doesn’t dial any digits, IntraMail will automatically route them to a speci-  
ed option (such as the operator or a mailbox). This lets rotary telephone users stay on the line to leave a  
message or have their call processed. Without Automatic Routing for Rotary Dial Callers, rotary callers  
would not be able to use the Automated Attendant.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Callers that don’t dial go to extension 300.  
Programming  
1.  
Program the Dial Action Table TIMEOUT function.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), assign the TIMEOUT function routing.  
- Since rotary dial callers can’t dial DTMF digits, the TIMEOUT function provides routing.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Consider routing rotary dial callers to a Guest Mailbox to collect messages.  
Operation  
None  
442  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Bilingual Voice Prompts  
Bilingual Voice Prompts  
Description  
Provides IntraMail voice prompts in one of two active languages.  
Bilingual Voice Prompts provides IntraMail voice prompts in one of two active languages (primary and sec-  
ondary). These language choices are available to Routing Mailboxes, outside lines, Station Mailboxes, and  
Group Mailboxes as follows:  
Routing Mailbox  
The language an Automated Attendant caller hears is set by the answering Routing Mailbox.  
Outside Line  
For outside lines not answered by the Automated Attendant, the language the caller hears if routed to  
voice mail is set by the line. An outgoing outside call also hears the line’s language setting if it is then  
transferred to a co-worker’s mailbox.  
Station Mailbox  
When you log onto your own mailbox and use its features, you always hear your mailbox language. If  
you call a co-worker and leave a message, you will hear the system’s Primary Language.  
Group Mailbox and UCD Group Mailbox  
Similar to a Station Mailbox, when you log into a Group or UCD Group Mailbox and use its features,  
you always hear the language programmed for that mailbox. If a co-worker leaves a message in the  
Group Mailbox, they hear the system’s Primary Language.  
There are up to six languages stored in the IntraMail CompactFlash card, any two of which you can make  
active. By default, English mnemonic and English numeric are active and the other four languages (if any)  
are inactive. You activate an inactive language through system programming.  
Automated Attendant callers can optionally dial a digit to select the language of their choice.  
How the System Handles Language Priority  
The following illustration shows how IntraMail prioritizes language selection while routing a call. For example:  
1. The Automated Attendant answers an outside call using a Call Routing Mailbox with the Secondary Lan-  
guage selected.  
2. The caller dials extension 308, which has the Primary Language enabled and is set up to hunt to voice  
mail if unanswered.  
3. Extension 308 doesn’t answer and the caller is routed to voice mail. The voice prompts played to the  
caller (except for the recorded Greeting and Mailbox Name) are in the Secondary Language. The Call  
Routing Mailbox language selection overrides language setting for the destination mailbox.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
443  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Bilingual Voice Prompts  
If an outside call is answered by a Routing Mailbox (e.g.,  
when Automated Attendant answers), the caller uses the  
Routing Mailbox language for the duration of the call.  
Priority 1  
Routing Mailbox  
When an outside call is answered by voice mail (e.g., when  
a DIL to an extension hunts to that extension’s mailbox),  
the caller uses the language programmed for the line for  
the duration of the call.  
Line  
Priority 2  
if you call a co-worker and leave a message, you will use  
the system’s Primary Language.  
System Primary  
Language  
Priority 3  
If you log onto your mailbox and use its features, you al-  
ways use your mailbox language.  
Subscriber’s  
Own Mailbox  
Priority 4  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Primary Language is English mnemonic.  
• Secondary Language is English numeric.  
• All mailboxes use the Primary Language.  
• There are currently no other stored languages available.  
Programming  
1.  
Review how the system handles language priority.  
2.  
Activate the system’s Primary and Secondary Languages.  
guage. From the six choices, you can activate one primary and one Secondary Language. The options  
are:  
- 1 for US English Mnemonic  
- 2 for US English Mnemonic  
- 3-6 - Not used  
2. In 4203-02: Secondary Voice Prompt Language (page 879), set the secondary IntraMail voice prompt lan-  
guage. From the six choices, you can activate one primary and one Secondary Language. The options are:  
- 1 for US English Mnemonic  
- 2 for US English Mnemonic  
- 3-6 - Not used  
444  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bilingual Voice Prompts  
3.  
4.  
Select the prompt language for Call Routing Mailboxes.  
calls answered or routed to the Routing Mailbox. The options are:  
- 1 for Primary Language  
- 2 for Secondary Language  
Optionally allow an Automated Attendant caller to dial a digit to switch languages.  
1. For the Call Routing Mailbox that will initially answer the call:  
caller should initially hear (1 for primary or 2 for secondary).  
- In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901) for the assigned Dial Action Table, for an available key:  
- For Action, enter 7 (GOTO).  
- For Number, enter the number of the Call Routing Mailbox that will have the alternate language.  
- Record an Instruction Menu that instructs the caller which digit to dial to switch languages.  
2. For the Call Routing Mailbox that will have the alternate language:  
guage (1 for primary or 2 for secondary).  
- (Optional) In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901) for the assigned Dial Action Table, for an available  
key:  
- For Action, enter 7 (GOTO).  
- For Number, enter the number of the Call Routing Mailbox that initially answered the call.  
- Record an Instruction Menu that tells the caller which digit to dial to return to the initial language.  
5.  
6.  
7.  
8.  
Select the prompt language for outside lines.  
are routed to voice mail. The options are:  
- 1 for Primary Language  
- 2 for Secondary Language  
Select the prompt language for Station Mailboxes.  
scriber hears when they log into their mailbox. The options are:  
- 1 for Primary Language  
- 2 for Secondary Language  
Select the prompt language for Ring Group Mailboxes.  
Group Mailbox user hears when they log into the Group Mailbox. The options are:  
- 1 for Primary Language  
- 2 for Secondary Language  
Select the prompt language for UCD Group Mailboxes.  
UCD Group Mailbox user hears when they log into the UCD Group Mailbox. The options are:  
- 1 for Primary Language  
- 2 for Secondary Language  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
445  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bilingual Voice Prompts  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Transferred outside calls use the language setting of the line.  
IntraMail Features  
When doing a Remote Logon through the Automated Attendant, the caller uses the destination mail-  
box language setting (not the language of the Routing Mailbox that answered the call).  
Message Notication uses the notifying mailbox’s language (not the language of the line used to place  
the callout).  
If leaving a Quick Message through the Automated Attendant, the caller uses the language of the  
Routing Mailbox that answered the call (not the language of the mailbox in which they are leaving the  
Quick Message).  
The language used for an extension’s Voice Prompting Messages is set by the Subscriber Mailbox lan-  
guage selection.  
Operation  
None  
446  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Forward to a Mailbox  
Call Forward to  
a
Mailbox  
Description  
An extension user can forward their calls to their mailbox.  
A subscriber can easily forward calls to their Subscriber Mailbox. Instead of dialing an extension as the for-  
warding destination, the user just presses theirV-MAIL key instead. With Call Forward to a Mailbox, the sub-  
scriber is assured that their calls don’t get forgotten when they are busy or unavailable. Unlike with  
Extension Hunting to Voice Mail, forwarding lets the subscriber choose when and how they want their unan-  
swered calls to go to voice mail (rather than have the telephone system reroute their calls automatically).  
Call Forwarding a Subscriber’s Direct Inward Line to their Mailbox  
The following table describes how IntraMail handles a subscriber’s Direct Inward Line when it is Call For-  
warded to their mailbox. The routing occurs when the caller dials a digit while listening to the recorded or  
default mailbox greeting.  
Dialing Options while Listening to a Subscriber Mailbox Greeting  
2144-04: Next Call  
Routing Mailbox  
2144-03: Dialing Option  
Digit  
Dialed  
Action  
Undened  
No  
0
Caller hears, “That is an invalid entry,” and  
the greeting repeats, and the caller is  
prompted to leave a message.  
1-9  
#
*
IntraMail hangs up.  
Caller skips greeting and can immediately  
start recording.  
1-16 (valid Call  
Routing Mailbox)  
No  
0
Caller follows 0 action in Next Call Routing  
Mailbox.  
1-9  
Caller hears, “That is an invalid entry,” the  
greeting repeats, and the caller is prompted to  
leave a message.  
#
*
Caller routes to the Next Call Routing Mail-  
box and hears its Instruction Menu.  
Caller skips greeting and can immediately  
start recording.  
1-16 (valid Call  
Routing Mailbox)  
Yes  
0
1-9  
#
Caller follows key’s action in Next Call Rout-  
ing Mailbox.  
Caller routes to the Next Call Routing Mail-  
box and hears its Instruction Menu.  
*
Caller skips greeting and can immediately  
start recording.  
Logging Onto a Subscriber Mailbox while Listening to the Greeting  
A subscriber who wishes to log onto their mailbox while listening to their greeting must have the option set  
in their Next Call Routing Mailbox. To allow this capability, for example:  
1. Program the Next Call Routing Mailbox # digit as LOGON to IXXX.  
2. While listening to their greeting, the subscriber can dial:  
# (to route to their Next Call Routing Mailbox), then  
# and their mailbox number to log onto their mailbox.  
By default, this option is provided in Call Routing Mailbox 1. Additionally, the subscriber should enable a  
Security Code for their mailbox to prevent unauthorized logons.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
447  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Call Forward to a Mailbox  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Call Forwarding is allowed, but not set up for any extensions.  
• Ring No Answer Call Forward occurs after 10 seconds.  
Programming  
1.  
Set how long an unanswered call will ring before forwarding.  
1. In 1601-03: Call Forward No Answer Timer (page 670), program how long an unanswered call will ring  
before forwarding.  
- For type 2 (Not Answered) and type 6 (Busy or Not Answered) forwarding, an unanswered call will  
forward after this interval.  
- This timer applies to transferred outside calls, Direct Inward Lines, and Intercom calls.  
- For more on timers that may affect Call Forwarding, see Call Forwarding (page 44).  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
When enabled, Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb automatically sends all calls from the Automated  
Attendant to the subscriber’s mailbox.  
Extension Hunting to Voice Mail automatically sends calls to an extension’s mailbox without the user  
having to set up Call Forwarding.  
A subscriber can forward a message in their Subscriber Mailbox to a co-worker.  
The setting of the Next Call Routing Mailbox and Dialing Option options determine the digits a caller  
can dial while listening to the recorded or default mailbox greeting.  
448  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Forward to a Mailbox  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Activating or Canceling Call Forward to your Mailbox  
To activate Call Forwarding:  
1.  
Select the Call Forwarding options.  
[Menu + Call Forward]  
[Menu + Cfwd]  
Alternately do one of the following:  
• Press INTERCOM and dial *3.  
• Press your Call Forwarding Feature Key.  
2.  
Select or cancel a Call Forwarding type.  
[Immediate]  
[Immed]  
Select Call Forwarding Immediate.  
• Alternately dial 4.  
1
[Ring/No Ans]  
[RNA]  
Select Call Forwarding when Not Answered.  
• Alternately dial 6.  
1
[Busy/No Ans]  
[BNA]  
Select Call Forwarding when Busy or Not Answered.  
• Alternately dial 2.  
[None]  
[More + More + None]  
Select to cancel Call Forwarding.  
• Alternately dial 0.  
Select the Call Forwarding destination:  
• An extension number.  
3.  
4.  
0 for the operator.  
• A UCD Group master number.  
V-MAIL for voice mail.  
Select the Call Forwarding mode.  
[All]  
[All]  
Select forwarding all calls.  
Alternately dial 2.  
[Line Only]  
[Line]  
Select forwarding outside calls only.  
Alternately dial 8.  
1
Option will not forward voice-announced Intercom calls.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
449  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Routing Mailbox  
Call Routing Mailbox  
Description  
The mailbox associated with an Answer Table that species the dialing options and  
announcements for Automated Attendant callers.  
The Call Routing Mailbox, associated with an Answer Table, species which dialing options (Dial Action  
Table) and announcements are available to Automated Attendant callers. By default, IntraMail provides 8  
Call Routing Mailboxes (1-8). However, you can assign any of the 16 Routing Mailboxes as a Call Routing  
Mailbox. The Call Routing Mailbox is an integral part of the Automated Attendant. The Automated Atten-  
dant can automatically answer the telephone system’s incoming calls, play an Instruction Menu message,  
and provide dialing options to callers. The block diagram below shows the default IntraMail Automated  
Attendant conguration. There are 3 major Automated Attendant components:  
The Answer Table (8 maximum) determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each  
line, according to the time of the day and day of the week that the call is ringing. The Answer Table  
divides the time of day and day of the week into individual schedules, which in turn assign a Call Rout-  
ing Mailbox to each call. When a specic schedule is not in effect, the Answer Table uses its Default  
Mailbox to determine routing.  
- By default, all lines use Answer Table 1. Answer Table 1 has a single schedule that runs Monday  
through Friday from 8:30AM to 5:00PM.  
Call Routing Mailbox  
A Call Routing Mailbox (16 maximum) is a mailbox associated with an individual Answer Table schedule or  
the Default Mailbox. It species which dialing options (Dial Action Table) are available to callers. It also  
provides the Instruction Menu to callers which typically greets the callers and describes the dialing options.  
- By default, Answer Table 1 has a single schedule that runs Monday through Friday from 8:30AM to  
5:00PM. This schedule and the Default Mailbox both use Call Routing Mailbox 1.  
Once the Automated Attendant answers, the Dial Action Table (16 maximum) provides the dialing  
options to callers. Each digit a caller can dial is assigned a specic action (function) in the Dial Action  
Table. The dial action used depends on the setting in the active Call Routing Mailbox, which in turn  
depends on the Answer Table setup.  
- By default, Call Routing Mailbox 1 uses Dial Action Table 1.  
3112-01: Direct Termination (Day)  
3112-04: Direct Termination (Night)  
DIL to Voice Mail  
Master (700)  
Automated Attendant Answering (Default)  
Lines Route to  
Answer Table 1  
3131-02: Answer Table  
Answer Table 1  
421x-Answer Table  
Dial Action Table 1  
Dialing Options  
Dial an extension number, or  
0 for the operator  
Calls always route to Call Routing Mailbox 001  
4212: Schedule  
Schedule 1 or  
Default Mailbox  
-
-
Schedule 1 active M-F 8:30AM-5:00PM.  
Default Mailbox active all other times.  
4211-01: Default Mailbox  
To record a new Instruction Menu  
Message (from Extension 300):  
All Lines  
Call Routing  
Mailbox 001  
422x: Routing Mailboxes (001)  
Automated Attendant  
V-MAIL + SA + I + 001  
Built-In Automated Attendant  
#AG + 001  
Dial Action  
Table 1  
423x: Dial Action Tables  
With these  
dialing options  
Use Answer  
Table 1  
Which Chooses Call  
Routing Mailbox 001.  
And Dial Action  
Table 1  
450  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Call Routing Mailbox  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• See Description above.  
Programming  
1.  
Set up the Call Routing Mailbox.  
- Select the Routing Mailbox (1-16) you want to program.  
- By default, Call Routing Mailboxes are 1-8.  
2.  
3.  
To record an Instruction Menu message for the Call Routing Mailbox:  
1. See Operation below.  
To assign which Dial Action Table will provide dialing options for this Call routing Mailbox:  
1. In 4222-01: Dial Action Table (page 891), enter the Dial Action Table (1-16) that will provide the dialing  
options for the Call Routing Mailbox.  
4.  
To change the amount of time Automated Attendant callers have to dial options:  
- By default, Automated Attendant callers have 5 seconds to dial commands.  
3. If the caller waits too long to dial:  
- When the associated Dial Action Table has a Timeout action programmed, the caller routes to that  
destination.  
- When the associated Dial Action Table does not have a Timeout action programmed, the Instruction  
Menu repeats 3 times and then IntraMail hangs up.  
5.  
To set the Maximum Length of Instruction Menus:  
onds) as required.  
- By default, this interval is 120 seconds.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The Call Routing Mailbox associates specic dialing options (Dial Action Table) with an Answer Table.  
The Automated Attendant can automatically answer the telephone system’s incoming calls, play an  
Instruction Menu message, and provide dialing options to callers.  
Denes the dialing options for the Call Routing Mailbox chosen by the active Answer Table.  
Provides callers with additional dialing options after they leave a message in an extension’s mailbox.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
451  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Routing Mailbox  
The System Administrator can record the Instruction Menu for a Call Routing Mailbox. See Opera-  
tion below.  
Operation  
Recording an Instruction Menu for a Call Routing Mailbox  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto System Administrator’s mailbox.  
Access System Administrator options.  
[System Admin] - [N/A]  
SA (72)  
Select Instruction Menus.  
[Instruction] - [Instr]  
I (4)  
Enter the Call Routing Mailbox number (001-016).  
Listen to the current Instruction Menu (if any).  
[Listen] - [Lstn]  
L (5)  
Exit listen mode.  
#
Record a new Instruction Menu.  
[Record] - [Rec]  
R (7)  
Record message.  
Pause or restart recording.  
[Resume] - [Resume]  
[Pause] - [Pause]  
*
Erase recording.  
[Cancel] - [Cancel]  
E (3)  
#
Exit recording mode.  
[Done] - [Done]  
Erase the Instruction Menu.  
[Erase] - [Erase]  
E (3)  
Go back to the System Administrator options.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
Go back to the System Administrator options.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
Plays Help message.  
0
452  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Screening  
Call Screening  
Description  
Users can screen (listen to) voice mail messages as they are being left in their mailbox.  
Call Screening allows a display keyset extension user to listen to (screen) a voice mail message as it is being  
left in their mailbox. Call Screening emulates a standard home answering machine — in addition to provid-  
ing more control when handling incoming messages. Similar to Personal Answering Machine Emulation, the  
extension user can listen as the message is being left, intercept the call, or end the screen and have the mes-  
sage recorded privately. Unlike Personal Answering Machine emulation, Call Screening does not require the  
extension user to forward their calls immediately to voice mail. The telephone display automatically shows  
the Call Screening soft key options as soon as the recording begins.  
When enabled, Call Screening will broadcast the caller’s message as soon as the mailbox Greeting com-  
pletes. Additionally, if the extension user intercepts (answers) the screened call, the rst portion of the mes-  
sage is automatically erased from the extension’s mailbox.  
Any caller that can leave a message can have their call screened by the extension user.  
Call Screening and Group Mailboxes  
If extensions share a Group Mailbox, any number of extensions in the group can screen an incoming message.  
The group extensions can monitor the incoming message simultaneously. If any group member answers the  
call (i.e., intercepts the incoming message), the remaining group members are immediately disconnected.  
Automatic Call Screening  
With Automatic Call Screening enabled, an extension will immediately screen (broadcast) an incoming mes-  
sage as soon as the caller starts to leave it in the extension’s mailbox. The extension user hears two beeps fol-  
lowed by the caller’s voice.  
Conditions  
• If more than one caller is leaving a message in a mailbox simultaneously, Call Screening will listen to  
the rst message.  
Default Setting  
• Call Screening disabled.  
Programming  
1.  
Should the extension be able to use Call Screening?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Any number of extensions in the group can screen an incoming message.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
453  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Call Screening  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Manual Call Screening Operation  
When Automatic Call Screening is off, you hear a single beep and V-MAIL ashes fast while IntraMail records your  
caller’s message. Your display automatically changes to show the Call Screening soft key options.  
Call Screening is only available while your telephone is idle.  
To intercept the call (and stop recording the message):  
[Answer]  
[Answ]  
This intercepts the call.  
• Alternately press the ashing V-MAIL key.  
1.  
To hear your caller’s message as it is recorded in your mailbox (i.e., activate the Call Screening mode):  
[Screen] - [Scrn]  
1.  
To intercept the call (and stop recording the message):  
[Answer]  
[Answ]  
This intercepts the call.  
Alternately press SPEAKER, lift the handset, or press V-MAIL.  
1.  
To continue listening to your caller’s message as it is being recorded:  
1.  
Do nothing.  
To exit Call Screening and allow the message to continue recording in private:  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
The message continues to record privately.  
1.  
To use another feature or process another call:  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
1.  
To use another feature, lift the handset or press any other feature key.  
To exit Call Screening and allow the message to continue being recorded in private:  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
The message continues to record privately.  
1.  
To use another feature or process another call:  
1.  
Lift the handset, press SPEAKER, or press any other feature key.  
454  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call Screening  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Automatic Call Screening Operation  
When Automatic Call Screening is on, your idle telephone automatically goes into the screen mode while your  
caller leaves a message.  
Call Screening is only available while your telephone is idle.  
To turn Automatic Call Screening on or off:  
[Menu + Screen]  
1.  
Enable or disable Automatic Call Screening.  
[Menu + More + More + Scrn]  
[On]  
[On]  
Turn Automatic Call Screening on.  
• The top line of the display shows the Automatic Call Screening status.  
[Off]  
[Off]  
Turn Automatic Call Screening off.  
• The top line of the display shows the Automatic Call Screening status.  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
Exit.  
To intercept the call (and stop recording the message):  
[Answer]  
[Answ]  
This intercepts the call.  
• Alternately press SPK, V-MAIL, or lift the handset.  
1.  
To continue listening to your caller’s message as it is being recorded:  
1.  
Do nothing.  
To exit Call Screening and allow the message to continue recording in private:  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
The message continues to record privately.  
1.  
To use another feature or process another call:  
[Exit]  
[Exit]  
To use another feature, lift the handset or press any other feature key.  
1.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
455  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Caller ID and Voice Mail  
Caller ID and Voice Mail  
Description  
A telephone company service that provides a caller’s number and optional name.  
Caller ID is a telephone company service that provides an extension with a caller’s number and optional  
name. With Caller ID, the keyset user knows who’s calling before they pick up the call. Caller ID Logging  
stores a record of the call on the user’s telephone which they can review and use to easily return the call.  
When used with IntraMail, Caller ID enables the Make Call feature for outside calls. After listening to a  
voice message, the subscriber can dial MC to return the call without knowing the callers phone number.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Caller ID is disabled in the telephone system programming.  
Programming  
Be sure the telephone system is congured to pass  
Caller ID to the IntraMail voice mail ports.  
1.  
2.  
No IntraMail specic programming required.  
1. No additional programming is required to enable Caller ID in IntraMail.  
Check your telco service.  
1. Be sure the telco provides Caller ID to the connected telephone system.  
Check your telephone system programming to be sure it is set up to receive Caller ID and pass  
it to the IntraMail voice mail ports.  
3.  
ANI = 3).  
4.  
Set up your basic Caller ID Logging programming.  
backs (1 = line, 2 = Line Group).  
use for Caller ID callbacks.  
98) the system will use for Caller ID callbacks.  
456  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Caller ID and Voice Mail  
Other Related Features  
Features  
Review these features for additional information.  
IntraMail Features  
An extension user can listen to a voice message and dial a code to return the call without knowing the  
caller’s phone number. Make call to an outside telephone number requires Caller ID.  
Screened Transfers from the Automated Attendant provide Caller ID data only after the user answers  
the call.  
Unscreened Transfers from the Automated Attendant provide Caller ID data while the call is ringing.  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
457  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Caller ID with Return Call  
Caller ID with Return Call  
Description  
458  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Calling the Automated Attendant  
Calling the Automated Attendant  
Description  
Outside callers can return to the Automated Attendant for additional dialing options.  
Automated Attendant callers can use various IntraMail features and then return to the Automated Attendant  
for additional dialing options. This lets the caller dial other extensions, leave messages for co-workers, or  
use other Automated Attendant features. The features below describe several ways to return to the Auto-  
mated Attendant.  
An extension user can transfer their outside call to the Automated Attendant so the outside caller can use  
the Automated Attendant dialing options.  
The Next Call Routing Mailbox provides callers with additional dialing options after they leave a mes-  
sage in a mailbox (depending on the setting of the Dialing Option).  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Operation  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
459  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Centrex Transfer  
Centrex Transfer  
Description  
The Automated Attendant can transfer a caller from a Centrex line to an outside number using  
the features of that Centrex line.  
Centrex Transfer is a Dial Action Table option that can transfer an Automated Attendant call from a Centrex  
line to an outside number using the features of that Centrex line. With Centrex Transfer, the Automated  
Attendant answers an outside call and then transfers the caller back to the telco using the same line on which  
the call initially rang. To set this up, assign a Dial Action Table action as a UTRF to a System Speed Dial bin  
(e.g., #201P). The bin should contain the complete dial string (preceded by a Flash command) required to  
initiate the Centrex Transfer. When the Automated Attendant answers, the caller dials the digit and IntraMail  
automatically routes them to the outside number.  
Centrex Transfer is only available if the telephone system connects to Centrex lines that provide the features  
required to complete the transfer. Similar to External Transfer, Centrex Transfer allows your callers to easily  
reach branch ofces and important off-site associates. Unlike External Transfer, Centrex Transfer requires  
unique telco features.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
1.  
Set up a Dial Action Table for Centrex Transfer.  
1. In 4222-01: Dial Action Table (page 891), assign a Dial Action Table (1-16) to each active Call Routing  
Mailbox.  
2. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter 2 to assign an available digit as a UTRF action  
- The corresponding Routing option should be # followed by the System Speed Dial bin, followed by  
a pause. (The pause gives the system time to dial the stored number.)  
- To enter a pause for the Routing option, press Feature Key 4.  
- For example, to have Centrex Transfer dial System Speed Dial bin 201, enter #201P.  
2.  
Program the System Speed Dial bin for Centrex Transfer.  
Feature), set up the Speed Dial bin for Centrex Transfer.  
- The stored number should ash the Centrex line and dial the number required to initiate the transfer  
- The stored number should be in the format FXXX (Flash + Number), and contain the complete dial  
string required to process a Centrex Transfer.  
- If using 1702-Assignment (System Speed Dial Assignment) to program System Speed Dial:  
- Press Feature Key 1 to enter a Flash.  
- Number is the number you want the system to dial into the Centrex to initiate the transfer.  
- Use bin type 2 (line) or 3 (line group), not 1 (Intercom) or 4 (extend).  
- If using #SP to program System Speed Dial:  
- Press FLASH to enter a Flash.  
- Number is the number you want the system to dial into the Centrex to initiate the transfer.  
- The LINE/GRP/ICM entry should be line (1-64) or Line Group (90-98), not INTERCOM.  
460  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Centrex Transfer  
3.  
Set the Flash and pause timers for compatibility with the connected Centrex lines.  
1. Set the Flash timer for compatibility with the connected Centrex lines.  
nected Centrex service.  
2. Set the Pause timer for compatibility with the Centrex Transfer feature.  
trex service.  
4.  
Enable Tandem Calls for the Centrex line.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Centrex Transfer uses the active Dial Action Table to route transfer an Automated Attendant caller  
back to the telco using the same Centrex line.  
External Transfer allows an Automated Attendant caller to automatically route to an outside telephone  
number.  
Operation  
Operation is automatic once set up in programming.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
461  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conversation Record  
Conversation Record  
Description  
Allows an extension user to record their active call as a message in their mailbox.  
Conversation Record allows a subscriber to record their active call as a new message in their mailbox, which  
they can review later on. Conversation Record can be helpful when an extension user is on a call that  
involves a lot of detail (such as a technical discussion or extensive directions). Rather than taking notes as  
the call progresses, the user can record the conversation and carefully review it later on. IntraMail broadcasts  
a beep and a voice prompt to the callers as Conversation Record begins. After calling their mailbox, the sub-  
scriber can save, edit, or delete the recorded conversation.  
Caution  
The use of monitoring, recording, or listening devices to eavesdrop, monitor, retrieve, or record telephone  
conversations or other sound activities, whether or not contemporaneous with transmission, may be ille-  
gal in certain circumstances under federal or state laws. Legal advice should be sought prior to imple-  
menting any practice that monitors or records any telephone conversation. Some federal and state laws  
require some form of notication to all parties to a telephone conversation, such as using a beep tone or  
other notication methods or requiring the consent of all parties to the telephone conversation, prior to  
monitoring or recording the telephone conversation. Some of these laws incorporate strict penalties.  
Conversation Record Key for a Co-worker’s Mailbox  
Your extension or DSS Console can have Conversation Record keys for co-worker’s mailboxes. While on a  
call, you can press the key to record your conversation directly into a co-worker’s mailbox. You can set up  
the key to record into any valid Subscriber Mailbox (including Group Mailboxes programmed as Subscriber  
Mailboxes). This could help a dispatcher, for example, that wants to record a conversation with a client right  
into the responsible technician’s mailbox.  
Your extension can have multiple Conversation Record keys, each associated with a different mailbox.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
1.  
Should extension be able to use Conversation Record?  
1. In 2102-01: Class of Service (page 724), check the extension’s Class of Service level.  
2.  
Optionally put a Record key on the extension or DSS Console.  
You can the Record [Rec] soft key in lieu of a Record Feature Key.  
1. To set up a Record key on an extension:  
sation you want to record (i.e., your own or a co-worker’s).  
2. To set up Record key on a DSS Console:  
versation you want to record (i.e., your own or a co-worker’s).  
462  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Conversation Record  
3.  
Enable the Conversation Record Beep and Warning.  
- If enabled, all parties on a call being recorded will hear the voice prompt Recording followed by a  
beep when the extension user initiates Conversation Record. If disabled, the voice prompt and beep  
will not occur.  
- Disabling this option may be interpreted as an invasion of privacy.  
4.  
Set the maximum length of recorded conversations.  
(1-4095 seconds).  
- The length of a recorded conversation is 10 times this interval.  
- Since the Conversation Record time cannot exceed 4095 seconds, any settings in this option larger  
than 409 have no effect on the length of recorded conversations.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Conversation Record is only available to subscriber extensions.  
Operation  
Conversation Record  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
To record your active call in your mailbox:  
• Only one party on a call can use Conversation Record at any one time. This includes Intercom calls and Conference calls.  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
[Record] [More + Rec]  
Select to enable Conversation Record.  
• The Conversation Record soft key is only available for outside calls.  
a.  
b.  
Press your Conversation Record Feature Key.  
• The record key can be assigned to yours or a co-worker’s mailbox.  
• The key will ash fast (green) on your keyset; ash fast (red) on your DSS Console.  
Once recording begins:  
2.  
You and your caller hear the voice prompt “Recording.”  
You see: RECORD MAILBOX XXX  
(where XXX is the number of the mailbox into which the conversation is recording).  
To turn Conversation Record off:  
Do one of the following.  
• The portion of the call already recorded is sent to your mailbox as a new message.  
1.  
a.  
b.  
Press V-MAIL.  
Press a Record Feature Key on your extension or DSS Console.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
463  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conversation Record  
User Programmable Feature  
Setting up a Conversation Record Key  
Feature  
Mnemonic  
#KP (#57)  
Operation  
Access Level  
Voice Mail  
#KP + Press key you want to program + HOLD + Dial 17  
+ Enter mailbox number or 0 for your own mailbox +  
HOLD + SPEAKER twice to exit.  
3-5  
464  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Dial Action Table  
Dial Action Table  
Description  
Denes the dialing options for Automated Attendant callers.  
The Dial Action Table denes the dialing options for the Call Routing Mailbox chosen by the active Answer  
Table, which in turn provides those dialing options to Automated Attendant callers. IntraMail provides 16  
Dial Action Tables. The Dial Action Table is an integral part of the Automated Attendant. The Automated  
Attendant can automatically answer the telephone system’s incoming calls, play an Instruction Menu mes-  
sage, and provide dialing options to callers. The block diagram below shows the default IntraMail Auto-  
mated Attendant conguration. There are 3 major Automated Attendant components:  
The Answer Table (8 maximum) determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each  
line, according to the time of the day and day of the week that the call is ringing. The Answer Table divides  
the time of day and day of the week into individual schedules, which in turn assign a Call Routing Mailbox  
to each call. When a specic schedule is not in effect, the Answer Table uses its Default Mailbox to deter-  
mine routing.  
- By default, all lines use Answer Table 1. Answer Table 1 has a single schedule that runs Monday  
through Friday from 8:30AM to 5:00PM.  
A Call Routing Mailbox (16 maximum) is a mailbox associated with an individual Answer Table schedule or  
the Default Mailbox. It species which dialing options (Dial Action Table) are available to callers. It also  
provides the Instruction Menu to callers which typically greets the callers and describes the dialing options.  
- By default, Answer Table 1 has a single schedule that runs Monday through Friday from 8:30AM to  
5:00PM. This schedule and the Default Mailbox both use Call Routing Mailbox 1.  
Dial Action Table  
Once the Automated Attendant answers, the Dial Action Table (16 maximum) provides the dialing  
options to callers. Each digit a caller can dial is assigned a specic action (function) in the Dial Action  
Table. The dial action used depends on the setting in the active Call Routing Mailbox, which in turn  
depends on the Answer Table setup.  
- By default, Call Routing Mailbox 1 uses Dial Action Table 1.  
3112-01: Direct Termination (Day)  
3112-04: Direct Termination (Night)  
DIL to Voice Mail  
Master (700)  
Automated Attendant Answering (Default)  
Lines Route to  
Answer Table 1  
3131-02: Answer Table  
421x-Answer Table
Answer Table 1  
Dial Action Table 1  
Dialing Options  
Dial an extension number, or  
0 for the operator  
All Lines  
Calls always route to Call Routing Mailbox 001  
4212: Schedule  
Schedule 1 or  
-
-
Schedule 1 active M-F 8:30AM-5:00PM.  
4211-01: Default Mailbox  
Default Mailbox  
Default Mailbox active all other times.  
To record a new Instruction Menu  
Message (from Extension 300):  
Call Routing  
Mailbox 001  
422x: Routing Mailboxes (001)  
Automated Attendant  
V-MAIL + SA + I + 001  
Built-In Automated Attendant  
#AG + 001  
Dial Action  
Table 1  
423x: Dial Action Tables  
With these  
dialing options  
Use Answer  
Table 1  
Which Chooses Call  
Routing Mailbox 001.  
And Dial Action  
Table 1  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
465  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Dial Action Table  
Dial Action Table Options  
The following table summarizes the Dial Action Table dial (key) actions and their associated features.  
Dial Action Table Key Action Summary  
Action  
STRF  
Description  
Screened Transfer (1)  
Allows an Automated Attendant caller to place  
a Screened Transfer to an extension. IntraMail  
calls (screens) the destination to see if the call  
can go through.  
Feature Reference  
For more, see:  
Unscreened Transfer (2)  
UTRF  
Allows an Automated Attendant caller to place  
an Unscreened Transfer to an extension.Intra-  
Mail transfers the call the destination and then  
hangs up.  
Quick Message with Greeting (3)  
REC1  
REC2  
Allows an Automated Attendant caller to leave  
a Quick Message at an extension. The caller  
will hear the extension’s personal greeting.  
Quick Message without Greeting (4)  
Allows an Automated Attendant caller to leave  
a Quick Message at an extension. The caller  
will not hear the extension’s personal greeting  
Log Onto Voice Mail (5)  
LOGON  
Allows an Automated Attendant caller to log  
onto a mailbox, either directly or one of their  
choosing.  
Hang Up (6)  
IntraMail says “Goodbye” and hangs up.  
Hang  
Up  
Go to a Mailbox, (7)  
Allows an Automated Attendant caller to route  
to another mailbox.  
GOTO  
Undened Routing (0)  
This action provides no routing.  
N/A  
UND  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• See Description above.  
466  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Dial Action Table  
Programming  
1.  
Assign a Dial Action Table to each active Call Routing Mailbox.  
1. In 4222-01: Dial Action Table (page 891), assign a Dial Action Table (1-16) to each active Call Routing  
Mailbox.  
2.  
Customize the Dial Action Table options.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), customize the Dial Action Table digit assignments as required.  
The following table shows the Dial Action Table default assignments.  
Dial Action Table Default Settings  
Key  
0
Dial Action Table 1  
Dial Action Tables 2-16  
UTRF to 300  
(Unscreened Transfer to 300)  
UND  
(Undened)  
1
2
3
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UTRF to XXX  
(Unscreened Transfer to  
user-dialed extension)  
UND  
(Undened)  
4
UTRF to XXX  
(Unscreened Transfer to  
user-dialed extension)  
UND  
(Undened)  
5
6
7
8
9
*
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
HNGUP  
(Hangup)  
UND  
(Undened)  
REC1 to IXXX  
(Quick Message with Greeting to  
user-dialed extension)  
UND  
(Undened)  
#
LOGON to IXXX  
(Logon to user-dialed mailbox)  
UND  
(Undened)  
Timeout  
UTRF to 300  
(Unscreened Transfer to 300)  
UND  
(Undened)  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
467  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dial Action Table  
4.  
To change the amount of time Automated Attendant callers have to dial options:  
- By default, Automated Attendant callers have 5 seconds to dial commands.  
3. If the caller waits too long to dial:  
- When the associated Dial Action Table has a Timeout action programmed, the caller routes to that  
destination.  
- When the associated Dial Action Table does not have a Timeout action programmed, the Instruction  
Menu repeats 3 times and then IntraMail hangs up.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The Automated Attendant can automatically answer the telephone system’s incoming calls, play an  
Instruction Menu message, and provide dialing options to callers.  
Determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each line.  
The mailbox associated with an Answer Table that species which dialing options (Dial Action Table)  
and announcement are available to Automated Attendant callers.  
Operation  
N/A  
468  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Directory Dialing  
Directory Dialing  
Description  
An Automated Attendant caller to reach an extension by dialing the rst few letters in the  
extension user’s name.  
Directory Dialing allows an Automated Attendant caller to reach an extension by dialing the rst few letters  
in the extension user’s name. With Directory Dialing, the caller does not have to remember the extension  
number of the person they wish to reach — just their name. Here’s how Directory Dialing works:  
1. When the Automated Attendant answers, it sends the call to a Directory Dialing Mailbox. (Optionally,  
the caller may be asked to dial a digit to access Directory Dialing.)  
2. The Directory Dialing Mailbox plays the Directory Dialing Message (recorded by the System Adminis-  
trator) which asks the caller to dial letters for the name of the person they wish to reach.  
3. The caller dials the letters for the person’s name plus #. They can dial by rst name or last name, depend-  
ing on how the Directory Dialing Message was recorded and the Directory Dialing Mailbox was set up.  
4. IntraMail searches the list of programmed extension names for a match of the caller-entered letters.  
5. Voice prompts announce the rst three matches, and allow the caller to dial a digit (1-3) to reach one of  
the announced matches. Additionally, the caller can dial 4 to hear additional matches (if any).  
6. The caller dials the digit for the extension they wish to reach, and IntraMail sends the call to that exten-  
sion. The call is sent as a Screened or Unscreened transfer, depending on programming.  
For callers to use Directory Dialing, the system must have a name programmed for each extension (up to 18  
characters, A-Z, using upper and lower case letters). Each extension should also have a name recorded in  
their Subscriber Mailbox. In addition, each extension used by Directory Dialing must be installed and must  
have their Subscriber Mailbox active (Personal or Group).  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
Basic Setup  
1.  
2.  
Set up the Directory Dialing Mailbox.  
1. In 4221-01: Routing Mailbox Type (page 890), enter 3 to assign the selected Routing Mailbox as a Direc-  
tory Dialing Mailbox.  
Set up Directory Lists to control which extensions Directory Dialing can access.  
1. In 2144-05: Directory List Number (page 774), Select the Directory List to which the extension  
belongs. The entries are:  
- 1-8 for lists 1-8  
0 (for no list)  
* (for all lists).  
the Directory Dialing Mailbox can route calls. The entries are 1-8 (for lists 1-8).  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
469  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Directory Dialing  
3.  
To record a Directory Dialing Message:  
1. See Operation below.  
- The Directory Dialing Message is the Instruction Menu for the Routing Mailbox programmed as a  
Directory Dialing Mailbox.  
- By default (without a custom message recorded), the Directory Dialing Message is, “Please enter  
one or more letters of the person’s name, then press the pound key.”  
- This option sets the maximum message length (1-4095 seconds) for Instruction Menus.  
Extension Name Programming and Routing  
1.  
Set up the name programming and enter names.  
1. In 1511-01: Name Format (page 655), set the name format. This determines how names should be  
- 1 for rst name followed by last name.  
- 2 for last name followed by rst name.  
2. In 2101-02: Station Name (page 720), enter a name for each extension. The format you use should fol-  
Directory Dialing Mailbox should route. This option allows for dial-by-rst-name and dial-by-last-name  
Directory Dialing. Enter:  
- 1 for rst.  
- 2 for last.  
2.  
3.  
Determine how many letters of the employee’s name the caller must dial.  
employee’s name the caller must dial to use Directory Dialing.  
- If the caller dials less than the specied minimum number of letters, IntraMail cannot route the call.  
When Directory Dialing nds a name match, should it route the call as a Screened or  
Unscreened Transfer?  
1. For Unscreened Transfer:  
2. For Screened Transfer:  
- In 4224-03: Screened Transfer Timeout (page 896), set how long a Screened Transfer from the  
Directory Dialing Mailbox will ring an unanswered extension before recalling. The entries are:  
1-255 seconds.  
0 for immediate recall.  
4.  
Do Directory Dialing callers have enough time to dial letters?  
- 01-99 seconds.  
- 0 for immediate timeout.  
- If the caller waits too long to dial, the Directory Dialing Message repeats.  
470  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Directory Dialing  
Additional Options  
1.  
Should Directory Dialing Mailbox be able to detect and route incoming faxes?  
1. In yes:  
- This allows the Directory Dialing Mailbox to detect fax CNG tone.  
- In 4224-09: Fax Transfer Extension (page 900), enter the extension to which the Directory Dialing  
Mailbox should route the fax.  
- When the Directory Dialing Mailbox detects fax CNG tone, it routes the call to this extension.  
2. If no:  
Should Directory Dialing Mailbox callers be able to dial 0 for other options or # to go to another  
routing mailbox?  
2.  
1. If yes, in 4224-07: Next Call Routing Mailbox (page 899) assign a Next Call Routing Mailbox (1-16) to  
the Directory Dialing Mailbox.  
2. If no, in 4224-07: Next Call Routing Mailbox (page 899) remove the assignment by pressing CLEAR.  
- Once assigned, dialing # routes to the Next Call Routing Mailbox and plays its message. Dialing 0  
follows the 0 action of the Next Call Routing Mailbox.  
3.  
4.  
To have an outside call be directly answered by the Directory Dialing Mailbox:  
1. Make sure the active Answer Table uses the Call Routing Mailbox programmed as a Directory Dialing  
Mailbox.  
To allow callers to access Directory Dialing from a Dial Action Table action:  
1. Make sure you have an action in the active Dial Action Table that is a GOTO to the Directory Dialing  
Mailbox.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
A Directory Dialing Mailbox is the type of mailbox required to implement Directory Dialing.  
Only the System Administrator can record the Directory Dialing Message.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
471  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Directory Dialing  
Operation  
Recording a Directory Dialing Message  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto System Administrator’s mailbox.  
Access System Administrator options.  
[System Admin] - [N/A]  
SA (72)  
Select Instruction Menus.  
[Instruction] - [Instr]  
I (4)  
Enter the Directory Dialing Mailbox number.  
Listen to the current Directory Dialing Message (if any).  
[Listen] - [Lstn]  
L (5)  
#
Exit listen mode.  
Record a new Directory Dialing Message.  
[Record] - [Rec]  
R (7)  
Record message.  
Pause or restart recording.  
[Resume] - [Resume]  
[Pause] - [Pause]  
*
Erase recording.  
E (3)  
[Cancel] - [Cancel]  
Exit recording mode.  
[Done] - [Done]  
#
Erase the Directory Dialing Message.  
[Erase] - [Erase]  
E (3)  
Go back to the System Administrator options.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
Go back to the System Administrator options.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
0
Plays Help message.  
Using Directory Dialing  
To use Directory Dialing:  
After the Automated Attendant answers, wait for the Directory Dialing Message.  
• The Automated Attendant may ask you to dial a digit for Directory Dialing.  
1.  
2.  
Dial the letters that correspond to the name of the person you wish to reach + #.  
• The Directory Dialing Message will tell you how many letters you need to dial, and whether you should  
enter the person’s rst name or last name.  
• To exit Directory Dialing without selecting a name, just dial #.  
The Automated Attendant will announce the name matches, and tell you which digit to dial (1-3) to reach each  
of the announced names.  
• To hear additional name matches (if any), dial 4 instead.  
3.  
4.  
Once you make your selection, the Automated Attendant will route your call to the name you select.  
472  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Directory Dialing  
Dialing Options Available while Entering a Name  
The following table shows the dialing options available to the caller while they are entering a name into a  
Directory Dialing Mailbox.  
By default, the caller can dial the digs 2-9 to enter the name or dial # to return to the Automated Attendant.  
If a Next Call Routing Mailbox is specied, the caller can dial the digits 2-9 to enter a name, dial 0 to follow  
the 0 action of the Next Call Routing Mailbox, or dial # to route directly to the Next Call Routing Mailbox.  
Directory Dialing Mailbox Name Entry Options  
(Options available while entering a name)  
Dialed Digit  
Next Call Routing Mailbox Setting  
Action  
N/A  
Entry is ignored.If no additional digits are dialed, repeats the Direc-  
tory Dialing Message (to make a new name entry) up to twice and  
then hangs up.  
1
N/A  
Interprets the digit as a letter and waits 6 seconds for additional input  
(i.e., more letters or a # to conclude name entry). If no additional dig-  
its are dialed, repeats the Directory Dialing Message (to make a new  
name entry) up to twice and then hangs up.  
2-9  
0
UND (Not assigned)  
Repeats the Directory Dialing Message (to make a new name entry)  
each time the caller dials the digit.  
1-16 (valid Call Routing Mail-  
box)  
Caller routes according to the 0 action of the Next Call Routing Mail-  
box’s Dial Action Table.  
N/A  
Repeats the Directory Dialing Message (to make a new name entry)  
each time the caller dials the digit.  
*
UND (Not assigned)  
Routes to the Automated Attendant (i.e., back to the Call Routing  
Mailbox that initially answered the call).  
#
1-16 (valid Call Routing Mail-  
box)  
Routes to the Next Call Routing Mailbox and plays that mailbox’s  
Instruction Menu.  
N/A  
Repeats the Directory Dialing Message (to make a new name entry)  
up to two times and then hangs up.  
Timeout  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
473  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Directory Dialing  
Dialing Options Available when more than one Employee has the Entered Name  
If the name the caller enters is used by more than one employee, IntraMail lets the caller select the employee  
to which they want to talk. The caller can dial 1, 2 or 3 to select the employee from the rst three name  
matches, or dial 4 to hear additional name matches.  
By default, the caller can also dial * to make a new entry or dial # to return to the Automated Attendant.  
If a Next Call Routing Mailbox is specied, the caller can also dial * to make a new entry, dial 0 to follow the  
0 action of the Next Call Routing Mailbox, or dial # to route directly to the Next Call Routing Mailbox  
.
Directory Dialing Mailbox Routing Options  
(Options available after a name is entered)  
Dialed Digit  
Next Call Routing Mailbox Setting  
Action  
N/A  
Route to the respective extension from the list of up to three  
announced matches.  
1-3  
N/A  
N/A  
If more than three matches for the entered name are found, provides  
access to the next set of three matches.  
4
5-9  
0
Plays “That is an invalid entry” and repeats the list of announced  
matches each time the caller dials the digit.  
UND (Not assigned)  
Plays “That is an invalid entry” and repeats the list of announced  
matches each time the caller dials the digit.  
1-16 (valid Call Routing Mail- Caller routes according to the 0 action of the Next Call Routing Mail-  
box)  
box’s Dial Action Table.  
N/A  
Repeats the Directory Dialing Message (to make a new name entry)  
each time the caller dials the digit.  
*
UND (Not assigned)  
Routes to the Automated Attendant (i.e., back to the Call Routing  
Mailbox that initially answered the call).  
#
1-16 (valid Call Routing Mail- Routes to the Next Call Routing Mailbox and plays that mailbox’s  
box)  
Instruction Menu.  
UND (Not assigned)  
Repeats the list of announced matches (up to two times). If no  
response, repeats the Directory Dialing Message (to make a new  
name entry) up to three times and then hangs up.  
Timeout  
474  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Directory Dialing Mailbox  
Directory Dialing Mailbox  
Description  
The mailbox type required for Directory Dialing.  
A Directory Dialing Mailbox is the Routing Mailbox type required to implement Directory Dialing. See  
Directory Dialing (page 469) for more on how to set up a Directory Dialing Mailbox.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No Directory Dialing Mailboxes assigned.  
Programming  
1.  
Set up the Directory Dialing Mailbox.  
1. In 4221-01: Routing Mailbox Type (page 890), enter 3 to assign the selected Routing Mailbox as a Direc-  
tory Dialing Mailbox.  
Turn to Directory Dialing (page 469) for more on how to program Directory Dialing.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Directory Dialing allows an Automated Attendant caller to reach an extension by dialing the rst few  
letters in the extension user’s name.  
Only the System Administrator can record the Directory Dialing Message.  
Operation  
Turn to Directory Dialing (page 469) for more on how to use Directory Dialing and record a Directory Dial-  
ing Message.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
475  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Erasing All Messages  
Erasing All Messages  
Description  
Lets the System Administrator delete mailbox messages system-wide.  
The System Administrator can delete all messages in a Subscriber Mailbox. Erasing All Messages is an  
administrator’s maintenance tool. The administrator may need to use this tool if an employee has left the  
company or has an excessive number of messages stored in their mailbox. By deleting the unwanted mes-  
sages, the administrator can prevent the IntraMail recording capacity from being reached (which would dis-  
able many of the IntraMail messaging features).  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
N/A  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can delete any messages left in their mailbox.  
Only the System Administrator can delete messages in a co-worker’s mailbox.  
Operation  
Erasing All Messages in a Subscriber Mailbox  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto System Administrator’s mailbox.  
Access System Administrator options.  
[System Admin] - [N/A]  
SA (72)  
Select Subscriber Mailbox Maintenance options.  
[Subscriber] - [Subs]  
S (7)  
Enter the number of the Subscriber Mailbox you want to maintain.  
Erase all Subscriber Mailbox messages.  
EA (32)  
[Erase All Messages] - [Msgs]  
Go back to System Administrator options.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
0
Plays Help message.  
476  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Exiting a Mailbox  
Exiting  
a
Mailbox  
Description  
Exit your mailbox by dialing a code or by hanging up.  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can exit their mailbox by dialing a code or by hanging up. After exiting, the sub-  
scriber can use their extension for normal call processing.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
N/A  
Other Related Features  
N/A  
Operation  
Exiting a Mailbox  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
To exit your mailbox:  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
Exit your mailbox.  
XX (99)  
[Exit + Exit] - [Exit + Exit]  
To exit and immediately return to your mailbox:  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
Exit and return to your mailbox.  
X# (9#)  
[Exit + RETURN] - [Exit + Return]  
0
Plays Help message.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
477  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Extension Hunting to Voice Mail  
Extension Hunting to Voice Mail  
Description  
Automatically sends unanswered calls to an extension’s mailbox.  
Extension Hunting to Voice Mail automatically sends calls to an extension’s mailbox without the user having  
to set up Call Forwarding. For example, Extension Hunting to Voice Mail can send unanswered transferred  
calls to an extension’s mailbox rather than recalling the transferring party. In addition, Extension Hunting to  
Voice Mail can send an unanswered Direct Inward Line to the extension’s mailbox instead of diverting to  
Key Ring. Hunting can also reroute calls from the Automated Attendant as well as ringing Intercom calls  
(depending on the hunt type). Unlike Call Forwarding, Extension Hunting to Voice Mail requires no action  
by the extension user to redirect calls; the system reroutes them automatically.  
There are 4 types of Extension Hunting to Voice Mail:  
Ring No Answer Line (Type 1)  
Type 1 hunting reroutes outside calls to the extension’s mailbox after a preset interval. Type 1 hunting  
reroutes outside calls when the extension is idle, busy, or in Do Not Disturb but does not reroute ringing  
or voice-announced Intercom calls. See the Routing Charts below for more.  
Ring No Answer / Busy Line (Type 2)  
Type 2 hunting also reroutes outside calls to the extension user’s mailbox. When the extension is idle,  
Type 2 hunting reroutes calls after an interval. Type 2 hunting reroutes outside calls immediately while  
the extension is busy or in Do Not Disturb. Like Type 1 hunting, Type 2 hunting does not reroute ringing  
or voice-announced Intercom calls. See the Routing Charts below for more.  
Ring No Answer / Busy All (Type 3)  
Type 3 hunting reroutes outside calls and ringing Intercom calls. If the extension is idle, calls reroute to  
the user’s mailbox after an interval. Type 3 hunting reroutes calls immediately when the extension is  
busy or in Do Not Disturb. It does not reroute voice-announced Intercom calls.See the Routing Charts  
below for more.  
Busy Line (Type 4)  
Type 4 hunting is similar to Type 2 hunting except that transferred outside calls to an idle extension do  
not reroute. Transferred outside calls, Direct Inward Lines, and calls from the Automated Attendant go  
immediately to the mailbox when the extension is busy or in Do Not Disturb. This type of hunting never  
reroutes ringing or voice-announced Intercom calls. See the Routing Charts below for more.  
Notes:  
Extension Hunting to Voice Mail does not reroute voice-announced Intercom calls.  
Extension Hunting to Voice Mail does not reroute Key Ring calls. See Key Ring (page 214) for more.  
478  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Extension Hunting to Voice Mail  
Extension Hunting to Voice Mail Routing Charts  
The following charts show in detail how each type of hunting handles incoming calls.  
Ring No Answer Line (Type 1) Hunting to Voice Mail Routing Chart  
Call Type  
Extension Idle  
Extension Busy  
Extension in DND  
Ringing Intercom Call  
Does not hunt (use Call Forwarding instead).  
Transferred Outside Call  
interval, then routes to mailbox.  
Timer (page 670) interval, then routes to mailbox.  
UTRF from Automated  
Attendant  
STRF from Automated  
Attendant1  
interval, then Automated  
Attendant prompts caller to  
leave a message.  
Automated Attendant immediately prompts caller to  
leave a message.  
Direct Inward Line  
val, then routes to mailbox.  
Follows night route for the  
line.  
1
Ring No Answer / Busy Line (Type 2) Hunting to Voice Mail Routing Chart  
Call Type  
Intercom  
Extension Idle  
Extension Busy  
Extension in DND  
Does not hunt (use Call Forwarding instead).  
Transferred Outside Call  
interval, then routes to mail-  
box.  
Call goes immediately to mailbox.  
UTRF from Automated  
Attendant  
STRF from Automated  
Attendant1  
Rings for 4224-03: Screened Automated Attendant immediately prompts caller to leave a  
interval, then Automated  
Attendant prompts caller to  
leave a message.  
Direct Inward Line  
interval, then routes to mail-  
box.  
Call goes immediately to  
mailbox.  
Follows night route for the  
line.  
1
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
479  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Extension Hunting to Voice Mail  
Ring No Answer / Busy All (Type 3) Hunting to Voice Mail Routing Chart  
Call Type  
Intercom  
Extension Idle  
Extension Busy  
Extension in DND  
Ringing Intercom call rings  
Call goes immediately to mailbox.  
routes to mailbox. Voice-  
announced Intercom calls  
do not hunt.  
Transferred Outside Call  
interval, then routes to  
mailbox.  
UTRF from Automated  
Attendant  
STRF from Automated  
Attendant1  
Rings for 4224-03: Screened Automated Attendant immediately prompts caller to leave a  
interval, then Automated  
Attendant prompts caller to  
leave a message.  
Direct Inward Line  
interval, then routes to  
mailbox.  
Call goes immediately to  
mailbox.  
Follows night route for the  
line.  
1
Busy Line (Type 4) Hunting to Voice Mail Routing Chart  
Call Type  
Intercom  
Extension Idle  
Extension Busy  
Extension in DND  
Does not hunt (use Call Forwarding instead).  
Transferred Outside Call  
Does not hunt (use Call  
Forwarding instead).  
Call goes immediately to mailbox.  
UTRF from Automated  
Attendant  
interval, then routes to  
mailbox.  
STRF from Automated  
Attendant1  
Rings for 4224-03: Screened Automated Attendant immediately prompts caller to leave a  
interval, then Automated  
Attendant prompts caller to  
leave a message.  
Direct Inward Line  
Does not hunt (use Call  
Forwarding instead).  
Call goes immediately to  
mailbox.  
Follows night route for the  
line.  
1
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
480  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Extension Hunting to Voice Mail  
Programming  
1.  
Set up the hunt type and destination for Type 1 hunting.  
- 1 for Ring No Answer Line.  
- 2 for Ring No Answer/Busy Line.  
- 3 for Ring No Answer/Busy All.  
- 4 for Busy Line.  
2. In 2115-01: Hunt Destination (page 746), enter 700 (the IntraMail master number).  
2.  
Set the system timers used for Type 1 hunting.  
1. In 1603-01: Transfer Recall Timer (page 675), set how long a transferred outside call or a UTRF from  
the Automated Attendant rings an idle extension before routing to the extension’s mailbox.  
2. In 1601-02: DIL No Answer Timer (page 669), set how long a DIL waits at an extension before routing to  
the extension’s mailbox.  
- Does not apply to hunt type 4.  
3. In 1601-03: Call Forward No Answer Timer (page 670), set how long a transferred outside call or UTRF  
from the Automated Attendant waits at a busy or DND extension before routing to the extension’s mailbox.  
- Does not apply to hunt types 2 and 4.  
4. In 4224-03: Screened Transfer Timeout (page 896), set how long a STRF from the Automated Attendant  
rings an idle extension before prompting the caller to leave a message.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
481  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Extension Hunting to Voice Mail  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
A subscriber can forward calls to their mailbox calls don’t go unanswered when they are unavailable.  
The telephone system can automatically reroute unanswered outside calls to the IntraMail Automated  
Attendant.  
Operation  
Extension Hunting to Voice Mail  
To force Extension Hunting to Voice Mail to redirect all your calls to your mailbox:  
Press DND.  
1.  
• Type 1 hunting will not redirect Intercom calls.  
482  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
External Transfer  
External Transfer  
Description  
An Automated Attendant caller can automatically route to an outside telephone number.  
External Transfer allows an Automated Attendant caller to automatically route to an outside telephone num-  
ber. To set this up, assign a Dial Action Table action as a UTRF to a System Speed Dial bin (e.g., #201 +  
Pause for system bin 201). When the Automated Attendant answers, the caller dials the digit and IntraMail  
automatically routes them to the outside number contained in the bin. Similar to Centrex Transfer, External  
Transfer allows your callers to easily reach branch ofces and important off-site associates. Unlike Centrex  
Transfer, External Transfer does not require unique telco features.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
1.  
Set up a Dial Action Table for External Transfer.  
1. In 4222-01: Dial Action Table (page 891), assign a Dial Action Table (1-16) to each active Call Routing  
Mailbox.  
2. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), assign a UTRF (2) action to an available digit.  
- The corresponding Routing option should be # followed by the System Speed Dial bin, followed by  
a pause. (The pause gives the system time to dial the stored number.)  
- Press Feature Key 1 to enter a Pause. For example, to have External Transfer dial System Speed  
Dial bin 201, enter #201P (entered by pressing Feature Key 1).  
2.  
3.  
Program the System Speed Dial bin for External Transfer.  
Feature), set up the Speed Dial bin for External Transfer.  
- The bin should contain just the outside telephone number you want External Transfer to dial.  
Enable Tandem Calls for the incoming line.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
483  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
External Transfer  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Centrex Transfer allows the Automated Attendant to transfer a caller over a Centrex line using the fea-  
tures of that Centrex line.  
External Transfer uses the active Dial Action Table to route an Automated Attendant caller to an out-  
side telephone number.  
Operation  
Operation is automatic once set up in programming.  
484  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fax Detection  
Fax Detection  
Description  
Automatically transfer incoming fax calls to a fax machine.  
The Automated Attendant can detect incoming fax calls and transfer them to a fax machine. With Fax Detec-  
tion enabled, after the Automated Attendant answers a call it listens for incoming fax CNG tone. If it detects  
the tone, it does an unscreened transfer of the call to the specied company fax machine. The incoming fax  
then prints out on the company fax machine. If you disable Fax Detection, the Automated Attendant will not  
detect and route incoming fax calls.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
1.  
To set up Fax Detection for a Call Routing Mailbox:  
2. In 4222-05: Fax Extension (page 892), specify the extension that should receive faxes from the Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
- Normally, this is the extension number of the analog port to which the fax machine is connected  
(e.g., 320).  
2.  
To set up Fax Detection for a Directory Dialing Mailbox:  
2. In 4224-09: Fax Transfer Extension (page 900), specify the extension that should receive faxes from the  
Call Routing Mailbox.  
- Normally, this is the extension number of the analog port to which the fax machine is connected  
(e.g., 320).  
Other Related Features  
None  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
485  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Flexible Answering Schedules  
Flexible Answering Schedules  
Description  
The Automated Attendant can answer outside calls with different announcements and dialing  
options, depending on the time of day and day of week.  
The Automated Attendant can answer outside calls with different announcements and dialing options,  
depending on the time of day and day of week. For example, a company can set up separate schedules for  
weekdays, evenings, weekends, and specic holidays. Each schedule can play a different announcement to  
callers, as well as provide them with unique dialing options. Once set up in programming, the schedule oper-  
ation is automatic.  
The Flexible Answering Schedules are determined by the set up of the IntraMail Answer Tables. See Answer  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
1.  
Determine which Answer Table answers each outside line.  
Answer Table that should handle the line’s Automated Attendant calls.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each line.  
The Automated Attendant can automatically answer the telephone system’s incoming calls, play an  
Instruction Menu message, and provide dialing options to callers.  
The mailbox associated with an Answer Table that species which dialing options (Dial Action Table)  
and announcements are available to Automated Attendant callers.  
Denes the dialing options for the Call Routing Mailbox chosen by the active Answer Table.  
Operation  
N/A  
486  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Flexible Call Routing  
Flexible Call Routing  
Description  
Provides outside callers with a wide variety of dialing (routing) options.  
The Automated Attendant can provide outside callers with a wide variety of dialing (routing) options. You  
can customize the announcements and routing options to exactly meet the site requirements. Use Flexible  
Call Routing to eliminate or minimize the need for an operator or receptionist to handle outside calls.  
There are 3 components to Flexible Call Routing.  
Determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each line, according to the time of  
the day and day of the week that the call is ringing.  
The mailbox associated with an Answer Table that species which dialing options (Dial Action Table)  
and announcement are available to Automated Attendant callers.  
Denes the dialing options for the Call Routing Mailbox chosen by the active Answer Table, which in  
turn provides those dialing options to Automated Attendant callers.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Options are available by default.  
Programming  
Refer to Automated Attendant (page 433) for more on how to set up your Flexible Answering Schedules.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail  
Determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each line.  
The Automated Attendant can automatically answer the telephone system’s incoming calls, play an  
Instruction Menu message, and provide dialing options to callers.  
The mailbox associated with an Answer Table that species which dialing options (Dial Action Table)  
and announcement are available to Automated Attendant callers.  
Denes the dialing options for the Call Routing Mailbox chosen by the active Answer Table.  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
487  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Flexible Mailbox Numbering Plan  
Flexible Mailbox Numbering Plan  
Description  
If telephone extension numbers are customized, set up IntraMail mailbox numbers to match.  
If the telephone system extension numbers are changed or swapped, IntraMail will automatically change the  
Subscriber Mailbox numbers to match. There is no extensive reprogramming required. After the swap, all of  
the subscriber’s messages and options are available at their new extension number. Flexible Mailbox Num-  
bering Plan lets you customize a site’s extension numbers and be assured that IntraMail will automatically  
adapt to the new conguration.  
Two-digit mailboxes are not supported in IntraMail.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Available  
Programming  
Flexible Numbering Plan Example  
1.  
To accommodate extension number 800 assigned to station number 2 (for example):  
2. In 1301-[01-10]: Expected Number of Digits (page 620), be sure the expected digits option for the digit  
8 is 3.  
3. In 1311-01: Station Extension Number (page 623), change the extension number for station 2 to 800.  
Customize the active Dial ActionTables to allow Automated Attendant callers to dial the new  
extension.  
2.  
- For key 8, enter UTRF (or TRF) for the Action and XXX for the corresponding Routing.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Be sure the Dial Action Table actions accommodate the revised telephone system numbering.  
Operation  
N/A  
488  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Forced Unscreened Transfer  
Forced Unscreened Transfer  
Description  
Automatically converts Automated Attendant ScreenedTransfers to Unscreened Transfers.  
A Subscriber Mailbox can optionally convert Automated Attendant Screened Transfers to Unscreened  
Transfers. Enable this option for a mailbox if the subscriber prefers to receive all calls sent by the Automated  
Attendant as Unscreened Transfers. With Unscreened Transfers,  
Calls from the Automated Attendant ring like other transferred calls and display the incoming Caller ID  
data (if provided by telco and enabled in programming) as the call is ringing.  
As with Screened Transfers, unanswered calls route to the subscriber’s greeting (recorded or default) so  
the caller can leave a message. However, with Unscreened Transfer the caller cannot dial 2 to reach the  
Next Call Routing Mailbox options (if programmed).  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled.  
Programming  
1.  
To enable Forced Unscreened Transfer for the Subscriber Mailbox:  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
If enabled in the Subscriber Mailbox, IntraMail automatically converts any Screened Transfers  
(STRFs) to the subscriber’s extension to Unscreened Transfers (UTRFs).  
After the Automated Attendant caller dials an extension, IntraMail calls (screens) the destination  
extension to see if the transfer can go through.  
After an Automated Attendant caller dials an extension, IntraMail immediately transfers the call to the  
extension and hangs up.  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
489  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Getting Recorded Help  
Getting Recorded Help  
Description  
Request help from the IntraMail voice prompts.  
If a Subscriber Mailbox user dials an incorrect code or forgets what to dial while in their mailbox, they can  
request help from the IntraMail voice prompts. Recorded Help provides the user with a built-in, interactive  
user’s guide. To get recorded help, the user dials 0.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
No additional programming required.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Voice Prompts provide real-time instructions on how to use the IntraMail features.  
Operation  
Getting Recorded Help  
Log onto your mailbox  
Get recorded help.  
0
• Recorded help is always available from the Main Menu.  
• Recorded help may not be available at all levels.  
490  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Go to a Mailbox  
Go to  
a
Mailbox  
Description  
An Automated Attendant caller can dial a digit and route directly into a mailbox.  
An Automated Attendant caller can dial a digit to route to a Call Routing or Announcement Mailbox. This is  
called the Go To (GOTO) action. The GOTO action can route directly to a specic Call Routing or  
Announcement Mailbox, or allow the Automated Attendant caller to go to a mailbox of their own choosing.  
Use the GOTO action to set up a “tree” of Automated Attendant options.  
The block diagram below shows how the Automated Attendant can provide the caller with a “tree” of dialing  
options. Dialing 1 (GOTO 9) routes to Announcement Mailbox 9, which plays the company directions. Dial-  
ing 2 (GOTO 1) routes to Call Routing Mailbox 2, which is set up to give the caller single-digit dialing to  
Tech Service technicians.  
The Announcement Message for Announcement Mailbox 9 tells the caller how to locate the company.  
The Instruction Menu for Call Routing Mailbox 1 instructs the caller which digits to dial for each techni-  
cian. The Dial Action Table for Call Routing Mailbox 2 contains the STRF or UTRF actions to each  
technician’s extension.  
Automated Attendant  
Company  
Directions  
1
GOTO 9  
Announcement Mailbox 9  
2
GOTO 2  
Tech Service  
Technicians  
Call Routing Mailbox 1  
Call Routing Mailbox 2  
The GOTO action can also log into a Subscriber Mailbox, although the LOGON action is normally reserved  
for this function.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No GOTO actions programmed.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
491  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Go to a Mailbox  
Programming  
1.  
Assign a GOTO action to the active Dial ActionTable.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), assign a GOTO action to an available key.  
To have Automated Attendant callers dial a single digit to go to a Call Routing or  
Announcement Mailbox:  
2.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter the mailbox number in the corresponding Routing option.  
- For example, to have key 1 go to Call Routing Mailbox 1, for key 1 enter GOTO for the Action and  
1 for the corresponding Routing.  
To have IntraMail require Automated Attendant callers to enter a Call Routing or Announcement  
Mailbox number in order to route:  
3.  
4.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter XXX in the corresponding Routing option. The key you  
choose must represent the rst digit in the mailbox numbers.  
- For example, to allow callers to go to mailboxes 1-16 by dialing 001-016, for key 0 enter GOTO for  
the Action and XXX for the corresponding Routing.  
To log into any valid Call Routing or Subscriber Mailbox:  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter IXXX in the corresponding Routing option.  
- For example, to allow callers to dial 1 plus any Call Routing or Announcement Mailbox number to  
go to, for key 1 enter GOTO for the Action and IXXX for the corresponding Routing.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The Automated Attendant can automatically answer the telephone system’s incoming calls, play an  
Instruction Menu message, and provide dialing options to callers.  
The GOTO action is a Dial Action Table option.  
Be sure the Instruction Menu for the active Call Routing Mailbox describes how to use the GOTO action.  
Operation  
Using the Automated Attendant GOTO Action  
For the outside caller:  
1.  
After Automated Attendant answers, the voice prompts will instruct you on which digits to dial.  
492  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Greeting  
Greeting  
Description  
A user can record a Greeting for their mailbox callers to hear.  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can record a personalized greeting for their mailbox. Caller’s to the user’s mail-  
box hear the prerecorded personalized greeting rather than a default message. The greeting can announce the  
subscriber’s name, provide a personal message (such as “Hello - I am on vacation this week”), or instruct the  
caller how to leave a message or use other mailbox options. A greeting that provides mailbox instructions is  
very helpful if the mailbox has a Next Call Routing Mailbox set up that provides additional dialing options.  
Without the greeting, the caller would not know which digits to dial.  
If a greeting has not been recorded, a caller leaving a message in the subscriber mailbox will hear, “At the  
tone, you can leave your message for (extension number or name).”  
While listening to a mailbox greeting, a caller can dial * to immediately leave a message.  
Multiple Greetings  
A subscriber can record up to three personalized greetings for their mailbox and make any one of the three  
active. Callers to the user’s mailbox hear the active greeting rather than a default message. When a caller  
leaves a message in the subscriber’s mailbox, they hear the active greeting. This allows the subscriber, for  
example, to record separate greetings for work hours, after work, and during vacation. Instead of rerecording  
their greeting when they leave the ofce, they can just activate the “after work” greeting instead.  
Remote Greetings  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can call into the Automated Attendant, access their mailbox, and remotely record  
their mailbox greeting. Following are two of the ways a user can do this:  
After the Automated Attendant answers, dial a digit (typically #) followed by their mailbox number. This  
method allows outside callers to log into their Subscriber Mailboxes from outside the company. Once  
they log into their mailbox, the user can dial G to record a greeting.  
If an extension has a Direct Inward Line that is forwarded to voice mail, the caller can dial # and log into  
their mailbox (instead of leaving a message). Once they log into their mailbox, the user can dial G to  
record a greeting. This option must be set up in the Next Call Routing Mailbox. To allow this capability,  
for example:  
- Program the Next Call Routing Mailbox # digit as LOGON to IXXX.  
- While listening to their greeting, the subscriber can dial:  
# (to route to their Next Call Routing Mailbox), then  
# and their mailbox number to log onto their mailbox.  
- By default, this option is provided in Call Routing Mailbox 1. Additionally, the subscriber should  
enable a Security Code for their mailbox to prevent unauthorized logons.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No greetings recorded.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
493  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Greeting  
Programming  
1.  
Set the maximum length of Subscriber Mailbox greetings.  
ings (1-4095 seconds).  
Enabling Remote Greeting  
1.  
Program a LOGON action in the active Dial ActionTable.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), assign a LOGON action to an available key.  
2.  
To log directly into a specic Subscriber Mailbox:  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter the mailbox number in the corresponding Routing option.  
- For example, to have key 4 log directly into Subscriber Mailbox 305, for key 4 enter LOGON for  
the Action and 305 for the corresponding Routing.  
To have IntraMail require Automated Attendant callers to dial a Subscriber Mailbox for remote  
logon (with an announcement):  
3.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter N in the corresponding Routing option.  
- The key you choose must represent the rst digit in the Subscriber Mailbox numbers.  
- For example, to have the Automated Attendant request callers to enter the number of the Subscriber  
Mailbox into which they wish to log, for key 3 enter LOGON for the Action and N for the corre-  
sponding Routing. When callers dial 3, they hear, “Please enter your mailbox number.”  
To have IntraMail require Automated Attendant callers to enter a Subscriber Mailbox for remote  
logon (without playing an announcement):  
4.  
5.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter XXX in the corresponding Routing option. The key you  
choose must represent the rst digit in the Subscriber Mailbox numbers.  
- For example, to allow callers to log onto mailboxes 300-399, for key 3 enter LOGON for the Action  
and XXX for the corresponding Routing.  
To remotely log into any valid Subscriber Mailbox (without playing an announcement):  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter IXXX in the corresponding Routing option.  
- For example, to allow callers to dial 1 plus any Subscriber Mailbox number to log on, for key 1  
enter LOGON for the Action and IXXX for the corresponding Routing.  
494  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Greeting  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb sends Automated Attendant calls directly to a subscriber’s mailbox.  
Their phone will not ring for calls from the Automated Attendant.  
The active Dial Action Table must have a LOGON action assigned to a key to enable Remote Greeting.  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can record their greeting after remotely logging onto IntraMail.  
To prevent unauthorized tampering, the subscriber should enable a Security Code for their mailbox.  
With Multiple Greetings, the System Administrator’s Subscriber Maintenance EG (34) option simul-  
taneously erases all recorded greetings in a Subscriber Mailbox. Additionally, the active greeting is  
reset to 1.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
495  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Greeting  
Operation  
Recording a Multiple Greeting and Setting Up Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
Access the Mailbox Greeting options.  
[Greeting] - [Greet]  
G (4)  
IntraMail does the following:  
Plays a summary of your current settings.  
Displays the status of your active Greeting (1-3).  
[GREETING n: RECORDED] - [GREETING n: RECORDED], or  
[GREETING n: NOT REC] - [GREETING n: NOT REC]  
Shows the Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb status.  
[Auto-Attendant DND:OFF] - [Auto-Attendant DND:OFF], or  
[Auto-Attendant DND:ON] - [Auto-Attendant DND:ON]  
Provides soft keys for each of the 3 greetings.  
[Greeting 1] - [Gr1]  
[Greeting 2] - [Gr2]  
[Greeting 3] - [Gr3]  
Select a Greeting (which also makes it active).  
(1) [Greeting 1] - [Gr1]  
(2) [Greeting 2] - [Gr2]  
(3) [Greeting 3] - [Gr3]  
Listen to the active greeting (if recorded).  
[Listen] - [Lstn]  
L (5)  
R (7)  
Record a new greeting (if not recorded), or rerecord the  
current greeting.  
[Record] - [Rec]  
Record at the tone, then press # when done.  
Pause or restart recording.  
[Resume] - [Resume]  
[Pause] - [Pause]  
*
Erase the greeting.  
E (3)  
[Cancel] - [Cncl]  
End the recording.  
[Done] - [Done]  
#
Erase the currently recorded greeting (if any).  
[Erase] - [Erase]  
Go back to the Mailbox Greeting options.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
Change Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb.  
Turn Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb off or on.  
[Auto-Attendant DND ON] - [Auto-Attendant DND ON]  
[Auto-Attendant DND OFF] - [Auto-Attendant DND OFF]  
O (6)  
Go back to mailbox Main Menu.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
0
Plays Help message.  
496  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Group Mailbox  
Group Mailbox  
Description  
Subscribers in the same group can share a mailbox.  
Ring Group Mailbox  
Group (Shared) Mailbox  
A Group Mailbox is a Ring Group Mailbox shared by a group of co-workers. It is normally a Subscriber  
Mailbox. If a caller leaves a message at any extension within the group that shares the mailbox, the system  
stores the message in the shared Group Mailbox. The Ring/Message lamp at all keyset extensions in the  
group ashes to indicate that there is a new voice mail message waiting. Any extension user in the group can  
log onto their mailbox to hear and process the shared message. The message count on all keyset displays  
increments and decrements as group messages are received, listened to, or deleted.  
Any extension sharing a Group Mailbox can record and activate the Greeting and set Automated Attendant  
Do Not Disturb. The system automatically uses the most recent Greeting, regardless of which member of the  
group recorded it.  
Group Mailboxes are helpful in both residential installations and larger business workgroups, since exten-  
sions share a common voice mailbox. Messages in the Group Mailbox can be listened to, forwarded, deleted,  
and otherwise processed by any member of the group.  
Group Mailbox uses Ring Group programming. You can separately set up Ring Group members to have the  
same Ring Group Mailbox. Since the system provides 8 Ring Groups, there are a total of 8 Ring Group  
Mailboxes available.  
The Ring Group Mailbox can optionally be a Routing Mailbox (see Understanding Mailbox Types below).  
Mailbox for a Ring Group  
A Ring Group Mailbox can also be the mailbox for a “stand-alone” Ring Group in which the members do  
not share the mailbox, but have personal mailboxes instead. The following types of unanswered calls route  
to this type of Ring Group Mailbox:  
Outside calls transferred to the Ring Group master number.  
Automated Attendant transfers (UTRF or STRF) to the Ring Group master number.  
UCD Group Mailbox  
If a UCD Group is set to overow to voice mail, an unanswered call into the group is picked up by the UCD  
Group Mailbox. The UCD Group Mailbox can be a Subscriber Mailbox (to allow the caller to leave a mes-  
sage) or a Routing Mailbox (to provide additional dialing options or an announcement). See Understanding  
Mailbox Types below.  
Understanding Group Mailbox Types  
If the Group Mailbox is a Subscriber Mailbox (1):  
The Group Mailbox has all the features of any other personal Subscriber Mailbox.  
If the Group Mailbox redirects to a Call Routing Mailbox (2):  
A co-worker attempting to leave a message at an extension assigned to the Group Mailbox hears: “Your  
call cannot go through. Goodbye.IntraMail then hangs up.  
An outside caller attempting to leave a message at an extension assigned to the Group Mailbox hears the  
prerecorded Instruction Menu message and can dial options allowed by the associated Dial Action Table.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
497  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Group Mailbox  
If the Group Mailbox user presses V-MAIL, they are asked to enter their mailbox number. After entering  
the number, they hear, “That mailbox does not exist.”  
An Automated Attendant caller attempting to leave a Quick Message or do a Remote Logon at an exten-  
sion assigned to the Group mailbox hears, “That mailbox does not exist.They then return to the Auto-  
mated Attendant.  
If the Group Mailbox redirects to an Announcement Mailbox (2):  
A co-worker attempting to leave a message at an extension assigned to the Group Mailbox hears: “Your  
call cannot go through. Goodbye.IntraMail then hangs up.  
An outside caller attempting to leave a message at an extension assigned to the Group Mailbox hears the  
prerecorded announcement and can use all other Announcement Mailbox features.  
If the Group Mailbox user presses V-MAIL, they are asked to enter their mailbox number. After entering  
the number, they hear: “That mailbox does not exist.”  
An Automated Attendant caller attempting to leave a Quick Message or do a Remote Logon at an exten-  
sion assigned to the Group mailbox hears, “That mailbox does not exist.They then return to the Auto-  
mated Attendant.  
If the Group Mailbox redirects to a Directory Dialing Mailbox (2):  
A co-worker attempting to leave a message at an extension assigned to the Group Mailbox hears: “Your  
call cannot go through. Goodbye.IntraMail then hangs up.  
An outside caller attempting to leave a message at an extension assigned to the Group Mailbox hears the  
Directory Dialing message and can use any of the options programmed for the Directory Dialing Mailbox.  
If the Group Mailbox user presses V-MAIL, they are asked to enter their mailbox number. After entering  
the number, they hear: “That mailbox does not exist.”  
An Automated Attendant caller attempting to leave a Quick Message or do a Remote Logon at an exten-  
sion assigned to the Group mailbox hears, “That mailbox does not exist.They then return to the Auto-  
mated Attendant.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No Group Mailboxes set up.  
498  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Group Mailbox  
Programming  
Programming a Ring Group Mailbox  
1.  
Assign each extension you want to have in the Ring Group.  
1. In 2113-02: Ring Group (page 738), assign the extension to a Ring Group (1-8).  
- The Ring Group assignment determines which Ring Group Mailbox the system uses as the exten-  
sion’s Group Mailbox.  
Ring Group Mailbox Assignments  
Ring Group Entry  
Ring Group Master Number Default Ring Group Mailbox  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
600  
601  
602  
602  
604  
605  
606  
607  
600  
601  
602  
603  
604  
605  
606  
607  
By default, this entry is 0 (no Ring Group assigned).  
If co-workers should share this mailbox, set the mailbox type of each extension in the Ring  
Group to Group.  
2.  
3.  
- If mailbox type is 2 and there is no Ring Group assignment in step 1, the extension has no mailbox.  
- Skip this step for a “stand-alone” Ring Group.  
For the Ring Group Mailbox that corresponds to the extension’s Ring Group, assign the  
mailbox type.  
1. For a Subscriber Mailbox:  
- In 2211-01: Mailbox Type (page 781), enter 1 and go to step 4.  
2. For a Routing Mailbox:  
use for the Ring Group Mailbox.  
4.  
Set up the Subscriber Mailbox options for the Ring Group Mailbox.  
1. For Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb:  
- In 2214-01: Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb (page 787), enable (Yes) or disable (No) Auto Atten-  
dant Do Not Disturb for the Group Mailbox.  
2. For Auto Erase or Save:  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
499  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Group Mailbox  
for Auto Save or 2 for Auto Erase).  
3. For Auto Time Stamp:  
- In 2213-03: Auto Time Stamp (page 785), enable (Yes) or disable (No) Auto Time Stamp for the  
Group Mailbox.  
4. For Conversation Record:  
- In 2213-05: Recording Conversation Beep (page 786), enable (Yes) or disable (No) the Conversa-  
tion Record beep for the Group Mailbox.  
5. For Directory Dialing:  
all lists) to which the Group Mailbox belongs.  
6. For Forced Unscreened Transfer:  
Unscreened Transfer for the Group Mailbox.  
7. For Message Playback Direction:  
(1 for LIFO, 2 for FIFO).  
8. For Message Retention:  
- In 2212-02: Message Retention (page 782), set how long the Group Mailbox will retain saved mes-  
sages.  
9. For Message Storage Limit:  
be left in the Group Mailbox.  
10.For Message Waiting Lamp:  
- In 2213-04: Message Waiting Lamp (page 785), enable (Yes) Message Waiting lamping at the  
extensions sharing the Group Mailbox.  
11.For Next Call Routing Mailbox:  
- In 2214-03: Dialing Option (page 788), enable (Yes) or disable (No) additional dialing options for  
Next Call Routing Mailbox calls.  
(1-16) to the Group Mailbox.  
12.For System Administrator:  
- In 2212-03: System Administrator (page 782), enterYes to optionally designate the Group Mailbox  
as a System Administrator.  
500  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Group Mailbox  
Programming a UCD Group Mailbox  
1.  
Set up the UCD Group.  
For the UCD Group Mailbox that corresponds to the UCD Group master number, assign the  
mailbox type.  
2.  
1. For a Subscriber Mailbox:  
2. For a Routing Mailbox:  
aMail will use for the UCD Group Mailbox.  
3.  
Set up the Subscriber Mailbox options for the Ring Group Mailbox.  
1. For Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb:  
- In 2314-01: Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb (page 798), enable (Yes) or disable (No) Auto Atten-  
dant Do Not Disturb for the Group Mailbox.  
2. For Auto Erase or Save:  
for Auto Save or 2 for Auto Erase).  
3. For Auto Time Stamp:  
- In 2313-03: Auto Time Stamp (page 796), enable (Yes) or disable (No) Auto Time Stamp for the  
Group Mailbox.  
4. For Conversation Record:  
- In 2313-05: Recording Conversation Beep (page 797), enable (Yes) or disable (No) the Conversa-  
tion Record beep for the Group Mailbox.  
5. For Directory Dialing:  
all lists) to which the Group Mailbox belongs.  
6. For Forced Unscreened Transfer:  
Unscreened Transfer for the Group Mailbox.  
7. For Message Playback Direction:  
(1 for LIFO, 2 for FIFO).  
8. For Message Retention:  
- In 2312-02: Message Retention (page 794), set how long the Group Mailbox will retain saved mes-  
sages.  
9. For Message Storage Limit:  
be left in the Group Mailbox.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
501  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Group Mailbox  
10.For Message Waiting Lamp:  
- In 2313-04: Message Waiting Lamp (page 797), enable (Yes) Message Waiting lamping at the  
extensions sharing the Group Mailbox.  
11.For Next Call Routing Mailbox:  
- In 2314-03: Dialing Option (page 798), enable (Yes) or disable (No) additional dialing options for  
Next Call Routing Mailbox calls.  
(1-16) to the Group Mailbox.  
12.For System Administrator:  
- In 2312-03: System Administrator (page 794), enterYes to optionally designate the Group Mailbox  
as a System Administrator.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
If a UCD Group is set up to overow to voice mail, unanswered callers into the group route to the  
UCD Group Mailbox.  
Ring Group Mailbox uses the mailbox assigned to the Ring Group to which the extension belongs.  
IntraMail Features  
Any extension sharing a Ring Group Mailbox can record and activate the Greeting and set Automated  
Attendant Do Not Disturb. The system automatically uses the most recent Greeting, regardless of  
which member of the group recorded it.  
An unanswered DIL to the Ring Group master number can be picked up by the Ring Group Mailbox.  
Operation  
See the following features for operation of the specic Group Mailbox type:  
502  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Guest Mailbox  
Guest Mailbox  
Description  
An outside party can have their own mailbox for receiving and sending messages.  
An outside party can have their own Guest Mailbox mailbox for receiving and sending messages. A Guest Mail-  
box is a Subscriber Mailbox that does not have an extension associated with it. A Guest Mailbox has many of  
the IntraMail features of a Subscriber Mailbox. A company visitor with a Guest Mailbox could, for example:  
Go to any extension, press INTERCOM + 700, then dial their mailbox number.  
Review their messages, leave messages for associates, or record a new greeting for their mailbox.  
Use many other features available to a Subscriber Mailbox.  
Voice mail routes calls to the Guest Mailbox in the following three ways:  
A Screened Transfer (STRF) or Unscreened Transfer (UTRF) from the Automated Attendant goes  
directly to the Guest Mailbox, even though there is no extension installed.  
An Intercom call to the uninstalled extension goes directly to the Guest Mailbox.  
A transferred call to the uninstalled extension also goes directly to the Guest Mailbox.  
For a brief overview of the features available at a Guest Mailbox, review the Related Features below. Then,  
go to the individual feature to nd out how it operates and any programming required to make it work.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No Guest Mailboxes assigned.  
Programming  
1.  
To set up a Guest Mailbox:  
1. In 2141-01: Station Mailbox Type (page 766) for an extension without an associated telephone, enter 1.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
After a guest listens to a message in their Guest Mailbox, IntraMail can automatically erase or save  
the message.  
An Automated Attendant LOGON action (assigned to the active Dial Action Table) can route callers to  
a Guest Mailbox.  
A Guest Mailbox can have a recorded greeting that plays to callers leaving a message.  
Review this feature to learn which features are available to the guest while listening to messages.  
A Guest Mailbox can have a recorded name.  
• A Guest Mailbox user can use Make Call to return a call left in the Guest Mailbox.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
503  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Guest Mailbox  
• A Subscriber Mailbox user cannot use Make Call to return a call left by a Guest Mailbox, since the  
Guest Mailbox does not have an associated extension.  
The Main Menu provides assess to the features available to a Guest Mailbox.  
Set the type of messages a guest will listen to when they dial  
L
(5) after logging into their Guest Mailbox.  
Once activated, Message Notication dials a telephone number to let the user know they have new  
messages in the Guest Mailbox.  
Set the Guest Mailbox message playback order.  
Review this feature to learn which features are available to the Guest Mailbox while recording and  
sending a message.  
Set the maximum number of messages that can be left in the mailbox.  
The Next Call Routing Mailbox provides additional dialing options after a caller leaves a message in a  
Guest Mailbox.  
If enabled, a Guest Mailbox caller must enter a security code before logging onto the mailbox.  
To transfer an outside call to a Guest Mailbox, the extension user presses INTERCOM, V-MAIL, and  
then dials the Guest Mailbox number.  
504  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Guest Mailbox  
Operation  
Accessing a Guest Mailbox  
To log onto a Guest Mailbox:  
1.  
2.  
Do one of the following.  
Press INTERCOM + Dial the IntraMail master number (e.g., 700) + Dial your mailbox number.  
You can optionally press a Call Coverage key assigned to the IntraMail master number.  
a.  
b.  
Press the Message Center key for the Guest Mailbox.  
When IntraMail answers, dial the Guest Mailbox number.  
Logging Onto a Guest Mailbox from the Automated Attendant:  
After the Automated Attendant answers, dial # + Dial the Guest Mailbox number.  
• This capability may be disabled in the Automated Attendant.  
Your automated attendant may have a LOGON action assigned to the Guest Mailbox. Check with your  
Communications Manager.  
1.  
Transferring your call to a Guest Mailbox:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Press INTERCOM.  
Press V-MAIL.  
Dial the Guest Mailbox number.  
Press SPEAKER to hang up.  
4.  
• To transfer a call to a co-worker’s mailbox from a single line telephone, use the following procedure:  
Hookash + Dial *8 + Dial the co-worker’s mailbox + Hang up.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
505  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hang Up  
Hang Up  
Description  
An Automated Attendant option that immediately hangs up the outside call.  
Hang Up is an Automated Attendant option that immediately hangs up the outside call. When setting up a  
Dial Action Table, you may want to use Hang Up for unused actions (rather than the caller hearing the stan-  
dard error message). You might also want to use the Hang Up action as the Timeout destination for callers  
that wait too long to dial after the Automated Attendant answers.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Key 9 in Dial Action Table 1 is set for Hang Up.  
Programming  
1.  
Optionally assign the Hang Up action to an available Dial Action Table key.  
- When the outside caller dials the key programmed with the Hang Up action, the Automated Atten-  
dant immediately hangs up.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The Automated Attendant can automatically answer the telephone system’s incoming calls, play an  
Instruction Menu message, and provide dialing options to callers.  
The Hang Up action is a Dial Action Table option.  
Operation  
N/A  
506  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Instruction Menu  
Instruction Menu  
Description  
Play an announcement to outside callers announcing the Automated Attendant dialing options.  
The Instruction Menu is the announcement that plays to Automated Attendant callers. Normally, the Instruc-  
tion Menu greets callers and provides them with the Automated Attendant dialing options. The Instruction  
Menu is associated with the active Call Routing Mailbox. Normally, you should have the System Adminis-  
trator customize (rerecord) the Instruction Menu to match the dialing options enabled in the site’s Dial  
Action Table. If a custom Instruction Menu is not recorded, the Automated Attendant callers hear:  
Thank you for calling. If you are calling from a touch tone phone, please dial the extension number you  
wish to reach, or dial 0 for assistance. If you are calling from a rotary dial phone, please stay on the line  
for assistance.”  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No custom Instruction Menus recorded.  
Programming  
N/A  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each line.  
The Answer Table determines how the Automated Attendant answers calls, and assigns the Call Rout-  
ing Mailbox to the call.  
The mailbox associated with an Answer Table that species which dialing options (Dial Action Table)  
and Instruction Menu are available to Automated Attendant callers.  
Denes the dialing options for the Call Routing Mailbox chosen by the active Answer Table.  
An Automated Attendant caller can press a single key to route to an extension, route to another desti-  
nation, or use an IntraMail feature.  
Only the System Administrator can record the Instruction Menu.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
507  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Instruction Menu  
Operation  
Recording an Instruction Menu for a Call Routing Mailbox  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto System Administrator’s mailbox.  
Access System Administrator options.  
[System Admin] - [N/A]  
SA (72)  
Select Instruction Menus.  
[Instruction] - [Instr]  
I (4)  
Enter the Call Routing Mailbox number.  
Listen to the current Instruction Menu (if any).  
[Listen] - [Lstn]  
L (5)  
Exit listen mode.  
#
Record a new Instruction Menu.  
[Record] - [Rec]  
R (7)  
Record message.  
Pause or restart recording  
[Resume] - [Resume]  
[Pause] - [Pause]  
*
Erase recording.  
E (3)  
[Cancel] - [Cancel]  
Exit recording mode.  
[Done] - [Done]  
#
Erase the Instruction Menu.  
[Erase] - [Erase]  
E (3)  
Go back to the System Administrator options.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
Go back to the System Administrator options.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
Plays Help message.  
0
508  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Leaving a Message  
Leaving  
a
Message  
Description  
Leave a voice message in a mailbox from inside or outside the company.  
An extension user or outside caller can leave a voice message in a co-worker’s mailbox if that extension is  
busy, unanswered, or in Do Not Disturb. Leaving a voice message is a handy and efcient way to communi-  
cate with co-workers that avoids post-it notes, message pads, and unnecessary email.  
Additional Options While Leaving a Message  
The following chart shows the additional dialing options a caller may have while listening to the mailbox  
greeting prior to leaving a message. What happens depends on the setting of the Next Call Routing and Dial-  
ing Option options.  
Dialing Options While Leaving a Message  
Action  
2144-04: Next Call  
Routing Mailbox  
Digit  
Dialed  
2144-03: Dialing Option  
Outside Call  
Intercom Call  
Undened  
No  
0
1-9  
#
Caller hears, “That is an invalid entry,” and the  
greeting repeats.  
IntraMail hangs up.  
*
Caller skips greeting and can immediately start  
recording.  
1-16 (valid Call  
Routing Mailbox)  
No  
0
Caller follows 0 action  
in Next Call Routing  
Mailbox.  
Caller hears, “That is  
an invalid entry,” and  
the greeting repeats.  
1-9  
#
Caller hears, “That is an invalid entry,” and the  
greeting repeats.  
Caller routes to the  
Next Call Routing  
Mailbox and hears its  
Instruction Menu.  
IntraMail hangs up.  
*
Caller skips greeting and can immediately start  
recording.  
1-16 (valid Call  
Routing Mailbox)  
Yes  
0
Caller follows key’s  
action in Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Caller hears, “That is  
an invalid entry,” and  
the greeting repeats.  
1-9  
#
*
Caller routes to the  
Next Call Routing  
Mailbox and hears its  
Instruction Menu.  
IntraMail hangs up.  
Caller skips greeting and can immediately start  
recording.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
509  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Leaving a Message  
Programming  
1.  
Set the maximum length of a message that can be left in a Subscriber Mailbox.  
leave in a Subscriber Mailbox (1-4095 seconds).  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The Next Call Routing Mailbox provides callers with additional dialing options after they leave a mes-  
sage in a mailbox (depending on the setting of the Dialing Option option).  
Quick Message allows Automated Attendant callers to leave a message in a Subscriber Mailbox.  
510  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Leaving a Message  
Operation  
Leaving a Message for a Co-worker  
To leave a message in the mailbox of an unanswered extension:  
1.  
2.  
Press V-MAIL.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Leave message and hang up.  
Leave message and dial #.  
• Dialing # sends the message and hangs up.  
To leave a message in a mailbox from outside the company:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Leave message and hang up.  
Leave message and dial #.  
• Dialing # may provide you with additional dialing options. This depends on how the called  
mailbox’s Next Call Routing Mailbox is set up.  
To leave a message in an extension’s mailbox, you can be:  
Transferred to an extension’s mailbox by another user.  
Automatically routed to a mailbox when the called party doesn’t answer or is unavailable.  
Sent to the mailbox from the Automated Attendant after dialing * plus the called party’s mailbox number.  
Routed from the Automated Attendant after dialing a uniquely programmed digit set up to send you to an extension’s  
mailbox.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
511  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listening to Messages  
Listening to Messages  
Description  
While or after listening to a message, an extension user has many message handling options  
from which to choose.  
While or after listening to a message, a Subscriber Mailbox user has many message handling options from  
which to choose. The listening options let you quickly and efciently manage your voice mail messages,  
respond to the message sender, or forward the message to a co-worker for additional handling. The following  
table shows these options.  
Message Listen Options  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Option  
Description  
RE (73)  
[Reply] - [N/A]  
Record a reply.  
MF (63)  
[Forward] - [N/A]  
Forward the message to another mailbox.  
MC (62)  
[Callback] - [N/A]  
Make a call to the message sender.  
TI (84)  
Hear the time and date the message was sent.  
SA (72)  
Save the message in your mailbox.  
Erase the message.  
E (3)  
[Erase] - [Erase]  
L (5)  
[Next Message] - [Next]  
Listen to the next message.  
B (2)  
Back up a few seconds.  
BB (22)  
[Repeat] - [Rpt]  
Back up to the beginning of the message.  
G (4)  
Go ahead a few seconds.  
Pause/resume listening.  
Select New Message List  
*
1N (16)  
[Message List + New Messages] - [N/A]  
Select Saved Message List  
1S (17)  
[Message List + Saved Messages] - [N/  
A]  
1A (12)  
[Message List + All Messages] - [N/A]  
Select All Message List  
#
[Exit] - [Exit]  
Exit the listen mode.  
Exit your mailbox.  
X (9)  
Dial 0 while listening to hear the list of options.  
512  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Listening to Messages  
Handling Partially Reviewed Messages  
When listening to multiple new messages when Auto Erase or Save is set to Save:  
Any message to which you partially listen is automatically saved.  
Any message to which you hang up during or do not listen is retained as a new message.  
For example, if you have three new messages, listen to part of message 1, dial L to hear part of message 2  
and then hang up, IntraMail automatically:  
Saves message 1.  
Retains messages 2 and 3 as new messages.  
Restarts the ashing ring/message lamp.  
Resets the telephone display to V-MAIL 02 (VM02).  
When listening to multiple new messages when Auto Erase or Save is set to Erase:  
Any message to which you partially listen is automatically erased.  
Any message to which you hang up during or do not listen is retained as a new message.  
For example, if you have three new messages, listen to part of message 1, dial L to hear part of message 2  
and then hang up, IntraMail automatically:  
Erases message 1.  
Retains messages 2 and 3 as new messages.  
Restarts the ashing ring/message lamp.  
Resets the telephone display to V-MAIL 02 (VM02).  
Telephone Display while Listening to a Message  
While listening to a message, your telephone display shows you important information about the message.  
This includes:  
The caller’s telephone number (if available).  
The selected Message List.  
The message number in the selected list.  
The date and time the message was left.  
Super Display  
Currently selected  
Message List  
Caller’s phone number  
(requires Caller ID)  
Message number (in  
selected Message List)  
Date message was left  
Time message was left  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
513  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Listening to Messages  
22-Button and 34-Button Display  
Currently selected  
Message List  
Caller’s phone number  
(requires Caller ID)  
Message number (in  
selected Message List)  
Date message was left  
Time message was left  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
1.  
Set the Message Backup/Go Ahead Time.  
1. In 4201-03: Message Backup/Go Ahead Time (page 872), set the Backup/Go Ahead Time ( -60 seconds).  
1
- This interval sets how far IntraMail backs up when a mailbox user dials B while recording or listen-  
ing to their messages.  
-
This interval also sets how far IntraMail jumps ahead when a user dials  
G
while listening to messages.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
When a mailbox user completely listens to a new message and then exits their mailbox, IntraMail will  
either automatically save or erase the message.  
While recording a message, a Subscriber Mailbox user has many recording options from which to choose.  
Operation  
Listening to Messages  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox  
Your Ring/Message Lamp ashes fast (red) when you have new messages.  
Access the Message Listen mode  
[Listen] - [Lstn]  
L (5)  
0
Plays Help message  
514  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Log Onto Voice Mail  
Log Onto Voice Mail  
Description  
An extension user can press a key to log onto (access) their IntraMail mailbox.  
A subscriber can log onto their mailbox using a method that best suits their needs and location. While at  
their own phone, the subscriber just presses a single key to log onto their mailbox. To use their mailbox  
while at a co-worker’s phone, the subscriber dials the IntraMail master number, followed by their mailbox  
number (which is normally the same as their extension number). If they are away from the ofce, the sub-  
scriber can still use their mailbox by calling in through the Automated Attendant.  
Local (On-site) Logon  
An extension user can log onto their mailbox in the following ways:  
Press their V-MAIL key to log onto their Subscriber Mailbox.  
Dial the IntraMail master number (e.g., 700), followed by their mailbox number. This method is typically  
used by Guest Mailbox users, as well as subscribers attempting to log into their Subscriber Mailbox from  
a co-worker’s phone.  
Remote Log On  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can call into the Automated Attendant and log onto their mailbox. Following are  
two of the ways a user can do this:  
After the Automated Attendant answers, dial a digit (typically #) followed by their mailbox number. This  
method allows outside callers to log into their mailboxes from outside the company. Once they log into  
their mailbox, they can use the allowed features in the mailbox main menu. To avoid unauthorized  
access to their mailbox, the user should enable their own unique Security Code.  
If an extension has a Direct Inward Line that voice mail picks up, the caller can dial # during their greet-  
ing to log into their mailbox (instead of leaving a message). This method allows subscribers to dial their  
own number and then use the features of their mailbox. This capability must be set up in the user’s Next  
Call Routing Mailbox. For example:  
- Program the Next Call Routing Mailbox # digit as LOGON to IXXX.  
- While listening to their greeting, the subscriber can dial:  
# (to route to their Next Call Routing Mailbox), then  
# and their mailbox number to log onto their mailbox.  
By default, this option is provided in Call Routing Mailbox 1. Additionally, the subscriber should enable  
a Security Code for their mailbox to prevent unauthorized logons.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Local Log On.  
• Remote Log On enabled for Call Routing Mailbox 1.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
515  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Log Onto Voice Mail  
Programming  
Remotely Logging Onto a Mailbox Through the Automated Attendant  
1.  
Program a LOGON action in the active Dial ActionTable.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), assign a LOGON action to an available key.  
2.  
To log directly into a specic Subscriber Mailbox:  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter the mailbox number in the corresponding Routing option.  
- For example, to have key 4 log directly into Subscriber Mailbox 305, for key 4 enter LOGON for  
the Action and 305 for the corresponding Routing.  
To have IntraMail require Automated Attendant callers to dial a Subscriber Mailbox for remote  
logon (with an announcement):  
3.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter N in the corresponding Routing option.  
- The key you choose must represent the rst digit in the Subscriber Mailbox numbers.  
- For example, to have the Automated Attendant request callers to enter the number of the Subscriber  
Mailbox into which they wish to log, for key 3 enter LOGON for the Action and N for the corre-  
sponding Routing. When callers dial 3, they hear, “Please enter your mailbox number.”  
To have IntraMail require Automated Attendant callers to enter a Subscriber Mailbox for remote  
logon (without playing an announcement):  
4.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter XXX in the corresponding Routing option. The key you  
choose must represent the rst digit in the Subscriber Mailbox numbers.  
- For example, to allow callers to log onto mailboxes 300-399, for key 3 enter LOGON for the Action  
and XXX for the corresponding Routing.  
5.  
6.  
To remotely log into any valid Subscriber Mailbox (without playing an announcement):  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter IXXX in the corresponding Routing option.  
- For example, to allow callers to dial 1 plus any Subscriber Mailbox number to log on, for key 1  
enter LOGON for the Action and IXXX for the corresponding Routing.  
Set the maximum length of a message that can be left in a Subscriber Mailbox.  
leave in a Subscriber Mailbox (1-4095 seconds).  
- For Remote Logon, this applies to a caller that remotely logs onto their mailbox and then dials RS  
to record and send a message to a co-worker.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The Automated Attendant allows Subscriber Mailbox users to log into their mailboxes.  
After remotely logging onto their mailbox, a subscriber mailbox user can remotely record their greeting.  
516  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Log Onto Voice Mail  
A guest can log onto their mailbox by dialing the IntraMail master number followed by the Guest  
Mailbox number.  
To avoid unauthorized access to their mailbox (particularly with Remote Log On), the user should  
enable their own unique Security Code.  
A subscriber can log into their mailbox by pressing a key on their telephone, dialing the IntraMail  
master number (followed by their mailbox number), or logging on through the Automated Attendant.  
Operation  
Logging OntoYour Mailbox  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
To log onto your Subscriber Mailbox:  
Press V-MAIL.  
1.  
• From a single line telephone, lift handset and dial *8.  
To log onto your Guest Mailbox or your Subscriber Mailbox from a co-worker’s extension:  
1.  
Do one of the following.  
Press INTERCOM + Dial the IntraMail master number (e.g., 700) + Dial your mailbox number.  
You can optionally press a Call Coverage key assigned to the IntraMail master number.  
a.  
b.  
Press the Message Center key for your mailbox.  
To log onto your Subscriber Mailbox from the Automated Attendant:  
Wait for the Automated Attendant to answer.  
1.  
2.  
Dial # and your mailbox number.  
• This option may be different in your system. Check with your Communications Manager.  
• After you remotely log onto your mailbox, you can optionally dial 9 then * to return to the Automated  
Attendant.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
517  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mailbox Name  
Mailbox Name  
Description  
A mailbox caller can hear the extension user’s prerecorded name instead of their mailbox number.  
A caller leaving a message in a Subscriber Mailbox can hear the mailbox’s prerecorded name instead of the  
mailbox number. The prerecorded Mailbox Name gives the subscriber’s mailbox that personal touch. Prior  
to leaving a message, caller’s will hear the name instead of the default “extension xxx” prompt. The recorded  
name can be up to 10 seconds long.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No mailbox names recorded.  
Programming  
N/A  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
A subscriber can record a name for their mailbox, or have the System Administrator record one for them.  
The System Administrator can record names for Subscriber Mailboxes.  
Operation  
RecordingYour Mailbox Name  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
Access the Mailbox Name Menu.  
[Name] - [N/A]  
RN (76)  
Listen to the currently recorded name (if any).  
[Listen] - [Lstn]  
L (5)  
Exit listen mode.  
#
Record a new name.  
[Record] - [Rec]  
R (7)  
Record message.  
Pause or restart recording.  
[Resume] - [Resume]  
[Pause] - [Pause]  
*
Erase recording.  
[Cancel] - [Cancel]  
E (3)  
#
Exit recording mode.  
[Done] - [Done]  
Erase the currently recorded name.  
[Erase] - [Erase]  
E (3)  
518  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Mailbox Name  
RecordingYour Mailbox Name  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Go back to the Mailbox Main Menu.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
0
Plays Help message.  
Recording or Erasing Co-worker’s Names from a System Administrator’s Mailbox  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto System Administrator’s Mailbox.  
Access System Administrator options.  
[System Admin] - [N/A]  
SA (72)  
Select Subscriber Mailbox Maintenance options.  
[Subscriber] - [Subs]  
S (7)  
Enter the number of the Subscriber Mailbox you want to maintain.  
Erase the mailbox name.  
EN (36)  
[Erase Name] - [Name]  
Record a new mailbox name.  
N (6)  
[Record MBOX Name] - [N/A]  
Listen to the currently recorded name (if any).  
[Listen] - [Lstn][  
L (5)  
Exit listen mode.  
#
Record a new name.  
[Record] - [Rec]  
R (7)  
Record message.  
Pause or restart recording.  
[Resume] - [Resume]  
[Pause] - [Pause]  
*
Erase recording.  
[Cancel] - [Cancel]  
E (3)  
#
Exit recording mode.  
[Done] - [Done]  
Erase the currently recorded name.  
[Erase] - [Erase]  
E (3)  
#
Go back to the Subscriber Maintenance Menu.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
Go back to System Administrator options.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
0
Plays Help message.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
519  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mailbox Options Menu  
Mailbox Options Menu  
Description  
A Subscriber Mailbox sub-menu that provides access to the AutoTime Stamp, Mailbox Security  
Code Delete, and Message Notication features.  
The Mailbox Options Menu is a sub-menu of a subscriber’s Main Menu that provides access to the Auto  
Time Stamp, Mailbox Security Code Delete, and Message Notication features. The chart below summa-  
rizes these options. Auto Time Stamp helps if the subscriber needs to know the time and date of each mes-  
sage they receive without taking any extra steps. If mailbox security is not an issue, the subscriber can delete  
their security code to simplify logging onto their mailbox.  
Mailbox Options Menu  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Option  
Description  
Erase the mailbox’s Security Code.  
S (7)  
[Security Code] - [Sec]  
N (6)  
[Notication] - [Notif]  
Set up Message Notication.  
AT (28)  
[Time Stamp] - [Time]  
Enable or disable Auto Time Stamp.  
To hear the list of Mailbox Options, dial 0.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Mailbox Options Menu available.  
Programming  
No additional programming required.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
IntraMail can optionally announce the time and date the message was left.  
The System Administrator can delete the security code for any Subscriber Mailbox.  
Message Notication dials a telephone or pager number to let the user know they have new messages  
in their mailbox.  
520  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Mailbox Options Menu  
Operation  
Accessing the Mailbox Options Menu  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
Access the Mailbox Options Menu.  
[MBOX Options] - [N/A]  
OP (67)  
Plays Help message.  
0
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
521  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mailbox Security Code Delete  
Mailbox Security Code Delete  
Description  
Allows the System Administrator to delete the security code for any mailbox.  
The System Administrator can delete the security code for any Subscriber Mailbox. This effectively unlocks  
the mailbox. If mailbox security is not necessary, deleting a mailbox’s security code speeds up mailbox logon.  
Without a security code, the subscriber just presses theirV-MAIL key to immediately log onto their mailbox.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
No additional programming required.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Mailbox Security Code Delete is available on the Mailbox Options Menu.  
Subscriber Mailboxes can have Security Codes.  
The System Administrator can delete a mailbox’s security code.  
Operation  
Deleting a Mailbox Security Code  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto System Administrator’s Mailbox.  
Access System Administrator options.  
[System Admin] - [N/A]  
SA (72)  
Select Subscriber Mailbox Maintenance options.  
[Subscriber] - [Subs]  
S (7)  
Enter the number of the Subscriber Mailbox you want to maintain.  
Erase the mailbox Security Code.  
[Erase Security Code] - [N/A]  
S (7)  
Go to the System Administrator Menu.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
0
Plays Help message.  
522  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Main Menu  
Main Menu  
Description  
Provides options to an extension user when they log onto their mailbox.  
After a Subscriber Mailbox user logs into their mailbox, IntraMail provides them with the Main Menu of  
options. The Main Menu provides quick access to the most commonly used mailbox features in a central  
location. It includes listening and recording options, as well as additional selections for recording mailbox  
names and greetings. The chart below summarizes these options.  
Mailbox Main Menu  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Option  
Description  
L (5)  
[Listen] - [Lstn]  
Listen to messages.  
RS (77)  
[Record] - [Rec]  
Record and send a message.  
G (4)  
[Greeting] - [Greet]  
Record a mailbox greeting.  
RN (76)  
[Name] - [N/A]  
Record a mailbox name.  
[Message List] - [N/A]  
Select the active Message List.  
1N (16)  
[Message List + New Messages] - [N/A]  
Select the New Message List.  
1S (17)  
Message List + Saved Messages] - [N/A]  
Select the Saved Message List.  
1A (12)  
[Message List + All Messages] - [N/A]  
Select the All Message List.  
OP (67)  
[MBOX Options] - [N/A]  
Use the Mailbox Options. See the following:  
SA (72)  
[System Admin] - [N/A]  
Access the System Administrator options.  
TI (84)  
Check the current time and date.  
X (9)  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
Exit your mailbox.  
To hear the complete Main Menu of options, dial 0 while in the Main Menu.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
523  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Main Menu  
Programming  
No additional programming required.  
Other Related Features  
See the Mailbox Main Menu chart above.  
Operation  
Accessing the Mailbox Main Menu  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
You automatically go to the mailbox Main Menu.  
Plays Help message which summarizes the Main Menu options.  
0
524  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Make Call  
Make Call  
Description  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can dial MC to return a call without knowing their caller’s number.  
Make Call lets a Subscriber Mailbox user listen to a voice message and dial MC to return the call without  
knowing their caller’s phone number. Make Call automates returning messages since you don’t have to dial  
the message sender’s telephone number. Make Call is always available for messages received from co-work-  
ers. Make call is available for messages received from outside callers if the system has Caller ID enabled  
(and provided by the connected telco).  
While listening to a message at a Super Display Telephone, rst 2 lines of the display show the callers num-  
ber (or extension) in addition to the date and time the message was left. At a 22-Button or 34-Button Tele-  
phone, the rst line of the display shows the date and time the message was left.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Available if Caller ID is enabled and provided by the telco.  
Programming  
1.  
No IntraMail specic programming required.  
1. No additional programming is required to enable Caller ID in IntraMail.  
2.  
Check your telco service.  
1. Be sure the telco provides Caller ID to the connected telephone system.  
Check your telephone system programming to be sure it is set up to receive Caller ID and pass  
it to the IntraMail voice mail ports.  
3.  
ANI = 3).  
4.  
Set up your basic Caller ID Logging programming.  
backs (1 = line, 2 = Line Group).  
use for Caller ID callbacks.  
98) the system will use for Caller ID callbacks.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
525  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Make Call  
To enable Make Call for remote logons (i.e., subscriber’s logging onto their mailbox through the  
Automated Attendant):  
5.  
1. In 3103-04: Tandem Calls (page 816), enterYes to enable Tandem Calls.  
- Enable this option for either the inbound or outbound lines (or both).  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Make Call for outside calls is available only if the telco provides Caller ID to the telephone system  
and the telephone system passes the Caller ID data to the IntraMail voice mail ports.  
Message Reply can not automatically reply to a message left by an outside caller. Use Make Call  
instead.  
Operation  
Using Make Call from your Mailbox  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
Listen to the message for which you want to make a return call.  
[Listen] - [Lstn]  
L (5)  
Dial this code while listening to the message you want to return.  
[Callback] - [N/A]  
• Make Call automatically places a return call to the co-worker that left you the message.  
MC (62)  
• If your system has Caller ID, Make Call can automatically place a return call to your out-  
side caller.  
• If you hear “Your call cannot go through,” your system’s Caller ID is not properly set up.  
You go right back to the listen mode for the message you were listening to when you tried  
the Make Call.  
526  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Master Mailbox  
Master Mailbox  
Description  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
527  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Message Count Display  
Message Count Display  
Description  
The telephone display can show the number of new messages waiting in a user’s mailbox.  
The telephone display provides interactive status updates for the subscriber’s mailbox. The subscriber  
doesn’t have to call their mailbox and wait for the voice prompts to nd out the number of new and saved  
messages in their mailbox. Then can just look at the display instead. While idle, the telephone display shows  
the number of new messages waiting in a subscriber’s mailbox. The message count automatically updates as  
the subscriber receives new messages and processes older messages. While logged into the mailbox, the tele-  
phone display shows the number of both new and saved messages.  
22-Button and 34-Button Display  
While Idle  
One new message waiting  
in the Subscriber Mailbox  
While Logged-in  
One new message waiting  
in the Subscriber Mailbox  
One saved message waiting  
in the Subscriber Mailbox  
Super Display  
While Idle  
One new message waiting  
in the Subscriber Mailbox  
528  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Message Count Display  
While Logged-in  
One new message waiting  
in the Subscriber Mailbox  
One saved message waiting  
in the Subscriber Mailbox  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
No additional programming required.  
Other Related Features  
N/A  
Operation  
Operation is automatic.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
529  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message Delete  
Message Delete  
Description  
An extension user can delete any messages left in their mailbox.  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can delete any messages left in their mailbox. Message Delete lets the subscriber  
do their own mailbox maintenance. They can delete messages they no longer need and save messages that  
contain essential information. With Message Delete, the subscriber doesn’t have to rely on the System  
Administrator to perform these routine mailbox maintenance functions.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
No additional programming required.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The System Administrator can delete all messages in a Subscriber Mailbox.  
A subscriber can log into their mailbox and delete any of their messages.  
Operation  
Deleting a Message  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
Access the Message Listen mode (to listen to the message that you want to delete).  
[Listen] - [Lstn]  
L (5)  
Erase the message.  
[Erase] - [Erase]  
You automatically return to the Message Listen mode.  
E (3)  
530  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Message Forward  
Message Forward  
Description  
A subscriber can forward a message in their mailbox to a co-worker.  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can forward a message in their mailbox to a co-worker. Forwarding is helpful  
when a subscriber receives a message with which a co-worker can assist them. Rather than sending a new  
message, the subscriber can just forward the message with which they need help. They can also optionally  
record a comment before the forwarded message. Typically, the comment would describe the reason for the  
message forwarding.  
IntraMail saves the message in the subscriber’s mailbox after they forward it. The Message Forward destina-  
tion receives the forwarded message as a new message.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled.  
Programming  
No additional programming required.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
An extension user can easily forward calls to their mailbox.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
531  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Message Forward  
Operation  
Forwarding a Message  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
Access the Message Listen mode and listen to the message that you want to forward.  
[Listen] - [Lstn]  
L (5)  
Access the Message Forward Menu.  
[Forward] - [N/A]  
MF (63)  
Enter the number of the mailbox to which you want to forward the message.  
Continue.  
#
[Continue] - [Cont]  
Do one of the following.  
Record a comment that will precede the forwarded message  
+ Dial #.  
a.  
b.  
Dial # to forward without a comment.  
While recording a comment for your forwarded message.  
Pause or restart recording.  
*
[Resume] - [Resume]  
[Pause] - [Pause]  
Cancel the forwarding and exit your mailbox.  
[Cancel] - [Cancel]  
E (3)  
End the recording.  
[Done] - [Done]  
#
Back up and re-enter the mailbox number.  
[Mailbox] - [Mbox]  
*
Go back to the Message Listen mode.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
Exit the Message Listen mode and go to the Mailbox Main Menu.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
0
Plays Help message.  
532  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message Length  
Message Length  
Description  
Through system programming, set the maximum length of a message that can be left in a  
user’s voice mailbox.  
You can set the maximum length of a message that can be left in a Subscriber Mailbox. When a caller tries to  
leave a message that exceeds the limit, they hear, “You have reached the recording limit.IntraMail sends the  
portion of the message that ts within the allowed Message Length and hangs up. The Message Length  
option helps you maximize the storage space reserved for messages. If you nd that callers are leaving  
unusually long messages, shorten the Message Length. IntraMail will cut off the message once the caller  
reaches the Message Length limit. On the other hand, if you hear that IntraMail is cutting off caller’s mes-  
sages prematurely, increase the Message Length to give callers more time.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• 120 seconds  
Programming  
1.  
Set the maximum length of recorded messages.  
recorded messages.  
Other Related Features  
N/A  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
533  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Message Listen Mode  
Message Listen Mode  
Description  
When a user calls their mailbox, they can dial a code to listen to all their messages, their new  
messages, or their saved messages.  
After logging onto their mailbox, the subscriber can select the category of messages to which they want to  
listen. Then can listen to just new messages, just saved messages, or all messages. Message Listen Mode lets  
the subscriber customize their mailbox to initially play just the list of messages to which they want to listen.  
For example, if a subscriber has many saved messages and just a few new messages, then can log onto their  
mailbox and dial 1N to select the new message list. When they press L, they will then cycle through just their  
new message.  
Initially, a Subscriber Mailbox uses the All Message List. If they select a different message list, IntraMail  
reinstates the all Message List the next time they log onto their mailbox.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
No additional programming required.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The Message Listen mode options are mailbox Main Menu selections.  
Operation  
Message Listen Mode  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
[Message List] - [N/A]  
1N (16)  
Listen to new messages.  
[Message List + New Messages] - [N/A]  
1S (17)  
Listen to saved messages.  
[Message List + Saved Messages] - [N/A]  
1A (12)  
Listen to all messages.  
[Message List + All Messages] - [N/A]  
0
Plays Help message.  
534  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Message Notification  
Message Notication  
Description  
Dials a telephone number to let the recipient know there are new messages in their mailbox.  
Once activated by the Subscriber Mailbox user, Message Notication dials a telephone number to let the  
user know when there are new messages in their mailbox. When Message Notication is on, a subscriber  
who is out of the ofce does not have keep calling their mailbox remotely to nd out if they have new mes-  
sages. IntraMail will let them know automatically. Notication can call extensions, local numbers, long dis-  
tance numbers and digital pagers. When a Subscriber Mailbox user sets up Message Notication, they  
choose from the following options:  
If Message Notication is enabled or disabled.  
(Message Notication can only occur if it is enabled.)  
The time of day Message Notication should begin and end.  
(Callouts will only occur between the begin and end times.)  
The type of device to which Message Notication will be calling.  
(Message Notication can call a normal telephone number or a digital pager.)  
The telephone or pager service phone number.  
To protect your mailbox from unauthorized access, be sure to record a security code for your mailbox before  
enabling Message Notication.  
How Message Notication Works to Normal Telephone Numbers  
1. The subscriber activates Message Notication for their mailbox (see Operation below).  
2. When the subscriber receives a new message, IntraMail dials the destination that should receive the Mes-  
sage Notication.  
- IntraMail waits up to 30 seconds for ringback, reorder, busy or voice activity from the called num-  
ber. If nothing is detected, the callout is considered unanswered.  
3. If the recipient answers, IntraMail plays the notication message (“Hello, I have a message for”) and  
asks the recipient to dial 1 to log onto their mailbox. The recipient hears the notication message if:  
- They say “Hello” after answering the callout, or  
- The system receives answer supervision from the telco after the recipient answers the call.  
(Note that the recipient can skip the announcement by dialing 1 to log onto their mailbox after  
answering the callout – without saying “Hello”.), or  
- The notication is to a system extension.  
4. Once the recipient logs onto the mailbox, the notication is considered acknowledged and will not reoc-  
cur until the subscriber receives new messages.  
5. If the recipient doesn’t answer, the system will retry the callout number. After completing the pro-  
grammed number of callout attempts, Message Notication will stop.  
6. Once the notication process begins, a new message does not restart the process if it is already in  
progress. Once the process ends (e.g., if the message is acknowledged or the maximum number of call-  
out attempts is reached), the next new message will restart the process.  
How Message Notication Works to Digital Pager Numbers  
1. The subscriber activates Message Notication for their mailbox (see Operation below).  
2. When the subscriber receives a new message, IntraMail immediately dials the pager service.  
- IntraMail waits up to 30 seconds for ringback, reorder, busy or voice activity from the called num-  
ber. If nothing is detected, the callout is considered unanswered.  
3. After the pager service answers, IntraMail sends a dial string which causes the pager display to show the  
subscriber’s mailbox number as well as the number of new messages in the mailbox.  
- The notication is considered acknowledged if the recipient logs onto the mailbox. Notication  
will not reoccur until the subscriber receives new messages.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
535  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Message Notification  
- If the pager service doesn’t answer, IntraMail will retry the callout number. Message Notication  
may eventually cancel if the callout remains unacknowledged.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
Programming that Applies to All Types of Message Notication  
1.  
Assign the Line Group the system uses for Message Notication callouts.  
use for callouts.  
-
You must make this assignment and have lines in the designated group for Message Notication  
callouts to work.  
2.  
Be sure the following Voice Mail port options do not restrict Message Notication callouts.  
3.  
Set the maximum number on incomplete callout attempts.  
1. In 4202-06: Number of Callout Attempts (page 876), set how many times (1-99 attempts) IntraMail will  
retry an incomplete Message Notication callout.  
- This total includes unacknowledged callouts, callouts to a busy destination, and callouts to an unan-  
swered destination.  
- This option applies to pager and non-pager callouts.  
4.  
Be sure Message Waiting lamping for Subscriber Mailboxes is on.  
- If Message Waiting lamping is disabled (No), Message Notication will not function.  
536  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message Notification  
Unique Programming for Non-pager Message Notication  
1.  
Set the intervals IntraMail will wait between incomplete non-pager notication callouts.  
1. In 4202-01: Wait Between Non-Pager Callout Attempts (page 873), set the minimum time (1-255 min-  
utes) between non-pager Message Notication callouts. This occurs when:  
- The destination answers and says “Hello,”  
- Dials 1 to acknowledge,  
- Enters the wrong security code,  
- Hangs up.  
OR  
Enters the wrong security code twice more (causing voice mail to hang up).  
2. In 4202-03: Wait Between Busy Non-Pager Callout Attempts (page 874), set how long IntraMail will wait  
(1-255 minutes), after it dials a busy non-pager callout destination, before retrying the callout number.  
3. In 4202-04: Wait Between RNA Non-Pager Callout Attempts (page 875), set how long IntraMail will wait  
(1-255 minutes), after it dials an unanswered non-pager callout destination, before retrying the callout.  
There are three types of unanswered non-pager callouts:  
- If the callout rings the destination longer than the 4202-05: Wait for Answer Non-Pager Callout  
- If the destination answers, says “Hello” (or the system detects answer supervision) and then hangs  
up without dialing 1 to log onto their mailbox. This typically happens if someone unfamiliar with  
notication answers the callout, or if the callout is picked up by an answering machine.  
- If the destination answers and then hangs up without saying “Hello.” This typically happens if  
someone unfamiliar with the notication answers the callout (like the above example), or if the call  
is picked up by an answering machine which insufcient outgoing message volume.  
2.  
Set how IntraMail determines when a non-pager callout rings without being answered.  
- If a non-pager callout rings the destination longer than this option, IntraMail marks the call as  
unanswered (Ring No Answer) and hangs up. This setting is approximate (+ a few ring cycles)  
depending on how long the telco takes to connect the call.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
537  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message Notification  
Unique Programming for Digital Pager Message Notication  
1.  
Set up the system-wide options that apply to the digital pager callback number.  
1. In 4202-08: Digital Pager Callback Number (page 877), set the Digital Pager Callback Number portion  
of the Message Notication callout number for a digital pager.  
- This is the portion of the callout number that is appended to the pager service telephone number.  
- By default, this option is X*M#, where:  
X is the number of the extension that generated the notication.  
* is a visual delimiter (to make the pager display easier to read).  
M is the number of new messages in the extension’s mailbox.  
# is the digit normally used by the pager service for positive disconnect.  
that occurs just before IntraMail dials the 4202-08: Digital Pager Callback Number portion of the Mes-  
sage Notication callout number for a digital pager.  
-
Set this delay so the pager service has enough time to connect to the digital pager before sending the  
callback number. Your pager service may be able to help you determine the best value for this option.  
- When placing a digital pager notication, the system:  
- Seizes the line specied in 4112-01: Outgoing Dial 9 Group.  
- Dials the user-entered notication number (in V-MAIL + OP + N).  
- Dials the number entered in 4202-08: Digital Pager Callback Number.  
- The system assumes that the notication number will complete dialing approximately 4 seconds  
after line seizure. This means that, by default, the Digital Pager Callback Number will be dialed  
into the pager service about 13 seconds after line seizure.  
2.  
Set up the system-wide options that apply to digital pager callouts.  
utes) between unacknowledged or unanswered digital pager Message Notication callouts.  
- A subscriber acknowledges a digital pager notication by logging onto their mailbox.  
- After this interval expires, IntraMail will try the callout again (for up to the number of times set in  
- If the system dials the callout number and the pager service is busy, it will retry the number in one  
minute.  
2. In 4202-07: Send Pager Callout Until Acknowledged (page 877), enterYes to have IntraMail continue to  
retry a digital pager Message Notication callout until the notication is acknowledged.  
- If this option is disabled (No), IntraMail will retry a digital pager Message Notication the number  
- This option does not apply to Message Notication callouts to telephone numbers.  
- A digital pager notication is considered acknowledged when the recipient logs onto the mailbox.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
To protect their mailbox from unauthorized access, the subscriber should be sure to record a Security  
Code for your mailbox before enabling Message Notication.  
538  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message Notification  
Operation  
Setting Up Message Notication (Page 1 of 2)  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
Access the Mailbox Options menu.  
[Mbox Options] - [N/A]  
OP (67)  
Access the Message Notication Options Menu.  
[Notication] - [Notif]  
N (6)  
IntraMail plays a summary of your Message Notication settings.  
• The your telephone display shows your current notication settings (see sample below).  
For telephone numbers  
Notify ON 8AM- 5PM  
NUMBER: 12039265400  
OR  
For pager numbers  
Notify ON 8AM- 5PM  
PAGER: 12039265400  
Turn Message Notication on or off.  
[On] - [On]  
[Off] - [Off]  
O (6)  
Change your Message Notication setup.  
[Change] - [Chnge]  
C (2)  
When you see: Notication Begin:  
Enter the hour you want Message Notication to begin.  
• Enter 2 digits for the hour  
Select AM  
A (2)  
[AM] - [AM]  
Select PM  
P (7)  
[PM] - [PM]  
Skip this option without changing your entry.  
[Next] - [Next]  
*
Back up to the previous level without changing your entry.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
When you see: Notication End:  
Enter the hour you want Message Notication to end.  
• Enter 2 digits for the hour.  
• For 24-hour notication, make the End Time the same as the Start  
Time.  
Select AM  
A (2)  
[AM] - [AM]  
Select PM  
P (7)  
[PM] - [PM]  
Skip this option without changing your entry.  
[Next] - [Next]  
*
Back up to the previous level without changing your entry.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
When you see: Notify Via:  
The notication destination is a telephone number.  
[Number] - [Num]  
N (6)  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
539  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message Notification  
Setting Up Message Notication (Page 2 of 2)  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
The notication destination is a digital pager.  
[Pager] - [Pager]  
D (3)  
*
Skip this option without changing your entry.  
[Next] - [Next]  
Back up to the previous level without changing your entry.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
When you see: Number  
Enter the Message Notication callout number (16 digits max).  
• Enter the number exactly as you want the system to dial it (includ-  
ing a leading 1 for toll calls, if required).  
• If the number you enter is 3 digits or less, it will be an Intercom  
call. If it is more than 3 digits, it will be an outside call.  
Accept the number entered and back up to the  
previous level.  
[OK] - [OK]  
#
[Clear]  
Erase the number you just entered.  
Skip this option without changing your entry.  
[Next] - [Next]  
*
Back up to the previous level without changing your entry.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
Go back to the Mailbox Options menu.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
Go back to the Main Menu.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
0
Plays Help message.  
Answering a Message Notication Callout to a Telephone  
To answer a Message Notication to a telephone:  
Answer the callout at the programmed destination.  
• If IntraMail doesn’t hear your voice (or you don’t speak), just go to the next step and dial 1 to proceed.  
1.  
2.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
Dial 1 to accept the Message Notication.  
Hang up to have the Message Notication call back later.  
When you dial 1, you automatically log onto the subscriber mailbox that left you the Message Notication.  
• If you don’t log onto your mailbox, IntraMail will re-send your notication.  
3.  
Answering a Digital Pager Message Notication Callout  
To answer a Digital Pager notication:  
Operation is automatic.  
• If you don’t call and log onto your mailbox, IntraMail will re-send your pager notication.  
1.  
540  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message On Hold  
Message On Hold  
Description  
A prerecorded message can play to callers while they wait on Hold  
Message On Hold allows the System Administrator to record a message that will play to callers while they  
wait on Hold. For example, you can record a message summarizing available services or hours of operation.  
This message will play to callers as soon as you put them on Hold, and continually repeat as long as they  
remain on Hold. Message On Hold recording is only available from the System Administrator’s Mailbox. Intr-  
aMail provides a single Message On Hold. Any number of callers can simultaneously listen to the Message  
On Hold recording.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
1.  
Enable Message On Hold for the line.  
2.  
Optionally set the Message On Hold message length.  
Message On Hold.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Message On Hold is an alternative to the telephone system’s Music On Hold.  
Only the System Administrator can record the Message On Hold.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
541  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Message On Hold  
Operation  
Recording the Message On Hold  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto System Administrator’s mailbox.  
Access System Administrator options.  
[System Admin] - [N/A]  
SA (72)  
Select Message On Hold.  
[Message On Hold] - [N/A]  
1
Listen to the current Message On Hold (if any).  
[Listen] - [Lstn]  
L (5)  
#
Exit listen mode.  
Record a new Message On Hold.  
[Record] - [Rec]  
R (7)  
Record message.  
Pause or restart recording.  
[Resume] - [Resume]  
[Pause] - [Pause]  
*
Erase recording.  
E (3)  
[Cancel] - [Cncl]  
Exit recording mode.  
[Done] - [Done]  
#
Erase the Message On Hold.  
[Erase] - [Erase]  
E (3)  
Go back to the System Administrator options.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
0
Plays Help message.  
Go back to the Main Menu options.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
0
Plays Help message.  
542  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message Playback Direction  
Message Playback Direction  
Description  
An extension user can listen to their messages in either LIFO (last-in-rst-out) or FIFO (rst-in-  
rst-out) order.  
When a user dials L (5) after logging into their mailbox, IntraMail will play their messages in either LIFO  
(last-in-rst-out) or FIFO (rst-in-rst-out) order. Since Message Playback Direction lets a subscriber listen  
to messages in the order they nd most helpful, check with them to nd out how they want this option set. If  
the subscriber prefers to hear their new messages rst, enable LIFO (last-in-rst-out) listening order. The  
newest (last-in) messages are at the top of the message list and the oldest messages are at the bottom of the  
list. If the subscriber wants to be reminded of their oldest messages rst, enable FIFO (rst-in-rst-out) lis-  
tening order. The oldest (rst-in) messages are at the top of the message list and the newest messages are at  
the bottom.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Messages are in FIFO (rst-in-rst-out) order.  
Programming  
1.  
Set the Message Playback Direction for a Subscriber Mailbox.  
- 1 for LIFO (last-in-rst-out, or newest messages rst).  
- 2 for FIFO (rst-in-rst-out, or oldest messages rst).  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
While listening to messages, Message Playback Direction lets the user change the playback order of  
the messages in the mailbox.  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
543  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Message Record  
Message Record  
Description  
544  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Message Reply  
Message Reply  
Description  
An extension user can reply to a message in their mailbox by dialing a simple code, without  
knowing the caller’s extension number.  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can reply to a message from a co-worker by dialing RE, without knowing the  
caller’s extension or mailbox number. Message Reply saves the subscriber valuable time since they don’t  
need to know the sender’s extension number or send a separate message to respond. The subscriber can just  
listen to the co-worker’s message, dial a code, and record their answer. The message sender receives the  
reply as a new message.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
No additional programming required.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Message Reply does not apply to outside calls. If the telephone system provides Caller ID information  
to IntraMail, a subscriber may be able to use Make Call (MC) to call the person back.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
545  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Message Reply  
Operation  
Message Reply  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
Listen to your messages.  
[Listen] - [Lstn]  
L (5)  
While listening to a message.  
Reply to the message.  
[Reply] - [N/A]  
RE (73)  
• If the mailbox does not exist, you will be prompted to enter the mailbox number to  
receive the reply. This can occur if you dial RE while listening to a message from an  
outside caller.  
Start recording.  
[Continue] - [Cont]  
#
Options available while recording.  
Pause or restart recording.  
*
[Resume] - [Resume]  
[Pause] - [Pause]  
Erase recording.  
E (3)  
[Cancel] - [Cncl]  
End the recording.  
[Done] - [Done]  
#
Back up and re-enter the mailbox number.  
[Mailbox] - [Mbox]  
*
[Exit] - [Exit]  
Exit without recording and go back to the Message Listen menu.  
Exit and go back to the mailbox Main Menu.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
0
Plays Help message  
546  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message Retention  
Message Retention  
Description  
Automatically deletes a mailbox’s messages after a preset time.  
IntraMail will save a Subscriber Mailbox’s new or saved messages for the Message Retention interval and  
then delete them. You’ll nd Message Retention to be an invaluable tool for managing IntraMail’s voice  
message storage space. If subscribers are letting old, unwanted messages build up in their mailboxes, shorten  
the Message Retention time. Be sure to let the subscribers know how long IntraMail will retain their mes-  
sages. By default, IntraMail retains all messages indenitely.  
IntraMail performs its Message Retention deletions at midnight of the day the message was marked for dele-  
tion. For example, if the mailbox has 1 day Message Retention, any messages left on Wednesday are deleted  
at midnight on Thursday.  
Message Retention Guard Time  
IntraMail has a Message Retention Guard Time that automatically starts when you change the date and time  
in the telephone system. Message deletion can occur only after the Message Retention Guard Time expires.  
This prevents Message Retention from inadvertently deleting messages when you change the telephone sys-  
tem time and date. The guard time is xed at 4 days.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Message Retention is indenite.  
Programming  
1.  
Set the Message Retention Interval for a Subscriber Mailbox.  
- 1-90 days.  
- Indenite (entered by dialing 0).  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The System Administrator can delete all messages in a Subscriber Mailbox.  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can delete any messages left in their mailbox.  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
547  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Message Storage Limit  
Message Storage Limit  
Description  
Sets how many messages a mailbox can store.  
Message Storage Limit sets how many messages can be left in a Subscriber Mailbox. Message Storage Limit  
is another invaluable tool for managing IntraMail’s voice message storage space. To conserve storage space  
and make it available for new messages, decrease the Message Storage Limit. If storage space is not an issue,  
increase the Message Storage Limit so subscribers can store additional messages. Be sure to let the subscrib-  
ers know how many messages their mailboxes can hold.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• 99 for extension 300.  
• 20 for all other extensions.  
Programming  
1.  
Set the maximum number of messages that can be left in a Subscriber Mailbox.  
store (1-99).  
- If a caller tries to leave a message once the maximum number is reached, they hear, “That mailbox  
is full.IntraMail then hangs up.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The System Administrator can delete all messages in a Subscriber Mailbox.  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can delete any messages left in their mailbox.  
Operation  
N/A  
548  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Message Waiting Lamp  
Message Waiting Lamp  
Description  
The Ring/Message Lamp ashes when the user has new messages waiting in their mailbox.  
An extension’s Ring/Message Lamp ashes on the telephone to indicate that the user has new messages  
waiting in their mailbox. Once IntraMail is properly installed and programmed, telephone Ring/Message  
Lamp operation is automatic. The Ring/Message Lamp will ash fast (red) when there are new messages in  
the extension user’s mailbox, providing a visual reminder of new messages. The subscriber does not have to  
call their mailbox and listen to the voice prompts to nd out when they have new messages.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
1.  
Turn Message Waiting lamping for Subscriber Mailboxes on or off.  
1. To turn lamping on, in 2143-04: Message Waiting Lamp (page 771) enterYes.  
2. To turn lamping off, in 2143-04: Message Waiting Lamp (page 771) enter No.  
- If Message Waiting lamping is disabled (N), Message Notication will not function.  
- In addition, the V-MAIL [VM] soft key will not show the number of new messages.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The V-MAIL LED is used for Call Screening only.  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
549  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Multiple Company Greetings  
Multiple Company Greetings  
Description  
By assigning a unique Answer Table to each line, a single IntraMail system can provide  
individual greetings and dialing options for several companies.  
The Automated Attendant can answer each individual line with a unique greeting and unique set of dialing  
options. Since there are a total of 8 Answer Tables, this allows up to 8 companies or departments to share a  
single IntraMail. Callers to each company hear that company’s greeting (Instruction Menu) and can dial  
options that may be only available to that specic company. You set this up as follows:  
Assign a unique Answer Table (1-8) to each line that you want to have an individual greeting.  
For each Answer Table, assign the Call Routing Mailbox that will handle the call.  
For each of the assigned Call Routing Mailboxes, set up the dialing options (Dial Action Table) and  
record an Instruction Menu.  
If multiple companies or departments share an IntraMail, messaging and calling between the workers of  
each company or department are not restricted.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• All outside lines are assigned to Answer Table 1.  
Programming  
1.  
Assign an Answer Table to each line.  
that the Automated Attendant should answer.  
2. See the following features for more:  
550  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Multiple Company Greetings  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each line.  
The Automated Attendant can automatically answer the telephone system’s incoming calls, play an  
Instruction Menu message, and provide dialing options to callers.  
The mailbox associated with an Answer Table that species which dialing options (Dial Action Table)  
and announcements are available to Automated Attendant callers.  
Denes the dialing options for the Call Routing Mailbox chosen by the active Answer Table.  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
551  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Next Call Routing Mailbox  
Next Call Routing Mailbox  
Description  
Provides callers with additional dialing options after they leave a message in an extension’s  
mailbox (depending on the setting of the Next Call Routing Mailbox Dial Mode).  
The Next Call Routing Mailbox provides callers with additional dialing options while listening to a Sub-  
scriber Mailbox recorded or default greeting. It also provides additional dialing options to callers routed to  
an Announcement Mailbox. Next Call Routing Mailbox lets the caller choose how IntraMail should handle  
their call. For example, if an Automated Attendant caller dials a subscriber’s extension and hears the greet-  
ing, Next Call Routing Mailbox (if programmed) allows them to dial other options instead of hanging up.  
Subscriber Mailbox Options  
The following chart shows the additional dialing options a caller may have while listening to a Subscriber  
Mailbox recorded or default greeting. The digits the caller can dial depends on the setting of the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox and Dialing Option options. For an explanation of the options a caller can dial while  
Dialing Options While Listening to a Subscriber Mailbox Greeting  
Action  
2144-04: Next Call  
Routing Mailbox  
Digit  
Dialed  
2144-03: Dialing Option  
Outside Call  
Intercom Call  
Undened  
No  
0
1-9  
#
Caller hears, “That is an invalid entry,” and the  
greeting repeats.  
IntraMail hangs up.  
*
Caller skips greeting and can immediately start  
recording.  
1-16 (valid Call  
Routing Mailbox)  
No  
0
Caller follows 0 action  
in Next Call Routing  
Mailbox.  
Caller hears, “That is  
an invalid entry,” and  
the greeting repeats.  
1-9  
#
Caller hears, “That is an invalid entry,” and the  
greeting repeats.  
Caller routes to the  
Next Call Routing  
Mailbox and hears its  
Instruction Menu.  
IntraMail hangs up.  
*
Caller skips greeting and can immediately start  
recording.  
1-16 (valid Call  
Routing Mailbox)  
Yes  
0
Caller follows key’s  
action in Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Caller hears, “That is  
an invalid entry,” and  
the greeting repeats.  
1-9  
#
*
Caller routes to the  
Next Call Routing  
Mailbox and hears its  
Instruction Menu.  
IntraMail hangs up.  
Caller skips greeting and can immediately start  
recording.  
552  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Next Call Routing Mailbox  
Logging Onto a Subscriber Mailbox while Listening to the Greeting  
A subscriber who wishes to log onto their mailbox while listening to their greeting must have the option set  
in their Next Call Routing Mailbox. To allow this capability, for example:  
Program the Next Call Routing Mailbox # digit as LOGON to IXXX.  
While listening to their greeting, the subscriber can dial:  
# (to route to their Next Call Routing Mailbox), then  
# and their mailbox number to log onto their mailbox.  
By default, this option is provided in Call Routing Mailbox 1. Additionally, the subscriber should enable a  
Security Code for their mailbox to prevent unauthorized logons.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
553  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Next Call Routing Mailbox  
Announcement Mailbox Options  
The following charts show how an Announcement Mailbox handles Automated Attendant calls.  
The rst chart explains what happens when the outside call is directly answered by the Announcement  
Mailbox. This happens when the Answer Table uses an Announcement Mailbox for routing instead of  
a Call Routing Mailbox.  
The second chart explains what happens when the outside call is answered by a Call Routing Mailbox  
and then routed to the Announcement Mailbox. This can happen, for example, when a caller dials a  
digit to hear an announcement of company directions.  
Direct Announcement Mailbox Routing  
(If the outside caller routes directly to the Announcement Mailbox)  
4223-03: Next Call  
Routing Mailbox  
4223-01: Repeat  
Count  
4223-02: Hang Up  
After  
Action  
Undened  
0 (No repeats)  
0 (No repeats)  
Yes or No  
If the caller doesn’t dial, after the  
announcement IntraMail hangs up.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, IntraMail says “That is an  
invalid entry” and hangs up.  
1-16 (valid Call  
Routing Mail-  
box)  
No  
If the caller doesn’t dial, after the  
announcement they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Yes  
If the caller doesn’t dial, after the  
announcement IntraMail hangs up.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Undened  
x (x number of  
repeats)  
Yes or No  
If caller doesn’t dial, they hear the  
announcement repeat x number of times  
and then IntraMail hangs up.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, IntraMail says “That is an  
invalid entry” and aborts the announce-  
ment. The announcement repeats (if  
allowed by the Repeat Count) and then  
IntraMail hangs up.  
1-16 (valid Call  
Routing Mail-  
box)  
x (x number of  
repeats)  
No  
If caller doesn’t dial, they hear the  
announcement repeat x number of times  
and then route to the Next Call Routing  
Mailbox.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Yes  
If caller doesn’t dial, they hear the  
announcement repeat x number of times  
and then IntraMail hangs up.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
554  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Next Call Routing Mailbox  
Routed Announcement Mailbox Routing (Page 1 of 2)  
(If the outside caller routes to the Announcement Mailbox from a Call Routing Mailbox)  
4223-03: Next Call  
Routing Mailbox  
4223-01: Repeat  
Count  
4223-02: Hang Up  
After  
Action  
Undened  
0 (No repeats)  
No  
If the caller doesn’t dial, after the  
announcement the caller goes back to the  
initial Call Routing Mailbox.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, IntraMail says “That is an  
invalid entry” and routes the caller goes  
back to the initial Call Routing Mailbox.  
Yes  
No  
If the caller doesn’t dial, after the  
announcement IntraMail hangs up.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, IntraMail says “That is an  
invalid entry” and hangs up.  
1-16 (valid Call  
Routing Mail-  
box)  
0 (No repeats)  
If the caller doesn’t dial, after the  
announcement they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Yes  
No  
If the caller doesn’t dial, after the  
announcement IntraMail hangs up.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Undened  
x (x number of  
repeats)  
If caller doesn’t dial, they hear the  
announcement repeat x number of times  
and then go back to the initial Call Routing  
Mailbox.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, IntraMail says “That is an  
invalid entry” and aborts the announce-  
ment. The announcement repeats (if  
allowed by the Repeat Count) and then  
IntraMail routes back to the initial Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Yes  
If caller doesn’t dial, they hear the  
announcement x number of times and then  
IntraMail hangs up.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, IntraMail says “That is an  
invalid entry” and aborts the announce-  
ment. The announcement repeats (if  
allowed by the Repeat Count) and then  
IntraMail hangs up.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
555  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Next Call Routing Mailbox  
Routed Announcement Mailbox Routing (Page 2 of 2)  
(If the outside caller routes to the Announcement Mailbox from a Call Routing Mailbox)  
4223-03: Next Call  
Routing Mailbox  
4223-01: Repeat  
Count  
4223-02: Hang Up  
After  
Action  
1-16 (valid Call  
Routing Mail-  
box)  
x (x number of  
repeats)  
No  
If caller doesn’t dial, they hear the  
announcement repeat x number of times  
and then route to the Next Call Routing  
Mailbox.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Yes  
If caller doesn’t dial, they hear the  
announcement repeat x number of times  
and then IntraMail hangs up.  
If the caller dials a digit during the  
announcement, they route to the Next Call  
Routing Mailbox.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
Subscriber Mailbox  
Next Call Routing Mailbox = 1  
Dial Option = None  
Announcement Mailbox  
Next Call Routing Mailbox = None (0)  
556  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Next Call Routing Mailbox  
Programming  
Programming Subscriber Mailboxes  
1.  
2.  
Optionally assign the Next Call Routing Mailbox to a Subscriber Mailbox.  
vide the caller leaving a message with additional dialing options.  
Optionally allow the caller to dial additional digits (not just 0) once in the Next Call Routing Mailbox.  
Programming Announcement Mailboxes  
1.  
Optionally assign the Next Call Routing Mailbox for the Announcement Mailbox.  
caller should route after hearing the Announcement Mailbox message.  
Enter the number of times the Announcement Mailbox message should repeat before routing to  
the Next Call Routing Mailbox.  
2.  
1. In 4223-01: Repeat Count (page 893), specify the number of Announcement Mailbox message repeats  
(1-10, or 0 for no repeats).  
By default, this option is 0 (no repeats).  
3.  
To be sure the Announcement Mailbox does not hang up after playing its message.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The Next Call Routing Mailbox dial options also apply to a subscriber’s Direct Inward Line while it is  
forwarded to their mailbox.  
Turn to this feature for an explanation of the options a caller can dial while recording.  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
557  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming Voice Mail  
Programming Voice Mail  
Description  
Customize IntraMail using the embedded telephone programming or the separately available  
System Administrator PC program.  
You program (customize) IntraMail by using the DSX telephone programming or the WindowsTM-based  
DSX System Administrator PC Program running on a PC or laptop. You can also do limited programming  
from the System Administrator’s mailbox. By using the many programmable options available with Intra-  
Mail, you should be able to set up the system to accurately meet the customer’s requirements.  
To customize IntraMail using the telephone programming, use this manual.  
To customize IntraMail using the PC program, see the DSX PC Program User Guide.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• N/A  
Programming  
See Description above.  
558  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Programming Voice Mail  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
IntraMail programming is available remotely via the System Administrator PC program.  
The System Administrator can do limited IntraMail programming, such as recording Automated  
Attendant announcements, recording mailbox names, and deleting messages from mailboxes.  
Operation  
See Description above.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
559  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Message  
Quick Message  
Description  
Automated Attendant callers can dial a digit followed by an extension number to leave a  
message directly in a user’s mailbox.  
Quick Message is a Dial Action Table action that allows Automated Attendant callers to dial a digit (normally *)  
followed by a mailbox number to leave a message in a Subscriber Mailbox. Since Quick Message is enabled by  
default, it is an efcient way for experienced Automated Attendant callers to leave messages. There is no need to  
dial an extension rst. To make this option more readily available to all Automated Attendant callers, consider  
having the active Instruction Menu describe how to use the Quick Message option.  
There are two Quick Message Dial Action Table actions:  
Quick Message with Greeting (REC1)  
The caller hears the mailbox greeting followed by a beep and can leave message. If the greeting is not  
recorded, the caller hears, “At the tone, you can leave your message for extension xxx (or name if  
recorded). Start recording at the tone. When you are done, press the # key or hang up.”  
Quick Message without Greeting (REC2)  
The caller bypasses the mailbox greeting (hearing “Recording” and a beep instead) and can leave a mes-  
sage. This is typically used with a Next Call Routing Mailbox when the caller is asked to dial a digit  
(e.g., 1) to leave a message. Otherwise, the mailbox greeting (if recorded) would be heard again.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Dial Action key * Action is REC1 and Routing is IXXX  
Programming  
1.  
Optionally set up a Quick Message with Greeting (REC1) Action.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter 3 to assign an available key as a REC 1 (Quick Message with  
Greeting) option.  
- To have the caller leave a Quick Message at a specic extension, the corresponding Routing option  
should be the extension number.  
- To have the caller leave a Quick Message at any caller-dialed extension, the corresponding Routing  
option should be IXXX.  
- To have the caller leave a Quick Message at a caller-dialed extension in a specic range, the corre-  
sponding Routing option should be XXX.  
(For example, to allow callers to leave a Quick Message extensions 300-399, for key 3 enter REC1  
for the Action and XXX for the corresponding Routing.)  
2.  
Optionally set up a Quick Message without Greeting (REC2) Action.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter 4 to assign an available key as a REC 2 (Quick Message  
without Greeting) option.  
- To have the caller leave a Quick Message at a specic extension, the corresponding Routing option  
should be the extension number.  
- To have the caller leave a Quick Message at any caller-dialed extension, the corresponding Routing  
option should be IXXX.  
- To have the caller leave a Quick Message at a caller-dialed extension in a specic range, the corre-  
sponding Routing option should be XXX.  
(For example, to allow callers to leave a Quick Message extensions 300-399, for key 3 enter REC2  
for the Action and XXX for the corresponding Routing.)  
560  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Quick Message  
3.  
Set the maximum message length for callers leaving a Quick Message in a mailbox.  
mated Attendant callers leaving a Quick Message in a Subscriber Mailbox.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Once the Automated Attendant answers, the Dial Action Table provides the dialing options to callers.  
Each digit a caller can dial is assigned a specic action (function) in the Dial Action Table. The dial  
action used depends on the setting in the active Call Routing Mailbox, which in turn depends on the  
Answer Table setup.  
The Quick Message without Greeting option (REC2) is typically used when the mailbox’s Next Call  
Routing Mailbox option allows the caller to dial a digit to leave a message. Otherwise, the caller  
would hear the mailbox greeting twice (once when initially accessing the mailbox and again when  
routed by the Next Call Routing Mailbox).  
Operation  
Leaving a Quick Message  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
To leave a Quick Message after the Automated Attendant answers:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Dial *.  
Dial the Subscriber Mailbox number.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
Leave message and hang up.  
Leave message and dial #.  
b.  
• Dialing # may provide you with additional dialing options. This depends on how the called  
mailbox’s Next Call Routing Mailbox is set up.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
561  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record and Send a Message  
Record and Send  
a
Message  
Description  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can record and send a message to any other Subscriber Mailbox.  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can record and send a message to any other Subscriber Mailbox. Record and  
Send a Message is the heart of IntraMail’s voice messaging system. It allows co-workers to efciently stay in  
touch and exchange essential information without relying on message slips, memos, or email.  
Recording Options  
While recording a message, a Subscriber Mailbox user has several recording options from which to choose.  
The following table shows these options.  
Message Recording Options  
Option  
Description  
Options available while recording:  
*
E (3)  
#
Pause/resume recording.  
Erase the recording.  
End recording.  
Dial 0 while recording to hear the list of options.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Always enabled (a permanent feature).  
Programming  
1.  
Set the maximum length of a message that can be left in a Subscriber Mailbox.  
leave in a Subscriber Mailbox (1-4095 seconds).  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
While or after listening to a message, an extension user has many message handling options from  
which to choose.  
562  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Record and Send a Message  
Operation  
Record and Send a Message  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
Record and send a message.  
[Record] - [Rec]  
RS (77)  
Enter the number of the mailbox to receive the message.  
Continue.  
#
[Continue] - [Cont]  
Options available while recording.  
Pause or restart recording.  
[Resume] - [Resume]  
[Pause] - [Pause]  
*
Erase recording.  
E (3)  
[Cancel] - [Cancel]  
End the recording.  
[Done] - [Done]  
#
Back up and re-enter the mailbox number.  
[Mailbox] - [Mbox]  
*
[Exit]  
Exit without recording and go back to the mailbox Main Menu.  
Exit without recording and go back to the mailbox Main Menu.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
563  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Remote Programming  
Remote Programming  
Description  
IntraMail programming is available remotely via the System Administrator PC program.  
You can remotely program IntraMail by using the WindowsTM-based DSX System Administrator PC Program  
running on a PC or laptop. After the initial installation, Remote Programming allows you to customize IntraMail  
to meet the customer’s requirements without being on-site. See the DSX PC Program User Guide for more.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• N/A  
Programming  
See the DSX PC Program User Guide.  
564  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Remote Programming  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Customize IntraMail using the embedded telephone programming or the separately available System  
Administrator PC program.  
Operation  
See the DSX PC Program User Guide.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
565  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Routing Mailbox  
Routing Mailbox  
Description  
A category of mailboxes used to route Automated Attendant calls  
Routing Mailboxes are a category of mailboxes normally used to route Automated Attendant calls. A Rout-  
ing Mailbox can be an Announcement Mailbox, a Call Routing Mailbox, or a Directory Dialing Mailbox.  
See the following for more on each of Routing Mailbox types:  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• N/A  
Programming  
See the following:  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
An Announcement Mailbox plays a pre-recorded announcement to Automated Attendant callers with-  
out providing dialing options.  
The Call Routing Mailbox, associated with an Answer Table, species which dialing options (Dial  
Action Table) and announcements are available to Automated Attendant callers.  
A Directory Dialing Mailbox is the Routing Mailbox type required to implement Directory Dialing.  
Operation  
See the following:  
566  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Screened Transfer  
Screened Transfer  
Description  
Similar to telephone system screened transfers in which the transferring party controls the  
transfer.  
Screened Transfer is an Automated Attendant option that allows callers to directly dial system extensions.  
Screened Transfer (and its related feature Unscreened Transfer) allows the IntraMail Automated Attendant to  
transfer outside calls to system extensions without the need for a live receptionist or operator. It is similar to  
telephone system screened transfers in which the transferring party controls the transfer. After an Automated  
Attendant caller dials an extension, IntraMail calls (screens) the destination extension to see if the transfer  
can go through.  
If the destination is busy or in DND, the Automated Attendant doesn’t extend the call and immediately  
provides the caller with additional options.  
If the destination is available, the Automated Attendant rings it. If the destination answers, the call goes  
through. If the destination doesn’t answer within a preset interval, the Automated Attendant doesn’t  
extend the call and provides the caller with additional options.  
Screened vs. Unscreened Transfer  
Both Screened and Unscreened Transfer allow Automated Attendant callers to directly dial system exten-  
sions. The following summarizes the differences between these two types of Automated Attendant transfer.  
With Unscreened Transfer, calls from the Automated Attendant ring like other transferred calls and dis-  
play the incoming Caller ID data (if provided by telco and enabled in programming). Screened Transfers  
ring like Intercom calls and do not display Caller ID until the call is answered.  
Both Screened and Unscreened Transfers route unanswered calls to the subscriber’s greeting (recorded  
or default) so the caller can leave a message. However, only Screened Transfer allows the caller to dial 2  
to reach the Next Call Routing Mailbox options (if programmed).  
Screened Transfer and Inactive Mailboxes  
Screened Transfer to an extension can only occur if the destination extension has an active mailbox. If the  
extension’s mailbox is inactive, the Automated Attendant caller hears, “That is an invalid entry,and then  
returns to the Automated Attendant.  
The table on the next page shows in detail how Screened Transfer operates.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
567  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Screened Transfer  
Screened Transfer (STRF) Operation  
Call = Call answered by the Automated Attendant.  
Extension = Extension dialed by Automated Attendant caller.  
If Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb is off (see page 427 for more on this feature):  
Extension Idle  
Extension Busy  
1. When busy:  
Extension in DND  
1. When in DND:  
With Active  
Greeting Recorded  
1. Places a screened (Inter-  
com) call to extension.  
-If answered, transfers call.  
-With no Next Call Routing  
Mailbox, caller hears greet-  
ing and can leave a message.  
-With a Next Call Routing  
Mailbox, caller can dial 1  
-With no Next Call Routing  
Mailbox, caller hears greet-  
ing and can leave a message.  
-With a Next Call Routing  
Mailbox, caller can dial 1  
1
2. If unanswered :  
-With no Next Call Routing  
Mailbox, caller hears greet-  
ing and can leave a message.  
-With a Next Call Routing  
Mailbox, caller can dial 1  
2
2
to leave a message or 2 for  
other options.  
to leave a message or 2 for  
other options.  
2
to leave a message or 2 for  
other options.  
With Active Greet- 1. Places a screened (Inter-  
ing Not Recorded  
1. When busy:  
1. When in DND:  
com) call to extension.  
-If answered, transfers call.  
-With no Next Call Routing  
Mailbox, IntraMail prompts  
caller to leave a message.  
-With a Next Call Routing  
Mailbox, caller can dial 1  
-With no Next Call Routing  
Mailbox, caller hears greet-  
ing and can leave a message.  
-With a Next Call Routing  
Mailbox, caller can dial 1  
1
2. If unanswered :  
-With no Next Call Routing  
Mailbox, IntraMail prompts  
caller to leave a message.  
-With a Next Call Routing  
Mailbox, caller can dial 1  
2
2
to leave a message or 2 for  
other options.  
to leave a message or 2 for  
other options.  
2
to leave a message or 2 for  
other options.  
If Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb is on (see page 427 for more on this feature):  
Extension Idle  
Extension Busy  
Extension in DND  
With Active Greet- 1. Sends call immediately to mailbox:  
ing Recorded or  
Not Recorded  
1
-Plays greeting (if recorded), or  
-Prompts caller to start recording.  
2
Dialing 2 routes the call to the Next Call Routing Mailbox for additional dialing options. See Next Call Routing Mailbox  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• No Screened Transfer actions assigned.  
568  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Screened Transfer  
Programming  
1.  
Assign the STRF action to a key on the active Dial ActionTable.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter 1 to assign an available key for Screened Transfer (STRF).  
2. Normally, the corresponding Routing option should be XXX. Note that the key you choose for this action  
is the rst digit of the called extension number.  
- For example, to allow callers to place Screened Transfers to extensions 300-399, for key 3 enter  
STRF for the Action and XXX for the corresponding Routing.  
3. To have Screened Transfer call a specic extension, the corresponding Routing option should be that  
extension’s number. The caller then dials that single digit to reach the extension.  
- For example, to have callers dial 8 to reach extension 303, for key 8 enter STRF for the Action and  
303 for the corresponding Routing.  
Set how long a Screened Transfer will ring an unanswered extension before recalling to the  
Automated Attendant.  
2.  
4. In 4222-03: Screened Transfer Timeout (page 891), set how long a Screened Transfer (STRF) from the  
Automated Attendant will ring (0-255 seconds) an unanswered extension before recalling.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each line.  
The Answer Table determines how the Automated Attendant answers calls.  
• The mailbox associated with an Answer Table that species which dialing options (Dial Action Table)  
and announcements are available to Automated Attendant callers.  
You cannot program a Call Routing Mailbox as a Screened Transfer (STRF) Dial Action Table destination.  
IntraMail provides Caller ID data for a Screened Transfer call after it is answered.  
Denes the dialing options for the Call Routing Mailbox chosen by the active Answer Table.  
The Subscriber Mailbox can optionally convert Automated Attendant Screened Transfers to  
Unscreened Transfers.  
After an Automated Attendant caller dials an extension, IntraMail immediately transfers the call to the  
destination and hangs up.  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
569  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Security Code  
Security Code  
Description  
A mailbox can have a security code to guard against unauthorized access.  
A mailbox can have a security code to protect it from unauthorized access. A Security Code must be 4 digits  
long, using 0-9. If a subscriber wants to keep their mailbox private, they can enter a Security Code. No one  
else can use the subscriber’s mailbox unless they know the code.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Always available, but no Security Codes entered.  
Programming  
N/A  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The System Administrator can delete a mailbox’s security code.  
Operation  
Changing or Deleting a Security Code (From your Subscriber Mailbox)  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
Access the Mailbox Options Menu.  
[MBOX Options] - [N/A]  
OP (67)  
Access the Security Code options.  
[Security Code] - [Sec]  
S (7)  
Enter new Security Code (4 digits, using 0-9).  
Accept Security Code entry and go back to the Mailbox Options Menu.  
[OK] - [OK]  
C (2)  
I (4)  
Do not accept Security Code entry and go back to the Security Code  
options Menu.  
[Clear] - [Clear]  
Optionally erase your Security Code and go back to the Mailbox Options Menu.  
[Erase] - [Erase]  
*
Exit to the Mailbox Options Menu without making any changes to your Security  
Code.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
0
Plays Help message.  
570  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Security Code  
Deleting a Security Code (From your System Administrator’s Mailbox)  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto System Administrator’s mailbox.  
Access System Administrator options.  
[System Admin] - [N/A]  
SA (72)  
Select Subscriber Mailbox Maintenance options.  
[Subscriber] - [Subs]  
S (7)  
Enter the number of the Subscriber Mailbox you want to maintain.  
Erase mailbox’s Security Code.  
S (7)  
[Erase Security Code] - [N/A]  
Go back to System Administrator options.  
[Exit] - [Exit]  
#
0
Plays Help message.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
571  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Single Digit Dialing  
Single Digit Dialing  
Description  
Allows an Automated Attendant caller to press a single key for an extension, another  
destination, or use an IntraMail feature.  
An Automated Attendant caller can press a single key to route to an extension, route to another destination, or  
use an IntraMail feature. Single Digit Dialing simplies the Automated Attendant since the caller just dials a  
single digit to reach an extension or use an option. If you set up Single Digit Dialing, be sure to customize the  
active Instruction Menu so it describes which digits the caller should dial to use the available options.  
All of the features in the following Dial Action Table Key Action Summary table are accessible from a single  
Dial Action Table digit.  
Dial Action Table Key Action Summary  
Action  
STRF  
Description  
Screened Transfer (1)  
Allows an Automated Attendant caller to place  
a Screened Transfer to an extension. IntraMail  
calls (screens) the destination to see if the call  
can go through.  
Feature Reference  
For more, see:  
Unscreened Transfer (2)  
Allows an Automated Attendant caller to place  
an Unscreened Transfer to an extension.Intra-  
Mail transfers the call the destination and then  
hangs up.  
UTRF  
Quick Message with Greeting (3)  
Allows an Automated Attendant caller to leave  
a Quick Message at an extension. The caller  
will hear the extension’s personal greeting.  
REC1  
REC2  
Quick Message without Greeting (4)  
Allows an Automated Attendant caller to leave  
a Quick Message at an extension. The caller  
will not hear the extension’s personal greeting  
Log Onto Voice Mail (5)  
Allows an Automated Attendant caller to log  
onto a mailbox, either directly or one of their  
choosing.  
LOGON  
Hang Up (6)  
IntraMail says “Goodbye” and hangs up.  
Hang  
Up  
Go to a Mailbox, (7)  
Allows an Automated Attendant caller to route  
to another mailbox.  
GOTO  
UND  
Undened Routing (0)  
This action provides no routing.  
N/A  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
572  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Single Digit Dialing  
Programming  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The active Instruction Menu should describe the Single Digit Dialing options.  
Operation  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
573  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Subscriber Mailbox  
Subscriber Mailbox  
Description  
The mailbox type normally used for telephone system extensions.  
A Subscriber Mailbox is the type of mailbox assigned to a telephone system extension. The telephone  
assigned to the Subscriber Mailbox is called the subscribers extension. When an extension user accesses their  
voice mail, they are using their Subscriber Mailbox. It provides the IntraMail voice messaging services. For a  
brief overview of the features available at a Subscriber Mailbox, review the Other Related Features below.  
Then, go to the individual feature to nd out how it operates and any programming required to make it work.  
IntraMail automatically assigns a mailbox to each extension in the number plan. In DSX-80/160, the rst 16  
(300-315) Subscriber Mailboxes are active. In DSX-40, the rst eight (300-307) Subscriber Mailboxes are active.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
DSX-80/160  
• 128 total Subscriber Mailboxes (300-427).  
• The rst 16 (300-315) are active.  
DSX-40  
• 34 total Subscriber Mailboxes (300-333).  
• The rst 8 (300-307) are active.  
Programming  
1.  
Set up a Subscriber Mailbox.  
1. In 2141-01: Station Mailbox Type (page 766), for each extension that should have a mailbox enter 1.  
- To set up a Group Mailbox, enter 2 and turn to Group Mailbox (page 497).  
2.  
3.  
Check to be sure message waiting lamping is enabled for the Subscriber Mailbox.  
Set the maximum length of recorded messages left in the Subscriber Mailbox.  
recorded messages left in the Subscriber Mailbox.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb sends Automated Attendant calls directly to a subscriber’s mailbox.  
Their phone will not ring for calls from the Automated Attendant.  
After a subscriber listens to a message in their Subscriber Mailbox, IntraMail can automatically erase  
or save the message.  
The Automated Attendant can route callers to a Subscriber Mailbox.  
574  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Subscriber Mailbox  
Enable or disable the Conversation Record beep for the Subscriber Mailbox.  
A Subscriber Mailbox user can record a personalized greeting for their mailbox. Callers to the user’s  
mailbox hear the prerecorded personalized greeting.  
Review this feature to learn which features are available to a subscriber while listening to messages.  
The Main Menu provides access to the features available to a Subscriber Mailbox.  
To simplify returning outside calls, IntraMail can ask the caller leaving a message to enter their phone  
number prior to leaving the message. The subscriber can then dial MC to call the person back.  
Set the type of messages a subscriber will listen to when they dial L (5) after logging into their Sub-  
scriber Mailbox.  
Once activated, Message Notication dials up to 3 telephone numbers to let the user know they have  
new messages in their Subscriber Mailbox.  
Set the subscriber Mailbox message playback order.  
Review this feature to learn which features are available to a subscriber while recording and sending a  
message.  
Set how long a Subscriber Mailbox will retain saved messages.  
Set the maximum number of messages that can be left in the mailbox.  
The Next Call Routing Mailbox provides additional dialing options after a caller leaves a message in a  
Subscriber Mailbox.  
If enabled, a subscriber must enter a security code before logging onto their Subscriber Mailbox.  
A Subscriber Mailbox designated as a System Administrator provides the subscriber with unique sys-  
tem administration capabilities through the SA menu.  
The Subscriber Mailbox can optionally convert Automated Attendant Screened Transfers to  
Unscreened Transfers.  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
575  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Administrator  
System Administrator  
Description  
The extension user that has IntraMail system administration capabilities.  
The System Administrator is a Subscriber Mailbox that has unique system administration features such as  
recording Instruction Menus and deleting messages in a co-worker’s mailbox. The System Administrator  
features are an essential part of IntraMail setup since they allow the recording of the system-wide messages  
and provide Subscriber Mailbox maintenance. After logging onto their Subscriber Mailbox, the System  
Administrator can use all of the features in the SA menu. The System Administrator Options table below  
shows these options.  
System Administrator Options  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Option  
Description  
For more, see:  
SA (72)  
[System Admin] - [N/A]  
Access the System Administrator options.  
Record an Instruction Menu.  
I (4)  
[Instruction] - [Instr]  
A (2)  
[Announcement] - [Annc]  
Record an Announcement Message.  
S (7)  
[Subscriber] - [Subs]  
Access the Subscriber Maintenance options (see the following features).  
EA (32)  
[Erase All Messages] - [Msgs]  
Erase all messages in a mailbox.  
Erase a mailbox greeting.  
EG (34)  
[Erase Greeting] - [Greet]  
With Multiple Greetings, this option  
simultaneously erases all recorded  
greetings in a Subscriber Mailbox.  
Additionally, the active greeting is  
reset to 1.  
EN (36)  
[Erase Name] - [Name]  
Erase a mailbox name.  
S (7)  
[Erase Security Code] - [N/A]  
Delete a mailbox Security Code.  
Record Mailbox Name.  
N (6)  
[Record Mailbox Name] - [N/A]  
O (6)  
[Answer Schedule] - [N/A]  
Override the active Answer Schedule.  
Message on Hold  
1
[N/A] - [N/A]  
V (8)  
[N/A] - [N/A]  
Hear the version number of the IntraMail stored voice prompts.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Extension 300 is the System Administrator.  
576  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Administrator  
Programming  
1.  
Designate a Subscriber Mailbox as a System Administrator.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Only a Subscriber Mailbox can be a System Administrator.  
Operation  
Refer to the individual features referenced in the System Administrator Options (page 576).  
Accessing the System Administrator Options  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto System Administrator’s Mailbox.  
Access the System Administrator Menu.  
[System Admin] - [N/A]  
SA (72)  
0
Plays Help message.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
577  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Administrator Mailbox  
System Administrator Mailbox  
Description  
A Subscriber Mailbox option that enables the system administration capabilities.  
A System Administrator Mailbox is a Subscriber Mailbox in which you have enabled the System Administra-  
tor option. This provides the subscriber with system administration capabilities. IntraMail can have multiple  
System Administrator Mailboxes. Turn to System Administrator (page 576) for more.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• The System Administrator Mailbox is 300.  
Programming  
1.  
Designate a Subscriber Mailbox as a System Administrator.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Only a Subscriber Mailbox can be a System Administrator.  
The System Administrator has unique system administration functions, such as recording Welcome  
Messages and Instruction Menus, and deleting messages in a co-worker’s mailbox.  
Operation  
578  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Reinitialization  
System Reinitialization  
Description  
Reinitializing IntraMail returns all programmed options to their default values.  
Initializing the telephone system automatically initializes all IntraMail programming. You may want to do  
this if the site requirements signicantly change and it is easier to start over from default than remove all  
your custom programming. Reinitializing returns all programmed options to their default values.  
Reinitializing the telephone system returns all programmed options to  
their factory set (default) values. Any site specic programming  
you have done will be erased following reinitialization.  
To initialize (erase) Subscriber Mailbox Security Codes and all recordings, use a System Administrator Mailbox.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• N/A  
Programming  
1.  
To reinitialize the telephone system data base:  
1. Press INTERCOM and dial #*#* + NECDSX + HOLD.  
2. Dial 9011 + HOLD.  
3. Dial 1 (for yes) + HOLD.  
- The telephone system data base initializes.  
- To cancel initialization, dial 0 + HOLD instead.  
2.  
To erase recorded messages and Subscriber Mailbox Security Codes:  
- The recorded messages include:  
Instruction Menus  
Announcement Mailbox messages  
Messages left in a Subscriber Mailbox  
Subscriber Mailbox greetings  
Subscriber Mailbox names  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
The System Administrator can delete Subscriber Mailbox security codes as well as IntraMail recorded  
messages.  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
579  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Time and Date with Voice Mail  
Time and Date with Voice Mail  
Description  
Set the system time and date.  
Since IntraMail is completely integrated with the telephone system software, the IntraMail time and date is  
the same as the phone system time and date. Since time and date is used on telephone displays and with the  
Auto Time Stamp and Time and Date Stamp features, be sure to set it accurately. To change the time and date,  
use either the system programmable options or the User Programmable features. See Programming below.  
The Time and Date is retained if the telephone system power should fail or the system resets.  
In addition, a Subscriber Mailbox user can hear the time and date when they call their mailbox.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• N/A  
Programming  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
After a user listens to a message, IntraMail can optionally announce the time and date the message  
was left.  
Turn to this feature for more on the Time and Date options.  
An extension can listen to a message and dial TI to hear the time the message was sent.  
Operation  
Hearing the Current Time and Date  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
Access the Time and Date option.  
• IntraMail plays the time and date, and then returns you to the mailbox Main Menu.  
TI (84)  
Plays Help message.  
0
580  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Time and Date Stamp  
Time and Date Stamp  
Description  
A mailbox user can listen to a message and dial a code to hear the time the message was sent,  
as well as the caller’s number.  
While listening to a message, a Subscriber Mailbox user can dialTI to hear the Time and Date the message  
was left. This is a handy option while reviewing messages. The subscriber can just dial a code to nd out  
when the message arrived.  
Time and Date Stamp with Caller ID  
With caller ID installed, a mailbox user can dialTI while listening to a message from an outside caller to hear  
the time the message was sent, as well as the caller’s number. This capability is always available for mes-  
sages left by an Intercom caller.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled  
Programming  
To get Time and Date Stamp with Caller ID, be sure Caller ID is properly installed and programmed in the  
connected telephone system.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
After a user listens to a message, IntraMail can optionally announce the time and date the message  
was left.  
With Caller ID installed and programmed, the Time and Date Stamp for outside calls also includes the  
caller’s number.  
Turn to this feature for additional listening options.  
You can set the system Time and Date from the telephone system programming or using the User-Pro-  
grammable Features.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
581  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Time and Date Stamp  
Operation  
Hearing the Time and Date a Message was Left  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
Log onto Subscriber Mailbox.  
Access the Message Listen mode.  
[Listen] - [Lstn]  
L (5)  
Hear the time and date the message was sent.  
TI (84)  
0
Plays Help message  
582  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transfer to a Mailbox  
Transfer to  
a
Mailbox  
Description  
An extension user can transfer their active call to a co-worker’s mailbox.  
An extension user can transfer their active call to a co-worker’s mailbox. This lets the caller leave a personal  
message for the co-worker. Transfer to a Mailbox is one of the big conveniences of IntraMail since the caller  
can state their business and not have to call back later. It saves the caller time and cuts down on unnecessary  
telephone system call processing. Transfer to a Mailbox is frequently used by attendants and receptionists as  
well as other co-workers.  
Transfer Message Handling  
When the transferring extension leaves a message before hanging up (which could occur if the destinations  
calls are forwarded to voice mail), the system will record two separate messages. One message will be from the  
transferring extension; the other from the transferred caller. Each message has the correct Caller ID assigned.  
Additionally, if a caller is transferred to an extension and Voice Mail picks up, the caller will hear the entire  
greeting for the called extension’s mailbox. The greeting will restart as soon as the system connects the  
caller to the Transfer destination’s mailbox.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Always enabled.  
Programming  
1.  
Set the maximum length of a message that the transferred caller can leave in a Subscriber Mailbox.  
leave in a Subscriber Mailbox (1-4095 seconds).  
Other Related Features  
Features  
• Pressing TRANSFER + Call Coverage Key can Transfer a call to an uninstalled extension’s mailbox  
(if the mailbox is enabled).  
• Pressing a Hotline key can Transfer a call to an uninstalled extension’s mailbox (if the mailbox is  
enabled).  
• Pressing TRANSFER + Call Coverage Key can Transfer a call to an uninstalled extension’s mailbox  
(if the mailbox is enabled).  
• Pressing a Hotline key can also Transfer a call to an uninstalled extension’s mailbox (if the mailbox is  
enabled).  
IntraMail Features  
When enabled, Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb automatically sends all calls from the Automated  
Attendant to the subscriber’s mailbox.  
Automated Attendant Screened Transfers can automatically transfer an outside caller to an extension.  
Automated Attendant Unscreened Transfers can automatically transfer an outside caller to an extension.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
583  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Transfer to a Mailbox  
Operation  
In these instructions:  
[Super Display Soft Key]  
[Keyset Soft Key]  
Transferring Calls to a Mailbox  
To Transfer your active call to a mailbox:  
Method A (Ring rst, then Transfer)  
1.  
2.  
Press TRANSFER.  
Dial the number of the mailbox to receive the Transfer.  
You can optionally press the DSS key for your co-worker.  
• To transfer the call to your own mailbox, dial your extension number.  
Press V-MAIL and hang up.  
3.  
4.  
Voice mail will prompt your caller to leave a message.  
• The caller will hear the entire mailbox greeting after the Transfer goes through.  
Press SPEAKER to hang up.  
• To transfer a call to a co-worker’s mailbox from a single line telephone, use the following procedure:  
Hookash + Dial *8 + Dial the co-worker’s mailbox + Hang up.  
Method B (Transfer without rst ringing)  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Press TRANSFER.  
Press V-MAIL.  
Dial the number of the mailbox to receive the Transfer.  
You can optionally press the DSS key for your co-worker.  
Voice mail will prompt your caller to leave a message.  
• The caller will hear the entire mailbox greeting after the Transfer goes through.  
4.  
Press SPEAKER to hang up.  
Method C (Using a Call Coverage key)  
Press TRANSFER.  
• If your extension has Hotline Automatic Transfer, skip this step.  
1.  
2.  
3.  
Press the Call Coverage key.  
Press V-MAIL.  
Voice mail will prompt your caller to leave a message.  
• The caller will hear the entire mailbox greeting after the Transfer goes through.  
4.  
Press SPEAKER to hang up.  
Method D (Using a Hotline key)  
1.  
2.  
Press the Hotline key.  
Press V-MAIL.  
Voice mail will prompt your caller to leave a message.  
• The caller will hear the entire mailbox greeting after the Transfer goes through.  
4.  
Press SPEAKER to hang up.  
584  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transfer to a UCD Group  
Transfer to  
a
UCD Group  
Description  
The Automated Attendant can transfer outside callers to UCD Group master numbers.  
The Automated Attendant can transfer outside callers to a UCD Group master number. If a customer has a  
UCD Group set up for a department (such as Sales or Tech Service), the Automated Attendant can send calls  
directly to that department without any operator intervention. It is not necessary to have a company  
employee handle the calls. The calls will ring a member of the group or queue (wait in line) if all co-  
worker’s in the group are busy.  
To set up Transfer to a UCD Group, assign a STRF or UTRF action in the active Dial Action Table to route  
to the UCD Group master number. Refer to Screened Transfer (page 567) and Unscreened Transfer  
(page 587) for more on how these Automated Attendant options handle calls.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
Optionally assign a STRF action to the key on the active Dial ActionTable that you want to route  
to the UCD Group master number.  
1.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter 1 to assign an available key as a STRF action.  
- To transfer directly to the master number, Action should be STRF and the corresponding Routing  
option should be the master extension number.  
Optionally assign a UTRF action to the key on the active Dial ActionTable that you want to  
route to the UCD Group master number.  
2.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter 2 to assign an available key as a UTRF action.  
- To transfer directly to the master number, Action should be UTRF and the corresponding Routing  
option should be the master extension number.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Set up STRF or UTRF Dial Action Table actions to route to the UCD Group master number.  
Automated Attendant Screened Transfers can automatically transfer an outside caller to a UCD Group  
master number.  
Automated Attendant Unscreened Transfers can automatically transfer an outside caller to a UCD  
Group master number.  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
585  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Undefined Routing  
Undened Routing  
Description  
A key pad digit for which the Automated Attendant has no routing dened.  
An Automated Attendant Undened Routing is a Dial Action Table key assignment for which there is no  
routing dened. When an Automated Attendant caller dials a digit and there is no routing assigned, IntraMail  
plays, “That is an invalid entry.IntraMail then repeats the dialing options (Instruction Menu) to the caller.  
If a Dial Action Table key assignment has no function, you should normally leave it undened.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• In Dial Action Table 1, keys 1, 2, 5, 6, 7, and 8 Undened Routing.  
• In Dial Action Tables 2-16, all keys have Undened Routing.  
Programming  
1.  
To set up an Undened Routing for a Dial Action Table:  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter 0 to assign an available key as an Undened Routing action.  
- For a key that should have an Undened Routing, the Action entry should display as UND. There is  
no corresponding Routing option entry.  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Undened Routing is a Dial Action Table Action.  
The active Call Routing Mailbox’s Instruction Menu repeats after a caller dials a digit with an Unde-  
ned Routing.  
Operation  
N/A  
586  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Unscreened Transfer  
Unscreened Transfer  
Description  
Similar to telephone system unscreened transfers in which the transferring party immediately  
extends the call.  
Unscreened Transfer is an Automated Attendant option that allows callers to directly dial system exten-  
sions. Unscreened Transfer (and its related feature Screened Transfer) allows the IntraMail Automated  
Attendant to transfer outside calls to system extensions without the need for a live receptionist or operator.  
It is similar to telephone system unscreened transfers in which the transferring party immediately extends  
the call. After an Automated Attendant caller dials an extension, IntraMail transfers the call to the destina-  
tion and hangs up. Any recalls or additional routing are handled by the telephone system – just as with any  
other unscreened transfer.  
Screened vs. Unscreened Transfer  
Both Screened and Unscreened Transfer allow Automated Attendant callers to directly dial system exten-  
sions. The following summarizes the differences between these two types of Automated Attendant transfer.  
With Unscreened Transfer, calls from the Automated Attendant ring like other transferred calls and dis-  
play the incoming Caller ID data (if provided by telco and enabled in programming). Screened Transfers  
ring like Intercom calls and do not display Caller ID until the call is answered.  
Both Screened and Unscreened Transfers route unanswered calls to the subscriber’s greeting (recorded  
or default) so the caller can leave a message. However, only Screened Transfer allows the caller to dial 2  
to reach the Next Call Routing Mailbox options (if programmed).  
Unscreened Transfer and Inactive Mailboxes  
An Unscreened Transfer will go through to the destination extension even if the destination doesn’t have an  
active mailbox. If the Unscreened Transfer is unanswered at the destination, the call returns to the Auto-  
mated Attendant.  
The following table shows in detail how Unscreened Transfer operates.  
Unscreened Transfer (UTRF) Operation  
Call = Call answered by the Automated Attendant.  
Extension = Extension dialed by Automated Attendant caller.  
If Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb is off (see page 427 for more on this feature):  
Extension Idle Extension Busy  
1. Transfers call to extension. 1. Transfers call to extension. 1. Transfers call to extension.  
Extension in DND  
With Active Greeting  
Recorded  
1
1
-If answered, connects call  
(just like a phone system  
transfer).  
2. If unanswered in a default 2. If unanswered in a default  
phone system, plays greet-  
ing (so caller can start  
phone system, plays greet-  
ing (so caller can start  
1
2
2
-If unanswered in a  
recording)  
recording).  
default phone system,  
plays greeting (so caller  
can start recording).  
2
With Active Greeting  
Not Recorded  
1. Transfers call to extension. 1. Transfers call to extension. 1. Transfers call to extension.  
1
1
-If answered, connects call  
(just like a phone system  
2. If unanswered in a default 2. If unanswered in a default  
phone system, plays name  
(if recorded) or extension  
number. IntraMail then  
prompts caller to leave a  
phone system, plays name  
(if recorded) or extension  
number. IntraMail then  
prompts caller to leave a  
transfer).  
If unanswered in a  
1
-
default phone system,  
plays name (if recorded)  
or extension number. Intr-  
aMail then prompts caller  
2
2
message.  
message.  
2
to leave a message.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
587  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Unscreened Transfer  
If Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb is on (see page 427 for more on this feature):  
Extension Idle  
Extension Busy  
Extension in DND  
With Active Greeting  
Recorded or Not  
Recorded  
1. Sends call immediately to mailbox:  
-Plays greeting (if recorded), or  
-Prompts caller to start recording.  
Custom phone system programming may redirect the unanswered call (for example, to a hunt group or another extension).  
2
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Dial Action Table 1 digits 3 and 4 are UTRFs to XXX (caller-dialed extension).  
Programming  
1.  
Assign the UTRF action to a key on the active Dial ActionTable.  
1. In 4231-Digit Assignment (page 901), enter 2 to assign an available key for Unscreened Transfer  
(UTRF).  
2. Normally, the corresponding Routing option should be XXX. Note that the key you choose for this action  
is the rst digit of the called extension number.  
- For example, to allow callers to place Unscreened Transfers to extensions 300-399, for key 3 enter  
UTRF for the Action and XXX for the corresponding Routing.  
3. To have Unscreened Transfer call a specic extension, the corresponding Routing option should be that  
extension’s number. The caller then dials that single digit to reach the extension.  
- For example, to have callers dial 8 to reach extension 303, for key 8 enter UTRF for the Action and  
303 for the corresponding Routing.  
2.  
Optionally set the telephone system’s Transfer Recall interval.  
1. In 1603-01: Transfer Recall Timer (page 675), set the Transfer Recall interval (0-9999 seconds) as  
required.  
- Unanswered Unscreened Transfers route to the extension’s mailbox after this interval.  
588  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Unscreened Transfer  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each line.  
The Answer Table determines how the Automated Attendant answers calls.  
The mailbox associated with an Answer Table that species which dialing options (Dial Action Table)  
and announcements are available to Automated Attendant callers.  
IntraMail provides Caller ID data for an Unscreened Transfer as the call is ringing.  
• Denes the dialing options for the Call Routing Mailbox chosen by the active Answer Table.  
You cannot program a Call Routing Mailbox as an Unscreened Transfer (UTRF) Dial Action Table  
destination.  
The Subscriber Mailbox can optionally convert Automated Attendant Screened Transfers to  
Unscreened Transfers.  
The Next Call Routing settings for a Subscriber Mailbox may provide additional options after the  
caller leaves a message.  
After an Automated Attendant caller dials an extension, IntraMail calls (screens) the destination  
extension to see if the transfer can go through.  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
589  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Mail Overflow  
Voice Mail Overow  
Description  
Insures that IntraMail will pick up calls that don’t go through.  
The telephone system can automatically reroute unanswered outside calls to the IntraMail Automated Atten-  
dant. Voice Mail Overow ensures that IntraMail will pick up calls that don’t go through. This allows callers  
to leave a message rather than having to call back later. Voice Mail can be the overow destination for the  
following types of unanswered calls:  
Key Ring Overow  
A line ringing an extension’s line keys can overow to the IntraMail Automated Attendant.  
UCD Group Overow  
A line that rings UCD Hunting group can overow to the group’s mailbox. See Group Mailbox  
Ring Group Overow  
A line transferred by an extension or the Automated Attendant (UTRF or STRF) to a Ring Group can  
overow to the group’s mailbox. See Group Mailbox (page 497) for more.  
Direct Inward Line (DIL) Overow  
A line that directly rings an extension or can overow to that extension’s mailbox if not answered.  
Ring Group Direct Inward Line (DIL) Overow  
A Direct Inward Line (DIL) to the Ring Group master number can overow to the group’s mailbox. See  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Disabled  
Programming  
Setting Up Key Ring Overow  
1.  
2.  
3.  
To set up Key Ring overow during the day:  
1. In 3112-01: Direct Termination in the Day (page 819), press CLEAR to make the line a Key Ring line  
during the day and at night.  
2. In 3112-02: Enable Day Overow (page 819), enterYes to activate overow during the day.  
To set up Key Ring overow at night:  
1. In 3112-04: Direct Termination at Night (page 820), press CLEAR to make the line a Key Ring line at  
night.  
2. In 3112-05: Enable Night Overow (page 820), enterYes to activate overow at night  
Set the overow time (the interval calls will Key Ring before overow occurs).  
-
A Key Ring call will overow to the IntraMail Automated Attendant if not answered after this interval.  
590  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Voice Mail Overflow  
Setting Up UCD Group Overow  
1.  
To set up UCD Group overow:  
Setting Up Ring Group Overow  
1.  
To set up UCD Group overow:  
Setting Up DIL Overow  
1.  
2.  
3.  
To set up DIL overow during the day:  
1. In 3112-02: Enable Day Overow (page 819), enterYes to activate overow during the day.  
To set up DIL overow only at night:  
1. In 3112-05: Enable Night Overow (page 820), enterYes to activate overow at night.  
Set the overow time (the interval calls will ring before overow occurs).  
1. In 1601-02: DIL No Answer Timer (page 669), enter the interval before overow occurs (0-9999 seconds).  
- A DIL to the Ring Group master number will overow to the IntraMail Automated Attendant if not  
answered after this interval.  
Setting Up Ring Group DIL Overow  
1.  
2.  
3.  
To set up Ring Group DIL overow during the day:  
1. In 3112-02: Enable Day Overow (page 819), enterYes to activate overow during the day.  
To set up Ring Group DIL overow only at night:  
1. In 3112-05: Enable Night Overow (page 820), enterYes to activate overow at night.  
Set the overow time (the interval calls will ring before overow occurs).  
1. In 1601-02: DIL No Answer Timer (page 669), enter the interval before overow occurs (0-9999 seconds).  
- A DIL to the Ring Group master number will overow to the IntraMail Automated Attendant if not  
answered after this interval.  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
591  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Mail Overflow  
Other Related Features  
Features  
None  
IntraMail Features  
Determines how the Automated Attendant answers outside calls on each line.  
The Answer Table determines how the Automated Attendant answers calls.  
The mailbox associated with an Answer Table that species which dialing options (Dial Action Table)  
and announcements are available to Automated Attendant callers.  
Denes the dialing options for the Call Routing Mailbox chosen by the active Answer Table.  
A subscriber’s mailbox can pick up their unanswered calls.  
Use Group Mailboxes for UCD Hunting and Ring Group Overow.  
Operation  
N/A  
592  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Prompting Messages  
Voice Prompting Messages  
Description  
IntraMail provides Voice Prompts that tell the extension user the status or progress of their call.  
IntraMail provides the telephone system with Voice Prompting Messages which tell the extension user the  
status or progress of their call. For example, if an extension user calls a co-worker while their extension is in  
DND, they hear, “Please do not disturb.Voice Prompting Messages guide the user while using certain fea-  
tures. The following table lists the available Voice Prompting Messages.  
Voice Prompting Messages  
Voice Prompt  
Feature  
Description  
The number you have dialed is not in service.  
Vacant number.  
The extension you called is part of the exten-  
sion data base but is not installed.  
The extension you called is not part of the  
extension data base.  
This is extension ___.  
You press  
N
(6) to hear your extension number.  
The time is ____. The date is ____.  
You pressT (8) on your idle keyset to hear the  
Time and Date.  
All lines are busy. For callback, press 2 or the Line Groups (page 225) You dial a Line Group access code (9 or 90-  
callback key.  
98) and no lines are available in that group.  
Extension ___ is busy. For callback, press 2 or  
the callback key.  
You place an Intercom call to a busy extension  
Your call cannot go through. Please call the  
operator.  
You place a call that is blocked by your exten-  
sion’s Toll Restriction  
Please do not disturb.  
You call an extension in Do Not Disturb.  
Please hold on. Your call is being rerouted.  
Call Forwarding Off Premise is rerouting your  
call to the programmed destination.  
If your DSX-80/160 has an UltraMail Voice Mail with Automated Attendant installed, you can install an  
IntraMail to provide the Voice Prompting Messages. The UltraMail will provide the voice mail services, not  
the IntraMail.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Enabled if IntraMail installed.  
Programming  
No additional programming is required.  
Other Related Features  
Bilingual Voice Prompts provides IntraMail voice prompts in one of two active languages.  
Operation  
N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
IntraMail Features  
593  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Volume Control with Voice Mail  
Volume Control with Voice Mail  
Description  
A mailbox user can turn the volume up or down while listening to their messages.  
Since IntraMail is completely integrated with the telephone system software, Volume Control is available at a  
subscriber’s keyset any time while listening to a message, greeting, or prerecorded voice prompt. Volume Con-  
trols let the user interactively adjust the loudness of the IntraMail messages and prompts to a comfortable level.  
Conditions  
• None  
Default Setting  
• Always enabled.  
Programming  
No additional programming required.  
Other Related Features  
N/A  
Operation  
Volume Control  
[Super Display Soft Key] - [Keyset Soft Key]  
To adjust the volume while using any mailbox feature:  
1.  
Press Volume Up or Volume Down.  
594  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
10xx-Configuration  
100x-System  
1001-Version  
System Options:  
1001-1702  
10xx-Conguration  
100x1-SVeyrsstiemn  
o
Description  
Use this program to check the system type, the system’s software version number, and version number of the  
embedded DSP.  
Options  
1001-01: System Type  
(System Type)  
Use this option to display the system name. This is a xed option which you cannot modify.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• None  
Default  
DSX  
1001-02: Software Version  
(S/W Version)  
Use this option to display the system software version. This is a xed option which you cannot modify.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• N/A  
Default  
• N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
595  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
10xx-Configuration  
100x-System  
1001-Version  
1001-03: DSP Version  
(DSP Version)  
Use this option to display the version of the embedded DSP software. This is a xed option which you can-  
not modify.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• N/A  
Default  
• N/A  
596  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
10xx-Configuration  
101x-ID  
1011-Name  
101x1-INDame  
Description  
Use this program to enter the system name and telephone number.  
Options  
1011-01: System Name  
(System Name)  
Use this option to enter the site name (up to 18 characters). Use the Name Programming Chart (page 598)  
when entering names.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Default  
• No entry  
1011-02:Telephone Number  
(Phone Number)  
Use this option to enter the site telephone number.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Digits (24 digits max. using 0-9, # and *.  
Default  
• No entry  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
597  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
10xx-Configuration  
101x-ID  
1011-Name  
Name Programming Chart  
Name Programming Chart  
Press a key the indicated number of times for desired character  
Key  
1 Time  
2 Times  
3 Times  
4 Times  
5 Times  
6 Times  
7 Times  
8 Times  
9 Times  
1
&
-
/
C
F
I
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
#
*
A
B
E
H
K
N
Q
U
X
:
a
d
g
j
b
e
c
f
2
3
4
5
6
r
D
G
h
k
i
J
M
L
O
R
V
Y
0
l
m
S
t
n
p
u
w
o
q
v
x
P
s
z
7
9
T
8
y
W
Z
space  
Not used  
Not used  
After selecting a letter, press a key for another letter or wait 2 seconds for the cursor to automatically advance.  
Additional Name Programming Options  
HOLD  
Save name.  
SPEAKER  
Volume Up  
Volume Down  
Exit user name programming.  
Scroll the cursor to the right.  
Scroll the cursor to the left.  
While editing, clears character to the right.  
At beginning of line, erases entire entry.  
At end of line, becomes a backspace key  
CLEAR  
CHECK  
Restore the previous entry,  
598  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
10xx-Configuration  
102x-Time  
1021-Set Time and Date  
102x1-TSiemt Teime and Date  
Description  
Use this program to set the system time and date.  
Options  
1021-01: System Time  
(Time)  
Use this option to set the system time. Enter data using the 24-hour format HH:MM:SS. For example,  
13:00:00 = 1:00 PM. The system shows Time and Date on telephone displays and in various system reports.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
HH:MM:SS (system time in 24-hour format)  
Default  
8:45PM (20:45:00)  
1021-02: System Date  
(Date)  
Use this option to set the system date. The system shows Time and Date on telephone displays and in various  
system reports.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
MM/DD/YY  
MM for month (1-12)  
DD for day (1-31)  
YYYY for year (e.g., 2006)  
Default  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
599  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
10xx-Configuration  
102x-Time  
1022-Daylight Savings Time  
1022-Daylight Savings Time  
Description  
Use this program to set the Automatic Daylight Savings Time option.  
Options  
1022-01: Automatic Daylight Savings Time Setting  
(Auto D.S.T.)  
Use this option to enable or disable automatic Daylight Savings Time adjustment. If enabled, the system will  
automatically set the time back 1 hour at 2:00 AM on the last Sunday in October and set the time forward 1  
hour at 2:00 AM on the rst Sunday in April. If disabled, this adjustment will not occur.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
600  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
10xx-Configuration  
102x-Time  
1023-Internet (Network Time Server [NTS])  
1023-Internet (Network Time Server [NTS])  
Description  
Use this program to specify the Network Time Server (NTS).  
Options  
1023-01: Network Time Server Name  
(Server Name)  
Use this option to enter the IP address of the Network Time Server (NTS), if any. The system will synchro-  
nize it’s date and time with this source.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
IP address in the format xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx  
Default  
• None  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
601  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
10xx-Configuration  
103x-Programming  
1031-Password Entry  
103x1-ParosgsrwaomrdmEingtry  
n
Description  
Use the program to customize the system passwords.  
Options  
1031-01: New Password  
(New Password)  
Use this option to change the system passwords. The table below shows the default system passwords. To  
avoid having to reinitialize your system, always keep a careful record of your passwords.  
Logging On with this  
Gives you access to these programs:  
Password:  
System Administrator 1 (level 1)  
Password = 0000  
System Administrator 2 (level 1)  
Password = 9999  
Installer (level 3)  
Password = NECDSX (632379)  
All  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Digits (8 digits max, using 0-9, # and *).  
Default  
• See the table above.  
602  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
11xx-CPU  
110x-I/O  
1101-RS232 Settings  
11xx-CPU  
110x1-IR/OS232 Settings  
Description  
Use this program to specify the baud rate of the system’s serial port, as well as indicate when an external  
modem is connected to the system.  
Options  
1101-01: Baud Rate  
(Baud Rate)  
Use this option to set the baud rate of the system’s RS232 port.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1 for 2400  
2 for 9600  
3 for19,200  
4 for 38,400  
5 for 57,600  
Default  
4  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
603  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
11xx-CPU  
110x-I/O  
1102-Modem Settings  
1102-Modem Settings  
Description  
TBD  
Options  
TBD  
604  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11xx-CPU  
110x-I/O  
1103-USB Settings  
1103-USB Settings  
Description  
TBD  
Options  
TBD  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
605  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11xx-CPU  
110x-I/O  
1104-Ethernet Setup  
1104-Ethernet Setup  
Description  
Use this program to set the DSX system’s IP address, subnet mask, and default gateway.  
Options  
1104-01: System IP Address  
(IP Addr)  
Use this option to set the DSX system’s IP address. You must set the IP address if you intend to connect to  
the system’s ethernet port. There are two ways to connect:  
To the site’s local area network (LAN) using a standard CAT5 patch cord.  
Directly from your PC to the DSX ethernet port using a standard CAT5 crossover cable.  
The IP address consists of four “octets” with three digits in each octet separated by a period. For example, a typ-  
ical router default IP address is 192.168.1.1. (Leading zeros are not required if the octet is less than three digits.)  
When connecting the DSX to the site’s local area network (LAN), the IP address you enter should be pro-  
vided to you by the site network administrator. It is essential that the address not duplicate that of any other  
device connected to the network.  
If you are connecting your PC to the system’s ethernet port using a standard crossover cable, the default IP  
address (192.168.1.250) should be adequate. Set your PC IP address to 192.168.1.249.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Digits using 0-9, 12 max. in the format xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx  
Default  
• 192.168.1.250  
1104-02: System Subnet Mask  
(Subnet)  
Use this option to set the DSX system’s subnet mask. The subnet mask distinguishes IP addresses of com-  
puters on your LAN from those outside your network (e.g., on the internet or a private WAN). Like the IP  
address, the subnet mask also consists of four 3-digit octets. The subnet mask uses the entry 255 to dene the  
masked octets and 0 to dene the unmasked octets.  
A typical entry of 255.255.255.0 means if two IP addresses have the same rst three octets, they are on the  
same network. For example, if:  
1. The IP addresses of the LAN begin with 192.168.1, and  
2. The subnet mask 255.255.255.0, then  
3. The network routers know that 192.168.1.250 and 192.168.1.1 are on the same network.  
Requests to these addresses are kept within the LAN (as opposed to being routed to the internet). When the  
rst three octets don’t match, the requests are routed out of the LAN.  
Features  
• None  
606  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
11xx-CPU  
110x-I/O  
1104-Ethernet Setup  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Digits using 0-9, 12 max. in the format xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx  
Default  
• 255.255.255.0  
1104-03: Default Gateway  
(Default Gateway)  
The gateway address is the address in the site router to which all outbound trafc is routed. The gateway  
address is required in order for DSX to communicate with computers not on your LAN (i.e., over the internet  
or a private WAN).  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Digits using 0-9, 12 max. in the format xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx  
Default  
• 255.255.255.0  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
607  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
11xx-CPU  
111x-Tones  
1111-DTMF Setup  
111x1-TDoTnMeFs Setup  
Description  
Use this program to set the DTMF durations for manual and Speed Dial calls.  
Options  
1111-01: Manual DTMF Tone On  
(Man DTMF On)  
Use this option to set the duration of DTMF digits for outside calls manually dialed by an extension user.  
This is required because the system buffers the digits the user dials. Set this timer for compatibility with the  
connected telco or PBX/Centrex.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
10-2550 mS  
Default  
150 mS  
1111-02: Manual DTMF Tone Off  
(Man DTMF Off)  
Use this option to set the duration of the interval between DTMF digits for outside calls manually dialed by  
an extension user. This is required because the system buffers the digits the user dials. Set this timer for com-  
patibility with the connected telco or PBX/Centrex.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
10-2550 mS  
Default  
100 mS  
1111-03: Speed Dial DTMF Tone On  
(SPD DTMF On)  
Use this option to set the duration of DTMF digits for Speed Dial outside calls automatically dialed by the  
system. Set this timer for compatibility with the connected telco or PBX/Centrex. If you set this interval too  
short, the telco or PBX/Centrex may not be able to properly detect the DTMF digit. If too long, outbound  
dialing is unnecessarily slowed down.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
10-2550 mS  
608  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
11xx-CPU  
111x-Tones  
1111-DTMF Setup  
Default  
100 mS  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
609  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11xx-CPU  
111x-Tones  
1111-DTMF Setup  
1111-04: Speed Dial DTMF Tone Off  
(SPD DTMF Off)  
Use this option to set the duration the quiet time between DTMF digits for Speed Dial outside calls automat-  
ically dialed by the system. Set this timer for compatibility with the connected telco or PBX/Centrex. If you  
set this interval too short, the telco or PBX/Centrex may not be able to set up to receive the next DTMF digit.  
If too long, outbound dialing is unnecessarily slowed down.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
10-2550 mS  
Default  
100 mS  
610  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
12xx-Slots  
120x-Stations  
1201-Type (Station Card Type)  
12xx-Slots  
120x1-STytapteio(nSstation Card Type)  
Description  
This program allows you to set the type for each station PCB plugged into your system.  
Options  
1201-01: Card Type  
(Card Type)  
Use this option to dene the type of station PCB plugged into each equipment cabinet PCB slot. Although  
PCBs auto-ID as you insert them, this option allows you to precongure a system prior to installation. You  
can also use this option to reorder PCBs after the initial installation is complete.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1 for 16ESIU  
2 for 16DSTU  
3 for 4SLIU  
4 for 8SLIU  
5 for 16SLIU  
6 for 2-port UltraMail  
7 for 4-port UltraMail  
8 for 6-port UltraMail  
9 for 8-port UltraMail  
Default  
• N/A  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
611  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
12xx-Slots  
120x-Stations  
1202-Ports (Primary Station Ports)  
1202-Ports (Primary Station Ports)  
Description  
Use this program to customize the system’s primary station port assignments.  
Options  
1202-01: Primary Station Port Assignment  
(xx Port xx Station)  
Use this option to associate physical (hardware) station ports with software station ports. If you installed  
your PCBs in order from left to right, and let Automatic Slot Conguration set up your system, your hard-  
ware and software ports should match.  
With the exception of Digital VANGARD voice mail, all station devices are single port.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-128 for station ports 1-128  
201-208 for voice mail ports 1-8 (xed assignment)  
301-304 for DSS Console ports 1-4 (xed assignment)  
• Undened  
Default  
• Physical and software station ports match.  
612  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
12xx-Slots  
120x-Stations  
1203-Secondary Station Ports  
1203-Secondary Station Ports  
Description  
Use this program to customize the system’s secondary station port assignments. This is only required when  
installing a Digital VANGARD voice mail.  
Options  
1203-01: Secondary Station Port Assignment  
(xx Port xx Station)  
Use this option to select a station port’s select port assignment. Currently, the secondary station port is only  
used for Digital VANGARD voice mail. Each digital voice mail port contains two ports: the primary port  
and the secondary port. The following table shows the typical primary and secondary station port assign-  
ments for an 8-port Digital VANGARD.  
NVM-Series Station Port Assignments  
Port 1  
Port 2  
Port 3  
Port 4  
201  
203  
205  
207  
Primary (1202)  
202  
204  
206  
208  
Secondary (1203)  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-128 for station ports 1-128  
201-208 for voice mail ports 1-8 (xed assignment)  
301-304 for DSS Console ports 1-4 (xed assignment)  
• Undened  
Default  
• Secondary station ports are not assigned.  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
613  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
12xx-Slots  
121x-Lines  
1211-Lines (Line Card Type)  
121x1-Lines (Line Card Type)  
Description  
This program allows you to set the type for each line PCB plugged into your system.  
Options  
1211-01: Card Type  
(Card Type)  
Use this option to dene the type of line PCB plugged into each equipment cabinet PCB slot. Although  
PCBs auto-ID as you insert them, this option allows you to precongure a system prior to installation. You  
can also use this option to reorder PCBs after the initial installation is complete.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1 for 4ATRU  
2 for 8ATRU  
3 for 16COIU  
4 for 24T1  
5 for 30E1  
Default  
• N/A  
614  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
12xx-Slots  
121x-Lines  
1212-Ports  
1212-Ports  
Description  
Use this program to customize the system’s line port assignments.  
Options  
1212-01: Line Port Assignment  
(xx Port xx Station)  
Use this option to associate physical (hardware) line ports with software line ports. If you installed your  
PCBs in order from left to right, and let Automatic Slot Conguration set up your system, your hardware and  
software ports should match.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-64 for line ports 1-64  
• Undened  
Default  
• Physical and software station ports match.  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
615  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
12xx-Slots  
121x-Lines  
1213-T1/E1 Card Setup  
1213-T1/E1 Card Setup  
Description  
Use this program to set up the parameters of the T1/E1 PCBs.  
Options  
1213-01: Number of PCM Channels  
(# PCM Channels)  
Use this option to determine the number of active channels on the PCB. PCBs congured for T1 have 24 avail-  
able channels, while E1 has 30. Enter the number of channels to be active, or enter 0 to activate all channels.  
If you are using all channels in the T1, leave this entry at 0. If you are connected to a fractional telco T1 cir-  
cuit (e.g., providing only 8 circuits), set this option to match the number of circuits in your fractional span.  
Additionally, you may have to limit the number of active channels if the system has a unique conguration  
that could exceed the 119 allowable timeslots.  
This option always selects the lowest channels. For example, an entry of 8 uses channels 1-8. When connecting  
to a DSU and splitting voice and data channels, the voice channels must be the lower-numbered channels.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 1-30  
0 for all channels  
Default  
0  
1213-02: Clock Control  
(Clock Control)  
Use this option to specify the clock source for the T1 PCB. The clock is required to synchronize the PCB’s  
operations. The PCB can be either the clock master (1) or the clock slave (2). As master, the T1 PCB uses its  
own internal clock as the clock source. As slave, the T1 PCB uses the connected T1 circuit from the telco as  
the clock source.  
When setting up Tie Lines, keep track of your clock sources. For example, if the local system is the clock  
master, the remote system should be set for slave so it uses the connected circuit as the clock source.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 1 for master  
2 for slave  
Default  
1  
616  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
12xx-Slots  
121x-Lines  
1213-T1/E1 Card Setup  
1213-03:Transmit Pulse Amplitude  
(Tx Pulse Ampl.)  
This option controls the amplitude (strength) of the T1 signals transmitted by the PCB to the telco smart jack  
or your CSU (if used).  
Entries 0-4 correspond to the distance from the T1 PCB to either the telco’s smart jack or your CSU (depend-  
ing on your installation). The T1 PCB automatically adjusts the signal amplitude based on your entry.  
You can alternately use entries 5-7 to make xed attenuation entries. If connected to a CSU, set your attenu-  
ation to match the requirements of the CSU. If your T1 PCB is connected directly to the telco’s smart jack,  
the telco will tell you if any attenuation is required.  
This option does not apply to E1 circuits.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1 for 0-133 feet (0 dB)  
2 for 133-266 feet  
3 for 266-399 feet  
4 for 399-533 feet  
5 for 533-655 feet  
6 for -7.5 dB  
7 for -15 dB  
8 for -22.5 dB  
Default  
1  
1213-04: Framer Type  
(ESF/CRC4)  
Use this option to set the Framer Type used by the PCB.  
If this option is enabled:  
T1 circuits use ESF (Extended Super Frame) mode. This is a 24-Frame mode which provides ABCD sig-  
naling bits and additional diagnostics).  
E1 circuits use CRC-4 16-Frame Multiframe mode.  
If this option is disabled:  
T1 circuits use D3/D4 (12-Frame Multiframe mode which supports AB signaling bits only).  
E1 circuits do not use CRC4 mode.  
Always set this option for compatibility with the connected telco. Normally, T1 circuits use ESF.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
617  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
12xx-Slots  
121x-Lines  
1213-T1/E1 Card Setup  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1213-05: Zero Suppression  
(B8ZS/HDB3)  
Use this option to enable or disable zero suppression for the PCB transmit path.  
If enabled, T1 PCBs use B8ZS zero suppression, while E1 PCBs use HDB3 zero suppression.  
If disabled, the PCB has no transmit zero suppression. (Note the receive zero suppression is always enabled.)  
Zero suppression may help prevent T1 PCB clocking problems, but should always be set for compatibility  
with the connected telco.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1213-06: Loopback Mode  
(Loopback Mode)  
Use this option to enable T1 PCB loopback. Although loopbacks are generally used for factory testing, you may  
nd Remote and Payload Loopback helpful for on-site troubleshooting. The available loopback entries are:  
None  
Loopback is not enabled.  
Metallic  
This option loops the T1 PCB internal analog output to the PCB internal analog input. The PCB external  
(telco side) connection is isolated during this test. Metallic Loopback is not normally used as a eld test.  
Digital  
This option loops the T1 PCB internal digital output through the PCB’s framer chip and then back to the  
PCB internal digital input. Digital Loopback is not normally used as a eld test.  
Remote  
This option loops any analog signal on the T1 PCB external (telco side) receive tip and ring to the exter-  
nal (telco side) transmit tip and ring. Remote Loopback may be useful for eld testing because it loops  
any analog test signal on the PCB receive tip and ring back to the transmit tip and ring.  
ST-Bus  
This option loops the T1 PCB internal digital output to the PCB internal digital input. It does not loop  
back through the framer chip. ST-Bus Loopback is not normally used as a eld test.  
Payload  
This option loops any digital signal on the T1 PCB external (telco side) receive tip and ring to the exter-  
nal (telco side) transmit tip and ring. Payload Loopback may be useful for eld testing because it loops  
any digital test signal on the PCB receive tip and ring back to the transmit tip and ring.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
618  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
12xx-Slots  
121x-Lines  
1213-T1/E1 Card Setup  
Options  
• 0 for none  
• 1 for metallic  
• 2 digital  
• 3 for remote  
• 4 for ST-Bus  
• 5 for payload  
Default  
0  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
619  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
13xx-Numbering  
130x-Dial Plan  
1301-Digits  
13xx-Numbering  
130x1-DiaglitPslan  
Description  
Use this option to customize the system’s number plan. For each dialed digit (0-9, excluding # and *), assign  
a Function Type and an Expected Digits entry. Function Type denes the digit’s function in the system (see  
the table below).  
Function Type  
Description  
1
2
3
Operator Access  
Extension Access  
Line Group Access  
Expected Digits sets how many digits the system expects to receive when the digit string begins with  
selected digit. For example, digit 3 has Function Type 2 and Expected Digits 3. This means that digits 300-  
399 are Intercom numbers.  
Options  
1301-[01-10]: Function Type  
(Fctn Type)  
For each dialed digit, use this option to assign the Function Type. This denes the digit’s function in the system.  
Features  
Options  
1 for Operator Access  
2 for Intercom and Direct Line Access  
3 for Line Group Access  
Default  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
1301-[01-10]: Expected Number of Digits  
(# of Digits)  
For each dialed digit, use this option to set how many digits the system expects to receive when the digit  
string begins this digit.  
Features  
620  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
13xx-Numbering  
130x-Dial Plan  
1301-Digits  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-3  
Default  
Default Dialing Plan  
Description  
Digit  
0
Function Type  
Expected Digits  
3
Use this option to dene the Function Type and  
Expected Digits for dial strings beginning with 0.  
These strings are normally used for telephone sys-  
tem operator access (1).  
1 (Operator  
Access)  
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
Use this option to dene the Function Type and  
Expected Digits for dial strings beginning with 1.  
These strings are normally reserved for Intercom  
access (2).  
2 (Extension  
Access)  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Use this option to dene the Function Type and  
Expected Digits for dial strings beginning with 2.  
These strings are normally reserved for Intercom  
access (2).  
2 (Extension  
Access)  
Use this option to dene the Function Type and  
Expected Digits for dial strings beginning with 3.  
These strings are by default assigned to Intercom  
access (2).  
2 (Extension  
Access)  
Use this option to dene the Function Type and  
Expected Digits for dial strings beginning with 4.  
These strings are by default assigned to Direct  
Line Access (2).  
2 (Extension  
Access)  
Use this option to dene the Function Type and  
Expected Digits for dial strings beginning with 5.  
These strings are normally reserved for Intercom  
access (2).  
2 (Extension  
Access)  
Use this option to dene the Function Type and  
Expected Digits for dial strings beginning with 6.  
These strings are normally reserved for Intercom  
access (2).  
2 (Extension  
Access)  
Use this option to dene the Function Type and  
Expected Digits for dial strings beginning with 7.  
These strings are normally reserved for Intercom  
access (2).  
2 (Extension  
Access)  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
621  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
13xx-Numbering  
130x-Dial Plan  
1301-Digits  
Default Dialing Plan  
Description  
Digit  
8
Function Type  
Expected Digits  
3
Use this option to dene the Function Type and  
Expected Digits for dial strings beginning with 8.  
These strings are normally reserved for Intercom  
access (2).  
2 (Extension  
Access)  
9
9
1
Use this option to dene the total length of dial  
strings beginning with 9. These strings are nor-  
mally 1 digit long for dial-9 line access.  
3 (Line Group  
Access)  
LN GRP  
1 = OPER  
2 = EXT  
Use this option to dene the Function Type and  
Expected Digits for dial strings beginning with 9.  
These strings are normally reserved to line access  
(3).  
3 (LN GRP)  
3 = LN GRP  
622  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
13xx-Numbering  
131x-Extensions  
1311-Stations  
131x1-ESxtatetinosnisons  
Description  
Use this program to customize extension numbering.  
Options  
1311-01: Station Extension Number  
(Extension #)  
Use this option to assign an extension number to each station.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
0-999 for extension numbers 0-999  
Default  
300-427 for extensions 300-347  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
623  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
13xx-Numbering  
131x-Extensions  
1312-Voice Mail Ports  
1312-Voice Mail Ports  
Description  
Use this program to customize voice mail extension numbering.  
Options  
1312-01:Voice Mail Extension Number  
(Extension #)  
Use this option to assign an extension number to each voice mail station.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0-999 for extension numbers 0-999  
Default  
500-507 for extensions 500-507  
624  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
13xx-Numbering  
131x-Extensions  
1313-Lines  
1313-Lines  
Description  
Use this program to customize line extension numbers.  
Options  
1313-01: Line Extension Number  
(Extension #)  
Use this option to assign an extension number to each line.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0-999 for line extension numbers 0-999  
Default  
101-164 for lines 1-64  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
625  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
13xx-Numbering  
131x-Extensions  
1314-Ring Groups  
1314-Ring Groups  
Description  
Use this program to customize Ring Group master extension numbers.  
Options  
1314-01: Ring Group Master Extension Number  
(Extension #)  
Use this option to assign a master extension number to each Ring Group. Although the master numbers are  
preassigned by default, you can customize them to meet the site requirements. The extension numbers you  
use must be unique and cannot be a physical port (e.g., 300).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Extension number (0-999)  
Default  
600 for Group 1  
601 for Group 2  
602 for Group 3  
603 for Group 4  
604 for Group 5  
605 for Group 6  
606 for Group 7  
607 for Group 8  
626  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
13xx-Numbering  
131x-Extensions  
1315-UCD Groups  
1315-UCD Groups  
Description  
Use this program to customize UCD Group master extension numbers.  
Options  
1315-01: UCD Group Master Extension Number  
(Extension #)  
Use this option to assign a master extension number to each UCD Group. Although the master numbers are  
preassigned by default, you can customize them to meet the site requirements. The extension numbers you  
use must be unique and cannot be a physical port (e.g., 300).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Extension number (0-999)  
Default  
700 for Group 1  
701 for Group 2  
702 for Group 3  
703 for Group 4  
704 for Group 5  
705 for Group 6  
706 for Group 7  
707 for Group 8  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
627  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1401-Features  
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x1-SFetaattiuornes  
Description  
Use this program to customize station (extension) Class of Service options.  
Options  
1401-01: System Speed Dial Access  
(System SPD)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to access System Speed Dial.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1401-02: Extended Ring  
(Extended Ring)  
Use this option to enable or disable Extended Ring at the extension.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1401-03: Privacy  
(Privacy)  
Use this option to enable or disable Privacy in an extension’s Class of Service. Privacy blocks Barge In  
attempts and incoming Camp-On / Call Waiting signals.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
628  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1401-Features  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1401-04: ACD Supervisor  
(ACD Sprvsr)  
This option is not used.  
1401-05: Soft Keys  
(Soft Keys)  
Use this option to enable or disable a keyset’s Interactive Soft Keys.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1401-06: Conversation Record  
(Record Conv)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to record conversations into their mailbox. If  
enabled, the user can press either their Conversation Record key or RECORD soft key to initiate recording.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1401-07: DND Override  
(DND Override)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to use DND Override. If enabled, an extension user  
can dial 1 or press their DND Override soft key to override an extension’s Do Not Disturb. If disabled, an exten-  
sion cannot dial 1 to override an extension’s DND and the DND Override soft key is unavailable. (This option  
does not apply when an extension user presses their Hotline key, since Hotline keys always provide the DND  
Override option.)  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
629  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1401-Features  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1401-08: Receive DID Calls  
(Allow DID Calls)  
Use this option to enable or disable the extension’s ability to receive DID calls. If enabled, the extension will  
receive DID calls routed to it by the system. If disabled, the extension will not receive DID calls. If a DID  
call attempts to route to an extension with this option disabled, the call follows Line Overow.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enable  
630  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1401-Features  
1401-09: Receive DID Camp-On  
(DID Camp-On)  
Use this option to enable or disable the ability of a DID call to Camp-On to the extension when it is busy. If  
enabled, a DID call to the extension will Camp-On for the 1601-02: DIL No Answer Timer. If still unan-  
swered, the call will divert to Key Ring. If disabled, the incoming call will not Camp-On and the caller will  
hear busy tone.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1401-10: Name Programming  
(Name Pgming)  
Use this option to enable or disable name programming at an extension. If enabled, the extension user can  
access name programming via their soft keys. If disabled, name programming is not allowed.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) for COS 1  
No (0) for COS 2-15  
1401-11: Language Programming  
(Lang Pgming)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to set their display language. If enabled, the extension  
user can access language programming via their soft keys. If disabled, language programming is not allowed.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) for COS 1  
No (0) for COS 2-15  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
631  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1401-Features  
1401-12: Call Screening  
(Call Screening)  
Use this option to enable or disable Call Screening. If enabled, a display keyset use can listen to (screen) a voice  
mail message as it is being left in their mailbox. If disabled, voice mail messages go to the mailbox normally.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1401-13: Hotline Automatic Transfer  
(Hotline Auto Transfer)  
Use this option to enable or disable Hotline Automatic Transfer for the extension. If enabled, an extension  
user busy on a call can just press their Hotline key and hang up to Transfer. If disabled, the extension user  
must press TRANSFER before their Hotline key.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
632  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1402-Access  
1402-Access  
Description  
Use this program to customize station access Class of Service options.  
Options  
1402-01: Forced Line Disconnect  
(Forced Disconnect)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to use Forced Line Disconnect.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) for COS 1  
No (0) for COS 2-15  
1402-02: Barge In (Intrusion)  
(Barge-In)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to Barge In on a co-worker.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes for COS 1  
No for COS 2-15  
1402-03: Camp-On to Busy Extension  
(Camp-On Busy Ext)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to Camp-On to a busy co-worker. Disable this option  
to prevent the extension from Camping-On to the busy co-worker. This option does not restrict Callback.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
633  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1402-Access  
Default  
Yes  
1402-04: Silent Monitor  
(Silent Monitor)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to use Silent Monitor.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1402-05: Activate Night Mode  
(Night Mode)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to activate Night Service.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1)for COS 1  
No (0) for COS 2-15  
1402-06: Direct Line Access  
(Direct Line Access)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to use Direct Line Access. Note that enabling  
Direct Line Access allows the user to bypass Toll Restriction.Option.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled for COS 1  
No (0) - Disabled for COS 2-15  
634  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1403-SLT’s (Single Line Telephone Options)  
1403-SLT’s (Single Line Telephone Options)  
Description  
Use this program to customize single line telephone Class of Service options.  
Options  
1403-01: Flash for Single Line Set  
(Flash for SLT)  
Use this option to enable or disable hookash for analog single line extensions.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1403-02: Single Ring for Single Line Set  
(Single Ring)  
Use this option to determine the type of ringing at analog single line extensions. If enabled, analog single  
line extensions always receive single ringing for outside calls. (Certain analog single line devices connected  
to the system may require this type of ringing.) If disabled, line ringing at analog single line extensions fol-  
lows the ringing pattern of the line. For example, if a line is ringing the system with two ring bursts, the sin-  
gle line extensions will follow the same ringing pattern.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1403-03: Special Dial Tone for Single Line Set  
(Special Dial Tone)  
Use this option to enable or disable single line telephone Special Dial Tone. Note that this option has no  
effect of keyset ports with the same Class of Service.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
635  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1403-SLT’s (Single Line Telephone Options)  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1403-04: High Voltage Message Waiting Lamp for Single Line Set  
(HV MW Lamp)  
Use this option to enable or disable High Voltage Message Waiting for single line ports. High Voltage Mes-  
sage Waiting is not available in DSX-40. If both this option and 1403-05: FSK Message Waiting Lamp for  
Single Line Set are enabled, the system uses FSK Message Waiting.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1403-05: FSK Message Waiting Lamp for Single Line Set  
(FSK MW Lamp)  
Use this option to enable or disable FSK Message Waiting for single line ports. If both this option and 1403-04:  
High Voltage Message Waiting Lamp for Single Line Set are enabled, the system uses FSK Message Waiting.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1403-06: Loop Disconnect for Single Line Set  
(Loop Disconnect)  
Use this option to enable or disable the ability of the system to send a loop supervision disconnect signal  
(i.e., drop pulse) to single line ports. Set this option for compatibility with the connected SLT device. (This  
option is always disabled for Voice Mail ports.)  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
636  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1403-SLT’s (Single Line Telephone Options)  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
637  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1404-Caller ID  
1404-Caller ID  
Description  
Use this program to customize Caller ID Class of Service options.  
Options  
1404-01: Caller ID Display  
(CID Display)  
Use this option to enable or disable the ability of an extension to display Caller ID. If enabled, Caller ID will  
occur for all extensions with this Class of Service provided Caller ID is enabled in other system program-  
ming. If disabled, Caller ID will never occur for extensions with this Class of Service.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1404-02: Second Call Caller ID  
(2nd Call CID)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to display Second Call Caller ID. If enabled, Sec-  
ond Call Caller ID will occur for all extensions with this Class of Service provided Second Call Caller ID is  
enabled in other system programming. If disabled, Second Call Caller ID will never occur for extensions  
with this Class of Service.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1404-03:Third Party Caller ID  
(3rd Party CID)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to use Third Party Call Caller ID Check. If  
enabled, Third Party Caller ID Check is available to all extensions with this Class of Service provided Caller  
ID is enabled in other system programming. If disabled, Third party Caller ID check is unavailable to exten-  
sions with this Class of Service.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
638  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1404-Caller ID  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1404-04: Caller ID Display Separator  
(CID Display “-”)  
Use this option to enable or disable the Caller ID display separator. If enabled, the telephone displays a dash  
separator after the area code and after the local exchange on a 7 or 10 digit number. If disabled, the calling  
party number displays without a separator.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1404-05: Outgoing ANI Privacy  
(OTG ANI Privacy)  
Use this option to enable or disable the extension’s ability to send outbound Automatic Number Identica-  
tion (ANI) over E1 lines using MFC dialing. This option only applies to outbound E1 calls using MFC  
dialing, and does not apply to systems installed in North America.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1404-06: Caller ID Alert Lamp  
(CID Alert Lamps)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s Ring/Message Lamp for Caller ID. If enabled, the lamp will  
ash whenever the extension receives new Caller ID logs. If disabled, the lamp will not ash for Caller ID.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
639  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1404-Caller ID  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
640  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1405-Distinctive Ringing  
1405-Distinctive Ringing  
Description  
Use this program to customize Distinctive Ringing Class of Service options.  
Options  
1405-01: Ring Type Conguration  
(Ring Cong)  
If enabled, this option allows an extension to customize the sound of their Ring Types by pressing the CON-  
FIG (CNFG) soft key. If disabled, the extension cannot customize their Ring Types and the system hides the  
CONFIG (CNFG) soft key.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1405-02: Station Ring Override  
(Sta Ring Override)  
If enabled, this option allows an extension to customize the distinctive ringing for Day Ring, Night Ring,  
and Delay Ring outside calls on line keys by pressing the ASSIGN (ASGN) soft key. If disabled, the exten-  
sion user cannot customize the distinctive ringing and the system hides the ASSIGN (ASGN) soft key. If you  
enable this option, and the user customizes their Extension Override settings, disabling this option will can-  
cel the user’s custom settings.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1405-03: Key Ring Override  
(Key Ring Override)  
If enabled, this option allows an extension to customize the distinctive ringing of individual Call Coverage,  
Group Call Pickup, and line keys by pressing the KEY soft key. If disabled, the extension cannot customize  
the distinctive ringing. If you enable this option, and the user customizes their Key Ring Override settings,  
disabling this option will cancel the user’s custom settings.  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
641  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1405-Distinctive Ringing  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
642  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1406-Call Forwarding Options  
1406-Call Forwarding Options  
Description  
Use this program to customize Call Forwarding Class of Service options.  
Options  
1406-01: Call Forwarding Off-Premises  
(Off-Premise)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to use Off Premise Call Forwarding. When dis-  
abled, the Off Premise Call Forwarding option is hidden on the telephone display.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1406-02: Internal Call Forwarding  
(Internal)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to use Call Forwarding. If an extension cannot use  
Call Forwarding, they cannot also use Off Premise Call Forwarding.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
643  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1407-Paging  
1407-Paging  
Description  
Use this program to customize paging Class of Service options.  
Options  
1407-01: Make All Call Page  
(All Call Page)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to make an All Call Paging announcement.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1407-02: Make Page Into Zone 1  
(Page Zone 1)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to make a Paging announcement into zone 1.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1407-03: Make Page Into Zone 2  
(Page Zone 2)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to make a Paging announcement into zone 2.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
644  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1407-Paging  
1407-04: Make Page Into Zone 3  
(Page Zone 3)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to make a Paging announcement into zone 3.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1407-05: Make Page Into Zone 4  
(Page Zone 4)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to make a Paging announcement into zone 4.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1407-06: Make Page Into Zone 5  
(Page Zone 5)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to make a Paging announcement into zone 5.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1407-07: Make Page Into Zone 6  
(Page Zone 6)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to make a Paging announcement into zone 6.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
645  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1407-Paging  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1407-08: Make Page Into Zone 7  
(Page Zone 7)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to make a Paging announcement into zone 7.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
646  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
141x-Line  
1411-Access  
141x1-LAicnceess  
Description  
Use this program to customize line access Class of Service options.  
Options  
1411-01: Camp-On to Busy Lines  
(Camp-On Busy Lines)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to Camp-On to a busy line. This option does not  
restrict Callback.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) for COS 1  
No (0) for CIS 2-15  
1411-02: Line Queue Priority  
(Line Que Priority)  
Use this option to enable or disable Line Queuing Priority at the extension. If more than one extension with pri-  
ority is queued on a busy line, the system services the priority extensions on a rst-queued, rst-served basis.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1411-03: Automatic Hold  
(Auto-Hold)  
Use this option to enable or disable Automatic Hold at the extension.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
647  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
141x-Line  
1411-Access  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1411-04: Enhanced Last Number Redial  
(Enhanced LND)  
Use this option to enable or disable Enhanced Last Number Redial for the extension. If enabled, the extension  
has Enhanced Last Number Redial with the 5 number redial buffer and the enhanced operation. If disabled, the  
extension has traditional Last Number Redial with a single number redial buffer and the standard operation.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1411-05: Unsupervised Conference  
(Unsuprvsd Conf)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to use Unsupervised Conference.  
Also enable this option to use Line-to-Line Transfer to set up a tandem call. See Using Line-to-Line Transfer  
This option ensures that enabling 3103-04: Tandem Calls (page 816) for Off Premise Call Forwarding does  
also not inadvertently enable Unsupervised Conference.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
648  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
141x-Line  
1412-Toll Restriction  
1412-Toll Restriction  
Description  
Use this program to customize Class of Service options that affect call restriction.  
Options  
1412-01:Walking Class of Service (Day)  
(Walking COS Day)  
Use this option to enable or disable Walking Class of Service for the extension while the system is in the day  
mode. This option affects the extension implementing this feature, not the extension at which the feature is  
being used. For example, if the extension 301 user goes to extension 305 and tries to use Walking Class of  
Service during the day, this option must be enabled for extension 301.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1412-02:Walking Class of Service (Night)  
(Walking COS Night)  
Use this option to enable or disable Walking Class of Service for the extension while the system is in the  
night mode. This option affects the extension implementing this feature, not the extension at which the fea-  
ture is being used. For example, if the extension 301 user goes to extension 305 and tries to use Walking  
Class of Service at night, this option must be enabled for extension 301.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1412-03: Station Locking  
(Station Locking)  
Use this option to enable or disable the extension’s ability to use Extension Locking.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
649  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
141x-Line  
1412-Toll Restriction  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
650  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
141x-Line  
1412-Toll Restriction  
1412-04: Forced Account Codes  
(Forced A/C)  
Use this option to enable or disable Forced Account Codes. If disabled, Optional Account Codes are still  
available.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1412-05:Veried Account Codes  
(Veried A/C)  
Use this option to enable or disable Veried Account Codes. If enabled, the system compares the Account  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1412-06: Account Codes for Toll Calls Only  
(A/C Toll Only)  
Use this option to enable Forced Account Codes only for toll (long distance) calls. If disabled, Forced  
Account Codes apply to all outgoing outside calls.  
has no effect.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
651  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
15xx-Options  
150x-Operators  
1501-Setup  
15xx-Options  
150x1-OSepteurpators  
Description  
Use this program to specify the number of system operators.  
Options  
1501-01: Number of Operators  
(# of Operators)  
Use this option to specify the number of operators in the system (1-4).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-4  
0 (no operators)  
Default  
0  
652  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
15xx-Options  
150x-Operators  
1502-Assignments  
1502-Assignments  
Description  
Use this program to assign the system’s operator extensions. If you enabled more than one operator in 1501-  
01: Number of Operators (page 652), all four of the following options are available. However, only the num-  
ber you specied in 1501-01: Number of Operators will function.  
Options  
1502-01: Operator Number 1  
(Operator 1)  
Assign the rst operator’s extension number. Be sure you have entered the correct number of operators in  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• Extension number  
None (Entered by pressing CLEAR)  
Default  
300  
1502-02: Operator Number 2  
(Operator 2)  
Assign the second operator’s extension number. Be sure you have entered the correct number of operators in  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• Extension number  
None (Entered by pressing CLEAR)  
Default  
None  
1502-03: Operator Number 3  
(Operator 3)  
Assign the third operator’s extension number. Be sure you have entered the correct number of operators in  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• Extension number  
None (Entered by pressing CLEAR)  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
653  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
15xx-Options  
150x-Operators  
1502-Assignments  
Default  
None  
1502-04: Operator Number 4  
(Operator 4)  
Assign the fourth operator’s extension number. Be sure you have entered the correct number of operators in  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• Extension number  
None (Entered by pressing CLEAR)  
Default  
None  
654  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
15xx-Options  
151x-Stations  
1511-Display  
151x1-SDtiastpiolanys  
Description  
Use this program to select the extension name entry format and clock display.  
Options  
1511-01: Name Format  
(Name Format)  
Use this option to determine how extension names should be entered in 2101-02: Station Name (page 720)  
or via the telephone. The options are 1 (rst-last) and 2 (last-rst).  
If you enter 1 (rst-last), the system assumes that all names are entered in the following format:  
M
A
R
Y
J
O
N
E
S
First  
Last  
Comma delimiter is only avail-  
able with the PC Program.  
Delimiter  
(space or comma)  
If you enter 2 (last-rst), the system assumes that all names are entered in the following format:  
J
O
N
E
S
M
A
R
Y
Last  
First  
Comma delimiter is only avail-  
able with the PC Program.  
Delimiter  
(space or comma)  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1 for rst-last  
2 for last-rst  
Default  
1  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
655  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
15xx-Options  
151x-Stations  
1511-Display  
1511-02: Clock Display Format  
(Clock Display Format)  
Use this option to change the format of a keyset’s Time and Date display. See the chart below for available  
entries. After changing the entry for this option, an extension user must either lift and replace the handset or  
receive an incoming call before their display will show the new format.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Clock Display Format Options  
(Using Tuesday, 3/28/2006, 4:44PM as an Example)  
Option  
Display Format  
1 (Default)  
Tue March 28  
4:44 PM  
Tue March 28  
16:44  
2
3
4
4:44 PM  
Tue March 28  
16:44  
Tue March 28  
Default  
1  
656  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
15xx-Options  
151x-Stations  
1512-Calls  
1512-Calls  
Description  
Use this program to set up the call handling Auto Handsfree and Call Waiting tones options.  
Options  
1512-01: Automatic Handsfree  
(Auto-Handsfree)  
Use this option to enable or disable Automatic Handsfree system-wide.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1512-02: Call Waiting Tones  
(Call Waiting Tones)  
Use this option to enable or disable Camp-On tones system-wide. If disabled, an extension user will not hear  
Camp-On tones if a co-worker camps-on to their extension or leaves them a Callback.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
657  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
15xx-Options  
151x-Stations  
1513-Intercom  
1513-Intercom  
Description  
Use this program to enable or disable Intercom voice announcements and Auto Handsfree system-wide.  
Options  
1513-01: Intercom Voice Announcements  
(Voice Announce)  
Use this option to enable or disable system-wide voice-announced Intercom calls. You must enable this  
option if you have 1513-02: Handsfree Reply (Handsfree Answerback) enabled below. If you disable this  
option, extension users can only receive ringing Intercom calls.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1513-02: Handsfree Reply (Handsfree Answerback)  
(HF Reply)  
Use this option to enable or disable system-wide Handsfree Reply for voice-announced Intercom calls. If  
you enable this option, you must also enable 1513-02: Handsfree Reply (Handsfree Answerback) above.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
658  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
15xx-Options  
152x-MOH/BGM  
1521-Setup  
152x1-MSeOtuHp/BGM  
Description  
Use this program to set up options for Music on Hold and Background Music.  
Options  
1521-01: Enable Music on Hold  
(Enable MOH)  
Use this option to enable or disable Music on Hold system wide.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1521-02: Music on Hold for Transferred Calls  
(MOH on Transfer)  
Use this option to enable or disable MOH for transferred calls system-wide. If enabled, transferred callers  
hear Music on Hold while waiting. If disabled, transferred callers hear ringback.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1521-03: Background Music Source  
(BGM Source)  
Use this option to specify the system’s Background Music source (none, audio input 1, or audio input 2).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for audio input 1  
2 for audio input 2  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
659  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
15xx-Options  
152x-MOH/BGM  
1521-Setup  
Default  
0  
1521-04: Background Music over External Page  
(BGM Over Page)  
Enable this option to have Background Music (if installed) play over the system's External Page. Disable this  
option if you don't want Background Music to play over the system's External Page.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
N (6) - No  
Y (9) - Yes  
Default  
N (6) - No  
660  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
15xx-Options  
152x-MOH/BGM  
1521-Setup  
1521-05: Audio Input 1 Gain Setting  
(Audio #1 Gain)  
Use this option to set the gain (volume) of Audio Input 1.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
01-25 (-12 dB to +12 dB in 1 dB steps)  
Default  
13 (0 dB)  
1521-06: Audio Input 2 Gain Setting  
(Audio #2 Gain)  
Use this option to set the gain (volume) of Audio Input 2.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
01-25 (-12 dB to +12 dB in 1 dB steps)  
Default  
13 (0 dB)  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
661  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
15xx-Options  
153x-Paging  
1531-Setup  
153x1-PSaegtuinpg  
Description  
Use this program to set up External Paging.  
Options  
1531-01: External Page Ring Type  
(Page Ring Type)  
Use this option to indicate the type of ringing that will broadcast over the External Page (none, station, or line).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for station  
2 for line  
Default  
0  
1531-02: Extension Ring Over External Page  
(Page Ring Extension)  
If 1531-01: External Page Ring Type is 1 (station), use this option to enter the number of the extension that  
should ring over the External Page.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Extension number (0-999)  
Default  
• No entry  
662  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
15xx-Options  
153x-Paging  
1531-Setup  
1531-03: External Page Ring Volume  
(Page Ring Volume)  
Use this option to adjust the volume of ringing over the External Paging system. This option does not affect  
the volume of Background Music, Door Chime, or External Page voice broadcasts. You can additionally  
control the volume of audio broadcasting from the External Page port in 1531-05: External Page Gain.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1 for low  
2 for medium  
3 for high  
Default  
2  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
663  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
15xx-Options  
153x-Paging  
1531-Setup  
1531-04: Door Chime Over External Page  
(Page DoorChime)  
Use this option to enable Door Chimes over External Page.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1531-05: External Page Gain  
(External Page Gain)  
Use this option to control the volume of any audio broadcasting from the External Page output. This includes  
Page broadcasts, Door Chimes, and ringing. Note that if you increase the External Page ring volume in  
1531-05: External Page Gain, you can additionally increase or decrease the volume of the Page output in  
this option.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
01-25 (-12 dB to +12 dB in 1 dB steps)  
Default  
13 (0 dB)  
664  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
15xx-Options  
153x-Paging  
1532-Ring Control  
1532-Ring Control  
Description  
If External Paging is set up to broadcast line ringing, use this program to specify the ringing type for each line.  
Options  
1532-[01-64]: External Page Line Ringing  
(Line nn Ring)  
If 1531-01: External Page Ring Type is 2 (line), use this option to individually set the ringing for each line  
over the External Page.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options for each line (1-64)  
Extension number (0-999)  
0 for no ringing  
1 for day and night ringing  
2 for night ringing only  
3 for delay ringing day and night  
Default  
• No entry  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
665  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
15xx-Options  
154x-SMDR (Station Message Detail Recording)  
1541-Setup  
154x1-SMetDupR (Station Message Detail Recording)  
Description  
Use this program to set up the SMDR options.  
Options  
1541-01: SMDR Port  
(SMDR Port)  
Use this option to specify the port the system uses for SMDR.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for RS232 port  
Default  
0  
1541-02: Print SMDR Headers  
(SMDR Headers)  
Use this option to enable or disable the header from the SMDR report. In enabled, the header will print at the  
beginning of the SMDR report and at the top of each page.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
1541-03: SMDR Language  
(SMDR Language)  
Use this option to set the language of the SMDR header and the data in the SMDR Call Type (T) eld.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1 for English  
2 for Spanish  
Default  
1  
666  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
15xx-Options  
155x-Account Codes  
1551-Setup  
155x1-ASectcount Codes  
u
p
Description  
Use this program to customize system-wide Account Code options.  
Options  
1551-01: Dial # to Enter Account Codes  
(# Key AC Codes)  
Use this option to enable an extension user to dial # to enter an Account Code while on an outside call. If dis-  
abled, the extension user can only enter an Account Code by pressing the Account Code soft key or a  
uniquely programmed Account Code Programmable Function Key.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1551-02: Allow Account Codes in Speed Dial Bins  
(Ac Codes in SPD)  
Enable this option if the user should be able to store Account Codes in Speed Dial bins. This causes the  
stored Account Code to properly display in the SMDR report Account column. If you disable this option,  
Account Codes stored in Speed Dial bins dial out as part of the stored number and display in the SMDR  
report Number Dialed column. They will not display in the Account column.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1551-03: Show Account Codes on Telephone Display  
(Show AC Codes)  
Use this option to show or hide user-entered Account Codes on their telephone’s display. If enabled, the  
dialed Account Codes show on the display. This may be a security risk, since a co-worker can easily read  
the telephone display as the user enters their Account Code. If disabled, Account Codes are shown as *  
characters on the telephone display. This option is disabled by default.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
667  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
15xx-Options  
155x-Account Codes  
1551-Setup  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
1551-04: Account Code Toll Restriction Level  
(AC Toll Level)  
from local calls for Account Code purposes. If you enter 0 for this option, toll calls are any calls the user  
dials that begin with 0 or 1. If you enter a toll level for this option (1-7), the system uses the toll level options  
programmed in 35xx-Toll Restriction (page 839) for that level to determine if the call is local or toll.  
If the toll level is set to deny the call, it is considered to be a long distance call and the system requires  
that the user must have entered an Account Code.  
If the toll level permits the call, it is considered to be a local call and no Account Code entry is required.  
Note that additional dialing restrictions enforced by an extension’s toll level are in effect and may also  
restrict dialing.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0-7  
Default  
0  
668  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
16xx-Timers  
160x-Feature Timers  
1601-Incoming Call Timers  
16xx-Timers  
160x1-FIn otumrienTgimCaelrlsTimers  
eca  
Description  
Use this program to adjust timers that affect incoming calls.  
Options  
1601-01: Line No Answer Timer  
(Ring No Answer)  
Use this option to set how long Hold Recall rings the extension that placed the call on hold before Key Ring  
occurs. Key Ring rings all extensions programmed to ring for that line.  
This timer also sets how long a DIL to a Ring Group master number rings an idle extension before Key Ring  
or overow occurs. Key Ring rings all extensions programmed to ring for that line.  
In addition, this timer sets how long a Transfer Recall rings the extension that initially transferred the call  
before Key Ring occurs.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
15 seconds  
1601-02: DIL No Answer Timer  
(DIL Ring No Answer)  
Use this option to set how long a DIL to an extension rings an idle extension before Key Ring or overow  
occurs. This option also sets how long a call rings the overow destination before diverting to Key Ring. Key  
Ring rings all extensions programmed to ring for that line.  
This timer also sets the interval after which DID Line Overow and DID Station Intercept occur.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
669  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
16xx-Timers  
160x-Feature Timers  
1601-Incoming Call Timers  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
15 seconds  
1601-03: Call Forward No Answer Timer  
(CFWD No Answer)  
For Call Forwarding Ring No Answer, use this option set how long a forwarded call rings an unanswered  
extension before routing to the forwarding destination.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
10 seconds  
1601-04: UCD No Answer Timer  
(UCD Overow)  
Use this option to set when UCD overow occurs. When all UCD agents are busy, a queued call rings for  
this interval and then overows to the UCD Overow destination.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
60 seconds  
670  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
16xx-Timers  
160x-Feature Timers  
1602-Outgoing Call Timers  
1602-Outgoing Call Timers  
Description  
Use this program to adjust timers that affect outgoing calls.  
Options  
1602-01: Interdigit Timer  
(Interdigit Time)  
Use this option to set the Intercom interdigit time. When an extension user places a call, they must dial each  
succeeding digit within this interval.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
Default  
6 seconds  
1602-02: Line Response Timer  
(Line Response)  
When the system sends a line seize message to the ATRU/COIU PCB, it waits this interval for a response  
from the line PCB. If the system gets no response within this interval, it marks the line as defective. Be sure  
the value you enter is compatible with the local telco. If you set this value too short, the system may mark  
properly functioning lines as defective. If too long, defective lines may be left in service.  
Features  
• N/A  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 in 100 mS intervals (e.g., 10 = 1 second, 100 = 10 seconds).  
Default  
100 (10 seconds)  
1602-03: Dialtone Detect Timer  
(Dialtone Detect)  
When the system seizes a line to place a Speed Dial call, it waits this interval for dial tone before outdialing  
the call. The system requires that the rst dial tone be at least 5 seconds long and the second dial tone to be  
at least 2.5 seconds long. Be sure the value you enter is compatible with the local telco. If you set this value  
too short, the system may not seize properly functioning lines. If too long, there will be too long a delay  
before the system skips over a defective line.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
671  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
16xx-Timers  
160x-Feature Timers  
1602-Outgoing Call Timers  
Options  
1-9999 in 100 mS increments (e.g., 10 = 1 second, 100 = 10 seconds).  
Default  
20 (2 seconds)  
672  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
16xx-Timers  
160x-Feature Timers  
1602-Outgoing Call Timers  
1602-04: Dial Pause Timer  
(Interdigit Time)  
Use this option to set the length of a pause stored in a Speed Dial bin.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
1 second  
1602-05: CO Busy Out Timer  
(CO Busy Out)  
Use this option to set the guard time for lines. When the system disconnects a line (e.g., after a user hang  
up), the system keeps the line idle until this timer expires. The CO Busy Out timer helps prevent call colli-  
sions. If you set this interval too short, call collisions may occur. If too long, there will be unnecessary delays  
before you can use the line for a new call.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
10-9999 mS  
Default  
10 mS  
1602-06: Repeat Redial Timer  
(Repeat Dial)  
Use this option to set the interval between Auto Redial callout attempts.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-99 seconds  
Default  
30  
1602-07: Repeat Redial Busy Timer  
(Repeat Busy)  
Use this option to set how long the system waits for busy tone when processing an Auto Redial callout  
attempt. The interval is measured from the last digit dialed to the receipt of busy tone. If the system doesn’t  
receive busy tone within this interval, it assumes that the call went through and cancels Auto Redial.  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
673  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
16xx-Timers  
160x-Feature Timers  
1602-Outgoing Call Timers  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-99 seconds  
Default  
6  
674  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
16xx-Timers  
160x-Feature Timers  
1603-Recall Timers  
1603-Recall Timers  
Description  
Use this program to adjust timers that affect system recalls.  
Options  
1603-01:Transfer Recall Timer  
(Transfer Recall)  
Use this timer to set how long a transferred call rings an idle destination extension or Ring Group before recall-  
ing the extension from which it was initially transferred. In addition, use this timer to set how long a transferred  
call rings a busy operator extension before recalling the extension from which it was initially transferred.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
1 second  
1603-02: Hold Recall Timer  
(Hold recall)  
Use this option to set how long a call stays on Hold before it recalls the extension that initially placed it on Hold.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
60 seconds  
1603-03: Exclusive Hold Recall Timer  
(X-Hold Recall)  
Use this option to set how long a call stays on Exclusive Hold before it recalls the extension that initially  
placed it on Exclusive Hold.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
675  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
16xx-Timers  
160x-Feature Timers  
1603-Recall Timers  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
90 seconds  
676  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
16xx-Timers  
160x-Feature Timers  
1603-Recall Timers  
1603-04: Park Orbit Recall Timer  
(Orbit Recall)  
Use this option to set how long a call stays in System Park Orbit before it recalls the extension that parked it.  
This timer if for orbits 60-67 only. The recall for orbits 68 and 69 is xed at 5 minutes.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
20 seconds  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
677  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
16xx-Timers  
160x-Feature Timers  
1604-Station Timers  
1604-Station Timers  
Description  
Use this program to adjust timers that affect stations.  
Options  
1604-01: Delay Ring Timer  
(Delay Ring)  
Use this option to set how long the system waits before ringing an extension that has the Delayed Ringing  
option enabled. This timer also sets the delay interval for delay ring lines ringing the External Paging system.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
10 seconds  
1604-02: Call Coverage Delay Ring Timer  
(CCK Delay)  
For extensions with Delayed Ringing Call Coverage keys, use this option to set how long a call ashes the  
key at an extension before it starts to ring.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
10 seconds  
1604-03: Extended Ringing Timer  
(Extended Ring)  
If an extension’s Class of Service enables Extended Ringing, use the timer to set the duration of the  
Extended Ringing.  
678  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
16xx-Timers  
160x-Feature Timers  
1604-Station Timers  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
20 seconds  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
679  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
16xx-Timers  
160x-Feature Timers  
1605-Control Timers  
1605-Control Timers  
Description  
Use this program to adjust timers that affect various system features.  
Options  
1605-01: Page Duration Timer  
(Page Duration)  
Use this option to set the maximum length of Page announcements.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
30 seconds  
1605-02: Meet Me Conference Join Timer  
(Meetme Conf)  
When a user initiates a Meet-Me Conference, use this option to set how long the system waits for the paged  
party to join the call.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
30 seconds  
1605-03: Door Relay Unlock Timer  
(Door Relay)  
This timer sets the interval that the system or PGDAD Module relay remains closed after a keyset user acti-  
vates (closes) the relay. After this interval, the relay automatically returns to its open (idle) state.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
30 seconds  
680  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
16xx-Timers  
160x-Feature Timers  
1605-Control Timers  
1605-04: Forced Program Exit Timer  
(Program Exit)  
Use this option to set the Forced Program Exit timer. If a telephone in the programming mode is inactive longer  
than this interval, the system automatically cancels the programming mode and makes the telephone idle.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
120 seconds  
1605-05: Backlight Idle Timer  
(Backlight Idle)  
Use this option to set how long an extension must be idle before it reverts to its idle backlight brightness setting.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-9999 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
6 seconds  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
681  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
16xx-Timers  
161x-COI (Analog Line) Timers  
1611-Incoming  
161x1-CInOcoI (mAinnaglog Line) Timers  
Description  
Use this program to adjust timers that affect incoming calls on the line (COIU) PCBs.  
Options  
1611-01: Minimum Ring Detect Timer  
(Ring Detect)  
Use this option to set the threshold for ring detection. If the ring signal is longer than this interval, the system  
interprets the signal as valid ringing. If the signal is equal to or shorter than this interval, the system ignores  
the ringing. Be sure the value you enter is compatible with the local telco. If you set this value too short, the  
system may detect line spikes and anomalies as ringing. If too long, the system may not properly interpret a  
valid ringing signal.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
8-2040 mS  
Default  
104 mS  
1611-02: Minimum Single Ring Detection Timer  
(Single Ring Min)  
The system uses this option to detect valid ringing signal from the connected telco or PBX. Valid single ring  
must be longer than this interval.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
8-2040 mS  
Default  
1216 mS  
682  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
16xx-Timers  
161x-COI (Analog Line) Timers  
1611-Incoming  
1611-03: Minimum Double Ring Detection Off Timer  
(Double Ring Min)  
The system uses this option to detect valid double ring from the connected PBX. Valid double ring must be  
longer than this interval.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
8-2040 mS  
Default  
288 mS  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
683  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
16xx-Timers  
161x-COI (Analog Line) Timers  
1611-Incoming  
1611-04: Maximum Double Ring Detection Off Timer  
(Double Ring Max)  
The system uses this option to detect valid double ring from the connected PBX. Valid double ring must be  
less than this interval.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
8-2040 mS  
Default  
576 mS  
1611-05: Ringing Signal End Detection Timer  
(Ring Stop)  
Use this option to set the Ringing Signal End Detection time. If the ringing signal on a line call is interrupted  
for longer than this interval, the system assumes ringing has stopped and terminates the call. Set this option  
for compatibility with the connected telco or PBX Centrex. If this interval is set to short, valid ringing will  
be inadvertently cut off. If too long, the system will leave the call set up even after ringing has stopped.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
64-16320 mS  
Default  
6016 mS  
1611-06: Caller ID Detection Timer  
(CID Detect)  
Use this option to set the Caller ID Detection Timer. With DSP-based Caller ID, the Caller ID Detection  
Timer is the amount of time between the rst and second ring bursts that the system can detect Caller ID dig-  
its. If this timer is set too long, the outside caller will hear ringing followed by reorder tone. If set too short,  
all the Caller ID digits may not be detected. This timer is only used with DSP-based Caller ID. This option  
does not apply to COIU PCBs.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
64-16320 mS  
Default  
2944 mS  
684  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
16xx-Timers  
161x-COI (Analog Line) Timers  
1612-Outgoing  
1612-Outgoing  
Description  
Use this program to adjust timers that affect outgoing calls on the line (COIU) PCBs.  
Options  
1612-01: DP Break Timer  
(Break Time)  
Use this timer to set the duration of the Dial Pulse Break signal (i.e., relay open). This is the “off” time in a  
Dial Pulse digit. Set this timer for compatibility with the connected telco or PBX/Centrex. Keep in mind that  
there are three components of a Dial Pulse digit: Make interval, Break interval and Interdigit interval. An  
improper setting may cause misdialing.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
60 mS  
1612-02: DP Make Timer  
(Make Time)  
Use this timer to set the duration of the Dial Pulse Make signal (i.e., relay closed). This is the “on” time in a  
Dial Pulse digit. Set this timer for compatibility with the connected telco or PBX/Centrex. Keep in mind that  
there are three components of a Dial Pulse digit: Make interval, Break interval and Interdigit interval. An  
improper setting may cause misdialing.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
40 mS  
1612-03: DP Interdigit Timer  
(Interdigit Time)  
Use this timer to set the duration of the Dial Pulse Interdigit signal (i.e., relay open time between each digit).  
Set this timer for compatibility with the connected telco or PBX/Centrex. Keep in mind that there are three  
components of a Dial Pulse digit: Make interval, Break interval and Interdigit interval. An improper setting  
may cause misdialing.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
685  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
16xx-Timers  
161x-COI (Analog Line) Timers  
1612-Outgoing  
Options  
100-9999 mS  
Default  
800 mS  
1612-04: PBX/Centrex Flash Timer  
(Flash 1 Time)  
Use this timer to set the Flash interval. When a user ashes a line (manually or in a Speed Dial number), the  
system opens the line circuit for this interval. For accurate ash function, be sure to set this interval for com-  
patibility with the connected telco or PBX/Centrex. If you set this interval too short, the telco may not  
always register the ash. If too long, inadvertent disconnects may occur.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
16-4080 mS  
Default  
800 mS  
1612-05: Flash Disconnect Timer  
(Flash 2 Time)  
This option is currently not implemented.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
16-4080 mS  
Default  
2496 mS  
1612-06: Ground Start Timer  
(Ground Time)  
Before the system can start a ground start line, the telco’s tip ground must be present for longer than this  
interval. Set this interval for compatibility with the connected telco or PBX/Centrex. If you set this interval  
too short, the system may inadvertently start a line it should not set up. If too long, the system may not start  
lines that are functioning normally.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
16-4080 mS  
Default  
800 mS  
686  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
16xx-Timers  
161x-COI (Analog Line) Timers  
1612-Outgoing  
1612-07: Shunt Pause Timer  
(Shunt Pause)  
Use this option to set the Shunt Pause Timer (Dial Pulse Mute Timer) for the ATRU PCB. While dial pulsing  
or doing a Flash, the ATRU PCB switches a low resistance shunt across tip and ring to maintain the correct  
impedance on the line. When dialing or ashing is complete, the ATRU PCB waits this interval before  
releasing the shunt.  
This option does not apply to the COIU PCB.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
8 mS  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
687  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
16xx-Timers  
161x-COI (Analog Line) Timers  
1613-Loop Control  
1613-Loop Control  
Description  
Use this program to adjust timers that affect the loop on the line (COIU) PCBs.  
Options  
1613-01: Loop Current Detection Timer  
(Loop Detect)  
For loop start lines, loop current must be present for this interval before the system seizes the line. Set this  
interval for compatibility with the connected telco or PBX/Centrex. If you set this interval too short, the sys-  
tem may inadvertently seize unstable lines. If too long, the system may not properly seize a valid line.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
800 mS  
1613-02: Far End Disconnect Timer  
(Clear Signal)  
Use this option to set the loop disconnect interval for outside calls. If the system detects a loop current inter-  
ruption longer than this interval it assumes the telco has disconnected the line. It then returns the line to idle.  
Set this interval for compatibility with the connected telco or PBX/Centrex. If you set the interval too short,  
lines may not properly disconnect when the far end hangs up. If you set the interval too long, the system may  
interpret momentary loop current interruptions as positive disconnect.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
300 mS  
688  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
16xx-Timers  
161x-COI (Analog Line) Timers  
1613-Loop Control  
1613-03: Power Failure Recovery Detect Timer  
(Loop Recovery)  
Use this option to set the Power Failure Recovery Detect time. When the ATRU or COIU PCB recovers from  
a power failure, it checks the power failure line for loop current for this interval. If loop current is detected, it  
assumes the power failure telephone is still connected and does not tear down the call. If loop current is not  
detected, the PCB switches the line out of the power failure mode.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
64-16320 mS  
Default  
3008 mS  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
689  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
16xx-Timers  
162x-SLI (Analog Single Line) Timers  
1621-Incoming  
162x1-SInLcIo(mAninglog Single Line) Timers  
a
Description  
Use this program to adjust the timers that affect incoming calls to analog single line telephones.  
Options  
1621-01: Minimum DP Break Timer  
(Minimum Break)  
Use this option to dene the minimum amount of time the loop must be opened to properly decode the dial  
pulse digits sent from analog devices connected to single line PCBs. Change this value only if the con-  
nected analog devices are set to dial at a rate other than 10 PPS.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
5-1275 mS  
Default  
10 mS  
1621-02: Maximum DP Break Timer  
(Maximum Break)  
Use this option to dene the maximum amount of time the loop must be opened to properly decode the dial  
pulse digits sent from analog devices connected to single line PCBs. Change this value only if the con-  
nected analog devices are set to dial at a rate other than 10 PPS.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
5-1275 mS  
Default  
100 mS  
690  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
16xx-Timers  
162x-SLI (Analog Single Line) Timers  
1621-Incoming  
1621-03: Minimum DP Make Timer  
(Minimum Make)  
Use this option to dene the minimum amount of time the loop must be closed to properly decode the dial  
pulse digits sent from analog devices connected to single line PCBs. Change this value only if the con-  
nected analog devices are set to dial at a rate other than 10 PPS.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
5-1275 mS  
Default  
10 mS  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
691  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
16xx-Timers  
162x-SLI (Analog Single Line) Timers  
1621-Incoming  
1621-04: Maximum DP Make Timer  
(Maximum Make)  
Use this option to dene the maximum amount of time the loop must be closed to properly decode the dial  
pulse digits sent from analog devices connected to SLIU PCBs. Change this value only if the connected  
analog devices are set to dial at a rate other than 10 PPS.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
5-1275 mS  
Default  
100 mS  
1621-05: Minimum Hookash Timer  
(Minimum Flash)  
For single line PCBs, use this option to dene the minimum amount of time the loop must be opened before  
the system starts to detect a transfer or hang up sequence. Open loop intervals shorter than the setting are  
ignored by the PCB.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
5-1275 mS  
Default  
105 mS  
1621-06: Maximum Hookash Timer  
(Maximum Flash)  
For single line PCBs, use this option to dene the maximum amount of time the loop can be opened in order  
for the system to detect a Transfer sequence. Open loop intervals longer than the setting are interpreted as  
hang up.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
5-1275 mS  
Default  
1000 mS  
1621-07: Minimum Off Hook Timer  
(Minimum Off Hook)  
For single line PCBs, use this option to dene how long a connected analog device must remain off-hook  
before the system recognizes the off-hook status.  
Features  
• None  
692  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
16xx-Timers  
162x-SLI (Analog Single Line) Timers  
1621-Incoming  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
5-1275 mS  
Default  
105 mS  
1621-08: Dial Pulse Guard Timer  
(Dial Pulse Guard)  
Use this option to set the interval the single line PCB waits between dial pulse digits before attempting to  
detect any additional DP digits. This timer helps prevent erroneous DP dialing due to hardware stabilization.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
5-1275 mS  
Default  
350 mS  
1621-09: Off Hook Guard Time  
(Off Hook Guard)  
Use this option to set the interval the single line PCB waits after an analog device hangs up before accepting any  
additional input from the device. This timer helps prevent erroneous detection due to hardware stabilization.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
5-1275 mS  
Default  
300 mS  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
693  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
16xx-Timers  
162x-SLI (Analog Single Line) Timers  
1622-Outgoing  
1622-Outgoing  
Description  
Use this program to adjust the timers that affect outgoing calls from analog single line telephones.  
Options  
1622-01: Loop Disconnect Timer  
(Loop Disconnect)  
Use this option to determine how long the single line PCB opens the loop to the connected analog device  
after the far end disconnects. This timer is used only if 1403-06: Loop Disconnect for Single Line Set  
(page 636) is enabled in the extension’s Class of Service.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
50-12750 mS  
Default  
2000 mS  
1622-02: Ring/MW Wait Period Time  
(MW Period)  
Use this option to determine the ringing sequence for the devices connected single line PCBs. Because of  
power consumption, it is not possible to ring all analog devices on a PCB simultaneously. Instead, the card is  
divided into 4 groups with two ports in each group. Ringing cycles between the 4 groups, ringing each group  
for this interval.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
50-12750 mS  
Default  
750 mS  
694  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
16xx-Timers  
163x-T1/E1 Timers  
1631-Incoming  
163x1-TIn1c/Eom1 Tinimg ers  
Description  
Use this program to adjust the timers that affect incoming T1/E1 calls.  
Options  
1631-01: Receive Loop Detection Timer  
(Rx Loop Detect)  
For loop start T1 lines, loop current must be present for this interval before the system seizes the line. Set  
this interval for compatibility with the T1 service provider. If you set this interval too short, the system may  
inadvertently seize unstable lines. If too long, the system may not properly seize a valid line.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
16-4080 mS  
Default  
48 mS  
1631-02: Receive Dial Pulse Minimum Break Timer  
(Rx Min Break)  
Use this option to set the minimum required duration of the T1 circuit receive Dial Pulse Break signal (i.e.,  
relay open). This is the minimum “off” time in a Dial Pulse digit. Set this timer for compatibility with the T1  
service provider. Keep in mind that there are three components of a Dial Pulse digit: Make interval, Break  
interval and Interdigit interval. An improper setting may cause misdialing.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
20 mS  
1631-03: Receive Dial Pulse Maximum Break Timer  
(Rx Max Break)  
Use this option to set the maximum allowed duration of the T1 circuit receive Dial Pulse Break signal (i.e.,  
relay closed). This is the maximum allowed “off” time in a Dial Pulse digit. Set this timer for compatibility  
with the T1 service provider. Keep in mind that there are three components of a Dial Pulse digit: Make inter-  
val, Break interval and Interdigit interval. An improper setting may cause misdialing.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
695  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
16xx-Timers  
163x-T1/E1 Timers  
1631-Incoming  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
104 mS  
1631-04: Receive Dial Pulse Minimum Make Timer  
(Rx Min Make)  
Use this option to set the minimum required duration of the T1 circuit receive Dial Pulse Make signal (i.e.,  
relay closed). This is the minimum “on” time in a Dial Pulse digit. Set this timer for compatibility with the  
T1 service provider. Keep in mind that there are three components of a Dial Pulse digit: Make interval,  
Break interval and Interdigit interval. An improper setting may cause misdialing.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
12 mS  
1631-05: Receive Dial Pulse Maximum Make Timer  
(Rx Max Make)  
Use this option to set the maximum allowed duration of the T1 circuit receive Dial Pulse Make signal (i.e.,  
relay closed). This is the maximum allowed “on” time in a Dial Pulse digit. Set this timer for compatibility  
with the T1 service provider. Keep in mind that there are three components of a Dial Pulse digit: Make inter-  
val, Break interval and Interdigit interval. An improper setting may cause misdialing.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
76 mS  
1631-06: Receive Minimum Flash Timer  
(Rx Min Flash)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
16-4080 mS  
Default  
640 mS  
696  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
16xx-Timers  
163x-T1/E1 Timers  
1631-Incoming  
1631-07: Receive Maximum Flash Timer  
(Rx Max Flash)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
16-4080 mS  
Default  
1008 mS  
1631-08: Receive Minimum Clear Signal Timer  
(Rx Min Clear)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
16-4080 mS  
Default  
400 mS  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
697  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
16xx-Timers  
163x-T1/E1 Timers  
1632-Outgoing  
1632-Outgoing  
Description  
Use this program to adjust the timers that affect outgoing T1/E1 calls.  
Options  
1632-01:Transmit Dial Pulse Break Timer  
(Tx Break Time)  
Use this option to set the duration of the T1 circuit transmit Dial Pulse Break signal (i.e., relay open). This is  
the “off” time in a Dial Pulse digit. Set this timer for compatibility with the T1 service provider. Keep in  
mind that there are three components of a Dial Pulse digit: Make interval, Break interval and Interdigit inter-  
val. An improper setting may cause misdialing.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
60 mS  
1632-02:Transmit Dial Pulse Make Timer  
(Tx Make Time)  
Use this option to set the duration of the T1 circuit transmit Dial Pulse Make signal (i.e., relay closed). This  
is the “on” time in a Dial Pulse digit. Set this timer for compatibility with the T1 service provider. Keep in  
mind that there are three components of a Dial Pulse digit: Make interval, Break interval and Interdigit inter-  
val. An improper setting may cause misdialing.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
40 mS  
1632-03:Transmit Dial Pulse Interdigit Timer  
(Tx Interdigit)  
Use this option to set the duration of the T1 circuit transmit Dial Pulse Interdigit signal (i.e., relay open time  
between each digit). Set this timer for compatibility with the T1 service provider. Keep in mind that there are  
three components of a Dial Pulse digit: Make interval, Break interval and Interdigit interval. An improper  
setting may cause misdialing.  
Features  
698  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
16xx-Timers  
163x-T1/E1 Timers  
1632-Outgoing  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
16-4080 mS  
Default  
800 mS  
1632-04:Transmit Flash Timer  
(Tx Flash Time)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
16-4080 mS  
Default  
800 mS  
1632-05:Transmit Clear Signal Timer  
(Tx Clear Time)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
16-4080 mS  
Default  
800 mS  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
699  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
16xx-Timers  
164x-T1 Specific Timers  
1641-Ring Detect  
164x1-TR1inSgpDeectiefictTimers  
Description  
Use this program to adjust the T1 Ring Detect timers.  
Options  
1641-01: Minimum Ring Detect Timer  
(Ring Detect)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
8-2040 mS  
Default  
104 mS  
1641-02: Single Ring Minimum Detection Timer  
(Single Ring Min)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
8-2040 mS  
Default  
504 mS  
1641-03: Double Ring Minimum Detection Timer  
(Double Ring Min)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
104 mS  
1641-04: Double Ring Maximum Detection Timer  
(Double Ring Max)  
Information to be provided.  
700  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
16xx-Timers  
164x-T1 Specific Timers  
1641-Ring Detect  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
304 mS  
1641-05: Ring Stop Detection Timer  
(Ring Stop)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
64-16320 mS  
Default  
6016 mS  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
701  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
16xx-Timers  
164x-T1 Specific Timers  
1642-Call Control  
1642-Call Control  
Description  
Use this program to adjust the T1 Call Control timers.  
Options  
1642-01:Transmit Wink Timer  
(TX Wink Time)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
152 mS  
1642-02: Receive Minimum Wink Timer  
(Rx Min Wink)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
100 mS  
1642-03: Receive Maximum Wink Timer  
(Rx Max Wink)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
300 mS  
1642-04: Ground Start Remove Ring Timer  
(GS Remove Ring)  
Information to be provided.  
702  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
16xx-Timers  
164x-T1 Specific Timers  
1642-Call Control  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
0 for undened (disabled)  
Default  
• Undened (disabled)  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
703  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
16xx-Timers  
165x-E1 Specific Timers  
1651-TX (Transmit Timers)  
165x1-ETX1 S(TpreacnismciTtiTmimeresrs)  
Description  
Use this program to adjust the E1 transmit timers.  
Options  
1651-01:Transmit Seize Acknowledge Timer  
(Tx Seize Ack)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
100 mS  
1651-02:Transmit Digit Acknowledge Timer  
(Tx Digit Ack)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
100 mS  
1651-03:Transmit Answer Timer  
(Tx Answer)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
8-2040 mS  
Default  
304 mS  
1651-04:Transmit Forced Clear Signal Timer  
(Tx Forced Clear)  
Information to be provided.  
704  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
16xx-Timers  
165x-E1 Specific Timers  
1651-TX (Transmit Timers)  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
16-4080 mS  
Default  
1008 mS  
1651-05:Transmit Seize Signal (BZL) Timer  
(Tx Seize Signal (BZL))  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
8-2040 mS  
Default  
800 mS  
1651-06:Transmit Double Answer (BZL) Timer  
(Tx Double Answer BZL)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
64-16320 mS  
Default  
2048 mS  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
705  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
16xx-Timers  
165x-E1 Specific Timers  
1652-RX (Receive Timers)  
1652-RX (Receive Timers)  
Description  
Use this program to adjust the E1 receive timers.  
Options  
1652-01: Receive Minimum Seize Acknowledge Timer  
(Rx Min Seize Ack)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
100 mS  
1652-02: Receive Maximum Seize Acknowledge Timer  
(Rx Max Seize Ack)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
300 mS  
1652-03: Receive Minimum Digit Acknowledge Timer  
(Rx Min Digit Ack)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
100 mS  
1652-04: Receive Maximum Digit Acknowledge Timer  
(Rx Max Digit Ack)  
Information to be provided.  
706  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
16xx-Timers  
165x-E1 Specific Timers  
1652-RX (Receive Timers)  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
300 mS  
1652-05: Receive Minimum Answer Timer  
(Rx Min Answer)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
8-2040 mS  
Default  
200 mS  
1652-06: Receive Maximum Answer Timer  
(Rx Max Answer)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
8-2040 mS  
Default  
400 mS  
1652-07: Receive Minimum Meter Pulse Timer  
(Rx Min Meter Pls)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
100 mS  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
707  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
16xx-Timers  
165x-E1 Specific Timers  
1652-RX (Receive Timers)  
1652-08: Receive Maximum Meter Pulse Timer  
(Rx Max Meter Pls)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
4-1020 mS  
Default  
300 mS  
1652-09: Receive Minimum Double Answer (BZL) Timer  
(Rx Min Dbl Answer [BZL])  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
64-16320 mS  
Default  
1536 mS  
1652-10: Receive Maximum Double Answer (BZL) Timer  
(Rx Max Dbl Answer [BZL])  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
64-16320 mS  
Default  
3008 mS  
1652-11: Receive Minimum Line Block Timer  
(Rx Min Line Block)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
64-16320 mS  
708  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
16xx-Timers  
165x-E1 Specific Timers  
1652-RX (Receive Timers)  
Default  
2048 mS  
1652-12: Receive Line Block Recover Timer  
(Rx Line Block Recover)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
64-16320 mS  
Default  
2048 mS  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
709  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
16xx-Timers  
165x-E1 Specific Timers  
1653-MFC Incoming Timers  
1653-MFC Incoming Timers  
Description  
Use this program to adjust the E1 MFC incoming timers.  
Options  
1653-01: GI Signal Timer  
(GI Signal)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-32 seconds  
Default  
12 seconds  
1653-02: GI Tone Complete Timer  
(GI Tone Complete)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-32 seconds  
Default  
12 seconds  
1653-03: GII Signal Timer  
(GII Signal)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-32 seconds  
Default  
12 seconds  
1653-04: GA Pulse Response Timer  
(GA Pulse Response)  
Information to be provided.  
710  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
16xx-Timers  
165x-E1 Specific Timers  
1653-MFC Incoming Timers  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
50-600 mS  
Default  
100 mS  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
711  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
16xx-Timers  
165x-E1 Specific Timers  
1654-MFC Outgoing Timers  
1654-MFC Outgoing Timers  
Description  
Use this program to adjust the E1 MFC outgoing timers.  
Options  
1654-01: GA Response Timer  
(GA Response)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-32 seconds  
Default  
12 seconds  
1654-02: GA Tone Complete Timer  
(GA Tone Complete)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-32 seconds  
Default  
12 seconds  
1654-03: GB Response Timer  
(GB Response)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-32 seconds  
Default  
12 seconds  
1654-04: GB Tone Complete Timer  
(GB Tone Complete)  
Information to be provided.  
712  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
16xx-Timers  
165x-E1 Specific Timers  
1654-MFC Outgoing Timers  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-32 seconds  
Default  
12 seconds  
1654-05: GC Response Timer  
(GC Response)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-32 seconds  
Default  
12 seconds  
1654-06: GC Tone Complete Timer  
(GC Tone Complete Timer)  
Information to be provided.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-32 seconds  
Default  
12 seconds  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
713  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
17xx-Speed Dial (System)  
170x-Setup  
1701-Format  
17xx-Speed Dial (System)  
170x1-SFoertumpat  
Description  
Use this program to set the maximum number of System Speed Dial bins (9, 99, or 999) that users can dial.  
This does not limit the number of bins you can program in 1702-Assignment (System Speed Dial Assign-  
Options  
1701-01: Number of System Speed Dial Bins  
(# of Speed Dials)  
Use this option to designate the number of digits (1-3) in a System Speed Dial bin number.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1 for 9 (10 bins numbered 1-9)  
2 for 99 (99 bins numbered 1-99)  
3 for 999 (999 bins numbered 001-999)  
Default  
2  
714  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
17xx-Speed Dial (System)  
170x-Setup  
1702-Assignment (System Speed Dial Assignment)  
1702-Assignment (System Speed Dial Assignment)  
Description  
Use this program to enter System Speed Dial numbers in to system memory.  
Options  
1702-[001-999]: Select System Speed Dial Bin to Program  
(Bin #)  
Use this option to select the System Speed Dial bin you want to program (normally 001-999).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
• 21-29 for 2-digit System Speed Dial.  
• 201-299 for 3-digit System Speed Dial  
• 2001-2999 for 4-digit System Speed Dial,  
Default  
• 201-299  
1702-[001-999]: System Speed Dial Bin Type  
(Bin Type)  
For the Personal Speed Dial bin selected, use this option to select the bin type (none, Intercom, line, or Line  
Group).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for Intercom  
2 for line  
3 for Line Group  
Default  
0  
1702-[001-999]: System Speed Dial Bin Line  
(Bin Line)  
For a type 2 (line) Personal Speed Dial bin, use this option to select the line (1-64) the bin will use for an  
outgoing call.  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
715  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
17xx-Speed Dial (System)  
170x-Setup  
1702-Assignment (System Speed Dial Assignment)  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-64 for lines 1-64  
Default  
• No entry  
1702-[001-999]: System Speed Dial Bin Group  
(Bin Group)  
For a type 3 (Line Group) System Speed Dial bin, use this option to select the Line Group (90-98) the bin  
will use for an outgoing call.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
90-98 for Line Groups 90-98  
Default  
• No entry  
1702-[001-999]: System Speed Dial Bin Number  
(Bin Number)  
Use this option to enter the System Speed Dial number (normally up to 16 characters). A System Speed Dial  
number can be up to 32 digits long, however. The system allows this by automatically using the next adja-  
cent bin for entries longer than 16 digits. Flash, Wait, and Pause commands count as a digit.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
Numbers (16 max without overowing into next adjacent bin), using 0-9, # and *.  
Flash (press Feature Key 1).  
Wait (press Feature Key 2).  
Pause (press Feature Key 3).  
Default  
• None  
716  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
17xx-Speed Dial (System)  
170x-Setup  
1702-Assignment (System Speed Dial Assignment)  
1702-[001-999]: System Speed Dial Bin Name  
(Bin Name)  
Use this option to enter a name (up to 16 characters) for the System Speed Dial bin. When entering names,  
use the following Name Programming chart.  
Name Programming Chart  
Press a key the indicated number of times for desired character  
Key  
1 Time  
2 Times  
3 Times  
4 Times  
5 Times  
6 Times  
7 Times  
8 Times  
9 Times  
1
&
-
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
#
*
A
B
E
H
K
N
Q
U
X
:
C
F
I
a
d
g
j
b
e
c
f
2
3
4
5
6
r
D
G
h
k
i
J
M
L
O
R
V
Y
0
l
m
S
t
n
p
u
w
o
q
v
x
P
s
z
7
9
T
8
y
W
Z
space  
Not used  
Not used  
After selecting a letter, press a key for another letter or wait 2 seconds for the cursor to automatically advance.  
Additional Name Programming Options  
HOLD  
Save name.  
SPEAKER  
Volume Up  
Volume Down  
Exit user name programming.  
Scroll the cursor to the right.  
Scroll the cursor to the left.  
While editing, clears character to the right.  
At beginning of line, erases entire entry.  
At end of line, becomes a backspace key  
CLEAR  
CHECK  
Restore the previous entry,  
DSX Software Manual  
System Options: 1001-1702  
717  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
17xx-Speed Dial (System)  
170x-Setup  
1702-Assignment (System Speed Dial Assignment)  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
Alpha-numeric characters (16 max.). See Name Programming Chart above.  
Default  
• None  
718  
System Options: 1001-1702  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21xx-Configuration  
210x-Setup  
2101-Type  
Stations: 2101-2501  
21xx-Conguration  
210x1-STyeptuep  
Description  
Use this program to set up basic station (extension) options.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2101-01: Station Type  
(Type)  
Use this option to assign circuit type to station devices. All circuit types should auto-ID when the station  
device is plugged in.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
00 for Undened  
01 for DSX 22 Button  
02 for DSX 34 Button  
03 for DSX Super Display  
04 for DS 22 Button Non-display  
05 for DS 22 Button Display  
06 for DS 34 Button  
07 for DS Super Display  
08 for Cordless Telephone  
09 for Single Line Telephone  
10 for Analog Door Box  
11 for DS 2-OPX Module  
Default  
• Telephones auto-ID when station is plugged in.  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
719  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
21xx-Configuration  
210x-Setup  
2101-Type  
2101-02: Station Name  
(Name)  
Use this option to assign a name (up to 16 characters) to the extension port.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
• See the Name Programming Chart on the next page.  
Default  
• No names entered.  
Name Programming Chart  
Press a key the indicated number of times for desired character  
Key  
1 Time  
2 Times  
3 Times  
4 Times  
5 Times  
6 Times  
7 Times  
8 Times  
9 Times  
1
&
-
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
#
*
A
B
E
H
K
N
Q
U
X
:
C
F
I
a
d
g
j
b
e
c
f
2
3
4
5
6
r
D
G
h
k
i
J
M
L
O
R
V
Y
0
l
m
S
t
n
p
u
w
o
q
v
x
P
s
z
7
9
T
8
y
W
Z
space  
Not used  
Not used  
After selecting a letter, press a key for another letter or wait 2 seconds for the cursor to automatically advance.  
Additional Name Programming Options  
HOLD  
Save name.  
SPEAKER  
Volume Up  
Volume Down  
Exit user name programming.  
Scroll the cursor to the right.  
Scroll the cursor to the left.  
While editing, clears character to the right.  
At beginning of line, erases entire entry.  
At end of line, becomes a backspace key  
CLEAR  
720  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
21xx-Configuration  
210x-Setup  
2101-Type  
Name Programming Chart  
Press a key the indicated number of times for desired character  
3 Times 4 Times 5 Times 6 Times 7 Times  
Key  
1 Time  
2 Times  
8 Times  
9 Times  
CHECK  
Restore the previous entry,  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
721  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21xx-Configuration  
210x-Setup  
2101-Type  
2101-03: Station Display Language  
(Language)  
Use this option to set the language for the extension’s display (including system programming).You can also  
set this option from the keyset using the soft keys.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1 for English  
2 for Spanish  
Default  
1  
2101-04: Door Chime Selection  
(Door Chime)  
If the extension is a Door Box, use this option to select the door chime type.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for normal Ring Group ringing  
1 for chime 1 (low pitch)  
2 for chime 2 (mid range pitch)  
3 for chime 3 (high pitch)  
Default  
• 0  
722  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
21xx-Configuration  
210x-Setup  
2101-Type  
2101-05: Outgoing ANI ID  
(ANI ID)  
For E1 lines only, use this option to specify the outgoing ANI data that identies the extension (1-4 digits  
appended to the system’s telephone number). This option is only for E1 MFC dialing. It is not used in North  
America. The allowable entries are 0-9, #, and * (4 digits). By default, there is no outgoing ANI data entered.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Digits (4 digits max., using 0-9, # and *.)  
Default  
• No entry  
2101-06: Door Relay Assignment  
(Door Relay)  
If the extension is a Door Box, use this option to assign the Door Box relay. This option only applies to  
DSX-40.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for CPU Relay 1 (DSX40-1)  
2 for CPU Relay 2 (DSXC40-2)  
Default  
0  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
723  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
21xx-Configuration  
210x-Setup  
2102-Access  
2102-Access  
Description  
Use this program to customize station (extension) access options.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2102-01: Class of Service  
(COS)  
Use this option to assign the extension’s Class of Service.  
Features  
• See the Features for each option in 14xx-COS (Class of Service) (page 628).  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 1-15  
Default  
1 for the attendant (extension 300)  
2 for all other extensions.Default  
2102-02: Station Toll Level (Day)  
(Toll Level - Day)  
Use this option to assign an extension’s Toll Level during the day mode.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 1-7 for Toll Restriction levels 1-7  
0 for no restriction  
Default  
0  
2102-03: Station Toll Level (Night)  
(Toll Level - Night)  
Use this option to assign an extension’s Toll Level during the day mode.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 1-7 for Toll Restriction levels 1-7  
0 for no restriction  
Default  
0  
724  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
21xx-Configuration  
210x-Setup  
2102-Access  
2102-04: User Programming Access Level  
(Pgm Level)  
Use this option to set an extensions Programming Access Level. This setting determines which User  
Programmable Features the extension can use.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-5  
Default  
5 for the operator (extension 300)  
3 for all other extensions  
2102-05: Station PIN Code  
(PIN Code)  
Use this option to assign a PIN code to an extension. The PIN code is used for both Extension Locking and  
Walking Class of Service.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Digits (4 digits required using 0-9, # and *)  
Default  
No entry  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
725  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
21xx-Configuration  
210x-Setup  
2103-Ringing  
2103-Ringing  
Description  
Use this program to customize station (extension) Distinctive Ringing options.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2103-01: Day Ring Type  
(Day Ring Type)  
Use this option to set the Extension Override Ring Type option for day ring lines ringing the extension. This  
is the same as following the ASSIGN (ASGN) soft key. If this option is 0 (Standard Group), the setting you  
make in this option will take effect. If this option is 1-3, the setting you make in this option will only take  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for line (follows the setting for the line in 3113-02: Day Ring Type)  
1 for ring type A  
2 for ring type B  
3 for ring type C  
Default  
0  
2103-02: Night Ring Type  
(Night Ring Type)  
Use this option to set the Extension Override Ring Type option for night ring lines ringing the extension.  
This is the same as following the ASSIGN (ASGN) soft key. If this option is 0 (Standard Group), the setting  
you make in this option will take effect. If this option is 1-3, the setting you make in this option will only  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for line (follows the setting for the line in 3113-03: Night Ring Type)  
1 for ring type A  
2 for ring type B  
3 for ring type C  
Default  
0  
2103-03: Delay Ring Type  
(Delay Ring Type)  
Use this option to set the Extension Override Ring Type option for delay ring lines ringing the extension.  
This is the same as following the ASSIGN (ASGN) soft key. If this option is 0 (Standard Group), the setting  
726  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
21xx-Configuration  
210x-Setup  
2103-Ringing  
you make in this option will take effect. If this option is 1-3, the setting you make in this option will only  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for line (follows the setting for the line in 3113-03: Night Ring Type)  
1 for ring type A  
2 for ring type B  
3 for ring type C  
Default  
0  
2103-04: Station’s Intercom Ring Tone  
(ICM Ring Tone)  
For the station’s incoming Intercom ringing, use this option to select the Distinctive Ringing ring tone used.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0-9 for ring tones 0-9.  
Default  
1  
2103-05: Station’s Ring Group Ring Tone  
(Group Ring Tone)  
For the station’s incoming Ring Group ringing, use this option to select the Distinctive Ringing ring tone used.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0-9 for ring tones 0-9.  
Default  
1  
2103-06: Station’s Recall Ring Tone  
(Recall Ring Tone)  
For the station’s incoming recall ringing, use this option to select the Distinctive Ringing ring tone used.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0-9 for ring tones 0-9.  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
727  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
21xx-Configuration  
210x-Setup  
2103-Ringing  
Default  
3  
2103-07: Station’s Ring “ATone  
(Type-A Ring Tone)  
For the station’s type “A” incoming ring, use this option to select the Distinctive Ringing ring tone used.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0-9 for ring tones 0-9.  
Default  
2  
2103-08: Station’s Ring “BTone  
(Type-B Ring Tone)  
For the station’s type “B” incoming ring, use this option to select the Distinctive Ringing ring tone used.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0-9 for ring tones 0-9.  
Default  
5  
2103-09: Station’s Ring “CTone  
(Type-B Ring Tone)  
For the station’s type “C” incoming ring, use this option to select the Distinctive Ringing ring tone used.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0-9 for ring tones 0-9.  
Default  
8  
728  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
21xx-Configuration  
210x-Setup  
2104-Display  
2104-Display  
Description  
Use this program to adjust the station (extension) display backlight brightness settings.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2104-01: Backlight Brightness While Active  
(Active Brightness)  
Use this option to set the telephone’s backlight brightness while it is active.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for backlight off  
1 - 8 for relative brightness settings 1-8  
Default  
8  
2104-02: Backlight Brightness While Idle  
(Idle Brightness)  
Use this option to set the telephone’s backlight brightness while it is idle.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for backlight off  
1 - 8 for relative brightness settings 1-8  
Default  
2  
2104-03: Key Pad Illumination  
(Dial Pad Illumination)  
Use this option to enable or disable the telephone’s key pad illumination.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for off (no illumination)  
1 for on (key pad illuminates when backlit display is active)  
Default  
1  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
729  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
21xx-Configuration  
210x-Setup  
2104-Display  
730  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2111-Features  
211x1-OFepatitounress  
Description  
Use this program to enable or disable various station (extension) features.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2111-01: Allow Do Not Disturb  
(Allow DND)  
Use this option to enable or disable Do Not Disturb at the extension.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
2111-02: Allow Background Music  
(Allow BGM)  
Use this option to enable or disable Background Music at the extension.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
2111-03: Enable DSS/BLF Keys  
(BLF Lamps)  
Use this option to enable or disable the DSS function for an extension’s Feature Keys.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
731  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2111-Features  
2111-04: Ringing Line Preference  
(Ringing Line Pref)  
Use this option to enable or disable Ringing Line Preference for the extension.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
2111-05: Key Access for Outside Lines  
(Key Line Access)  
Use this option to enable or disable the extension user’s ability to press a line key to access an outside line.  
This option does not restrict calls on loop keys.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
2111-06: Line Dial Up  
(Line Dial Up)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to use Line Dial Up.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
2111-07: Retain Line Volume Setting  
(Retain Line Volume)  
If this option is enabled, the system remembers the user-set handset and Handsfree volume for each outside  
call. If disabled, the system uses a median handset and Handsfree volume setting each time the user places  
an outside call.  
Features  
732  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2111-Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
2111-08: Answering Machine  
(Answering Machine)  
For systems without voice mail that are using a customer-provided answering machine, use this option to  
designate the extension as an Answering Machine. This will cause any outside call picked up by the answer-  
ing machine not to be marked as answered in the Caller ID log.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
733  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2111-Features  
2111-09: Personal Speed Dial  
(Personal SPD)  
Use this option to enable or disable Personal Speed Dial for the extension.  
If the extension has this option disabled, Call Forwarding Off Premises is not available.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
734  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2112-Speaker Control  
2112-Speaker Control  
Description  
Use this program to customize features of the station (extension) speaker.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2112-01: Automatic Handsfree  
(Auto Handsfree)  
Use this option to enable or disable Automatic Handsfree for the extension.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
2112-02: Headset Mode  
(Headset)  
Use this option to enable or disable the headset mode for the extension.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
2112-03:Voice Announcements Through Speaker  
(Voice Announce)  
Use this option to enable or disable incoming voice-announced Intercom calls while the extension is not in  
the headset mode. If disabled, all Intercom calls to the extension ring.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
735  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2112-Speaker Control  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
736  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2112-Speaker Control  
2112-04:Voice Announcements in Headset Mode  
(Headset V.A.)  
Use this option to enable or disable incoming voice-announced Intercom calls while the extension is in the  
headset mode. If enable, the user hears 2 beeps in the headset when they receive an incoming Intercom call.  
If disabled, the user hears ringing over the telephone speaker.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
2112-05: Handsfree Reply (Handsfree Answerback)  
(Handsfree Reply)  
Use this option to enable or disable Handsfree reply (Handsfree Answerback) for the extension.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
2112-06: Paging Through Speaker  
(Paging)  
Use this option to enable or disable the ability of the keyset extension to receive Paging through the tele-  
phone speaker.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
737  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2113-Groups  
2113-Groups  
Description  
Use this program to assign the various groups to which the station (extension) belongs.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2113-01: Dial 9 Group  
(Dial 9 Group)  
Assign the line group (90-98) the extension accesses when the user dials 9 for an outside line or presses a  
Switched Loop key.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
90-98 for Line Groups 90-98  
Default  
90  
2113-02: Ring Group  
(Ring Group)  
Use this option to designate to which Ring Group the extension or Door Box belongs.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-8 (Ring Groups 1-8)  
0 (none)  
Default  
0  
738  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2113-Groups  
2113-03: Pickup Group  
(Pickup Group)  
Use this option to assign the extension to a Pickup Group.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-8 (pickup groups 1-8)  
0 (unassigned)  
Default  
0  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
739  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2113-Groups  
2113-04: Privacy Group  
(Privacy Group)  
Use this option to assign an extension to a Privacy Release Group.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-16 for Privacy Release Groups 1-16  
0 for unassigned  
Default  
0  
2113-05: Page Group (Zone)  
(Page Group)  
Use this option to assign the extension to a page zone.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 1-7 for Paging Groups 1-7  
0 for All Call only  
Default  
1  
740  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2114-Off Hook Options  
2114-Off Hook Options  
Description  
Used this program to customize the off-hook options for the station (extension).  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2114-01: Prime Line Type  
(Prime Line Type)  
Use this option to set the extension’s Prime Line type (none, key, line, or Line Group).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for key  
2 for line  
3 for Line Group  
Default  
1 for key  
2114-01: Prime Line Key  
(Prime Line Key)  
If 2114-01: Prime Line Type is set for key (1), use this option to select the key assigned as the extension’s  
Prime Line.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-24 (Feature Keys 1-24)  
00 for Intercom Prime Line  
Default  
00 for Intercom Prime Line  
2114-01: Prime Line Line  
(Prime Line Line)  
If 2114-01: Prime Line Type is set for line (2), use this option to select the line the extension seizes when the  
user lifts the handset. The line does not have to be on a Feature Key appearing on the phone. Also use this  
option to set up Prime Line for single line telephones.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
741  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2114-Off Hook Options  
Options  
1-64 (lines 1-64)  
Default  
1  
2114-01: Prime Line Group  
(Prime Line Group)  
If 2114-01: Prime Line Type is set for line (3), use this option to select the Line Group the extension seizes  
when the user lifts the handset. The line does not have to be on a Feature Key appearing on the phone. Also  
use this option to set up Prime Line for single line telephones.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
90-98 (Line Groups 90-98)  
Default  
90  
742  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2114-Off Hook Options  
2114-02: Station Ring Down Type  
(Ring Down Type)  
Use this option to set the extension’s Ring Down type (none, extension, System Speed Dial, or Personal  
Speed Dial).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for extension  
2 for System Speed Dial  
3 for Personal Speed Dial  
Default  
0 for none  
2114-02: Station Ring Down Destination  
(Ring Down Dest)  
Use this option to assign the extension’s Ring Down destination. Depending on the setting of 2114-02: Sta-  
tion Ring Down Type, the destination can be an extension, a UCD or Ring Group master number, the voice  
mail master number, or a Speed Dial bin. The Ringdown destination cannot be an outside line.  
Also use this option to designate the extension associated with the cordless telephone base unit Desk button.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• For type 1 (extension) Ring Down:  
- Extension number  
- UCD Group master number (700-707)  
- Voice Mail master number (700)  
- Ring Group master number (600-607)  
• For type 2 (System Speed Dial) Ring Down:  
- System Speed Dial bin (#201-#299)  
• For type 3 (Personal Speed Dial) Ring Down:  
- Personal Speed Dial bin (#701-#720)  
Default  
0 for None (Ring Down disabled)  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
743  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2114-Off Hook Options  
2114-03: Station’s Operator Extension Number  
(Operator Ext)  
Assign the extension’s operator. This is the co-worker the extension user reaches when they dial 0.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Extension number  
None (Entered by pressing CLEAR)  
Default  
300  
744  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2115-Hunting and Overflow Options  
2115-Hunting and Overflow Options  
Description  
Use this program to set the Extension Hunting and DID Intercept options for the extension (station).  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Sample Hunt Group Programming  
Circular Hunting  
Circular Hunting Programming (for 301, 303 and 304)  
Enter the same Hunt Type for all three extensions:  
1 = Ring No Answer Line  
2 = Busy/Ring No Answer Line  
3 = Busy/Ring No Answer All Calls  
4 = Busy Line  
301 303  
303 304  
304 301 (This causes hunting to loop back to 301)  
1603-01: Transfer Recall Timer This timer sets how long an outside call waits at a busy member  
extension. It also sets how long a call rings each member extension  
as it cycles through the group.  
1601-02: DIL No Answer Timer This timer sets how long a DIL rings its destination member exten-  
sion before cycling through the group.  
Terminal Hunting  
Terminal Hunting Programming (for 301 and 303)  
Enter the same Hunt Type for all three extensions:  
1 = Ring No Answer Line  
2 = Busy/Ring No Answer Line  
3 = Busy/Ring No Answer All Calls  
4 = Busy Line  
301 303  
303 304  
304 Press CLEAR to undene entry. (Hunting stops at 304.)  
1603-01: Transfer Recall Timer This timer sets how long an outside call waits at a busy member  
extension. It also sets how long a call rings each member extension  
as it cycles through the group.  
1601-02: DIL No Answer Timer This timer sets how long a DIL rings its destination member exten-  
sion before cycling through the group.  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
745  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2115-Hunting and Overflow Options  
UCD Hunting  
UCD Hunting Programming (for 301, 303 and 304 with master 701)  
Enter the Hunt Type 5 for all three extensions.  
Enter 701 for all three extensions.  
1601-04: UCD No Answer Timer This timer sets when UCD overow occurs. When all UCD agents are  
busy, a queued call rings for this interval and then overows to the  
.
Options  
2115-01: Hunt Type  
(Hunt Type)  
Use this option to assign the hunt type for the extension.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for Ring No Answer Line  
2 for Busy/Ring No Answer Line  
3 for Busy/Ring No Answer All Calls  
4 for Busy Line  
5 for Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)  
Default  
0  
2115-01: Hunt Destination  
(Hunt Destination)  
For type 1-4 hunting only, use this option to assign the next extension in the Circular or Terminal Hunt Group.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
Extension number (0-999)  
None (entered by pressing CLEAR)  
Default  
None  
2115-01: UCD Group Master Number  
(Hunt Master)  
For type 5 hunting only, use this option to assign the hunt group  
746  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2115-Hunting and Overflow Options  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
700 (UCD Group 1) through 707 (UCD Group 8)  
None (entered by pressing CLEAR)  
Default  
None  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
747  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2115-Hunting and Overflow Options  
2115-02: DID Station Intercept Type  
(DID Intercept Type)  
Use this option to set the extension’s DID Intercept type. Intercept can occur when the extension is busy, in  
Do Not Disturb, or unanswered.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for Busy/DND  
- DID Intercept occurs when the extension is busy or in Do Not Disturb.  
2 for Ring No Answer  
- DID Intercept occurs when the extension is unanswered.  
3 for Busy/DND and Ring No Answer  
- DID Intercept occurs when the extension is busy, in Do Not Disturb, or is unanswered.  
Default  
0  
2115-02: DID Station Intercept Destination  
(DID Intercept Destination)  
Use this option to set the extension’s DID Intercept destination. When DID Intercept occurs, the incoming  
DID call routes to the destination specied in this option. The destination can be an extension, a UCD or  
Ring Group master number, or the voice mail master number.  
For Ring No Answer Intercept, intercept occurs after the 1601-02: DIL No Answer Timer interval. If the call  
is not picked up at the intercept destination (or intercept is not programmed to pick up the call), the call fol-  
lows the line overow routing.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Extension number (0-999)  
UCD Group master number (700-707)  
Voice Mail master number (700)  
Ring Group master number (600-607)  
Default  
300  
748  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2116-Off Hook Signaling Options  
2116-Off Hook Signaling Options  
Description  
Use this program to set the station (extension) Off-Hook Signaling options.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2116-01: Off Hook Signaling for Incoming Intercom Calls  
(OHS Intercom)  
Use this option to assign an extension’s Off-Hook Signaling mode for incoming Intercom calls. The options  
are no signaling, Call Waiting beeps, and Voice Over.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for no signaling  
1 for Camp-On  
2 for Voice Over  
Default  
1  
2116-02: Off Hook Signaling for Calls from Hotline Partner  
(OHS Hotline)  
Use this option to assign an extension’s Off-Hook Signaling options for calls from the Hotline partner. Refer  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for Camp-On (Hotline call from partner will send Camp-On tones).  
2 for Voice Over (Hotline call from partner will initiate Voice Over).  
Default  
0  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
749  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2116-Off Hook Signaling Options  
2116-03: Off Hook Signaling for Incoming Outside Calls  
(OHS Lines)  
To have the system audibly alert the operator when outside calls are waiting, assign an extension’s Off-Hook  
Signaling options for outside calls (no Off-Hook Signaling, Call Wait beeps over speaker, or Off-hook ringing).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for no Off-Hook Signaling  
1 for Call Wait beeps over the telephone speaker  
2 for Off-hook ringing  
Default  
2  
750  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2117-Call Logging (Caller ID Logging)  
2117-Call Logging (Caller ID Logging)  
Description  
Use this program to set up Caller ID Logging at the extension (station).  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2117-01: Caller ID Log Type  
(CID Log Type)  
Use this option to specify the type of Caller ID Logging at an extension (none, personal, or group). With per-  
sonal logging, an extension’s records are stored on their phone. With group logging, all extensions within the  
same Caller ID logging group share the same records. If the number of records is exceeded at the extension  
or in a group, new call records overwrite old call records (FIFO, or rst-in, rst-out).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for personal  
2 for group  
Default  
1  
2117-01: Caller ID Log Size  
(CID Log Size)  
If 2117-01: Caller ID Log Type is 1 (personal), use this option to specify the number of Caller ID records the  
extension should have.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-99 Caller ID records  
Default  
10  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
751  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
21xx-Configuration  
211x-Options  
2117-Call Logging (Caller ID Logging)  
2117-01: Caller ID Log Group  
(CID Log Group)  
If 2117-01: Caller ID Log Type is 2 (group), use this option to specify to which Caller ID Logging Group the  
extension belongs.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-8 (Caller ID Logging Group 1-8)  
Default  
1  
752  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
21xx-Configuration  
212x-Keys  
2121-Feature Keys  
212x1-KFeaytsure Keys  
Description  
Use this program to assign the Feature Keys on a keyset. The defaults are as follows:  
In DSX-80/160, keys 1-12 are line keys for lines 1-12 and keys 13-24 are undened.  
In DSX-40, keys 1-8 are line keys for lines 1-8 and keys 9-24 are undened.  
For attendants:  
- Key 12 (on 22-button) or key 24 (on 34-button) is an Operator Call Key.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
The following chart shows the available extension Feature Key assignments.  
Extension Feature Key Assignments (Page 1 of 5)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
00  
Operation  
Use this option to designate a Feature Key as  
undened (no function).  
N/A  
Undened  
01  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Switched Loop key.  
Press the key to  
place or answer call.  
Loop Key  
(Switched)  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Loop key idle.  
On (green) . . . .You are busy on a loop key call.  
Slow Flash . . . .Line is ringing.  
02 + nn (Line Group  
90-98)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Fixed Loop key.  
Loop Key (Fixed)  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Loop key idle.  
On (green) . . . .You are busy on a loop key call.  
Slow Flash . . . .Line is ringing.  
03 + nn (line  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
line key.  
Press the key to  
place or answer call.  
Line  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Line is idle or not installed.  
On . . . . . . . . .Line is busy.  
Slow Flash . . . .Line is ringing.  
04 + nn (Park Orbit  
60-69)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Park Orbit key.  
Press key to Park or  
retrieve parked call.  
Park Orbit  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Orbit is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . .Orbit is holding a parked call.  
Wink On . . . . . .Orbit is holding a call you parked.  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
753  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
21xx-Configuration  
212x-Keys  
2121-Feature Keys  
Extension Feature Key Assignments (Page 2 of 5)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
Operation  
05 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Hotline key.  
Press key to call  
Hotline partner.  
Hotline  
A keyset user can use the #HL user-program-  
mable procedure to change the Hotline assign-  
ments on their console.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Partner extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . .Partner extension is busy or ringing.  
Fast Flash. . . . .Partner extension is in Do Not Disturb.  
06 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as an  
immediately ringing Call Coverage Key.  
Press key to call cov-  
ered extension or  
pick up ringing call.  
Call Coverage  
Immediate Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Covered extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . .Covered extension is busy.  
Fast Flash. . . . .Covered extension is in Do Not Disturb.  
Slow Flash . . . .Covered extension is ringing.  
07 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
lamp only (no ring) Call Coverage Key.  
Press key to call cov-  
ered extension or  
pick up ringing call.  
Call Coverage No  
Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Covered extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . .Covered extension is busy.  
Fast Flash. . . . .Covered extension is in Do Not Disturb.  
Slow Flash . . . .Covered extension is ringing.  
08 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
delayed ringing Call Coverage Key.  
Press key to call cov-  
ered extension or  
pick up ringing call.  
Call Coverage  
Delay Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Covered extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . .Covered extension is busy.  
Fast Flash. . . . .Covered extension is in Do Not Disturb.  
Slow Flash . . . .Covered extension is ringing.  
09 + nn (Pickup  
Group 01-16)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as an  
immediately ringing Group Call Pickup key.  
Press key to answer  
call ringing Pickup  
Group.  
Group Pickup  
Immediate Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .No call is ringing the pickup group.  
Slow Flash . . . .A call is ringing the pickup group.  
754  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21xx-Configuration  
212x-Keys  
2121-Feature Keys  
Extension Feature Key Assignments (Page 3 of 5)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
Operation  
10 + nn (Pickup  
Group 01-16)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
lamp only (no ring) Group Call Pickup key.  
Press key to answer  
call ringing Pickup  
Group.  
Group Pickup No  
Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .No call is ringing the pickup group.  
Slow Flash . . . .A call is ringing the pickup group.  
11 + nn (Pickup  
Group 01-16)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
delay ring Group Call Pickup key.  
Press key to answer  
call ringing Pickup  
Group.  
Group Pickup  
Delay Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .No call is ringing the pickup group.  
Slow Flash . . . .A call is ringing the pickup group.  
13 + n (Page Zone 1-  
7, 0 for All Call)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Page Zone key.  
Press key to Page  
into assigned zone.  
Page Zone  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
On . . . . . . . . .The assigned Page zone is busy.  
Off . . . . . . . . .The assigned Page zone is idle.  
14 + nnn (bin 001-  
999)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
System Speed Dial key. You assign the key to  
specic System Speed Dial bin.  
Press key to dial  
stored number.  
System Speed  
Dial  
• There is no BLF for this key type.  
15 + nnn (bin 1-20)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Personal Speed Dial key.You assign the key to  
a specic Personal Speed Dial bin.  
Press key to dial  
stored number.  
Personal Speed  
Dial  
• There is no BLF for this key type.  
16 + n (1=manual,  
2=automatic)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Call Timer key. There are two types of timer  
key: manual and automatic.  
Press key to start or  
stop Call Timer.  
Call Timer  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
On . . . . . . . . .Call Timer on.  
Off . . . . . . . . .Call Timer off.  
17 + nnn (extension  
number of valid Sub-  
scriber Mailbox)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
voice mail Record key.  
Press key to record  
conversation into  
mailbox.  
Voice Mail  
Record  
You must have voice mail installed to  
use this key.  
• A voice prompt and periodic beep will  
remind you that your calls are being  
recorded.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
On . . . . . . . . .Conversation Record is being set up.  
Off . . . . . . . . .Conversation Record is off.  
Fast Flash. . . . .Conversation Record is on.  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
755  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21xx-Configuration  
212x-Keys  
2121-Feature Keys  
Extension Feature Key Assignments (Page 4 of 5)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
Operation  
18 + CLEAR  
(System Night key)  
18 + UCD Group  
master number  
(UCD Night key)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Night key. There are two options: System  
Night key and UCD Night key. The System  
Night key puts all Key Ring lines and lines  
terminated to Ring Group master numbers  
into the night mode. The UCD Night key puts  
all lines terminated to the UCD Group master  
number into the night mode.  
Press key to put Key  
Ring lines and lines  
terminated to Ring  
Group master into  
night mode.  
Night  
OR  
Press key to put  
lines terminated to  
UCD master into  
night mode.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
On . . . . . . . . .Night mode is on.  
Off . . . . . . . . .Night mode is off.  
20  
21  
Use this option to assign a programmable key  
as a Split key.  
Split  
Use this option to assign a programmable key  
as an Intercom Directory Dialing key.  
Press key to access  
Intercom Directory  
Dialing.  
Intercom  
Directory Dialing  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
On . . . . . . . . .Intercom Directory Dialing is active (being used).  
Off . . . . . . . . .Intercom Directory Dialing is inactive (off).  
23 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Reverse Voice Over key.  
While on a handset  
call, press key to  
place a private  
Reverse Voice  
Over Key  
Intercom call to  
covered extension.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Assigned extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . .Assigned extension is busy or ringing  
Fast Flash. . . . .Assigned extension is in Do Not Disturb.  
24 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Message Center key.  
Press key to call  
Message Center  
Mailbox.  
Message Center  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .No messages waiting in the Message Center Mailbox.  
Fast Flash. . . . .Messages waiting in the Message Center Mailbox.  
756  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21xx-Configuration  
212x-Keys  
2121-Feature Keys  
Extension Feature Key Assignments (Page 5 of 5)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
25  
Operation  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Save Number Dialed key.  
• There is no BLF for this key type.  
While on a call:  
Save Number  
Dialed  
Press key to save  
the number you just  
dialed.  
While idle:  
Press key to redial a  
previously saved  
number.  
26  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as an  
Account Code key.  
1. Place or answer out-  
side call.  
Account Code  
2. Press key.  
3. Enter Account Code.  
4. Press key to return to  
the call.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Not in Account Code mode or not entering Account Codes.  
Fast Flash. . . . .In the Account Code entry mode.  
On . . . . . . . . .On a call for which the user has entered an Account Code.  
27  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Call Forwarding key.  
Press key instead of  
pressing INTER-  
Call Forwarding  
COM and dialing *3  
.
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Extension not call forwarded or in the Call Forwarding setup mode.  
Fast Flash. . . . .In the Call Forwarding setup mode.  
Wink Off . . . . . .Extension has Call Forwarding enabled.  
28  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Headset key.  
Press key to enable  
or disable headset  
mode.  
Headset  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Extension is not in the headset mode.  
On . . . . . . . . .Extension is in the headset mode.  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
757  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21xx-Configuration  
212x-Keys  
2121-Feature Keys  
Options  
2121-[01 to 24]: Feature Key Codes  
(Key xx Type)  
Use this option to enter the key codes for an extension’s Feature Keys. Refer to Extension Feature Key  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Default  
• In DSX-80/160, keys 1-12 are line keys for lines 1-12 and keys 13-24 are undened.  
• In DSX-40, keys 1-8 are line keys for lines 1-8 and keys 9-24 are undened.  
• For attendants:  
- Key 12 (on 22-button) or key 24 (on 34-button) is an Operator Call Key.  
2121-[01 to 24]: Feature Key Data  
(Key xx Data)  
Use this option to enter the data (if any) associated with a Feature Key code. Refer to Extension Feature Key  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Default  
• In DSX-80/160, keys 1-12 are line keys for lines 1-12 and keys 13-24 are undened.  
• In DSX-40, keys 1-8 are line keys for lines 1-8 and keys 9-24 are undened.  
• For attendants:  
- Key 12 (on 22-button) or key 24 (on 34-button) is an Operator Call Key.  
758  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
21xx-Configuration  
212x-Keys  
2122-Ring Override (Key Ring Override)  
2122-Ring Override (Key Ring Override)  
Description  
Use this program to set up Distinctive Ringing Key Ring Override at the extension (station).  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2122-[01 to 24]: Key Ring Override  
(Key xx Ring)  
Use this option to set up Key Ring Override from system programming.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for line (follows the setting for the line in 3113-03: Night Ring Type)  
1 for ring type A  
2 for ring type B  
3 for ring type C  
Default  
0  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
759  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
21xx-Configuration  
212x-Keys  
2123-BLF (DSS Keys)  
2123-BLF (DSS Keys)  
Description  
Use this program to set up the station (extension) DSS/BLF keys.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2123-[01-24]: DSS/BLF Key Assignments  
(Key xx Type)  
Use this option to program an extension’s DSS keys. Feature Keys automatically become DSS keys when  
the user press INTERCOM. While in the DSS mode, the extension has one button Intercom access and a  
Busy Lamp Field for the assigned co-worker. By default, BLF keys are undened.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Extension number (0-999) for stations only (not UCD Groups or Ring Groups)  
Undened  
Default  
Undened  
760  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
21xx-Configuration  
212x-Keys  
2124-Soft Keys (Idle Menu Soft Keys for Super Display)  
2124-Soft Keys (Idle Menu Soft Keys for Super Display)  
Description  
Use this program to customize the Super Display Telephone idle menu soft keys.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2124-[01-12]: Idle Menu Soft Key Assignments (Super Display)  
(xx Key xx Type)  
Use this option to customize the Super Display Telephone idle menu soft keys. You can tailor the idle mode  
display to meet the needs of each Super Display Telephone user. The rst chart below shows the default idle  
menu soft key assignments. The second chart shows all the available idle mode soft keys, their denitions,  
and the related programming codes. When an extension’s soft keys are customized, the user must take some  
action at the telephone (such as lifting and replacing the handset) before the change takes effect.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• See the following charts.  
Default  
• See the following charts.  
Super Display Telephone Default Idle Menu Soft Key Assignments  
Key  
Display  
DIRECTORY  
PROGRAM  
V-MAIL --  
Display  
Key  
1
(BLANK)  
7
2
3
4
5
6
(BLANK)  
(BLANK)  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
CALLS --  
SP DIAL 1  
PAGE  
SP DIAL 2  
(BLANK)  
(BLANK)  
Super Display Telephone Idle Menu Soft Key Options (Page 1 of 2)  
Entry  
Display  
Description  
00  
UNDEFINED  
The key has no function and the idle menu display is blank.  
Press to access additional soft keys for Intercom, System Speed Dial,  
and Personal Speed Dial Directory Dialing.  
01  
DIRECTORY  
02  
03  
INTERCOM  
PERSONAL  
Press to directly access Intercom Directory Dialing.  
Press to directly access Personal Speed Dial Directory Dialing.  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
761  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
21xx-Configuration  
212x-Keys  
2124-Soft Keys (Idle Menu Soft Keys for Super Display)  
Super Display Telephone Idle Menu Soft Key Options (Page 2 of 2)  
Entry  
Display  
Description  
04  
05  
COMPANY  
PROGRAM  
Press to directly access System Speed Dial Directory Dialing.  
Press to program the following:  
Call Forwarding  
Call Screening  
Distinctive Ringing  
Handsfree Reply  
Intercom Voice Announce and Forced Intercom Ringing  
Language Selection  
Name Programming  
Speed Dial  
Volume for Ringing, Off-Hook Ringing, and Page  
Press to call your voice mail mailbox. This soft key also shows the  
number of new messages in your mailbox.  
06  
V-MAIL  
Press to review your Caller ID log. This soft key also shows the num-  
ber of new calls you have not yet reviewed.  
07  
08  
09  
CALLS  
PAGE  
Press to initiate a Page announcement.  
Press to access Personal Speed Dial bins 701-710. The display shows  
the Speed Dial numbers (or names - if programmed).  
SP DIAL 1  
Press to access Personal Speed Dial bins 711-720. The display shows  
the Speed Dial number (or name - if programmed).  
SP DIAL 2  
10  
Press to access the associated Personal Speed Dial bin (701-720). The  
display shows the Speed Dial number (or name - if programmed).  
PERS SPDL BIN 1-  
20  
11-30  
762  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21xx-Configuration  
213x-Access  
2131-Lines  
213x1-ALicn ess  
ces  
Description  
Use this program to set up the station (extension) access to outside lines.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2131-[01-64]: Line Access  
(xx Line xx Access)  
Use this option to set the extension’s access options for lines (no access, incoming only, outgoing only, or  
full access).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for no access  
1 for incoming access only  
2 for outgoing access only  
3 for full access  
Default  
3 for all extensions  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
763  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
21xx-Configuration  
213x-Access  
2132-Ringing  
2132-Ringing  
Description  
Use this program to set up the station (extension) ringing for outside lines.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2132-[01-64]: Line Ringing  
(xx Line xx Ring)  
Use this option to set the extension’s ringing assignments for lines (lamp only, day and night ringing, night  
ringing only, and delay ringing day and night).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for lamp only (no ringing) day and night  
1 for day and night ringing  
2 for night ringing only  
3 for delay ringing day and night  
Default  
• DSX-80/160  
1 for extensions 300-315  
0 for all other extensions  
• DSX-40  
1 for all extensions  
764  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
21xx-Configuration  
213x-Access  
2133-Line Groups  
2133-Line Groups  
Description  
Use this option to set the station (extension) access to Line Groups 90-98.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2133-[01-64]: Line Group Access  
(xx Group xx Access)  
Use this option to enable or disable the extension’s outgoing access to each Line Group (90-98).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
765  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
21xx-Configuration  
214x-IntraMail (Station Mailbox)  
2141-Type  
214x1-ITnytpraeMail (Station Mailbox)  
Description  
Use this program to assign the station (extension) mailbox type.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2141-01: Station Mailbox Type  
(Mailbox Type)  
Use this option to set the extension’s mailbox type. The mailbox can be either a personal mailbox (assigned  
just to the extension) or a group mailbox (shared by all members of the extension’s Ring Group). An exten-  
sion’s mailbox is not accessible when it is disabled (even though its stored messages and conguration are  
retained in memory.) If disabled, a user pressing V-MAIL will initiate a remote logon and be asked to enter  
their mailbox number. A voice prompt then announces, “That mailbox does not exist.”  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for personal  
2 for group  
Default  
1  
766  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
21xx-Configuration  
214x-IntraMail (Station Mailbox)  
2142-Setup  
2142-Setup  
Description  
Use this program to set up the Station Mailbox.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2142-01: Number of Messages  
(# of Messages)  
Use this option to set the maximum number of messages that can be left in the Subscriber Mailbox. If a  
caller tries to leave a message once this limit is reached, they hear, “That mailbox is full.IntraMail then  
hangs up. (If a mailbox approaches the message limit as multiple incoming messages are being recorded, it  
may be possible to temporarily receive more than the maximum number of messages.)  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-99 messages  
Default  
20  
2142-02: Message Retention  
(Msg Retention)  
Use this option to determine how long a Subscriber Mailbox will retain saved messages. If a message is left  
in a Subscriber Mailbox longer than this interval, IntraMail deletes it.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
• 1-99 days  
0 for indenite  
Default  
0  
2142-03: System Administrator  
(System Admin)  
Use this option to designate the Subscriber Mailbox as a System Administrator. This allows the subscriber to  
use the SA options after logging onto their mailbox.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
767  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
21xx-Configuration  
214x-IntraMail (Station Mailbox)  
2142-Setup  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
2142-04: Station Mailbox Voice Prompt Language  
(Voice Prompts)  
Use this option to set the Station Mailbox voice prompt language. You can choose either the Primary Lan-  
guage or the Secondary Language. To activate a different primary or Secondary Language, see 4203-Voice  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1 for Primary Language  
2 for Secondary Language  
Default  
1 for Primary Language  
768  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
21xx-Configuration  
214x-IntraMail (Station Mailbox)  
2143-Options  
2143-Options  
Description  
Use this program to customize various Station Mailbox options.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2143-01: Message Playback Order  
(Playback Order)  
Use this option to set the Subscriber Mailbox message playback order. When a subscriber listens to their  
messages, IntraMail can play the oldest messages rst (rst-in-rst-out, or FIFO), or the newest messages  
rst (last-in-rst-out, or LIFO).  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1 for LIFO  
2 for FIFO  
Default  
1  
2143-02: Auto Erase/Save of Messages  
(Auto Erase/Save)  
Use this option to determine what happens when a Subscriber Mailbox user completely listens to a new mes-  
sage and then exits their mailbox without either saving (SA) or erasing (E) the message. Depending on the  
setting of this option, IntraMail will either automatically save or erase the message. If the mailbox user  
hangs up before listening to the entire new message, IntraMail retains the message as a new message.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
• 1 for Auto Save  
2 for Auto Erase  
Default  
1  
2143-03: Auto Time Stamp  
(Auto Time Stamp)  
Use this option to enable or disable Auto Time Stamp for the Subscriber Mailbox. If enabled, after the sub-  
scriber listens to a message IntraMail will announce the time and date the message was left. Auto Time  
Stamp will also announce the message sender (if known).  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
769  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
21xx-Configuration  
214x-IntraMail (Station Mailbox)  
2143-Options  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
770  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21xx-Configuration  
214x-IntraMail (Station Mailbox)  
2143-Options  
2143-04: Message Waiting Lamp  
(MW Lamp)  
Use this option to enable or disable Message Waiting lamping at the extension associated with the Sub-  
scriber mailbox. For Subscriber Mailboxes, you should leave this option enabled. For Guest Mailboxes, you  
should leave this option disabled. Disabling this option will also disable Message Notication.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
2143-05: Recording Conversation Beep  
(Rec Conv Beep)  
Use this option to enable or disable the Conversation Record beep. If enabled, all parties on a call will hear  
the voice prompt “Recording” followed by a beep when the extension user initiates Conversation Record. If  
disabled, the voice prompt will not occur. When you disable the Conversation Record beep, the following  
voice prompts do not occur while IntraMail records the conversation:  
• “Recording” (followed by a beep)  
• “That mailbox is full” (if the mailbox storage capacity is reached)  
• “You have reached the recording limit” (if the recorded message is too long)  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
771  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
21xx-Configuration  
214x-IntraMail (Station Mailbox)  
2144-Auto-Attendant (Automated Attendant)  
2144-Auto-Attendant (Automated Attendant)  
Description  
Use this program to set up the Automated Attendant options for the Station Mailbox.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2144-01: Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb  
(Auto-Att DND)  
Use this option to enable or disable Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb. When a subscriber enables Auto Atten-  
dant Do Not Disturb, an Automated Attendant caller will route directly to the mailbox, hear the greeting, and  
be asked to leave a message.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
2144-02: Forced Unscreened Transfer  
(Force UTRF)  
Use this option to enable or disable Automated Attendant Forced Unscreened Transfer for the Subscriber  
Mailbox. If enabled, each Screened Transfer (STRF) to the extension is converted to an Unscreened Transfer  
(UTRF). If disabled, Screened Transfers from the Automated Attendant occur normally.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
2144-03: Dialing Option  
(Dialing Option)  
Dialing Option provides additional dialing options for Next Call Routing Mailbox calls (see 2144-04: Next  
Call Routing Mailbox below). If enabled, a caller who accesses the Subscriber Mailbox to leave a message  
can dial any of the options in the Next Call Routing Mailbox’s Dial Action Table. If disabled, the caller can  
only dial 0 (to use the Next Call Routing Mailbox’s 0 action).  
Features  
• None  
772  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
21xx-Configuration  
214x-IntraMail (Station Mailbox)  
2144-Auto-Attendant (Automated Attendant)  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
773  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21xx-Configuration  
214x-IntraMail (Station Mailbox)  
2144-Auto-Attendant (Automated Attendant)  
2144-04: Next Call Routing Mailbox  
(Next CRMB)  
Use this option to assign a Next Call Routing Mailbox to the Subscriber Mailbox. This provides callers with  
additional dialing options while listening to a Subscriber Mailbox recorded or default greeting. The digits  
the caller can dial depends on the setting of the Next Call Routing Mailbox and Dialing Option options.  
• For a detailed explanation of the interaction of these two programs, turn to Dialing Options While Lis-  
• For an explanation of the options a caller can dial while recording, see Record and Send a Message  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
• 1-16 for Routing Mailboxes 1-16  
0 for undened  
Default  
1  
2144-05: Directory List Number  
(Directory List)  
Use this option to specify the Directory List to which the Subscriber Mailbox belongs. When setting up  
Directory Dialing Mailboxes, you must specify which Directory List you want the Directory Dialing Mail-  
box to use. The Directory Dialing Mailbox can only call Subscriber Mailboxes that belong to the list it is  
programmed to use.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-8 for Directory List 1-8  
9 for all lists  
0 for no list  
Default  
0  
774  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
21xx-Configuration  
215x-Speed Dial (Personal)  
2151-Assignment (Personal Speed Dial Bin Assignment)  
215x1-SApseseigdnDmieanl t(P(Peresrosonnala)l Speed Dial Bin Assignment)  
Description  
Use this option to enter an extension’s Personal Speed Dial numbers from system programming.  
If programming multiple extensions, you may nd 9021-Station Copy (page 921) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
2151-[01-20]: Personal Speed Dial Bin Type  
(xx Bin xx Type)  
For the Personal Speed Dial bin selected, use this option to select the bin type (none, Intercom, line, or Line  
Group).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for Intercom  
2 for line  
3 for Line Group  
4 for Extend (i.e., the second bin of a chained number)  
Default  
0  
2151-[01-20]: Personal Speed Dial Bin Line  
(xx Bin xx Line)  
For a type 2 (line) Personal Speed Dial bin, use this option to select the line (1-64) the bin will use for an  
outgoing call.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-64 for lines 1-64  
Default  
• No entry  
2151-[01-20]: Personal Speed Dial Bin Group  
(xx Bin xx Group)  
For a type 3 (Line Group) Personal Speed Dial bin, use this option to select the Line Group (90-98) the bin  
will use for an outgoing call.  
Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
775  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
21xx-Configuration  
215x-Speed Dial (Personal)  
2151-Assignment (Personal Speed Dial Bin Assignment)  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
90-98 for Line Groups 90-98  
Default  
• No entry  
2151-[01-20]: Personal Speed Dial Bin Number  
(xx Bin xx Number)  
Use this option to enter the Personal Speed Dial number (normally up to 16 characters). A Personal Speed  
Dial number can be up to 32 digits long, however. The system allows this by automatically using the next  
adjacent bin for entries longer than 16 digits. Flash, Wait, and Pause commands count as a digit.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Numbers (16 max without overowing into next adjacent bin), using 0-9, # and *.  
Flash (press Feature Key 1).  
Wait (press Feature Key 2).  
Pause (press Feature Key 3).  
Default  
• None  
776  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
21xx-Configuration  
215x-Speed Dial (Personal)  
2151-Assignment (Personal Speed Dial Bin Assignment)  
2151-[01-20]: Personal Speed Dial Bin Name  
(xx Bin xx Name)  
Use this option to enter a name (up to 16 characters) for the Personal Speed Dial bin. When entering names,  
use the following Name Programming chart.  
Name Programming Chart  
Press a key the indicated number of times for desired character  
Key  
1 Time  
2 Times  
3 Times  
4 Times  
5 Times  
6 Times  
7 Times  
8 Times  
9 Times  
1
&
-
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
#
*
A
B
E
H
K
N
Q
U
X
:
C
F
I
a
d
g
j
b
e
c
f
2
3
4
5
6
r
D
G
h
k
i
J
M
L
O
R
V
Y
0
l
m
S
t
n
p
u
w
o
q
v
x
P
s
z
7
9
T
8
y
W
Z
space  
Not used  
Not used  
After selecting a letter, press a key for another letter or wait 2 seconds for the cursor to automatically advance.  
Additional Name Programming Options  
HOLD  
Save name.  
SPEAKER  
Volume Up  
Volume Down  
Exit user name programming.  
Scroll the cursor to the right.  
Scroll the cursor to the left.  
While editing, clears character to the right.  
At beginning of line, erases entire entry.  
At end of line, becomes a backspace key  
CLEAR  
CHECK  
Restore the previous entry,  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
777  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
21xx-Configuration  
215x-Speed Dial (Personal)  
2151-Assignment (Personal Speed Dial Bin Assignment)  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Alpha-numeric characters (16 max.). See Name Programming Chart above.  
Default  
• None  
778  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
22xx-Ring Groups  
220x-Setup  
2201-Identification  
22xx-Ring Groups  
220x1-SIdetnutpification  
e
Description  
For each Ring Group, use this program to specify the Ring Group name and Ring Type.  
Options  
2201-01: Ring Group Name  
(Name)  
Use this option to enter a name (up to 16 characters) for the Ring Group. When entering names, use the fol-  
lowing Name Programming chart.  
Name Programming Chart  
Press a key the indicated number of times for desired character  
Key  
1 Time  
2 Times  
3 Times  
4 Times  
5 Times  
6 Times  
7 Times  
8 Times  
9 Times  
1
&
-
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
#
*
A
D
G
J
B
E
H
K
N
Q
U
X
:
C
F
I
a
d
g
j
b
e
c
f
2
3
4
5
6
r
h
k
i
L
O
R
V
Y
0
l
M
P
m
S
t
n
p
u
w
o
q
v
x
s
z
7
9
T
8
y
W
Z
space  
Not used  
Not used  
After selecting a letter, press a key for another letter or wait 2 seconds for the cursor to automatically advance.  
Additional Name Programming Options  
HOLD  
Save name.  
SPEAKER  
Volume Up  
Volume Down  
Exit user name programming.  
Scroll the cursor to the right.  
Scroll the cursor to the left.  
While editing, clears character to the right.  
At beginning of line, erases entire entry.  
At end of line, becomes a backspace key  
CLEAR  
CHECK  
Restore the previous entry,  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
779  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
22xx-Ring Groups  
220x-Setup  
2201-Identification  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Alpha-numeric characters (16 max.). See Name Programming Chart above.  
2201-02: Ring Group Incoming Ring Type  
(Ring Type)  
Use this option to assign a ring type to calls ringing the Ring Group master number. When an extension in  
the Ring Group rings, it uses the ring type specied in this option.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for “Standard” (the system’s default ringing for Ring Group calls which cannot be customized)  
1 for ring type A  
2 for ring type B  
3 for ring type C  
Default  
0  
780  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
22xx-Ring Groups  
221x-IntraMail (Ring Group Mailbox)  
2211-Type  
221x1-ITnytpraeMail (Ring Group Mailbox)  
Description  
Use this program to set the Ring Group Mailbox type.  
Options  
2211-01: Mailbox Type  
(Mailbox Type)  
Use this option to set the Ring Group Mailbox type (Subscriber or Routing).  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
0 for none  
1 of Subscriber  
2 for Routing (as specied in 2211-01: Routing Mailbox Number below)  
Default  
• 1  
2211-01: Routing Mailbox Number  
(Routing MBox #)  
If 2211-01: Mailbox Type is set to 2 (Routing), use this option to specify the Routing Mailbox the system  
will use for the Ring Group Mailbox.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-16 for Routing Mailboxes 1-16  
Default  
1  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
781  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
22xx-Ring Groups  
221x-IntraMail (Ring Group Mailbox)  
2212-Setup  
2212-Setup  
Description  
Use this program to set up the Ring Group Mailbox.  
Options  
2212-01: Number of Messages  
(# of Messages)  
Use this option to set the maximum number of messages that can be left in the Subscriber Mailbox. If a  
caller tries to leave a message once this limit is reached, they hear, “That mailbox is full.IntraMail then  
hangs up.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-99 messages  
Default  
• 20  
2212-02: Message Retention  
(Msg Retention)  
Use this option to determine how long a Subscriber Mailbox will retain saved messages. If a message is left  
in a Subscriber Mailbox longer than this interval, IntraMail deletes it.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
• 1-99 days  
0 for indenite  
Default  
0  
2212-03: System Administrator  
(System Admin)  
Use this option to designate the Subscriber Mailbox as a System Administrator. This allows the subscriber to  
use the SA options after logging onto their mailbox.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
782  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
22xx-Ring Groups  
221x-IntraMail (Ring Group Mailbox)  
2212-Setup  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
2212-04: Ring Group Mailbox Voice Prompt Language  
(Voice Prompts)  
Use this option to set the Ring Group Mailbox voice prompt language. You can choose either the Primary  
Language or the Secondary Language. To activate a different primary or Secondary Language, see 4203-  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1 for Primary Language  
2 for Secondary Language  
Default  
1 for Primary Language  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
783  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
22xx-Ring Groups  
221x-IntraMail (Ring Group Mailbox)  
2213-Options  
2213-Options  
Description  
Use this program to customize various Ring Group Mailbox options.  
Options  
2213-01: Message Playback Order  
(Playback Order)ƒ  
Use this option to set the Subscriber Mailbox message playback order. When a subscriber listens to their  
messages, IntraMail can play the oldest messages rst (rst-in-rst-out, or FIFO), or the newest messages  
rst (last-in-rst-out, or LIFO).  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1 for LIFO  
2 for FIFO  
Default  
1  
2213-02: Auto Erase/Save of Messages  
(Auto Save/Erase)  
Use this option to determine what happens when a Subscriber Mailbox user completely listens to a new mes-  
sage and then exits their mailbox without either saving (SA) or erasing (E) the message. Depending on the  
setting of this option, IntraMail will either automatically save or erase the message. If the mailbox user  
hangs up before listening to the entire new message, IntraMail retains the message as a new message.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
• 1 for Auto Save  
2 for Auto Erase  
Default  
1  
784  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
22xx-Ring Groups  
221x-IntraMail (Ring Group Mailbox)  
2213-Options  
2213-03: Auto Time Stamp  
(Auto Time Stamp)  
Use this option to enable or disable Auto Time Stamp for the Subscriber Mailbox. If enabled, after the sub-  
scriber listens to a message IntraMail will announce the time and date the message was left. Auto Time  
Stamp will also announce the message sender (if known).  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
2213-04: Message Waiting Lamp  
(MW Lamp)  
Use this option to enable or disable Message Waiting lamping at the extension associated with the Sub-  
scriber mailbox. For Subscriber Mailboxes, you should leave this option enabled. For Guest Mailboxes, you  
should leave this option disabled. Disabling this option will also disable Message Notication.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
785  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
22xx-Ring Groups  
221x-IntraMail (Ring Group Mailbox)  
2213-Options  
2213-05: Recording Conversation Beep  
(Rec Conv Beep)  
Use this option to enable or disable the Conversation Record beep. If enabled, all parties on a call will hear  
the voice prompt “Recording” followed by a beep when the extension user initiates Conversation Record. If  
disabled, the voice prompt will not occur. When you disable the Conversation Record beep, the following  
voice prompts do not occur while IntraMail records the conversation:  
• “Recording” (followed by a beep)  
• “That mailbox is full” (if the mailbox message storage capacity is reached)  
• “You have reached the recording limit” (if the recorded message is too long)  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
786  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
22xx-Ring Groups  
221x-IntraMail (Ring Group Mailbox)  
2214-Auto-Attendant (Automated Attendant)  
2214-Auto-Attendant (Automated Attendant)  
Description  
Use this program to set up the Automated Attendant options for the Ring Group Mailbox.  
Options  
2214-01: Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb  
(Auto-Att DND)  
Use this option to enable or disable Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb. When a subscriber enables Auto Atten-  
dant Do Not Disturb, an Automated Attendant caller will route directly to the mailbox, hear the greeting, and  
be asked to leave a message.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
2214-02: Forced Unscreened Transfer  
(Force UTRF)  
Use this option to enable or disable Automated Attendant Forced Unscreened Transfer for the Subscriber  
Mailbox. If enabled, each Screened Transfer (STRF) to the extension is converted to an Unscreened Transfer  
(UTRF). If disabled, Screened Transfers from the Automated Attendant occur normally.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
787  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
22xx-Ring Groups  
221x-IntraMail (Ring Group Mailbox)  
2214-Auto-Attendant (Automated Attendant)  
2214-03: Dialing Option  
(Dialing Option)  
Dialing Option provides additional dialing options for Next Call Routing Mailbox calls (see 2214-04: Next  
Call Routing Mailbox below). If enabled, a caller who accesses the Subscriber Mailbox to leave a message  
can dial any of the options in the Next Call Routing Mailbox’s Dial Action Table. If disabled, the caller can  
only dial 0 (to use the Next Call Routing Mailbox’s 0 action).  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
2214-04: Next Call Routing Mailbox  
(Next CRMB)  
Use this option to assign a Next Call Routing Mailbox to the Subscriber Mailbox. This provides callers with  
additional dialing options while listening to a Subscriber Mailbox recorded or default greeting. The digits  
the caller can dial depends on the setting of the Next Call Routing Mailbox and Dialing Option options.  
• For a detailed explanation of the interaction of these two programs, turn to Dialing Options While Lis-  
• For an explanation of the options a caller can dial while recording, see Record and Send a Message  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
• 1-16 for Routing Mailboxes 1-16  
0 for undened  
Default  
0  
788  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
22xx-Ring Groups  
221x-IntraMail (Ring Group Mailbox)  
2214-Auto-Attendant (Automated Attendant)  
2214-05: Directory List Number  
(Directory List)  
Use this option to specify the Directory List to which the Subscriber Mailbox belongs. When setting up  
Directory Dialing Mailboxes, you must specify which Directory List you want the Directory Dialing Mail-  
box to use. The Directory Dialing Mailbox can only call Subscriber Mailboxes that belong to the list it is  
programmed to use.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-8 for Directory List 1-8  
9 for all lists  
0 for no list  
Default  
0  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
789  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
23xx-UCD Groups  
230x-Setup  
2301-Identification  
23xx-UCD Groups  
230x1-SIdeetnutpification  
Description  
For each UCD Group, use this program to specify the UCD Group name and Ring Type.  
Options  
2301-01: UCD Group Name  
(Name)  
Use this option to enter a name (up to 16 characters) for the UCD Group. When entering names, use the fol-  
lowing Name Programming chart.  
Name Programming Chart  
Press a key the indicated number of times for desired character  
Key  
1 Time  
2 Times  
3 Times  
4 Times  
5 Times  
6 Times  
7 Times  
8 Times  
9 Times  
1
&
-
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
#
*
A
D
G
J
B
E
H
K
N
Q
U
X
:
C
F
I
a
d
g
j
b
e
c
f
2
3
4
5
6
r
h
k
i
L
O
R
V
Y
0
l
M
P
m
S
t
n
p
u
w
o
q
v
x
s
z
7
9
T
8
y
W
Z
space  
Not used  
Not used  
After selecting a letter, press a key for another letter or wait 2 seconds for the cursor to automatically advance.  
Additional Name Programming Options  
HOLD  
Save name.  
SPEAKER  
Volume Up  
Volume Down  
Exit user name programming.  
Scroll the cursor to the right.  
Scroll the cursor to the left.  
While editing, clears character to the right.  
At beginning of line, erases entire entry.  
At end of line, becomes a backspace key  
CLEAR  
CHECK  
Restore the previous entry,  
790  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
23xx-UCD Groups  
230x-Setup  
2301-Identification  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Alpha-numeric characters (16 max.). See Name Programming Chart above.  
2301-02: UCD Group Incoming Ring Type  
(Ring Type)  
Use this option to assign a ring type to calls ringing the UCD Group master number. When an extension in  
the UCD Group rings, it uses the ring type specied in this option.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for “Standard” (the system’s default ringing for UCD Group calls which cannot be customized)  
1 for ring type A  
2 for ring type B  
3 for ring type C  
Default  
0  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
791  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
23xx-UCD Groups  
230x-Setup  
2302-Options  
2302-Options  
Description  
Use this program to specify the UCD Group overow destination.  
Options  
2302-01: UCD Group Overow Destination  
(Overow Dest)  
Use this option to assign the UCD Group overow destination.  
Features  
Features  
• None  
Options  
• Extension number  
UCD Group master number (700-707)  
Voice mail master number (700)  
Ring Group master number (600-607)  
None (by pressing CLEAR)  
Default  
• None  
792  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
23xx-UCD Groups  
231x-IntraMail (UCD Group Mailbox)  
2311-Type  
231x1-ITnytpraeMail (UCD Group Mailbox)  
Description  
Use this program to set the UCD Group Mailbox type.  
2311-01: UCD Group Mailbox Type  
(Mailbox Type)  
Use this option to set the UCD Group Mailbox type (Subscriber or Routing).  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
0 for none  
1 of Subscriber  
2 for Routing (as specied in 2311-01: UCD Group Routing Mailbox Number below)  
Default  
• 1  
2311-01: UCD Group Routing Mailbox Number  
(Routing Mailbox #)  
If 2311-01: UCD Group Mailbox Type is set to 2 (Routing), use this option to specify the Routing Mailbox  
the system will use for the UCD Group Mailbox.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-16 for Routing Mailboxes 1-16  
Default  
1  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
793  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
23xx-UCD Groups  
231x-IntraMail (UCD Group Mailbox)  
2312-Setup  
2312-Setup  
Description  
Use this program to set up the UCD Group Mailbox.  
Options  
2312-01: Number of Messages  
(# of Messages)  
Use this option to set the maximum number of messages that can be left in the Subscriber Mailbox. If a  
caller tries to leave a message once this limit is reached, they hear, “That mailbox is full.IntraMail then  
hangs up.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-99 messages  
Default  
• 20  
2312-02: Message Retention  
(Msg Retention)  
Use this option to determine how long a Subscriber Mailbox will retain saved messages. If a message is left  
in a Subscriber Mailbox longer than this interval, IntraMail deletes it.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
• 1-99 days  
0 for indenite  
Default  
0  
2312-03: System Administrator  
(System Admin)  
Use this option to designate the Subscriber Mailbox as a System Administrator. This allows the subscriber to  
use the SA options after logging onto their mailbox.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
794  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
23xx-UCD Groups  
231x-IntraMail (UCD Group Mailbox)  
2312-Setup  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
2312-04: UCD Group Mailbox Voice Prompt Language  
(Voice Prompts)  
Use this option to set the UCD Group Mailbox voice prompt language. You can choose either the Primary  
Language or the Secondary Language. To activate a different primary or Secondary Language, see 4203-  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1 for Primary Language  
2 for Secondary Language  
Default  
1 for Primary Language  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
795  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
23xx-UCD Groups  
231x-IntraMail (UCD Group Mailbox)  
2313-Playback  
2313-Playback  
Description  
Use this program to customize various UCD Group Mailbox options.  
Options  
2313-01: Message Playback Order  
(Playback Order)  
Use this option to set the Subscriber Mailbox message playback order. When a subscriber listens to their  
messages, IntraMail can play the oldest messages rst (rst-in-rst-out, or FIFO), or the newest messages  
rst (last-in-rst-out, or LIFO).  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1 for LIFO  
2 for FIFO  
Default  
1  
2313-02: Auto Erase/Save of Messages  
(Auto Save/Erase)  
Use this option to determine what happens when a Subscriber Mailbox user completely listens to a new mes-  
sage and then exits their mailbox without either saving (SA) or erasing (E) the message. Depending on the  
setting of this option, IntraMail will either automatically save or erase the message. If the mailbox user  
hangs up before listening to the entire new message, IntraMail retains the message as a new message.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
• 1 for Auto Save  
2 for Auto Erase  
Default  
1  
2313-03: Auto Time Stamp  
(Auto Time Stamp)  
Use this option to enable or disable Auto Time Stamp for the Subscriber Mailbox. If enabled, after the sub-  
scriber listens to a message IntraMail will announce the time and date the message was left. Auto Time  
Stamp will also announce the message sender (if known).  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
796  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
23xx-UCD Groups  
231x-IntraMail (UCD Group Mailbox)  
2313-Playback  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
2313-04: Message Waiting Lamp  
(MW Lamp)  
Use this option to enable or disable Message Waiting lamping at the extension associated with the Sub-  
scriber mailbox. For Subscriber Mailboxes, you should leave this option enabled. Disabling this option will  
also disable Message Notication.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
2313-05: Recording Conversation Beep  
(Rec Conv Beep)  
Use this option to enable or disable the Conversation Record beep. If enabled, all parties on a call will hear  
the voice prompt “Recording” followed by a beep when the extension user initiates Conversation Record. If  
disabled, the voice prompt will not occur. When you disable the Conversation Record beep, the following  
voice prompts do not occur while IntraMail records the conversation:  
• “Recording” (followed by a beep)  
• “That mailbox is full” (if the mailbox message storage capacity is reached)  
• “You have reached the recording limit” (if the recorded message is too long)  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
797  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
23xx-UCD Groups  
231x-IntraMail (UCD Group Mailbox)  
2314-(Auto-Attendant) Automated Attendant  
2314-(Auto-Attendant) Automated Attendant  
Description  
Use this program to set up the Automated Attendant options for the UCD Group Mailbox.  
Options  
2314-01: Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb  
(Auto-Att DND)  
Use this option to enable or disable Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb for the Hunt Group Mailbox. When a  
subscriber enables Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb, an Automated Attendant caller will route directly to the  
mailbox, hear the greeting, and be asked to leave a message.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
2314-02: Forced Unscreened Transfer  
(Force UTRF)  
Use this option to enable or disable Automated Attendant Forced Unscreened Transfer for the Subscriber  
Mailbox. If enabled, each Screened Transfer (STRF) to the mailbox is converted to an Unscreened Transfer  
(UTRF). If disabled, Screened Transfers from the Automated Attendant occur normally.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
2314-03: Dialing Option  
(Dialing Option)  
Dialing Option provides additional dialing options for Next Call Routing Mailbox calls (see 2314-03: Dial-  
ing Option below). If enabled, a caller who accesses the Subscriber Mailbox to leave a message can dial any  
of the options in the Next Call Routing Mailbox’s Dial Action Table. If disabled, the caller can only dial 0 (to  
use the Next Call Routing Mailbox’s 0 action).  
Features  
• None  
798  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
23xx-UCD Groups  
231x-IntraMail (UCD Group Mailbox)  
2314-(Auto-Attendant) Automated Attendant  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
2314-04: Next Call Routing Mailbox  
(Next CRMB)  
Use this option to assign a Next Call Routing Mailbox to the Subscriber Mailbox. This provides callers with  
additional dialing options while listening to a Subscriber Mailbox recorded or default greeting. The digits  
the caller can dial depends on the setting of the Next Call Routing Mailbox and Dialing Option options.  
• For a detailed explanation of the interaction of these two programs, turn to Dialing Options While Lis-  
• For an explanation of the options a caller can dial while recording, see Record and Send a Message  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
• 1-16 for Routing Mailboxes 1-16  
0 for undened  
Default  
0  
2314-05: Directory List Number  
(Directory List)  
Use this option to specify the Directory List to which the Subscriber Mailbox belongs. When setting up  
Directory Dialing Mailboxes, you must specify which Directory List you want the Directory Dialing Mail-  
box to use. The Directory Dialing Mailbox can only call Subscriber Mailboxes that belong to the list it is  
programmed to use.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-8 for Directory List 1-8  
9 for all lists  
0 for no list  
Default  
0  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
799  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
24xx-DSS Consoles  
240x-Setup  
2401-Config (DSS Console Configuration)  
24xx-DSS Consoles  
240x1-SCeotn  
u
p
g
(DSS Console Configuration)  
Description  
Use this program to designate an owner for each DSS Console.  
Options  
2401-01: DSS Owner  
(DSS Owner)  
For each DSS Console, use this option to assign the console owner. The owner is the keyset using the DSS  
Console. A DSS Console can only have one owner.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
Extension using 0-999  
Default  
300 (for console 1).  
800  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
24xx-DSS Consoles  
240x-Setup  
2402-Keys (DSS Console Keys)  
2402-Keys (DSS Console Keys)  
Description  
Use this program to designate the Feature Keys for each DSS Console.  
2402-[01-60]: DSS Console Key Codes  
(Key xx Type)  
Use this option to enter the key codes for the DSS Console’s Feature Keys. Refer to DSS Console Feature  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Default  
2402-[01-60]: DSS Console Key Data  
(Key xx Data  
Use this option to enter the data (if any) associated with a Feature Key code. Refer to DSS Console Feature  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Default  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
801  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
24xx-DSS Consoles  
240x-Setup  
2402-Keys (DSS Console Keys)  
The following chart shows the available DSS Console Feature Key assignments.  
DSS Console Feature Key Assignments (Page 1 of 4)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
00  
Operation  
Use this option to designate a Feature Key as  
undened (no function).  
N/A  
Undened  
03 + nn (line  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
line key.  
Press the key to  
place or answer call.  
Line  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Line is idle or not installed.  
On . . . . . . . . .Line is busy.  
Slow Flash . . . .Line is ringing.  
04 + n (Park Orbit  
60-69)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Park Orbit key.  
Press key to Park or  
retrieve parked call.  
Park Orbit  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Orbit is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . .Orbit is holding a parked call.  
Wink On . . . . . .Orbit is holding a call you parked.  
05 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Hotline key. You cannot set up a hotline for an  
outside line.  
Press key to call  
Hotline partner.  
Hotline  
A DSS Console can also have a Hotline key for  
a line (e.g., 101). However, this capability  
requires that Direct Line Access be enabled for  
the extension. See Direct Line Access  
(page 115) for more.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Partner extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . .Partner extension is busy or ringing.  
Fast Flash. . . . .Partner extension is in Do Not Disturb.  
06 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as an  
immediately ringing Call Coverage Key.  
Press key to call cov-  
ered extension or  
pick up ringing call.  
Call Coverage  
Immediate Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Covered extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . .Covered extension is busy.  
Fast Flash. . . . .Covered extension is in Do Not Disturb.  
Slow Flash . . . .Covered extension is ringing.  
802  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
24xx-DSS Consoles  
240x-Setup  
2402-Keys (DSS Console Keys)  
DSS Console Feature Key Assignments (Page 2 of 4)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
Operation  
07 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
lamp only (no ring) Call Coverage Key.  
Press key to call cov-  
ered extension or  
pick up ringing call.  
Call Coverage No  
Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Covered extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . .Covered extension is busy.  
Fast Flash. . . . .Covered extension is in Do Not Disturb.  
Slow Flash . . . .Covered extension is ringing.  
08 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
delayed ringing Call Coverage Key.  
Press key to call cov-  
ered extension or  
pick up ringing call.  
Call Coverage  
Delay Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Covered extension is idle.  
On . . . . . . . . .Covered extension is busy.  
Fast Flash. . . . .Covered extension is in Do Not Disturb.  
Slow Flash . . . .Covered extension is ringing.  
09 + nn (Pickup  
Group 01-16)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as an  
immediately ringing Group Call Pickup key.  
Press key to answer  
call ringing Pickup  
Group.  
Group Pickup  
Immediate Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .No call is ringing the pickup group.  
Slow Flash . . . .A call is ringing the pickup group.  
10 + nn (Pickup  
Group 01-16)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
lamp only (no ring) Group Call Pickup key.  
Press key to answer  
call ringing Pickup  
Group.  
Group Pickup No  
Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .No call is ringing the pickup group.  
Slow Flash . . . .A call is ringing the pickup group.  
11 + nn (Pickup  
Group 01-16)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
delay ring Group Call Pickup key.  
Press key to answer  
call ringing Pickup  
Group.  
Group Pickup  
Delay Ring  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .No call is ringing the pickup group.  
Slow Flash . . . .A call is ringing the pickup group.  
13 + n (Page Zone 1-  
7, 0 for All Call)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Page Zone key.  
Press key to Page  
into assigned zone.  
Page Zone  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
On . . . . . . . . .The assigned Page zone is busy.  
Off . . . . . . . . .The assigned Page zone is idle.  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
803  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
24xx-DSS Consoles  
240x-Setup  
2402-Keys (DSS Console Keys)  
DSS Console Feature Key Assignments (Page 3 of 4)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
Operation  
14 + nnn (bin 001-  
999)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
System Speed Dial key. You assign the key to  
specic System Speed Dial bin.  
Press key to dial  
stored number.  
System Speed  
Dial  
• There is no BLF for this key type.  
15 + nnn (bin 1-20)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Personal Speed Dial key.You assign the key to  
a specic Personal Speed Dial bin.  
Press key to dial  
stored number.  
Personal Speed  
Dial  
• There is no BLF for this key type.  
17 + nnn (extension  
number of valid Sub-  
scriber Mailbox)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Voice Mail Record key.  
Press key to record  
conversation into  
mailbox.  
Voice Mail  
Record  
You must have voice mail installed to  
use this key.  
• A voice prompt and periodic beep will  
remind you that your calls are being  
recorded.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
On . . . . . . . . .Conversation Record is being set up.  
Off . . . . . . . . .Conversation Record is off.  
Fast Flash. . . . .Conversation Record is on.  
18 + CLEAR  
(System Night key)  
18 + UCD Group  
master number  
(UCD Night key)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Night key. There are two options: System  
Night key and UCD Night key. The System  
Night key puts all Key Ring lines and lines  
terminated to Ring Group master numbers  
into the night mode. The UCD Night key puts  
all lines terminated to the UCD Group master  
number into the night mode.  
Press key to put Key  
Ring lines and lines  
terminated to Ring  
Group master into  
night mode.  
Night  
OR  
Press key to put  
lines terminated to  
UCD master into  
night mode.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
On . . . . . . . . .Night mode is on.  
Off . . . . . . . . .Night mode is off.  
20  
21  
Use this option to assign a programmable key  
as a Split key.  
Split  
Use this option to assign a programmable key  
as an Intercom Directory Dialing key.  
Press key to access  
Intercom Directory  
Dialing.  
Intercom  
Directory Dialing  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
On . . . . . . . . .Intercom Directory Dialing is active (being used).  
Off . . . . . . . . .Intercom Directory Dialing is inactive (off).  
804  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
24xx-DSS Consoles  
240x-Setup  
2402-Keys (DSS Console Keys)  
DSS Console Feature Key Assignments (Page 4 of 4)  
Key Type  
Description  
Key Code and Data  
Operation  
24 + nnn (extension  
number)  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Message Center key.  
Press key to call  
Message Center  
Mailbox.  
Message Center  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .No messages waiting in the Message Center Mailbox.  
Fast Flash. . . . .Messages waiting in the Message Center Mailbox.  
25  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Save Number Dialed key.  
• There is no BLF for this key type.  
While on a call:  
Save Number  
Dialed  
Press key to save  
the number you just  
dialed.  
While idle:  
Press key to redial a  
previously saved  
number.  
26  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as an  
Account Code key.  
1. Place or answer out-  
side call.  
Account Code  
2. Press key.  
3. Enter Account Code.  
4. Press key to return to  
the call.  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Not in Account Code mode or not entering Account Codes.  
Fast Flash. . . . .In the Account Code entry mode.  
On . . . . . . . . .On a call for which the user has entered an Account Code.  
27  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Call Forwarding key.  
Press key instead of  
pressing INTER-  
Call Forwarding  
COM and dialing *3  
.
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Extension not call forwarded or in the Call Forwarding setup mode.  
Fast Flash. . . . .In the Call Forwarding setup mode.  
Wink Off . . . . . .Extension has Call Forwarding enabled.  
28  
Use this option to assign a Feature Key as a  
Headset key.  
Press key to enable  
or disable headset  
mode.  
Headset  
Busy Lamp Field (BLF)  
Off . . . . . . . . .Extension is not in the headset mode.  
On . . . . . . . . .Extension is in the headset mode.  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
805  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
25xx-Text Messages (Selectable Display Messaging)  
250x-Setup  
2501-Text  
25xx-Text Messages (Selectable Display Messaging)  
250x1-STeextut p  
Description  
Use this program to customize the Selectable Display Messages.  
Options  
2501-[01-16]: Selectable Display Messages  
(Message Text)  
Use this option to program the system’s 16 Selectable Display Messages. Each message can be up to 18  
characters long, including any blank spaces you may want to add for readability. All messages are append-  
able by user-entered digits. When entering names, use the Name Programming Chart (page 807). When cre-  
ating a new user-appendable message, consider adding a space at the end of the text portion to improve  
readability. In the table below, the X characters reserve space for user-entered digits.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Default  
Option  
Default  
Message 01  
Message 02  
Message 03  
Message 04  
Message 05  
Message 06  
Message 07  
Message 08  
Message 09  
Message 10  
Message 11  
Message 12  
Message 13  
Message 14  
Message 15  
CALL (plus 13 user entries)  
BACK BY (plus 10 user entries)  
MEETING IN ROOM (plus 2 user entries)  
OUT TO LUNCH (plus 5 user entries)  
GONE FOR THE DAY (plus 1 user entries)  
ON VACATION (plus 6 user entries)  
ON BUSINESS TRIP (plus 1 user entries)  
IN A MEETING (plus 5 user entries)  
OUT UNTIL (plus 8 user entries)  
Undened (up to 18 characters)  
Undened (up to 18 characters)  
Undened (up to 18 characters)  
Undened (up to 18 characters)  
Undened (up to 18 characters)  
Undened (up to 18 characters)  
806  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
25xx-Text Messages (Selectable Display Messaging)  
250x-Setup  
2501-Text  
Option  
Default  
Message 16  
Undened (up to 18 characters)  
Name Programming Chart  
Name Programming Chart  
Press a key the indicated number of times for desired character  
Key  
1 Time  
2 Times  
3 Times  
4 Times  
5 Times  
6 Times  
7 Times  
8 Times  
9 Times  
1
&
-
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
#
*
A
B
E
H
K
N
Q
U
X
:
C
F
I
a
d
g
j
b
e
c
f
2
3
4
5
6
r
D
G
h
k
i
J
M
L
O
R
V
Y
0
l
m
S
t
n
p
u
w
o
q
v
x
P
s
z
7
9
T
8
y
W
Z
space  
Not used  
Not used  
After selecting a letter, press a key for another letter or wait 2 seconds for the cursor to automatically advance.  
Additional Name Programming Options  
HOLD  
Save name.  
SPEAKER  
Volume Up  
Volume Down  
Exit user name programming.  
Scroll the cursor to the right.  
Scroll the cursor to the left.  
While editing, clears character to the right.  
At beginning of line, erases entire entry.  
At end of line, becomes a backspace key  
CLEAR  
CHECK  
Restore the previous entry,  
DSX Software Manual  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
807  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
25xx-Text Messages (Selectable Display Messaging)  
250x-Setup  
2501-Text  
808  
Station Options: 2101-2501  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
31xx-Configuration  
310x-Setup  
3101-Type  
Lines: 3101-3715  
31xx-Conguration  
310x1-STyeptuep  
Description  
Use this program to set the line circuit type, name, PBX option, and E1 signaling (for Latin America instal-  
lations only).  
If programming multiple lines, you may nd 9022-Line Copy (page 923) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
3101-01: Line Type  
(Type)  
Use this option to set the line’s circuit type for compatibility with the connected telco or PBX.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
00 for uninstalled  
01 for Loop start  
02 for Ground Start1  
03 for DID Wink Start1  
04 for DID Immediate Start1  
05 for E&M Wink Start1  
06 for E&M Immediate Start1  
1
Requires T1 PCB.  
Default  
• 51  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
809  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
31xx-Configuration  
310x-Setup  
3101-Type  
3101-02: Line Name  
(Name)  
Use this option to assign a name (up to 16 characters) to the line.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• See the Name Programming Chart on the next page.  
Default  
• No names entered.  
Name Programming Chart  
Press a key the indicated number of times for desired character  
Key  
1 Time  
2 Times  
3 Times  
4 Times  
5 Times  
6 Times  
7 Times  
8 Times  
9 Times  
1
&
-
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
#
*
A
B
E
H
K
N
Q
U
X
:
C
F
I
a
d
g
j
b
e
c
f
2
3
4
5
6
r
D
G
h
k
i
J
M
L
O
R
V
Y
0
l
m
S
t
n
p
u
w
o
q
v
x
P
s
z
7
9
T
8
y
W
Z
space  
Not used  
Not used  
After selecting a letter, press a key for another letter or wait 2 seconds for the cursor to automatically advance.  
Additional Name Programming Options  
HOLD  
Save name.  
SPEAKER  
Volume Up  
Volume Down  
Exit user name programming.  
Scroll the cursor to the right.  
Scroll the cursor to the left.  
While editing, clears character to the right.  
At beginning of line, erases entire entry.  
At end of line, becomes a backspace key  
CLEAR  
CHECK  
Restore the previous entry,  
810  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
31xx-Configuration  
310x-Setup  
3101-Type  
3101-03: DTMF Dialing  
(DTMF Dialing)  
Use this option to set the type of dialing used by the line (DTMF or Dial Pulse).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Dial Pulse  
Yes (1) - DTMF  
Default  
Yes (1) - DTMF  
3101-04: PBX Line  
(PBX Line)  
Use this option to designate a line as a PBX line. Enable this option if the line connects to a PBX instead of  
the telco.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
3101-05: E1 Signaling Type  
(E1 Signaling)  
For E1 lines only, use this option to specify the E1 Signal Type 0-9. Set this option for compatibility with the  
connected telco.  
Features  
• N/A  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for Q.421  
1 for Q.421 Pls Clear  
2 for Q.421 Pls Answer  
3 for Brazil #1  
4 for Brazil #2  
5 for Brazil #3  
6 for Brazil #4  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
811  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
31xx-Configuration  
310x-Setup  
3101-Type  
7 for Brazil #5  
8 for Brazil #6  
Default  
0  
3101-06: MFC Signaling Type  
(MFC Signaling)  
For E1 lines only, use this option to specify the MFC Dialing Type.  
Features  
• N/A  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for MFC not used  
1 for ITU  
2 for Argentina  
3 for Brazil  
4 for Chile  
5 for Columbia  
6 for Mexico  
7 for Venezuela  
Default  
0  
812  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
31xx-Configuration  
310x-Setup  
3102-Access  
3102-Access  
Description  
Use this program to set the line Class of Service and Toll Level.  
If programming multiple lines, you may nd 9022-Line Copy (page 923) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
3102-01: Line Class of Service  
(COS Level)  
Use this option to assign the line’s Class of Service.  
Features  
• See the Features for each option in 14xx-COS (Class of Service) (page 628).  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 1-15  
Default  
• 1  
3102-02: Line Toll Level  
(COS Level)  
Use this option to set the toll level for the line. If this toll level is higher than the extension’s toll level, it may  
cause additional dialing restrictions. If it is lower, it will have no effect.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0-7 for toll levels 0-7  
Default  
0  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
813  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
31xx-Configuration  
310x-Setup  
3103-Settings  
3103-Settings  
Description  
Use this program to customize basic settings for the line.  
If programming multiple lines, you may nd 9022-Line Copy (page 923) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
3103-01:Transmit Gain  
(Transmit Gain)  
Use this option to set the line’s transmit gain. This gain setting allows you to compensate for the transmit  
gain characteristics of the connected telco or PBX. The setting is applied to each line seizure.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0-30 (0 dB to 30 dB gain in .5 dB steps)  
31-60 (.5 dB loss to 15 dB loss in .5 dB steps)  
Default  
• 0  
3103-02: Receive Gain  
(Receive Gain)  
Use this option to set the line’s receive gain. This gain setting allows you to compensate for the receive gain  
characteristics of the connected telco or PBX. The setting is applied to each line siezure.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0-30 (0 dB to 30 dB gain in .5 dB steps)  
31-60 (.5 dB loss to 15 dB loss in .5 dB steps)  
Default  
• 0  
814  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
31xx-Configuration  
310x-Setup  
3103-Settings  
3103-03: Loop Length  
(Loop Length)  
Use this option to compensate for a line’s loop length. Use the default option for normal installations. Use  
the short option only when the system is very close to the central ofce or behind a PBX. Use the long  
option when the loop length is abnormally long.  
Set this option for optimal speakerphone performance.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for default (normal)  
1 for short loop  
2 for long loop  
Default  
• 0  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
815  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
31xx-Configuration  
310x-Setup  
3103-Settings  
3103-04:Tandem Calls  
(Tandem Calls)  
Use this option to enable or disable Tandem Calls for the line.  
Enable Tandem Calls for lines if Off Premises Call Forwarding should be able to route incoming calls to an  
off-premises location. The originating line (i.e., the line that Off Premises Call Forwarding will reroute)  
must have this option enabled. If enabled, the system can forward an incoming over a second line to an off-  
premise number. If disabled, line-to-line forwarding cannot occur. This option is not required when the sys-  
tem is forwarding Intercom calls off-premises. When this option is disabled (N), the system will immediately  
route a line ringing an OPX Call Forwarded extension to Key Ring. It will not attempt to reroute the call.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
3103-05: Music On Hold Source  
(MOH Source)  
Use this option to assign the Music on Hold music source.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
0 for none.  
1 for audio input minijack 1.  
2 for audio input minijack 2.  
3 for internal tone 1.  
4 for internal tone 2.  
5 for IntraMail Message On Hold. See Message On Hold (page 541) for more.  
Default  
816  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
31xx-Configuration  
311x-Options  
3111-Features  
311x1-OFepatitounress  
Description  
Use this program to enable or disable various line features.  
If programming multiple lines, you may nd 9022-Line Copy (page 923) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
3111-01: Disable Forced Account Codes  
(Disable Forced AC)  
Use this option to enable or disable Forced Account Codes for an individual line. If enabled, the system will  
not enforce Forced Account Codes for the line. If disabled, the system will enforce Forced Account Codes  
for the line.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
3111-02: Override Extension’s Toll Level  
(Override Ext Toll)  
Use this option to “release” the Toll Restriction on a line. If enabled, any user can dial any number on the  
line without restriction.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
3111-03: Dial Tone Detection  
(Dialtone Detect)  
Use this option to enable or disable Dial Tone Detection for the line.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
817  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
31xx-Configuration  
311x-Options  
3111-Features  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
3111-04: Enable MFC Group B  
(MFC Group B)  
For E1 lines only, use this option to enable or disable the MFC Dialing Group B supervisory signaling. Since  
not all central ofces provide Group B signaling, set this option for compatibility with the connected telco.  
Features  
• N/A  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
3111-05: Store and Forward  
(Store and Forward)  
Use this option to enable or disable Store and Forward for every line in the line group the user will access  
when they dial a line access code or press a loop key. If enabled, the system buffers the user-dialed digits and  
dials them on the line when the user has completed dialing. If disabled, manually dialed digits output on the  
line as the user dials them. You should enable store and forward for every line in accessed line group.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
3111-06: Station Message Detail Recording  
(SMDR)  
Use this option to enable or disable SMDR reporting for the line. If enabled, the SMDR report includes data  
for the line. If disabled, the SMDR report does not include data for the line.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
818  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
31xx-Configuration  
311x-Options  
3112-Termination  
3112-Termination  
Description  
Use this program to set the line termination options.  
If programming multiple lines, you may nd 9022-Line Copy (page 923) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
3112-01: Direct Termination in the Day  
(Day Termination)  
Use this option to set the day termination (answering point) for the line. If the line is a Direct Inward Line, it  
rings the answering point directly during the day.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
Extension number (0-999)  
UCD Group master number (700-707)  
Voice mail master number (700)  
Ring Group master number (600-607)  
Key Ring (entered by pressing CLEAR).  
Default  
• Key Ring  
3112-02: Enable Day Overow  
(Day Overow)  
Use this option to enable or disable day mode overow for the line.  
If disabled, an unanswered DID call during the day diverts to Key Ring without overow (unless intercepted  
by another feature).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
819  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
31xx-Configuration  
311x-Options  
3112-Termination  
3112-03: Day Overow Destination  
(Day OvDestination)  
Use this option to set the overow destination for day mode calls (including DILs). The destination can be  
an extension, UCD Group master number, voice mail master number, Ring Group master number, or Key  
Ring (by pressing CLEAR).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
Extension (0-999)  
Key Ring (entered by pressing CLEAR).  
Default  
• 300  
3112-04: Direct Termination at Night  
(Night Termination)  
Use this option to set the night termination (answering point) for the line. If the line is a Direct Inward Line,  
it rings the answering point directly at night.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
Extension number (0-999)  
UCD Group master number (700-707)  
Voice mail master number (700)  
Ring Group master number (600-607)  
Key Ring (entered by pressing CLEAR).  
Default  
• Key Ring  
3112-05: Enable Night Overow  
(Night Overow)  
Use this option to enable or disable night mode overow for the line.  
If disabled, an unanswered DID call during the day diverts to Key Ring without overow (unless intercepted  
by another feature).  
Features  
820  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
31xx-Configuration  
311x-Options  
3112-Termination  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
3112-06: Night Overow Destination  
(Night OvDestination)  
Use this option to set the overow destination for night mode calls (including DILs). The destination can be  
an extension, UCD Group master number, voice mail master number, Ring Group master number, or Key  
Ring (by pressing CLEAR).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
Extension (0-999)  
Key Ring (entered by pressing CLEAR).  
Default  
• 300  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
821  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
31xx-Configuration  
311x-Options  
3113-Ringing  
3113-Ringing  
Description  
Use this program to set the line Pickup Group assignment and ring types.  
If programming multiple lines, you may nd 9022-Line Copy (page 923) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
3113-01: Pickup Group Assignment  
(Pickup Group)  
Use this option to have an incoming call on the line ring all the extensions in the assigned pickup group.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-8 (pickup groups 1-8)  
0 (unassigned)  
Default  
• 0  
3113-02: Day Ring Type  
(Day Ring Type)  
Use this option to assign a ring type (A, B, or C) for the line’s day ringing. When the line rings an extension  
in the day ring mode, it uses the ring type specied in this option.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 0 for standard (non-customizable system default)  
1 for ring type A  
2 for ring type B  
3 for ring type C  
Default  
• 1  
822  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
31xx-Configuration  
311x-Options  
3113-Ringing  
3113-03: Night Ring Type  
(Night Ring Type)  
Use this option to assign a ring type (A, B, or C) for the line’s night ringing. When the line rings an extension  
in the night ring mode, it uses the ring type specied in this option.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 0 for standard (non-customizable system default)  
1 for ring type A  
2 for ring type B  
3 for ring type C  
Default  
• 1  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
823  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
31xx-Configuration  
311x-Options  
3113-Ringing  
3113-04: Delay Ring Type  
(Delay Ring Type)  
Use this option to assign a ring type (A, B, or C) for the line’s delay ringing. When the line rings an exten-  
sion in the delay ring mode, it uses the ring type specied in this option.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 0 for standard (non-customizable system default)  
1 for ring type A  
2 for ring type B  
3 for ring type C  
Default  
• 1  
824  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
31xx-Configuration  
312x-Caller ID  
3121-Settings  
312x1-CSeatllteinrgIDs  
Description  
Use this program to set the line Caller ID parameters.  
If programming multiple lines, you may nd 9022-Line Copy (page 923) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
3121-01: Caller ID Type  
(CID Type)  
Use this option to enable Caller ID for each line. If enabled, Caller ID will occur if also enabled by the other  
Caller ID programmable options.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for DSP  
2 for ATRU PCB daughter board  
3 for T1/E1ANI  
Default  
• 0  
3121-02: ANI/DNIS Format  
(ANI/DNIS Format)  
Use this option to specify the type of ANI/DNIS Caller ID data provided by T1 lines. Set this option for com-  
patibility with the incoming ANI/DNIS data provided by the local telco. When entering data, the options are:  
ANI/DNIS Data Format  
Option  
0
Description  
Entry  
NONE  
The DID line will not detect ANI/DNIS data.  
The DID line will detect ANI data without using delimiters  
1
2
ANI  
*ANI*  
The DID line will detect ANI data using a delimiter (*) at the begin-  
ning and end of the ANI Caller ID string.  
3
4
*DNIS*  
The DID line will detect DNIS data without using delimiters.  
*ANI*DNIS*  
The DID line will detect both ANI and DNIS data using a delimiter  
(*) at the beginning and end of the string. An additional delimiter  
separates the ANI and DNIS data.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
825  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
31xx-Configuration  
312x-Caller ID  
3121-Settings  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for ANI  
2 for *ANI*  
3 for *DNIS*  
4 for *ANI*DNIS*  
Default  
• 0  
3121-03: ANI/DNIS Delimiter  
(ANI/DNIS Delimiter)  
For ANI/DNIS format options 2-4 (see 3121-02: ANI/DNIS Format above), use this option to set the type of  
data delimiter provided by the telco. The delimiter designates the beginning and end of the ANI/DNIS data  
string. The delimiter can be any character 0-9, # or *. Always set this option for compatibility with the  
incoming ANI/DNIS data provided by the local telco.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Digit 0-9, # or * (single digit entry)  
Default  
• *  
3121-04: Number of ANI Digits  
(# ANI Digits)  
For ANI/DNIS format option 1 (see 3121-02: ANI/DNIS Format above), use this option to specify the num-  
ber of digits in the ANI number. This is required for option 1 since delimiters do not mark the beginning and  
end of the data string. The system must know how many digits of incoming ANI Caller ID data to interpret.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
• 1-16  
Default  
• 10  
826  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
31xx-Configuration  
312x-Caller ID  
3122-Groups  
3122-Groups  
Description  
Use this program to specify to which Caller ID Groups the line belongs.  
If programming multiple lines, you may nd 9022-Line Copy (page 923) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
3122-[01-08]: Caller ID Group Membership  
(xx CID Group x)  
Use this option to indicate into which Caller ID Logging Group the line should log its calls. The line can be  
a member of any or all groups.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Logging disabled for selected group.  
Yes (1) - Logging enabled for selected group.  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled for all groups  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
827  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
31xx-Configuration  
313x-Voice Mail  
3131-Settings  
313x1-VSoeitctiengMail  
s
Description  
For each line, use this program to set the voice mail Caller ID option and IntraMail Answer Table.  
If programming multiple lines, you may nd 9022-Line Copy (page 923) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
3131-01: Pass Caller ID to Voice Mail  
(Pass CID to VM)  
Use this option to enable or disable the capability of the line to send Caller ID data to voice mail. If enabled,  
the line will send incoming Caller ID data to voice mail. (This will occur, for example, if the line is a DIL  
terminated to the voice mail master number.) If disabled, the line will not provide Caller ID data to voice  
mail. If you enable this option, you must also enable Caller ID in 3121-01: Caller ID Type (page 825).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
3131-02: IntraMail Answer Table Assignment  
(Intramail Answer Table #)  
Use this option to assign an IntraMail Answer Table to the line.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-8 for Answer Tables 1-8  
Default  
1  
828  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
31xx-Configuration  
313x-Voice Mail  
3131-Settings  
3131-03: Line Voice Prompt Language  
(Voice Prompts)  
Use this option to set the line voice prompt language. You can choose either the Primary Language or the  
Secondary Language. To activate a different primary or Secondary Language, see 4203-Voice Prompts  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1 for Primary Language  
2 for Secondary Language  
Default  
1 for Primary Language  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
829  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
31xx-Configuration  
314x-TIE Line  
3141-Dialing  
314x1-TDIiEalLininge  
Description  
For each tie line, use this program to select the line’s dial 9 group and operator extension.  
If programming multiple lines, you may nd 9022-Line Copy (page 923) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
3141-01:Tie Line Caller’s Outbound Dial 9 Group  
(Dial 9 Group)  
Use this option to specify the Line Group (0-8) selected when an incoming (remote) Tie Line callers dials 9  
to place an outgoing call. This is the Line Group in the local system used by the remote Tie Line caller for  
placing outgoing calls.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
90-98 for Line Groups 90-98  
Default  
90  
3141-02:Tie Line Caller’s Operator Extension  
(Operator Ext)  
Use this option to specify the extension reached in the local system when an incoming (remote) Tie Line  
caller dials 0.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Extension (0-999)  
Default  
300  
830  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
31xx-Configuration  
314x-TIE Line  
3142-Line Access  
3142-Line Access  
Description  
Use this program to set the tie line outbound line access.  
If programming multiple lines, you may nd 9022-Line Copy (page 923) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
3142-[01-64]:Tie Line Caller’s Outbound Line Access  
(Line xx Access)  
Use this option to set up a line access matrix between each Tie Line in the local system and each outgoing  
line in the local system. For each Tie Lie (1-64), you can assign the access type for each of the 64 lines in the  
local system. This option further restricts which local system lines an incoming (remote) tie line caller can  
access for outgoing calls.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for no access  
1 for incoming access only  
2 for outgoing access only  
3 for full access  
Default  
3 for all extensions  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
831  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
31xx-Configuration  
314x-TIE Line  
3143-Group Access  
3143-Group Access  
Description  
Use this program to set the tie line outbound Line Group access.  
If programming multiple lines, you may nd 9022-Line Copy (page 923) a handy time-saving tool.  
Options  
3143-[01-64]:Tie Line Caller’s Outbound Line Group Access  
(xx Group xx Access)  
Use this option to enable or disable the extension’s outgoing access to each Line Group (90-98).  
Use this option to enable or disable Line Group Access for incoming (remote) Tie Line callers. If enabled for  
a Line Group, remote Tie Line callers will be able to use that group in the local system for outgoing calls.  
You separately enable this option for each of the 9 Line Groups (90-98). The access matrix you set up in  
3142-[01-64]: Tie Line Caller’s Outbound Line Access may limit which lines Line Group Access can use.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
832  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
32xx-Groups  
320x-Setup  
3201-Order  
32xx-Groups  
320x1-SOerdtuepr  
Description  
Use this program to set up Line Groups.  
Options  
3201-[01-64]: Line Group  
(xx 1st line)  
Use this option to program lines (1-64) into each of the nine Line Groups (90-98). The order in which you  
enter lines into a group determines the order in which the system will access the lines when placing an out-  
side call. A line can be in more than one group. In DSX-80/160, you can program a line into a group only if  
the line is on an installed COIU PCB. If you program a line into a group, and then remove its PCB, the sys-  
tem automatically removes the line from the group.  
The following chart shows how you could set up Line Group 90 with lines 1-8 enter in descending order.  
When placing an outgoing call using group 90, the system will try line 8 rst and line 1 last.  
Sample Line Group Program Entry  
Line Group  
Program entry number  
Line number  
8
90  
1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• Line 1-64 (for Line Group entries 1-64)  
Default  
• Lines 1-8 are in Line Group 90.  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
833  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
33xx-DID (Direct Inward Dialing)  
330x-Setup  
3301-Options  
33xx-DID (Direct Inward Dialing)  
330x1-SOepttuiopns  
Description  
Use this program to specify the number of DID digits expected from the telco.  
Options  
3301-01: Number of DID Digits  
(# DID Digits)  
Use this option to specify the number of incoming DID digits expected from the telco. This entry should  
match the type of DID service the telco provides. The DID Translation Table will use the last 3 digits pro-  
vided by telco for routing and ignore the rest. By default, this option is 3 digits.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1-8 digits  
Default  
• 3  
834  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
33xx-DID (Direct Inward Dialing)  
330x-Setup  
3302-Translations  
3302-Translations  
Description  
Use this program to set up the system’s DID routing. The DID Translation Table analyzes the DID string  
received from the telco and routes it to the corresponding extension.You make separate day and night rout-  
ing entries. The DID Translation Table has 100 entries, using 0-9, with * used as a wild card to represent  
.
DID Example: Routing DID Block 400-416  
For example, to have DID block 400-416 route to extensions 300-316 during the day and 300 at night  
For 3302-01: Incoming DID Digits entry 1, enter 4**.  
This entry will route all DID digits in the 400-499 range.  
The system will strip off the leading digit (4), replace it with 3, and route to extensions 300-399.  
All calls go to extension 300 when the system is in the night mode.  
Default Routing  
By default, the system uses the last 2 digits of the DID string to route to extensions 300-399 because:  
The rst entry in the table is *** (i.e., wild card representing any received 3-digit string)  
The day routing is 3** (i.e., the last 2 digits of the received string are used to route to the corresponding  
extension beginning with 3). For example, a DID block of 400-499 routes to extensions 300-399.  
Since the night route is not programmed, night routing follows the day route setting.  
Programming Ranges and Exceptions  
When programming a range and exceptions into the DID Translation Table, be sure to put the exceptions in  
the table rst. The following tables show both the correct and incorrect method of setting this up.  
Ranges and Exceptions – Correct Conguration  
Table Entry  
Digits Received  
Day Route  
303  
Night Route  
01  
02  
03  
301  
302  
3**  
700  
700  
304  
3**  
Calls to 301 route to 303 in the day and the Automated Attendant at night.  
Calls to 302 route to 304 in the day and the Automated Attendant at night.  
All other calls in the 3xx range route to their respective extensions.  
Ranges and Exceptions – Incorrect Conguration  
Table Entry  
Digits Received  
Day Route  
3**  
Night Route  
01  
02  
03  
3**  
301  
302  
303  
700  
700  
304  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
835  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
33xx-DID (Direct Inward Dialing)  
330x-Setup  
3302-Translations  
Ranges and Exceptions – Incorrect Conguration  
Digits Received Day Route  
Table Entry  
Night Route  
In the day, all calls in the 3xx range route to their respective extensions. The day mode exception rout-  
ing for 301 and 302 is ignored.  
Only at night is the exception routing for 301 and 302 in force.  
Options  
3302-01: Incoming DID Digits  
(Incoming Digits)  
For the table entry you are programming, use this option designate the incoming digits you want to translate.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Digits (1-8 digits using 0-9)  
* (wild card representing any digit)  
Default  
*** for entry 001. All other table entries blank.  
3302-01: Day Translation Destination  
(Day Translation)  
For the table entry you are programming, use this option to designate the day mode destination for the  
incoming DID digits.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Digits (1-8 digits using 0-9)  
* (wild card representing any digit)  
Default  
3** for entry 001. All other table entries blank.  
3302-01: Night Translation Destination  
(Night Translation)  
For the table entry you are programming, use this option to designate the night mode destination for the  
incoming DID digits.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Digits (1-8 digits using 0-9)  
836  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
33xx-DID (Direct Inward Dialing)  
330x-Setup  
3302-Translations  
* (wild card representing any digit)  
Default  
3** for entry 001. All other table entries blank.  
3302-01: MFC Category  
(MFC Category)  
For E1 lines only, use this option to set the MFC Dialing Category for each DID Table entry. This option is  
not used in North America. The available options are:  
1403-DID MFC Dialing Category Options  
Option  
Description  
0
Normal  
1
2
Without charge  
Called Party Release  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for Normal  
1 for Without Charge  
2 for Called Party Release  
Default  
0  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
837  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
34xx-PBX  
340x-Setup  
3401-Codes  
34xx-PBX  
340x1-SCeotd  
u
es  
p
Description  
Use this program to set up the PBX Access Codes Table.  
Options  
3401-01: PBX Access Code Digits  
(PBX Access Digits)  
Use this option to enter codes into the PBX Access Codes Table. You can enter up to 10 PBX Access Codes.  
Each code is either 1 or 2 digits long, using the digits 0-9 and #. You can use * as a wild card character that  
can be entered in any position.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Digits (2 max, using 0-9 and #, with * as a wild card representing any digit).  
Default  
• No entries  
838  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
35xx-Toll Restriction  
350x-Setup  
3501-Type  
35xx-Toll Restriction  
350x1-STyeptuep  
Description  
Use this program to set the Toll Restriction country type and enter additional emergency numbers.  
Options  
3501-01:Toll Restriction Country Type  
(Toll Restrict Type)  
Use this option to set the Toll Restriction country type. You should select US Domestic (1) for systems  
installed in North America.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
1 for US Domestic (North American) Toll Restriction  
2 for Latin American Toll Restriction  
Default  
1  
3501-02: Emergency Number  
(Emergency Num)  
This option is xed at 911 for systems using US Domestic (North American) Toll Restriction. You cannot  
change this setting.  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
839  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
35xx-Toll Restriction  
351x-Options  
3511-Settings  
351x1-OSeptttiionngss  
Description  
Use this program to enable or disable Active Key Pad (continuous dialing).  
Options  
3511-01: Active Key Pad  
(Active Dial Pad)  
Use this option to enable or disable Active Key Pad (continuous dialing) for outside calls.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
840  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
35xx-Toll Restriction  
351x-Options  
3512-U.S. Dialing  
3512-U.S. Dialing  
Description  
Use this program to enable or disable the following types of dialing:  
• 0 + XXX Operator Assisted Dialing  
• 011 + XXX International Dialing  
• 101x Equal Access Dialing  
• Allow N11 Dialing  
Options  
3512-01: Allow 0 + XXX Operator Assisted Dialing  
(0+XXX)  
Use this option to enable or disable an extension’s ability to manually dial 0 + (operator assisted) calls.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
3512-02: Allow 011 + XXX International Dialing  
(Allow 011+XXX)  
Use this option to enable or disable 011 (international) dialing.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
3512-03: Allow 101x Equal Access Dialing  
(Allow 101X)  
This option disables or enables the dialing of Equal Access Codes 1011 through 1019. It has no affect on the  
more common 1010 XXX Equal Access Codes. Use 352x-1010-XXX / Local XXX (Equal Access Dialing)  
(page 844) to restrict the more common 1010 codes.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
841  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
35xx-Toll Restriction  
351x-Options  
3512-U.S. Dialing  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
3512-04: Allow N11 Dialing  
(Allow N11)  
Use this option to enable or disable dialing N11 services such as directory assistance (411) and repair (611).  
This option does not restrict 911 or 1 + 911 calls. These calls are always allowed.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
842  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
35xx-Toll Restriction  
351x-Options  
3513-International Dialing  
3513-International Dialing  
Description  
This program is not applicable to systems installed in North America.  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
843  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
35xx-Toll Restriction  
352x-1010-XXX / Local XXX (Equal Access Dialing)  
3521-Table Options  
352x1-1Ta0b10le-XXXtio/ Lnoscal XXX (Equal Access Dialing)  
O
p
Description  
Use this program to set up the 1010 + XXX Equal Access Dialing Table. By default, this type of dialing is  
enabled because the 1010 + XXX Equal Access Dialing Table is a deny table with no entries (i.e., it denies  
nothing). A table entry is 3 digits long, using the digits 0-9. You can use the * character as a wild card,  
which can be entered in any position in the table. A wild card allows the table to accept any digit in that  
position. For example, the entry 2*0 represents 200 through 290. The Veried Account Code Table can  
hold up to 96 entries.  
Options  
3521-01: Initialize Table  
(Initialize Table)  
Use this option to initialize the 1010 + XXX Equal Access Dialing Table.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Initialize the 1010 + XXX Equal Access Dialing Table.  
Yes (1) - Do not initialize the 1010 + XXX Equal Access Dialing Table.  
Default  
• N/A  
3521-02:Table Type (Allow or Deny)  
(Allow/Deny)  
Use this option to designate the table as an allow or deny table. If set as an allow table, Toll Restriction will  
allow (permit) only those codes programed into the table.If set as a deny table, Toll Restriction will deny  
(block) only those codes listed in the table.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 0 for deny  
1 for allow  
Default  
0  
844  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
35xx-Toll Restriction  
352x-1010-XXX / Local XXX (Equal Access Dialing)  
3522-Table Entries  
3522-Table Entries  
3522-xx:Table Data  
(Dial Code)  
Use this option to enter data into the 1010 + Equal Access Dialing Table. You can enter up to 96 codes.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 3 digits using 0-9  
* is a wild card entry representing any digit  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
845  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
35xx-Toll Restriction  
353x-1+XXX / TBL-A XXX (NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table)  
3531-Table Options  
353x1-1Ta+bXlXeXO/pTtBion-sA XXX (NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table)  
L
Description  
Use this program to set up the 1 + NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table. By default, this type of dialing is  
enabled because the 1 + NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table is a deny table with no entries (i.e., it denies  
nothing). A table entry is 3 digits long, using the digits 0-9. You can use the * character as a wild card,  
which can be entered in any position in the table. A wild card allows the table to accept any digit in that  
position. For example, the entry 2*0 represents 200 through 290. The Veried Account Code Table can  
hold up to 96 entries.  
Do not enter either 911 or 1911 into the table. When a user presses a line key and dials either 911 or 1911,  
the system immediately bypasses all Toll Restriction and Account Code programming and routes the call.  
Options  
3531-01: Initialize Table  
(Initialize Table)  
Use this option to initialize the 1 + NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Initialize the 1 + NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table.  
Yes (1) - Do not initialize the 1 + NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table.  
Default  
• N/A  
3531-02:Table Type (Allow or Deny)  
(Allow/Deny)  
Use this option to designate the table as an allow or deny table. If set as an allow table, Toll Restriction will  
allow (permit) only those codes programed into the table.If set as a deny table, Toll Restriction will deny  
(block) only those codes listed in the table.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 0 for deny  
1 for allow  
Default  
0  
846  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
35xx-Toll Restriction  
353x-1+XXX / TBL-A XXX (NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table)  
3532-Table Entries  
3532-Table Entries  
3532-xx:Table Data  
(Dial Code)  
Use this option to enter data into the 1 + NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table. You can enter up to 96 codes.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 3 digits using 0-9  
* is a wild card entry representing any digit  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
847  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
35xx-Toll Restriction  
354x-1+XXX-XXX / TBL-A XXXXXXX (1 + NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table)  
3541-Table Options  
354x1-1Ta+bXlXeXO-XpXtioXn/sTBL-A XXXXXXX (1  
+
NPA  
+
NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table)  
Description  
Use this program to set up the 1 + NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table. By default, this type of dialing is  
enabled because the 1 + NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table is a deny table with no entries (i.e., it denies  
nothing). A table entry is 3 digits long, using the digits 0-9. You can use the * character as a wild card,  
which can be entered in any position in the table. A wild card allows the table to accept any digit in that  
position. For example, the entry 2*0 represents 200 through 290. The Veried Account Code Table can  
hold up to 96 entries.  
Do not enter either 911 or 1911 into the table. When a user presses a line key and dials either 911 or 1911,  
the system immediately bypasses all Toll Restriction and Account Code programming and routes the call.  
Options  
3541-01: Initialize Table  
(Initialize Table)  
Use this option to initialize the 1 + NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Initialize the 1 + NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table.  
Yes (1) - Do not initialize the 1 + NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table.  
Default  
• N/A  
3541-02:Table Type (Allow or Deny)  
(Allow/Deny)  
Use this option to designate the table as an allow or deny table. If set as an allow table, Toll Restriction will  
allow (permit) only those codes programed into the table.If set as a deny table, Toll Restriction will deny  
(block) only those codes listed in the table.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 0 for deny  
1 for allow  
Default  
0  
848  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
35xx-Toll Restriction  
354x-1+XXX-XXX / TBL-A XXXXXXX (1 + NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table)  
3542-Table Entries  
3542-Table Entries  
3542-xx:Table Data  
(Dial Code)  
Use this option to enter data into the 1 + NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table. You can enter up to 96 codes.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 3 digits using 0-9  
* is a wild card entry representing any digit  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
849  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
35xx-Toll Restriction  
355x-XXX / TBL-B-XXX (NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table)  
3551-Table Options  
355x1-XTaXb  
Xle/ TOBpLti-on-sXXX (NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table)  
B
Description  
Use this program to set up the NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table. By default, this type of dialing is enabled  
because the NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table is a deny table with no entries (i.e., it denies nothing). A table  
entry is 3 digits long, using the digits 0-9.You can use the * character as a wild card, which can be entered  
in any position in the table. A wild card allows the table to accept any digit in that position. For example,  
the entry 2*0 represents 200 through 290. The Veried Account Code Table can hold up to 96 entries.  
Do not enter either 911 or 1911 into the table. When a user presses a line key and dials either 911 or 1911,  
the system immediately bypasses all Toll Restriction and Account Code programming and routes the call.  
Options  
3551-01: Initialize Table  
(Initialize Table)  
Use this option to initialize the NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Initialize the NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table.  
Yes (1) - Do not initialize the NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table.  
Default  
• N/A  
3551-02:Table Type (Allow or Deny)  
(Allow/Deny)  
Use this option to designate the table as an allow or deny table. If set as an allow table, Toll Restriction will  
allow (permit) only those codes programed into the table.If set as a deny table, Toll Restriction will deny  
(block) only those codes listed in the table.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 0 for deny  
1 for allow  
Default  
0  
850  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
35xx-Toll Restriction  
355x-XXX / TBL-B-XXX (NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table)  
3552-Table Entries  
3552-Table Entries  
3552-xx:Table Data  
(Dial Code)  
Use this option to enter data into the NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table. You can enter up to 96 codes.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 3 digits using 0-9  
* is a wild card entry representing any digit  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
851  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
35xx-Toll Restriction  
356x-XXX-XXX / TBL-B XXXXXX (NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table)  
3561-Table Options  
356x1-XTaX  
b
Xle-XOXpXti/o  
T
n
BsL-B XXXXXX (NPA  
+
NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table)  
Description  
Use this program to set up the NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table. By default, this type of dialing is enabled  
because the NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table is a deny table with no entries (i.e., it denies nothing). A table  
entry is 3 digits long, using the digits 0-9.You can use the * character as a wild card, which can be entered in  
any position in the table. A wild card allows the table to accept any digit in that position. For example, the  
entry 2*0 represents 200 through 290. The Veried Account Code Table can hold up to 96 entries.  
Do not enter either 911 or 1911 into the table. When a user presses a line key and dials either 911 or 1911,  
the system immediately bypasses all Toll Restriction and Account Code programming and routes the call.  
Options  
3561-01: Initialize Table  
(Initialize Table)  
Use this option to initialize the NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Initialize the NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table.  
Yes (1) - Do not initialize the NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table.  
Default  
• N/A  
3561-02:Table Type (Allow or Deny)  
(Allow/Deny)  
Use this option to designate the table as an allow or deny table. If set as an allow table, Toll Restriction will  
allow (permit) only those codes programed into the table.If set as a deny table, Toll Restriction will deny  
(block) only those codes listed in the table.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 0 for deny  
1 for allow  
Default  
0  
852  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
35xx-Toll Restriction  
356x-XXX-XXX / TBL-B XXXXXX (NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table)  
3562-Table Entries  
3562-Table Entries  
3562-xx:Table Data  
(Dial Code)  
Use this option to enter data into the NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table. You can enter up to 96 codes.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 3 digits using 0-9  
* is a wild card entry representing any digit  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
853  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
36xx-AC Codes (Verified Account Codes Table)  
360x-Setup  
3601-Codes  
36xx-AC Codes (Veried Account Codes Table)  
360x1-SCeotd  
u
es  
p
Description  
Use this option to enter codes into the Veried Account Codes Table. When 1412-05: Veried Account Codes  
(page 651) is enabled, the system compares the Account Code the user dials to the entries in this table. If an  
entry matches, the system allows the call (provided it is not prevented by an extension’s Toll Restriction). If  
there is no match, the system denies the call.  
A Veried Account Code can be from 1 to 10 digits long, using the digits 0-9. You can use the * character as  
a wild card, which can be entered in any position in a Veried Account Code. A wild card allows the user to  
dial any digit in that position. For example, the entry 11*1 represents entries 1101, 1111, 1121, etc.  
The Veried Account Code Table can hold up to 1000 entries.  
Do not enter either 911 or 1911 into the Veried Account Codes Table. When a user presses a line key and  
dials either 911 or 1911, the system immediately bypasses all Toll Restriction and Account Code program-  
ming and routes the call.  
Options  
3601-xx:Veried Account Code Data  
(Account Code)  
Use this option to enter codes into the Veried Account Codes Table.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Digits (10 max, using 0-9 and * as a wild card representing any digit).  
• 1000 table entries maximum.  
Default  
• No entries.  
854  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
37xx-Caller ID (System-Wide Options)  
370x-Log Groups (Caller ID Logging Groups)  
3701-Setup  
37xx-Caller ID (System-Wide Options)  
370x1-LSoegtuGproups (Caller ID Logging Groups)  
Description  
Use this program to set the record size (capacity) of each Caller ID Logging Group.  
Options  
3701-[01-08]: Caller ID Logging Group Size  
(CID Group 1 Log Size)  
Determine the total number of Caller ID records that can be stored in each Caller ID Group. Each group can  
contain up to 99 records. When assigning records, you cannot exceed the total allowed by the system (1000).  
For example, if you attempt to assign 50 records and there are only 10 left, the system will automatically  
change your entry to 10  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0-99 Caller ID Group records  
Default  
• Group 1 has 99 records and all other groups are blank  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
855  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
37xx-Caller ID (System-Wide Options)  
371x-Callback  
3711-Route  
371x1-CRaolulbteack  
Description  
Use this program to set up the Caller ID callback route.  
Options  
3711-01: Caller ID Callback Route Type  
(Route Type)  
Use this option to specify the type of route used for Caller ID callbacks (line or Line Group).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for line  
2 for Line Group  
Default  
• 0  
3711-01: Caller ID Callback Line  
(Callback Line)  
For a type 1 (line) Caller ID callback route, use this option to select the line (1-64) the system will use when  
placing the callback.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-64 (line 1-64)  
Undened (entered by pressing CLEAR)  
Default  
• Undened  
856  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
37xx-Caller ID (System-Wide Options)  
371x-Callback  
3711-Route  
3711-01: Caller ID Callback Group  
(Callback Group)  
For a type 2 (Line Group) Caller ID callback route, use this option to select the Line Group (90-98) the sys-  
tem will use when placing the callback.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
90-98 (Line Group 90-98)  
Undened (entered by pressing CLEAR)  
Default  
• Undened  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
857  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
37xx-Caller ID (System-Wide Options)  
371x-Callback  
3712-Treatment Options (Caller ID Callback Dial Treatment Options)  
3712-Treatment Options (Caller ID Callback Dial Treatment Options)  
Description  
Use this program to set the Caller ID Dial Treatment options.  
Options  
3712-01: Initialize Caller ID Dial Treatment Tables  
(Initialize Table)  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Exit the option without initializing  
Yes (1) - Initialize the Caller ID Dial Treatment Tables  
Default  
• N/A  
3712-02: 10-Digit Local Calls  
(10 Digit Local Calls)  
Use this option to indicate if the system is installed in an area that uses 10 digit local calling. Enable this  
option if the system is in a 10-digit local calling area. Disable this option if the system is not in a 10-digit  
local calling area. If enabled, the system will dial all your local Caller ID callbacks as 10-digit calls. If dis-  
abled, the system will dial all your local Caller ID callbacks as 7-digit calls.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
858  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
37xx-Caller ID (System-Wide Options)  
371x-Callback  
3712-Treatment Options (Caller ID Callback Dial Treatment Options)  
3712-03: Home Area Code Exception List Type  
(HNPA Exception Type)  
Use this option to set the Home Area Code Exception List type (toll or local).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for local  
1 for toll  
Default  
0  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
859  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
37xx-Caller ID (System-Wide Options)  
371x-Callback  
3713-Home NPA’s (Home Area Code Table)  
3713-Home NPA’s (Home Area Code Table)  
Description  
Use this program to set up the Caller ID Home Area Code (HNPA) Table.  
Options  
3713-[01-16]: Home Area Code Table Data  
(xx HNPA #x)  
Use this option to specify your system’s home area code. This is the area code in which the system is  
installed. You must make an assignment in this program so that Caller ID can properly process callbacks  
(return calls).  
tion List Table Data determine how the system redials Caller ID calls received as 10 digits or less. This is the  
US standard (i.e., the leading 1 is not received from telco for long distance calls). If the system is in an area  
where the telco provides more than 10 digits, the digits are redialed as is (with no modication).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 3 digits (using 0-9)  
* for wild card representing any digit  
Default  
• None (no entry)  
860  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
37xx-Caller ID (System-Wide Options)  
371x-Callback  
3714-HNPA Exceptions (Home Area Code Exception List Table)  
3714-HNPA Exceptions (Home Area Code Exception List Table)  
Description  
Use this program to set up the Caller ID Home Area Code (HNPA) Exception List Table.  
Options  
3714-[01-96]: Home Area Code Exception List Table Data  
(xx Dial Code)  
Use this option to identify which (if any) calls within your home area code are toll calls. You can set up the  
Exception List Table as a local table (L) or toll table (T). By default, the HNPA Exception List is a Toll Table  
with no entries. (This means that the system outdials all calls within the home area code without the leading 1.)  
When set up as a Local Table, the system identies the NPA + NXX codes you enter as local codes. All  
other NPA + NXX combinations within your home area code are agged as toll calls.  
- If 3712-02: 10-Digit Local Calls is enabled, the system dials all local calls as 10-digit (NPA + NNX  
+ xxxx).  
- If 3712-02: 10-Digit Local Calls is disabled, the system strips the NPA and dials all local calls as 7-  
digit (NXX + xxxx).  
When set up as a Toll Table, the system identies the NPA + NXX codes you enter as toll calls. The sys-  
tem outdials them with a leading 1. All other NPA + NXX combinations are considered local codes.  
- If 3712-02: 10-Digit Local Calls is enabled, the system dials all local calls as 10-digit (NPA + NNX  
+ xxxx).  
- If 3712-02: 10-Digit Local Calls is disabled, the system strips the NPA and dials all local calls as 7-  
digit (NXX + xxxx).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 3 digits (using 0-9)  
* for wild card representing any digit  
Default  
• The HNPA Exception List is a Toll Table with no entries (i.e., all calls within the home area code outdial  
without the leading 1).  
DSX Software Manual  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
861  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
37xx-Caller ID (System-Wide Options)  
371x-Callback  
3715-FNPA Exceptions (Foreign Area Code Exception List Table)  
3715-FNPA Exceptions (Foreign Area Code Exception List Table)  
Description  
Use this program to set up the Caller ID Foreign Area Code (FNPA) Exception List Table.  
Options  
3715-[01-96]: Foreign Area Code Exception List Table Data  
(xx Dial Code)  
If your dialing area has calls in an adjacent area code that are local calls, enter those codes in this table. If the  
system nds the code in the table, it will dial it as 10-digit (without the leading 1). If the system does not nd  
the code, the system will outdial it as 1 + 10-digit.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• 3 digits (using 0-9)  
* for wild card representing any digit  
Default  
• None (no entry)  
862  
Line Options: 3101-3714  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
41xx-Configuration  
410x-System (Voice Mail System Options)  
4101-Type  
Voice Mail Options:  
4101-4231  
41xx-Conguration  
410x1-STyypsetem (Voice Mail System Options)  
Description  
Use this program to set the voice mail type and master number.  
Options  
4101-01:Voice Mail Type  
(VM Type)  
Use this option to set the type of voice mail connected to your system.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for Built-In Automated Attendant  
2 for IntraMail  
3 for UltraMail (DSX-80/160 only)  
4 for external  
Default  
1 with IntraMail installed  
3 with UltraMail installed (DSX-80/160 only)  
0 if no voice mail installed  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
863  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
41xx-Configuration  
410x-System (Voice Mail System Options)  
4101-Type  
4101-02:Voice Mail Master Number  
(VM UCD Master)  
Use this option to set the voice mail master extension number (e.g., 700). In most installations, you should  
not change this option from its default setting (700).  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Extension number using 0-9 (3 digits max.)  
Default  
700  
864  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
41xx-Configuration  
411x-Ports (Voice Mail Port Setup)  
4111-Options (Voice Mail Port Options)  
411x1-POoprttison(Vso(iVcoeicMeaMilaPiol rPtoSrtetOuppt)ions)  
Description  
Use this program to enter the voice mail port name as well as set the voice mail Class of Service and Toll  
Restriction Level.  
Options  
4111-01:Voice Mail Port Name  
(Name)  
Use this option to modify the name for all voice mail ports. The system displays this name when a keyset  
user calls a voice mail port (either by pressingV-MAIL or dialing the master number).You should always end  
the name with the # character. The system substitutes the port number for the #. Using the default name VM  
PORT # for example, the keyset display shows VM PORT 1 when calling port 1.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Default  
VM PORT #  
4111-02:Voice Mail Port Class of Service  
(COS Level)  
Use this option to set the Class of Service for all voice mail ports. Normally, you use the voice mail port  
Class of Service to control Message Notication callouts.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-15 for Class of Service 1-15  
Default  
• 2  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
865  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
41xx-Configuration  
411x-Ports (Voice Mail Port Setup)  
4111-Options (Voice Mail Port Options)  
4111-03:Voice Mail Port Toll Restriction Level (Day)  
(Day Toll Level)  
Use this option to set the day mode Toll Restriction Level for all voice mail ports. This allows you to restrict  
Message Notication callouts placed during the day.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
0-7 for Toll Levels 0-7  
Default  
0  
4111-04:Voice Mail Port Toll Restriction Level (Night)  
(Night Toll Level)  
Use this option to set the night mode Toll Restriction Level for all voice mail ports. This allows you to  
restrict Message Notication callouts placed at night.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
0-7 for Toll Levels 0-7  
Default  
• 0  
866  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
41xx-Configuration  
411x-Ports (Voice Mail Port Setup)  
4111-Options (Voice Mail Port Options)  
Name Programming Chart  
Name Programming Chart  
Press a key the indicated number of times for desired character  
Key  
1 Time  
2 Times  
3 Times  
4 Times  
5 Times  
6 Times  
7 Times  
8 Times  
9 Times  
1
&
-
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
#
*
A
B
E
H
K
N
Q
U
X
:
C
F
I
a
d
g
j
b
e
c
f
2
3
4
5
6
r
D
G
h
k
i
J
M
L
O
R
V
Y
0
l
m
S
t
n
p
u
w
o
q
v
x
P
s
z
7
9
T
8
y
W
Z
space  
Not used  
Not used  
After selecting a letter, press a key for another letter or wait 2 seconds for the cursor to automatically advance.  
Additional Name Programming Options  
HOLD  
Save name.  
SPEAKER  
Volume Up  
Volume Down  
Exit user name programming.  
Scroll the cursor to the right.  
Scroll the cursor to the left.  
While editing, clears character to the right.  
At beginning of line, erases entire entry.  
At end of line, becomes a backspace key  
CLEAR  
CHECK  
Restore the previous entry,  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
867  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
41xx-Configuration  
411x-Ports (Voice Mail Port Setup)  
4112-Off Hook (Voice Mail Port Off Hook Options)  
4112-Off Hook (Voice Mail Port Off Hook Options)  
Description  
Use this program to set the voice mail dial 9 group and operator extension.  
Options  
4112-01: Outgoing Dial 9 Group  
(Dial 9 Group)  
Use this option to specify the dial-9 group for voice mail ports. Whenever a voice mail port dials 9, the sys-  
tem accesses the rst available line in the group specied by this option. This may occur when voice mail is  
processing Message Notication callouts.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
90-98 for line groups 90-98  
Default  
90  
4112-02: Operator’s Extension  
(Operator Ext)  
Assign the voice mail operator. This is the extension reached when a voice mail port dials 0.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Extension number  
None (Entered by pressing CLEAR)  
Default  
300  
868  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
41xx-Configuration  
411x-Ports (Voice Mail Port Setup)  
4113-Line Access (Voice Mail Port Outgoing Line Access)  
4113-Line Access (Voice Mail Port Outgoing Line Access)  
Description  
Use this program to set the voice mail outgoing line access.  
Options  
4113-xx: Outgoing Line xx Access  
(Line xx Access)  
Use this option to set the voice mail port’s access options for lines (no access, incoming only, outgoing only,  
or full access).  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
0 for no access  
1 for incoming access only  
2 for outgoing access only  
3 for full access  
Default  
3 for all extensions  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
869  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
41xx-Configuration  
411x-Ports (Voice Mail Port Setup)  
4114-Group Access (Outgoing Line Group Access)  
4114-Group Access (Outgoing Line Group Access)  
Description  
Use this program to set the voice mail Line Group access.  
Options  
4114-xx: Outgoing Line Group xx Access  
(Group xx Access)  
Use this option to enable or disable the voice mail port’s outgoing access to each Line Group (90-98).  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
870  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
42xx-IntraMail  
420x-Options  
4201-Messages (IntraMail Message Options)  
42xx-IntraMail  
420x1-OMpetsisoangses (IntraMail Message Options)  
Description  
Use this program to set basic voice mail messaging options.  
Options  
4201-01: Outgoing Message Length  
(OGM Msg Length)  
Use this option to set the maximum length of recorded outgoing messages. Outgoing messages include:  
• Announcement Mailbox Messages.  
• Call Routing Mailbox Instruction Menus.  
• Directory Dialing Messages.  
• Greetings for Subscriber Mailboxes.  
• Message On Hold.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-4095 seconds  
Default  
4095 seconds  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
871  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
42xx-IntraMail  
420x-Options  
4201-Messages (IntraMail Message Options)  
4201-02: Incoming Message Length  
(ICM Msg Length)  
Use this option to set the maximum length of recorded incoming messages: Incoming messages include:  
• Conversation Record.  
• Extension users leaving a message in a Subscriber Mailbox.  
• Outside Automated Attendant callers accessing a mailbox via a LOGON command and then dialing  
RS to record and send a message.  
• Subscriber Mailbox users dialing RS to record and send a message.  
• Automated Attendant callers leaving a message or Quick Message in a Subscriber Mailbox.  
• Outside callers transferred by an extension user to a Subscriber Mailbox.  
The length of a Conversation Record is 10 times the Subscriber Message Length. Since the Conversation  
Record time cannot exceed 4095 seconds, any settings in Subscriber Message Length larger than 409 have  
no effect on the length of recorded conversations.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-4095 seconds.  
Default  
120 seconds.  
4201-03: Message Backup/Go Ahead Time  
(Backup/Advance Time)  
Use this option to set the backup/go ahead interval. This interval sets how far IntraMail backs up when a user  
dials B while recording or listening to a message. This interval also sets how far IntraMail jumps ahead  
when a user dials G while listening to a message.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-60 seconds  
0 for disabled  
Default  
5  
872  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
42xx-IntraMail  
420x-Options  
4202-Notification (Message Notification Options)  
4202-Notification (Message Notification Options)  
Description  
Use this program to set the voice mail Message Notication options.  
Options  
4202-01:Wait Between Non-Pager Callout Attempts  
(Notication Interval)  
Use this option to set the minimum time between non-pager Message Notication callouts in which the des-  
tination answers, says “Hello,” dials 1 to acknowledge and then enters the wrong security code. By default,  
this interval is 20 minutes.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-255 minutes  
Default  
20  
4202-02:Wait Between Digital Pager Callout Attempts  
(Pager Notif. Interval)  
Use this option to set minimum time between unacknowledged or unanswered digital pager Message Noti-  
cation callouts. (A subscriber acknowledges a digital pager notication by logging onto their mailbox.) After  
this interval expires, IntraMail will try the callout again (for up to the number of times set in 4202-06: Num-  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-255 minutes  
Default  
15  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
873  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
42xx-IntraMail  
420x-Options  
4202-Notification (Message Notification Options)  
4202-03:Wait Between Busy Non-Pager Callout Attempts  
(Busy Notif. Interval)  
Use this option to set how long IntraMail will wait, after it dials a busy non-pager callout destination, before  
retrying the callout number.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-255 minutes  
Default  
15  
874  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
420x-Options  
4202-Notification (Message Notification Options)  
4202-04:Wait Between RNA Non-Pager Callout Attempts  
(RNA Notif. Interval)  
Use this option to set how long IntraMail will wait, after it dials an unanswered non-pager callout destina-  
tion, before retrying the callout number.  
There are three types of unanswered non-pager callouts:  
option.  
If the destination answers, says “Hello” (or the system detects answer supervision) and then hangs up  
without dialing 1 to log onto their mailbox. This typically happens if someone unfamiliar with notica-  
tion answers the callout, or if the callout is picked up by an answering machine.  
If the destination answers and then hangs up without saying “Hello.” This typically happens if someone  
unfamiliar with the notication answers the callout (like the above example), or if the call is picked up  
by an answering machine with insufcient outgoing message volume.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-255 minutes  
Default  
30  
4202-05:Wait for Answer Non-Pager Callout Attempts  
(RNA # of Rings)  
If a non-pager callout rings the destination longer than this interval, IntraMail marks the call as unanswered  
(Ring No Answer) and hangs up. This setting is approximate (+ a few ring cycles) depending on how long  
the telco takes to connect the call.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-99 rings  
Default  
5  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
875  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
42xx-IntraMail  
420x-Options  
4202-Notification (Message Notification Options)  
4202-06: Number of Callout Attempts  
(Notication Attempts)  
Use this option to set how many times IntraMail will retry an incomplete Message Notication callout. This  
total includes unacknowledged callouts, callouts to a busy destination, and callouts to an unanswered desti-  
nation. This option applies to pager and non-pager callouts.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-99 attempts  
Default  
5  
876  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
420x-Options  
4202-Notification (Message Notification Options)  
4202-07: Send Pager Callout Until Acknowledged  
(Pager Retry Until ACK)  
When this option is enabled, IntraMail will continue to retry a digital pager Message Notication callout  
until the notication is acknowledged. If this option is disabled, IntraMail will retry a digital pager Message  
Notication the number of time specied in 4202-06: Number of Callout Attempts. This option does not  
apply to Message Notication callouts to telephone numbers.  
A digital pager notication is considered acknowledged when the recipient logs onto the mailbox.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
4202-08: Digital Pager Callback Number  
(Pager Callback Number)  
Use this option to set the Digital Pager Callback Number portion of the Message Notication callout num-  
ber for a digital pager. This is the portion of the callout number that is appended to the pager service tele-  
phone number. Normally, this option should be X*M#, where:  
- X is the number of the extension that generated the notication.  
- * is a visual delimiter (to make the pager display easier to read).  
- M is the number of new messages in the extension’s mailbox.  
- # is the digit normally used by the pager service for positive disconnect.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
Digits, 12 maximum, using 0-9, # and *  
M for number of messages  
N for none  
X for extension number  
IntraMail automatically replaces the X command with the number of the extension that initially  
received the message.  
Default  
X*M#  
4202-09: Delay in Dialing Digital Pager Callback Number  
(Pager Dial Delay)  
Use this option to set the delay that occurs just before IntraMail dials the Digital Pager Callback Number  
portion of the Message Notication callout number for a digital pager. Set this delay so the pager service has  
enough time to connect to the digital pager before sending the callback number. Your pager service may be  
able to help you determine the best value for this option. When placing a digital pager notication, the sys-  
tem:  
1. Seizes the line specied.  
2. Dials the user-entered notication number (in V-MAIL + OP + N).  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
877  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
42xx-IntraMail  
420x-Options  
4202-Notification (Message Notification Options)  
4. Dials the number entered in 4202-08: Digital Pager Callback Number.  
The system assumes that the notication number will complete dialing approximately 4 seconds after line  
seizure. This means that, by default, the Digital Pager Callback Number will be dialed into the pager service  
about 13 seconds after line seizure.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
0-99 seconds  
Default  
9  
878  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
42xx-IntraMail  
420x-Options  
4203-Voice Prompts (Active System Voice Prompt Languages)  
4203-Voice Prompts (Active System Voice Prompt Languages)  
4203-01: Primary Voice Prompt Language  
(Primary Lang)  
Use this option to set the primary IntraMail voice prompt language. There are six possible voice prompt lan-  
guages, two of which can be active at any one time. One can be active as the Primary Language; the other  
active as the Secondary Language. If you select a language that doesn’t exist (e.g., 3-6), system will use the  
default language (1 - English mnemonic).  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1 for US English Mnemonic  
2 for US English Numeric  
3-6 - Not used  
Default  
1 - US English Mnemonic  
4203-02: Secondary Voice Prompt Language  
(Secondary Lang)  
Use this option to set the primary IntraMail voice prompt language. There are six possible voice prompt lan-  
guages, two of which can be active at any one time. One can be active as the Primary Language; the other  
active as the Secondary Language.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1 for US English Mnemonic  
2 for US English Numeric  
3-6 - Not used  
Default  
1 - US English Mnemonic  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
879  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
42xx-IntraMail  
421x-Answer Table  
4211-Setup (Answer Table Setup)  
421x1-ASents  
u
wpe(rA  
T
nasbleer Table Setup)  
w
Description  
For each Answer Table, use this program to set the Default Mailbox, Answer Schedule Override options, and  
optional Answer Table linking.  
Options  
4211-01: Default Mailbox  
(Default Mbox)  
Use this option to set the Answer Table’s Default Mailbox. IntraMail uses the Default Mailbox whenever an  
Answer Schedule is not in effect. By default, this occurs at all times other than Monday through Friday  
from 8:30 AM to 5:00 PM.  
• If the Default Mailbox is an Announcement Mailbox, the outside caller will hear the recorded  
announcement. Depending on how the Announcement Mailbox is programmed, IntraMail will then  
hang up, reroute the call, or provide additional dialing options.  
• If the Default Mailbox is a Call Routing Mailbox, the outside caller will hear the instruction menu and  
can dial any options allowed by the associated Dial Action Table.  
• If the Default Mailbox is a Directory Dialing Mailbox, the outside caller will hear the Directory Dial-  
ing Message and can reach an extension by dialing the rst few letters of the person’s name.  
• If the Default Mailbox is a Subscriber Mailbox, the outside caller hears the mailbox greeting (if  
recorded) and can leave a message.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-16 for Routing Mailboxes 1-16  
600-607 for Ring Group Mailboxes 600-607  
700-707 for UCD Group Mailboxes 700-707  
300-427 for Subscriber Mailboxes 300-427  
0 for undened  
Default  
1  
4211-02: Answer Schedule Override  
(Override Flag)  
Use this option to enable or disable Answer Schedule Override for the selected Answer Table. If enabled  
(and you make an entry for 4211-03: Override Mailbox), the active Answer Table will route calls to the  
Override Mailbox.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
880  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
42xx-IntraMail  
421x-Answer Table  
4211-Setup (Answer Table Setup)  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
4211-03: Override Mailbox  
(Override Mbox)  
Use this option to specify the mailbox to which Automated Attendant calls should route when you also  
• If the Override Mailbox is an Announcement Mailbox, the outside caller will hear the recorded  
announcement. Depending on how the Announcement Mailbox is programmed, IntraMail will then  
hang up, reroute the call, or provide additional dialing options.  
• If the Override Mailbox is a Call Routing Mailbox, the outside caller will hear the instruction menu  
and can dial any options allowed by the associated Dial Action Table.  
• If the Default Mailbox is a Directory Dialing Mailbox, the outside caller will hear the Directory Dial-  
ing Message and can reach an extension by dialing the rst few letters of the person’s name.  
• If the Override Mailbox is a Subscriber Mailbox, the outside caller hears the mailbox greeting (if  
recorded) and can leave a message.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-16 for Routing Mailboxes 1-16  
600-607 for Ring Group Mailboxes 600-607  
700-707 for UCD Group Mailboxes 700-707  
300-427 for Subscriber Mailboxes 300-427  
0 for undened  
Default  
0  
4211-04: Next Answer Table  
(Next Table #)  
When 10 Answer Schedules within an Answer Table are not sufcient, use this option to link two Answer  
Tables together. IntraMail treats the two linked tables as a single 20 entry Answer Table.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-8 for Answer Table 1-8  
Undened by pressing CLEAR.  
Default  
• Undened  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
881  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
42xx-IntraMail  
421x-Answer Table  
4212-Schedule (Schedule Setup)  
4212-Schedule (Schedule Setup)  
Description  
Use this program to set the Answer Schedule for each Answer Table.  
Options  
4212-[01-10]: Schedule Type  
(Entry xx Type)  
Use this option to assign a Schedule Type to the selected Answer Schedule. The Schedule Type determines  
how the Answer Schedule answers calls.  
The schedule can be one of the following types:  
1. Day of the Week  
A Type 1 Answer Schedule runs on a specic day of the week. For this type of schedule, you select:  
- The day of the week the schedule should run:  
- The schedule start time.  
- The schedule end time.  
- The Call Routing or Announcement Mailbox used to answer calls.  
2. Range of Days  
A Type 2 Answer Schedule runs for a range of days. For this type of schedule, you select:  
- The day of the week the schedule should start.  
- The day of the week the schedule should stop.  
- The time on the start day the schedule should start.  
- The time on the stop day the schedule should stop.  
- The Call Routing or Announcement Mailbox used to answer the calls.  
3. Date  
A type 3 Answer Schedule runs only on a specic day of the year. For this type of schedule, you select:  
- The specic date the schedule should run.  
- On the selected date, the time the schedule should start.  
- On the selected date, the time the schedule should stop.  
- The Call Routing or Announcement Mailbox used to answer the calls.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1 for Day of the Week  
2 for Range of Days  
3 for Date  
Undened entered by pressing CLEAR  
Default  
• Answer Schedule 1 for Answer Table 1 is type 2 (Range of Days). It runs Monday through Friday  
from 8:30 AM to 5:00 PM.  
• All other Answer Schedules are undened.  
882  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
42xx-IntraMail  
421x-Answer Table  
4212-Schedule (Schedule Setup)  
4212-[01-10]: Routing Mailbox Number  
(Entry xx Mbox)  
Use this option to select the mailbox that will answer calls when this Answer Schedule is active.  
• If the Routing Mailbox is an Announcement Mailbox, the outside caller will hear the recorded  
announcement. Depending on how the Announcement Mailbox is programmed, IntraMail will then  
hang up, reroute the call, or provide additional dialing options.  
• If the Routing Mailbox is a Call Routing Mailbox, the outside caller will hear the instruction menu  
and can dial any options allowed by the associated Dial Action Table.  
• If the Default Mailbox is a Directory Dialing Mailbox, the outside caller will hear the Directory Dial-  
ing Message and can reach an extension by dialing the rst few letters of the person’s name.  
• If the Routing Mailbox is a Subscriber Mailbox, the outside caller hears the mailbox greeting (if  
recorded) and can leave a message.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-16 for Routing Mailboxes 1-16  
600-607 for Ring Group Mailboxes 600-607  
700-707 for UCD Group Mailboxes 700-707  
300-427 for Subscriber Mailboxes 300-427  
0 for undened  
Default  
• Answer Schedule 1 for Answer Table 1 uses Routing Mailbox 1. It is a type 2 (Range of Days) sched-  
ule that runs Monday through Friday from 8:30 AM to 5:00 PM.  
• All other Answer Schedules are undened.  
4212-[01-10]: Schedule Start Day  
(Entry xx (Start) Day)  
Use this option to specify the day of the week the Answer Schedule should start. For type 1 (Day of Week)  
schedules, this is the day the schedule should run. For type 2 (Range of Days) schedules, this is the day the  
schedule should start. This option does not apply to type 3 (Date) schedules.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
- 1 for Sunday.  
- 2 for Monday.  
- 3 for Tuesday.  
- 4 for Wednesday.  
- 5 for Thursday.  
- 6 for Friday.  
- 7 for Saturday.  
Default  
• Answer Schedule 1 for Answer Table 1 starts on day 1. It is a type 2 (Range of Days) schedule that  
runs Monday through Friday from 8:30 AM to 5:00 PM.  
• All other Answer Schedules are undened.  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
883  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
42xx-IntraMail  
421x-Answer Table  
4212-Schedule (Schedule Setup)  
4212-[01-10]: Schedule End Day  
(Entry xx End Day)  
Use this option to specify the day of the week a type 2 (Range of Days) schedule should stop. This option  
does not apply to type 1 (Day of Week) and type 3 (Date) schedules.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
- 1 for Sunday.  
- 2 for Monday.  
- 3 for Tuesday.  
- 4 for Wednesday.  
- 5 for Thursday.  
- 6 for Friday.  
- 7 for Saturday.  
Default  
• Answer Schedule 1 for Answer Table 1 stops on day 5. It is a type 2 (Range of Days) schedule that  
runs Monday through Friday from 8:30 AM to 5:00 PM.  
• All other Answer Schedules are undened.  
4212-[01-10]: Schedule Run Date  
(Entry xx Date MM/DD)  
Use this option to specify the day of the week a type 3 (Date) schedule should run. This option does not  
apply to type 1 (Day of Week) and type 2 (Range of Days) schedules.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
MMDD for Month and Day.  
• For example, for Christmas day enter 1225.  
Default  
• Answer Schedule 1 for Answer Table 1 is a type 2 (Range of Days) schedule that runs Monday  
through Friday from 8:30 AM to 5:00 PM.  
• All other Answer Schedules are undened.  
884  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
42xx-IntraMail  
421x-Answer Table  
4212-Schedule (Schedule Setup)  
4212-[01-10]: Schedule Start Time  
(Entry xx Start Time HH:MM)  
Use this option to specify the time of day the schedule should start. It applies to all schedule types.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
HHMM for time of day (in 24-hour format)  
• For example, for 8:00AM enter 0800.  
Default  
• Answer Schedule 1 for Answer Table 1 is a type 2 (Range of Days) schedule that starts Monday at  
8:30 AM.  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
885  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
421x-Answer Table  
4212-Schedule (Schedule Setup)  
4212-[01-10]: Schedule End Time  
(Entry xx End Time HH:MM)  
Use this option to specify the time of day the schedule should stop. It applies to all schedule types.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
HHMM for time of day (in 24-hour format)  
• For example, for 8:00AM enter 0800.  
Default  
• Answer Schedule 1 for Answer Table 1 is a type 2 (Range of Days) schedule that starts Monday at  
8:30 AM.  
886  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
421x-Answer Table  
4212-Schedule (Schedule Setup)  
Type 1 (Day of Week) Schedule Example  
Type 1 (Day of Week) Example  
Answer Table = 1  
Schedule = 1  
Schedule Type = 2  
Mailbox Number = 2  
Start Day = 1  
End Day = 4  
Start Time = 0800  
End Time = 1030  
Schedule = 2  
Schedule Type = 2  
Mailbox Number = 8  
Start Day = 1  
End Day = 4  
Start Time = 1030  
End Time = 1130  
Schedule = 3  
Schedule Type = 1  
Mailbox Number = 9  
Day of Week = 3  
Start Time = 0900  
End Time = 1000  
Summary  
Schedule 1 is a Range of Days schedule and runs Sunday through Wednesday from 8:00 AM to 10:30  
AM and answers with Call Routing Mailbox 2.  
Schedule 2 is a Range of Days schedule and runs Sunday through Wednesday from 10:30 AM to 11:30  
AM and answers with Announcement Mailbox 8.  
Schedule 3 is a Day of Week schedule and runs on Wednesday from 9:00 AM to 10:00 AM and uses  
Announcement Mailbox 9.  
The Default Mailbox (normally Call Routing Mailbox 1) answers at all other times not covered by the  
Schedules 1-3.  
When setting up Answer Tables with multiple types, build the Answer Schedules in the following order:  
1. Range of Days  
2. Day of Week  
3. Date.  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
887  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
421x-Answer Table  
4212-Schedule (Schedule Setup)  
Type 2 (Range of Days) Schedule Example  
Type 2 (Range of Days) Example  
Answer Table = 1  
Schedule = 1  
Schedule Type = 2  
Mailbox Number = 2  
Start Day = 1  
End Day = 4  
Start Time = 0830  
End Time = 1700  
Schedule = 2  
Schedule Type = 2  
Mailbox Number = 8  
Start Day = 5  
End Day = 7  
Start Time = 0830  
End Time = 1700  
Summary  
Schedule 1 is a Range of Days schedule that runs Sunday through Wednesday from 08:30 AM to 5:00  
PM and answers with Call Routing mailbox 2.  
Schedule 2 is a Range of Days schedule that runs Thursday through Saturday from 08:30 AM through  
5:00 PM and answers with Announcement Mailbox 8.  
The Default Mailbox (usually Call Routing Mailbox 1) answers at all other times not covered by Sched-  
ules 1 and 2.  
When setting up Answer Tables with multiple types, build the Answer Schedules in the following order  
1. Range of Days  
2. Day of Week  
3. Date.  
888  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
421x-Answer Table  
4212-Schedule (Schedule Setup)  
Type 3 (Date) Schedule Example  
Type 3 (Date) Example  
Answer Table = 1  
Schedule = 1  
Schedule Type = 2  
Mailbox Number = 2  
Start Day = 2  
End Day = 6  
Start Time = 0800  
End Time = 1700  
Schedule = 2  
Schedule Type = 2  
Mailbox Number = 8  
Start Day = 7  
End Day = 1  
Start Time = 0800  
End Time = 1700  
Schedule = 3  
Schedule Type = 3  
Mailbox Number = 9  
Date = 1225  
Start Time = 0800  
End Time = 1700  
Summary  
Schedule 1 is a Range of Days schedule and runs Monday through Friday from 8:00 AM to 5:00 PM and  
answers with Call Routing Mailbox 2.  
Schedule 2 is a Range of Days schedule and runs Saturday and Sunday from 8:00 AM to 5:00 PM and  
answers with Announcement Mailbox 8.  
Schedule 3 is a Date schedule that only runs on Christmas day from 8:00 AM to 5:00 PM and answers  
with Announcement Mailbox 9.  
The Default Mailbox (usually Call Routing Mailbox 1) answers at all other times not covered by Sched-  
ules 1-3.  
When setting up Answer Tables with multiple types, build the Answer Schedules in the following order:  
1. Range of Days  
2. Day of Week  
3. Date.  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
889  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
422x-Routing Mailbox  
4221-Setup (Routing Mailbox Setup)  
422x1-RSeotuutpin(gRMouatiilnbgoxMailbox Setup)  
Description  
Use this program to set the Routing Mailbox type.  
Options  
4221-01: Routing Mailbox Type  
(Mailbox Type)  
Use this option to assign a mailbox type to the selected Routing Mailbox. Routing Mailboxes can be Call  
Routing Mailboxes, Announcement Mailboxes, or Directory Dialing Mailboxes.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
0 for none  
1 for Call Routing Mailbox  
2 Announcement Mailbox  
3 Directory Dialing Mailbox  
Default  
• Routing Mailboxes 0-7 are Call Routing Mailboxes (1).  
• Routing Mailboxes 8-15 are Announcement Mailboxes (2).  
4221-02: Routing Mailbox Voice Prompt Language  
(Voice Prompts)  
Use this option to set the Routing Mailbox voice prompt language. You can choose either the Primary Lan-  
guage or the Secondary Language. To activate a different primary or Secondary Language, see 4203-Voice  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1 for Primary Language  
2 for Secondary Language  
Default  
1 for Primary Language  
890  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
42xx-IntraMail  
422x-Routing Mailbox  
4222-Routing Options  
4222-Routing Options  
Description  
Use this program to set the routing options for each Call Routing Mailbox. The entries you make in this pro-  
gram are valid only if the Routing Mailbox is assigned as a Call Routing Mailbox (1) in 4221-01: Routing  
Options  
4222-01: Dial Action Table  
(Dial Action Table)  
Use this option to assign the Dial Action Table to the Call Routing Mailbox. The Dial Action Table denes  
the dialing options for the call Routing Mailbox.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-16 (Dial Action Table 1-16)  
Default  
1  
4222-02:Time Limit for Dialing Commands  
(Dialing Timeout)  
This option determines how long IntraMail will wait for an Automated Attendant caller who doesn’t dial  
before routing the call to the Timeout destination. Be sure your Dial Action Tables have a Timeout action  
programmed.  
If the caller waits too long to dial:  
• When the associated Dial Action Table has a Timeout action, the caller routes to that destination.  
• When the associated Dial Action Table does not have a Timeout action programmed, the Instruction  
Menu repeats 3 times and then IntraMail hangs up.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-99 seconds  
0 causes the Automated Attendant to immediately route callers to the Timeout destination.  
Default  
5  
4222-03: Screened Transfer Timeout  
(STRF Timeout)  
Use this option to set how long a Screened Transfer (STRF) from the Automated Attendant will ring an  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
891  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
42xx-IntraMail  
422x-Routing Mailbox  
4222-Routing Options  
unanswered extension before recalling. The 1603-01: Transfer Recall Timer (page 675) has no interaction  
with this option.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-255 seconds  
0 causes immediate recall  
Default  
15  
4222-04: Fax Detection  
(Fax Detection)  
Use this option to enable or disable Fax Detection for the Call Routing Mailbox. If enabled, the Call Routing  
Mailbox will detect incoming fax CNG tone. The fax will then route to the fax machine specied in 4222-  
05: Fax Extension below. If disabled, the Call Routing Mailbox will not detect incoming fax calls.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
4222-05: Fax Extension  
(Fax Transfer Ext)  
Use this option to specify the extension number of the fax machine associated with the Call Routing Mail-  
box. When the Call Routing Mailbox answers a call and detects fax (CNG) tone, it automatically transfers  
the call to this extension.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
Extension number 0-999  
None entered by pressing CLEAR  
Default  
• None  
892  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
42xx-IntraMail  
422x-Routing Mailbox  
4223-Announcement Opts (Announcement Mailbox Options)  
4223-Announcement Opts (Announcement Mailbox Options)  
Description  
If the Routing Mailbox is an Announcement Mailbox, use this program to set the Announcement Mailbox  
options. The entries you make in this program are valid only if the Routing Mailbox is assigned as an  
Announcement Mailbox (2) in 4221-01: Routing Mailbox Type.  
Options  
4223-01: Repeat Count  
(# of Repeats)  
Enter the number of times you want the Announcement Mailbox message to repeat to callers. After an  
Announcement Mailbox caller initially listens to the message, it will repeat the number of times specied in  
this option. This option interacts with 4223-02: Hang Up After and 4223-03: Next Call Routing Mailbox  
when providing routing options. For a detailed explanation of the interaction of these options, turn to the fol-  
lowing charts:  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-10 (Announcement repeats 1-10 times)  
0 (No repeats)  
Default  
• 0  
4223-02: Hang Up After  
(Hangup Option)  
tional routing options to Automated Attendant callers. For a detailed explanation of the interaction of these  
options, turn to the following charts:  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
893  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
42xx-IntraMail  
422x-Routing Mailbox  
4223-Announcement Opts (Announcement Mailbox Options)  
4223-03: Next Call Routing Mailbox  
(Next CRMB)  
If you set up an Announcement Mailbox to answerAutomated Attendant calls, use this option to provide addi-  
tional routing options to the Automated Attendant callers. This option interacts with 4223-01: Repeat Count  
and 4223-02: Hang Up After below. For a detailed explanation of the interaction of these options, turn to the  
following charts:  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-16 for Call Routing Mailbox numbers 1-16  
0 for undened  
Default  
• 0  
894  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
422x-Routing Mailbox  
4224-Directory Options (Directory Dialing Mailbox Options)  
4224-Directory Options (Directory Dialing Mailbox Options)  
Description  
If the Routing Mailbox is a Directory Dialing Mailbox, use this option to set the Directory Dialing options.  
The entries you make in this program are valid only if the Routing Mailbox is assigned as a Directory Dial-  
ing Mailbox (3) in 4221-01: Routing Mailbox Type.  
Options  
4224-01: Directory List Number to Use  
(Directory List)  
Use this option to specify which Directory List the Directory Dialing Mailbox should use. The Directory  
Dialing Mailbox can only call Subscriber Mailboxes that are in the list specied by this option.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-8 for Directory List 1-8  
Default  
1  
4224-02:Time Limit for Dialing Commands  
(Dialing Timeout)  
This option determines how long IntraMail will wait for the caller connected to the Directory Dialing Mail-  
box to dial before repeating the Directory Dialing Message. If the caller doesn’t dial within three repeats of  
the message, IntraMail routes the call to the Next Call Routing Mailbox for the Directory Dialing Mailbox.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-99 seconds  
0 immediate timeout  
Default  
5  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
895  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
42xx-IntraMail  
422x-Routing Mailbox  
4224-Directory Options (Directory Dialing Mailbox Options)  
4224-03: Screened Transfer Timeout  
(STRF Timeout)  
Use this option to set how long a Screened Transfer (STRF) from the Directory Dialing Mailbox will ring  
an unanswered extension before recalling.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-255 seconds  
0 for immediate recall  
Default  
15  
896  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
422x-Routing Mailbox  
4224-Directory Options (Directory Dialing Mailbox Options)  
4224-04: Extension Name Match  
(Name Match)  
Use this option to determine which portion of the extension’s programmed name Directory Dialing will use  
to route the call. The options are 1 (rst) or 2 (last). The setting you choose in this option depends on how  
you set up 1511-01: Name Format (page 655). For example:  
Entered Name  
Directory Dialing Routes by:  
1 (rst-last)  
1 (rst)  
2 (last)  
1 (rst)  
2 (last)  
Mary Jones  
Mary  
Jones  
Jones  
Mary  
2 (last-rst)  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1 for rst  
2 for last  
Default  
1  
4224-05: Minimum Number of Letters Required  
(Minimum Letters)  
Use this option to specify the minimum number of letters the caller should dial in order to be routed by the  
Directory Dialing Mailbox. Callers must dial this minimum number of letters, followed by #.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-3 for 1 to 3 letters required  
Default  
1  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
897  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
42xx-IntraMail  
422x-Routing Mailbox  
4224-Directory Options (Directory Dialing Mailbox Options)  
4224-06:Transfer Options  
(Transfer Option)  
Use this option to dene the action Directory Dialing uses when routing a call (Screened or Unscreened  
Transfer)  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1 for Screened Transfer (STRF)  
2 for Unscreened Transfer (UTRF)  
Default  
1  
898  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
422x-Routing Mailbox  
4224-Directory Options (Directory Dialing Mailbox Options)  
4224-07: Next Call Routing Mailbox  
(Next CRMB)  
Use this option to specify the Next Call Routing Mailbox for the Directory Dialing Mailbox. If a Next Call  
Routing Mailbox is specied, the following will occur:  
If the caller dials 0 while listening to the Directory Dialing Message, they route to the 0 action pro-  
grammed into the Dial Action Table associated with the Next Call Routing Mailbox.  
If the caller dials # while listening to the Directory Dialing Message, they route immediately to the  
Next Call Routing Mailbox and listen to the recorded Instruction Menu Message for that mailbox.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
1-16 for Routing Mailboxes 1-16  
0 for undened  
Default  
0  
4224-08: Fax Detection  
(Fax Detection)  
Use this option to enable or disable Fax Detection for the Directory Dialing Mailbox. If enabled, the Direc-  
tory Dialing Mailbox will detect incoming fax CNG tone. The fax will then route to the fax machine speci-  
ed in 4224-08: Fax Detection below. If disabled, the Directory Dialing Mailbox will not detect incoming  
fax calls.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
No (0) - Disabled  
Yes (1) - Enabled  
Default  
No (0) - Disabled  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
899  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
42xx-IntraMail  
422x-Routing Mailbox  
4224-Directory Options (Directory Dialing Mailbox Options)  
4224-09: Fax Transfer Extension  
(Fax Transfer Ext)  
Use this option to specify the extension number of the fax machine associated with the Directory Dialing  
Mailbox. When the Direct Dialing Mailbox answers a call and detects fax (CNG) tone, it automatically  
transfers the call to this extension.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
Extension number 0-999  
None entered by pressing CLEAR  
Default  
• None  
900  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
423x-Dial Actions (Dial Action Table Options)  
4231-Digit Assignment  
423x1-DiaglitAAcstisoingsnm(Deinatl Action Table Options)  
Description  
Use this program to set up the IntraMail Dial Action Tables. The Dial Action Table denes the options than  
an Automated Attendant caller can dial. A Dial Action Table is associated with a Call Routing Mailbox,  
which is in turn associated with an Answer Table. When an Answer Table is active, its associated Call Rout-  
ing Mailbox selects the Dial Action Table which provides dialing options to callers. The illustration below  
shows how this works in a default IntraMail system. There are 16 Dial Action Tables.  
3112-01: Direct Termination (Day)  
3112-04: Direct Termination (Night)  
DIL to Voice Mail  
Master (700)  
Automated Attendant Answering (Default)  
Lines Route to  
Answer Table 1  
3131-02: Answer Table  
421x-Answer Table
Answer Table 1  
Dial Action Table 1  
Dialing Options  
Dial an extension number, or  
0 for the operator  
All Lines  
Calls always route to Call Routing Mailbox 001  
4212: Schedule  
Schedule 1 or  
-
-
Schedule 1 active M-F 8:30AM-5:00PM.  
4211-01: Default Mailbox  
Default Mailbox  
Default Mailbox active all other times.  
To record a new Instruction Menu  
Message (from Extension 300):  
Call Routing  
Mailbox 001  
422x: Routing Mailboxes (001)  
Automated Attendant  
V-MAIL + SA + I + 001  
Built-In Automated Attendant  
#AG + 001  
Dial Action  
Table 1  
423x: Dial Action Tables  
With these  
dialing options  
Use Answer  
Table 1  
Which Chooses Call  
Routing Mailbox 001.  
And Dial Action  
Table 1  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
901  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
423x-Dial Actions (Dial Action Table Options)  
4231-Digit Assignment  
The following table shows the Dial Action Table default assignments.  
Dial Action Table Default Settings  
Key  
0
Dial Action Table 1  
Dial Action Tables 2-16  
UTRF to 300  
(Unscreened Transfer to 300)  
UND  
(Undened)  
1
2
3
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UTRF to XXX  
(Unscreened Transfer to  
user-dialed extension)  
UND  
(Undened)  
4
UTRF to XXX  
(Unscreened Transfer to  
user-dialed extension)  
UND  
(Undened)  
5
6
7
8
9
*
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
UND  
(Undened)  
HNGUP  
(Hangup)  
UND  
(Undened)  
REC1 to IXXX  
(Quick Message with Greeting to  
user-dialed extension)  
UND  
(Undened)  
#
LOGON to IXXX  
(Logon to user-dialed mailbox)  
UND  
(Undened)  
Timeout  
UTRF to 300  
(Unscreened Transfer to 300)  
UND  
(Undened)  
Timeout provides the routing for rotary dial callers. See Automatic Routing for Rotary Dial Callers  
902  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
42xx-IntraMail  
423x-Dial Actions (Dial Action Table Options)  
4231-Digit Assignment  
Options  
4231-01: Digit xx Action  
(Digit x Action)  
Use this option to assign the actions (functions) to the keys that Automated Attendant callers can dial. See  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
STRF for Screened Transfer (dial 1)  
UTRF for Unscreened Transfer (dial 2)  
REC1 for Quick Message with Greeting (dial 3)  
REC2 for Quick Message without Greeting (dial 4)  
LOGON for Log Onto Voice Mail (dial 5)  
Hang Up for Hang up (dial 6)  
GOTO for go to a mailbox (dial 7)  
UND for undened routing (dial 0)  
Default  
4231-01: Digit xx Routing Data  
(Digit x Routing)  
Using this option to assign the routing data to each key action. See Dial Action Table Routing Options  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
903  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
423x-Dial Actions (Dial Action Table Options)  
4231-Digit Assignment  
Options  
• Extension number using 0-9, # and *  
N for no routing (press Feature Key 1)  
I for ignore caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 2)  
X for caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 3)  
P for pause (press Feature Key 4)  
Default  
904  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
42xx-IntraMail  
423x-Dial Actions (Dial Action Table Options)  
4231-Digit Assignment  
Dial Action Table Actions  
STRF Action - Screened Transfer (1)  
(STRF)  
Use this action to allow an Automated Attendant caller to place a Screened Transfer to an extension. After an  
Automated Attendant caller dials an extension, IntraMail calls (screens) the destination to see if the transfer  
can go through.  
If the destination is available, the Automated Attendant rings it. If the destination answers, the call goes  
through.  
If the destination doesn’t answer within a preset interval, is busy, or is in Do Not Disturb, the Automated  
Attendant doesn’t extend the call. It then provides the caller with additional options.  
Routing  
Normally, the corresponding Routing option should be XXX. Note that the key you choose for this action is  
the rst digit of the called extension number.  
• For example, to allow callers to place Screened Transfers to extensions 300-399, for key 3 enter STRF  
for the Action and XXX for the corresponding Routing.  
To have Screened Transfer call a specic extension, the corresponding Routing option should be that exten-  
sion’s number. The caller then dials that single digit to reach the extension.  
• For example, to have caller’s dial 8 to reach extension 303, for key 8 enter STRF for the Action and  
303 for the corresponding Routing.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options for Action  
1 for STRF  
Options for Routing  
• Digits using 0-8, # and * (8 max.)  
N for no routing (press Feature Key 1)  
I for ignore caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 2)  
X for caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 3)  
P for pause (press Feature Key 4)  
Default  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
905  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
42xx-IntraMail  
423x-Dial Actions (Dial Action Table Options)  
4231-Digit Assignment  
UTRF Action - Unscreened Transfer (2)  
(UTRF)  
Use this action to allow an Automated Attendant caller to place an Unscreened Transfer to an extension. This  
is similar to telephone system unscreened transfers in which the transferring party immediately extends the  
call. After an Automated Attendant caller dials an extension, IntraMail transfers the call to the destination  
and hangs up. Any recalls or additional routing are handled by the telephone system - just as with any other  
unscreened transfer.  
Routing  
Normally, the corresponding Routing option should be XXX. Note that the key you choose for this action is  
the rst digit of the called extension number.  
• For example, to allow callers to place Unscreened Transfers to extensions 300-399, for key 3 enter  
UTRF for the Action and XXX for the corresponding Routing.  
To have Unscreened Transfer call a specic extension, the corresponding Routing option should be that  
extension’s number. The caller then dials that single digit to reach the extension.  
• For example, to have caller’s dial 8 to reach extension 303, for key 8 enter UTRF for the Action and  
303 for the corresponding Routing.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options for Action  
2 for UTRF  
Options for Routing  
• Digits using 0-8, # and * (8 max.)  
N for no routing (press Feature Key 1)  
I for ignore caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 2)  
X for caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 3)  
P for pause (press Feature Key 4)  
Default  
906  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
423x-Dial Actions (Dial Action Table Options)  
4231-Digit Assignment  
REC1 Action - Quick Message With Greeting (3)  
(REC1)  
Use this action to allow an Automated Attendant caller to leave a Quick Message at an extension. With this  
action, the caller will hear the extension’s greeting prior to leaving the message.  
Routing  
To have the caller leave a quick Message at a specic extension, the corresponding Routing option should be  
the extension number.  
To have the caller leave a Quick Message at any caller-dialed extension, the corresponding Routing option  
should be IXXX.  
To have the caller leave a Quick Message at a caller-dialed extension in a specic range, the corresponding  
Routing option should be XXX.  
• For example, to allow callers to leave a Quick Message extensions 300-399, for key 3 enter REC1 for  
the Action and XXX for the corresponding Routing.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options for Action  
3 for REC1  
Options for Routing  
• Digits using 0-8, # and * (8 max.)  
N for no routing (press Feature Key 1)  
I for ignore caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 2)  
X for caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 3)  
P for pause (press Feature Key 4)  
Default  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
907  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
423x-Dial Actions (Dial Action Table Options)  
4231-Digit Assignment  
REC2 Action - Quick Message Without Greeting (4)  
(REC2)  
Use this action to allow an Automated Attendant caller to leave a Quick Message at an extension. With this  
action, the caller will not hear the extension’s greeting prior to leaving the message. Instead, the caller hears  
the voice prompt “Recording” followed by a beep.  
Routing  
To have the caller leave a quick Message at a specic extension, the corresponding Routing option should be  
the extension number.  
To have the caller leave a Quick Message at any caller-dialed extension, the corresponding Routing option  
should be IXXX.  
To have the caller leave a Quick Message at a caller-dialed extension in a specic range, the corresponding  
Routing option should be XXX.  
• For example, to allow callers to leave a Quick Message extensions 300-399, for key 3 enter REC2 for  
the Action and XXX for the corresponding Routing.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options for Action  
4 for REC2  
Options for Routing  
• Digits using 0-8, # and * (8 max.)  
N for no routing (press Feature Key 1)  
I for ignore caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 2)  
X for caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 3)  
P for pause (press Feature Key 4)  
Default  
908  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
423x-Dial Actions (Dial Action Table Options)  
4231-Digit Assignment  
LOGON Action - Log Onto Voice Mail (5)  
(LOGON)  
Use this key action to allow an Automated Attendant caller to log onto voice mail. Depending on program-  
ming (see Routing below), the caller is logged directly into a Subscriber Mailbox or is prompted to enter a  
Subscriber Mailbox of their own choosing. You cannot use the LOGON option with Call Routing and  
Announcement Mailboxes.  
Routing  
To log directly into a specic Subscriber Mailbox, enter the mailbox number in the corresponding Routing  
option.  
• For example, to have key 4 log directly into Subscriber Mailbox 305, for key 4 enter LOGON for the  
Action and 305 for the corresponding Routing.  
To have IntraMail request Automated Attendant callers to select a Subscriber Mailbox to log into, enter N in  
the corresponding Routing option. The key you choose must represent the rst digit in the Subscriber Mail-  
box numbers.  
• For example, to have the Automated Attendant request callers to enter the number of the Subscriber  
Mailbox into which they wish to log, for key 3 enter LOGON for the Action and N for the correspond-  
ing Routing. When callers dial 3, they hear, “Please enter your mailbox number.”  
To have IntraMail require Automated Attendant callers to enter a Subscriber Mailbox to log into (without  
playing an announcement), enter XXX in the corresponding Routing option. The key you choose must repre-  
sent the rst digit in the Subscriber Mailbox numbers.  
• For example, to allow callers to log onto mailboxes 300-399, for key 3 enter LOGON for the Action  
and XXX for the corresponding Routing.  
To log into any valid Subscriber Mailbox, enter IXXX in the corresponding Routing option.  
- For example, to allow callers to dial 1 plus any Subscriber Mailbox number to log on, for key 1  
enter LOGON for the Action and IXXX for the corresponding Routing.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options for Action  
5 for LOGON  
Options for Routing  
• Digits using 0-8, # and * (8 max.)  
N for no routing (press Feature Key 1)  
I for ignore caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 2)  
X for caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 3)  
P for pause (press Feature Key 4)  
Default  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
909  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
423x-Dial Actions (Dial Action Table Options)  
4231-Digit Assignment  
Hang Up Action (6)  
(HNGUP)  
When an Automated Attendant caller presses a key assigned to this action, IntraMail says “Goodbye” and  
immediately hangs up.  
Routing  
There is no entry required in the corresponding Routing option.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options for Action  
6 for Hang Up  
Options for Routing  
• Digits using 0-8, # and * (8 max.)  
N for no routing (press Feature Key 1)  
I for ignore caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 2)  
X for caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 3)  
P for pause (press Feature Key 4)  
Default  
910  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
423x-Dial Actions (Dial Action Table Options)  
4231-Digit Assignment  
GOTO Action - Go to Mailbox (7)  
(GOTO)  
Use this option to provide Automated Attendant callers with the ability to route to Routing Mailboxes. For  
example, a caller can dial a digit for Sales, and then go to the Call Routing or Announcement Mailbox that  
provides the dialing options and instructions for Sales.  
Routing  
To have Automated Attendant callers dial a single digit to go to a Routing Mailbox, enter the mailbox num-  
ber in the corresponding Routing option.  
• For example, to have key 1 go to Call Routing Mailbox 1, for key 1 enter GOTO for the Action and 1  
for the corresponding Routing.  
To have IntraMail require Automated Attendant callers to enter a Routing Mailbox to go to, enter XXX in  
the corresponding Routing option. The key you choose must represent the rst digit in the mailbox numbers.  
• For example, to allow callers to go to mailboxes 1-16, for key 0 enter GOTO for the Action and XXX  
for the corresponding Routing.  
To log into any valid Routing Mailbox, enter IXXX in the corresponding Routing option.  
• For example, to allow callers to dial 1 plus any Routing Mailbox number to go to, for key 1 enter  
GOTO for the Action and IXXX for the corresponding Routing.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options for Action  
7 for GOTO  
Options for Routing  
• Digits using 0-8, # and * (8 max.)  
N for no routing (press Feature Key 1)  
I for ignore caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 2)  
X for caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 3)  
P for pause (press Feature Key 4)  
Default  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
911  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
423x-Dial Actions (Dial Action Table Options)  
4231-Digit Assignment  
UND Action - Undened Routing (0)  
(UND)  
Use this key action if you want a key to have no routing (no operation). When an Automated Attendant caller  
presses an undened key, they hear, “That is an invalid entry.The caller can then dial another option.  
Features  
• N/A  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options for Action  
0 for undened  
Options for Routing  
• Digits using 0-8, # and * (8 max.)  
N for no routing (press Feature Key 1)  
I for ignore caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 2)  
X for caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 3)  
P for pause (press Feature Key 4)  
Default  
912  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42xx-IntraMail  
423x-Dial Actions (Dial Action Table Options)  
4231-Digit Assignment  
Dial Action Table Routing Options  
Digits  
(0-9, #, and *)  
Use Dial Action Table digits to route an Automated Attendant call to a specic location (such as an exten-  
sion). For example, to set up a STRF Action to route to extension 305, for digit 3 enter STRF for the Action  
and 305 for the corresponding Routing.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
• Digits using 0-8, # and * (8 max.)  
Default  
Caller Dialed Digits  
(X)  
Use the X option to route an Automated Attendant call based on digits the caller dials. Each X entry repre-  
sents one caller-dialed digit. For example, to set up a STRF Action to route to any caller dialed extension in  
the 300-399 range, for digit 3 enter STRF for the Action and XXX for the corresponding Routing.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
X for caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 3)  
Default  
Ignore Digits  
(I)  
Use the I option to represent any digit dialed by the Automated Attendant caller that IntraMail ignores for  
routing. An example of this is REC action assigned to the * key in Dial Action Table 1 by default. The Action  
is REC2 and the Routing is IXXX. This means that a caller can dial * + any mailbox number to leave a  
Quick Message in that mailbox. IntraMail ignores the rst digit dialed by the caller (*), and routes according  
to the next 3 digits dialed.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
I for ignore caller dialed digit (press Feature Key 2)  
Default  
DSX Software Manual  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
913  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
42xx-IntraMail  
423x-Dial Actions (Dial Action Table Options)  
4231-Digit Assignment  
No Routing  
(N)  
Use the N option when you want no Automated Attendant routing to automatically occur. This can be used  
with the LOGON action when you want to prompt the caller to enter a mailbox number. To do this for the #  
key (for example), for the # key enter LOGON for the Action and N for the corresponding Routing. When the  
caller dials #, they hear, “Please enter the mailbox number. Or, to exit, press the pound key.”  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
N for no routing (press Feature Key 1)  
Default  
Pause  
(P)  
Use the P option when you want the Automated Attendant to pause while dialing. This option is typically used  
with the Centrex Transfer feature to give the system adequate time to dial the stored System Speed Dial number.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
Options  
P for pause (press Feature Key 4)  
Default  
914  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
90xx-Utilities  
900x-Reset (Reset Utilities)  
9001-System (System Reset)  
Maintenance Options:  
9001 - 9042  
90xx-Utilities  
900x1-RSyesteetm(R(eS  
s
y
e
stteUtiliRtieesse)t)  
m
Description  
Use this program to reset the system.  
Options  
9001-01: System Reset  
(System)  
Use this option to reset the system. A reset will restart the system with all the programming intact.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Exit without resetting  
Yes (1) - Reset  
Default  
No (0) - Exit without resetting  
DSX Software Manual  
Maintenance Options: 9001-9211  
915  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
90xx-Utilities  
900x-Reset (Reset Utilities)  
9002-Station (Station Reset)  
9002-Station (Station Reset)  
Description  
Use this program to reset a station port.  
9002-01: Station Reset  
(Station)  
Use this option to reset a station port. A reset will restart the specic extension with all the programming  
intact. You cannot reset the secondary port of a 2PGDAD Module Door Box port.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
Extension Number  
Default  
• None  
916  
Maintenance Options: 9001-9211  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
90xx-Utilities  
901x-Initialize (Initialize Utilities)  
9011-System (Initialize System)  
901x1-ISnyitsiatelimze(I(nInitiitaialilzizeeSUytsiltietimes))  
Description  
Use this program to initialize the system.  
Options  
9011-01: System Initialization  
(System)  
Use this option to initialize the system database.  
Warning  
Initializing the system erases all your programmed entries  
and replaces them with the factory-installed default values.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Exit without initializing  
Yes (1) -Initialize  
Default  
• 1  
DSX Software Manual  
Maintenance Options: 9001-9211  
917  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
90xx-Utilities  
901x-Initialize (Initialize Utilities)  
9012-Toll Restrictions (Initialize Toll Restriction)  
9012-Toll Restrictions (Initialize Toll Restriction)  
Description  
Use this program to initialize Toll Restriction.  
Options  
9012-01: Initialize Toll Restriction  
(Toll Restrict)  
Use this option to initialize Toll Restriction. You should initialize Toll Restriction before using if for the rst  
time. This will also initialize Caller ID Tables 3711 through 3715.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Initialize Toll Restriction  
Yes (1) - Do not initialize Toll Restriction  
Default  
• None  
918  
Maintenance Options: 9001-9211  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
90xx-Utilities  
901x-Initialize (Initialize Utilities)  
9013-CID Logs (Initialize Caller ID Logs)  
9013-CID Logs (Initialize Caller ID Logs)  
Description  
Use this program to initialize the Caller ID logs system-wide.  
Options  
9013-01: Initialize Caller ID Logs  
(CID Logs)  
Use this option to initialize (clear) all the Caller ID logs system-wide. This utility clears all the personal logs  
as well as all the group logs. It has no effect on other Caller ID programming.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Initialize Caller ID Logs  
Yes (1) - Do not initialize Caller ID Logs  
Default  
• None  
DSX Software Manual  
Maintenance Options: 9001-9211  
919  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
90xx-Utilities  
901x-Initialize (Initialize Utilities)  
9014-Ring Tones (Initialize Ring Tones)  
9014-Ring Tones (Initialize Ring Tones)  
Description  
Use this program to initialize Distinctive Ringing system-wide.  
Options  
9014-01: Initialize Ring Tones  
(Ring)  
Use this option to initialize all ring tones system-wide. This returns all ring tones on all extensions to their  
default settings.  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Do not initialize ringing system-wide  
Yes (1) - Initialize ringing system-wide  
Default  
• None  
920  
Maintenance Options: 9001-9211  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
90xx-Utilities  
902x-Copy  
9021-Station Copy  
902x1-CStoaptiyon Copy  
Description  
Use this program to copy data from an extension to another extension or range of extensions.  
Options  
9021-01: Station Copy  
(Station Copy)  
This option allows you to copy station data from one extension to another extension or range of extensions.  
The table below shows the programs you can copy.  
9021 - Station Copy Program Options  
Option  
01  
Station Program  
2101-Type (Station Type)1  
2102-Access  
Option  
13  
Station Program  
2122-Ring Override  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
10  
11  
12  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
2123-BLF  
2103-Ringing  
2124-Soft Keys  
2104-Display  
2131-Lines  
2111-Features  
2132-Ringing  
2112-Speaker Control  
2113-Groups  
2133-Line Groups  
2141-Type (Mailbox Type)  
2142-Setup (Mailbox Setup)  
2143-Options (Mailbox Options)  
2144-Auto-Attendant (Mailbox AA Options)  
2151-Assignment (Personal Speed Dial Bins)  
2114-Off Hook  
2115-Hunt/Overow  
2116-Off Hook Signal  
2117-Call Logging  
2121-Feature Keys  
1 2101-02: Names data is not copied  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• Turn to the following page for help using 9021: Station Copy.  
Default  
• None  
DSX Software Manual  
Maintenance Options: 9001-9211  
921  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
90xx-Utilities  
902x-Copy  
9021-Station Copy  
Using 9021-01: Station Copy  
To copy data from an extension to another extension or range of extensions:  
1.  
2.  
Access option 9021-01. You see: Copy Program  
Press HOLD and select the option (01-23) corresponding to the station program you want to copy.  
You can dial the option number (01-23) or press Volume Up and Volume Down to scroll through the selections.  
3.  
4.  
Press HOLD. You see: From Extension  
Enter the source extension number + HOLD. You see: To Extension  
• This is the extension from which the data will be copied.  
Enter the target extension number + HOLD. You see: Thru Extension  
• This is the extension to which the data will be copied.  
• If you are copying data to a range of extensions, this is the rst (lowest) extension in the range.  
5.  
6.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
If copying data to a single extension, re-enter the extension you entered in step 5 above + HOLD.  
If copying data to a range of extensions, enter the highest (last) extension in the range + HOLD.  
7.  
When the copy has successfully completed, you see: Copy Complete  
922  
Maintenance Options: 9001-9211  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
90xx-Utilities  
902x-Copy  
9022-Line Copy  
9022-Line Copy  
Description  
Use this program to copy data from a line to another line or range of lines.  
Options  
9022-01: Line Copy  
(Line Copy)  
This option allows you to copy data from one line to another line or range of lines. The table below shows  
the programs you can copy.  
9022 - Line Copy Program Options  
Option  
01  
Line Program  
Option  
7
Line Program  
3101-Type (Line Type)1  
3121-Settings (Caller ID)  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
8
3102-Access  
3122-Groups (Caller ID)  
3131-Settings (Voice Mail)  
3141-Dialing (Tie Line)  
9
3103-Settings  
3111-Features  
3112-Termination  
3113-Ringing  
10  
11  
12  
3142-Line Access (Tie Line)  
3143-Group Access (Tie Line)  
1 3101-02: Names data is not copied  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• Turn to the following page for help using 9022: Line Copy.  
Default  
• None  
DSX Software Manual  
Maintenance Options: 9001-9211  
923  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
90xx-Utilities  
902x-Copy  
9022-Line Copy  
Using 9022-01: Line Copy  
To copy data from a line to another line or range of lines:  
1.  
2.  
Access option 9022-01. You see: Copy Program  
Press HOLD and select the option (01-12) corresponding to the line program you want to copy.  
You can dial the option number (01-23) or press Volume Up and Volume Down to scroll through the selections.  
3.  
4.  
Press HOLD. You see: From Line  
Enter the source line number + HOLD. You see: To Line  
• This is the line from which the data will be copied.  
Enter the target line number + HOLD. You see: Thru Line  
• This is the line to which the data will be copied.  
• If you are copying data to a range of lines, this is the rst (lowest) line in the range.  
5.  
6.  
Do one of the following.  
a.  
b.  
If copying data to a single line, re-enter the line you entered in step 5 above + HOLD.  
If copying data to a range of lines, enter the highest (last) line in the range + HOLD.  
7.  
When the copy has successfully completed, you see: Copy Complete  
924  
Maintenance Options: 9001-9211  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
90xx-Utilities  
903x-Swap Ports  
9031-Station Swap  
903x1-SwtaatiponPoSrwtsap  
Description  
Use this program swap two extensions. This swaps all the programming between the two extensions, includ-  
ing the extension number and station name. With 9031-Station Swap, it is no longer necessary to install and  
wire cross-connect blocks to easily swap two extensions.  
Options  
9031-01: Station Swap  
(Swap with Ext)  
This option allows you swap two extensions. This swaps all the programming between the two extensions. If  
the extension being swapped is a 2PGDAD Module Door Box port with the secondary port assigned, this  
program will also swap the secondary port.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• See below.  
Default  
• None  
Using 9031-01: Station Swap  
To swap two extensions:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
Access option 9031-01.  
Press TRANSFER and select the rst extension.  
Press HOLD and enter the second extension.  
Press HOLD again to make the swap. You see: Swap Complete!  
You cannot swap an extension busy on a call.  
DSX Software Manual  
Maintenance Options: 9001-9211  
925  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
90xx-Utilities  
903x-Swap Ports  
9032-Line Swap  
9032-Line Swap  
Description  
Use this program swap two line circuits. For example, if you swap line 1 with line 2, line 1 now uses the  
telco circuit formerly assigned to line 2 and vise versa. With 9032-Line Swap, it is no longer necessary to  
install and wire cross-connect blocks to easily swap two lines.  
Options  
9032-01: Line Swap  
(Swap with Ext)  
This option allows you swap two line circuits.  
Features  
• None  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
• See below.  
Default  
• None  
Using 9032-01: Line Swap  
To swap two lines:  
1.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
Access option 9032-01.  
Press TRANSFER and select the rst line extension number.  
Press HOLD and enter the second line extension number.  
Press HOLD again to make the swap. You see: Swap Complete!  
926  
Maintenance Options: 9001-9211  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
90xx-Utilities  
904x-Backup/Restore  
9041-Backup  
904x1-Backup/Restore  
Description  
Use this option to back up (save) the system database to a CompactFlash Card plugged into the IntraMail  
CompactFlash Card slot. You can then restore (load) the system database using 9042-Restore (page 928).  
You can store the system database on the IntraMail CompactFlash Card or on a separate FAT16 or FAT32  
formatted CompactFlash card. The entire system database uses about 500 Kbytes Of Compact Flash mem-  
ory. See your system’s Hardware Manual for more and how to install a CompactFlash Card.  
Options  
9041-01: Backup to CompactFlash  
(Backup to CF)  
Use this option to back up the system database to a CompactFlash Card. You can use 9042-Restore  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Do not backup  
Yes (1) - Start backup  
Default  
• None  
Using 9041-01: Backup  
To backup your DSX system database:  
Insert your CompactFlash card into the system’s IntraMail CompactFlash Card slot.  
You can use your IntraMail CompactFlash for backup or a standard FAT16/FAT32 formatted card.  
• The DSX system database only takes up 500K Bytes of your CompactFlash Card memory.  
1.  
2.  
2.  
Access option 9041-01. You see: Backup to CF  
Press HOLD and do one of the following.  
Dial 1 (Yes) + HOLD to begin the backup.  
• During the backup:  
- You see: Please Wait  
- The CPU Serial Port LED (DS-80/160) winks on (green).  
a.  
- The CompactFlash LED occasionally winks on (red).  
• When the backup completes (after about 1 minute), you see: Backup Complete!  
b.  
Dial 0 (No) + SPEAKER to abort the backup.  
DSX Software Manual  
Maintenance Options: 9001-9211  
927  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
90xx-Utilities  
904x-Backup/Restore  
9042-Restore  
9042-Restore  
Description  
Use this option to restore (load) the database previously backed-up (saved) on a CompactFlash Card using  
or on a separate FAT16 or FAT32 formatted CompactFlash card. The entire system database uses about 500  
Kbytes Of Compact Flash memory. See your system’s Hardware Manual for more and how to install a Com-  
pactFlash Card.  
Options  
9042-01: Restore from CompactFlash  
(Restore from CF)  
Use this option to restore the system database previously saved to a CompactFlash Card using 9041-Backup  
Features  
IntraMail Features  
• None  
Options  
No (0) - Do not restore  
Yes (1) - Start restore  
Default  
• None  
Using 9042-01: Restore  
To restore your DSX system database:  
Insert your CompactFlash card into the system’s IntraMail CompactFlash Card slot.  
• Use the same CompactFlash Card to which you previously backed up the site data.  
1.  
2.  
2.  
Access option 9042-01. You see: Restore from CF  
Press HOLD and do one of the following.  
Dial 1 (Yes) + HOLD to begin the restore.  
• The system will automatically restart with the restored data loaded.  
a.  
b.  
Dial 0 (No) + SPEAKER to abort the restore.  
928  
Maintenance Options: 9001-9211  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DSX  
Program List  
DSX Program List  
DSX Program List  
System Options: 1001-1702  
10xx-Configuration  
100x-System  
1001-Version  
1001-01: System Type  
1001-02: Software Version  
1001-03: DSP Version  
101x-ID  
1011-Name  
1011-01: System Name  
1011-02: Telephone Number  
Name Programming Chart  
102x-Time  
1021-Set Time and Date  
1021-01: System Time  
1021-02: System Date  
1022-Daylight Savings Time  
1022-01: Automatic Daylight Savings Time Setting  
1023-Internet (Network Time Server [NTS])  
1023-01: Network Time Server Name  
103x-Programming  
1031-Password Entry  
1031-01: New Password  
11xx-CPU  
110x-I/O  
1101-RS232 Settings  
DSX Program List  
929  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DSX Program List  
1101-01: Baud Rate  
1102-Modem Settings  
1103-USB Settings  
1104-Ethernet Setup  
1104-01: System IP Address  
1104-02: System Subnet Mask  
1104-03: Default Gateway  
111x-Tones  
1111-DTMF Setup  
1111-01: Manual DTMF Tone On  
1111-02: Manual DTMF Tone Off  
1111-03: Speed Dial DTMF Tone On  
1111-04: Speed Dial DTMF Tone Off  
12xx-Slots  
120x-Stations  
1201-Type (Station Card Type)  
1201-01: Card Type  
1202-Ports (Primary Station Ports)  
1202-01: Primary Station Port Assignment  
1203-Secondary Station Ports  
1203-01: Secondary Station Port Assignment  
121x-Lines  
1211-Lines (Line Card Type)  
1211-01: Card Type  
1212-Ports  
1212-01: Line Port Assignment  
1213-T1/E1 Card Setup  
1213-01: Number of PCM Channels  
1213-02: Clock Control  
1213-03: Transmit Pulse Amplitude  
1213-04: Framer Type  
1213-05: Zero Suppression  
1213-06: Loopback Mode  
13xx-Numbering  
130x-Dial Plan  
1301-Digits  
1301-[01-10]: Function Type  
1301-[01-10]: Expected Number of Digits  
131x-Extensions  
1311-Stations  
1311-01: Station Extension Number  
1312-Voice Mail Ports  
1312-01: Voice Mail Extension Number  
1313-Lines  
1313-01: Line Extension Number  
1314-Ring Groups  
1314-01: Ring Group Master Extension Number  
1315-UCD Groups  
1315-01: UCD Group Master Extension Number  
14xx-COS (Class of Service)  
140x-Station  
1401-Features  
930  
DSX Program List  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSX Program List  
1401-01: System Speed Dial Access  
1401-02: Extended Ring  
1401-03: Privacy  
1401-04: ACD Supervisor  
1401-05: Soft Keys  
1401-06: Conversation Record  
1401-07: DND Override  
1401-08: Receive DID Calls  
1401-09: Receive DID Camp-On  
1401-10: Name Programming  
1401-11: Language Programming  
1401-12: Call Screening  
1401-13: Hotline Automatic Transfer  
1402-Access  
1402-01: Forced Line Disconnect  
1402-02: Barge In (Intrusion)  
1402-03: Camp-On to Busy Extension  
1402-04: Silent Monitor  
1402-05: Activate Night Mode  
1402-06: Direct Line Access  
1403-SLT’s (Single Line Telephone Options)  
1403-01: Flash for Single Line Set  
1403-02: Single Ring for Single Line Set  
1403-03: Special Dial Tone for Single Line Set  
1403-04: High Voltage Message Waiting Lamp for Single Line Set  
1403-05: FSK Message Waiting Lamp for Single Line Set  
1403-06: Loop Disconnect for Single Line Set  
1404-Caller ID  
1404-01: Caller ID Display  
1404-02: Second Call Caller ID  
1404-03: Third Party Caller ID  
1404-04: Caller ID Display Separator  
1404-05: Outgoing ANI Privacy  
1404-06: Caller ID Alert Lamp  
1405-Distinctive Ringing  
1405-01: Ring Type Configuration  
1405-02: Station Ring Override  
1405-03: Key Ring Override  
1406-Call Forwarding Options  
1406-01: Call Forwarding Off-Premises  
1406-02: Internal Call Forwarding  
1407-Paging  
1407-01: Make All Call Page  
1407-02: Make Page Into Zone 1  
1407-03: Make Page Into Zone 2  
1407-04: Make Page Into Zone 3  
1407-05: Make Page Into Zone 4  
1407-06: Make Page Into Zone 5  
1407-07: Make Page Into Zone 6  
1407-08: Make Page Into Zone 7  
141x-Line  
1411-Access  
DSX Program List  
931  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSX Program List  
1411-01: Camp-On to Busy Lines  
1411-02: Line Queue Priority  
1411-03: Automatic Hold  
1411-04: Enhanced Last Number Redial  
1411-05: Unsupervised Conference  
1412-Toll Restriction  
1412-01: Walking Class of Service (Day)  
1412-02: Walking Class of Service (Night)  
1412-03: Station Locking  
1412-04: Forced Account Codes  
1412-05: Verified Account Codes  
1412-06: Account Codes for Toll Calls Only  
15xx-Options  
150x-Operators  
1501-Setup  
1501-01: Number of Operators  
1502-Assignments  
1502-01: Operator Number 1  
1502-02: Operator Number 2  
1502-03: Operator Number 3  
1502-04: Operator Number 4  
151x-Stations  
1511-Display  
1511-01: Name Format  
1511-02: Clock Display Format  
1512-Calls  
1512-01: Automatic Handsfree  
1512-02: Call Waiting Tones  
1513-Intercom  
1513-01: Intercom Voice Announcements  
1513-02: Handsfree Reply (Handsfree Answerback)  
152x-MOH/BGM  
1521-Setup  
1521-01: Enable Music on Hold  
1521-02: Music on Hold for Transferred Calls  
1521-03: Background Music Source  
1521-04: Background Music over External Page  
1521-05: Audio Input 1 Gain Setting  
1521-06: Audio Input 2 Gain Setting  
153x-Paging  
1531-Setup  
1531-01: External Page Ring Type  
1531-02: Extension Ring Over External Page  
1531-03: External Page Ring Volume  
1531-04: Door Chime Over External Page  
1531-05: External Page Gain  
1532-Ring Control  
1532-[01-64]: External Page Line Ringing  
154x-SMDR (Station Message Detail Recording)  
1541-Setup  
1541-01: SMDR Port  
1541-02: Print SMDR Headers  
932  
DSX Program List  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSX Program List  
1541-03: SMDR Language  
155x-Account Codes  
1551-Setup  
1551-01: Dial # to Enter Account Codes  
1551-02: Allow Account Codes in Speed Dial Bins  
1551-03: Show Account Codes on Telephone Display  
1551-04: Account Code Toll Restriction Level  
16xx-Timers  
160x-Feature Timers  
1601-Incoming Call Timers  
1601-01: Line No Answer Timer  
1601-02: DIL No Answer Timer  
1601-03: Call Forward No Answer Timer  
1601-04: UCD No Answer Timer  
1602-Outgoing Call Timers  
1602-01: Interdigit Timer  
1602-02: Line Response Timer  
1602-03: Dialtone Detect Timer  
1602-04: Dial Pause Timer  
1602-05: CO Busy Out Timer  
1602-06: Repeat Redial Timer  
1602-07: Repeat Redial Busy Timer  
1603-Recall Timers  
1603-01: Transfer Recall Timer  
1603-02: Hold Recall Timer  
1603-03: Exclusive Hold Recall Timer  
1603-04: Park Orbit Recall Timer  
1604-Station Timers  
1604-01: Delay Ring Timer  
1604-02: Call Coverage Delay Ring Timer  
1604-03: Extended Ringing Timer  
1605-Control Timers  
1605-01: Page Duration Timer  
1605-02: Meet Me Conference Join Timer  
1605-03: Door Relay Unlock Timer  
1605-04: Forced Program Exit Timer  
1605-05: Backlight Idle Timer  
161x-COI (Analog Line) Timers  
1611-Incoming  
1611-01: Minimum Ring Detect Timer  
1611-02: Minimum Single Ring Detection Timer  
1611-03: Minimum Double Ring Detection Off Timer  
1611-04: Maximum Double Ring Detection Off Timer  
1611-05: Ringing Signal End Detection Timer  
1611-06: Caller ID Detection Timer  
1612-Outgoing  
1612-01: DP Break Timer  
1612-02: DP Make Timer  
1612-03: DP Interdigit Timer  
1612-04: PBX/Centrex Flash Timer  
1612-05: Flash Disconnect Timer  
1612-06: Ground Start Timer  
DSX Program List  
933  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSX Program List  
1612-07: Shunt Pause Timer  
1613-Loop Control  
1613-01: Loop Current Detection Timer  
1613-02: Far End Disconnect Timer  
1613-03: Power Failure Recovery Detect Timer  
162x-SLI (Analog Single Line) Timers  
1621-Incoming  
1621-01: Minimum DP Break Timer  
1621-02: Maximum DP Break Timer  
1621-03: Minimum DP Make Timer  
1621-04: Maximum DP Make Timer  
1621-05: Minimum Hookflash Timer  
1621-06: Maximum Hookflash Timer  
1621-07: Minimum Off Hook Timer  
1621-08: Dial Pulse Guard Timer  
1621-09: Off Hook Guard Time  
1622-Outgoing  
1622-01: Loop Disconnect Timer  
1622-02: Ring/MW Wait Period Time  
163x-T1/E1 Timers  
1631-Incoming  
1631-01: Receive Loop Detection Timer  
1631-02: Receive Dial Pulse Minimum Break Timer  
1631-03: Receive Dial Pulse Maximum Break Timer  
1631-04: Receive Dial Pulse Minimum Make Timer  
1631-05: Receive Dial Pulse Maximum Make Timer  
1631-06: Receive Minimum Flash Timer  
1631-07: Receive Maximum Flash Timer  
1631-08: Receive Minimum Clear Signal Timer  
1632-Outgoing  
1632-01: Transmit Dial Pulse Break Timer  
1632-02: Transmit Dial Pulse Make Timer  
1632-03: Transmit Dial Pulse Interdigit Timer  
1632-04: Transmit Flash Timer  
1632-05: Transmit Clear Signal Timer  
164x-T1 Specific Timers  
1641-Ring Detect  
1641-01: Minimum Ring Detect Timer  
1641-02: Single Ring Minimum Detection Timer  
1641-03: Double Ring Minimum Detection Timer  
1641-04: Double Ring Maximum Detection Timer  
1641-05: Ring Stop Detection Timer  
1642-Call Control  
1642-01: Transmit Wink Timer  
1642-02: Receive Minimum Wink Timer  
1642-03: Receive Maximum Wink Timer  
1642-04: Ground Start Remove Ring Timer  
165x-E1 Specific Timers  
1651-TX (Transmit Timers)  
1651-01: Transmit Seize Acknowledge Timer  
1651-02: Transmit Digit Acknowledge Timer  
1651-03: Transmit Answer Timer  
934  
DSX Program List  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSX Program List  
1651-04: Transmit Forced Clear Signal Timer  
1651-05: Transmit Seize Signal (BZL) Timer  
1651-06: Transmit Double Answer (BZL) Timer  
1652-RX (Receive Timers)  
1652-01: Receive Minimum Seize Acknowledge Timer  
1652-02: Receive Maximum Seize Acknowledge Timer  
1652-03: Receive Minimum Digit Acknowledge Timer  
1652-04: Receive Maximum Digit Acknowledge Timer  
1652-05: Receive Minimum Answer Timer  
1652-06: Receive Maximum Answer Timer  
1652-07: Receive Minimum Meter Pulse Timer  
1652-08: Receive Maximum Meter Pulse Timer  
1652-09: Receive Minimum Double Answer (BZL) Timer  
1652-10: Receive Maximum Double Answer (BZL) Timer  
1652-11: Receive Minimum Line Block Timer  
1652-12: Receive Line Block Recover Timer  
1653-MFC Incoming Timers  
1653-01: GI Signal Timer  
1653-02: GI Tone Complete Timer  
1653-03: GII Signal Timer  
1653-04: GA Pulse Response Timer  
1654-MFC Outgoing Timers  
1654-01: GA Response Timer  
1654-02: GA Tone Complete Timer  
1654-03: GB Response Timer  
1654-04: GB Tone Complete Timer  
1654-05: GC Response Timer  
1654-06: GC Tone Complete Timer  
17xx-Speed Dial (System)  
170x-Setup  
1701-Format  
1701-01: Number of System Speed Dial Bins  
1702-Assignment (System Speed Dial Assignment)  
1702-[001-999]: Select System Speed Dial Bin to Program  
1702-[001-999]: System Speed Dial Bin Type  
1702-[001-999]: System Speed Dial Bin Line  
1702-[001-999]: System Speed Dial Bin Group  
1702-[001-999]: System Speed Dial Bin Number  
1702-[001-999]: System Speed Dial Bin Name  
DSX Program List  
935  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSX Program List  
Stations: 2101-2501  
21xx-Configuration  
210x-Setup  
2101-Type  
2101-01: Station Type  
2101-02: Station Name  
2101-03: Station Display Language  
2101-04: Door Chime Selection  
2101-05: Outgoing ANI ID  
2101-06: Door Relay Assignment  
2102-Access  
2102-01: Class of Service  
2102-02: Station Toll Level (Day)  
2102-03: Station Toll Level (Night)  
2102-04: User Programming Access Level  
2102-05: Station PIN Code  
2103-Ringing  
2103-01: Day Ring Type  
2103-02: Night Ring Type  
2103-03: Delay Ring Type  
2103-04: Station’s Intercom Ring Tone  
2103-05: Station’s Ring Group Ring Tone  
2103-06: Station’s Recall Ring Tone  
2103-07: Station’s Ring “A” Tone  
2103-08: Station’s Ring “B” Tone  
2103-09: Station’s Ring “C” Tone  
2104-Display  
2104-01: Backlight Brightness While Active  
2104-02: Backlight Brightness While Idle  
2104-03: Key Pad Illumination  
211x-Options  
2111-Features  
2111-01: Allow Do Not Disturb  
2111-02: Allow Background Music  
2111-03: Enable DSS/BLF Keys  
2111-04: Ringing Line Preference  
2111-05: Key Access for Outside Lines  
2111-06: Line Dial Up  
2111-07: Retain Line Volume Setting  
2111-08: Answering Machine  
2111-09: Personal Speed Dial  
2112-Speaker Control  
2112-01: Automatic Handsfree  
2112-02: Headset Mode  
2112-03: Voice Announcements Through Speaker  
2112-04: Voice Announcements in Headset Mode  
2112-05: Handsfree Reply (Handsfree Answerback)  
2112-06: Paging Through Speaker  
2113-Groups  
2113-01: Dial 9 Group  
936  
DSX Program List  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSX Program List  
2113-02: Ring Group  
2113-03: Pickup Group  
2113-04: Privacy Group  
2113-05: Page Group (Zone)  
2114-Off Hook Options  
2114-01: Prime Line Type  
2114-01: Prime Line Key  
2114-01: Prime Line Line  
2114-01: Prime Line Group  
2114-02: Station Ring Down Type  
2114-02: Station Ring Down Destination  
2114-03: Station’s Operator Extension Number  
2115-Hunting and Overflow Options  
Sample Hunt Group Programming  
2115-01: Hunt Type  
2115-01: Hunt Destination  
2115-01: UCD Group Master Number  
2115-02: DID Station Intercept Type  
2115-02: DID Station Intercept Destination  
2116-Off Hook Signaling Options  
2116-01: Off Hook Signaling for Incoming Intercom Calls  
2116-02: Off Hook Signaling for Calls from Hotline Partner  
2116-03: Off Hook Signaling for Incoming Outside Calls  
2117-Call Logging (Caller ID Logging)  
2117-01: Caller ID Log Type  
2117-01: Caller ID Log Size  
2117-01: Caller ID Log Group  
212x-Keys  
2121-Feature Keys  
2121-[01 to 24]: Feature Key Codes  
2121-[01 to 24]: Feature Key Data  
2122-Ring Override (Key Ring Override)  
2122-[01 to 24]: Key Ring Override  
2123-BLF (DSS Keys)  
2123-[01-24]: DSS/BLF Key Assignments  
2124-Soft Keys (Idle Menu Soft Keys for Super Display)  
2124-[01-12]: Idle Menu Soft Key Assignments (Super Display)  
213x-Access  
2131-Lines  
2131-[01-64]: Line Access  
2132-Ringing  
2132-[01-64]: Line Ringing  
2133-Line Groups  
2133-[01-64]: Line Group Access  
214x-IntraMail (Station Mailbox)  
2141-Type  
2141-01: Station Mailbox Type  
2142-Setup  
2142-01: Number of Messages  
2142-02: Message Retention  
2142-03: System Administrator  
2142-04: Station Mailbox Voice Prompt Language  
DSX Program List  
937  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSX Program List  
2143-Options  
2143-01: Message Playback Order  
2143-02: Auto Erase/Save of Messages  
2143-03: Auto Time Stamp  
2143-04: Message Waiting Lamp  
2143-05: Recording Conversation Beep  
2144-Auto-Attendant (Automated Attendant)  
2144-01: Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb  
2144-02: Forced Unscreened Transfer  
2144-03: Dialing Option  
2144-04: Next Call Routing Mailbox  
2144-05: Directory List Number  
215x-Speed Dial (Personal)  
2151-Assignment (Personal Speed Dial Bin Assignment)  
2151-[01-20]: Personal Speed Dial Bin Type  
2151-[01-20]: Personal Speed Dial Bin Line  
2151-[01-20]: Personal Speed Dial Bin Group  
2151-[01-20]: Personal Speed Dial Bin Number  
2151-[01-20]: Personal Speed Dial Bin Name  
22xx-Ring Groups  
220x-Setup  
2201-Identification  
2201-01: Ring Group Name  
2201-02: Ring Group Incoming Ring Type  
221x-IntraMail (Ring Group Mailbox)  
2211-Type  
2211-01: Mailbox Type  
2211-01: Routing Mailbox Number  
2212-Setup  
2212-01: Number of Messages  
2212-02: Message Retention  
2212-03: System Administrator  
2212-04: Ring Group Mailbox Voice Prompt Language  
2213-Options  
2213-01: Message Playback Order  
2213-02: Auto Erase/Save of Messages  
2213-03: Auto Time Stamp  
2213-04: Message Waiting Lamp  
2213-05: Recording Conversation Beep  
2214-Auto-Attendant (Automated Attendant)  
2214-01: Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb  
2214-02: Forced Unscreened Transfer  
2214-03: Dialing Option  
2214-04: Next Call Routing Mailbox  
2214-05: Directory List Number  
23xx-UCD Groups  
230x-Setup  
2301-Identification  
2301-01: UCD Group Name  
2301-02: UCD Group Incoming Ring Type  
2302-Options  
2302-01: UCD Group Overflow Destination  
938  
DSX Program List  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSX Program List  
231x-IntraMail (UCD Group Mailbox)  
2311-Type  
2311-01: UCD Group Mailbox Type  
2311-01: UCD Group Routing Mailbox Number  
2312-Setup  
2312-01: Number of Messages  
2312-02: Message Retention  
2312-03: System Administrator  
2312-04: UCD Group Mailbox Voice Prompt Language  
2313-Playback  
2313-01: Message Playback Order  
2313-02: Auto Erase/Save of Messages  
2313-03: Auto Time Stamp  
2313-04: Message Waiting Lamp  
2313-05: Recording Conversation Beep  
2314-(Auto-Attendant) Automated Attendant  
2314-01: Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb  
2314-02: Forced Unscreened Transfer  
2314-03: Dialing Option  
2314-04: Next Call Routing Mailbox  
2314-05: Directory List Number  
24xx-DSS Consoles  
240x-Setup  
2401-Config (DSS Console Configuration)  
2401-01: DSS Owner  
2402-Keys (DSS Console Keys)  
2402-[01-60]: DSS Console Key Codes  
2402-[01-60]: DSS Console Key Data  
25xx-Text Messages (Selectable Display Messaging)  
250x-Setup  
2501-Text  
2501-[01-16]: Selectable Display Messages  
Name Programming Chart  
DSX Program List  
939  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSX Program List  
Lines: 3101-3715  
31xx-Configuration  
310x-Setup  
3101-Type  
3101-01: Line Type  
3101-02: Line Name  
3101-03: DTMF Dialing  
3101-04: PBX Line  
3101-05: E1 Signaling Type  
3101-06: MFC Signaling Type  
3102-Access  
3102-01: Line Class of Service  
3102-02: Line Toll Level  
3103-Settings  
3103-01: Transmit Gain  
3103-02: Receive Gain  
3103-03: Loop Length  
3103-04: Tandem Calls  
3103-05: Music On Hold Source  
311x-Options  
3111-Features  
3111-01: Disable Forced Account Codes  
3111-02: Override Extension’s Toll Level  
3111-03: Dial Tone Detection  
3111-04: Enable MFC Group B  
3111-05: Store and Forward  
3111-06: Station Message Detail Recording  
3112-Termination  
3112-01: Direct Termination in the Day  
3112-02: Enable Day Overflow  
3112-03: Day Overflow Destination  
3112-04: Direct Termination at Night  
3112-05: Enable Night Overflow  
3112-06: Night Overflow Destination  
3113-Ringing  
3113-01: Pickup Group Assignment  
3113-02: Day Ring Type  
3113-03: Night Ring Type  
3113-04: Delay Ring Type  
312x-Caller ID  
3121-Settings  
3121-01: Caller ID Type  
3121-02: ANI/DNIS Format  
3121-03: ANI/DNIS Delimiter  
3121-04: Number of ANI Digits  
3122-Groups  
3122-[01-08]: Caller ID Group Membership  
313x-Voice Mail  
3131-Settings  
3131-01: Pass Caller ID to Voice Mail  
940  
DSX Program List  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSX Program List  
3131-02: IntraMail Answer Table Assignment  
3131-03: Line Voice Prompt Language  
314x-TIE Line  
3141-Dialing  
3141-01: Tie Line Caller’s Outbound Dial 9 Group  
3141-02: Tie Line Caller’s Operator Extension  
3142-Line Access  
3142-[01-64]: Tie Line Caller’s Outbound Line Access  
3143-Group Access  
3143-[01-64]: Tie Line Caller’s Outbound Line Group Access  
32xx-Groups  
320x-Setup  
3201-Order  
3201-[01-64]: Line Group  
33xx-DID (Direct Inward Dialing)  
330x-Setup  
3301-Options  
3301-01: Number of DID Digits  
3302-Translations  
DID Example: Routing DID Block 400-416  
Default Routing  
Programming Ranges and Exceptions  
3302-01: Incoming DID Digits  
3302-01: Day Translation Destination  
3302-01: Night Translation Destination  
3302-01: MFC Category  
34xx-PBX  
340x-Setup  
3401-Codes  
3401-01: PBX Access Code Digits  
35xx-Toll Restriction  
350x-Setup  
3501-Type  
3501-01: Toll Restriction Country Type  
3501-02: Emergency Number  
351x-Options  
3511-Settings  
3511-01: Active Key Pad  
3512-U.S. Dialing  
3512-01: Allow 0 + XXX Operator Assisted Dialing  
3512-02: Allow 011 + XXX International Dialing  
3512-03: Allow 101x Equal Access Dialing  
3512-04: Allow N11 Dialing  
3513-International Dialing  
352x-1010-XXX / Local XXX (Equal Access Dialing)  
3521-Table Options  
3521-01: Initialize Table  
3521-02: Table Type (Allow or Deny)  
3522-Table Entries  
3522-xx: Table Data  
353x-1+XXX / TBL-A XXX (NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table)  
3531-Table Options  
DSX Program List  
941  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSX Program List  
3531-01: Initialize Table  
3531-02: Table Type (Allow or Deny)  
3532-Table Entries  
3532-xx: Table Data  
354x-1+XXX-XXX / TBL-A XXXXXXX (1 + NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table)  
3541-Table Options  
3541-01: Initialize Table  
3541-02: Table Type (Allow or Deny)  
3542-Table Entries  
3542-xx: Table Data  
355x-XXX / TBL-B-XXX (NPA/NXX Dialing 3-Digit Table)  
3551-Table Options  
3551-01: Initialize Table  
3551-02: Table Type (Allow or Deny)  
3552-Table Entries  
3552-xx: Table Data  
356x-XXX-XXX / TBL-B XXXXXX (NPA + NXX Dialing 6-Digit Table)  
3561-Table Options  
3561-01: Initialize Table  
3561-02: Table Type (Allow or Deny)  
3562-Table Entries  
3562-xx: Table Data  
36xx-AC Codes (Verified Account Codes Table)  
360x-Setup  
3601-Codes  
3601-xx: Verified Account Code Data  
37xx-Caller ID (System-Wide Options)  
370x-Log Groups (Caller ID Logging Groups)  
3701-Setup  
3701-[01-08]: Caller ID Logging Group Size  
371x-Callback  
3711-Route  
3711-01: Caller ID Callback Route Type  
3711-01: Caller ID Callback Line  
3711-01: Caller ID Callback Group  
3712-Treatment Options (Caller ID Callback Dial Treatment Options)  
3712-01: Initialize Caller ID Dial Treatment Tables  
3712-02: 10-Digit Local Calls  
3712-03: Home Area Code Exception List Type  
3713-Home NPA’s (Home Area Code Table)  
3713-[01-16]: Home Area Code Table Data  
3714-HNPA Exceptions (Home Area Code Exception List Table)  
3714-[01-96]: Home Area Code Exception List Table Data  
3715-FNPA Exceptions (Foreign Area Code Exception List Table)  
3715-[01-96]: Foreign Area Code Exception List Table Data  
942  
DSX Program List  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSX Program List  
Voice Mail Options: 4101-4231  
41xx-Configuration  
410x-System (Voice Mail System Options)  
4101-Type  
4101-01: Voice Mail Type  
4101-02: Voice Mail Master Number  
411x-Ports (Voice Mail Port Setup)  
4111-Options (Voice Mail Port Options)  
4111-01: Voice Mail Port Name  
4111-02: Voice Mail Port Class of Service  
4111-03: Voice Mail Port Toll Restriction Level (Day)  
4111-04: Voice Mail Port Toll Restriction Level (Night)  
Name Programming Chart  
4112-Off Hook (Voice Mail Port Off Hook Options)  
4112-01: Outgoing Dial 9 Group  
4112-02: Operator’s Extension  
4113-Line Access (Voice Mail Port Outgoing Line Access)  
4113-xx: Outgoing Line xx Access  
4114-Group Access (Outgoing Line Group Access)  
4114-xx: Outgoing Line Group xx Access  
42xx-IntraMail  
420x-Options  
4201-Messages (IntraMail Message Options)  
4201-01: Outgoing Message Length  
4201-02: Incoming Message Length  
4201-03: Message Backup/Go Ahead Time  
4202-Notification (Message Notification Options)  
4202-01: Wait Between Non-Pager Callout Attempts  
4202-02: Wait Between Digital Pager Callout Attempts  
4202-03: Wait Between Busy Non-Pager Callout Attempts  
4202-04: Wait Between RNA Non-Pager Callout Attempts  
4202-05: Wait for Answer Non-Pager Callout Attempts  
4202-06: Number of Callout Attempts  
4202-07: Send Pager Callout Until Acknowledged  
4202-08: Digital Pager Callback Number  
4202-09: Delay in Dialing Digital Pager Callback Number  
4203-Voice Prompts (Active System Voice Prompt Languages)  
4203-01: Primary Voice Prompt Language  
4203-02: Secondary Voice Prompt Language  
421x-Answer Table  
4211-Setup (Answer Table Setup)  
4211-01: Default Mailbox  
4211-02: Answer Schedule Override  
4211-03: Override Mailbox  
4211-04: Next Answer Table  
4212-Schedule (Schedule Setup)  
4212-[01-10]: Schedule Type  
4212-[01-10]: Routing Mailbox Number  
4212-[01-10]: Schedule Start Day  
4212-[01-10]: Schedule End Day  
DSX Program List  
943  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSX Program List  
4212-[01-10]: Schedule Run Date  
4212-[01-10]: Schedule Start Time  
4212-[01-10]: Schedule End Time  
Type 1 (Day of Week) Schedule Example  
Type 2 (Range of Days) Schedule Example  
Type 3 (Date) Schedule Example  
422x-Routing Mailbox  
4221-Setup (Routing Mailbox Setup)  
4221-01: Routing Mailbox Type  
4221-02: Routing Mailbox Voice Prompt Language  
4222-Routing Options  
4222-01: Dial Action Table  
4222-02: Time Limit for Dialing Commands  
4222-03: Screened Transfer Timeout  
4222-04: Fax Detection  
4222-05: Fax Extension  
4223-Announcement Opts (Announcement Mailbox Options)  
4223-01: Repeat Count  
4223-02: Hang Up After  
4223-03: Next Call Routing Mailbox  
4224-Directory Options (Directory Dialing Mailbox Options)  
4224-01: Directory List Number to Use  
4224-02: Time Limit for Dialing Commands  
4224-03: Screened Transfer Timeout  
4224-04: Extension Name Match  
4224-05: Minimum Number of Letters Required  
4224-06: Transfer Options  
4224-07: Next Call Routing Mailbox  
4224-08: Fax Detection  
4224-09: Fax Transfer Extension  
423x-Dial Actions (Dial Action Table Options)  
4231-Digit Assignment  
4231-01: Digit xx Action  
4231-01: Digit xx Routing Data  
STRF Action - Screened Transfer (1)  
UTRF Action - Unscreened Transfer (2)  
REC1 Action - Quick Message With Greeting (3)  
REC2 Action - Quick Message Without Greeting (4)  
LOGON Action - Log Onto Voice Mail (5)  
Hang Up Action (6)  
GOTO Action - Go to Mailbox (7)  
UND Action - Undefined Routing (0)  
Digits  
Caller Dialed Digits  
Ignore Digits  
No Routing  
Pause  
944  
DSX Program List  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSX Program List  
Maintenance Options: 9001 - 9042  
90xx-Utilities  
900x-Reset (Reset Utilities)  
9001-System (System Reset)  
9001-01: System Reset  
9002-Station (Station Reset)  
9002-01: Station Reset  
901x-Initialize (Initialize Utilities)  
9011-System (Initialize System)  
9011-01: System Initialization  
9012-Toll Restrictions (Initialize Toll Restriction)  
9012-01: Initialize Toll Restriction  
9013-CID Logs (Initialize Caller ID Logs)  
9013-01: Initialize Caller ID Logs  
9014-Ring Tones (Initialize Ring Tones)  
9014-01: Initialize Ring Tones  
902x-Copy  
9021-Station Copy  
9021-01: Station Copy  
9022-Line Copy  
9022-01: Line Copy  
903x-Swap Ports  
9031-Station Swap  
9031-01: Station Swap  
9032-Line Swap  
9032-01: Line Swap  
904x-Backup/Restore  
9041-Backup  
9041-01: Backup to CompactFlash  
9042-Restore  
9042-01: Restore from CompactFlash  
DSX Program List  
945  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DSX Program List  
946  
DSX Program List  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Index  
Call Forwarding Off Premises. . .51  
Call Forwarding Toggle in a Personal Speed Dial  
Bin. . .45  
Call Routing  
A
Account Codes. . .14  
And Emergency Calls. . .15  
Last Number Redial and Save. . .14  
Administrator for IntraMail. . .576  
Alphanumeric Display. . .21  
Announcement Mailbox. . .412  
Announcement Message. . .417  
Answer Schedule Override. . .418  
Answer Tables. . .420  
Flexible. . .487  
Call Routing Mailbox. . .450  
Call Screening. . .453  
Call Timer. . .55  
Call Waiting / Camp On. . .58  
Callback. . .61  
Caller ID. . .63  
Caller ID Integration with Voice Mail. . .63  
Caller ID on the SMDR Report. . .63  
Caller ID to Single Line Telephones. . .64  
Display Separator. . .64  
Second Call Caller ID. . .63  
Single and Multiple Message Format  
Compatibility. . .63  
Answering Machine  
Built-In Automated Attendant. . .436  
Answering Machine Emulation. . .425  
Answering Schedules  
Flexible. . .486  
Application Examples for IntraMail. . .399  
Attendant Call Queuing. . .22  
Attendant Position. . .24  
Auto Attendant Do Not Disturb. . .427  
Auto Erase or Save. . .429  
Auto Redial. . .28  
Auto Time Stamp. . .431  
Automated Attendant. . .433  
Built-In. . .436  
Third Party Caller ID Check. . .64  
Voice Mail. . .456  
Caller ID and Answering Machines. . .69  
Caller ID and Voice Mail. . .456  
Caller ID Logging. . .68  
Caller ID and Answering Machines. . .69  
Caller ID Return Call. . .525  
Calling the Automated Attendant. . .459  
Central Office Calls, Answering. . .74  
Central Office Calls, Placing. . .78  
Centrex Transfer. . .460  
Calling. . .459  
Automated Attendant Transfer. . .441  
Automatic Handsfree. . .30  
Automatic Hold. . .202  
Automatic Ring Down. . .32  
Automatic Routing for Rotary Dialing Callers. . .442  
Chaining Speed Dial Bins. . .316  
Check Key. . .86  
Circular Hunting. . .154  
Class of Service. . .88  
Company Greetings. . .550  
Conference. . .89  
B
C
Background Music. . .34  
Background Music Over External Page. . .260  
Barge In. . .36  
Battery Backup. . .38  
Bilingual Voice Prompts. . .443  
Built In Automated Attendant. . .436  
Conference, Meet-Me. . .91  
Conference, Unsupervised. . .92  
Conversation Record. . .462  
Conversation Record Key for a Co-worker’s  
Mailbox. . .372  
Conversation Record with Voice Mail. . .372  
Cordless Telephone. . .94  
Call Coverage Guard Timer. . .40  
Call Coverage Keys. . .40  
Call Forward to a Mailbox. . .447  
Call Forwarding. . .44  
D
Date and Time Stamp. . .581  
Date and Time with Voice Mail. . .580  
Delayed Ringing. . .95  
Deleting a Mailbox Security Code. . .522  
Deleting a Message. . .530  
Detecting a Fax. . .485  
Call Forwarding Toggle in a Personal Speed Dial  
Bin. . .45  
Mailbox. . .447  
Call Forwarding Cancel. . .44  
Call Forwarding Chaining. . .44  
Dial Action Table. . .465  
Dial Number Preview. . .96  
DSX Software Manual  
Index  
947  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Index  
Dial Tone Detection. . .98  
Dialing by Name. . .469  
G
Getting Recorded Help. . .490  
Go to a Mailbox. . .491  
GOTO. . .491  
Direct Inward Dialing. . .99  
ANI/DNIS Support. . .100  
Direct Inward Line. . .109  
Greeting. . .493  
Direct Line Access. . .115  
Greetings for Multiple Companies. . .550  
Group Call Pickup. . .184  
Group Listen. . .187  
Group Mailbox. . .497  
Group Ring. . .189  
Direct Station Selection (DSS). . .117  
Direct Station Selection (DSS) Console. . .120  
Account Code Key. . .15  
Directed Call Pickup. . .129  
Directory Dialing. . .131, 469  
Directory Dialing Mailbox. . .475  
Displaying the Message Count. . .528  
Distinctive Ringing. . .135  
Guest Mailbox. . .503  
H
Do Not Disturb. . .143  
Handsfree and Handsfree Answerback. . .195  
Hang Up. . .506  
Auto Attendant. . .427  
Do Not Disturb Override. . .146  
Door Box. . .147  
Door Chime Over External Page. . .260  
Headset Compatibility. . .198  
Help  
Recorded Help for IntraMail. . .490  
Hold. . .202  
Automatic Hold. . .202  
Exclusive Hold. . .202  
Intercom Hold. . .202  
System Hold. . .202  
Hold Message. . .541  
Hotline. . .207  
E
Equal Access Compatibility. . .152  
Erase or Save, Automatic. . .429  
Erasing All Messages. . .476  
Exclusive Hold. . .202  
Exiting a Mailbox. . .477  
Extended Ringing. . .153  
Extension Hunting. . .154  
Extension Hunting to Voice Mail. . .478  
Extension Locking. . .166  
Extension Mailbox  
Hunting  
Circular. . .154  
Terminal. . .155  
UCD. . .155  
Hunting to Voice Mail. . .478  
See Subscriber Mailbox. . .574  
External Paging. . .259  
External Transfer. . .483  
I
Idle Menu Message Count. . .528  
Idle Prime Lines. . .274  
Instruction Menu. . .507  
Interactive Soft Keys. . .210  
Intercom. . .211  
Intercom Calls  
Off-Hook Signaling. . .255  
Intercom Hold. . .202  
F
Fax Detection. . .485  
Feature Glossary for IntraMail. . .402  
Feature Keys. . .169  
Flash. . .177  
Flexible Answering Schedules. . .486  
Flexible Call Routing. . .487  
Flexible Mailbox Numbering Plan. . .488  
Flexible Numbering Plan. . .179  
Forced Account Codes. . .14  
Forced Line Disconnect. . .182  
Forced Unscreened Transfer. . .489  
Forwarding a Message. . .531  
Intercom Prime Line. . .274  
Intercom Ring Over External Page. . .260  
Internal Paging. . .259  
IntraMail  
Application Examples. . .399  
Feature Glossary. . .402  
Remote Programming. . .564  
Specifications. . .398  
Start-up (Default) Configuration. . .395  
Start-Up Programming. . .396  
System Administrator. . .576  
948  
Index  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Menu  
Instruction. . .507  
Mailbox Options. . .520  
Main. . .523  
Message  
K
L
Key Ring. . .214  
Lamping for Messages. . .549  
Language Selection. . .217  
Language Selection and SMDR. . .217  
Languages  
Bilingual Voice Prompts. . .443  
Last Number Redial. . .219  
Leaving a Message. . .509  
Leaving a Message in Voice Mail. . .372  
Line Group Routing. . .223  
Line Groups. . .225  
Announcement. . .417  
Listen. . .512  
Quick. . .560  
Message Center Mailbox. . .373  
Message Count Display. . .528  
Message Delete. . .530  
Message Erase. . .476  
Message Forward. . .531  
Message Length. . .533  
Message Listen Mode. . .534  
Message Notification. . .535  
Message on Hold. . .541  
Message Playback Direction. . .543  
Message Reply. . .545  
Message Retention. . .547  
Message Storage Limit. . .548  
Message Waiting. . .238  
Message Waiting Lamp. . .549  
Messaging  
Leaving a Message. . .509  
Microphone Mute. . .241  
Monitor / Silent Monitor. . .243  
Multilingual Voice Prompts. . .443  
Multiple Company Greetings. . .550  
Multiple Directory Numbers. . .245  
Music on Hold. . .246  
Line Keys. . .227  
Line Queuing / Line Callback. . .230  
Listening Mode for Messages. . .534  
Listening to Messages. . .512  
Log Onto Voice Mail. . .515  
Loop Keys. . .233  
M
Mail Menu. . .523  
Mailbox  
Announcement. . .412  
Call Routing. . .450  
Call Routing, Next. . .552  
Directory Dialing. . .475  
Group. . .497  
Guest. . .503  
Logging onto a Mailbox. . .515  
Next Call Routing. . .552  
Ring Group. . .497  
N
Name  
Routing. . .566  
Mailbox. . .518  
Shared. . .497  
Subscriber. . .574  
System Administrator. . .578  
Transfer. . .583  
Name Dialing. . .469  
Names for Extensions and Lines. . .249  
Next Call Routing Mailbox. . .552  
Night Service / Night Ring. . .252  
UCD Hunting Group. . .497  
Mailbox Call Forwarding. . .447  
Mailbox Exit. . .477  
Notifying when you have new messages. . .535  
Numbering Plan for Mailboxes. . .488  
Numeric Prompts. . .443  
Mailbox Greeting. . .493  
Mailbox Name. . .518  
Mailbox Numbering Plan. . .488  
Mailbox Options Menu. . .520  
Mailbox Password. . .570  
Mailbox Security Code Delete. . .522  
Make Call. . .525  
Master Mailbox  
See Group Mailbox. . .527  
Meet-Me Conference. . .236  
O
Off-Hook Signaling. . .255  
Off-Hook Signaling for Hotline Calls. . .255  
Off-Site Message Notification. . .535  
One-Touch Keys. . .258  
Optional (Unforced) Account Codes. . .14  
Options for a Mailbox. . .520  
Outside Calls  
DSX Software Manual  
Index  
949  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Off Hook Signaling. . .255  
Overflow  
Priority vs. Prime Line. . .296  
Rotary Dialing Callers  
Automatic Routing. . .442  
Routing  
To Voice Mail. . .590  
Voice Mail. . .373  
Undefined. . .586  
Routing a Call  
Flexible. . .487  
Routing Mailbox. . .566  
P
Paging. . .259  
Background Music Over External Page. . .260  
Door Chime Over External Page. . .260  
Intercom Ring Over External Page. . .260  
S
Paging, Meet-Me Conference. . .265  
Park. . .266  
Save Number Dialed. . .298  
Schedule Override. . .418  
Schedules  
Flexible Answering Schedules. . .486  
Screened Transfer. . .567  
Screening Your Calls. . .453  
Password for Mailbox. . .570  
PBX / Centrex Compatibility. . .270  
PC Program (System Administrator). . .272  
Playback Direction for Messages. . .543  
Prime Line Preference. . .274  
Intercom Prime Line. . .274  
Priority vs. Ringing Line Preference. . .274  
Priority  
Security Code. . .570  
Security Code Delete for a Mailbox. . .522  
Selectable Display Messaging. . .300  
Sending a Message for a Co-Worker. . .562  
Setting the Message Playback Direction. . .543  
Shared Mailbox. . .497  
Prime Line vs. Ringing Line Preference. . .274,  
296  
Privacy. . .277  
Sharing an IntraMail with Multiple Companies. . .550  
Silent Monitor. . .304  
Single Digit Dialing. . .572  
Single Line Telephones. . .305  
Soft Keys. . .314  
Privacy Release Groups. . .278  
Private Line. . .280  
Programmable Idle Menu Soft Keys (Super  
Display). . .282  
Programming IntraMail Remotely. . .564  
Programming Voice Mail. . .558  
Pulse to Tone Conversion. . .285  
Speed Dial. . .315  
Speed DiL  
Storing Line Routing in a Speed Dial Bin. . .315  
Split (Alternate). . .323  
Start-up (Default) Configuration for IntraMail. . .395  
Start-up Programming for IntraMail. . .396  
Station Instruments. . .325  
Station Message Detail Recording. . .328  
Storage Limit for Messages. . .548  
Subscriber Mailbox. . .574  
Q
R
Quick Message. . .560  
Record and Send a Message. . .562  
Recorded Help for IntraMail. . .490  
Recording a Conversation. . .462  
Recording a Name for your Mailbox. . .518  
Regional Defaults. . .286  
Reinitializing the system. . .579  
Remote Programming for IntraMail. . .564  
Removing Lines and Extensions from Service. . .287  
Replying to a Message. . .545  
Greeting. . .493  
System Administrator. . .576  
System Administrator (PC Program). . .333  
System Administrator Mailbox. . .578  
System Hold. . .202  
System Identification. . .334  
System Programming Backup and Restore. . .335  
System Programming Password Protection. . .336  
System Reinitialization. . .579  
Return Call. . .525  
Reverse Voice Over. . .289  
Ring Groups. . .292  
Ring Over Page Volume Adjustment. . .260  
Ringdown Extension. . .293  
T
T1 Calling. . .338  
FSK Caller ID. . .338  
Tandem Calling / Unsupervised Conference. . .341  
Ringing Line Preference. . .295  
950  
Index  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Terminal Hunting. . .155  
Tie Lines. . .344  
Time and Date. . .349  
Time and Date Stamp. . .581  
Time and Date with Voice Mail. . .580  
Time Stamp  
Voice Over. . .385  
Voice Prompting Messages. . .593  
Voice Prompts  
. . .443  
Bilingual. . .443  
Volume Control with Voice Mail. . .594  
Volume Controls. . .388  
Auto. . .431  
Toll Restriction. . .351  
Transfer. . .358  
W
Centrex. . .460  
Walking Class of Service. . .392  
External. . .483  
Forced Unscreened. . .489  
Screened. . .567  
To a Mailbox. . .583  
To a UCD Group with IntraMail. . .585  
Unscreened. . .587  
Transfer to a Mailbox. . .583  
Transfer to a UCD Group. . .585  
Transferring to Voice Mail. . .372  
U
UCD Group Transfer with IntraMail. . .585  
UCD Hunting. . .155  
UCD Hunting and Call Coverage Keys. . .155  
Undefined Routing. . .586  
Unscreened Transfer. . .587  
Unscreened Transfer, Forced. . .489  
Unsupervised Conference. . .367  
User Greeting. . .493  
User Mailbox  
See Subscriber Mailbox. . .574  
User Programmable Features. . .368  
V
Verified Account Codes. . .14  
Voice Mail. . .372  
Caller ID. . .456  
Conversation Record. . .372  
Conversation Record Key for a Co-worker’s  
Mailbox. . .372  
Hunting to. . .478  
Leaving a Message. . .372  
Logon. . .515  
Message Center Mailbox. . .373  
Overflow. . .373  
Programming. . .558  
Time and Date. . .580  
Transferring to Voice Mail. . .372  
Volume Control. . .594  
Voice Mail and Caller ID. . .456  
Voice Mail Overflow. . .590  
DSX Software Manual  
Index  
951  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
952  
Index  
DSX Software Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NEC Unified Solutions, Inc.  
4 Forest Parkway, Shelton, CT 06484  
Tel: 800-365-1928 Fax: 203-926-5458  
www.necunifiedsolutions.com  
Other Important Telephone Numbers  
Sales: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203-926-5450  
Customer Service: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203-926-5444  
Customer Service FAX: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203-926-5454  
Technical Service: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203-925-8801  
Discontinued Product Service: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .900-990-2541  
Technical Training: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203-926-5430  
Emergency Technical Service (After Hours): . . . . . . . .203-929-7920  
(Excludes discontinued products)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NEC Unied Solutions, Inc.  
4 Forest Parkway, Shelton, CT 06484  
TEL: 203-926-5400 FAX: 203-929-0535  
www.necuniedsolutions.com  
( 1 0 9 3 1 0 0 )  
Printed in U.S.A.  
June 9, 2006, Rev 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Miele Oven DG 6100 User Manual
Multiquip Staple Gun MVH 200GH User Manual
Niles Audio Home Theater System PRO15SW User Manual
NuTone Ventilation Hood WHV 30BD WHV 36BD User Manual
Oreck Air Cleaner 21057 03 User Manual
Oregon Scientific Thermometer RAR621 User Manual
Oregon Scientific Thermometer RMR682A User Manual
Panasonic Cordless Telephone KX TGE210 User Manual
Panasonic Vacuum Cleaner MC CG467 User Manual
ParaBody Home Gym 205101 User Manual